CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN,...

834
CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) VOLUME 1 DESIGN AND CONTRACT STANDARDS OFFICE ISSN 2291-0298 (2-VOLUME SET) © Copyright Queen’s Printer for Ontario 2017 Reproduced With Permission

Transcript of CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN,...

Page 1: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATINGANDDOCUMENTATION(CDED)

VOLUME 1

DESIGN AND CONTRACT STANDARDS OFFICE ISSN 2291-0298 (2-VOLUME SET)

© Copyright Queen’s Printer for Ontario 2017 Reproduced With Permission

Page 2: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 3: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE

to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL

VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B

This sheet should be retained permanently in this page sequence in the Manual. All revised material should be inserted as soon as received and the relevant entries made by hand in the spaces provided to show who incorporated the Revision and the date this was done. If this practice is followed faithfully it will be a simple matter to tell whether or not this copy of the Manual is up to date since all future Revisions will be dated.

Revision Entered By Date

No. Dated

This manual includes Revision 217 dated August 31, 2017

Page 4: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 5: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Disclaimer

To all users of this publication: The information contained herein has been carefully compiled and is believed to be accurate at the date of publication. Freedom from error however cannot be guaranteed. Portable Document Format (PDF) copies of this manual are available for download, free of charge, from the MTO Technical Publications website at: http://www.raqs.mto.gov.on.ca/techpubs/cded.nsf/ Enquiries regarding amendments, suggestions or comments to the CDED manual and its contents can be submitted via e-mail to: [email protected] or may be directed to:

ISSN 2291-0298 © Copyright Queen’s Printer for Ontario 2017

Ministry of Transportation Design & Contract Standards Office Highway Standards Branch 301 St. Paul Street, 2nd Floor St. Catharines, Ontario L2R 7R4 Tel Number: (905) 704-2293 Fax Number: (905) 704-2051

Ministère des Transports Bureau de la conception et des normes de contrats Direction des normes routières 301, rue St. Paul, 2e étage St. Catharines (Ontario) L2R 7R4 Tél. : (905) 704-2293 Téléc. : (905) 704-2051

August 2017 CDED A-001

Page 6: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 7: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS CDED - CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTMATING AND DOCUMENTATION MANUAL

A-001 Disclaimer

A-005 Table of Contents

A-010 Introduction to the CDED 1.0 CDED Volumes 2.0 August 2017 CDED Update 3.0 Feedback 4.0 Summary of Changes 5.0 Definitions

CHAPTER A - CONTRACT DOCUMENTATION

A-050 Chapter A - Title Page

A-100 Contract Documentation 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Offices Involved In Contract Documentation

a) Role of ESSMS b) Role of PFOS c) Role of P&D d) Role of RFAs

3.0 Ministry Policy Documents 3.1 CDED Manual 3.2 Other Manuals and Documents 4.0 Ministry Directives and Memoranda 4.1 Obtaining Copies of Ministry Directives and Memoranda 4.2 Naming and Numbering Convention 4.3 Directives and Memoranda Applicable to Contract Documentation

A-105 List of Directives and Memoranda

A-200 Standard Documentation 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Reviewing, Developing, and Updating Standard Documentation 2.1 Administrative Updates 2.2 Technical Updates

a) Consultation With Internal Stakeholders b) Consultation With External Stakeholders c) Timelines for Consultation and Review d) Version Selection

3.0 Developing and Updating Supporting Documentation 4.0 Publishing of Standard Documentation 5.0 Implementation of Changes In CPS 6.0 Categorization of Changes

a) Category 1 Changes b) Category 2 Changes

7.0 Submission of Changes to ESSMS 8.0 Communication of CPS Changes to Design Staff

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 8: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

A-205 List of Standard Documentation Custodians

A-210 Standard Documentation Numbering Protocol 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Numbering Protocol for Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) 3.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSS General & Construction Specifications 4.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSS Material Specifications 5.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSDs for Roads, Drainage & Structures 6.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSDs for Electrical Work

A-300 Non-Standard Documentation 1.0 Introduction 1.1 Types of NSSPs

a) Provincial / Head Office b) Regional c) Local

2.0 NSSP Clean-up Initiative 2.1 NSTI Clean-up Initiative 3.0 Policy for Management of Non-Standard Documentation 3.1 Non-Standard Tender Items (NSTIs) 3.2 Development of Non-Standard Documentation

a) Regional and Local Documentation for Minor Departures b) Regional and Local Documentation for Major Departures

3.3 Process for Development and Approval of Non-Standard Documentation 4.0 Implementation of Non-Standard Documentation in CPS

A-305 PFO Contact List for Endorsement of NSTIs and NSSPs

A-310 Non-Standard Documentation Endorsement Request Form (Coming Soon)

A-315 Sample Policy NSSPs (Coming Soon)

A-400 CPS Updates 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Changes to Standard Documentation 2.1 Types of Changes

a) Category 1 Changes b) Category 2 Changes

2.2 Incorporating Changes Into Contract Packages a) Incorporating Changes During the Production Stage b) Incorporating Changes During the Submission Stage c) Incorporating Changes During the Tendering Stage d) Incorporating Category 2 Changes - Special Cases

3.0 Changes to Non-Standard Documentation

CHAPTER B - DETAIL ESTIMATING

B-050 Chapter B - Title Page

B-110 Tender Items and Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Tender Items 2.1 Tender Item Status 2.2 Unit of Measure (UOM) and PQP Status 2.3 Item Type

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 9: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

2.4 Item Code and Title 2.5 Item Category 2.6 Item Asset Category 2.7 Column Type

a) Normal b) Variation

2.8 Tender Item Accessories 3.0 Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) 3.1 Measured Quantity (MQ) Items 3.2 Lump Sum (LS) Items 3.3 Adjusted Plan Quantity 3.4 Final Verification of PQP Quantities 4.0 Tender Items With Small Quantities

B-120 Contingencies and Allowances 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Operations Requiring the Application of an Allowance 3.0 Application of Allowances and Percentages

B-130 Checking of Quantities 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Checking 3.0 Checking of Items Paid for by an Outside Agency 4.0 Checking Verification

B-150 List of Active Standard Tender Items

B-180 Writer's Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections 1.0 Introduction 1.1 Contract Documentation 1.2 Authors and Readers of CDED Chapter B Sections 1.3 Writing Chapter B Sections 1.4 Section, Sub-section Numbering and Headings 2.0 Step Process to Write a Draft CDED Chapter B section 2.1 Use of Words 3.0 References 3.1 Reference Documents (as applicable to this guide) 4.0 Tender Items 5.0 Specifications 6.0 Special Provisions 7.0 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) 8.0 Standard Drawings 9.0 Design 10.0 Computation 11.0 Documentation

B-190 List of Active Detail Estimating Sections

B-201… Copies of Detail Estimating Sections

CHAPTER C - DESIGNATED SOURCES FOR MATERIALS

C-050 Chapter C - Title Page

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 10: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

C-100 Designated Sources for Materials 1.0 Introduction 2.0 The Road Authority (TRA) 3.0 Prequalification 3.1 Product Classification 3.2 The Classification Process 3.3 Classification Matrix 4.0 MTO's DSM Requirements for Listing of Vendors and Products 4.1 Custodial Office Criteria for Creation of a New DSM Listing 5.0 DSM Online Interface 5.1 System Access for DSM Custodians 5.2 Deadline for Submission of Listings 6.0 Delisting of Vendors 6.1 Standard Wording for Delisting Notice

C-110 MTO and TRA Contact Information

C-120 DSM Custodial Offices Contact List

C-130 DSM Custodian List

CHAPTER D - SPECIFICATIONS

D-050 Chapter D - Title Page

D-200 OPSSs 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Implementation of OPSSs in CPS 3.0 List of Active OPSSs 4.0 OPSS Number 5.0 Type 6.0 Title 7.0 Issue Date 8.0 Implementation Date

D-205 List of Active OPSSs

CHAPTER E - SPECIAL PROVISIONS

E0 Chapter E - Title Page

E0-2 Chapter E - Introduction

E1-0 E1.0 Special Provisions 1.0.1 Reference Documents 1.1 General 1.1.1 How SPs Fit within the Contract Documents 1.1.2 Implementation of Special Provisions 1.2 Functions of a Special Provision 1.3 Types of Special Provisions 1.3.1 Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) 1.3.2 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 11: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

E2-0 E2.0 Writing Guidelines For Special Provisions (SPs) 2.1 Introduction 2.2 Principles Of Writing Special Provisions 2.3 Special Provision Formatting 2.4 Special Provision Style

E2Ap1 Appendix 1 - Formatting Guidelines for SSPs

E2Ap2 Appendix 2 - Sample SSPs

E2ApN1... Sample Copies

ESAp3 Appendix 3 - Standard Statements for Amendments to OPSSs

E3-0 Information About Copies of Standard Special Provisions

100S02… Copies of Standard Special Provisions

E-3-1 List of Active Standard Special Provisions

CHAPTER F - PLANS, DRAWINGS, AND QUANTITY SHEETS

F-050 CHAPTER F - Title Page

F-200 Standard Drawings 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Standard Drawings 3.0 Incorporating Standard Drawings Into the Contract Package 4.0 Modification of Standard Drawings

F-210 OPSDs 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Implementation of OPSDs for Use by MTO 3.0 Copies of OPSDs 4.0 List of Active OPSDs 5.0 OPSD Number 6.0 Title 7.0 Issue Date 8.0 Implementation Date 9.0 Drawing Revision Number 10.0 Use and Modification of OPSDs 11.0 Documenting Modified OPSDs in Contract Documents

F-215 Lists of Active OPSDs

F-220 MTODs 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Implementation and Publishing of MTODs 3.0 Copies of MTODs 4.0 List of Active MTODs 5.0 MTOD Number 6.0 Title 7.0 Issue Date 8.0 Implementation Date 9.0 Drawing Revision Number 10.0 Office

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 12: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

11.0 Remarks 12.0 Use of MTODs 13.0 Modification of MTODs 14.0 Documenting Modified MTODs in Contract Documents

F-225 List of Active MTODs

101.070… Copies of Division 100 to 900 MTODs

F-235 List of Active SSDs

F-300 Contract Plans 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Incorporating Contract Plans Into the Contract Package 3.0 ASLs and CASLs 4.0 Foundation Investigation Reports (FIRs) 5.0 Soils Profiles 6.0 Contract Drawing Books

a) Contract Drawings b) Quantity Sheets

F-400 Contract Drawings 1.0 Introduction 2.0 MTO AutoCAD Standards Guide 3.0 Preparation of Contract Drawings

F-500 Quantity Sheets 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Types of Quantity Sheets 3.0 Cover Page for Quantity Sheet Booklets 4.0 Index 5.0 Preparation of Quantity Sheets 6.0 Quantity Sheets for Limited Plans Contracts 7.0 Sample Index Sheet 8.0 Sample Quantity Sheets

F-505 Sample Index Sheet

F-510 Sample Quantity Sheets

CHAPTER G - TENDER DOCUMENTS

G-050 CHAPTER G - Title Page

G-200 Contract Preparation System (CPS) 1.0 Introduction 2.0 CPS Access Roles 3.0 CPS User’s Training Guide 4.0 Obtaining Access to CPS 4.1 Assistance With CPS Technical Issues 4.2 Assistance With CPS Content 5.0 CPS Definitions

G-300 Work Projects 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Types of Contracts and Work Project Files

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 13: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

a) Large/Major Capital Work Project Types b) Small/Minor Capital Work Project Types c) Maintenance Work Project Types

3.0 Recent Changes to Use of Work Project Types in CPS 4.0 Assignment of Group and Work Project Numbers

G-400 Form of Tender 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Proposed Work 3.0 Allocation of Funds 4.0 Services Sundry 5.0 Acquisitions/Constructions of Physical Assets

a) Force Accounts and Contingencies b) Utilities and Work by Others

6.0 Recoverables to Ministry and Province 7.0 Supplies By MTO to Contractors 7.1 Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner 7.2 List of Materials Supplied for Specific Tender Items 7.3 Free on Board (F.O.B.) 7.4 Manual Editing of the Schedule of Materials

G-500 Tender Document 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Cover Page

a) Tender Closing Date and Time b) Contract Information and Location c) Qualified Versus Designated Contracts d) Classification and Ratings

3.0 Table of Contents 4.0 Tender Item List 5.0 Instructions to Bidders 6.0 Conflict of Interest Declaration 7.0 Schedule of Provisions, Plans, Drawings, Specifications and GCs 8.0 Signed Statement and Tax Compliance Declaration 9.0 Section A: Special Provisions 9.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

a) General NSSPs b) Item Specific NSSPs

9.2 Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) a) General SSPs (100 Series) b) Item Specific SSPs (200 to 900 Series) c) Fill-In SSPs d) Modified SSPs

9.3 Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner 10.0 Section B: Fair Wage Program (FWP) 11.0 Section C: Liquidated Damages

a) Working Days and Charges (Formerly SSP 100F09) b) Fixed Completion Date and Charges (Formerly SSP 100F10)

G-600 Addenda 1.0 Introduction 1.1 Transferring Ownership of the CPS File 1.2 Transferring Ownership of the HiCo File 1.3 QDCHANGE NSSP 1.4 Addenda Structure 2.0 Revising Tender Items

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 7 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 14: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

a) Linking an Item to an Existing SSP b) Adding a New Tender Item c) Deleting a Tender Item

3.0 Revising Plans a) Adding a Foundation Report(s) or Aggregate Source List

4.0 Revising Special Provisions a) Adding a New SSP or NSSP b) Deleting a Special Provision c) Replacing an SSP with a New Version d) Replacing an SSP with a Modified Version e) Special Provisions in Multiple Addenda

5.0 Revising Liquidated Damages SP 6.0 Revising Contract Drawings

a) New Drawings Added to the End of an Existing Book b) New Drawings Added Within an Existing Book c) Revising an Existing Drawing d) Deleting an Existing Drawing

7.0 Revising Quantity Sheets a) Revising a Single Quantity Sheet in a Run b) Revising Quantity Sheets in More Than One Consecutive Run c) Revising Many Quantity Sheets Throughout Several Runs in a Book d) Revising Quantity Sheets in Subsequent Addenda e) Adding New Quantity Sheets to the End of the Last Book f) Printing of Quantity Sheets

8.0 Issuing an Extension of Time 9.0 Formatting the Addenda Tender Document

a) Document Header b) Removal of White Space

10.0 The Tender Item List

CHAPTER H - CONTRACT REVIEW, SUBMISSION, AND TENDERING

H-050 CHAPTER H - Title Page

H-100 Contract Review 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Preparation of the Contract Package 3.0 Assembly of the Final Contract Package 4.0 Review of the Final Contract Package

H-200 Contract Submission 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Submission to Regional Contract Review Office (CRO) 3.0 Submission to Contract Tendering Section (CTS) 4.0 CTS Submission Guidelines

a) Submission Enquiries b) Due Dates c) Rejection of Submissions d) Regional Review of Documents Posted on RAQS/MERX e) Contract Drawing Book

5.0 Attachments That Do Not Form Part of the Contract 6.0 Changes After Submission 7.0 Review and Submission of Addenda

a) Review of Addenda b) Submission of Addenda

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 8 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 15: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Table of Contents

H-300 Contract Tendering 1.0 Introduction 2.0 Requirements for Tendering 3.0 Highway Costing System (HiCo) 4.0 Award / Non-Award Process 5.0 Contract Award

H-400 CTS Checklists and Forms

H-401 Contract Package Review Checklist (Coming Soon)

H-402 Addenda Package Review Checklist (Coming Soon)

H-410 Contract Package Submission Form (Coming Soon)

H-411 Design Build Contract Package Submission Form (Coming Soon)

H-420 Foundation Investigation Reports - Cover Page

H-422 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - Central Region

H-423 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - West Region

H-424 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - Eastern Region

H-425 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - Northeastern Region

H-426 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - Northwestern Region

H-427 Contract Drawings - Cover Page - Addendum

H-430 Quantity Sheets - Cover Page

H-431 Quantity Sheets - Cover Page - Addendum

CHAPTER I - REGIONAL GUIDELINES, FORMS, AND INFORMATION (Coming Soon)

I-050 CHAPTER I - Title Page (Coming Soon)

I-200 Central Region Guidelines, Forms, and Information (Coming Soon)

I-300 West Region Guidelines, Forms, and Information (Coming Soon)

I-400 Eastern Region Guidelines, Forms, and Information (Coming Soon)

I-500 Northeastern Region Guidelines, Forms, and Information (Coming Soon)

I-600 Northwestern Region Guidelines, Forms, and Information (Coming Soon)

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 9 of 9 CDED A-005

Page 16: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 17: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

INTRODUCTION TO THE CDED MANUAL 1.0 CDED Volumes

The Contract Design Estimating and Documentation (CDED) Manual consists of four volumes: Volumes 1&2 - Contains information common to all types of contracts. Volume 3 - Contains information specific to Electrical work. Volume 4 - Contains information specific to Advanced Traffic Management

System (ATMS) work. References throughout this document to individual chapters, etc., refer specifically to the "main" CDED Volumes 1 & 2, unless otherwise noted. The intent of the Contract Design Estimating and Documentation (CDED) Manual is to ensure that Contract Documents are prepared in a consistent manner across the province and that the methods of calculation, formatting, language, and content are as accurate and consistent as possible. The CDED Manual provides extensive guidelines to support this goal and it is important for Custodians and Designers to avoid using previous documentation as "templates" when preparing new contract documentation. Previous contract documentation is often quickly out of date due to the rapid pace of change in today's engineering environment therefore the CDED should always be used as the primary and authoritative source of up-to-date information for contract documentation.

The CDED Manual is the Authoritative Source of Information for Contract Documentation.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 18: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

2.0 August 2017 CDED Manual Update August 2017 represents a significant update to the CDED Manual. The CDED has been revised and expanded to provide Designers, Custodians, Service Providers, and technical staff with fundamental information necessary to support the thorough and accurate completion of contract documentation, detail estimating, contract preparation, and contract tendering. Under this initiative a substantial amount of NEW content has been added, several chapters have been reassigned to accommodate the new information, and a significant amount of pre-existing content has been cancelled, moved, revised, or expanded. All of the content has been prepared by the Engineering Standards Analyst within the Engineering Standards and Specifications Management Section (ESSMS). Content with the (UNDER REVIEW) notation beside the issue date in the footer should be treated as draft. In the coming months these sections will be revised, where necessary, based on feedback from users and review by the Contract Documentation Committee (CDC) formerly the Design Implementation Committee (DIC). Revised content will be issued via the usual CPS Update process. Also, additional content is still under development and will be released in the coming months.

3.0 Feedback Ministry staff and Service Providers are asked to review all of the content in detail, and are encouraged to submit comments, questions, and suggestions to the following e-mail address:

[email protected]

4.0 Summary of Changes

Changes made under the "August 2017 CDED Manual Update" are summarized in the following table:

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 19: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

AUGUST 2017 CDED MANUAL UPDATE Summary of Changes

(A) Contract Documentation

• Contains NEW content about documentation policies and the development, implementation, incorporation, and use of contract documentation.

(B) Detail Estimating

• Contains NEW content about tender items and Plan Quantity Payment (PQP).

• Contains revised and expanded content about writing detail estimating sections, calculating contingencies and allowances, and checking of quantities, from former Chapter B sections.

• Contains existing detail estimating sections for guidance with the estimating and documentation of tender items.

(C) Designated Sources for Materials

• Contains NEW content about the Ministry's official list of pre-qualified products and vendors, custodial office information, and criteria for creation of new listings and delisting of vendors.

(D) Specifications

• Contains revised and expanded content about specifications and

OPSSs from former Chapter H.

(E) Special Provisions

• Contains existing information about the content and use of SSPs, writer's guide for assistance with the development and updating of SPs, copies and samples of SSPs, and SP formatting guidelines.

• The content of this chapter is under review and will be revised, expanded, and released at a later date.

(F) Plans, Drawings, and Quantity Sheets

• Contains NEW content about plans, drawings, and quantity sheets.

• Contains revised and expanded content about the preparation of quantity sheets and standard drawings from former Chapters G, H, and I.

(G) Tender Documents

• Contains NEW content about the use of CPS and the preparation of tender documents and addenda.

• Contains revised and expanded content about tender forms including services sundry, supplies by MTO, acquisitions / constructions of physical assets, and recoverables from former Chapters C and D.

(H) Contract Review, Submission, and Tendering

• Contains NEW content about the review, submission, and tendering of contract packages and addenda.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 20: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

5.0 Definitions For the purpose of this Manual, the following definitions apply: Actual Measurement means the field measurement of that quantity within the specified limits of the work. Addendum means an addition to or a change in the Contract Documents issued prior to tender closing. Agreement means the signed document between the Minister or delegated representative and the Contractor for the performance of the Work included in the Contract Documents. Contract means the undertaking by the Owner and the Contractor to perform their respective duties, responsibilities, and obligations as prescribed in the Contract Documents. Contract Administrator means the person, partnership, or corporation designated by the Owner to be the Owner's representative for the purposes of the Contract. Contract Bulletin means a publication of MTO on the MTO’s website www.raqs.merx.com. Contract Documents means the Agreement, Tender, MTO General Conditions of Contract, Standard Specifications and Drawings, Special Provisions, Contract Drawings, Addenda incorporated into any aforementioned document, documents referenced in the aforementioned documents, and subsequent amendments to any of these documents made pursuant to the provisions of the Agreement. Contract Drawings or Contract Plans mean drawings or plans provided by the Owner for the Work and without limiting the generality thereof may include soil profiles, foundation investigation reports, reinforcing steel schedules, aggregate sources lists, quantity sheets, and cross-sections. Contractor means the person, partnership, or corporation undertaking the Work as identified in the Agreement. Contract Package means the collective set of Contract Documents, Design Documents, and other attachments that are assembled into a Contract Package suitable for the tendering of a highway capital project for the construction, repair, or rehabilitation of provincial highway infrastructure. Contract Preparation means the preparation and assembly of the Design Documents into a Contract Package for a particular project.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 21: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

Design Documents means the specific Contract Documents that have been developed, revised, and incorporated into a particular design project. Designer means any Ministry and/or Service Provider staff involved in the completion of the Contract Documents for a highway capital project. Design Team means the Ministry and/or Service Provider staff involved in the design and preparation of a particular Contract Package for a highway capital project. Engineer means a professional engineer licensed by the Professional Engineers Ontario to practice in the Province of Ontario. Estimate means a calculation of the quantity or cost of the Work or part of it, depending on the context. Highway means a common and public highway any part of which is intended for or used by the general public for the passage of vehicles and includes the area between the lateral property lines thereof. Lump Sum Item means a tender item indicating a portion of the Work for which payment shall be made at a single tendered price. Payment is not based on a measured quantity, although a quantity may be given in the Contract Documents. Material means material, machinery, equipment, and fixtures forming part of the Work. Owner means the party to the Agreement for whom the Work is being performed, as identified in the Agreement, and includes, with the same meaning and import, “Authority.” Plan Quantity means that quantity as computed from within the boundary lines of the Work as shown in the Contract Documents. Quantity Sheet means a list of the locations, estimated design quantities, and other details of Work to be completed for tender items. Record Drawings mean marked-up Contract Drawings prepared by the Contractor that show all differences, design changes, and deviations from the original Contract Drawings. Regional Operations Office means the Operations Office in the MTO Region administering the Contract. Service Provider means those providing services for the completion of outsourced highway design projects.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 22: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED MANUAL Introduction to the CDED Manual

Special Provision means special direction within the Contract Documents containing requirements particular to the Work. Standard means, when used alone, the generic term for Standard Specifications and Standard Drawings. Standard Specification or Standard Drawing means a standard practice required and stipulated by the Owner for performance of the Work. Tender Item means a material, component, product, or process required for the construction of the Work Project. Work means the total construction and related services required by the Contract Documents. Working Drawings or Working Plans means any drawings or plans prepared by the Contractor for the execution of the Work and may, without limiting the generality thereof, include falsework and formwork plans, roadway protection plans, shop drawings, shop plans, or erection diagrams.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 6 CDED A-010

Page 23: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

CHAPTER A

CONTRACT DOCUMENTATION

August 2017 CDED A-050

Page 24: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 25: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

CONTRACT DOCUMENTATION 1.0 Introduction

Contract documentation involves the development, implementation, and use of Contract and Design Documents for use in highway capital projects. The development and implementation of new and revised Contract Documents occurs on a continual basis and is generally initiated by the Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs). When the development of new or revised documentation is initiated by members of a Design Team in response to the unique conditions encountered on a particular design project, then the documentation is developed in cooperation between the members of the Design Team and the PFO. Contract Preparation involves the preparation and assembly of the Design Documents into a Contract Package for a particular project. It takes place during the detail design phase of a highway capital project for the construction, repair, or rehabilitation of provincial highway infrastructure. Design Documents are the specific Contract Documents that have been developed, revised, and incorporated into a particular design project. A Contract Package is the collective set of Contract Documents, Design Documents, and other attachments that are assembled into a package suitable for the tendering of a highway capital project. Design Documents and Contract Packages are prepared by internal design staff as well as external Service Providers working on behalf of the Ministry. Contract and Design Documents generally consist of:

• Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs) • Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) • Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) • Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs) • Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTODs) • Structural Standard Drawings (SSDs) • Contract Plans, Contract Drawings, and Quantity Sheets • Agreement, Tender, MTO General Conditions, and Addenda

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 26: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

2.0 Offices Involved In Contract Documentation The primary offices involved in the development and implementation of Contract Documents and the preparation of a Contract Package for the tendering of highway capital projects are:

a) Engineering Standards and Specification Management Section (ESSMS) b) Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs) c) Highway Planning & Design (P&D) d) Regional Functional Areas/Specialty Offices (RFOs)

a) Role of ESSMS In regards to contract documentation the primary role of the Engineering Standards and Specification Management Section (ESSMS) is assisting in the development and implementation of standard and non-standard documentation. ESSMS is the custodian of the CDED manual and is responsible for improving the overall consistency and quality of Contract Documents.

b) Role of PFOs In regards to contract documentation the primary role of the Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs) is the development of both standard and non-standard Contract Documents. The main PFOs involved in developing contract documentation are:

• Design and Contract Standards Office (DCSO) - Engineering Standards & Specification Management Section - Design Standards Section

• Materials Engineering and Research Office (MERO)

- Bituminous - Concrete - Pavements & Foundations - Soils & Aggregates

• Bridge Office (BO) • Environmental Policy Office (EPO)

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 27: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

• Contract Management Office (CMO) - Contract Award - Tendering & Estimating - Construction & Engineering - Construction Contracts

• Contract Innovations Office (CIO) • Traffic Office (TO)

- Electrical Engineering - Intelligent Transportation Systems (ITS) Program - Safety & Information Management - Traffic Operations Engineering

c) Role of P&D The regional Highway Planning and Design (P&D) sections are responsible for the management, design, and delivery of highway capital projects administered by the Ontario Ministry of Transportation (Ministry). Within P&D, the Project Manager is the person responsible for the delivery of a highway capital project and the coordination of the Design Team members involved in the completion of the project. Within P&D, the Designer is the person(s) responsible for the preparation of Design Documents, the estimating of quantities and costs, and the assembly of all of the necessary documents into a Contract Package suitable for the tendering of a highway capital project. The term "Designer" is used throughout the CDED Manual and shall be understood to mean any Ministry or Service Provider staff involved in the contract documentation and contract preparation process.

d) Role of RFAs

During design, Regional Functional Areas (RFAs) and specialty offices provide support to P&D for the design and delivery of highway capital projects. The main RFAs involved are:

• Drainage and Hydrology • Electrical • Environmental • Geomatics • Geotechnical

• Operations • Property • Structural • Traffic

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 28: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

3.0 Ministry Policy Documents

Unless otherwise specified, Ministry manuals, directives, memoranda and standards represent “POLICY” and are to be followed for all activities related to contract documentation, contract preparation, and contract tendering. Deviations from policy are to be identified and approved. Some deviations will be approved by the Manager, Engineering and some will require approval by the Highway Standards Branch. When there is a need to deviate from policy, the justification and associated approval is an integral part of project documentation.

3.1 CDED Manual The Contract Design, Estimating and Documentation (CDED) Manual is the primary document and authoritative source of information for the development and implementation of Contract Documents, the detail estimating of Tender Items, the preparation of Design Documents, the assembly of Contract Packages, and the Tendering of capital projects for the construction, repair, or rehabilitation of provincial highway infrastructure.

3.2 Other Manuals and Documents

Other manuals and documents to support highway planning and design, contract documentation and preparation, and the delivery of the Ministry's Capital Construction Program are available from the Ministry's Project Management Best Practices (PMBP) website under Reference Materials.

4.0 Ministry Directives and Memoranda The Ministry Directive System is administered by the Corporate Business Services Branch (CBSB) and it is the official method of disseminating policy within the Ministry. Further information on issuing, revising, and cancelling Ministry Directives can be obtained from the CBSB, Executive Office. Directives are issued as permanent references at three authority levels: by the Deputy Minister, by a division or branch head, or by a branch head or office manager. Provincial Memoranda are issued by the Provincial Offices to inform of any new or upcoming changes to Ministry policy, standards and guidelines.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 29: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

Regional Offices may prepare Regional Directives and/or Memoranda to provide additional guidance. These Regional Directives and/or Memoranda should only be used when provincially issued policy documents, manuals, memoranda, etc. do not address a matter. Prior to relying on the information in a directive or memorandum, users must confirm if the directive or memorandum and content is still current/active.

4.1 Obtaining Copies of Ministry Directives and Memoranda Copies of Ministry directives can be obtained from the Ministry's intranet site under PHM, Resources, Directives. Copies of memoranda can be obtained from the Ministry's Project Management Best Practices (PMBP) website under Reference Materials.

Selected directives and memoranda are also available in the Contract Preparation System (CPS) application however their individual status as active or obsolete does not necessarily reflect their current status or the applicability of their content. The directives in CPS are currently under review and all directives not directly related to contract documentation will eventually be made obsolete in CPS. The majority of directives directly applicable to contract documentation will also be cancelled once their applicable content has been incorporated into the CDED manual.

4.2 Naming and Numbering Convention Directives are identified by a three or four letter code according to the division in which they originate followed by a single letter denoting their classification/authority level, and a three digit sequential number based on their divisional grouping. Example: PHY - B - 003

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 30: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Contract Documentation

There are three classification/authority levels as follows:

Class Issuing Authority Application

A Deputy Minster To announce policy that has a major effect on the Ministry; to introduce a division; to identify responsibilities or objectives within a division or any significant change in these.

B ADMs and Directors

To announce policy on a subject that effects an activity within a division; general procedural statements on a division activity.

C Directors and Office Managers

To set out specific procedures or instructions within a division's activities, including special performance criteria.

Directives applicable to contract documentation and preparation have been issued by: PHY - Provincial Highways Management Division QST - Quality and Standards Directives originally issued under QST, that require revision in the future will be cancelled and re-issued under the following divisions depending on the subject matter: OPR - Operations Division PLNG - Policy and Planning Division

4.3 Directives and Memoranda Applicable to Contract Documentation A list of Ministry directives and memoranda applicable to contract documentation and preparation is provided in Section A-105 of this chapter. The list is provided for reference purposes only and does not reflect their individual status as current or obsolete.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 6 CDED A-100

Page 31: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

LIST OF DIRECTIVES AND MEMORANDA Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

Technical Policies and Standards

HSBM DO 2014-01

Format and Method for Policies Issued by HSB

To provide guidance for the format and method of communicating the implementation of technical policies and standards issued by HSB.

Mar 24, 2014

Contract Preparation System (CPS) QST-B-033 Contract Preparation

System (CPS) Implementation of CPS and assignment of responsibilities for training, system support, and system maintenance.

Nov 30, 1994

Feb 01, 2017

Replaced: PHY-B-213

Contract Documentation

PHY-C-066 Processing of Standard Special Provisions

To confirm existing procedures for preparing, issuing and implementing special provisions.

Nov 26, 1979

References: PHY-C-84

PHY-C-073 Monitoring and Reviewing Specifications and Special Provisions

Policies and procedures for monitoring and reviewing the application of specifications and special provisions in contract documents.

Feb 20, 1980

Feb 21, 2017

References: PHY-A-002At.17

PHY-B-164 Preparation and Administration of Regional/District Construction and Maintenance Contracts and Municipal Contracts for Local Road Boards and Statue Labour Boards

1. To establish uniform policies for the preparation and administration of Regional / District construction and maintenance contracts, and Air Program, municipal contracts for Local Roads Boards and Statute Labour Boards, prepared, tendered and awarded by the Regions / Districts*.

2. To provide guidelines and standard procedures for use in applying these policies. * Herein called "Regional / District Contracts". This Directive is not applicable to Structural Coatings Contracts. See Directive B-187.

May 19, 1983

References: PHY-B-058

PHY-C-161 Canadian Content In Construction Contracts

To introduce guidelines and procedures for use by the Regional construction staff, to monitor the origin of structural steel, reinforcing steel, steel H and tube piles and strand used for prestressing and post tensioning work.

Jul 8, 1985

PHY-C-053 No-Plans Contract Format

1. To change the terminology for the small size contract format from No-Plans Format to Limited Plans Format.

2. To re-emphasize the use of this format as an effective way to accelerate the design process and to reduce pre-contract engineering costs.

3. To extend the use of the format to include new construction, rehabilitation (preservation) and capital maintenance type contracts.

Dec 13, 1985

References: RECAP 6:2 PHY-B-13A.2&3 PHY-B-228 CDED Ch. F

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 32: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

PHY-C-173 Special Provision Format and Numbering

To introduce a new special provision format and standard special provision numbering system for use in contract documents.

Apr 22, 1988

References: PHY-C-084

PHY-B-232 Post Construction Contract Package Evaluation Processes

Process for evaluating the effectiveness of the Contract Package after completion of construction.

Jul 1, 1989

N/A

QST-B-013 Ontario Provincial Standards - General Conditions of Contract (OPS GC)

To implement-OPS General Conditions of Contract -MTO Supplemental General Conditions of contract.-Standard General Special Provisions associated with the OPS GC and MTO Supplemental GC.

Sep 2, 1992

Jun 28, 2001

QST-C-013 Implementation of Revisions to Standards, Procedures and Policies That Affect the Preparation of the Capital Construction Contract Package

To define the processes and procedures to be followed for the introduction of new or revised standards and policies into capital construction contract packages.

Sep 6, 1994

Replaced: PHY-C-084 References: PHY-C-066

QST-B-037 Pre-Contract Engineering Quality Control Process

Responsibilities of Regional and Head Office Units in the preparation of contract documents.

Feb 1, 1995

Replaced: PHY-B-231 PHY-C-144 References: PHY-B-113 PHY-B-185 QST-C-013

DCSO Memo

Implementation of OPS Specifications in Construction Contracts

1. To update QST-C-13 for determining implementation dates of OPSSs.

2. To establish a communication protocol between OPS and MTO for the review of OPSSs.

Aug 27, 2007

Updates QST-C-013

DCSO Memo

Renumbering of OPS Construction Specifications - OPS Relocation Initiative

To provide a status update on how the ministry is managing implementation of changes to the numbering system of OPS Construction Specifications and related changes to MTO contract documents.

Feb 3, 2011

HDB 2008-03

Management of New NSTIs, NSSPs and Modified SPs

To establish procedures to manage the development and use of new NSTIs, NSSPs, and modified SSPs in contract documents as part of detail design work.

Sep 19, 2008

DCSO Memo 2014-05

Implementation of the Design Policy for Identification of Designated Substances Through SSP 101F21

To provide requirements for documenting Designated Substances on MTO contracts.

Oct 20, 2014

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 33: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

Contract Plans and Drawings

PHY-C-005 Revised MTO Form 902 - Structure Excavation Detail Design and Contract Documentation

1. To introduce and explain revised estimating presentation and documentation procedures for contracts advertised after 78 10 04.

2. To introduce the revised Concrete and Timber Culvert Sheet, DB RD 53.

Aug 11, 1978

References: MTC FORM 539 MTC FORM 902

PHY-C-013 Aggregate Sources Lists for Maintenance Crushed Gravel Contracts

To update requirements for provision of Aggregate Sources Lists with tender documents for maintenance crushed gravel contracts.

Oct 25, 1978

PHY-C-052 Contract Package Preparation and Content (2) - Contract Drawings Details

To implement further CPPC Recommendations to minimize and/or simplify information on contract drawings.

Aug 13, 1979

References: CPPC 10 CPPC 11 CPPC 15 CPPC Rec.Extra

PHY-C-048 CPPC a) Horizontal &

Vertical Control Drawings

b) Alignment Detail Drawings

To eliminate Horizontal and Vertical Control and Alignment Detail Drawings from contract books and streamline the process.

Sep 17, 1979

References: ASD C-3?? RECAP 6:6 CPPC Rec. #2 CPPC Rec. #7

PHY-B-080 Working Drawings for Falsework and Other Temporary Structures

To introduce a new policy with respect to specification requirements of working drawings for falsework and other temporary structures.

Apr 15, 1980

N/A

PHY-C-041 Contract Books - Printing Contract Documents

Implementation of duplex (back-to-back) printing for the printing of all Ministry Contract Books.

Jul 31, 1980

References: PHY-C-085 CPPC Dir. #3

PHY-C-103 CPPC (4) - Guideline for Contract Drawing Preparation

This directive formally introduces Book II of the CPPC Task Force, thereby completing the work of the Task Force.

Feb 3, 1981

References: PHY-C-048 PHY-C-052 PHY-C-085 CPPC Book1 RECAP 6:4

PHY-C-132 Standard Drawings - Electrical

To introduce highway engineering traffic signal standard drawings (DD ) that were previously issued as construction design (CD) drawings.

Jul 6, 1982

N/A

PHY-C-147 Abbreviations and Symbols Manual

To introduce the revised Abbreviations and Symbols Manual as a single source document for all abbreviations and symbols that may be used in the preparation of plans and contract documents.

Sep 12, 1983

PHY-B-074 Original Cross-Section for Capital Construction Projects

The purpose of this directive is to state Ministry policy and to establish requirements and responsibilities for the taking and retention of original cross-sections on capital construction projects by conventional, photogrammetric and total station methods.

Jun 5, 1986

Replaces: PHY-C-077 References: RECAP 7:4

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 34: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

PHY-C-085 CPPC (3) - Depiction of Details in Contract Drawings and Documents

Contains appended guidelines for the depiction of details in contract drawings and documents.

Jul 22, 1986

References: PHY-C-048 PHY-C-052 PHY-C-026 PHY-C-041 PHY-C-053

PHY-B-218 Foundation Investigation Data in Capital Construction Contracts

To provide bidders with foundation investigation data on appropriate Capital Construction Contracts.

Mar 11, 1988

PHY-C-175 Original Contract Drawings

Availability and preservation of Original Contract Drawings.

Oct 27, 1988

N/A

PHY-C-186 Contract Drawings - Guide Rail Details

To change Ministry policy regarding the depiction of guide rail details on contract drawings.

Feb 1, 1991

Feb 21, 2017

Cancelled By: CDED B721-1, B721-2, B723, B730, B731 References: CPPC 1981 PHY-C-085

QST-C-009 Modifications To Standard Drawings

To detail the policy and procedure for preparing modified Standard Drawings.

May 1, 1993

N/A

QST-C-015 Horizontal and Vertical Control Drawings

To eliminate horizontal and vertical control drawings from the contract books and to make the horizontal and vertical control information available during bidding.

Nov 29, 1994

Replaced: PHY-C-181

QST-B-038 Integrated Engineering System (IES) Steering Committee

Roles, responsibilities, membership, and reporting relationships of the IES steering committee.

Mar 16, 1995

N/A

HSB Memo 2010-001

Providing Digital Information to Contractors SSP 199F61

To provide the ministry's policy with respect to facilitating project construction by providing digital and data files to contractors.

Mar 4, 2010

DCSO Memo

Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTODs)

To implement a new method of including MTODs in contract documents of capital construction projects.

Jun 23, 2011

Estimating

PHY-B-067 Project Value Determination, Update Procedures From Project Inception to Project Award

1. To establish a procedure for the updating and recording of Cost Estimates for projects on the Construction Program, on a regular basis.

2. To define the areas responsible for each of the project design phases (inception of project by Status Report, Preliminary Design, Detailed Design, D4 to tender opening).

Jan 16, 1980

May 22, 2012

References: PHY-B-002

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 35: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

PHY-C-072 Estimating Engineering Costs and Establishing the Number of Working Days for Construction Contracts

To define policies and appropriate procedures for: A) Estimating Engineering Costs for

Construction Contracts. B) Establishing the number of working days,

free time period, and commencement date to be assigned to construction contracts.

Feb 20, 1980

References: RECAP 4:12 RECAP 15:2 PHY-B-068

PHY-B-081 Major Items. Payments of Overruns Exceeding the Percentage Stated in the Contract

To state Ministry policy covering the payment to contractors during the negotiations on major items that overrun in excess of the percentage stated in the contract.

Apr 16, 1980

Mar 23, 2000

Replaced: B-58

PHY-C-086 Small Quantity Tender Items

The purpose of this memorandum is to raise the awareness of Design and Construction staff to the potential cost savings possible by utilizing small quantity tender items only when practical and cost-effective to do so.

Jul 14, 1980

References: RECAP 6:4

PHY-B-105 Working Days and Liquidated Damages

To introduce revised Special Provisions for liquidated damages and working days to be used in MTC contracts.

Jan 19, 1981

Mar 23, 2000

PHY-B-002 (a) The Security of Estimated and Bid Prices (b) Responsibility for the Preparation of Cost Estimates and the Determination of Project Values

1. Redefine the respective responsibilities of the units that provide a design service to the Regions in the preparation of project values for projects on the Capital Construction, Maintenance and Municipal Roads Program.

2. Stress the need to provide the Transportation Capital Branch with accurate project values throughout the pre-contract engineering process in order to facilitate programming and expenditure prediction for projects on the Capital Roads Program.

3. Reaffirm the confidential nature of Ministry estimated costs and unit prices and contractors' bid unit prices.

Jan 15, 1985

N/A

PHY-B-113 Plan Quantity Payment For Construction Contracts

To implement Plan Quantity Payment. Further instructions on procedures and implementation policies will be issued as attachments to this directive.

Nov 6, 1986

Feb 01, 2017

References: RECAP 16:1

PHY-B-231 Final Verification of Plan Quantity Payment Quantities

To redefine the Final Verification of Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) Quantities Process, to cancel the requirement for carrying out an Independent Verification of PQP Quantities, and to state the respective responsibilities of the Regional and Head Office Units.

May 1, 1989

Mar 23, 2000

Cancelled By: QST-B-037 References: PHY-B-113 PHY-B-185 PHY-C-047

HOC 2006-05

Calculation of Liquidated Damages

To provide uniformity in the calculation and administration of Liquidated Damages.

Aug 22, 2006

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 36: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Directives and Memoranda

Issuer / Ref. #

Title Purpose Issue Date

Cancel. Date

Notes

Contract Tendering

PHY-B-068 Refinement of Award Schedule (Both Current and Multi-year)

1. To refine the establishment of the current and multi-year Award Schedule.

2. To obtain the optimal award date for each project.

Feb 4, 1980

References: RECAP 4:8 RECAP 15:2

PHY-B-111 Scheduling of Maintenance Contracts and Provision of Aggregate Sources Lists

To clarify the scheduling process, from submission of District requirements to issuance of D4's and Aggregate Sources Lists, and to provide procedural guidelines for the preparation of Aggregate Sources Lists.

Aug 12, 1981

References: RECAP 12:2 B-2?

PHY-C-114 Information To Contractors During Period Of Tender Calling

To ensure uniformity of replies to questions raised by bidders during the tendering period on the Ministry's Engineering contracts opened in Downsview.

Oct 1, 1981

PHY-B-146 Guidelines for Rehabilitation Contracts in Locations With High Traffic Volumes

To establish guidelines and procedures for compiling, advertising and awarding rehabilitation contracts in locations having unusually high traffic volumes.

Jun 28, 1982

N/A

PHY-B-178 Time of Tender Calls (Engineering Contracts)

To advise the industry of the days throughout the year on which tenders will not be opened in Downsview.

Jun 25, 1984

N/A

Note: The directives and memos listed in the above table are for reference purposes only

and do not reflect the actual status as active or obsolete.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 6 CDED A-105

Page 37: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

STANDARD DOCUMENTATION 1.0 Introduction

This section of Chapter A describes the types of standard documentation used in capital contract packages and outlines the procedures to be followed for reviewing, updating, developing, and implementing standard documentation. Standard documentation consists of:

• Standard Specifications (OPSSs)

• Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) • Standard Drawings (OPSDs, MTODs, SSDs)

There are three types of OPSSs: commons, provincial-oriented (PROV), and municipal-oriented (MUNI). OPSS commons are currently being phased out therefore no new commons will be created and all existing ones will eventually be split into separate PROVs and MUNIs as they are updated. The Engineering Specifications and Standards Management Section (ESSMS) and OPS Administration Unit (OPSAU) coordinates the development of standard documentation. OPSAU - Coordinates the development of standard documentation produced by

the OPS Specialty Committees, i.e. OPSS.COMMs, OPSS.MUNIs, and OPSDs.

ESSMS - Coordinates the development of standard documentation produced by

the Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs), i.e. OPSS.PROVs, SSPs, MTODs, and SSDs.

2.0 Reviewing, Developing, and Updating Standard Documentation Standard specifications, drawings, and special provisions are the primary instruments relied on for the safe and cost effective construction of durable highway infrastructure. Standard documentation is used on large numbers of projects throughout the province and the impact of errors or omissions can be significant therefore the development and review of standard documentation, prior to implementation, must be thorough and structured in order to mitigate this risk.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 38: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

The review and consultation process outlined in this section has been developed to promote consistency and to ensure that a thorough and structured review and consultation process is followed by all the functional offices and staff members involved in the development and review of standard documentation. Standard documentation must be reviewed on an ongoing basis and should generally be updated at least every 5 years. There are two types of updates: administrative and technical.

2.1 Administrative Updates An MTO objective is to minimize the overall volume of contract documentation through streamlining efforts. This objective is accomplished through the use of administrative updates which involves the consolidating/merging of standard documents for example, by incorporating the content of one or more SSPs into an associated OPSS. Administrative updates are completed by ESSMS and are limited to steps 6 and 7 of Table B, as they are not required to undergo the full review and consultation process. A listing of administrative updates is however, provided to ORBA for information purposes, prior to implementation. Administrative updates will generally occur when an OPSS is modified by one or more standard special provisions that:

a) are always included with the tender item or the engineering material covered by the special provision;

b) exceed a total length of two pages, excluding any text that is directly related to any fill-in portions of the special provision, and

c) where at least one of the special provisions has been implemented for a minimum of two construction seasons.

As part of administrative updates, minor changes or corrections may be made to the specification as necessary in order to address obsolete terminology or other minor issues as outlined in Table A but no changes are made to the core technical information. If no changes are made to the content then an administrative update is effectively a reaffirmation of the standard, requiring only a change to the date.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 39: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

Table A Administrative Changes

Type of Administrative Change Examples

Obsolete nomenclature corrections. Replace “Authority” with “Owner”.

Correction of phrasing. Replace “labour, equipment and material” with “labour, Equipment, and Material”.

Replace “paid as extra work” with “administered as a Change in the Work”.

Correction of titles. Replace “Untreated Granular, Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, and Stockpiling” with “Untreated Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, Selected Subgrade, and Stockpiling”.

Replace “MNR” with “MNRF”.

Adjustment of section numbering, table numbering, and text as required to incorporate standard special provision content.

Updates to the current version of external standards (requires PFO endorsement).

2.2 Technical Updates

Technical updates involve changes to the requirements of the work and are completed by the provincial functional office (PFO) that is the primary custodian of the standard documentation. PFOs develop new and updated documentation in consultation with internal stakeholders such as ESSMS and the Contract Documentation Committee (CDC), and external stakeholders such as the Ontario Road Builders’ Association (ORBA). a) Consultation With Internal Stakeholders

OPSAU and ESSMS provide direct support to the PFOs for all aspects of the management, review, development, updating, publishing, and implementation of standard documentation. Additionally ESSMS coordinates the activities of the CDC with the Standards Engineer within ESSMS acting as chair and the Engineering Standards Analyst acting as secretary. The CDC meets as required, approximately four to six times per year and consists of the following representatives:

• Head, ESSMS • Standards Engineer, ESSMS

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 40: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

• Senior Engineering Standards Analyst, ESSMS • Engineering Standards Analyst, ESSMS • Head, Contract Award, CMO • Team Lead, Contract Tendering Section, CMO • One Regional Head, P&D acting on behalf of all the regions. • One Contract Review Officer or Supervisor from each region. • One Regional Head, Claims acting on behalf of all the regions.

ESSMS and the CDC provide support to the PFOs for the development, review, and updating of standard documentation and designer information contained in the CDED manual in order to encourage provincial uniformity in the preparation of capital construction contract packages. ESSMS and the CDC also provide advice and assistance in the coordination of the ministry wide implementation of new documentation, policies, and procedures that affect the preparation of capital construction contract packages. The following offices should be contacted when the subject matter involves them:

• Regional Managers of Operations • Regional Managers of Engineering • Manager, Contract Management Office (CMO) • Manager, Claims Office • Manager, Materials Engineering and Research Office • Manager, Design and Contract Standards Office (DCSO) • Manager, Maintenance Management Office • Manager, Bridge Office • Manager, Environmental Policy Office • Manager, Traffic Office

b) Consultation With External Stakeholders MTO has also committed to sharing changes to standard documentation with our key industry stakeholder, the Ontario Road Builders’ Association (ORBA). The process includes the sharing of applicable changes with ORBA prior to implementation as determined by Construction and Engineering Contracts Section (CECS), Contract Management Office in consultation with the Provincial Functional Office (PFO) custodian.

c) Timelines for Consultation and Review

The timelines for the consultation, review, development, and updating of standard documentation shall be according to Table B "Process for the Development and Updating of Standard Documentation".

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 41: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

Supporting documentation as noted in Table C "List of Common Supporting Documentation" shall be developed or updated concurrently. The final submission of standard documentation to ESSMS for implementation in CPS (Table B, Step 6) shall include final drafts of all supporting documentation.

d) Version Selection

When a specification requires updating and the implemented version in CPS is older than the latest published version, the specification developer in the custodial office shall determine which version will be used as the basis for the update. In most cases, the newer version published by OPS shall be used since the references in it will more up-to-date and some of MTO’s special provisions may have already been included. The style and format of the newer specification is also likely to be more in line with current OPS practices.

The older implemented version of the OPS specification may be used when:

i) The latest published version of the OPS specification has clearly been written

for municipal purposes and using the latest published version would require more rewriting than using the older implemented version.

Depending on the age of the specifications, the Word documents for both versions are available from the OPS Administration Unit, within ESSMS.

ii) Agreement from the Head, Quality Systems Section, DCSO, has been

obtained.

When the older implemented version is used the developer shall ensure that all references in the specification are updated and the style and format conform to current OPS practices. OPS style guides and templates are available from OPSAU. The OPS review process encourages the review and publication of construction and associated material specifications simultaneously therefore if the latest published version of an OPS construction specification is being used for the updating process, the latest published version of the OPS material specification should also be used.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 42: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

Table B Process for the Development and Updating of Standard Documentation Steps Details Timeline

1 Research & Consultation

PFO carries out research and internal and external (stakeholder) consultation (including with technical committees) as appropriate.

Months/ Years

2 Internal Review

PFO circulates draft standard(s) to selected MTO offices and staff members for review. Circulation of the draft standard(s) and CDED Detail Estimating Section to the Contract Documentation Committee (CDC) is recommended.

3 Weeks

3 ESSMS Review

PFO forwards final draft standard(s) and supporting documentation (e.g., CDED, DSM, CAITM, etc.) to Standards Engineer and Senior Standards Analyst in ESSMS. Marked up draft standard(s) and supporting documentation is returned to PFO. ESSMS review focuses on conflicts with existing documentation, ambiguity, repetition, structure, and compliance with the language and formatting conventions of the OPS Style, Format, and How To Guide, CDED Writing Guidelines for Special Provisions, and CDED Writer's Guide for CDED Chapter B - Detail Estimating.

1 Week

4 CECS Review

PFO submits clean and tracked versions of draft standard(s) and supporting documentation (e.g., CAITM) to Head, CECS. If required, marked up draft standard(s) and supporting documentation returned to PFO, with a copy to ESSMS. If not required, CECS proceeds to Step 5. CECS review focuses on measurement for payment, basis of payment, payment adjustments, contract administration issues, constructability issues and conflicts with the MTO General Conditions of Contract.

2 Weeks

5 ORBA Review

CECS circulates draft standard(s) to ORBA for information only or for review, as determined by CECS. ORBA comments, if any, are forwarded to the PFO by CECS. If applicable, ORBA comments are reviewed by the PFO and appropriate action is taken. A response is prepared for CECS review and subsequent forwarding to ORBA.

3 Weeks

6 Submission to ESSMS

PFO submits final draft standard(s) to Senior Standards Analyst in ESSMS. ESSMS completes final quality control check and submits OPSS.PROV standards to OPSAU for publishing. Specifications must be submitted to ESSMS by March 1 for the April 30 OPS publishing, and by October 1 for the November 30 OPS publishing.

1 Week

7 Implementation In CPS

ESSMS in consultation with the PFO and the CDC determines implementation timelines. Category I changes are due 4 weeks prior to the implementation date. Category II changes are generally due 8 weeks prior but this timeline can be longer if significant changes to contract preparation are involved. PFO submits final drafts of documents to the Senior Standards Analyst in ESSMS. ESSMS completes final quality control check, formatting, and posting of documents in CPS.

Varies

Note: Timelines do not include time required to address review comments.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 43: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

3.0 Supporting Documentation

Standard documentation is generally accompanied by supporting documentation. A CDED Manual, Chapter B, Detail Estimating section is required for all standard documentation containing measured (non-lump sum) items. When creating new standard documentation, consideration should be given as to whether or not a Designated Sources for Materials (DSM) listing is required. Similarly, products on an existing DSM listing shall be reviewed as part of the standard documentation update process. More information on the DSM can be found in Chapter C. Standard documentation requiring specific actions by the contract administrator, or inspections at the time of construction, require appropriate instructions to be added to the Contract Administration and Inspection Task (CAIT) Manual. Changes may be required to other supporting documentation as shown in Table C.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 7 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 44: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

Table C List of Common Supporting Documentation

Documentation Purpose Custodial Office

Contacts

Contract Design, Estimating, and Documentation Manual

Instructions to designers – design, calculating quantities, documenting the work on Contract Drawings and quantity sheets

DCSO Standards Engineer

Construction Administration and Inspection Task Manual

Instructions to contract administrator and construction inspectors – communications, reviews, contact names / offices, transmittal of information, inspection tasks including documentation requirements

CMO Construction Contracts Engineer

Laboratory Standards Manual

Instruction to laboratories – protocols for testing and calculation / documentation of test results

MERO Aggregate Standards

Testing Engineer

Designated Sources for Materials Manual

Listing of pre-qualified suppliers of products and systems for construction

DCSO Standards Engineer

Technical Manuals and Guidelines

Examples include Structural Manual, Roadside Safety Manual, Drainage Manual, Retained Soil Systems Design Guidelines

PFO (Note 1)

PH-CC-XXX Forms Standard forms for the documentation and transmittal of contract information. To be completed by Contract Administrator, Contractor, QA Laboratory, or others as appropriate

CMO Construction Review Officer

Consultant Agreement Terms of Reference

For design, contract administration, laboratory services, etc. The terms of reference occasionally must be revised to reflect changes to standards

CMO Head, Consultant Contracts

Design and Construction Memorandums

Alert engineering and construction staff, and service providers of new requirements or procedures. Note: The revision of standard reference manuals is more effective than the issuance of design or construction memorandums.

PFO (Note 1)

Notes: Contacts are generally noted on the manuals, guidelines, and memorandums in question.

4.0 Publishing of Standard Documentation

OPSAU - Publishes OPSSs and OPSDs on behalf of the Ontario Provincial

Standards (OPS) organization which is a separate entity jointly owned by MTO and the Municipal Engineers Association (MEA). These documents are intended for use by both MTO and MEA and are published twice yearly on April 30th and November 30th.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 8 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 45: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

In order to be published by OPSAU in April, the submission of the updated OPSS to DCSO must be made no later than October 31 of the previous year. In order to be published by OPS in November, the submission must be made no later than May 31 of the same year. Submissions should be scheduled throughout the year(s) to level the workload.

ESSMS - Publishes SSPs, MTODs and SSDs on behalf of MTO. These

documents are intended for use only by MTO and are published on an on-going basis throughout the year in conjunction with their implementation in CPS.

Upon publication all standard documents are available for viewing and download from the MTO Technical Publications Website.

5.0 Implementation of Changes In CPS

The updating of standard documentation includes the implementation of new documentation as well as the revision and cancellation of existing documentation. The implementation of changes to standard documentation housed in CPS affects the preparation of contract packages therefore careful consideration must be given to the timing and method of introducing the changes, as incorporating changes into contract packages increases the potential for errors and may affect the scheduling, delivery, and tendering of projects. Before implementing any changes to standard documentation, the changes must be reviewed and potential conflicts must be identified and resolved. Associated documents must be prepared (i.e. Policy Memos, Special Provisions, Detail Estimating Chapters, etc.) and the impacts to the preparation of contract packages must be assessed. This is completed by the various PFOs in consultation with ESSMS. Once completed, the PFOs submit their requests to ESSMS for implementation of the changes in CPS. SSPs, MTODs, and SSDs are developed internally and are meant for use by MTO only, therefore the above noted review is completed during the development of the documents and they are published simultaneously in conjunction with their implementation for use by MTO in CPS. OPSSs and OPSDs however are developed both internally (PFOs) and externally (OPS Specialty Committees), are meant for use by both MTO and MEA, and are published only twice per year therefore they are not immediately implemented for use by MTO in CPS. Documents developed by the OPS Specialty Committees are reviewed by the PFOs after the development and publishing of the documents.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 9 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 46: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

The latest published version of an OPS specification will be adopted by MTO if it suits MTO’s needs. It will be considered to suit MTO’s needs when:

i) Its technical content fulfills MTO requirements and

ii) Its administrative, quality control and quality assurance, and payment content conform to MTO policy and practice, or

a standard special provision with a total length of not more than two pages, excluding any text that is directly related to any fill-in portion of the special provision, can be used to make the latest published version of the OPS specification conform to i) and ii) above.

6.0 Categorization of Changes Documentation changes such as revisions to standard drawings, specifications or special provisions may be required as a result of new materials, new construction methods, or construction experience. Changes are categorized as either Category 1 or Category 2 depending on the extent of the effects on the preparation of contract packages. Categorization of changes is determined by the initiating office in consultation with the Engineering Standards and Specification Management Section (ESSMS) and the Design Implementation Committee (DIC). a) Category 1 Changes

Category 1 changes have minimal effect on the preparation of contract packages. Category 1 changes affect only the information in the Tender such as the version dates of OPSSs, SSPs, OPSDs, etc. but do not affect the contract drawings and/or quantity sheets. Incorporating Category 1 changes into contract packages requires only minimal effort by designers as the changes do not affect the contract drawings, quantity sheets, or tender items, with the exception of minor changes to tender item names and/or descriptions.

b) Category 2 Changes Category 2 changes have a significant effect on the preparation of contract packages.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 10 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 47: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

In addition to affecting the Tender, Category 2 changes also affect the contract drawings and/or quantity sheets. Incorporating Category 2 changes into contract packages requires significant effort by designers as the changes may result in the need for new and/or revised contract drawings, recalculation of quantities, updating of quantity sheets, addition of new tender items, etc.

7.0 Submission of Changes to ESSMS Category 1 changes require submission of final documents to ESSMS a minimum of 4 weeks prior to the scheduled implementation date in order to allow posting of documents with a pending status in CPS for a minimum period of 3 weeks in order to allow sufficient time for designers to update contract packages. Category 2 changes require submission of final documents to ESSMS 8 weeks prior to the scheduled implementation date in order to allow posting of documents with a pending status in CPS for a minimum period of 6 weeks or longer (depending on the complexity of the changes) in order to allow sufficient time for designers to update contract packages. The category and appropriate length of time for posting of Pending documentation in CPS shall be determined by the PFO in consultation with ESSMS. Submissions must be received in full by ESSMS by the stipulated deadline and all documents must be final. Submissions that include new standard special provisions should include:

(a) warrants for use (b) a short history of the development of the SP (c) a list of all the offices involved in developing the SP (d) details of any controversy that had to be resolved

A final check and formatting revisions will be made to special provisions and CDED chapters before uploading them to CPS. Once a document is uploaded to CPS with a Pending Status no further changes will be permitted as designers will have already exported the content and begun the process of updating their contract packages. If technical errors are identified they will have to be corrected via an NSSP issued on or after the CPS implementation date.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 11 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 48: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation

8.0 Communication of CPS Changes to Design Staff The implementation of changes in CPS is carried out by the CPS Administrator. The changes are communicated via CPS Information Update Memos that are widely distributed to internal staff via e-mail and to all CPS users via posting of the memos in the CPS News. CPS updates are scheduled several times per year however the dates may be subject to change and additional updates may occasionally be scheduled on short notice in order to address critical operational needs.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 12 of 12 CDED A-200

Page 49: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Standard Documentation Custodians

LIST OF STANDARD DOCUMENTATION CUSTODIANS

Office / Section / Group Custodian Name and Position

Design & Contract Standards Office

Engineering Standards & Specification Management

Lola Vaz Head, ESSMS Aimee Tupaz Standards Engineer Mark Rankie Sr. Eng. Standards Analyst Rachel Kyte Eng. Standards Analyst

Design Standards

Mike Pearsall Head, DS

Traffic Safety Mark Ayton Sr. Engineer, Highway Design Arshad Azhar Design & Contract Standards Eng. Kenneth Shannon Design & Contract Standards Eng. Vicente Benitez Design & Contract Standards Eng.

Drainage Hani Farghaly Sr. Eng., Hydro Technical Design Art Groenveld Sr. Eng., Drainage Design

Landscape Paula Berketo Principal Landscape Architect

Materials Engineering & Research Office

Bituminous

Pamela Marks Head, Bituminous Anne Holt Sr. Bituminous Eng., Geotechnical Seyed Tabib Sr. Bituminous Eng. Imran Bashir Bituminous Eng. Heather Bell Materials Project Eng. Masud Ahmed Sr. Bituminous Materials Officer

Concrete

Hanna Schell Head, Concrete Section Melissa Titherington Sr. Concrete Eng. David Rhead Sr. Concrete Eng. Steve Paiva Sr. Concrete Materials Eng. Officer Mohammad Aqel Concrete Eng. Grant Ridley Chemical Eng.

Pavements & Foundations

Stephen Lee Head, Pavements & Foundations

Foundation Group Ken Ahmad Sr. Foundations Eng. Tony Sangiuliano Sr. Foundations Eng. David Staseff Sr. Foundations Eng. Pavement Group Betty Bennett Sr. Pavement Design Eng. Susanne Chan Pavement Design Eng. Warren Lee Pavement Design Eng.

Soils & Aggregates

Joel Magnan Head, S & A John Blair Sr. Soils & Aggregates Eng. Vacant Sr. Aggregate Resources Eng.

August 2017 Page 1 of 2 CDED A-205

Page 50: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A List of Standard Documentation Custodians

Office / Section / Group Custodian Name and Position

Contract Management

Office

Contract Award

Estimating Kathy Wood Team Lead, Estimating

Tendering Ed Marcon Team Lead, Tendering

Construction & Engineering

Kevin English Head, C & E Construction Contracts Maria Bianchin Construction Contracts Eng. Kyle Perdue Construction Contracts Eng. Mireya Hidalgo Construction Contracts Eng. Ron Belansky Construction Admin Review Officer Finlay Buchanan Construction Officer

Traffic Office (Central Region)

Electrical Engineering Eric Yao Head, EE

Intelligent Transportation Systems (ITS) Program

ITS Innovation & Planning Lija Whittaker Project Engineer

ITS Operations & Deployment Robert Chan Supervising Engineer

Traffic Office

Electrical Engineering Section Martin Aitkenhead Head, EES Arun Kapur Sr. Electrical Engineer

Safety & Information Management John Zajac Head, SIM

Traffic Operations Engineering

Roger DeGannes Head, TOE Vacant Sr. Traffic Engineer Vereen Rattigan Engineer, Traffic Signals Ousama Shebeeb Engineer, Traffic Signals Tracey Difede Sr. PM, Traffic Operations

Maintenance Office Maintenance Performance Alain Beaulieu Manager, MO Vacant Head, MP

Bridge Office

Walter Kenedi Head, Bridge Design Kris Mermigas Head, Bridge Management David Lai Head, Bridge Rehabilitation Magdy Meleka Head, Bridge Standards Jim Connell Lead Bridge Eng. Ben Huh Lead Bridge Eng. Victor Weziak Bridge Design Technician

Environmental Policy Office

Brenda Carruthers Policy Analyst Vacant Sr. Policy Analyst, Acoustics Diane Ivanauskas Sr. Policy Analyst, Waste April Currie Sr. Policy Analyst, Fisheries

Contract Innovations Office Jeremy Landry Sr. Contract Innovations Analyst Felipe Mendoza Sr. Contract Innovations Analyst Steve Needham Sr. Contract Innovations Analyst

August 2017 Page 2 of 2 CDED A-205

Page 51: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation Numbering Protocol

STANDARD DOCUMENTATION NUMBERING PROTOCOL 1.0 Introduction

This section of Chapter A provides information regarding the numbering system used for standard documents.

2.0 Numbering Protocol for Standard Special Provisions (SSPs)

SSP Prefix Used For

100 Amendments to MTO General Conditions of Contract

101 - 109 Amendments to Existing General Specifications

110 - 125 Amendments to Existing Material Specifications

168 General Requirements for ATMS Related Work

199 General Requirements Not Related to Existing General Specifications

200 - 900 Item Specific Amendments to Construction Specifications

299 - 999 Item Specific Requirements Not Related to Existing Construction Specifications

3.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSS General & Construction Specifications

Division OPSS Title Associated General SSPs

Associated Item Specific SSPs

100 General Conditions of Contract 100xxx n/a

1xx General Specifications 101xxx n/a

200 General Grading 102xxx 2xxxxx

300 Pavement (Flexible & Rigid) 103xxx 3xxxxx

400 Drainage, Watermains, and Utility 104xxx 4xxxxx

500 Miscellaneous 105xxx 5xxxxx

600 Electrical 106xxx 6xxxxx

700 Traffic Safety 107xxx 7xxxxx

800 Environmental and Landscape 108xxx 8xxxxx

900 Structural 109xxx 8xxxxx

August 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED A-210

Page 52: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation Numbering Protocol

4.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSS Material Specifications

Division OPSS Title Associated General SSPs

Associated Item Specific SSPs

1000 Aggregates 110xxx n/a

1100 Bitumens 111xxx n/a

1200 Seals, Bearings, Waterstops 112xxx n/a

1300 Cement and Concrete 113xxx n/a

1400 Metal 114xxx n/a

1500 Safety Related 115xxx n/a

1600 Wood and Plastics 116xxx n/a

1700 Coatings 117xxx n/a

1800 Pipes and Associated Drainage Items 118xxx n/a

1900 Environmental 119xxx n/a

2000 Signs and Sign Support 120xxx n/a

2100 Clothing, Cloth and the Like 121xxx n/a

2200 Unassigned 122xxx n/a

2300 Miscellaneous 123xxx n/a

2400 Electrical 124xxx n/a

2500 Chemicals 125xxx n/a

5.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSDs for Roads, Drainage & Structures

Division OPSD Title

100 Abbreviations

200 Grading Sections

300 Side Entrances

400 Frames and Grates

500 Paving

600 Curbs and Gutters

700 Catch Basins and Manholes

800 Culverts and Drains

900 Fencing, Guide Rails

1000 Sanitary Sewers

1100 Watermains

3000 Structures

August 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED A-210

Page 53: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Standard Documentation Numbering Protocol

6.0 Numbering Protocol for OPSDs for Electrical Work

Division OPSD Title

2000 Abbreviations

2100 Underground Work, etc.

2200 Foundations, etc.

2300 Work on Structure

2400 Purchasing Standards

2500 Traffic Signals

2600 Sign Lighting

August 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED A-210

Page 54: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 55: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

NON-STANDARD DOCUMENTATION 1.0 Introduction

Non-standard documentation consists of non-standard tender items (NSTIs), non-standard special provisions (NSSPs), modified standard special provisions (SSPs), and modified standard drawings (OPSDs, MTODs, and SSDs). Non-standard documentation is created for use in trials of new methods and materials, or to address unique project-specific or regional requirements. The creation of new non-standard documentation is initiated by Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs) and/or by members of a Design Team working on the design of highway capital projects.

1.1 Types of NSSPs There are three types of NSSPs: a) Provincial / Head Office

Provincial Office NSSPs are developed and issued by PFOs to address a wide variety of issues and are applicable for use in all projects throughout the province based on their associated warrants for use. They are stored in the Head Office NSP folder in CPS and Designers can obtain further information about their use from the Provincial NSSP Index housed within the same folder in CPS.

b) Regional Regional NSSPs are developed and issued by the regions, in consultation with PFOs, to address unique regional requirements. They are stored in the corresponding regional NSP folder in CPS. Designers can obtain further information about their use from the Regional NSSP Indexes housed within the same folders in CPS.

c) Local Local NSSPs are initiated by Design Teams working on the design of highway capital projects, in consultation with the Regional Functional Areas (RFAs) and Provincial Functional Offices (PFOs) to address project-specific requirements. They are intended for one time use and are not stored in the NSP folder in CPS. They are inserted directly into the specific Work Project files in CPS.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 56: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

2.0 NSSP Clean-Up Initiative Prior to 2008 there were few guidelines in place to limit or control the creation of non-standard documentation. As a result, the number of NSTIs, NSSPs, and modified SSPs began to grow unchecked, and without sufficient input and oversight by the appropriate PFOs. The practice of creating regionally modified SSPs to suit regional preferences without sufficient input and oversight from PFOs increases the potential for conflicts with other documentation, and results in unnecessary duplication of effort by designers and the needless creation of documentation containing similar and/or contradictory content. In order to address concerns about the proliferation of non-standard documentation and resulting lack of province wide consistency, Highway Standards Branch (HSB) issued Highway Design Bulletin (HDB) 2008-003 in order to establish procedures to manage the development and use of non-standard documentation. HDB 2008-003 was an important step in moving away from the practice of developing independent regional solutions and towards the practice of working collaboratively with PFO staff to generate province wide solutions. Since 2008 the Engineering Specifications and Standards Management Section (ESSMS) has taken an increasingly active role in managing and coordinating the development of non-standard documentation in order to promote standardized approaches and consistency in contract documentation across the province. In 2014 ESSMS in conjunction with representatives from the Contract Documentation Committee (CDC), formerly the Design Implementation Committee (DIC), began work on an initiative to review and clean-up the large number of regional NSSPs, many of which were created prior to 2008. As of July 2017 the number of regional NSSPs has been reduced by approximately 50%, from over 300 down to approximately 150. This number will continue to be reduced under this initiative. As part of the initiative to reduce the number of regional NSSPs and promote consistency throughout the province, ESSMS has been working with the regional Contract Review Officers (CROs) and PFOs to create Provincial Office NSSPs for use with corresponding NSTIs. The development of Provincial Office NSSPs results in improved oversight by the PFOs, higher quality content, significant time savings, and a reduction in the duplication of effort associated with the needless "re-creation" of content. In order to further assist Designers and PFOs in managing the use of NSSPs, in 2016 ESSMS developed a Provincial Office NSSP Index for tracking the use of Provincial Office NSSPs. The Index is updated concurrently whenever any changes are made to the NSSPs. Designers should develop the habit of checking on a weekly basis in order to verify whether any changes have occurred that may affect their contracts.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 57: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

To further assist designers, in 2016 ESSMS developed a NSTI/NSSP Cross Reference List which allows designers to quickly verify whether there is a corresponding Provincial Office NSSP available for use with a particular tender item. The list is housed in the Head Office NSP folder in CPS and is updated concurrently whenever a new Provincial Office NSSP is developed for use with an associated tender item.

2.1 NSTI Clean-Up Initiative In March 2017, ESSMS performed a large scale clean-up of NSTIs and significantly reduced the number of active items by approximately 50%, from over 1000 to approximately 500. A new system for managing the creation and expiry of NSTIs was subsequently implemented. The new system, outlined in section 3.1 below, is self-sustaining and automatically purges the system of unused items on a continuous basis. It also prevents the inappropriate use of old items that may no longer be relevant or suitable for use. At a glance it can now be determined how many NSTIs are in use, how recently a particular NSTI has been used, and which NSTIs have been in use for the longest period of time. This makes it easier for ESSMS and the PFOs to identify items that should be assessed for standardization.

3.0 Policy for Management of Non-Standard Documentation Former HDB 2008-003 established procedures for the development and use of new non-standard tender items (NSTIs), non-standard special provisions (NSSPs), and modified standard special provisions (SSPs) in contract documents as part of detail design work. As part of detail design work Designers have the ability to introduce non-standard documentation to suit project-specific requirements. This latitude is required to accommodate unusual circumstances and specific technical needs for individual projects however appropriate controls and safeguards also need to be established to reduce the risk of developing and using inappropriate non-standard documentation. The new policy and procedures outlined further in this document establishes these controls and safeguards, and enhances the content of the original bulletin. MTO Project Managers shall be responsible for compliance with this policy on their assigned Work Projects and shall ensure that non-standard documentation is minimized to the extent permitted by standard documentation. Pre-existing NSTIs and regional NSSPs that were already active in Contract Preparation System (CPS) prior to the issue of HDB 2008-003 were “grandfathered”

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 58: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

in and may be used where appropriate, without the express endorsement of the associated PFO, however Designers should note that departures from the use of standard documentation are to be brought to the attention of the appropriate PFOs prior to being used, regardless of whether or not endorsement is required. Standard documentation (i.e. OPSSs, SSPs, OPSDs, MTODs, and SSDs) and Provincial Office NSSPs are updated on a regular basis in CPS therefore Designers shall review all non-standard documentation for conflicts immediately prior to final submission of the Contract Package for tendering. Non-standard documentation that involves the use of new materials or construction techniques shall be developed with the full involvement of the PFO. When completed, this documentation may be used on a trial basis on other contracts upon the request of the PFO and agreement by the region. All non-standard documentation shall be completed, approved, and incorporated into Contract Packages prior to the Design Complete Presentation. The inclusion of non-standard documentation in a Contract Package after the Design Complete Presentation requires Head of Planning and Design approval. Such approval shall be granted only when the NSSP or modified SSP is critical. Designers shall regularly review the non-standard documentation uploaded to CPS and incorporate any that apply into the Contract Documents of applicable projects. When standard documentation is to be updated, PFOs shall review all related non-standard documentation in CPS and incorporate appropriate content into the updated standard documentation. Any non-standard documentation in CPS that is identified by the PFO as inappropriate or obsolete shall be removed from CPS.

3.1 Non-Standard Tender Items (NSTIs) The creation of new NSTIs and the re-activation of expired NSTIs require approval/endorsement from the appropriate PFO in order for the CPS Administrator within ESSMS to proceed with the creation, or reactivation and release of the item for use within a specific Work Project. Creation of new NSTIs or reactivation of existing ones by the CPS Administrator within ESSMS shall not occur without this approval. All new NSTIs will be created with an initial expiry date of two years from the date of authorization. Each time an NSTI is subsequently released for use the expiry date shall be extended for a further two year period. In this manner, NSTIs that are used at least once every two years will remain active indefinitely unless specifically cancelled by the associated PFO. NSTIs that are not used for a period of at least two years will auto expire.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 59: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

NSTIS that have expired and are classified as obsolete in CPS shall require endorsement from the associated PFO in order to be reactivated and released for use. Unless otherwise directed by the PFO, once reactivated, a NSTI will then be available for use for a minimum two year period or longer as outlined above.

3.2 Development of Non-Standard Documentation a) Regional and Local Documentation for Minor Departures

Regional and Local non-standard documentation that is developed for non-contentious/minor departures, shall be approved by the regional section head of the corresponding Regional Functional Area (RFA). Non-standard documentation used by a region and adopted by another region shall be approved by the applicable regional section head in the adopting region.

b) Regional and Local Documentation for Major Departures Regional and Local non-standard documentation that is developed for contentious/major departures shall be approved by the appropriate PFO prior to use in any capital construction contract. A major departure includes, but is not limited to, a change that: • Changes the method or approach for contract administration or quality assurance. • Changes the unit of measurement of a standard tender item. • Requires a new type of construction equipment and / or method. • Introduces new or stricter material specifications or test methods. • Increases penalties and decrease bonuses for materials or early / late completion. • Requires a labour, payment, performance or maintenance bond. • Requires a warranty. • Does not permit change proposals. • Changes the Instructions to Bidders. • Requires a mandatory pre-bid meeting(s), and/or mandatory site visit(s) during the

tendering period. • Limits competitive bidding, for example:

o Specifies new or stricter construction tolerances. o Requires personnel qualifications or certifications. o Specifies only one source for a product or material with or without allowing an

"equivalent". o Requires new professional engineering services from contractors. o Requires the contractor to obtain approval of a third party. o Requires subcontractor qualifications or a pre-qualification procedure.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 60: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

Major departures from Ministry policy and practice may require approval of the Director, Highway Standards Branch (HSB) and/or the Director, Contract Management and Operations Branch (CMOB), as determined by the PFO manager. These will normally require industry notification and/or consultation by the PFO manager prior to advertising the construction contract.

3.3 Process for Development and Approval of Non-Standard Documentation The development of non-standard documentation shall be according to Table A.

Table A Process for Development and Approval of Non-Standard Documentation

Step Details

1 The Design Team shall determine the need for non-standard documentation to address project specific requirements in the early stages of detail design.

2 The need for NSTIs or NSSPs shall be confirmed at least 3 months in advance of the Design Complete Presentation. The CRO shall be consulted regarding documentation alternatives.

3

If the need for an NSTI or major departure NSSP is confirmed, a concept approval request shall be submitted to the applicable PFO at least 2 months in advance of the Design Complete Presentation. The Non-Standard Documentation Endorsement Request Form provided in Section A-310 shall be used. The MTO Project Manager (PM) shall submit the request the CRO. The CRO shall review the request prior to submission to the PFO. a) Within 10 business days the PFO shall respond by completing the bottom portion of

the request form. b) If the request is not approved, the NSTI shall not be authorized and the major

departure non-standard documentation shall not be developed. c) If the request is approved:

• It shall be forwarded by the CRO to ESSMS for creation or reactivation of an NSTI, if applicable.

• When the major departure non-standard documentation is not contentious, as determined by the PFO, the project team develops the documentation.

• When the major departure non-standard documentation is contentious, as determined by the PFO, the project team develops the documentation with the assistance of the PFO. Consultations with external stakeholders and internal approvals shall be by the PFO with coordination through appropriate channels.

5 Non-standard documentation shall be approved by the applicable PFO section head (major departure & contentious) or regional section head (non-contentious).

6 NSSPs and modified SPs shall include the developer name, section name, the approver name, approval date, and WP# or regional NSSP label in the footer. See Section A-315 for examples. Modified standard drawings shall be as per CDED Sections F-200, F-210, and F-220.

7 All final non-standard documentation shall be forwarded to the appropriate PFO with a reference to the contract number, for reference and filing.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 61: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A Non-Standard Documentation

4.0 Implementation of Non-Standard Documentation in CPS The implementation of changes to non-standard documentation in CPS is carried out by the CPS Administrator within the Engineering Specifications and Standards Management Section (ESSMS), on as as-needed basis. Provincial office and region specific NSSPs developed for ongoing use by a particular region shall be submitted to ESSMS for a final quality control check, formatting, and posting in the appropriate Head Office or Regional NSP folder in CPS. All NSSPs must contain a warrant and identification of the custodian. Changes are documented and communicated via CPS Non-Standard Information Update Memos. The memos are posed in CPS News and are circulated internally via e-mail along with supporting documentation, including copies of the PO NSSP Index and NSTI/NSSP Cross Reference Sheet when applicable. Designers should develop the habit of checking CPS News on a weekly basis in order to verify whether any changes have occurred that may affect their contracts.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 7 of 7 CDED A-300

Page 62: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 63: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A PFO Contact List for Endorsement of NSTIs and NSSPs

PFO CONTACT LIST FOR ENDORSEMENT OF NSTIs and NSSPs

Specialty Area Contact Phone # Acronym

• Intelligent Transportation Systems, ATMS / PVMS Robert Chan (416) 235-4501 ATMS

• Asphaltic & Bituminous Related Mixes, Products, Cements, Emulsions, Materials, Sealants, & Anti-Stripping Additives

• Bituminous Warranty & Performance Based Specs

Pamela Marks (416) 235-3725 BITU

• Bridges, Decks, Integral Abutments • Temporary Modular Bridges

Tony Merlo (905) 704-2341 BRDG

• General Conditions, Financial Incentives / Disincentives • Warranty & Performance Based Specifications

Kevin English (905) 704-2197 CMOB

• Construction Site Access Finlay Buchanan (905) 704-2707 CMOB

• Unit of Measure • Payment Clauses

Kathy Wood (905) 704-2196 CMOB

• Concrete, Waterproofing, Bearings for Bridges • Metals & Chemical Products

Hannah Schell (416) 235-3708 CONC

• Drainage & Hydrology, Municipal Drains • Stormwater Management, Detention Ponds • Ditches, Swales, Gutters, CB’s, Sewers, Culverts

Art Groenveld Hani Farghaly

(905) 704-2239 (905) 704-2244

DRAI

• Electrical Installations • Traffic Signals & Highway Illumination

Martin Aitkenhead (905) 704-2254 ELEC

• Environmental Standards & Practices • Erosion & Sediment Control, Wildlife Mitigation

Brenda Carruthers (905) 704-2207 ENVR

• Waste, Contaminated Materials Management, Spills • Earth Management & Excess Materials Management

Dianne Ivanauskas (416) 585-7339 ENVR

• Fish & Fish Habitat • Wetlands

April Currie (416) 585-7338 ENVR

• Retained Soil Systems Issues (RSS) David Staseff (416) 235-3513 FOUN

• Seed & Cover, Topsoil, Sodding • Tree Preservation & Protection, Shrub & Tree Planting

Paula Berketo (905) 704-2229 LAND

• Maintenance Standards • Road Weather Information Systems (RWIS)

Alain Beaulieu (905) 704-2340 MAIN

• Acoustics • Noise Control

Slavi Grozev (416) 585-7298 NOIS

• Materials for Pavement Markings • Structural Steel Coatings

Grant Ridley (416) 235-3728 PAIN

• Pavement Design & Rehabilitation • Foundation Engineering, Hydrogeology, Tunnelling

Stephen Lee (416) 235-3732 PVMT

• Roadside Safety, Curbs, Fencing, Utilities • Barrier Systems, End Treatments, Crash Cushions

Mark Ayton (905) 704-2295 SAFE

• Soils & Aggregates • Geotextiles

Joel Magnan (416) 235-3739 SOAG

• Traffic Safety & Information Management • Traffic Data Collection

John Zajac (905) 704-2921 TRAF

• Traffic Operations • Signs & Markings

Roger De Gannes (905) 704-2947 TRAF

August 2017 Page 1 of 1 CDED A-305

Page 64: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 65: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A CPS Updates

CONTRACT PREPARATION SYSTEM (CPS) UPDATES 1.0 Introduction

This section of Chapter A outlines the procedures to be followed for incorporating changes to standard and non-standard documentation changes into capital Contract Packages.

2.0 Changes to Standard Documentation Changes to standard documentation are made via regular updates in CPS which are communicated via CPS Information Update Memos that are prepared and distributed via e-mail, to an extensive internal audience, by the Engineering Specifications and Standards Management Section (ESSMS). The memos are also posted in CPS News for access by all CPS users.

2.1 Types of Changes As noted in the CDED Chapter A section on Standard Documentation, there are two types of changes: a) Category 1 Changes

• Have minimal effect on the preparation of a Contract Package.

• Do not require significant time or effort on the part of Designers in order to incorporate the updated information into a Contract Package.

b) Category 2 Changes

• Have a significant effect on the preparation of a Contract Package.

• Require significant time and effort on the part of Designers in order to incorporate the updated information into a Contract Package because Design Documents and Contract Drawings and/or Quantity Sheets are affected.

2.2 Incorporating Changes Into Contract Packages

Incorporating changes into a Contract Package depends on the type of change and the stage of preparation that the package is in.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 3 CDED A-400

Page 66: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A CPS Updates

a) Incorporating Changes During the Production Stage

The production stage is before submission to the regional Contract Review Office (CRO). When applicable, all Category 1 and 2 changes that are implemented in CPS shall be incorporated by the Designer into Contract Packages that are in the production stage.

b) Incorporating Changes During the Submission Stage

The submission stage is from the date of submission to the CRO to the date of tender advertising. When applicable, Category 1 changes that are implemented in CPS shall be incorporated by the Designer into Contract Packages that are in the submission stage. The changes may be made prior to advertising, time permitting, or after advertising via the preparation of an Addendum. Category 2 changes that are implemented in CPS are not required to be incorporated into Contract Packages that are in the submission stage.

c) Incorporating Changes During the Tendering Stage The tendering stage is from the date of tender advertising to the date of tender closing. Category 1 changes that are implemented in CPS do not have to be incorporated into Contract Packages that are in the tendering stage unless they are identified as critical. Category 1 changes that are identified as critical by the MTO Project Managers in consultation with the regional Contract Review Officers (CROs), Contract Tendering Section (CTS), and the initiator of the changes, shall be incorporated by Designers into applicable Contract Packages via the preparation of Addenda. The additional time and effort required to prepare Addenda for Category 1 changes is not significant and anticipated tender closing dates are not usually affected however in some cases the changes may result in a delay to the tender closing date and subsequent need for CTS to issue an Extension of Time. Category 2 changes that are implemented in CPS are not required to be incorporated into Contract Packages that are in the tendering stage.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 3 CDED A-400

Page 67: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER A CPS Updates

d) Incorporating Category 2 Changes - Special Cases In some cases it may be deemed necessary to incorporate Category 2 changes into Contract Packages that are in the submission and/or tendering stages. In these cases the approval of the Director of the Highway Standards Branch shall be obtained. In order to obtain approval the initiating office must provide a thorough justification of the need and the cost benefits since significant costs may be incurred due to the additional time and effort required by Service Providers to prepare updated Contract Packages and/or Addenda. Incorporating Category 2 changes into a Contract Package that is in the submission stage will require the Designer to generate and deliver an updated Contract Package. This may result in delays to the anticipated tender advertising and closing dates.

Incorporating Category 2 changes into a Contract Package that is in the tendering stage will require the Designer to prepare an Addendum. This may result in a delay to the tender closing date and subsequent need for CTS to issue an Extension of Time. Category 2 special cases shall be identified by the MTO Project Manager in consultation with the regional CRO, CTS, and the initiator of the changes.

3.0 Changes to Non-Standard Documentation Changes to non-standard documentation are made via regular updates in CPS which are communicated via CPS Non-Standard Information Update Memos that are prepared and distributed via e-mail, to an extensive internal audience, by ESSMS. The memos are also posted in CPS News for access by all CPS users. Changes to Provincial/Head Office NSSPs are also documented in the Head Office NSSP Index housed in the Head Office NSP folder in CPS. The index provides information to Designers about the appropriate use and application of Head Office NSSPs.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 3 CDED A-400

Page 68: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 69: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Detail Estimating

CHAPTER B

DETAIL ESTIMATING

August 2017 CDED B-050

Page 70: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 71: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

TENDER ITEMS AND PLAN QUANTITY PAYMENT (PQP) 1.0 Introduction

This section of Chapter B discusses Tender Items and Plan Quantity Payment (PQP). The information in this section will assist Designers in understanding Tender Items and PQP and will assist document Custodians in creating Tender Items with the correct item type, parameters, unit of measure, PQP designation, and asset category.

2.0 Tender Items Tender Items are materials, components, products, or processes required for the construction of the work project. The parameters associated with Tender Items are: item code, item title, item type, item number, column type, unit of measure, PQP designation, steel designation (no longer used), item category, asset category, status, implementation date, and expiry date. Tender Item details can be obtained from the Master Items List in CPS.

Additional details can be obtained by selecting the item then choosing "Details" under the "Actions" menu. By selecting the various tabs additional information can be obtained about associated documentation, item variations, accessories, etc.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 72: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

2.1 Tender Item Status The status of a Tender Item will be shown as Active, Pending, Future, or Obsolete: Active status Tender Items have been implemented and are available for use in Work Projects. Pending status Tender Items will be implemented and available for use in Work Projects on the date shown in the "Imp Date" column. Obsolete status Tender Items were cancelled on the date shown in the "Expiry Date" column and are no longer available for use in Work Projects. Future status Tender Items will be implemented in the future on a date that has not yet been determined and are not available for use in Work Projects.

2.2 Unit of Measure (UOM) and PQP Status There are many units of measure available for selection in CPS such as each, hour, m², m³, tonne, lump sum, LS/M, metre, etc. Additionally there are options for electronic rounding, conversion factors, and customized display of information on the Quantity Sheets. For example: • a Tender Item can be created whereby the individual quantities are entered to

two decimal points accuracy on the Quantity Sheets and the quantity total is subsequently rounded to one decimal place for bidding purposes on the Tender Item List,

• a unit of measure such as LS/M can be used to designate an item as lump sum on the Tender Item List for bidding purposes but allows the entry of quantities in metres on the Quantity Sheets for estimating purposes, or

• a unit of measure with a conversion factor can be used to designate an item as one unit on the Quantity Sheets for estimating purposes and another on the Tender Item List for bidding purposes (e.g. a conversion factor of 0.0001 can be entered to automatically convert m² quantities on the Quantity Sheets to hectares on the Tender Item List).

New units of measure, conversion factors, and rounding options can be created as needed by contacting the CPS Administrator in the Engineering Specifications and Standards Management Section (ESSMS).

Items designated as PQP are identified by a checkmark in the "PQP" column. PQP is discussed in further detail in Section 3 below.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 73: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

2.3 Item Type There are three types of Tender Items: Standard, Non-Standard, and Warranty. Standard Tender Item - has standard documentation associated with the item that governs the work of constructing the item. In CPS standard items are electronically linked to the associated standard specifications (OPSSs) and/or standard special provisions (SSPs) which are automatically inserted into the Work Project when the item is added to the project. Non-Standard Tender Item - does not have standard documentation associated with the item. Provincial and Regional NSSPs are available for use with certain Non-Standard Tender Items, but in most cases the designer must prepare a Local NSSP for use with the item. Warranty Tender Item - is used when the minimum bid price of an item must be a certain percentage of the total bid price of certain other selected items. The assignment of an item to this category triggers electronic input from the Tendering Section at the time of advertisement. Warranty items may or may not contain the word “warranty” in their title. Warranty items must have an associated Special Provision with information in the Basis for Payment section that outlines the criteria for the minimum bid price. Example: Payment at the Contract price shall be full compensation for all labour, Equipment, Materials and services required to provide Maintenance and Warranty during Phase II. The Contract price for this item shall be not less than 10 % of the total tender value of ATMS items as listed in the table below:

Item Code Item Title

2.4 Item Code and Title

Standard Tender Items are coded, titled, and categorized based on the associated standard specification or special provision. For example: • A Tender Item associated with a standard specification (e.g. OPSS 201) would

be coded with a corresponding 200 series number (e.g. 0201-0010) and titled as per the name specified in the OPSS.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 74: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

• A Tender Item associated with a Standard Special Provision (SSP) with no corresponding Standard Specification (e.g. SSP 399F01) would be coded with a corresponding number (e.g. 0399-0010) and titled as per the name specified in the SSP.

2.5 Item Category A Tender Item is normally assigned to the Item Category which matches the series of its associated specification. For example a 200 series item associated with an OPSS 200 series specification is normally assigned to the Grading category although there are exceptions. Non-Standard Tender Items (NSTIs) are almost always assigned to the Non-Standard Item Category regardless of the nature of the work, although there are exceptions. The available categories are:

• Grading • Materials • Drainage • Miscellaneous • Electricals • Watermains

• Structures • Warranty Items • Maintenance • Specialties • Performance Based

2.6 Item Asset Category

The Asset Category information assigned to Tender Items in CPS is used to assist the Investment Strategies Branch (ISB) in the tracking and calculating of asset deterioration and the establishment of investment strategies and funding requirements for the multi-year program for provincial highways. The categories and types of Tender Items that are typically included in each category are detailed in the following table: Pavement and Road Surface

- Asphalt, Concrete or Composite Pavements Road Subsurface

- Granulars, Drainage, Ditches, Sewers - All Culverts Less Than 3 Metres - Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, & Ditch Inlets

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 75: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

Road Appurtenances - Noise and Privacy Barriers, Median Barriers - Roadside Protection (i.e. Guide Rail, End Treatments) - Signage, Pavement Markings - Curbs and Gutters - Metal Culverts Over 3 Metres - ATMS (Software & Hardware) - Illumination & Lighting, Traffic Signals - Security & Fencing - Weather Warning Systems

Bridge Decks

- Abutments, Fixtures, Expansion Joints - Bearings, Parapets, Wingwalls, Girders

Bridge Structures

- Bridge Sub-Structure (i.e. Piers, Footings, and Piles) - Bridge Approaches, Skyway Structures - Concrete Culverts Over 3 Metres

Buildings

- Truck Inspection Stations, Patrol Yards, Service Centers Land Improvements

- Land for Structures - Rock-Cuts, Backfilling and Grading - Berms, Retention Ponds, - Fisheries, Landscaping, Environmental

2.7 Column Type

There are four column types that can be assigned to a Tender Item: Normal, Variation, Special, and Breakdown. The majority of Tender Items are either Normal or Variation types and are discussed further in this section. The Special and Breakdown column types are primarily used for Electrical and ATMS related work and are discussed in further detail in Volumes 3 and 4 of the CDED Manual. a) Normal

The title of a Normal Tender Item that is displayed in Contract Preparation System (CPS) is the exact title that will be displayed on the Tender Item List generated from CPS, as well as the column heading of the corresponding Quantity Sheets, with the exception that some titles are abbreviated in the

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 76: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

column headings of the Quantity Sheets in order to avoid spillover of the text onto the adjacent area of the Quantity Sheets. Abbreviated quantity sheet column headings are predetermined in CPS and cannot be edited by the designer. All of the quantities for Normal Tender Items are shown in a single column on the associated Quantity Sheets.

b) Variation The titles of Variation Tender Items that are displayed in CPS are the exact titles that will appear on the Tender Item Lists that are generated from CPS, however the titles that appear in the column heading of the corresponding Quantity Sheets can be modified by designers for the purpose of displaying different variations of an item, for example different sizes, colours, and types. As with Normal Tender Items the quantity sheet column heading titles may also be abbreviated in order to avoid spillover of the text. Tender item variations can be encoded to allow the selection of specific options by the designer for example red, black, or blue; or they can be left open to allow the entry of customized text by the designer. The quantities for Variation Tender Items will appear in a single column if only one variation is entered/selected by the designer, or in multiple columns, when more than one variation is selected. When multiple variations/columns are used the quantities for each variation are sub-totalled, then combined into the total for the Tender Item. The total quantity is the quantity that is shown on the Tender Item List that is generated from CPS.

2.8 Tender Item Accessories Certain Tender Items have associated accessories and detailed information about those accessories is provided in one or more adjacent columns of the associated Quantity Sheets. The quantity of each accessory column is sub-totalled for information purposes only. The sub-totals are not included in the Tender Item totals as the cost of accessories is included in the price of the associated Tender Item(s). In some cases a Tender Item with associated accessories may be used but the accessories are not applicable to the use of that item on a particular project. In this case the accessory column still appears on the associated Quantity Sheets but no quantities are entered or shown in the column.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 77: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

Example Variation Tender Item With Accessories The following example details a Variation type Tender Item with accessories.

As shown above the title of the Tender Item is Detector Loops. This is the title that will be displayed on the Tender Item List generated from CPS.

As shown below, by selecting the "Parms" tab the item Heading and associated Paramaters can be viewed.

The Heading is the title that appears in the column heading of the Quantity Sheets. Since this is a variation item the designer will be prompted to enter additional information when the item is inserted into the Quantity Sheets. The "%1" coding in the heading corresponds to Parameter No. 1 which will prompt the designer to enter the type of loop. In this case the designer will select from the predetermined Values of Simple, Duplex, or Diamond. The selected Value is

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 7 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 78: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

inserted into the corresponding position in the column heading. The designer can repeat the process to enter multiple columns and variations as shown below.

By selecting the "Acc" tab the Accessory information and associated Paramaters can be viewed. In this case there are no further Parameters or Values associated with the Accessory therefore the title in the column heading of the Quantity Sheets will appear as shown in the Heading field of the Accessory.

As shown in the sample quantity sheet below the quantities for each variation are sub-totalled, then combined into the total for the Tender Item. As discussed earlier, the accessories total is displayed for information purposes only and is not included in the quantity of the Tender Item.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 8 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 79: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

3.0 Plan Quantity Payment (PQP)

As stated in the General Conditions, "Measurement of the quantities of the Work shall be either by Actual Measurement or by Plan Quantity as indicated in the Contract Documents. Adjustments to Plan Quantities shall normally be made by modifying boundary lines and grades of the work on the plans to calculate new adjusted Plan Quantities but may, where appropriate, be made using Actual Measurements. Those items identified on the tender by the notation (P) in the unit column shall be paid according to the Plan Quantity. Items where the notation (P) does not occur shall be paid according to Actual Measurement or lump sum." Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) is a system of using theoretical design quantities for making payments on construction contracts. This system was adopted by the Ministry for the majority of contract Tender Items in order to reduce overhead and eliminate duplication of work. Plan Quantity means the quantity computed from the boundaries of the work as shown in the contract documents. It is computed prior to award of the contract but is subject to recomputation where either the boundaries of the work are changed or the computed quantity is found to be in error. Under the PQP system, payment is made according to the Plan Quantity. The work is verified to ensure it is constructed in accordance with the contract requirements, but the completed work is not measured for payment.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 9 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 80: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

Prior to the introduction of the PQP system all Tender Item quantities were computed during detail design for the purpose of calculating the tender estimate and then recomputed later in the field, from as constructed measurements for the purpose of contract payment. The majority of contract Tender Items are now designated as PQP however there are some that are paid by measured quantity; that is, the payment quantity is derived from field measurement of the work.

3.1 Measured Quantity (MQ) Items Certain items do not lend themselves to payment by PQP therefore these Tender Items are paid by Measured Quantity (MQ). Measured Quantity means the quantity within the approved limits of the work, measured in the field. Examples of such items include: granulars, hot mix, etc. These quantities are referred to as "Measured Quantities".

3.2 Lump Sum (LS) Items Lump Sum Item means a Tender Item indicating a portion of the Work for which payment shall be made at a single tendered price. Payment is not based on a measured quantity, although a quantity may be given in the Contract Documents.

3.3 Adjusted Plan Quantity

Adjusted Plan Quantity means the Plan Quantity is subject to adjustment because of an error in calculation or because of approved additions and/or deletions. Measurement for these additions and deletions will be by Plan Quantity procedures or, when necessary, actual field measurements. During construction it is often necessary to order changes which will result in amendments to the Plan Quantity, the resultant quantity is referred to as an Adjusted Plan Quantity. Corrections to the Plan Quantity that are made during construction as a result of errors are also referred to as Adjusted Plan Quantities.

3.4 Final Verification of PQP Quantities The purpose of the Final Verification of PQP quantities is to assure that the quantities are correct and that there has been uniform application of MTO policies and procedures, as the quantities represent the final payment to the Contractor.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 10 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 81: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Tender Items and PQP

Designers are responsible for providing accurate quantities for PQP Tender Items and for carrying out the final verification of PQP quantities for all capital design projects. Designers shall:

a) Ensure that the design quantities are accurate for final payment.

b) Review the detailed calculations to ensure that the design quantities are calculated in accordance with:

• plan sheets • Soils Design Report recommendations • standard drawings, special provisions and specifications • Contract Design, Estimating & Documentation Manual procedures • property agreements • mathematical principals • detailed field measurements

c) Review Construction Grading Report/Template Sheets for errors or

omissions.

d) Review the Contract Drawings to ensure there is no conflict with the calculated quantities.

e) Spot-check reinforcing steel schedule for accuracy in number and type of

bars (coated or non-coated).

4.0 Tender Items With Small Quantities Tender Items with small or impractical quantities should not be included in the Tender. These items should be included under Services Sundry or Force Account and Contingencies payment. The decision rests with the Project Manager who will determine the best course of action in consultation with the Regional Operations Office. Services Sundry and Force Account and Contingencies are discussed further in Chapter G, Section G-200.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 11 of 11 CDED B-110

Page 82: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 83: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Contingencies and Allowances

CONTINGENCIES AND ALLOWANCES 1.0 Introduction

For various reasons, “as-constructed” quantities are often at variance with the estimated quantities, therefore compensating factors must be applied to the estimated quantities to bring them more into line with expected “as-constructed” quantities. The compensating factors take the form of allowances and percentages which are added to the computed/estimated quantities. The allowances and percentages are applied on the basis of usage rather than the type of material used, and are subject to review by the Regional Geotechnical Sections.

2.0 Operations Requiring the Application of an Allowance The types of operations that require the application of an allowance or percentage to the estimated material quantities are:

a) Compaction of earth and granulars b) Placing granular base on granular sub-base c) Maintenance of traffic on gravel surfaces d) Fine grading of existing gravel surfaces prior to paving e) Placing granular sub-base on a previously constructed subgrade f) Placing granular sub-base on rock subgrade g) Stockpiling of aggregates

3.0 Application of Allowances and Percentages a) Compaction of Earth and Granulars

Earth and granular materials computed in cubic metres are increased by 15% to compensate for handling and compaction losses, in the following situations:

• Placing fill material (embankments) • Placing backfill material (swamps, structures, culverts, sewers)

Granular materials computed by volume and converted to tonnes by applying the appropriate conversion factor; do not require to be increased by 15%, as the conversion factor includes the percentage increase.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 3 CDED B-120

Page 84: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Contingencies and Allowances

b) Placing Granular Base on Granular Sub-base

To compensate for the loss of base course material into the sub-base, an additional 500t/km (for two-lane highways) of base course material is added to the computed quantity.

c) Maintenance of Traffic on Gravel Surfaces On contracts where traffic must be maintained on the granular base or gravel shoulders (including unpaved detours), the quantity of the surface material is increased by 10%.

d) Fine Grading of Existing Gravel Surfaces Prior to Paving Gravel Surfaces constructed under other contracts and open to traffic, need to be reshaped and restored to the specified cross-section prior to paving. Consult with the Operations Office or Regional Geotechnical Section in determining the rate of additional granular material to be applied to the existing roadbed for fine grading purposes. Generally, the rate varies between 100t/km and 300t/km for two-lane highways.

e) Placing Granular Sub-base on a Previously Constructed Subgrade Where the subgrade of a roadway was constructed one or more years prior to the intended placing of granular materials, the quantity computed for the granular sub-base is increased by 10%.

f) Placing Granular Sub-base on Rock Subgrade Where Granular B, Types I and III sub-base material is placed on rock grade (cuts and fills), the computed quantities are increased by the equivalent of an additional 150 mm depth of material to compensate for the expected loss caused by voids in the shatter and embankments. Where Granular B, Types II sub-base material is placed on rock grade (cuts and fills), the computed quantities are increased by the equivalent of an additional

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 3 CDED B-120

Page 85: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Contingencies and Allowances

100 mm depth of material to compensate for the expected loss caused by voids in the shatter and embankments.

g) Stockpiling of Aggregates For economic reasons, in areas where commercial aggregates are not generally available, the material required for surface treatment may be stockpiled under a grading contract. A 10% allowance should be added when calculating the required amount of stockpiled aggregate. Stockpiling of granular materials is paid for under the appropriate Tender Item.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 3 CDED B-120

Page 86: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 87: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B Checking of Quantities

CHECKING OF QUANTITIES 1.0 Introduction

Under the Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) concept, the accuracy of the plan quantities is of utmost importance. For jobs designed "in-house" the accuracy rests with the issuing office. The structural component is the responsibility of the Structural Office, the electrical component is the responsibility of the Electrical Office, etc. For jobs designed by Service Providers the accuracy rests with the designated provider. The Designer is responsible to ensure the accuracy of its component and that all relevant components are properly documented and assembled for a complete package.

2.0 Checking Each section in this chapter will eventually state the degree to which checking is required for individual tender items. Generally, Major Items or items with relatively high unit costs require 100% checking, for others spot checking is acceptable as noted. "Checking" means verification of quantity calculations and checking of all activities considered to be "TakeOff", i.e. scaling of offsets, scaling of installation lengths, counting of components for "each" items, etc. Spot checking means 100% checking of 20-25% of the work.

3.0 Checking of Items Paid for by an Outside Agency Items paid for fully, or in part, by an outside agency through an agreement must be checked 100% regardless of the recommendations stated in the individual sections.

4.0 Checking Verification All calculations and quantity summary sheets must be signed and dated by the person who performed the calculations and by the person doing the checking."

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 1 CDED B-130

Page 88: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 89: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

LIST OF ACTIVE STANDARD TENDER ITEMS

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0001-0000 Bonding & Insurance Normal lump sum N 0201-0010 Clearing Normal ha Y 0201-0020 Clearing Normal each Y 0201-0050 Close Cut Clearing Normal ha Y 0201-0060 Close Cut Clearing Normal each Y 0201-0070 Grubbing Normal ha Y 0201-0080 Grubbing Normal each Y 0201-0090 Mechanical Stump Cutting Normal each Y 0201-0100 Removal of Piled Boulders Normal m3 Y 0201-0101 Removal of Piled Boulders Normal lump sum N 0201-0110 Removal of Surface Boulders Normal ha Y 0201-0111 Removal of Surface Boulders Normal lump sum N 0202-0010 Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling Variation h N 0202-0020 Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling Variation h N 0202-0030 Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting Normal m N 0202-0040 Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting Normal m3 N 0203-0010 Rock Bolting Variation each N 0203-0020 Rock Shotcreting Normal m2 N 0203-0030 Rock Drains Normal each N 0203-0040 Concrete Buttress Normal m3 N 0206-0010 Earth Excavation, Grading Normal m3 Y 0206-0030 Rock Excavation, Grading Normal m3 Y 0206-0040 Rock Face Normal m2 Y 0206-0050 Excavation for Pavement Widening Normal m Y 0206-0055 Rock Embankment Normal m3 Y 0206-0060 Rock Supply Normal m3 N 0209-0010 Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Dragline Normal h N 0209-0015 Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Hydraulic Backhoe Normal h N 0209-0020 Geotextile for Swamp Treatment Normal m2 Y 0209-0030 Select Subgrade Material Normal t N 0209-0040 Select Subgrade Material (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0209-0050 Select Subgrade Material (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0212-0010 Earth Borrow Normal m3 N 0220-0010 Wick Drains Normal m Y 0299-0015 Earth Ditch Cleanout Normal m Y 0299-0035 Rock Ditch Cleanout Normal m Y 0299-2053 Shot Rock Normal m3 N 0299-2062 Rental of Motor Grader - 10,500 kg. Minimum Operating Weight Normal h N 0299-2063 Rental of Backhoe - Telescopic Boom, Carrier Mounted, Remote Control, 18,000 kg.,

Minimum Operating Weight Normal h N

0299-2064 Rental of Motor Grader - 4,500 kg. Minimum Operating Weight Normal h N 0299-2065 Rental of Hydraulic Backhoe-Rubber Tire with Wrist Action Bucket, 0.5 M3 - 12,000 kg Normal h N 0299-2067 Rental of Hydraulic Backhoe-Crawler Mounted,20,000 kg Minimum Operating Weight Normal h N 0299-2069 Rental of Truck-Dump, Tandem Rear Axle, Diesel or Gas, 18,000 kg. Minimum Operating

Weight Normal h N

August 2017 Page 1 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 90: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0299-2100 Drill and Blast Rock in Ditches Normal m N 0301-0010 Restoring Unpaved Roadway Surfaces Normal m2 Y 0304-0010 Binder (Type) Variation kg N 0304-0020 Class 1 Aggregate Normal t N 0304-0021 Class 1 Aggregate Normal m3 N 0304-0022 Class 1 Aggregate, from Stockpile Normal t N 0304-0023 Class 1 Aggregate, from Stockpile Normal m3 N 0304-0024 Class 1 Aggregate, Stockpiled Normal t N 0304-0025 Class 1 Aggregate, Stockpiled Normal m3 N 0304-0030 Class 2 Aggregate Variation t N 0304-0031 Class 2 Aggregate Variation m3 N 0304-0032 Class 2 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation t N 0304-0033 Class 2 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation m3 N 0304-0034 Class 2 Aggregate, Stockpiled Normal t N 0304-0035 Class 2 Aggregate, Stockpiled Normal m3 N 0304-0050 Class 4 Aggregate Variation t N 0304-0051 Class 4 Aggregate Variation m3 N 0304-0052 Class 4 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation t N 0304-0053 Class 4 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation m3 N 0304-0054 Class 4 Aggregate, Stockpiled Variation t N 0304-0055 Class 4 Aggregate, Stockpiled Variation m3 N 0304-0060 Class 6 Aggregate Variation t N 0304-0061 Class 6 Aggregate Variation m3 N 0304-0062 Class 6 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation t N 0304-0063 Class 6 Aggregate, from Stockpile Variation m3 N 0304-0064 Class 6 Aggregate, Stockpiled Variation t N 0304-0065 Class 6 Aggregate, Stockpiled Variation m3 N 0304-0070 Traffic Convoy Normal h N 0305-0015 Granular Sealing (m2) Variation m2 Y 0305-0025 Granular Sealing (kg) Variation kg N 0307-0010 SC-800 Patching Material Normal t N 0307-0020 Emulsified Asphalt Patching Material Normal t N 0307-0025 Proprietary Cold Patching Material Normal t N 0308-0010 Tack Coat Variation m2 Y 0311-0010 Asphalt Sidewalk Variation m2 Y 0311-0011 Asphalt Driveway Normal m2 Y 0311-0012 Asphalt Boulevard Normal m2 Y 0311-0020 Sidewalk Resurfacing Variation m2 Y 0312-0011 Asphalt Curb and Gutter Variation m Y 0312-0020 Asphalt Gutter Outlets Normal each Y 0312-0030 Asphalt Spillways Normal m Y 0312-0040 Asphalt Surfacing of Gutter Normal m Y 0313-1369 Superpave 4.75 Variation t N 0313-1370 Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous Normal m2 Y 0313-1372 Superpave 9.5 Variation t N 0313-1373 Superpave 12.5 Variation t N 0313-1374 Superpave 12.5FC 1 Variation t N 0313-1375 Superpave 12.5FC 2 Variation t N

August 2017 Page 2 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 91: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0313-1376 Superpave 19.0 Variation t N 0313-1377 Superpave 25.0 Variation t N 0313-1378 Superpave 37.5 Variation t N 0313-1385 Superpave 19.0 Variation m2 Y 0313-1390 Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix Variation t N 0313-1391 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix Variation t N 0313-1392 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix Variation t N 0313-1393 Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix Variation t N 0313-1394 Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix Variation t N 0313-1410 SMA 9.5 Variation t N 0313-1415 SMA 12.5 Variation t N 0313-1420 SMA 19.0 Variation t N 0313-1421 SMA 19.0 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1422 SMA 19.0 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1423 SMA 19.0 - 70 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1425 SMA 9.5 - 25 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1426 SMA 9.5 - 30 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1427 SMA 9.5 - 35 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1430 SMA 12.5 - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1431 SMA 12.5 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1432 SMA 12.5 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1530 Superpave 9.5 - 25 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1531 Superpave 9.5 - 30 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1532 Superpave 9.5 - 35 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1535 Superpave 12.5 - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1536 Superpave 12.5 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1537 Superpave 12.5 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1540 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1541 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1542 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1545 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1546 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1547 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1551 Superpave 19.0 - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1552 Superpave 19.0 - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1553 Superpave 19.0 - 70 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1610 Superpave 25.0 - 80 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1611 Superpave 25.0 - 90 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1612 Superpave 25.0 - 100 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1613 Superpave 25.0 - 110 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1620 Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1621 Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1622 Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1625 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1626 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1627 Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1630 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix - 40 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1631 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y

August 2017 Page 3 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 92: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0313-1632 Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1635 Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix - 50 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1636 Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix - 60 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1637 Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix - 70 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1640 Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix - 80 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1641 Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix - 90 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1642 Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix - 100 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0313-1643 Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix - 110 mm Lift Thickness Variation m2 Y 0314-0071 Granular A Variation t N 0314-0081 Granular A (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0086 Granular A (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0091 Granular A, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0101 Granular A, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0106 Granular A, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0111 Granular A, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0121 Granular A, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0126 Granular A, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0130 Granular B, Type I Variation t N 0314-0140 Granular B, Type I (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0145 Granular B, Type I (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0150 Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0160 Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0165 Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0170 Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0180 Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0185 Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0190 Granular B, Type II Variation t N 0314-0200 Granular B, Type II (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0205 Granular B, Type II (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0210 Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0220 Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0225 Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0230 Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0240 Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0245 Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0250 Granular M Normal t N 0314-0260 Granular M (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0265 Granular M (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0270 Granular M, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0280 Granular M, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0285 Granular M, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0290 Granular M, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0300 Granular M, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0305 Granular M, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0310 Select Subgrade Material, Compacted Normal t N 0314-0320 Select Subgrade Material, Compacted (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0330 Select Subgrade Material, Compacted (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0340 Granular O Normal t N

August 2017 Page 4 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 93: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0314-0341 Granular O (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0342 Granular O (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0343 Granular O, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0344 Granular O, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0345 Granular O, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0346 Granular O, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0347 Granular O, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0348 Granular O, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0390 Granular B, Type III Variation t N 0314-0401 Granular B, Type III (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0402 Granular B, Type III (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0403 Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled Normal t N 0314-0404 Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0405 Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0406 Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile Normal t N 0314-0407 Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile (End Area Method) Normal m3 N 0314-0408 Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Normal m3 N 0316-0011 Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment Variation m2 Y 0320-0020 Open Graded Drainage Layer Normal m2 Y 0330-0010 In-Place Full Depth Reclamation of Bituminous Pavement and Underlying Granular Variation m2 Y 0331-0010 Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization Normal m2 Y 0332-0010 Hot In-Place Recycled Mix Normal m2 Y 0333-0010 Cold In-Place Recycled Mix Normal m2 Y 0335-0010 Cold In-Place Recycled Expanded Asphalt Mix Normal m2 Y 0336-0010 Micro-Surfacing Type II Normal m2 Y 0336-0015 Micro-Surfacing Type III Modified Normal m2 Y 0336-0020 Micro-Surfacing Type III Normal m2 Y 0337-0101 Slurry Seal - Type I Normal m2 Y 0337-0111 Slurry Seal - Type II Normal m2 Y 0337-0121 Slurry Seal - Type III Normal m2 Y 0341-0010 Routing and Sealing Cracks in Asphalt Pavement Normal m N 0341-0020 Sealing Cracks in Asphalt Pavement Normal m N 0342-0130 Centreline Rumble Strips - Asphalt Variation m Y 0342-0140 Shoulder Rumble Strips - Asphalt Variation m Y 0342-0150 Shoulder Rumble Strips for Bicycle Buffer Zones - Asphalt Variation m Y 0350-0010 Concrete Pavement Normal m2 Y 0350-0020 Concrete Base Normal m2 Y 0351-0010 Concrete Sidewalk Variation m2 Y 0351-0012 Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps Normal EACH SET Y 0353-0011 Concrete Curb and Gutter Variation m Y 0353-0020 Concrete Gutter Outlets Variation each Y 0355-0010 Interlocking Concrete Pavers Variation m2 Y 0363-0010 Precast Concrete Slab Repair Normal m2 Y 0365-0010 Cross-Stitching Longitudinal Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base Variation each N 0369-0010 Resealing of Joints and Sealing or Resealing of Cracks in Concrete Pavement Normal m Y 0399-1010 Full Depth Concrete Repair Variation m2 Y 0399-1020 Fast Track Full Depth Concrete Repair Variation m2 N 0399-1030 Partial Depth Concrete Repair Variation m2 N

August 2017 Page 5 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 94: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0399-1040 Fast Track Partial Depth Concrete Repair Variation m2 N 0399-2010 Full Depth Crack Repairs Normal m Y 0399-2020 Temporary Hot Mix Pavement Normal t N 0399-3180 Cut and Fill Grooves in Surface Course Normal m N 0399-3220 Bituminous Patches to Spalls Normal m2 N 0399-3230 Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth Variation t N 0399-3240 Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth Normal m2 Y 0399-3280 Reclaim Asphalt Pavement, Full Depth, Over Concrete Normal m2 Y 0399-3415 Clear Stone Normal t N 0403-0010 Rock Excavation for Trenches and Associated Structures Normal m3 Y 0405-0010 Pipe Subdrains Variation m Y 0405-0015 Closed Circuit Television Inspection Normal m N 0407-0010 600 mm x 600 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0020 600 mm x 1200 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0030 600 mm x 1450 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0040 1200 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0050 1200 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m Normal each Y 0407-0060 1500 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0070 1500 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m Normal each Y 0407-0080 1800 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0090 1800 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m Normal each Y 0407-0100 2400 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0110 2400 mm Manholes Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m Normal each Y 0407-0200 Special Design Manholes Normal each Y 0407-0300 Adjusting and Rebuilding Manholes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0407-0400 Breaking into Manholes Catch Basins,Ditch Inlets,Culverts and Sewers Normal each Y 0407-0500 Rock Excavation for Sewers, Manholes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Normal m3 Y 0407-0600 Catch Basin Collar Normal each Y 0408-0001 Item TBA Normal n/a N 0410-0100 100 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0200 200 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0300 300 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0400 400 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0500 500 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0600 600 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0700 700 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0800 800 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-0900 900 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1000 1000 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1200 1200 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1300 1300 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1400 1400 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1500 1500 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1600 1600 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1800 1800 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-1900 1900 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2000 2000 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2100 2100 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y

August 2017 Page 6 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 95: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0410-2200 2200 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2400 2400 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2500 2500 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2600 2600 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-2700 2700 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-3000 3000 mm Pipe Sewer Variation m Y 0410-4500 Concrete Appurtenances (for Pipe Sewers) Normal m3 Y 0410-6400 Clay Seal Normal lump sum N 0415-0010 Tunnel Normal m Y 0415-0020 Rock Excavation In Tunnelling Normal m3 Y 0416-0010 Jacking and Boring Variation m Y 0421-0105 100 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0205 200 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0305 300 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0405 400 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0505 500 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0605 600 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0705 700 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0805 800 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-0905 900 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1005 1000 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1205 1200 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1305 1300 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1405 1400 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1505 1500 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1605 1600 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1805 1800 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-1905 1900 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2005 2000 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2105 2100 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2205 2200 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2405 2400 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2505 2500 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2605 2600 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-2705 2700 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-3005 3000 mm Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-6205 1400 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6206 1600 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6207 1800 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6211 400 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6212 500 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6213 600 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6214 700 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6215 800 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6216 900 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6217 1000 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6219 1200 mm Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6222 500 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y

August 2017 Page 7 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 96: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0421-6223 600 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6224 700 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6225 800 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6226 900 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6227 1000 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6229 1200 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Variation m Y 0421-6400 Clay Seal Normal lump sum N 0421-6500 Concrete Appurtenances (for Pipe Culverts) Normal m3 Y 0421-7040 400 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7050 500 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7060 600 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7070 700 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7080 800 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7090 900 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7100 1000 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7110 1100 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7120 1200 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7130 1300 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7140 1400 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7150 1500 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7160 1600 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7170 1700 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7180 1800 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7190 1900 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7200 2000 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7210 2100 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7220 2200 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7240 2400 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0421-7250 2500 mm Non-circular Pipe Culvert Variation m Y 0422-0100 1800 mm x 900 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0110 1800 mm x 1200 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0120 2400 mm x 1200 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0130 2400 mm x 1500 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0140 2400 mm x 1800 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0145 2500 mm x 1830 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0150 3000 mm x 1500 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0160 3000 mm x 1800 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0170 3000 mm x 2100 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0422-0180 3000 mm x 2400 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert Normal m Y 0441-0010 Watermains Variation m Y 0441-0020 Valves Variation each Y 0441-0030 Hydrant Sets Variation each Y 0441-0050 Service Connection Pipe Variation m Y 0441-0055 Service Connection Appurtenance Sets Normal each Y 0441-0060 Connections to Existing Watermains Normal each Y 0493-0010 Temporary Potable Water Supply Services Normal lump sum N 0499-4040 Granular Filter Blanket Normal t N 0499-4050 Rock Excavation for Subdrains Normal m3 Y

August 2017 Page 8 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 97: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0499-4071 Clean Out Catch Basins, Maintenance Holes and Ditch Inlets Normal each Y 0499-4080 Weld and Release Maintenance Hole and Catch Basin Frames and Grates Normal each Y 0510-3130 Cutting Existing Pavement Variation m Y 0510-3133 Removal of Asphalt Pavement Variation m2 Y 0510-3134 Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces Variation m2 Y 0510-3136 Removal of Asphalt-Treated Base Normal m2 Y 0510-3137 Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial-Depth Variation m2 Y 0510-3139 Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures Normal m2 Y 0510-3501 Removal of Concrete Pavement Variation m2 Y 0510-3504 Removal of Cement-Treated Base Variation m2 Y 0510-3505 Removal of Concrete Base Variation m2 Y 0510-3507 Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial-Depth Variation m2 Y 0510-3512 Removal of Concrete Sidewalk Normal m2 Y 0510-3531 Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter Variation m Y 0510-3532 Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter Variation m Y 0510-4071 Removal of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers Normal each Y 0510-4072 Abandonment of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers,

Partial-Depth Variation each Y

0510-4073 Capping of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers Normal each Y 0510-4075 Removal of Pipe Subdrains Normal m Y 0510-4076 Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts Normal m Y 0510-4210 Removal of Pipes and Culverts Variation m Y 0510-5401 Removal of Fence Variation m Y 0510-5402 Removal of Ramp Closure Gates Normal each Y 0510-5500 Removal of Energy Attenuators Variation each Y 0510-5511 Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier Variation m Y 0510-5521 Removal of Delineator Posts Variation each Y 0510-5523 Removal of Cable Guide Rail Variation m Y 0510-5526 Removal of Anchor Blocks Normal each Y 0510-5528 Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail Variation m Y 0510-5530 Removal of Concrete Barrier Variation m Y 0510-5991 Removal of Noise Barrier Variation m Y 0510-7081 Removal of Hydrants Normal each Y 0510-7082 Removal of Valves Normal each Y 0510-7083 Removal of Watermain Appurtenances Normal each Y 0510-7085 Removal of Gabions Normal m3 Y 0510-9010 Removal of Bridge Structure Normal LS/M3 N 0510-9015 Removal of Bridge Footings Normal m3 N 0510-9030 Removal of Concrete Normal m3 Y 0510-9035 Removal of Sign Support Structure Normal each Y 0510-9038 Removal of Sign Support Structure Footings Normal each Y 0510-9055 Removal and Reinstallation of Steel Handrails Normal LS/M N 0510-9065 Removal and Reinstallation of Diaphragms Normal lump sum N 0510-9070 Removal and Reinstallation of Railway Blast Deflection Plates Normal lump sum N 0510-9075 Removal and Reinstallation of Appurtenances Normal lump sum N 0510-9080 Removal of Appurtenances Normal lump sum N 0510-9183 Removal of Modular Bridge Variation LS/T N 0510-9184 Removal of Modular Bridge Substructures Normal LS/M3 N

August 2017 Page 9 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 98: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0511-0120 Rock Protection Normal m3 Y 0511-0130 Granular Sheeting Normal m2 Y 0511-0145 Rip-Rap Variation m2 Y 0511-0150 Geotextile Variation m2 Y 0512-0010 Gabions Normal m3 Y 0512-0015 Gabion Structures Not Exceeding 2m Height Normal m3 Y 0517-0010 Dewatering System Normal lump sum N 0517-0020 Temporary Flow Passage System Normal lump sum N 0539-0040 Protection System Normal lump sum N 0599-5311 Geogrid Normal m2 N 0599-5320 Snow Fence Normal m N 0599-5948 Grader Rental Normal h N 0599-5960 Retained Soil System, True Abutment Normal lump sum N 0599-5961 Retained Soil System, False Abutment Normal lump sum N 0599-5962 Retained Soil System, Wall/Slope, High Performance Normal lump sum N 0599-5963 Retained Soil System, Wall/Slope, Medium Performance Normal lump sum N 0599-5964 Retained Soil System, Wall/Slope, Low Performance Normal lump sum N 0599-5965 Retained Soil System with Finishing Cap, Wall/Slope, High Performance Normal lump sum N 0599-5966 Retained Soil System with Finishing Cap, Wall/Slope, Medium Performance Normal lump sum N 0599-5969 Retained Soil System, Roadbase Embankment Normal lump sum N 0599-5970 Backfill for Retained Soil System, Ultra Lightweight Normal t N 0599-5971 Backfill for Retained Soil System, Lightweight Normal t N 0599-5972 Backfill for Retained Soil System, High Performance Normal t N 0599-5973 Backfill for Retained Soil System, Medium Performance Normal t N 0599-5974 Backfill for Retained Soil System, Low Performance Normal t N 0601-0010 Maintenance and Operation For Temporary Traffic Signal System Work Normal lump sum N 0602-0025 Electrical Maintenance Holes Variation each Y 0602-0026 Electrical Maintenance Holes (Temporary) Variation each Y 0602-0031 Adjusting and Rebuilding Electrical Chambers Normal each Y 0602-0045 Electrical Handholes Variation each Y 0602-0046 Electrical Handholes (Temporary) Variation each Y 0602-0050 Electrical Chamber Drains Variation m Y 0602-0051 Electrical Chamber Drains (Temporary) Variation m Y 0603-0025 Flexible Ducts Special m Y 0603-0026 Flexible Ducts (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0027 Flexible Ducts by Subsurface Installation Special m Y 0603-0028 Flexible Ducts by Subsurface Installation (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0029 Flexible Ducts by Subsurface Installation for Magnetic Detectors Variation m Y 0603-0030 Rigid Ducts, Concrete Encased for Magnetic Detectors Variation m Y 0603-0035 Rigid Ducts, Concrete Encased Special m Y 0603-0036 Rigid Ducts, Concrete Encased (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0045 Rigid Ducts, Direct Buried Special m Y 0603-0046 Rigid Ducts, Direct Buried (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0055 Rigid Ducts by Subsurface Installation Special m Y 0603-0056 Rigid Ducts by Subsurface Installation (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0065 Rigid Ducts, Steel Encased by Subsurface Installation Special m Y 0603-0066 Rigid Ducts, Steel Encased by Subsurface Installation (Temporary) Special m Y 0603-0071 Rock Excavation for Electrical Installations Normal m3 Y

August 2017 Page 10 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 99: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0603-0081 Surface Mounted Duct Systems Special m Y 0603-0082 Surface Mounted Duct Systems (Temporary) Special m Y 0604-0015 High Voltage Cables, Direct Buried Variation m Y 0604-0016 High Voltage Cables, Direct Buried (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0020 Low Voltage Cables, Direct Buried Variation m Y 0604-0021 Low Voltage Cables, Direct Buried (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0025 Extra Low Voltage Cables, Direct Buried Variation m Y 0604-0026 Extra Low Voltage Cables, Direct Buried (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0030 Traffic Signal Cables, Direct Buried Variation m Y 0604-0031 Traffic Signal Cables, Direct Buried (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0035 Coaxial Cables, Direct Buried Normal m Y 0604-0036 Coaxial Cables, Direct Buried (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0040 High Voltage Cables, in Ducts Variation m Y 0604-0041 High Voltage Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0045 Low Voltage Cables, in Ducts Variation m Y 0604-0046 Low Voltage Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0050 Extra Low Voltage Cables, in Ducts Variation m Y 0604-0051 Extra Low Voltage Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0052 Extra Low Voltage Cables for Magnetic Detectors, In Ducts Normal m Y 0604-0053 Extra Low Voltage Cables for Magnetic Detectors, In Ducts (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0055 Traffic Signal Cables, in Ducts Variation m Y 0604-0056 Traffic Signal Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0060 Coaxial Cables, in Ducts Normal m Y 0604-0061 Coaxial Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0065 Communication Cables, in Ducts Normal m Y 0604-0066 Communication Cables, in Ducts (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0070 Low Voltage Cables, Aerial with ACSR Neutral Variation m Y 0604-0071 Low Voltage Cables, Aerial with ACSR Neutral (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0075 Low Voltage Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable Variation m Y 0604-0076 Low Voltage Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0080 Extra Low Voltage Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable Variation m Y 0604-0081 Extra Low Voltage Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0085 Traffic Signal Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable Variation m Y 0604-0086 Traffic Signal Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0090 Coaxial Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable Normal m Y 0604-0091 Coaxial Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0092 Communication Cables Aerial Normal m Y 0604-0093 Communication Cables Aerial (Temporary) Normal m Y 0604-0095 Steel Messenger Cables, Aerial Variation m Y 0604-0096 Steel Messenger Cables, Aerial (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0100 ACSR Cables, Aerial Variation m Y 0604-0101 ACSR Cables, Aerial (Temporary) Variation m Y 0604-0105 High Voltage Terminations and Splices Normal each Y 0604-0106 High Voltage Terminations and Splices (Temporary) Normal each Y 0609-0020 Ground Wires Variation m Y 0609-0021 Ground Wires (Temporary) Variation m Y 0609-0030 Ground Electrodes Variation each Y 0609-0031 Ground Electrodes (Temporary) Variation each Y

August 2017 Page 11 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 100: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0609-0040 Bonding Jumpers Variation each Y 0609-0041 Bonding Jumpers (Temporary) Variation each Y 0610-0010 Removal of Electrical Equipment Variation lump sum N 0611-0020 Underpass Luminaires Variation each Y 0611-0021 Underpass Luminaires (Temporary) Variation each Y 0611-0040 Replace Underpass Luminaires Variation each Y 0611-0050 Relamp Underpass Luminaires Variation each Y 0614-0030 Distribution Assemblies Variation each Y 0614-0031 Distribution Assemblies (Temporary) Variation each Y 0614-0040 Supply Control Cabinet Assemblies Variation each Y 0614-0041 Supply Control Cabinet Assemblies (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0020 Sectional Steel Poles, Direct Buried in Earth Variation each Y 0615-0021 Sectional Steel Poles, Direct Buried in Earth (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0030 Concrete Poles, Direct Buried in Earth Variation each Y 0615-0031 Concrete Poles, Direct Buried in Earth (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0040 Wood Poles, Direct Buried in Earth Variation each Y 0615-0041 Wood Poles, Direct Buried in Earth (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0060 Sectional Steel Poles, Direct Buried in Rock Variation each Y 0615-0061 Sectional Steel Poles, Direct Buried in Rock (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0070 Concrete Poles, Direct Buried in Rock Variation each Y 0615-0080 Wood Poles, Direct Buried in Rock Variation each Y 0615-0081 Wood Poles, Direct Buried in Rock (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0099 Heavy Class Sectional Steel Poles, Base Mounted Variation each Y 0615-0100 Sectional Steel Poles, Base Mounted Variation each Y 0615-0101 Sectional Steel Poles, Base Mounted (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0109 Heavy Class Steel Poles, Base Mounted Variation each Y 0615-0110 Steel Poles, Base Mounted Variation each Y 0615-0111 Steel Poles, Base Mounted (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0120 Aluminum Poles, Base Mounted Variation each Y 0615-0121 Aluminum Poles, Base Mounted (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0130 Frangible Bases Variation each Y 0615-0131 Frangible Bases (Temporary) Variation each Y 0615-0140 Guy Anchors Normal each Y 0615-0141 Guy Anchors (Temporary) Normal each Y 0615-0160 Breakaway Base Anti-Theft Device Normal each Y 0616-0020 Concrete Footings in Earth Variation each Y 0616-0021 Concrete Footings in Earth (Temporary) Variation each Y 0616-0030 Concrete Footings in Rock Variation each Y 0616-0031 Concrete Footings in Rock (Temporary) Variation each Y 0616-0040 Concrete Pads Variation each Y 0616-0041 Concrete Pads (Temporary) Variation each Y 0616-0045 Wooden Pads Variation each Y 0616-0046 Wooden Pads (Temporary) Variation each Y 0616-0050 Steel Footings Variation each Y 0616-0051 Steel Footings (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0020 Roadway Lighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies Variation each Y 0617-0021 Roadway Lighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0022 LED Roadway Lighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies Variation each Y

August 2017 Page 12 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 101: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0617-0023 LED Roadway Lighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0030 Floodlighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies Variation each Y 0617-0031 Floodlighting Luminaires and Bracket Assemblies (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0040 Replace Roadway Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0041 Replace LED Roadway Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0050 Replace Floodlighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0060 Relamp Roadway Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0070 Relamp Floodlighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0080 High Mast Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0081 High Mast Lighting Luminaires (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0082 Replace High Mast Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0083 Relamp High Mast Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0084 LED High Mast Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0617-0085 LED High Mast Lighting Luminaires (Temporary) Variation each Y 0617-0086 Replace LED High Mast Lighting Luminaires Variation each Y 0620-0020 Single Member Arms and Signal Hangers Variation each Y 0620-0021 Single Member Arms and Signal Hangers (Temporary) Variation each Y 0620-0030 Overbrace Arms and Signal Hangers Variation each Y 0620-0031 Overbrace Arms and Signal Hangers (Temporary) Variation each Y 0620-0040 Double Arm Brackets Variation each Y 0620-0041 Double Arm Brackets (Temporary) Variation each Y 0620-0050 Highway Type Signal Heads Normal each Y 0620-0051 Highway Type Signal Heads (Temporary) Normal each Y 0620-0060 Special Type Signal Heads Variation each Y 0620-0061 Special Type Signal Heads (Temporary) Variation each Y 0620-0070 Standard Type Signal Heads Normal each Y 0620-0071 Standard Type Signal Heads (Temporary) Normal each Y 0620-0080 Pedestrian Type Signal Heads Normal each Y 0620-0081 Pedestrian Type Signal Heads (Temporary) Normal each Y 0620-0090 Single Signal Head Sections Variation each Y 0620-0091 Single Signal Head Sections (Temporary) Variation each Y 0620-0100 Optically Directed Signal Heads Normal each Y 0620-0101 Optically Directed Signal Heads (Temporary) Normal each Y 0620-0110 Traffic Signal Equipment Modifications Breakdown each Y 0620-0111 Traffic Signal Equipment Modifications (Temporary) Breakdown each Y 0621-0020 Flasher Beacons and Downlights Variation each Y 0621-0021 Flasher Beacons and Downlights (Temporary) Variation each Y 0621-0030 Flasher Beacons Variation each Y 0621-0031 Flasher Beacons (Temporary) Variation each Y 0621-0040 Sign Light Assemblies for Keep Right Signs Variation each Y 0621-0041 Sign Light Assemblies for Keep Right Signs (Temporary) Variation each Y 0621-0050 Internally Illuminated Signs Variation each Y 0621-0051 Internally Illuminated Signs (Temporary) Variation each Y 0621-0060 Flasher Mechanisms Variation each Y 0621-0061 Flasher Mechanisms (Temporary) Variation each Y 0622-0020 Traffic Signal Controllers Variation each Y 0622-0021 Traffic Signal Controllers (Temporary) Variation each Y 0622-0040 Traffic Signal Controller Modifications Breakdown each Y

August 2017 Page 13 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 102: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0623-0020 Loop Detectors Variation each Y 0623-0021 Loop Detectors (Temporary) Variation each Y 0623-0022 ATMS Loop Detectors Variation each Y 0623-0023 ATMS Loop Detectors (Temporary) Variation each Y 0623-0030 Prefabricated Detector Loops Variation each Y 0623-0035 Traffic Count Station Variation each Y 0623-0040 Probe Detectors Variation each Y 0623-0041 Probe Detectors (Temporary) Variation each Y 0623-0080 Pedestrian Pushbuttons Normal each Y 0623-0081 Pedestrian Pushbuttons (Temporary) Normal each Y 0623-0082 Accessible Pedestrian Signals Normal each Y 0623-0083 Accessible Pedestrian Signals (Temporary) Normal each Y 0623-0084 Non-Intrusive Detection System Normal each Y 0623-0085 Non-Intrusive Detection System (Temporary) Normal each Y 0630-0025 25m Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles and Equipment Variation each Y 0630-0030 30m Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles and Equipment Variation each Y 0630-0035 35m Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles and Equipment Variation each Y 0630-0040 40m Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles and Equipment Variation each Y 0630-0045 45m Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles and Equipment Variation each Y 0631-0020 Concrete Footings for High Mast Lighting Poles Normal each Y 0631-0022 Maintenance Platform for High Mast Lighting Poles Variation each N 0681-0010 Maintenance and Warranty for Advanced Traffic Management System Work Normal lump sum N 0681-0020 Training For Advanced Traffic Management System Work Normal lump sum N 0681-0030 Spare Components for Advanced Traffic Management System Work Normal lump sum N 0681-0040 System Integration Testing for Advanced Traffic Management System Work Normal lump sum N 0681-0050 Ground Deployment of Portable Variable Message Signs Normal each Y 0681-0055 Fixed Support Deployment of Variable Message Signs Normal each Y 0681-0060 Maintenance and Warranty for Portable Variable Message Signs Normal lump sum N 0682-0009 ATMS Field Equipment Cabinet Maintenance Sites Variation each Y 0682-0030 Extra Low Voltage Cables in Sawcut Slots Variation m Y 0682-0045 Uninterruptible Power Supply Units Normal each Y 0682-0046 External Uninterruptible Power Supply Units Normal each Y 0682-0050 Base Mounted Communication Pedestals Normal each Y 0682-0055 Controller Cabinets, Pole Mounted Normal each Y 0682-0060 Controller Cabinets Variation each Y 0682-0061 Controllers Normal each Y 0682-0063 Non-Intrusive Traffic Sensors (Microwave) Normal each Y 0682-0065 Loop Vehicle Detector Sensor Units Variation each Y 0682-0070 Test Existing Loop Detectors Normal each Y 0682-0071 Sawcut Slot for Extra Low Voltage Cables Normal m Y 0682-0080 Removal of Advanced Traffic Management System Equipment Breakdown lump sum N 0682-0081 Removal of Advanced Traffic Management System Equipment Variation lump sum N 0682-0091 Inner Chambers Variation m Y 0682-0100 Concrete Pole, Direct Buried in Earth with Camera Raising and Lowering System Variation each Y 0682-0105 Concrete Pole, Direct Buried in Rock with Camera Raising and Lowering System Variation each Y 0683-0009 Splice Enclosures for Fibre Optic Cables Variation each Y 0683-0010 Fibre Optic Communication Cables, in Ducts Variation m Y 0683-0012 Data Interface Cables Normal lump sum N

August 2017 Page 14 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 103: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0683-0013 Fibre Optic Communication Cables, In Ducts (Temporary) Normal m Y 0683-0014 Fibre Optic Communication Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable Variation m Y 0683-0015 Fibre Optic Communication Cables, Aerial on Messenger Cable (Temporary) Normal m Y 0683-0020 Video Transmitters and Receivers Variation each Y 0683-0023 Video System Line Up and Test Normal lump sum N 0683-0027 Gateway Routers Normal each Y 0683-0030 Drop/Insert Nodes Normal each Y 0683-0034 Port Sharing Devices Normal each Y 0683-0035 Data System Line Up and Test Normal lump sum N 0683-0036 Fibre Optic Modems Normal each Y 0683-0037 Fibre Optic Ethernet Modems Normal each Y 0683-0050 Wireless Ethernet Bridges Normal each Y 0683-0055 Digital Video Encoders and Decoders Variation each Y 0683-0060 Port Servers Normal each Y 0683-0065 Ethernet Switches Variation each Y 0684-0010 Outdoor Closed Circuit Television Cameras Normal each Y 0684-0051 Closed Circuit Television Video Monitors Variation each Y 0684-0055 Dome Camera System Normal each Y 0685-0010 Variable Message Signs Variation each Y 0685-0021 Fixed Support Mountable Variable Message Signs Normal each Y 0687-9010 Rack Assemblies Normal each Y 0699-6040 Snow Melting Systems Normal lump sum N 0699-6140 Modification of Power Supply Equipment Normal lump sum N 0699-6141 Lighting Control System Normal lump sum N 0699-6142 Power Supply Cabinets Variation each Y 0699-6143 Power Supply Cabinets (Temporary) Normal each Y 0699-6145 Generators (Temporary) Normal each Y 0699-6146 Outdoor Receptacles Normal each Y 0699-6148 Power Service Pedestals Normal each Y 0699-6149 Transformers Normal each Y 0699-6210 Flasher Beacons with Signs Normal each Y 0699-6232 Emergency Vehicle Pre-emption Equipment Normal each Y 0699-6233 Emergency Vehicle Pre-emption Equipment (Temporary) Normal each Y 0703-0020 Small Signs, Ground Mounted, New Normal each Y 0703-0021 Small Signs, Relocation Normal each Y 0703-0022 Small Signs, Removal Normal each Y 0704-0025 Post Mounted Delineators Variation each Y 0705-0020 Flexible Delineator Post - Permanent Variation each Y 0705-0025 Flexible Delineator Post - Temporary Variation each Y 0705-0030 Flexible Delineator Post - Relocation Variation each Y 0706-0012 Portable Variable Message Sign, Relocation Variation each Y 0706-0013 Portable Variable Message Sign (Temporary) Variation each Y 0706-0015 Temporary Traffic Control Signs Normal lump sum N 0706-0020 Automated Flagger Assistance Devices Normal each Y 0706-0045 Road Closing / Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) Normal each Y 0707-0010 Modified Overhead Signboards Normal each Y 0708-0010 Portable Temporary Traffic Signals Normal each Y 0710-0007 Pavement Marking Obliterating - By Abrasive Blasting Normal m Y

August 2017 Page 15 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 104: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0710-0008 Pavement Marking Obliterating - By Grinding Normal m Y 0710-0009 Pavement Marking Obliterating - By Black Line Mask Normal m Y 0710-0010 Pavement Marking Variation m Y 0710-0016 Pavement Markers, Recessed Normal each Y 0710-0020 Pavement Marking Symbols Variation each Y 0710-0030 Pavement Marking, Durable Variation m Y 0710-0040 Pavement Marking Symbols, Durable Variation each Y 0710-0050 Pavement Marking, Temporary Variation m Y 0710-0051 Pavement Marking, Temporary Normal lump sum N 0710-0060 Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary Variation each Y 0710-0070 Pavement Marking, Temporary - Removable Variation m Y 0710-0080 Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary - Removable Variation each Y 0710-0090 Raised Pavement Markers, Temporary Variation each Y 0710-0110 Pavement Marking, Temporary, Field Reacted Polymeric - Fluorescent Orange Variation m Y 0710-0115 Pavement Marking, Temporary, Paint - Fluorescent Orange Variation m Y 0710-0120 Pavement Marking, Temporary Removable - Fluorescent Orange Variation m Y 0721-0037 Adjust Cable Guide Rail Normal m Y 0721-0038 Cable Guide Rail Post Replacement Normal each Y 0721-0050 Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail Variation m Y 0721-0053 Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail, Base Plated For Shallow Culverts Variation m Y 0721-0060 Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail with Channel Variation m Y 0721-0070 Double Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail Variation m Y 0721-0080 Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Wooden Posts Variation m Y 0721-0085 Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Steel Posts Variation m Y 0721-0090 Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Steel Posts with Steel Offset Blocks Variation m Y 0723-4100 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, Narrow Variation each Y 0723-4101 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, Wide Variation each Y 0723-4102 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, Extra Wide Variation each Y 0723-4103 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, High Exposure Variation each Y 0723-4104 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, Single Sided Normal each Y 0723-4105 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Narrow Variation each Y 0723-4106 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Wide Variation each Y 0723-4107 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Extra Wide Variation each Y 0723-4108 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Reduced Exposure Variation each Y 0723-4109 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Dual Duty Variation each Y 0723-4110 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Narrow Variation each Y 0723-4111 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Wide Variation each Y 0723-4112 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Extra Wide Variation each Y 0723-4113 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Reduced Exposure Variation each Y 0723-4114 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Dual Duty Variation each Y 0723-4115 Energy Attenuator - Permanent, Super Wide Variation each Y 0723-4116 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Super Wide Variation each Y 0723-4117 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Super Wide Variation each Y 0732-0100 Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal System Variation each Y 0740-0010 Concrete Barrier Variation m Y 0740-0012 Asymmetric Concrete Barrier Variation m Y 0740-0015 Tall Wall Barrier Variation m Y 0740-0018 Asymmetric Tall Wall Barrier Variation m Y

August 2017 Page 16 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 105: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0741-0020 Temporary Concrete Barrier Normal m Y 0741-0025 Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation Normal m Y 0741-0028 Temporary Concrete Barrier, Drainage Gap Normal each Y 0741-0030 Temporary Concrete Barrier, Reduced Deflection Normal m Y 0741-0035 Temporary Concrete Barrier, Reduced Deflection, Relocation Normal m Y 0741-0100 Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier Normal m Y 0741-0110 Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation Normal m Y 0741-0120 Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift Normal lump sum N 0741-5600 Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Pinned Normal m Y 0741-5601 Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Strapped Normal m Y 0741-5602 Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Bolted Normal m Y 0753-0010 Connecticut Impact Attenuation System Normal each Y 0760-5100 2 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5105 2.5 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5110 3 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5111 3 m Noise Barrier System Including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0760-5115 3.5 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5116 3.5 m Noise Barrier System Including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0760-5117 3.5 m Noise Barrier System on Structures Normal m Y 0760-5120 4 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5121 4 m Noise Barrier System Including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0760-5122 4 m Noise Barrier System on Structures Normal m Y 0760-5125 4.5 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5126 4.5 m Noise Barrier System Including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0760-5130 5 m Noise Barrier System Normal m Y 0760-5131 5 m Noise Barrier System Including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0760-5132 5 m Noise Barrier System on Structures Normal m Y 0760-5165 Noise Barrier Access Normal each Y 0771-0010 Highway Fence Normal m Y 0771-0020 Brace Panels Normal each Y 0771-0030 Gates Normal each Y 0772-0011 Chain-Link Fence Variation m Y 0772-0013 Gates Normal each Y 0791-0010 Expanded Metal Antiglare Screen Normal m Y 0799-0010 Bollards Variation each Y 0799-0050 Intermediate Signs, Ground Mounted, New Normal each Y 0799-0052 Intermediate Signs, Relocation Normal each Y 0799-0054 Intermediate Signs, Removal Normal each Y 0799-5503 Temporary Transition Rail Normal each Y 0799-5504 Permanent REACT 350 Variation each Y 0799-6015 Ramp Closure Gates Normal each Y 0799-6016 Concrete In Ramp Closure Gate Support Footings Normal each Y 0799-7010 Adjust Water Valve Boxes Normal each N 0799-7020 Supply & Place Watermains and Accessories Normal lump sum N 0799-7040 Water Valve Chamber Normal each Y 0799-8010 High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail - Shoulder Installation Normal m Y 0799-8015 High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail - Slope Installation Normal m Y 0799-8020 High Tension Cable Guide Rail Terminal System Normal each Y

August 2017 Page 17 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 106: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0799-8030 Steel Beam Terminal System Normal each Y 0801-0010 Barrier for Tree Protection Normal m Y 0802-0011 Preparation for Topsoil Normal lump sum N 0802-0020 Topsoil from Stockpiles Normal m3 N 0802-0030 Topsoil, Imported Normal m3 N 0803-0006 Sod Variation m2 Y 0804-0050 Seed Variation m2 Y 0804-0051 Seed and Mulch Variation m2 Y 0804-0052 Seed and Erosion Control Blanket Variation m2 Y 0804-0053 Seed and Matrix Variation m2 Y 0805-0010 Light-Duty Sediment Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0020 Light-Duty Straw Bale Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0030 Light-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0035 Light-Duty Fibre Roll Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0040 Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0060 Heavy-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0065 Heavy-Duty Wire-Backed Silt Fence Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0070 Berm Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0080 Sandbag Barriers Normal m Y 0805-0085 Fibre Roll Grade Breaks Normal m Y 0805-0090 Flow Check Dams Normal each Y 0805-0100 Straw Bale Flow Check Dams Normal each Y 0805-0105 Fibre Roll Flow Check Dams Normal each Y 0805-0115 Sandbag Flow Check Dams Normal each Y 0805-0120 Rock Flow Check Dams Normal each Y 0805-0130 Sediment Traps Normal each Y 0805-0135 Slope Drains Normal each Y 0805-0145 Diversion Ditches Normal each Y 0805-0155 Sediment Traps for Dewatering Normal each Y 0805-0160 Filter Bags Normal each Y 0805-0161 Turbidity Curtains Normal m Y 0805-0170 Cofferdams Normal each Y 0810-0010 Rootwad Structure Normal each Y 0811-0010 Large Woody Debris Normal m N 0812-0010 Wood LUNKERS Normal m N 0812-0020 Stone LUNKERS Normal m N 0820-0010 Riffles Normal m2 Y 0821-0010 Pools Normal m2 Y 0822-0010 Rocky Ramps Normal m2 Y 0823-0010 Low Flow Channel Normal m Y 0823-0020 Low Flow Channel Normal t N 0824-0010 Baffles in a Culvert Normal each Y 0899-0010 Management and Disposal of Materials Containing Asbestos Normal lump sum N 0899-5360 Sedimentation Basin Normal each N 0899-5390 Aquatic Vegetation Variation each Y 0899-5395 Bulb Normal each Y 0899-5400 Shrub Root Mass Normal each Y 0899-5402 Shrub, 600 mm Height Variation each Y

August 2017 Page 18 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 107: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0899-5403 Shrub, 1.0 m Height Variation each Y 0899-5404 Coniferous Tree, 500 mm Height Variation each Y 0899-5406 Coniferous Tree, 1.0 m Height Variation each Y 0899-5408 Coniferous Tree, 1.5 m Height Variation each Y 0899-5409 Coniferous Tree, 2.0 m Height Variation each Y 0899-5411 Deciduous Tree, 2.0 m Height Variation each Y 0899-5414 Deciduous Tree, 45 mm Caliper Variation each Y 0899-5415 Deciduous Tree, 50 mm Caliper Variation each Y 0899-5416 Deciduous Tree, 60 mm Caliper Variation each Y 0899-5419 Deciduous Tree, Whip Variation each Y 0899-5420 Perennial, 10 cm Pot Normal each Y 0899-5425 Perennial, 1 Gal. Pot Normal each Y 0902-0010 Earth Excavation for Structure Normal m3 Y 0902-0020 Rock Excavation for Structure Normal m3 Y 0902-0030 Dewatering Structure Excavations Normal lump sum N 0902-0040 Clay Seal Normal lump sum N 0903-0010 Supply Equipment for Driving Piles Normal LS/M N 0903-0012 Supply Equipment for Installing Caisson Piles Normal lump sum N 0903-0014 Supply Equipment for Installing Displacement Caisson Piles Normal lump sum N 0903-0020 Sheet Piles Normal m2 N 0903-0050 H-Piles - HP 310X79 Normal m N 0903-0052 H-Piles - HP 310X94 Normal m N 0903-0054 H-Piles - HP 310X110 Normal m N 0903-0060 Tube Piles Normal m N 0903-0070 Wood Piles Normal m N 0903-0080 Precast Concrete Piles Normal m N 0903-0090 Caisson Piles Normal m N 0903-0100 Displacement Caisson Piles Normal m N 0903-0120 Driving Shoes Normal each Y 0903-0130 Rock Points Normal each Y 0903-0150 Retapping Piles Normal lump sum N 0904-0015 Concrete in Culverts Normal m3 Y 0904-0035 Mass Concrete Normal m3 Y 0904-0045 Tremie Concrete Normal m3 Y 0904-0055 Concrete in Footings Normal m3 Y 0904-0065 Concrete in Barrier Wall Footings Normal m3 Y 0904-0075 Concrete in Structure Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0085 Concrete in Substructure Variation LS/M3 N 0904-0095 Concrete in Substructure and Retaining Walls Variation LS/M3 N 0904-0105 Concrete in Deck Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0110 Prestressed Concrete Bridge Deck Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0115 Concrete in Barrier Walls Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0125 Concrete in Parapet Walls Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0135 Concrete in Approach Slabs Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0145 Concrete in Slope Paving Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0150 Concrete in Toe Wall Normal lump sum N 0904-0185 High Performance Concrete in Substructure Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0190 High Performance Concrete in Structure Normal LS/M3 N

August 2017 Page 19 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 108: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0904-0195 High Performance Concrete in Approach Slab Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0200 High Performance Concrete in Deck Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0205 High Performance Concrete in Barrier Walls Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0210 High Performance Concrete in Parapet Walls Normal LS/M3 N 0904-0215 High Performance Concrete in Substructure and Retaining Walls Normal LS/M3 N 0905-0010 Reinforcing Steel Bar Normal LS/T N 0905-0025 Stainless Steel Reinforcing Bar Normal LS/T N 0905-0030 Mechanical Connectors Normal each Y 0905-0045 Stainless Steel Mechanical Connectors Normal each Y 0906-0011 Fabrication of Structural Steel Normal LS/T N 0906-0020 Delivery of Structural Steel Normal LS/T N 0906-0030 Erection of Structural Steel Normal LS/T N 0907-0010 Wood in Structure Normal LS/M3 N 0907-0020 Wood in Cribs Normal m3 Y 0908-0010 Pedestrian Railing Normal m Y 0908-0020 Barrier Wall Railing Normal m Y 0908-0030 Parapet Wall Railing Normal m Y 0908-0040 Bicycle Railing Normal m Y 0908-0050 Metal Traffic Barrier Normal m Y 0909-0030 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 900 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0031 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1200 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0032 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1400 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0033 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1600 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0034 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1900 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0035 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 2300 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0036 Prestressed Concrete Girders Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0040 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 900 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0041 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1200 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0042 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1400 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0043 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1600 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0044 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1900 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0045 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 2300 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0046 Prestressed Concrete Girders Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0050 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 900 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0051 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1200 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0052 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1400 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0053 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1600 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0054 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 1900 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0055 Prestressed Concrete Girders CPCI 2300 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0056 Prestressed Concrete Girders Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0130 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 900 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0131 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1200 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0132 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1400 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0133 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1600 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0134 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1900 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0135 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 2300 Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0136 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume Fabrication Normal LS/M N 0909-0140 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 900 Delivery Normal LS/M N

August 2017 Page 20 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 109: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0909-0141 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1200 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0142 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1400 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0143 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1600 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0144 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1900 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0145 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 2300 Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0146 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume Delivery Normal LS/M N 0909-0150 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 900 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0151 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1200 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0152 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1400 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0153 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1600 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0154 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 1900 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0155 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume CPCI 2300 Installation Normal LS/M N 0909-0156 Prestressed Concrete Girders Containing Silica Fume Installation Normal LS/M N 0910-0020 Longitudinal Stressing System Normal LS/T N 0910-0030 Transverse Stressing System Normal LS/T N 0910-0040 Vertical Stressing System Normal LS/T N 0911-0010 Coating Existing Structural Steel Normal LS/M2 N 0911-0012 Coating New Structural Steel Normal LS/M2 N 0911-0015 Coating Steel Railing System(s) Normal LS/M2 N 0911-0016 Coating New Structural Steel Sign Support Structures Normal lump sum N 0911-0020 Environmental Protection During Coating of Structural Steel and Railing System(s) Normal LS/M2 N 0913-0010 Embedded Work in Structure (Ministry) Normal LS/M N 0913-0020 Embedded Work in Structure (Bell Canada) Normal LS/M N 0913-0040 Embedded Work in Structure (Utility) Normal LS/M N 0913-0050 Embedded Work in Structure (Utility - 2) Normal LS/M N 0914-0011 Bridge Deck Waterproofing Normal LS/M2 N 0914-0021 Modification of Deck Drains Normal each Y 0914-0031 Form and Fill Grooves Normal m Y 0914-0040 Membrane Reinforcement Normal m Y 0914-0050 Deck Surface Preparation Normal m2 Y 0915-0012 Concrete in Ground Mounted Static Sign Support Footings, Tri-chord and Cantilever Normal each Y 0915-0013 Concrete in Median Mounted Static Sign Support Footings, Tri-chord and Cantilever Normal each Y 0915-0014 Concrete in Steel Monotube Overhead Sign Support Footings Normal each Y 0915-0015 Concrete in Steel Column Breakaway Sign Support Footings Normal each Y 0915-0016 Concrete in Steel Column Non-Breakaway Sign Support Footings Normal each Y 0915-0017 Concrete in Ground Mounted Variable Message Sign Support Footings Normal each Y 0915-0018 Concrete in Median Mounted Variable Message Sign Support Footings Normal each Y 0915-0032 Steel Monotube Overhead Sign Support Structures, Span 0 - 18.0 m Normal each Y 0915-0033 Steel Monotube Overhead Sign Support Structures, Span Greater Than 18.0 m Normal each Y 0915-0040 Steel Column Breakaway Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0041 Steel Column Non-Breakaway Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0050 Wood Column Breakaway Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0051 Wood Column Non-Breakaway Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0060 Cantilever Static Sign Support Structures, Class .... Variation each Y 0915-0065 Cantilever Tri-Chord Static Sign Support Structures, Class ... Variation each Y 0915-0070 Aluminum Bridge Mounted Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0075 Tri-Chord Static Sign Support Structures, Span 0 - 18.50 m Normal each Y 0915-0076 Tri-Chord Static Sign Support Structures, Span 18.51 - 27.50 m Normal each Y

August 2017 Page 21 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 110: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0915-0077 Tri-Chord Static Sign Support Structures, Span Greater Than 27.50 m Normal each Y 0915-0097 Variable Message Sign Support Structures, Span 0 - 22.00 m Normal each Y 0915-0098 Variable Message Sign Support Structures, Span 22.01 - 28.00 m Normal each Y 0915-0099 Variable Message Sign Support Structures, Span Greater Than 28.00 m Normal each Y 0915-0100 Pole Mounted Variable Message Sign Support Structures Normal each Y 0915-0105 Repair of Existing Structure Normal lump sum N 0915-0110 Attachment of Signboards Normal each Y 0918-0015 Temporary Modular Bridge Normal LS/T N 0919-0010 Temporary Support Normal lump sum N 0920-0010 Deck Joint Assemblies, Installation Normal LS/M N 0920-0020 Deck Joint Assemblies, Modification Normal LS/M N 0920-0030 Repair of Existing Deck Joints Normal lump sum N 0922-0010 Bearings Normal lump sum N 0928-0050 Scarifying Normal m2 N 0928-0055 Access to Work Area, Work Platform and Scaffolding Normal lump sum N 0928-0060 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type A Normal m3 N 0928-0061 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type A Normal m2 N 0928-0065 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type B Normal m3 N 0928-0066 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type B Normal m2 N 0928-0070 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type C Normal m3 N 0928-0071 Concrete Removal - Partial Depth - Type C Normal m2 N 0928-0075 Concrete Removal - Full Depth Normal m3 N 0928-0078 Concrete Removal - Full Depth Normal lump sum N 0928-0080 Concrete Removal - Complete Deck Normal lump sum N 0928-0085 Concrete Removal - Deck Joint Assemblies Normal LS/M3 N 0928-0090 Concrete Removal - Structural Component Normal lump sum N 0929-0030 Abrasive Blast Cleaning of Reinforcing Steel Normal m2 N 0929-0040 Abrasive Blast Cleaning for Overlays Normal LS/M2 N 0929-0051 Abrasive Blast Cleaning of Structural Steel in Contact with Concrete Normal LS/M2 N 0930-0065 Place Concrete Overlay Normal m3 N 0930-0070 Place Silica Fume Concrete Overlay Normal m3 N 0930-0095 Finish and Cure Concrete Overlay Normal LS/M2 N 0930-0100 Finish and Cure Silica Fume Concrete Overlay Normal lump sum N 0930-0125 Concrete Refacing Normal m3 N 0930-0130 Concrete Refacing, Form and Pump Normal m3 N 0930-0135 Concrete Patches, Unformed Surface Normal m3 N 0930-0145 Concrete Patches, Formed Surface Normal m3 N 0930-0150 Concrete Patches, Form and Pump Normal m3 N 0930-0165 Modification of Deck Drains Normal each Y 0930-0175 Drainage Tubes in Deck Normal each Y 0931-0015 Normal Shotcrete Normal m3 N 0931-0030 Silica Fume Shotcrete Normal m3 N 0932-0010 Crack Injection Normal m N 0932-0020 Routing and Sealing - Hot-Poured Rubberized Joint Sealing Compound Normal m N 0932-0030 Routing and Sealing - Cold Applied Joint Sealing Compound Normal m N 0935-0100 Acceptance Testing for Cathodic Protection Normal lump sum N 0935-0110 Anode Mesh Normal m2 N 0935-0120 Cathode Connections Normal each Y

August 2017 Page 22 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 111: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER B List of Active Standard Tender Items

Item Code Title Col Type U.O.M. PQP 0935-0130 Cathodic Protection Cabinets Normal each Y 0935-0140 Cathodic Protection Rectifiers Normal lump sum N 0935-0150 Cathodic Protection Remote Monitoring and Control Units Normal lump sum N 0935-0160 Concrete Pads for Cathodic Protection Normal each Y 0935-0170 Extra Low Voltage Cables for Cathodic Protection Normal LS/M N 0935-0180 Reference Cells Normal each Y 0935-0190 Rigid Ducts and Junction Boxes for Cathodic Protection Normal lump sum N 0942-0010 Pre-Production Test Anchors Normal m N 0942-0012 Production Anchor Normal m N 0942-0014 Post-Grouting of Bond Length Normal kg N 0999-0165 Dowels Into Concrete Normal each Y 0999-0310 Precast Concrete Bridge Elements, Fabrication Normal lump sum N 0999-0311 Precast Concrete Bridge Elements, Delivery Normal lump sum N 0999-0312 Precast Concrete Bridge Elements, Installation Normal lump sum N 0999-9020 Dry Stone Retaining Wall Not Exceeding 2m Height Normal m3 N 0999-9081 Handrail Repairs Normal lump sum N 0999-9100 Concrete Sealer Normal m2 N 0999-9150 Glass Fibre Reinforced Polymer Reinforcing Bar Normal LS/M3 N 0999-9170 Rock Anchors Normal each N 0999-9180 Socketing Piles into Rock Normal each N 0999-9182 Augering Piles Normal m N 0999-9190 Dead Men and Tie Rods Normal lump sum N 0999-9191 Dywidag Bars Normal each Y 0999-9192 Shear Connectors Normal each Y 0999-9210 Joint Seal Normal m N 0999-9220 Jacking of Superstructure Normal lump sum N 0999-9310 Deck Drains Normal each Y 0999-9311 Deck Drain Extension Normal lump sum N 0999-9312 Void Drains Normal each N 0999-9321 Drain Tube Extension Normal lump sum N 0999-9330 Deck Anchorage Normal lump sum N 0999-9340 Stressing System Normal lump sum N 0999-9350 Temporary Decking Normal lump sum N

August 2017 Page 23 of 23 CDED B-150

Page 112: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 113: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

WRITER’S GUIDE FOR CHAPTER B DETAIL ESTIMATING SECTIONS 1.0 Introduction

The purpose of this document is to provide insight and guidance to persons involved in writing Contract Design Estimation and Documentation (CDED) Chapter B Detail Estimating sections. Detail Estimating sections provide designer guidance on how to design, estimate quantities and document tender items related to each applicable Ontario Provincial Standard (OPS) construction specification. The CDED Manual, Chapter B typically forms part of the terms-of-reference for detailed design projects. Design project managers and the project team shall follow the guidance given unless reasons exist to do things in different ways. Designers shall be prepared to explain and justify departures from the guidance provided. The end-product includes a biddable tender package and a constructible design package that is suitable for administration of capital construction projects on the Ministry’s Provincial highway network. The CDED Manual is the guide for designers to complete detailed design for highways. Some Structural and all Electrical engineering functions are not covered by the CDED Manual, Chapter B. Guidance in detailed design for those engineering functions may be obtained in the Structural Manual, CDED Volume 3 Electrical, and CDED Volume 4 Advanced Traffic Management Systems (ATMS).

1.1 Contract Documentation The core of tender packages consists of the Tender. The Tender is supported by engineering standards, including: • Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs), • Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs) and Ministry of Transportation

Ontario Drawings (MTODs). • Standard Special Provisions (SSPs) are used to modify OPSSs, as warranted.

The Contract Package includes: • Contract Drawings are drawings or plans provided by the owner for the work,

as defined in the MTO General Conditions of Contract (OPSS.PROV 100), GC 1.07.

• Non-standard special provisions (NSSPs) which supplement and modify the standards to provide specific information on the Construction Project.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 114: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

The MTO General Conditions of Contract (OPSS.PROV 100), GC 2.02, Order of Precedence, provides guidance on the relationship between the different types of documents. The tender package contains adequate information to estimate the cost of the work for tendering purposes. Supporting information in the design package provides all the details required to construct the work. This includes all dimensioned data, such as detailed cross-sections for example. When changes are made to engineering standards, the corresponding sections of the CDED Manual, Chapter B and the CA&IT Manual should be updated. Having these documents compatible with one-another will help to ensure that tender packages are properly assembled and construction contracts are properly administered. Relationship to Other Documents:

Document Custodial Office Primary Reader Task Performed by Primary Reader

CDED Manual, Chapter B *

Design and Contract Standards Office (DCSO)

Design Project Manager and Project Team

Detailed Design

Engineering Standards (OPSS, OPSD, SSP)

Applicable Provincial Functional Office (PFO)

Contractor Construction

Construction Administration and Inspection Task (CAIT) Manual

Contract Management Office (CMO)

Contract Administrator (CA)

Construction Administration

* The Electrical and ATMS CDED chapters and the Structural Manual cover their respective functions.

1.2 Authors and Readers of CDED Chapter B Sections Authors of CDED Chapter B sections:

• are typically representatives from engineering functional offices within the Ministry that are similarly involved with writing and updating design policies and contract documentation, including OPS Specifications.

• are assumed to have a good understanding of the technical subject (engineering discipline) that is relevant to the Chapter B section. For multi-disciplinary Chapter B sections, consultation with other functional offices may be necessary. The author and their office colleagues are assumed to have a good understanding of ministry construction practice with respect to the particular subject. Liaison with CMO may be necessary to confirm ministry practice regarding construction administration. Liaison with regional staff and the appropriate functional committee(s) may be necessary to obtain an adequate understanding of the current practices in all of the ministry’s regions.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 115: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

• may not have direct experience in creating contract documents or administering construction contracts and may need some assistance with the documentation functions. Staff of the Engineering and Specifications Management Section (ESSMS), DCSO are able to assist with this.

Readers of Chapter B sections:

• are typically project managers and their project team for a detailed design project. These persons could be ministry staff or employees of an engineering consulting firm.

• will often be relying on the technical content of design reports and will not be in a position to technically review them or accept responsibility for their content.

• will often be responsible to assemble a contract package as a deliverable. Such a person may have a reasonable understanding of ministry construction practice and the components of a tender package and a design package.

1.3 Writing Chapter B Sections Write the CDED section as if you are directly telling the reader how to design, estimate and document the design project to create a tender package. Use standard English with good grammar and complete sentences. Where appropriate, diagrams, figures, tables, numbered lists or bulleted lists may be used. Large tables or figures should be included in an appendix to the Chapter B section. Expand all acronyms at first usage within the section. Under sub-section 1: GENERAL, provide a general description of the subject being covered. Discuss major principles, constraints or limitations. Describe how other tender item quantities may be influenced by installations under these tender items, as applicable. For these cases provide reference to the appropriate CDED Chapter B sections. For example, many tender items cover installation of appurtenances (i.e. safety hardware, drainage features, illumination, etc.) that will influence grading requirements. Details on the contents of sub-sections 2 through 8 are given below in the corresponding sub-section.

1.4 Section, Sub-section Numbering and Headings The CDED B-section title should match the title of the corresponding OPS construction specification, where practical. The Chapter B section number corresponds to the three-digit OPS construction specification number and the first four digits of the tender item code (first digit is “zero”) for related tender items. Where multiple CDED Chapter B sections are applicable to one OPSS, they are further identified as -1, -2, etc. There are nine mandatory standardized first-level sub-section headings in each Chapter B section. Second-level headings may be used at the author’s discretion.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 116: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

Some possible second level headings are provided, but their applicability depends on the subject being covered. Second-level headings are appropriate to subdivide a lengthy sub-section. Mandatory first-level sub-section headings

Examples of second-level sub-section headings. These may be determined at the author’s discretion

NNN.1: GENERAL NNN.1.1: Introduction NNN.1.2: Definitions

NNN.2: REFERENCES

NNN.3: TENDER ITEMS

NNN.4: SPECIFICATIONS

NNN.5: SPECIAL PROVISIONS

NNN.5.1: Fill-in Special Provisions NNN.5.2: Non-Standard Special Provisions

NNN.6: STANDARD DRAWINGS NNN.6.1: Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs) NNN.6.2: MTO Drawings (MTODs) NNN.6.3: Contract Drawings

NNN.7: DESIGN NNN.7.1: Information to be Provided to Bidders

NNN.8: COMPUTATION

NNN.9: DOCUMENTATION

NNN.9.1: Contract Drawings NNN.9.2: Quantity Sheets NNN.9.3: Documentation Accuracy NNN.9.4: Non-Standard Special Provisions

For cases when a sub-section is not used, its title shall be included with the words “- not applicable” added for sub-sections 1, 7, 8 & 9. For all other sub-sections, 2 through 6, the word “- none” shall be included with the title, when that sub-section is not used.

2.0 Step Process to Write a Draft CDED Chapter B section A CDED Chapter B Section shall be revised to be compatible with any changes are made to the corresponding OPSS, or SSPs. This process should be initiated when an OPSS and related documents are being developed by the ministry or by an OPS Specialty Committee. This will allow the CDED Chapter B section to be nearly complete by the time that the OPSS is published. Final edits may be done, based on the published OPSS, when it becomes available. This will help to ensure that OPSS and all related documents may be implemented in CPS per the scheduling requirements set out in the Memorandum ‘Implementation of OPS Specifications in Construction Contracts’ (dated: August 27, 2007 and signed by G. Todd).

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 117: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

Step 1 - Assemble and Review all Relevant Contract Documentation • Obtain the existing CDED Chapter B section, as applicable • Obtain the applicable published OPS specification (or OPSS under development, as applicable)

and standard drawings. • Obtain existing applicable standard special provisions (SSPs). Additional information may be

found in ‘Regional’ non-standard special provisions (Regional NSSPs). • Confirm whether the published specification is compatible with current ministry practices and

policies. • Follow the requirements of the document: ‘Scheduling and Tracking Updates of Standard

Specifications and the CDED Manual’ (dated November 30, 2007) See Appendix A. • Establish whether the existing and/or proposed standard tender items are appropriate. • SSP(s) may be required to modify the published OPSS.

Step 2 Gather all Pertinent Design-Related Information • Obtain and review the content of any design documents that may be a reference document (i.e.

manuals, design memoranda, design bulletins). • ESSMS can provide a list of OPSSs and SSPs that have a reference to the subject OPSS.

Step 3 Produce First Draft of CDED Chapter B Section • Refer to this document and existing, recently published CDED Chapter B sections for guidance

and examples.

Step 4 Review Content with Appropriate Functional Committee(S) and/or Regional Staff • Review the contract documentation and draft CDED section to ensure that it is compatible with

current practice. • Make revisions based on feedback from functional committees or regional staff. • Construction administration issues should be reviewed with CMO.

Step 5 Review Content with ESSMS • Via E-mail, send electronic copies of the draft CDED Chapter B section, along with the

applicable OPS specification, any draft SSP(s) and applicable standard drawings. • In the covering E-mail, describe all the documentation for implementation, along with any

proposed tender item revisions. Also note any corresponding documentation that is currently active in CPS which will be superseded.

• Address comments received back from ESSMS.

Step 6 Review with Contract Documentation Committee (CDC) • CDC meeting agendas and schedules are arranged through ESSMS. • The draft CDED Chapter B section, and all related documents (OPSS, OPSDs, SSPs, as

applicable) shall be distributed to CDC a minimum of two weeks in advance of the next scheduled meeting.

• Functional office representation at the CDC meeting is essential. • Address CDC comments and finalize Chapter B section.

Step 7 Implement the CDED Section and Associated Documentation in CPS • Submit final documentation to ESSMS with a covering E-mail as per Step 5, above. • As applicable, co-ordinate this activity with an update to the Construction Administration and

Inspection Task (CAIT) Manual that is administered by CMO.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 118: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

2.1 Use of Words ‘shall’: indicates a mandatory obligation and is widely used in standard specifications and similarly used in CDED Chapter B Sections. ‘should’: is used to describe use of a recommended practice. ‘may’: indicates that there is a choice. ‘May’ is typically to allow an exception to a rule, provided that certain circumstances apply

3.0 References List all applicable Ministry design manuals, directives, memoranda or bulletins in this section. Construction standards documentation is listed under appropriate headings below. Do not repeat references of documentation that are provided in the referenced OPSS. Referenced documents should be discussed within the body of the CDED Chapter B section so that designers are directed appropriately to these specific documents. All referenced documents should be readily available to the designer. Include the source of the document, as applicable. The source could be a library, publisher or web-site. Such reference documents would typically be listed in the terms-of-reference for a consultant assignment of a detailed design project. List proprietary documentation, such as design guides or installation guides, if applicable. A brief description of the type of information to be obtained from reference documents may be provided, as it pertains to the applicable tender item(s). Any design document referred to within the Chapter B section should be listed in the REFERENCES sub-section. List project-specific design reports that are typically provided for the applicable engineering function. As a CDED Chapter B section is typically used by project Managers and the project team, it is not necessary to include reference documents of a highly technical nature that would be used only by practitioners of specific engineering functions. Designers would typically rely upon and follow the recommendations within a design report from such practitioners and would not need to address or verify the details provided by those functions.

3.1 Reference Documents (as applicable to this guide) • OPSS.PROV 100; MTO General Conditions of Contract • Recently implemented CDED Chapter B Sections

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 6 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 119: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

• Highway Design Bulletin 2008-003; Management of New: NSTs, NSSPs and Modified SSPs

• Structural Manual • Electrical Engineering Manual • Construction Administration and Inspection Task Manual

4.0 Tender Items List tender item names. These should exactly match the tender item names given in the OPS specification or SSPs (if applicable) and in CPS. Applicable tender items are identified in CPS by the 2nd, 3rd and 4th digits of the tender item code which correspond to the three-digit OPSS construction specification number and the three-digit number for the CDED Chapter B Section. Codes are not required to be included.

5.0 Specifications Provide a general reference about where applicable Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSS) are located. The subject OPSS is identified, as applicable. The OPSS number may represent either an OPSS.common or OPSS.PROV (Provincial) Specification, as applicable. However, if an OPSS.MUNI (Municipal) is required, it must be specifically identified.

6.0 Special Provisions Provide a general reference about where applicable standard special provisions (SSPs) are located. Specific references to SSPs should not be given. Designers will rely on SSP warrants to ensure that appropriate SSPs are included in the contract documents. Use of fill-in SSPs may be appropriate for cases where similar project-specific details must be included repetitively in many contracts. The ‘Notes to Designer’ appendix to an SSP should only be used to include information to assist the designer to complete fill-in SSPs. All other SSP-related information should be contained in the corresponding CDED Chapter B section. The warrant for use of each SSP is provided at the end of the SSP.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 7 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 120: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

7.0 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Discuss possible needs for NSSPs, if applicable, under Section 9: DOCUMENTATION, below. Regional Offices have ‘Regional’ NSSPs that they typically use to apply specific requirements to particular situations. Regional NSSPs may be downloaded from CPS.

8.0 Standard Drawings Provide a general reference about where applicable standard drawings are located. Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs), MTO Drawings (MTODs) and Structural Standard Drawings (SSDs) may be applicable. Reference would typically be made to a division or ‘hundred’ series of drawings, not the individual drawing numbers. For example: 200 Series drawings are for General Grading features. The individual OPSDs or MTODs may change on a frequent basis which, if included, would require updating of the corresponding CDED Chapter B section each time such a change was made.

9.0 Design Discuss circumstances where use of specific tender items is recommended. Information may be provided on the relationship and applicability of the various design manuals to the particular tender items. Any design manuals shall be listed in sub-section 2: REFERENCES, above. For cases where design manuals do not exist, a complete discussion of design requirements is appropriate in this sub-section. Providing a brief summary of design requirements is not recommended because it may be problematic, as readers may be led to believe that all design requirement details have been met. a) Information to be Provided to Bidders

Bidders will need specific information in order to bid on the tendered work. Providing such detailed information will allow bidders to provide a well-informed and competitive bid. This will help to reduce risks and extra costs associated with uncertainty. Such information could include but is not limited to: • Geotechnical borehole data • Survey data • Existing condition data

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 8 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 121: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

10.0 Computation Discuss each tender item or group of similar tender items in a separate paragraph. Indicate whether each tender item is Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) item. This information is available in CPS for existing tender items but will need to be determined for all new tender items. The level of checking or verification should be provided for PQP tender items. There is a unique unit-of-measure (UOM) to express the quantity for each tender item, as provided in CPS. Discuss the UOM for each tender item and specifically how the quantity is measured. For example, linear measure in metres, m, could be either horizontal or following a slope. Describe from where the quantity measurement may be obtained. For example: quantities may be measured from field measurement, design cross-sections or contract drawings, etc. Detailed discussion may be provided on how to measure tender quantities in difficult or unusual project-specific situations, where appropriate. The ‘complimentary summary sheet’ form (PH-CC-44) should be identified for use for computation of applicable tender item quantities. Some tender items have UOMs of LS/M, LS/M2, LS/M3 and LS/T. These are not PQP items and are mostly structural oriented. Quantities are provided for estimating purposes only. They are similar to lump-sum tender items but allow for tracking of unit prices on a length, area, volume or weight basis. In the tender document, the quantities for these items appear as 100% and the measured quantities do not appear. Discuss how work done under these tender items may influence requirements for other tender items or their quantities. It may be necessary to discuss how to avoid double payment of the same feature over multiple tender items, where applicable. An example of where double payment could occur would be where the neat lines of different excavations overlap, causing double payment for this excavation.

11.0 Documentation This sub-section provides guidance on how to document tender item(s) with respect to contract drawings, quantity sheets and NSSPs. Project-specific details are provided in these documents. Improving consistency in documentation across the province will improve quality and efficiency. OPSSs often contain wording, such as: “…., as specified in the Contract Documents”. This guides readers to seek out more project-specific information elsewhere in the contract. Such information may reside in other specifications, SSPs, quantity sheets or drawings (OPSDs or MTODs). However, for some cases,

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 9 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 122: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

such information may be required within the non-standard documentation to address project-specific circumstances. For each such notation in the OPSS, the writer of the CDED Chapter B section should verify that the required information is either contained in the accompanying standard documents or will be accounted for in the project-specific non-standard documentation. Where non-standard documentation is needed, the CDED Chapter B section must provide guidance to the designer as to how and where in the tender package the details are to be provided. This type of information is often detailed in Appendix A of OPSS’s. Appendix A is not used by the Ministry, but it provides useful information that is typically provided in the CDED Chapter B section. Information contained in standard specifications or other contract documentation should not be repeated. a) Contract Drawings

Contract drawings include drawings or plans, profiles, typical cross-sections and non-standard details and may include other reports, lists or schedules. These may include standard or modified OPSDs or MTODs. Explain how to show the information on these drawings, as applicable. Standard symbology is provided in the 100 series of both OPSDs and MTODs. Provide descriptions of any other information that shall be provided on the contract drawings to support these tender items. For example: geotechnical borehole data. Quantity sheets are considered to be contract drawings. Sample quantity sheets may be obtained from Chapter F. Instructions on which quantity sheet format to use and how to complete filling it out, for each applicable tender item, is covered in sub-section 9: DOCUMENTATION.

b) Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets) Q-sheets are usually provided in 11X17 format. Information on Q-sheets is contained in CDED Chapter F. As applicable to the tender item, provide a line entry in the Q-sheet for each installation or segment of product to be supplied, installed or constructed. As applicable, locate the installation by including start and end locations (chainages) of each installation and indicate left or right of centreline. Separate tender items should not be combined on one line of the Q-sheet. Indicate whether additional information in addition to chainage is required, for example: offset, left or right. In complex projects, staging considerations should be accounted for such that quantities applicable to each stage are provided. The required accuracy of such dimensions should be included in the CDED Chapter B section, where appropriate.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 10 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 123: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B Writer’s Guide for Chapter B Detail Estimating Sections

For variation tender items, list each possible variation with a brief explanation of its application. Each variation of the tender item shall be entered in a separate column heading in the Q-sheet. The space available for headings is 92 characters (4 lines of up to 23 characters each). Quantities for each installation shall be entered in the Q-sheet in the appropriate box where the line for that installation meets the column applicable to the tender item variation. An appropriate title shall be provided for each column in the quantity sheet. Tender item “column types” : Normal, Variation, Special, and Breakdown. “Column types” of tender items are documented in Contract Preparation System (CPS), under CPS Help. This type influences how these items are documented in quantity sheets (Q-sheets). The type of each tender item listed in CPS is listed under “Items Master”.

c) Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Discuss how project-specific information is documented in NSSPs, modified SSPs and fill-in SSPs. Improperly drafted NSSPs are a major source of contractual problems that lead to engineering claims. Use of NSSPs should be minimized, where possible. The use of existing contract documentation, including NSSPs that have been successfully used before, is usually preferable to drafting new NSSPs. References on how to write NSSPs are included in the SP writer’s guide. See CDED Chapter E for detailed information on how to write SSPs and NSSPs. The requirements of Highway Design Bulletin 2008-003, Management of New: Non-Standard Tender Items, Non-Standard Special Provisions and Modified Standard Special Provisions, shall be complied with for the NSSP and non-standard tender item review process.

d) Documentation Accuracy Indicate the accuracy (rounding) for the UOM of the tender quantity.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 11 of 11 CDED B-180

Page 124: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 125: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B List of Active Detail Estimating Sections

LIST OF ACTIVE DETAIL ESTIMATING SECTIONS CDED Title Issue Date B201-1 Clearing May 2013 B201-3 Grubbing May 2013 B201-4 Removal of Boulders May 2013 B201-6 Mechanical Stump Cutting May 2013 B202 Rock Removal by Manual Scaling, Machine Scaling, Trim Blasting, or Controlled

Blasting Feb 2014

B203 Rock Stabilization Aug 2015 B206-1 Earth Grading Apr 2014 B206-2 Rock Grading Jan 2014 B206-3 Excavation for Pavement Widening Jan 2014 B209 Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils Mar 2012 B212 Earth Borrow Jan 2014 B299-1 Rental of Equipment May 1994 B299-2 Ditch Cleanout Apr 2014 B301 Restoring Unpaved Roadway Surfaces May 1996 B304 Surface Treatments Feb 2005 B305 Granular Sealing Dec 2016 B307 Stockpiling of Patching Materials and Patching of Asphalt Pavement Jun 2012 B308 Tack Coat Feb 2017 B311 Asphalt Sidewalk Jan 1996 B312-1 Asphalt Curb and Gutter Systems Oct 1991 B312-2 Asphalt Surfacing of Gutter Nov 1992 B313-1 Hot Mix Asphalt Apr 2016 B313-10 Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous Dec 2014 B314 Untreated Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, Selected Subgrade, and Stockpiling Jun 2016 B316 Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment May 2008 B320 Open Graded Drainage Layer Apr 2016 B330 In-Place Full Depth Reclamation of Bituminous Pavement and Underlying Granular Feb 2012 B331 Full-Depth Reclamation With Expanded Asphalt Stabilization Nov 2015 B332 Hot In-Place Recycling Nov 2016 B333 Cold In-Place Recycling Nov 2015 B335 Cold In-Place Recycling With Expanded Asphalt Nov 2015 B336 Micro-Surfacing Jan 2009 B337 Slurry Seal Nov 2013 B341 Routing and Sealing and/or Sealing Cracks in Asphalt Pavement Feb 2008 B342 Centreline and Shoulder Rumble Strips In Asphalt Feb 2016

August 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B-190

Page 126: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B List of Active Detail Estimating Sections

B350 Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement Apr 1999 B351 Concrete Sidewalk Jan 2016 B353 Concrete Curb and Gutter Systems Mar 2016 B355 Interlocking Concrete Pavers Nov 2011 B360 Full Depth Repair of Concrete Pavement or Concrete Base Jan 1999 B362 Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement Jan 1999 B363 Repairing Rigid Pavement With Precast Concrete Slabs Aug 2016 B364 Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement Jan 1999 B365 Cross-Stitching Longitudinal Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base Aug 2016 B369 Sealing or Resealing of Joints and Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base Jan 2009 B399-2 Reclaim Asphalt Pavement May 2001 B405 Pipe Subdrains Jun 2009 B407-1 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Sep 1999 B407-2 Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets Sep 1999 B410 Pipe Sewers Nov 2015 B415 Tunnelling Oct 1991 B416 Jacking and Boring Nov 1994 B421-2 Pipe Culverts Nov 2015 B422 Precast Reinforced Concrete Box Culverts and Box Sewers Apr 2016 B441 Watermains Nov 2016 B510-0 Removal Feb 2014 B510-1 Removal - Bridge Work Feb 2014 B510-2 Removal - Drainage Work Oct 2016 B510-3 Removal - Fence and Noise Barrier Work Feb 2014 B510-4 Removal - Delineators, Traffic Barriers and Energy Attenuator Work Nov 2014 B510-5 Removal - Pavement Work Apr 2014 B510-6 Removal - Concrete Work Oct 2016 B510-7 Removal - Right of Way Work Feb 2014 B510-8 Removal - Miscellaneous Work Feb 2014 B511 Rip-Rap, Rock Protection, and Granular Sheeting Apr 2017 B512 Gabions Jan 2014 B517 Dewatering May 2017 B703 Permanent Small Signs and Supports Nov 2014 B704 Post Mounted Delineators Nov 2014 B705 Flexible Delineator Posts Nov 2014 B706 Temporary Traffic Control Devices Feb 2017 B707 Modified Overhead Signboards Apr 2016 B708 Portable Temporary Traffic Signals (PTTS) Nov 2016 B710 Pavement Marking Sep 2011

August 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B-190

Page 127: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER B List of Active Detail Estimating Sections

B721-1 Adjust Cable Guide Rail and Cable Guide Rail Post Replacement May 2017 B721-2 Steel Beam Guide Rail Jul 2016 B723 Energy Attenuators Mar 2016 B732 Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal (SBEAT) SYSTEMS Dec 2016 B740 Concrete Barrier Feb 2014 B741 Temporary Concrete Barriers (TCB) Jul 2015 B741-2 Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier (MTCB) Aug 2016 B753 Connecticut Impact Attenuation System (CIAS) Feb 2014 B760 Noise Barrier Systems Jun 2015 B771 Standard Highway Fence Mar 2013 B772 Chain-Link Fence Mar 2013 B799-10 Permanent Intermediate Signs and Support Systems Feb 2017 B799-2 REACT 350 Sep 2011 B799-6 Ramp Closure Gates May 2013 B799-8 High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail and High Tension Cable Guide Rail Terminal

Systems Dec 2016

B799-9 Steel Beam Terminal (SBT) Dec 2016 B802 Topsoil Sep 2011 B803 Sodding Nov 2015 B804 Seed and Cover Apr 2014 B805 Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control Measures Jan 2016 B810 Rootwad Structures May 2017 B811 Large Woody Debris May 2017 B812 LUNKERS May 2017 B820 Riffles On Streambeds May 2017 B821 Pools In Streambeds May 2017 B822 Rocky Ramps On Streambeds May 2017 B823 Low Flow Channels May 2017 B824 Baffles In a Culvert May 2017 B902 Excavation and Backfill for Structures May 1996 B904 Concrete In Culverts Apr 1995 B905 Reinforcing Steel, Coated Reinforcing Steel May 1996 B907 Structural Wood Systems Jun 2013 B908 Metal Traffic Barriers and Metal Railings for Structures Nov 2014 B914 Waterproofing Bridge Deck Dec 2014 B932 Crack Repair - Concrete Feb 1999 B942 Prestressed Soil and Rock Anchors Nov 2013

August 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B-190

Page 128: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 129: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 1 of 11 B201-1

B201-1 - CLEARING - OPSS 201 201-1.1 GENERAL The removal of vegetation, usually, is the first operation performed in the

construction of a highway and comes in 2 forms; clearing and close cut clearing. Clearing consists of the cutting of trees, brush and undergrowth at or below one-half

metre (0.5 m) above the ground, and includes the removal and disposal of windfalls, felled timber, branches and other litter.

Close cut clearing is the cutting of trees at ground level (i.e. leaving no stump) and is

typically employed in areas where there will be no following grubbing operation. Where close cut clearing is substituted for clearing (as discussed in subsection B201-1.1.5) grubbing may be required as determined in CDED B201-3.

Additionally, close cut clearing may be followed by stump removal by mechanical

cutter as specified in CDED B 201-6. 201-1.2 REFERENCES CDED B201-3 - Grubbing CDED B201-6 - Mechanical Landscape Planning Report Roadside Safety Manual 201-1.3 TENDER ITEMS

Clearing Close Cut Clearing

201-1.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for clearing and close cut clearing are contained in OPSS 201. 201-1.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions.

Page 130: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 2 of 11 B201-1

Fill-in special provisions are to be included in the contract documents according to their warrants for the following:

i) Salvaging of trees for property sellers ii) Disposition of marketable timber from Crown Lands.

201-1.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None 201-1.7 DESIGN 201-1.7.1 Environmental Considerations

The value of vegetation is considered high enough to warrant saving the maximum number of trees possible, rather than follow the practice of completely removing all growth. In addition, other significant vegetative communities may be identified for protection. The Ministry would prefer to maintain a sizable specimen tree or established woodlot than replant with nursery stock. Also, vegetation retained on the right-of-way has value in minimizing construction impacts and in blending the reconstructed right-of-way with the adjacent landscape.

Wholesale clearing is to be discouraged, and every effort made to preserve as many trees as possible, taking into account the cost involved and providing that they do not constitute a safety hazard and that their condition warrants their retention.

A special effort should be made to save trees adjacent to private property, as they serve to screen the property from road traffic.

These environmental concerns should be discussed with the Ministry's Environmental Section.

201-1.7.2 Limits of Clearing

The limits of clearing are established on a project specific basis, with the aim of providing a roadside landscape which will allow an economical maintenance program. Clearing should be limited to those areas of actual roadway construction and where the retention of existing natural growth is deemed undesirable.

Removal of all growth to the right-of-way limits is required only where winter maintenance (snow storage) or the need for greater exposure to winter sunlight justify such extra width.

Page 131: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 3 of 11 B201-1

The designer should discuss the limits of clearing for each project with: i) Principle Landscape Architect, Design and Contract Standards Office ii) Regional Environmental Section iii) Regional Operations Office iv) Regional Geotechnical Office

201-1.7.3 Advance Clearing

Clearing may be scheduled ahead of the grading contract for the following reasons:

a) To facilitate utility relocation, where only a small portion of the overall clearing needs to be done to accommodate the work, with the remainder of the clearing left as part of the grading contract.

b) To provide winter work in areas of high unemployment. c) Where the area to be cleared is small. d) To avoid migratory bird nesting timing restrictions where trees need to be cleared

to accommodate the work before the end of the bird nesting timing window. Advance clearing may be carried out by: a) The contractor - as a separate contract by tender b) Operational Services - if available for such work c) A utility company - for a utility relocation

201-1.7.4 Clearing - Under Grading Contract

Where clearing is part of the main grading contract, and there is insufficient lead time to relocate utilities in advance of construction possibly affecting the contractor's schedule of operations, clearing should be done by the Contractor as one of his first operations and a non-standard special provision is to be included in the contract to advise the Contractor of the staging requirements. Clearing of a minor nature may be done by Operational Services (check with the Regional Head of Operational Services regarding manpower needs and availability) and the work paid for out of Services (Sundry) funds (see Chapter 'D').

201-1.7.5 Clearing for Utility Relocation

Where clearing is done by a utility company to install or relocate a utility and the clearing is a Ministry requirement for other construction or for safety reasons, then the total cost of the clearing will be borne by the Ministry.

Page 132: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 4 of 11 B201-1

Where the Ministry requests the relocation of a utility to an area beyond the limits of clearing proposed under the contract, then the utility company shall pay half the cost of labour for such additional clearing.

Where the utility company installs a new plant or relocates an existing plant within the Ministry right-of-way and no clearing or grading is scheduled in that area, then the utility company shall pay the total cost of labour for clearing.

201-1.7.6 Clearing on Crown and Private Lands

a) Crown Lands

All timber cut on a right-of-way through Crown lands becomes the property of the Ministry who will, in due course, be invoiced by the Ministry of Natural Resources (MNR) for merchantable wood.

Regional Planning and Design are required to notify the MNR of the proposed

clearing or close cut clearing at least two months prior to the scheduled design completion date to allow sufficient time to organize a timber cruise. When notifying MNR, the following information should be forwarded:

i) Commencement date of clearing operation ii) Whether clearing is to be done by contract or by Operational Services iii) Commencement date of construction operations iv) Plan of construction area

The value of the timber will have been determined previously by the MNR from a

timber cruise of the area. Following receipt of an invoice from the MNR, the Ministry will transfer the ownership of the timber to the Contractor by including the applicable standard special provision.

b) Timber Licence The Regional Planning and Design Section is to enquire of the MNR whether

timber rights (e.g. timber berth, registered mining claims, etc.) exist on Crown lands scheduled for clearing. This information is passed to the Contractor by means of a standard special provision.

c) Timber Salvage on Private Lands

All timber cut from privately owned lands purchased for right-of-way purposes

becomes the property of the Contractor, unless property purchase agreements specify otherwise.

Page 133: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 5 of 11 B201-1

The Regional Design Office must check with the Property Section for timber salvage information and provide details of same in the contract drawings (see Subsection 201-1.9 Documentation) and in the contract documents (see Subsection 201-1.5 Special Provisions).

201-1.7.7 Selective Clearing

Selective clearing is normally carried out after the general contract using Operational Services, with funds established under "Services (Sundry)" (see Chapter 'D').

Areas for selective clearing are detailed on the construction drawings outside (and usually adjacent to) the limits of "contract" clearing. These areas are normally protected by a barrier and denoted as "Areas (or trees) to be retained".

As there are no clearing quantities to be computed for this operation, the work of the designer is limited to:

a) Liaison with:

i) Principle Landscape Architect, Design and Contract Standards Office ii) Regional Environmental Section iii) Regional Operations Office iv) Utility Co-ordinator in order to determine the need for tree retention areas and selective clearing;

b) Presenting tree retention areas on construction drawings, with suitable notes, and

distributing copies to those concerned, for comments; c) Providing the appropriate OPSS 801 for Tree Protection; d) If needed, generating a tender item "Barrier for Tree Protection" and computing

quantities.

201-1.7.8 Areas of Clearing

Areas which are to be included in the clearing item are as follows:

a) Areas within the right-of-way required for construction, including corners of intersections where growth may obstruct visibility.

b) Curves where visibility is a problem. c) Areas recommended for clearing in the Landscape Planning Report. d) Areas required to construct detours. e) Areas required to construct stream diversions sideroads, entrances, etc. f) Areas required to construct ditches within the right-of-way and on areas of limited

interest.

Page 134: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 6 of 11 B201-1

g) Areas required to accommodate utility relocation within the right-of-way or on areas of limited interest.

h) Areas with fruit trees on MTO right-of-way in Southern Ontario. i) Areas within the roadside clear zone. (See the Roadside Safety Manual) j) Areas for the disposal of surplus materials within MTO right-of-way. k) Embankments up to and including 1.2 m in height.

Areas cleared, but not included in this item are: a) Borrow pits. b) Access roads. c) Haul roads. Areas or work covered by other tender items where clearing is paid for as part of the work of that tender item, such as fencing in wooded areas not designated for clearing. When the clearing item is small and there is a close cut clearing item in the contract, it may be more practical to indicate close cut clearing only, and to include grubbing where required. When both clearing and close cut clearing are large, the clearing item could be eliminated, but only where experience has shown that separate items would not result in cost savings.

201-1.7.9 Areas of Close Cut Clearing

Close cut clearing will be prescribed for areas where grubbing is considered unnecessary or undesirable, such as those: a) Under embankments higher than 1.2 metres. b) Where grubbing operations could damage fences, building foundations or

underground utilities (not requiring relocation); c) Where a matted surface (roots, etc.) provides slope stability; d) In swamps, where grubbing could rupture the matted surface; e) Where roots left in place would not interfere with construction or maintenance

operations.

Page 135: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 7 of 11 B201-1

Page 136: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 8 of 11 B201-1

201-1.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. 201-1.8.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of the tender item "Clearing" and “Close Cut Clearing” are the field survey notebooks (see Fig. B201-1-1) and available plans (B Plans; ETR Books; Photogrammetry Contour Plans).

201-1.8.2 Clearing by Area

The unit of measurement for clearing by area is the hectare (ha). Clearing by area may comprise areas of solid bush, trees in clumps and rows, or individual trees, all of which are computed in square metres.

Clearing quantities are computed from details recorded in the field survey notebooks, or, if not available, by scaling available plans in square metres.

Page 137: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 9 of 11 B201-1

Page 138: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 10 of 11 B201-1

201-1.8.3 Clearing of Trees

On suitable projects where the number of trees to be cleared is minimal and there is no other clearing by area (hectare), the clearing calculation may be based on the total number of trees greater than 100 mm diameter to be removed, under the unit "each":

The diameter of each tree is determined by measuring its girth at a height of 1.3 metres and recording its diameter; the information being found in the field survey notebooks.

Those trees which are to remain within the construction area should be suitably marked by the contractor or by Operational Services.

Do not refer to this operation as "Selective Clearing” (see Section 201-1.7.7). 201-1.9 DOCUMENTATION 201-1.9.1 Contract Drawings

Where clearing areas are extensive, they are shown on the removal drawings. However, where clearing is minor, they may be placed on construction drawings, providing they do not obstruct the construction details. Areas identified where timber is to be cut and remain on the property of the property seller shall be shown on the Removal drawings.

If specific trees are to be retained in an area of clearing, the areas should be shown on the Removal Drawings, with the note - "....... to be retained". The outline of the treed area or individual trees to be retained should be shown also on the construction plans in full intensity.

Prints should be sent to the Principle Landscape Architect for identification of clearing and subsequent refurbishment, the Regional Environmental Unit for review by the environmental planner, and the utility co-ordinator to identify clearing and trees to be saved during construction and utility relocation.

201-1.9.2 Contract Documents

Areas to be cleared are to be entered onto the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet in square metres by station location. The position information must clearly indicate the extent, by centre-line offset, of each individual area to be cleared since this information will be used for layout & verification purposes during construction. Quantities, in hectares, are automatically calculated and then totalled at the bottom of the column.

Page 139: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CLEARING

May 2013 Page 11 of 11 B201-1

Diagrams may be drawn on the Removals sheet to indicate partial clearing in solid bush areas. Where entire bush areas are to be cleared, diagrams are not necessary as this type of situation can be described adequately by chainage and offset.

Quantity sheets produced which precludes sketching, may have 350 meter quantity summaries as long as removal drawings and separate quantity calculations are provided.

Where rows of trees to be removed are denoted by a single chainage, offsets to both the beginning and end of the row are required (e.g. Sta. 16 + 473 - 4.1 m Lt. to 25.6 m Lt.).

It is important that quantities shown on the Quantity sheet have a degree of accuracy sufficient to be used in the contract as the final payment quantities.

Clumps of single trees are documented by combined spread and area rather than as single trees.

201-1.9.3 Documentation Accuracy

Chainage Stations: One-tenth of a metre (0.1m) Chainage offsets: One-tenth of a metre (0.1m) Areas in square metres: One square metre (1.0 m²) Areas in hectares: One hundredth of a hectare (0.01 ha)

In calculating areas, work to one extra place of decimals and record to the accuracy shown above.

Page 140: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 141: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRUBBING

May 2013 Page 1 of 3 B201-3

B201-3 - GRUBBING - OPSS 201 201-3.1 GENERAL Grubbing consists of the removal and disposal of all stumps, roots, embedded logs,

debris and second growth, with the operation usually being performed immediately following, and as part of, the same contract as clearing or close cut clearing.

Where the right-of-way, or a portion thereof, has been previously cleared or close cut

cleared (under a separate contract, or by Operational Services), the Contractor will, under the item "Grubbing", clear, remove and dispose of all second growth, brush and debris from those areas designated for grubbing.

When grubbing requirements are minor, the work may be done by Operational

Services, with funds provided from 'Services (Sundry)' - (see Chapter 'D'). Surface boulders lying within areas designated for grubbing are removed as part of the

work of grubbing, except those one cubic metre (1.0 m³) or larger in volume which are removed under the item "Rock Excavation (Grading)". For treatment of boulders see section CDED B201-4.

201-3.2 REFERENCES CDED B201-1 - Clearing CDED B201-4 - Removal of Boulders CDED B206-1 - Earth Excavation (Grading) CDED Chapter D - Services and Acquisition - Construction 201-3.3 TENDER ITEMS

Grubbing 201-3.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for grubbing are contained in OPSS 201. 201-3.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions.

Page 142: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRUBBING

May 2013 Page 2 of 3 B201-3

201-3.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None 201-3.7 DESIGN 201-3.7.1 Limits of Grubbing Fig. B201-2-1 in CDED B201-1 shows in principle the application of grubbing. The designer should discuss the limits of grubbing for each project with: The Regional Maintenance Office The Regional Construction Office The Utility Co-Ordinator The Regional Environmental Section 201-3.7.2 Grubbing and Advance Grubbing for Utility Relocation and Fencing Grubbing operations, including advance grubbing, for utility relocations and fencing

are governed by the same principles outlined in CDED B201-1. 201-3.7.3 Areas of Grubbing Areas to be grubbed are:

a) Excavation areas (except swamp excavation); b) Under low embankments - up to and including 1.2 metres in height; c) Offtake ditches and watercourse corrections.

Where swamp excavation is required, embedded low stumps, etc. will be removed as

part of swamp excavation (see CDED B206-1). 201-3.7.4 Disposal of Debris Debris from grubbing operations may be disposed of both on and off the right-of-way. In bush areas, debris such as stumps, roots, earth, usually is pushed onto adjacent

private or Crown lands under agreement with the owner or Ministry of Natural Resources respectively, and with the approval of the Ministry of the Environment; all arrangements for disposal being the responsibility of the Contractor. Alternatively, debris may be pushed to the back of the right-of-way and, in suitable areas,

Page 143: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRUBBING

May 2013 Page 3 of 3 B201-3

incorporated into the flattening of sideslopes, but in no case will it be disposed of within embankments.

Surface litter and second-growth material may be burned on the right-of-way, under

those conditions stated in CDED B201-1. In rare cases, debris may require hauling off the right-of-way, to disposal sites

arranged for by the Contractor. 201-3.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. Computation procedures for grubbing are the same as those for clearing (see CDED

B201-1). 201-3.9 DOCUMENTATION Documentation procedures for grubbing are the same as those for clearing (see CDED

B201-1). 201-3.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Chainage Stations: One-tenth of a metre (0.1m) Chainage offsets: One-tenth of a metre (0.1m) Areas in square metres: One square metre (1.0 m²) Areas in hectares: One hundredth of a hectare (0.01 ha)

In calculating areas, work to one extra place of decimals and record to the accuracy shown above.

Page 144: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 145: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL OF BOULDERS

May 2013 Page 1 of 4 B201-4

B201-4 - REMOVAL OF BOULDERS - OPSS 201 201-4.1 GENERAL The removal of boulders includes the disposal of both surface and piled boulders.

Surface boulders are defined as boulders or rock fragments that measure 200 mm or greater in any one dimension, above original ground, and can be removed without excavation.

Piled boulders are defined as any cobbles, boulders, or rock fragments that have been placed in fencerows or piles.

Boulders or rock fragments one cubic metre (1.0 m³) or larger are not part of this

tender item, but are removed under the item "Rock Excavation (Grading)", or, if there is no such item, as a Change in the Work.

201-4.2 REFERENCES - None 201-4.3 TENDER ITEMS

Removal of Surface Boulders Removal of Piled Boulders

201-4.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for the removal of surface and piled boulders are contained in

OPSS 201. 201-4.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions. 201-4.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None

Page 146: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL OF BOULDERS

May 2013 Page 2 of 4 B201-4

201-4.7 DESIGN 201-4.7.1 Removal of Surface Boulders Surface boulders are designated for removal only where they would interfere with

construction or the intended level of maintenance, or where they could become a traffic hazard. Surface boulders in areas of close cut clearing do not require removal, unless they interfere with construction.

Where surface boulders occur in fill sections exceeding 1.0 m in height then the

boulders could remain in place. This item is used when surface boulders to be removed are located beyond areas to be

grubbed. Surface boulders within grubbing areas are removed as part of grubbing operations

and paid for under the item "Grubbing". No designation or quantity for surface boulders is indicated on the contract drawings or quantity sheets, in this instance.

Where a surface boulder area lies partly within an area to be grubbed, only that

portion outside the grubbed area is calculated as removal of surface boulders; the remainder will be removed under the grubbing operation, as described above.

201-4.7.2 Removal of Piled Boulders Piled boulders are removed only where they interfere with construction; fence

erection; the intended level of maintenance, or would create a hazard to traffic. Piled boulders (total quantity greater than 100 m³), both within and beyond grubbing

areas, are included in the tender item "Removal of Piled Boulders", regardless of whether the work is done before or during the grubbing operation. (For a total quantity smaller than 100 m³, see subsection 201-4.8.3).

Boulders in piles or fencerows within areas of surface boulder removal are also

removed as part of the item "Removal of Piled Boulders". No deduction of areas covered by boulders in piles and fencerows are made from any

areas designated for grubbing or removal of surface boulders. 201-4.8 COMPUTATION When measured, these are Plan Quantity Payment items.

Page 147: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL OF BOULDERS

May 2013 Page 3 of 4 B201-4

Lump sum payment may be used for these items when locations are well defined the quantity is small and it is unlikely that the quantity will vary.

201-4.8.1 Source of Information The main sources of information for the computation of the tender item "Removal of

Surface Boulders" are the field survey notebooks and the Geotechnical Report. The main sources of information for the computation of the tender item "Removal of

Piled Boulders" are the field survey notebooks and ETR (Engineering and Title Records) Plans (or contour plans).

201-4.8.2 Methods of Calculation The basic unit of measurement for the removal of surface boulders is the hectare (ha). The areas of surface boulders to be removed under this tender item are calculated

initially from the field survey notebooks in square metres (m2), summarized on the Quantity Sheets and converted to hectares.

The basic unit of measurement for the removal of piled boulders is the cubic metre

(m³). 201-4.8.3 Small Quantities Small quantities of surface boulders (up to 0.20 ha) and/or piled boulders (100 m³ or

less), beyond grubbing areas requiring removal may be included as part of other work such as "Earth Excavation Grading". A special provision is required to include these removals with the other work, and the extent of piled boulder removals must be shown on the contract drawings.

Small quantities within grubbing areas, if not designated on the contract drawings for

removal under a separate tender item, are removed as part of the grubbing operation, as specified in OPSS 201; a special provision is not required.

201-4.9 DOCUMENTATION 201-4.9.1 Surface Boulders Boulder-strewn areas do not normally require demarcation on contact drawings unless

the area is very irregular and difficult to describe. Areas requiring the removal of surface boulders within grubbing areas are designated as grubbing on the Quantity Sheets, and not as removal of surface boulders.

Page 148: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL OF BOULDERS

May 2013 Page 4 of 4 B201-4

The calculated surface boulder areas are detailed on the Quantity Sheet. Entries are listed by station and offset at each location where surface boulders (beyond grubbing areas) are to be removed. All areas are totalled and the tender total transferred to the Tender document.

When lump sum payment is chosen, the quantities are indicated on the Quantity Sheet

at each location where surface boulders are to be removed, as described above. 201-4.9.2 Piled Boulders Piled boulders are shown on the plans using a hand-drawn symbol, and appropriately

labelled (e.g. "1.5 m Boulder Pile" or "0.5 m Fencerow"). The calculated quantities are detailed on the Quantity Sheets. Entries are listed by station and offset at each where piled boulders are to be removed.

All quantities are totalled on the Quantity Sheet and the total transferred to the Tender

documents. When piled boulders quantities are small and removed under lump sum payment or as

part of other work, the locations are indicated on the contract drawings and entered on the Quantity Sheet, listing each location and quantity where piled boulders are to be removed.

Page 149: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MECHANICAL STUMP CUTTING

May 2013 Page 1 of 2 B201-6

B201-6 - MECHANICAL STUMP CUTTING - OPSS 201 201-6.1 GENERAL Stump removal using a mechanical cutter is a chipping operation whereby tree stumps

are removed to a depth of 0.15 m below the surrounding area, leaving the root systems undisturbed.

Under this tender item, only those stumps 150 mm diameter and greater are

considered for stump removal by mechanical cutter. For innumerable small trees, those less than 150 mm diameter, close cut clearing is a

more practical and acceptable means of removing hazards or improving aesthetics. 201-6.2 REFERENCES CDED B201-1 - Clearing 201-6.3 TENDER ITEMS

Mechanical Stump Cutting 201-6.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for grubbing are contained in OPSS 201. 201-6.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions. 201-6.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None 201-6.7 DESIGN 201-6.7.1 Areas of Stump Removal by Mechanical Cutter Following are typical conditions under which stump removal by mechanical cutter is

considered desirable:

Page 150: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MECHANICAL STUMP CUTTING

May 2013 Page 2 of 2 B201-6

a) In urban areas, beyond grading limits, where grubbing is an unwarranted expense

and regular mowing a necessity; b) Areas where underground utility installations are liable to damage from grubbing

operations; c) Areas where grubbing operations may affect culverts, or undermine buildings,

sidewalks, pavement or shoulders; d) Following clearing or close cut clearing - to remove hazards, permit mowing or to

improve aesthetics, without having to remove entire root systems, as is the case in grubbing operations.

201-6.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. Computation procedures for mechanical stump cutting are the same as those for

clearing (see CDED B201-1) except that the unit of measurement is "each", and all stumps removed, regardless of size, are included in one tender item..

201-6.9 DOCUMENTATION Documentation procedures for mechanical stump cutting are the same as those for

clearing (see CDED B201-1). All stumps to be removed must be so designated on the contract drawings.

Page 151: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

B202 - ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING,

TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING - OPSS.PROV 202 202.1 GENERAL Rock removal by manual scaling, machine scaling, trim blasting, or controlled

blasting is typically localized and completed to remove unstable or potentially unstable rock mass that may be a safety hazard. Less frequently, these items are used to remove unstable rock from an existing rock mass in advance of other work.

Refer to MERO-043 for additional detail on rock removal. 202.2 REFERENCES MERO-043, RHRON: Ontario Rockfall Hazard Rating System – Field Procedures

Manual Rockfall Hazard Investigation and Design Report – project specific The above report typically includes a description of the rock mass, stability analysis,

RHRON hazard rating, recommended hazard mitigation, any applicable drawings and special provisions, and photographic prints identifying locations, proposed alternative and recommended treatments, tender quantity estimates, and other detailed requirements or relevant special features. The report must be prepared by a qualified person (P.Eng. or P.Geo, with related training or experience) knowledgeable in rock mechanics and geotechnical engineering. The report is referred to as “Design Report” hereafter in this document.

202.3 TENDER ITEMS Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting 202.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender item are contained in OPSS 202.

February 2014 Page 1 of 6 B202

Page 152: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

202.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special

provisions. 202.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no applicable standard drawings. 202.7 DESIGN Recommendations for the limits and method of rock removal are contained in the

Design Report. The Design Report typically contains site-specific recommendations. Trim blasting and controlled blasting are generally used to remove specific features

from existing rock slopes such as localized overhangs, areas that can “launch” falling rocks towards the roadway, and specific rock zones at risk of sliding, toppling or other failure mechanisms, that cannot be easily removed by manual or machine scaling methods. Controlled blasting requires the use of wall control blasting techniques to prevent the formation of additional blast fractures which could cause further unstable rock.

The OPSS 206 Rock Excavation, Grading item is generally used for removal of large

masses of rock during new highway construction or widening, including widening to mitigate rockfall hazards, and used in conjunction with the OPSS 206 Rock Face item where relatively smooth, maintenance free, rock slopes are required.

The OPSS 206 Rock Face item is not used in conjunction with the Rock Excavation,

Controlled Blasting item. 202.7.1 Management of Material Management of the removed rock material is included in the items. When the

material is to be used for a specific purpose, such as flattening embankments, an NSSP is required to define the requirements.

202.8 COMPUTATION 202.8.1 Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling

Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting

February 2014 Page 2 of 6 B202

Page 153: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

The items and unit of measurement are:

- Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling, hr - Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling, hr - Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting, m - Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting, m³

The estimated number of scaling hours, length of drilling for trim blasting, and

volume of controlled blasting, for each location, are contained in the Design Report. The work of trim blasting and controlled blasting includes scaling after blasting.

Scaling of trim blasting and controlled blasting areas shall not be included in scaling quantity calculations.

202.9 DOCUMENTATION 202.9.1 Contract Drawings Rock removal areas and the method of removal are to be detailed using images of the

rock mass, using only one of the following two approaches: a) Include in the Contract Drawings, high resolution images of each rock mass

requiring rock removal. Each image is to be accompanied by location referencing, manually delineated removal areas, and the method of removal identified. The image and details must be sufficient to eliminate any uncertainty regarding the location and the type of work to be done. Example images are shown in Fig. 1.

b) Include with the Contract Package, a Rock Hazard Report with high resolution

colour images of each rock mass requiring rock removal, containing the same information described in a) above.

Typically, option a) is used when there are only a few rock mass locations requiring

work, and option b) used when there are multiple rock mass locations or when colour images are required to eliminate uncertainty regarding the location and/or scope of the work.

February 2014 Page 3 of 6 B202

Page 154: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

Fig. 1: Example images showing rock removal location and requirements.

February 2014 Page 4 of 6 B202

Page 155: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

202.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets) Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling

Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting Removal areas are documented by station to station limits and offset Lt or Rt on the

Q-sheets. Where stationing is not available, the areas may be documented by NAD83 northing and easting coordinates and offset or by distance/direction from a geographic landmark and offset.

The individual column entries are totalled and are transferred to the Form of Tender. 202.9.2.1 Variation Items Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling and Rock Excavation, Machine Scaling are

variation items. For both items, the maximum height from the base of the rock mass to the area requiring scaling is specified.

Where an item has more than one height specified, separate columns are used for

each height. 202.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Write any required project specific requirements in a NSSP. For example:

- The use of the excavated rock for specific purposes, such as slope flattening. - The identification of rock disposal location options. - Modifications to the item requirements. - Conditions specified by utilities. - Restrict the work to specialized contractors qualified to do the work (approval to

restrict procurement may be required). - Work by a specialized person to be done during/after rock removal. - Access restrictions. - Environmental constraints.

202.9.4 Documentation Accuracy Quantities of Rock Excavation, Manual Scaling and Rock Excavation, Machine

Scaling are rounded to whole numbers. Quantities of Rock Excavation, Trim Blasting are rounded to the nearest 0.1 m. Quantities of Rock Excavation, Controlled Blasting are rounded to whole numbers.

February 2014 Page 5 of 6 B202

Page 156: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK REMOVAL BY MANUAL SCALING, MACHINE SCALING, TRIM BLASTING, OR CONTROLLED BLASTING

202.9.5 Information to be Provided to Bidders When applicable, the following information is to be provided to Bidders:

- Rock Hazard Report

February 2014 Page 6 of 6 B202

Page 157: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK STABILIZATION

B203 – ROCK STABILIZATION - OPSS.PROV 203 203.1 GENERAL

Rock stabilization by one or a combination of rock bolts, rock drains, shotcrete, or concrete buttresses is typically completed at locations of unstable or potentially unstable rock mass that may be a safety hazard, or to stabilize a rock mass supporting other work such as structures.

203.2 REFERENCES N/A

203.3 TENDER ITEMS Rock Bolting (variation) Rock Shotcreting Rock Drains Concrete Buttress

203.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender item are contained in OPSS.PROV 203.

203.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

203.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no applicable standard drawings.

203.7 DESIGN Recommendations for the limits and method of rock stabilization are contained in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report. The report contains site-specific recommendations.

August 2015 Page 1 of 4 B203

Page 158: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK STABILIZATION

203.7.1 Information to be Provided to Bidders When applicable, the following information is to be provided to bidders: - Foundation Investigation Report

203.8 COMPUTATION 203.8.1 Rock Bolting

Rock Shotcreting Rock Drains Concrete Buttress

The items and unit of measurement are: - Rock Bolting, ea - Rock Shotcreting, m² - Rock Drains, ea - Concrete Buttress, m³

203.9 DOCUMENTATION 203.9.1 Contract Drawings

Rock stabilization work locations are to be specified using minimum 3508 x 4961 pixels resolution images of the rock mass, included in the Contract Documents using one of the following two approaches: a) Include with the Contract Package, a Foundation Investigation Report with colour

images of each rock mass requiring stabilization. Each image is to be accompanied by station referencing and the specific stabilization work locations (areas of rock shotcrete and/or concrete buttress, rock bolting locations, and rock drain locations) manually inserted. The image and details must be sufficient to eliminate any uncertainty regarding the location and the type of work to be done.

b) Include in the Contract Drawings, images of each rock mass requiring rock

stabilization, and containing the same information described in a) above.

Option a) is the default approach. When there are only a few rock mass locations requiring stabilization work, and grayscale images are sufficient to identify the work locations, option b) may be used. Include the following details on Contract Drawings, as applicable.

August 2015 Page 2 of 4 B203

Page 159: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK STABILIZATION

For Rock Bolting:

(1) Spacing and inclination of rock bolts

(2) Size and properties of the bolts if different from the bolts specified in OPSS.PROV 203.

(3) Dimensions of the holes to be drilled for grouted rock bolts.

(4) Grout material to fill annular space between drilled hole and rock bolt.

(5) Testing requirements including acceptance criteria.

For Concrete Buttress:

(1) The size, properties, and installation pattern and depths of dowels and

reinforcing steel.

(2) Properties of concrete. 203.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Rock Bolting Rock Shotcreting Rock Drains Concrete Buttress Work locations are documented by station to station limits and offset Lt or Rt on the Q-sheets. Rock bolting is a variation item. The anchor type (Resin Anchor, Grout Anchor) shall be identified at the top of the column. Separate columns are required for each anchor type, when both are present on the same project. The individual column quantities are totalled, combined into the tender total, and transferred to the Form of Tender. For other items, the individual column entries are totalled and transferred to the Form of Tender.

203.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Station limits are to the nearest 0.1 m. Quantities of Rock Shotcreting and Concrete Buttress are rounded to whole numbers.

August 2015 Page 3 of 4 B203

Page 160: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK STABILIZATION

203.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Write any required project specific requirements in a NSSP. For example: - Modifications to the item requirements (requires approval of MERO Foundations

group). - Conditions specified by utilities. - Restrict the work to specialized contractors qualified to do the work (approval to

restrict procurement may be required). - Access restrictions. - Environmental constraints.

August 2015 Page 4 of 4 B203

Page 161: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 1 of 32 B206-1

B206-1 - EARTH GRADING - OPSS.PROV 206 206-1.1 GENERAL

This section deals with the excavation, haulage, placement, compaction, and management of earth material, as defined in OPSS.PROV 206. This section should be read in conjunction with Section B206-2 - Rock Grading, as the computation methods, balancing of quantities and documentation apply to both. Earth excavation is a main component of highway construction and it includes grading for highways, sideroads, entrances, ditches, detours, etc.

206-1.1.1 Classification of Earth Materials The following materials, when encountered during grading operations, are usually treated the same as earth and are included in the item Earth Excavation, Grading: A. Earth Overburden

Stripping and Earth Cut quantities originating from earth overburden on rock formations are estimated and treated as earth excavation in accordance with the geotechnical recommendations.

B. Boulders and Fragmented Rock in Earth Cuts

The treatment of boulders and fragmented rock smaller than 1.0 m³ encountered in earth cuts is normally stipulated in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report and, unless otherwise directed, they are dealt with as per Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings.

C. Fragmented Rock and Weathered Rock

Quantities of fragmented and weathered rock, smaller than 1.0 m³, excavated from existing road embankments or cuts, will be included in Earth Excavation, Grading quantities. Certain rock deposits such as shale may be designated as earth to the bottom of excavation or to a designated pay surface, below which it would be classified as solid rock.

D. Granular Deposits

Any granular or select subgrade material deposits which meet the requirements of OPSS 1010, when obtained from within the right-of-way, is paid for as Earth

Page 162: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 2 of 32 B206-1

Excavation, Grading. Relevant estimating procedures apply equally to granular material.

206-1.2 REFERENCES

Commercial Access Manual Design Criteria - project specific Drainage Management Manual Environmental Assessment Report (various names) - project specific Foundation Investigation and Design Report - project specific Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways Geotechnical Report - project specific Highway Design Bulletin 2010-001, Providing Digital Information to Contract,

Special Provision SP 199F61 Hydrology Report - project specific Pavement Design Report - project specific Preliminary Design Report - project specific Recommended Practice For Establishing Rock Elevation For New Highway

Construction, MERO-030 Soils Profile - project specific Survey Information - project specific

206-1.3 TENDER ITEMS

Earth Excavation, Grading

206-1.3.1 Other Tender Items with Earth Excavation Earth excavation for the following is not carried out under the item Earth Excavation, Grading, but under separate items and governing OPS Specifications:

Pavement Widening, when using linear measurement Culverts Sewers, Manholes, Catchbasins, Ditch Inlets Subdrains Structures

These items are detailed elsewhere in this Chapter.

Page 163: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 3 of 32 B206-1

206-1.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work are contained in:

OPSS.PROV 206 Grading OPSS 209 Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils OPSS 316 Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Frost Heave Treatment OPSS 351 Concrete Sidewalk OPSS 501 Compacting OPSS 510 Removal

206-1.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions. As of the publication date of this CDED section, special provisions are required: 1) When there are pipes and culverts less than 200 mm diameter and/or expanded

polystyrene insulation to be removed as part of the item Earth Excavation, Grading.

2) Where the existing pavement is removed, and the volume of pavement removed is

included in the excavation quantity for the item Earth Excavation, Grading. 3) When there is prime, surface treated, and mulch pavement less than 50 mm thick

to be removed as part of the item Earth Excavation, Grading.

206-1.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the OPSD 200 series. To establish the physical limits on which to base quantities, a familiarity with applicable standard drawings is required. It may be required to develop typical sections or modify existing standard drawings for specific situations, such as, but not limited to:

Sideroad Intersections Commercial Entrances Private Entrances Design of Open Channels

Page 164: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 4 of 32 B206-1

In addition, review of the following manuals should be done, where appropriate:

Commercial Access Manual Drainage Management Manual Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways

For Swamps:

1) OPSDs are only valid for where the depth of the swamp, d is less than orequal to 6 metres.

2) For any swamp excavation exceeding 6 metres in depth, project specificrecommendations and applicable drawings are required. Refer to theFoundation Investigation and Design Report.

206-1.7 DESIGN

Earth Excavation, Grading item includes material from the following operations:

Stripping in Cuts Stripping under Fills Earth Cut/Fill (integral with roadway Section)

- roadway - side ditches - transition points - sidewalks - widening - entrances - frost heaves - excavation below subgrade

Ditching- interceptor - intake/offtake

Swamp Excavation, when by the cubic metre- roadway - culverts

Watercourse Correction Frost Heaves, isolated Sidewalks, isolated Entrances

The benching of existing sideslopes for roadbed widening in fills is a construction operation only; it is not to be computed for inclusion in the item Earth Excavation, Grading.

Page 165: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 5 of 32 B206-1

The work of compaction is included in the item Earth Excavation, Grading and does not require any design. The compaction of earth is described in OPSS 501. Pipes and culverts less than 200 mm in diameter including subdrains shall be removed as part of the item Earth Excavation, Grading provided they are located within the excavation. This work is specifically excluded from the work done under OPSS 510 Removal. The locations of the pipes and culverts are to be specified in the Contract Documents as descried in section B510 Removal. Prime, surface treatment, and mulch pavement less than 50 mm in thickness are removed under the item Earth Excavation, Grading.

206-1.7.1 Source of Information

A. Design Criteria

The Design Criteria represents a statement of the application of ministry policy and design standards for a project. The Design Criteria is a concise form for describing the geometric elements and standards that form the basis for the design of a new facility or improvements to an existing facility and the extent of the work to be completed on any project.

B. Survey Information

Survey information is obtained using various methods and technologies depending upon the needs and requirements of each project. Available Survey Information will aid in the design and may include field notes, data, cross-sections, horizontal and vertical alignments, and plans. Field notes are produced by survey crews and provide details of existing surface features on the main roadway, sideroads and entrances, and data.

C. Soils Profile

The Soils Profile, when available, shows the existing ground line, proposed vertical alignment, existing drainage data, and relevant soils data.

D. Reports

A number of reports contain data needed to establish cross-sections upon which cut and fill quantities will be based. These reports are:

Environmental Assessment Report (various names) Foundation Investigation and Design Report Geotechnical Report

Page 166: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 6 of 32 B206-1

Hydrology Report Pavement Design Report Preliminary Design Report

E. Field Review

A comprehensive field review at the start of the design phase, with plans to record observations and notes, is invaluable to understand the work and design required. A field review to verify the design should be carried out near the end of the design process.

206-1.7.2 Establishing the Rock Surface

Establishing the rock surface is essential to accurate earth and rock quantity estimates. The survey information, soils information and borehole data is used to establish the rock surface. The final interpretation should be reviewed with the geotechnical staff on the project. Information that can assist in establishing the rock surface is in The Recommended Practice For Establishing Rock Elevation For New Highway Construction, MERO-030.

206-1.7.3 Earth Borrow The item Earth Borrow is required when the breakdown of item quantities indicates a shortage in quantities between earth fill required and earth material available. Smaller differences might be eliminated by widening backslopes in cut sections or by revising the profile grade. With certain types of projects, it will be evident in the planning stage, that insufficient fill material will be generated by the limited excavation opportunities and that an item for Earth Borrow will be required. The item Earth Borrow is discussed in Section B212 - Earth Borrow.

206-1.7.4 Composite Earth and Rock Fills

A composite earth and rock fill embankment has an earth core and a rock shell. Embankment fills are typically either earth fill or rock fill. Circumstances may require consideration of a composite earth and rock embankment fill. These circumstances include:

1) Insufficient quantities of earth or rock fill. 2) Haulage distance.

Page 167: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 7 of 32 B206-1

3) Environmental. Design guidelines for composite earth and rock fill embankments are available from the Pavements and Foundations Section, Materials Engineering and Design Office (MERO).

206-1.7.5 Surcharges

Surcharges that are removed usually have the material used on the project. When the surcharge is fragmented rock smaller than 1.0 m³ rock, the surcharge removal is completed under the item Earth Excavation, Grading. The use of the excavated rock material is determined based on the project needs. When the surcharge is earth, other than fragmented rock smaller than 1.0 m³, the surcharge removal and use is completed under the item Earth Excavation, Grading. When the surcharge is granular, the surcharge removal and use of the granular material in the work is completed under the appropriate tender item, Granular from Stockpile (see OPSS 314).

206-1.7.6 Existing Rock Fills and Rock Stockpiles

Excavation of existing rock fills and rock stockpiles, that are shatter, rock fill and previously blasted rock (smaller than 1.0 m³) is completed under the item Earth Excavation, Grading. The use of the excavated rock material is determined based on the project needs.

206-1.7.7 Management of Excavated Materials

Excavated materials may be utilized in the following ways:

Stripping - topsoil for graded areas to be sodded or seeded - stockpiled for future use - designing flatter or contoured slopes

Earth Cut (suitable)

- embankment construction backfilling of excavations - designing flatter slopes - berms - stockpiled for future use

Earth Cut (unsuitable)

- embankment construction beyond the minimum specified earth and rock embankment slopes

Page 168: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 8 of 32 B206-1

- berms - designing flatter slopes

Ditching

- as for Earth Cut

Swamp Excavation - flattening of embankment slopes beyond the minimum specified earth and

rock embankment slopes - berms - topsoil, only when the material has been determined to be acceptable for use

for graded areas to be sodded or seeded Frost Heaves

- as for Earth Cut

Watercourse Correction - disposal in old streambed

Rock Surcharges, Existing Rock Fills and Rock Stockpiles

- embankment construction, under the item Rock Embankment - stockpiled for future use

Notes: 1) Guide rail may be eliminated by the use of slope flattening. 2) Slopes behind guide rail may be flattened, even when the guide rail will still be

required. 3) Excess bituminous pavement, concrete, and masonry surplus to the recycling

requirements on a project may be incorporated into embankments, provided it is acceptable material and is processed as specified elsewhere in the contract.

206-1.7.7.1 Surplus Materials

The maximum of amount of excavated earth material is to be incorporated into the design of a facility to reduce or eliminate surplus earth material. Material that is in excess of embankment requirements should be incorporated into the design. The cross sections and/or locations for such material are to be included in the design. When there is material quantity that is not used in the design, then the material is surplus.

Page 169: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 9 of 32 B206-1

To accommodate the surplus material within the project limits, when feasible, there should be “optional” cross-sections and typical sections or locations or both provided for use of surplus material. The quantity that can be accommodated at each location is to be provided. Note that “optional” locations may not have material placed there, and such are not to be used for locations where construction is mandatory, such as but not limited to, locations where guide rail has been eliminated from the design with slope flattening. Whenever possible, use/disposal locations for surplus materials should be identified within the project limits. When this is not feasible, then potential locations within the highway right-of-way and not within the project limits can be used (i.e. slope flattening, interchange locations, etc.). This would cause the project limits to be changed. Costs to accommodate earth material within the right-of-way will usually be cheaper than requiring the contractor to dispose of the material outside the right-of-way. Only after all possibilities of incorporation of materials are exhausted, is disposal of surplus materials outside the right-of-way, regardless of the type of materials, contemplated.

206-1.7.7.2 Ownership of Designated Disposal Locations Property designated as a disposal location for excavated material must be owned by MTO, or MTO must have a legal agreement in place. MTO ownership is preferred. In Crown Land areas, additional R.O.W. should be taken into the right-of-way to ensure excavated swamp material can be disposed of adjacent to the swamp excavation. Section B209 should be read for additional information and considerations on disposal of excavated swamp material.

206-1.7.8 Information to be Provided to Bidders The following document contains the requirements for the digital and data information and hard copy information to be provided to all contractors:

Highway Design Bulletin 2010-001, Providing Digital Information to Contractors, Special Provision SP 199F61

Notes: 1) Soils Data sheets as part of the Contract Drawings. 2) Do not provide a Mass Haul Diagram to bidders.

206-1.8 COMPUTATION Earth Excavation, Grading is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

Page 170: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 10 of 32 B206-1

The unit of measure is the cubic metre. The Earth Excavation, Grading item quantity is to be determined for each stage of the work. In computing earth quantities, for cut and fill, subtotal the figures every 350 m along the highway; and on service roads, sideroads, detours, ramps and entrances, where the length justifies such a breakdown. Each subtotal will constitute a single-line entry on the Quantity Sheets. Separation of quantities may be required for left and right sides of a widening project. Drawings and cross-sections are used to establish the physical limits on which to base quantities.

206-1.8.1 Stage Construction

When stage construction is proposed, quantities must be determined for each separate stage, as material excavated in one stage may not necessarily be available for embankment/fill purposes in a later stage. In order to obtain accurate quantities for material available, fill required, unsuitable material, and earth borrow, both quantity calculation and quantity sheets must be prepared for each stage of the contract. After the initial determination of quantities for each stage, an analysis to determine a more cost effective staging strategy and other design changes is to be done when material is not balancing for each stage. Several iterations may be required to determine the most cost effective and best design for the project.

206-1.8.2 Contingencies and Allowances

Refer to B999-A - APPENDIX “A” to this Chapter for information on “Contingencies and Allowances”.

206-1.8.3 Methods of Calculation Grading quantities are usually determined with electronic computation. However, in instances of small minor areas, it may be efficient and appropriate to use manual methods. The use of manual calculations to determine quantities is to be approved by Ministry management staff in the Planning and Design Section. Excavation quantities are to be determined using the average end area method, except for intersections, roundabouts, parking lots, and other similar locations where other methods achieve better quantity estimates.

Page 171: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 11 of 32 B206-1

Computer applications have many methods of calculating volumes and therefore it is important to ensure that the desired method is selected. The current version of the computer application in use with the Ministry for highway design is to be used for the design and determining grading quantities, when electronic computation is to be completed.

206-1.8.4 Cross Sections The interval of cross-sections may vary depending upon the work and roughness of the terrain, up to the usual maximum interval. Closer intervals should be used for tight curves. Usual cross-section minimum intervals between sections are:

25 m, plus break points, for earth, rock embankment (fill), swamp, and borrow areas

10 m, plus break points, for rock cut areas 20 m, plus break points, for possible rock areas

Cross-sections normally are plotted at a scale of 1:100 both horizontally and vertically. The following details should be incorporated in the cross-section from input data:

Original Ground Rock Surface Design Section including,

- top of pavement; top of granular; subgrade - grading limits; ditching limits; stripping limits - frost treatments; transition point treatment - shatter - swamp excavation limits - any other excavation below subgrade - optional construction sections, when optional areas for disposal of surplus

material are provided (this will require separate quantities to be determined and documented)

In addition the cross-section will include:

cross-section station number offset distances and elevation for profile grade elevation offset distances and elevations for original ground surface

Page 172: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 12 of 32 B206-1

206-1.8.5 Mass Haul Diagram

Mass Haul diagrams are to be prepared for all major grading contracts. Mass Haul diagrams are to consider the stages of the project, including physical and environmental restrictions during the stages. A Mass Haul Diagram serves as a guide in the appraisal of moving materials and balancing quantities. The comparison of the availability and usage of the excavation quantities provides guidance as to the feasibility and economy of a grading project. When analyzing a mass haul diagram for rock excavation and embankment consider the possible use of rock materials for aggregate production and other similar uses. After analyzing the diagram, revisions to the set grades or other solutions may be required. Should a grade revision be required, it is necessary to amend the cross-sections accordingly, recalculate the pertinent grading quantities and revise the Mass Haul Diagram.

206-1.8.6 Components of Earth Excavation, Grading

A. Stripping

Stripping consists of the removal of the upper layer of soil, which is predominantly organic and generally known as topsoil. Topsoil is a valuable commodity, to be stockpiled for later use in the contract as topsoil on graded areas, prior to seeding or sodding, or stockpiled for future use. The depths of required stripping under fills and in cuts, also the percentage of stripping considered as suitable for use as topsoil, will be as recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project, based on soils investigations and provided in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. On projects where all of the excavated earth is unsuitable for embankment construction, or where there are no embankments to be constructed, and there is no need to salvage stripping material for topsoiling on the project or stockpiling for future use, then stripping over cuts need not be computed.

The stockpiling of stripping to be used as topsoil is difficult and may not be feasible on projects where there is a limited work area (i.e. stand-alone bridge and culvert projects in urban areas). (a) Stripping in Cuts

Cut stripping occurs when the subgrade is below the original ground surface.

Page 173: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 13 of 32 B206-1

Topsoil is to be removed for the full width of the cut to the depth recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. In the absence of any recommendation, a depth of 0.15 m is to be used.

(b) Stripping under Fills

i. Stripping under Fills of 1.2 m or less in Height

The height of fill is defined as the vertical distance between the top of granular base and the ground surface at centreline. Fill stripping occurs when the subgrade is above the original ground surface and less than 1.2 m in height. The width of stripping under shallow embankments coincides with the width of the proposed embankment, i.e. toe to toe of slope. This does not include areas under embankments due to slope flattening. Topsoil is to be removed to the depth recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. In the absence of such recommendation, a depth of 0.3 m is to be used.

ii. Stripping under Fills more than 1.2 m in Height

Stripping is not required under fills more than 1.2 m unless:

1. There is a shortage of topsoil, in which case the height limitation

may be waived and the stripping area extended, rather than resorting to the more expensive operation of importing topsoil.

2. Required by the recommendations in the Geotechnical

Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

(c) Stripping in Areas to be Grubbed

Stripping is calculated for all areas to be grubbed within the grading limits. Excavated material is considered lost and not available for further use. The depth of stripping in grubbing areas is that recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project or 0.3 m, whichever is the greater.

Page 174: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 14 of 32 B206-1

(d) Stripping in Swamps Stripping in swamps is not applicable.

(e) Stripping in Areas of Embankment Widening In areas of reconstruction requiring embankment widening, stripping of previously constructed slopes is estimated using a depth of 0.15 m, or as recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

(f) Stripping of Sideslopes Prior to Benching

Although benching of sideslopes is not a measured quantity, stripping is computed over the benched area to the depth recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. If no depth is recommended, a depth of 0.15 m is to be used.

B. Earth Cut for Roadways, Interchanges, Detours, Sideroads, Entrances and Sidewalks

Earth Cut is material classified as earth as per OPSS.PROV 206, and which is excavated from below the stripping down to subgrade level (i.e. bottom of granular sub-base), as outlined in the theoretical section which applies to that particular project. When the granular and/or subgrade material underlying the pavement is to be removed as part of the Earth Excavation, Grading item, the cross-sectional area of the earth cut section is measured from the top of pavement, and the volume of pavement removed (including concrete base, lean concrete base and asphalt treated base) is included in the excavation quantity for the item Earth Excavation, Grading. On projects where there is removal of pavement as part of earth excavation, the volume of pavement removed must be subtracted from the excavation quantity when calculating the amount of material available for fill.

The removal of in-place processed pavement material by means of fine grading to specified lines and grades, prior to paving, is considered part of the work of the item In Place Processing of Bituminous Pavement, and must not be computed under the item Earth Excavation, Grading. Quantities are computed separately for roadways, interchanges, detours, etc., and subtotalled at 350 m intervals.

Page 175: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 15 of 32 B206-1

Excavated earth, usually, is suitable fill material, and the total volume computed is considered available for embankment construction and backfilling excavated areas. When some of the material is not acceptable, the percentage available for use as earth fill is normally shown on the Soils Profile or contained in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

The Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report may be supplemented by other forms of presentation, such as the Soils Profile which may indicate an average percentage waste (unsuitable material) for all cut material on the project or an expected percentage waste (unsuitable material) in each individual cut. The percentage waste is based on the earth excavation quantity remaining after deducting stripping volumes, pavement volumes and material removed in grubbing operations. Boulders and fragmented rock measuring 1.0 m³ or larger within earth excavation is regarded as rock and is not included in the earth quantities.

(a) Earth Excavation for Transition Treatment

In order to overcome the variance in bearing and frost heave characteristics found at the transition between cuts and fills, excavation and backfilling is carried out in accordance with OPSDs for Transition Treatments, and the resulting excavation quantities included under “Earth Cut”. Values for “d” (depth of granular base and subbase), “t” (transition treatment depth), and “Do” (depth of organic, leached and accumulate layers) as indicated in the OPSDs are obtained from the geotechnical staff on the project.

(b) Widening of Existing Roadbed

On projects which include the widening of an existing roadbed to increase lane width or add an entire lane, the work is included as part of the item Earth Excavation, Grading. The excavation is computed in cubic metres and, generally, the material is available for fill purposes, unless otherwise recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project. In some instances the work of widening may be included in the item Rental of Motor Grader, see Section B299-1, although this is rarely done. Another alternative to cubic measurement (m³) for this item is linear measurement (m) as discussed in Section B206-3 Excavation for Pavement Widening.

Page 176: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 16 of 32 B206-1

In order to maintain traffic during stage construction, cut sections may require widening beyond the limits set in the standards. Where widening to maintain traffic is necessary it should be considered as a detour and the appropriate quantities should be included in the tender.

(c) Excavation for Widening in Cuts to Achieve a Project or Stage Balance

In order to achieve a balance of cut and fill requirements for a grading contract when grade adjustment is not feasible, widening of cut sections beyond the limits set in the standards, or excavating within interchange loops, medians or similar operations are acceptable alternatives. These possibilities should always be investigated and if no conflict with design or soils recommendations is apparent, should be implemented, if the total cost of excavating, including the stripping quantity not usable for fill, the haul to the required fill area, and utility relocations is more economical than borrow from outside sources, and property is available.

(d) Frost Treatment

Frost heaving is caused by freezing temperatures acting upon frost-susceptible soils and free water below the subgrade. The combination of these factors results in the formation of frost lenses, which, by expanding upward, cause substantial and costly damage to the pavement structure. Frost heave damage is particularly severe on roads in the northern part of the Province. Frost heave treatment is applied in areas specified by the geotechnical staff on the project and is done according to OPSD standard or as recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. All frost-susceptible material is excavated to the lengths, widths and depths recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project. Such excavations are backfilled with acceptable material and compacted. Frost heave areas must be given drainage treatment by means of deepening ditches, if possible, or by installing subdrains or French drains. It is important to ensure drainage is provided to an adequate outlet so ponding in the excavated area does not occur. Where the provision of drainage is very costly, the geotechnical staff on the project should be consulted for possible alternative treatments not requiring a drainage outlet. Approval of management staff in the Planning and Design Section is required when a drainage outlet is recommended to not be provided. The treatment of frost heaves using extruded expanded polystyrene is discussed in Section B316 of this Chapter.

Page 177: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 17 of 32 B206-1

(e) Earth Excavation Below Subgrade

In some cases, the geotechnical staff on the project will recommend excavating below subgrade where there are pockets of unsuitable soil. The depths to be excavated will usually not be uniform.

The illustrations in Figs. B206-1-1 and B206-1-2 are examples of additional excavation required below subgrade. The upper hatched area indicates the granular base courses, while the lower hatched area indicates the additional excavation below subgrade, which is may be backfilled with earth or granular material as stipulated in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. Note: In Fig. B206-1-1 where it states “Regional Geotechnical Section”, read

this to mean; “in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report”.

Page 178: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 18 of 32 B206-1

Page 179: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 19 of 32 B206-1

C. Earth Excavation for Ditching and Watercourse Correction

(a) Ditching Any excavation required to construct an open drainage course is defined as ditching, and is subject to the following conditions:

i. the excavation is outside the limits of the theoretical roadway cross-

section, or ii. the excavation is within the limits of the theoretical section, but

outside the point of intersection of the subgrade and the side slope; and the point of intersection is above original ground (see Fig. B206-1-3).

Generally, 50% of the estimated quantity for ditching is considered available for fill when balancing quantities. This percentage is subject to change depending on the recommendations of the geotechnical staff on the project.

Ditches of the following types are usually constructed:

side ditches interceptor ditches intake and offtake ditches

Note: The designer should review the design earth ditching cross-sections

and, where the intersection of the theoretical earth ditch backslope intersects the original ground surface at an elevation equal to or above the edge of subgrade elevation, then this excavation should be documented as earth cut, (see Fig, B206-1-3A. The left ditch is shown as earth cut and the right ditch is shown as ditching), for the following reasons:

i. earth ditching and earth cut require different excavation methods and equipment, which will affect a contractors bid.

Page 180: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 20 of 32 B206-1

ii. earth ditching is considered 50% available for fill.

(b) Watercourse Correction

A watercourse correction is defined as an alteration to a natural watercourse, up to a culvert or apron face, if flowing through a culvert. Excavation within the limits of a culvert, and its aprons/end section is part of the work of other tender items and is paid for accordingly. The Hydrology Report will have information on the watercourse requirements for the computation of quantities and the incorporation of the final design into the contract drawings. The use of excavated material depends on the material properties. Usually, the excavated material is used for filling-in the old streambed, and a note to that effect placed on the contract drawings. Illustrations Fig. B206-1-4 & B206-1-4A show typical plan, profile and section of a proposed watercourse correction, as they appear on the contract drawings.

Page 181: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 21 of 32 B206-1

D. Swamps and Compressible Soils

This section should be read in conjunction with Section B209 Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils. Refer to Section B209 for fill design and computation information for embankments in swamp excavation locations.

Page 182: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 22 of 32 B206-1

The Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report will contain specific excavation, backfill and embankment material recommendations to be used for each swamp. OPSDs show typical swamp excavation and backfill sections and they should be reviewed with the excavation and backfill recommendations. (a) Swamp Removal by Excavation Method

Swamp excavation is completed either as an Earth Excavation, Grading tender item, or as an hourly rental tender item under OPSS 209. Recommendations for the design and construction of embankments over swamps and compressible soils/soft ground are contained in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. These reports typically contain site-specific investigations and recommendations including a description of the behaviour and properties of the soil in the swamp, method of construction, borehole locations, and soil strata drawings. The above reports will recommend how the excavation is to be completed. It will identify swamps for excavation using an Earth Excavation, Grading tender item with a volume (m³) unit-of-measure, and excavation using Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment item(s) with a time (hour) unit-of-measure. Different swamps can vary widely in depth, consistency, and groundwater conditions. However, the following general guidelines can be provided:

i. Where depth is less than or equal to 2m, swamps are usually administered by the Earth Excavation, Grading item, regardless of material consistency, however Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report should confirm.

ii. Where depth is greater than 2m, a recommendation on the excavation

method and item(s) to be used will be provided in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

Excavation depth may vary across a swamp. A founding elevation for the embankment backfill and a practical excavation cut geometry is normally part of the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. The report will also address the stability and settlement characteristics of excavated material and its suitability for subsequent use.

Page 183: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 23 of 32 B206-1

When a surcharge is to be used, refer to Section B209 for design and computation information. In highway reconstruction, other than specifying excavation on the widened portion of the embankment, the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report may recommend excavation of the existing embankment (in whole or part) and the underlying material. In such cases, the cross-sectional area of the embankment is measured separately from that of the swamp excavation and is considered available for fill purposes. The limit of embankment excavation is the surface joining the toes of existing embankment slopes. Both the adjacent and underlying swamp materials are excavated, either by an hourly rental tender item under OPSS 209, or by cubic measurement with the item Earth Excavation, Grading, with the material considered not available for fill. The bottom limits of swamp excavation must be shown on the contract profiles, as described in Section 206-1.9 Documentation.

(b) Swamp Removal by Displacement Method

Refer to Section B209 for fill design and computation information. (c) Swamp Removal by Floatation Method

Refer to Section B209 for fill design and computation information.

(d) Swamp Excavation for Culverts

Swamp excavation for placing culverts is considered part of the item Earth Excavation, Grading, and is included in the main swamp excavation quantity.

If the culvert is being placed in a swamp displacement area, any excavation required to place the culvert is calculated as culvert excavation under the other items.

E. Rock Surcharges, Existing Rock Fills and Rock Stockpiles

Excavation of existing rock surcharges, existing rock fills and rock stockpiles is done under the item Earth Excavation, Grading when the rock material is smaller than 1.0 m³.

206-1.8.7 Utilization Excavated Materials

Based on the recommendations of the geotechnical staff on the project, indicate in the calculations, which cut materials are suitable and available for embankment construction, and those, which are marginal or unsuitable for embankment

Page 184: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 24 of 32 B206-1

construction. Materials not recommended for roadway embankment construction are either incorporated into the work within the right-of-way, other than in designed roadway embankments, or disposed of outside the right-of-way. The use of the excavated rock material from rock surcharges, existing rock fills and rock stockpiles is determined based on the project needs. When the rock material is to be used in embankment construction, it is used under the item Rock Embankment, and therefore is not available as earth fill. (a) Embankment Construction (Earth Fill)

Earth fill is excavated earth material that is placed within the design section, from the bottom surface of the design up to the subgrade elevation. In estimating fill quantities, where displacement or settlement is anticipated, an allowance should be made for the material needed to compensate for these occurrences. (1) Combination Fills (Rock and Earth) that are not Composite Earth and Rock

Fills

Combination earth and rock fills are rare and not done as a matter of the usual design practice, but are sometimes done to use the material available. Ministry geotechnical staff is to be involved in the decision to use combination fills. Embankments may consist of both earth and rock materials in varying proportions. Earth fill should not be placed over rock fill due to the risk of future distortion due to earth moving into rock voids. Also the materials should be placed full width i.e., no longitudinal transitions between earth and rock. Transverse transitions are to be as per OPSD. When earth is the predominant grading material, the earth fill section standard is applied even though the project contains some rock material. Below is an example (fictional) calculation to show the process: volume of fill (based on earth fill section) 10 000 m³ less: available rock fill (includes bulking factor) 2 000 m³ earth fill volume 8 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 9 200 m³

Page 185: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 25 of 32 B206-1

When rock is the predominant grading material, the rock fill section standard is applied even though the project contains some earth excavation. The method of calculation is as follows: volume of fill (based on rock fill section) 10 000 m³ less: available rock fill (includes expansion factor) 9 000 m³ earth fill volume 1 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 1 150 m³ In these examples, note that in each case the total quantity of available rock material (major or minor) is utilized before computing earth fill requirements.

(2) Rock Fill (Boulders) In earth embankments where boulders from adjacent cuts are used for fill, quantities are adjusted. Below is an example (fictional) calculation to show the process: volume of fill 12 000 m³ less: rock fill (boulders)* 1 000 m³ earth fill volume 11 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 12 650 m³ *The rock bulking factor is not applied to boulders placed in fills.

(b) Stripping Backfill

In fill sections where stripping is required, an allowance equal to the depth of stripping, as recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report, must be made in order to fill the resultant voids. In sections where the profile grade is close to the original ground surface, analyze carefully the extent of stripping backfill since the area of stripping may, in part or totally; correspond to the area of the granular base and/or subbase.

(c) Stripping Backfill in Grubbing Areas

Where grubbing is required within embankment grading limits, an allowance, equal to the depth of stripping, of additional fill material must be provided to compensate for stripping.

Page 186: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 26 of 32 B206-1

(d) Backfill below Subgrade

Where the geotechnical staff on the project has recommended excavation of earth material from below the subgrade, the resultant voids must be backfilled with acceptable earth, rock or granular material.

(e) Frost Heave Backfill

Roadbeds excavated for frost heave treatment will be backfilled with granular material in accordance with Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings, as set out in Section B314 of this Chapter.

(f) Swamp Backfill (Earth)

Earth may be used as backfill to swamp excavation, if the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report states earth may be used as the swamp backfill material. Reports will contain specific excavation, backfill and embankment material recommendations to be used for each swamp. Any material that is outside of the theoretical neat lines for swamp excavation, that is expected to be excavated to obtain stable slopes, needs to be included in the fill requirements. This will be discussed in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. Where displacement of swamp is required, the fill in that area will consist of the actual embankment required for roadway construction plus the earth material required to effect the swamp displacement. The additional fill material is designated as Swamp Backfill (Earth), and is equal in volume to the displaced swamp material.

(g) Benching of Earth Slopes and Widening Existing Embankments

Where benching of earth slopes is required (in widening existing embankments), no measurement or payment will be made in respect of quantities excavated during this operation. Stripping, however, if required as a separate operation, will be measured and included for payment under the item Earth Excavation, Grading. Additional earth quantities will be computed as Stripping Backfill, but no quantities, cut or backfill, will be computed for benching. Existing embankment slopes should be benched as specified in the OPSDs. When widening existing embankments, the constructability of narrow widenings needs to be considered, and it may be necessary to design a wider embankment so that the embankment is constructable with safe access and it can be built and compacted with construction equipment.

Page 187: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 27 of 32 B206-1

(h) Use of Unsuitable Materials

Every effort should be made to incorporate all excavated material into the work. When unsuitable material is used for areas where an errant vehicle could travel, then the material must be able to support the vehicle. Areas within the right-of-way where marginal, unsuitable or swamp material may be utilized are:

i. Designing flatter slopes, beyond the minimum design requirements. This

improves the safety of the highway and may eliminate the need for guide rail.

Note: Drainage gaps must be provided when slope flattening rock or granular

embankments with poor draining material, in accordance with the appropriate OPSD. The drainage gap locations must be identified on the plans. The slope flattening limits and the volumes involved must also be shown on the plans.

ii. Designing berms - which may improve the aesthetics of the highway;

improve landscaping; shield drivers from roadside distractions, and provide noise and dust control.

(i) Optional Locations for Surplus Materials

Refer to the section 206-1.7.7.1 Surplus Materials for information on the use of surplus material in “optional” cross-sections, typical sections, and locations. Quantity calculations are required.

206-1.9 DOCUMENTATION

206-1.9.1 Contract Drawings

Drawings are to show the embankment dimensions, including shape, grades and limits. This is done with standard OPSDs, plans, profiles, cross-sections and typical drawings. Profiles show graphically information from the design cross-sections. Modifications to standard drawings and project typical sections may be required for the locations where material excavated is to be incorporated into the design, or used, or disposed of within the right-of-way. Modifications to standard drawings and project typical sections may be required for the locations where additional fill material must be placed after expected

Page 188: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 28 of 32 B206-1

displacement or settlement has occurred, to achieve the design profile and cross section. Material that is to be incorporated within the right-of-way must have its location shown on the plans. The notation “unsuitable, or swamp material’ should be used on the drawings, at locations where these materials are to be used, or may be disposed. To accommodate the surplus material within the project limits there should be “optional” cross-sections and typical sections or locations or both specified for such material. Where OPSDs do not reflect the project requirements, typical design cross-sections are to be included in the contract drawings. Typicals are usually required to reflect the project requirements. Typical cross sections are required for frost heave treatment areas (where the OPSD is not typical), and areas where excavation below subgrade is needed, showing the full extent of treatment necessary, including provision for drainage, where required. When OPSDs for Transition Treatments are used, values for “t” (transition treatment depth) and “d” (depth granular base and subbase) and “Do” (depth of organic, leached and accumulate layers) are included in the drawings. This is shown on the Profile drawings. When OPSDs for Frost Heave Treatments are used, values for “d” (depth of granular base and subbase) and “k” (depth of frost treatment below profile grade) are included in the drawings. This is shown on the Profile drawings, in a table, or typical sections. Plans are to clearly show the full extent of drainage improvements to achieve positive drainage of the subgrade for frost heaves. When flared guiderail terminations are required, show the location of the widened embankment. This may mean that interpolated cross-sections have to be inserted at the termination points. Existing fills that are excavated and that contain shatter, rock fill, and previously blasted rock, require the areas to be clearly defined in terms of location, depth, etc. in the drawings or in a NSSP. When a particular type of material is to be used at a specific location, that material must be identified on the drawings or in a NSSP. Swamp must be plotted on profile and treatment (by OPSD No., or typical section) indicated.

Page 189: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 29 of 32 B206-1

For swamp excavation locations, the profile drawings must indicate the elevation the swamp is to be excavated to. Include the following note for each swamp; - “Excavate to an Elevation of _______m”. For each swamp, the total quantity of embedment, settlement and construction loss for material below the waterline quantities is to be included in the special provisions or the contract drawings. Refer to Section B209 for additional information. Any excavations below subgrade must be shown on the profile sheets. The location of the drainage gaps should be indicated on the contract drawings by station and standard number.

Where excavated materials have disposal sites, the drawings are to show the disposal site design and generally are to indicate:

the area boundaries; maximum height; side slope angles; setbacks from sensitive areas; estimated capacity should be indicated on the contract drawings for each

disposal site; specify/label the sites for swamp material disposal (typically the sites closest to

swamp excavations); retaining embankment requirements; drainage requirements; environmental protection; and other information as required, such as but not limited to, temporary haul roads,

berms and other works required so that the disposal sites may be used. Soils Data sheets as part of the Contract Drawings and contain, when applicable:

title block (date(s) of investigation, name of firm, type of equipment used, and disclaimers);

soils borehole logs; soils and aggregates laboratory testing data; and other information as required.

206-1.9.1.1 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Quantity sheets are usually provided in 11X17 format. Information on Quantity sheets is contained in Chapter F of this manual. The quantities are documented on the “Quantities - Grading” sheet.

Page 190: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 30 of 32 B206-1

When stage construction is proposed, quantities must be documented for each separate stage. The quantities for the following locations are shown separately for 350 m intervals:

Highways Service Roads Ramps and Loops (when separate profiles are shown) Sideroads Detours

Separation of quantities may also be required for left and right sides where it will clarify the quantity information. This could apply to widening projects, reconstruction projects and other work as appropriate. The quantities for the following locations are shown for the total contract:

Entrances Sidewalk (isolated locations not part of grading section)

The quantities for the following components of Earth Excavation, Grading are shown separately in individual rows for each location:

Cut/Fill Stripping, (cut and fill stripping quantities need not be separated on Q-sheets;

only a single heading “Stripping” need be shown) Ditching/Sidewalk Swamp Frost Heaves (isolated locations not part of grading section) Watercourse Corrections Unusually large entrance quantities Other (specify: stockpiles, surcharges, etc.)

Totals for each component location are entered in columns designated for:

Earth Excavation, Grading Earth Available Earth Fill Required Optional Earth Fill

The Earth Available and Earth Fill Required may be separated into two uses:

Suitable Material available for use as fill within the designed embankment

slopes.

Page 191: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 31 of 32 B206-1

Surplus, unsuitable or swamp material is available for use as fill beyond the designed embankment slopes, unless otherwise recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project. Typical uses indicated in the quantity sheets are optional Slope Flattening and Earth Berms.

The totals of suitable earth quantities resulting from the work of culverts, structures, etc. are transferred from their respective quantity sheets to the quantity grading sheets as materials available for fill when the quantities are significant. Rock material from rock surcharges, existing rock fills and rock stockpiles excavated under the item Earth Excavation, Grading that is to be used to construct rock embankments under the item Rock Embankment must have its location and quantity shown, and it must be indicated that the rock material is to be used for the item Rock Embankment. Material that is in the design to be incorporated inside the right-of-way must have its location and quantity shown on the quantity sheet. Material that is “optional” for use inside the right-of-way must have its location and quantity shown on the quantity sheet. The location, extent, and quantity of unsuitable material below subgrade, other than swamps, to be removed are to be documented. Where there is a shortage of material available for the fill required, the “Earth Borrow” item entry must be completed on the quantity sheet for each stage of the project (see Section B212). The total quantity of stripping available, for topsoil, for the project is transferred to the stripping breakdown in the bottom left hand corner of the quantity sheet. The top soil required and the stripping balance are calculated and recorded. The Earth Excavation, Grading column is totalled and the quantity is transferred to the Tender documentation. All other columns on the quantity sheets are totalled and the tender item box is crossed out as they are non-tender item quantities.

206-1.9.2 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Write project and item specific requirements in a NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that require a NSSP are:

Changes to the earth layer compaction method.

Page 192: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH GRADING

April 2014 Page 32 of 32 B206-1

Where alternative materials are required or allowed in embankment construction (e.g. expanded polystyrene, wood chips, bark or granular blast furnace slag).

Areas where larger or interlocking materials, such as but not limited to boulders, rock, etc., are not to be used in the embankment or fills (i.e. where there are future structures or other areas where these materials are not to be placed).

Existing fills that are excavated and that contain shatter, rock fill, and previously blasted rock, should have the areas clearly defined in terms of location, depth, etc. in a the drawings or in a NSSP.

The maximum limit of open excavation allowed adjacent to the travelled roadway, when the normal contract provisions will not suffice. Restrictions may be needed for stability of the existing roadway.

Excavation and embankment fill restrictions.

Embankment construction requirements that influence the use of designated disposal areas.

Disposal site requirements.

For each swamp, the total quantity of embedment, settlement and construction loss for material below the waterline quantities is to be included in the special provisions or the contract drawings. Refer to Section B209 for additional information.

When a particular type of material is to be used at a specific location, that material must be identified on the drawings or in a NSSP.

Staged embankment construction requirements over compressible soil.

When a material is stockpiled for use on a future job the details are to be provided including how hauling and placement is paid.

Restrictions on use of excavated swamp material.

Detour and staging requirements.

Environmental considerations.

206-1.9.2.1 Operational Constraint for Mandatory Construction Sequence

The sequence of excavation and embankment construction must be such that disposal areas that are specified will be available when the associated material is excavated. A NSSP may be required to establish a mandatory construction sequence to ensure the specified disposal areas are available when the associated material is excavated.

206-1.9.3 Documentation Accuracy All quantities are rounded to whole numbers.

Page 193: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 1 of 27 B206-2

B206-2 - ROCK GRADING - OPSS.PROV 206 206-2.1 GENERAL

This section deals with the excavation, haulage, placement, compaction, and management of rock material, as defined by OPSS.PROV 206. This section should be read in conjunction with Section B206-1 - Earth Grading, as the computation methods, balancing of quantities and documentation apply to both. Rock excavation in roadway cuts, including detours, utilizes a method called “wall-control blasting”, which is a precise method of rock blasting that minimizes the overbreak of rock produced by standard blasting techniques, leaving a rock face / rock surface, as specified. The savings realized in the reduction of rock quantities offset the additional costs of precision blasting, while safety conditions are improved by the elimination of irregular walls of jagged rock. Wall-control blasting is administered under the item Rock Face, which applies in rock cuts. Earth material overlying rock formations is termed earth overburden and treated as earth. Weathered rock may be classified as earth. Geotechnical staff on the project should be providing recommendations on when weathered rock is to be classified as earth and this is usually identified in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report and shown on the Soils Profile. On projects where there is rock blasting adjacent to existing pavement, which is not planned for removal or resurfacing, it has been found that, irrespective of the type of protection employed, damage to the pavement usually resulted. Therefore, where widening of rock cuts with a height of 1.5 m or more above the roadway surface is required adjacent to existing pavement as noted above, an allowance for the resurfacing of that area of the highway exposed to falling rock is required to be included in pavement items. See Section B313 for details.

206-2.1.1 Classification of Rock Materials

The following materials, when encountered during grading operations, usually are treated as rock, and are included in the item Rock Excavation, Grading: A. Solid Rock Solid rock means natural beds of hard, cemented parts of the earth's crust

(igneous, metamorphic or sedimentary in origin), which may or may not be

Page 194: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 2 of 27 B206-2

weathered; the weathered material may be highly or only moderately weathered, but the key is that it has not been moved from its natural bed; as identified in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report and shown on the Soils Profile.

B. Boulders and Fragmented Rock Boulders and fragmented rock measuring 1.0 m³ or larger. C. Shatter Shatter is the fracturing of solid rock within the road section by the use of

explosives, to form a suitable foundation to receive the granular base course, and to provide drainage of the roadbed.

206-2.2 REFERENCES

Commercial Access Manual Design Criteria - project specific Drainage Management Manual Environmental Assessment Report (various names) - project specific Foundation Investigation and Design Report - project specific Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways Geotechnical Report - project specific Highway Design Bulletin 2010-001, Providing Digital Information to Contract,

Special Provision SP 199F61 Hydrology Report - project specific Pavement Design Report - project specific Preliminary Design Report - project specific Recommended Practice For Establishing Rock Elevation For New Highway

Construction, MERO-030 Soils Profile - project specific Survey Information - project specific

206-2.3 TENDER ITEMS

Rock Excavation, Grading Rock Face Rock Supply Rock Embankment

Page 195: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 3 of 27 B206-2

206-2.3.1 Other Tender Items with Rock Excavation Rock excavation for the following is not carried out under the item Rock Excavation, Grading, but under separate items and governing OPS Specifications: Culverts Sewers, Manholes, Catchbasins, Ditch Inlets Subdrains Structures

These items are detailed elsewhere in this Chapter.

206-2.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work are contained in:

OPSS.PROV 206 Grading OPSS 209 Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils OPSS 316 Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Frost Heave Treatment OPSS 351 Concrete Sidewalk

206-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions. As of the publication date of this CDED section, special provisions are required: 1. When shale is excavated with the item Rock Excavation, Grading. The bulking

factor for shale and other factors are required to be stated for shale. 2. Amendment to OPSS 206 for Material For Rock Embankment. Always with

OPSS.PROV 206, November 2013.

206-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the OPSD 200 series. To establish the physical limits on which to base quantities, a familiarity with applicable standard drawings is required.

Page 196: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 4 of 27 B206-2

It may be required to develop typical sections or modify existing standard drawings for specific situations, such as, but not limited to: Sideroad Intersections Commercial Entrances Private Entrances Design of Open Channels

In addition, review of the following manuals should be done, where appropriate:

Commercial Access Manual Drainage Management Manual Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways

206-2.7 DESIGN A. Rock Excavation, Grading This item includes material from the following operations:

Rock Cut and Shatter (integral with roadway section) - roadway - side ditches - transition points - sidewalks - widening - entrances - frost heaves - excavation below subgrade

Ditching - interceptor - intake/offtake

Boulders and Fragmented Rock, 1.0 m³ or larger Watercourse Correction Frost Heaves, isolated Sidewalks, isolated Entrances

B. Rock Face

This item applies to those excavations that are part of the final roadway, whether highway, side road, entrance, detour, etc.

Page 197: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 5 of 27 B206-2

C. Rock Supply This item is used to provide rock materials if there is insufficient rock materials for the rock embankments and/or to compensate the contractor if the contractual rock surplus quantity is not realized. The item Rock Supply is always used when the contract has either the item Rock Excavation, Grading or the item Rock Embankment item. The item Rock Supply is required even when there is a rock surplus on the project.

D. Rock Embankment

This item is for the construction of rock embankments.

206-2.7.1 Source of Information

A. Design Criteria

The Design Criteria represents a statement of the application of ministry policy and design standards for a project. The Design Criteria is a concise form for describing the geometric elements and standards that form the basis for the design of a new facility or improvements to an existing facility and the extent of the work to be completed on any project.

B. Survey Information

Survey information is obtained using various methods and technologies depending upon the needs and requirements of each project.

Available Survey Information will aid in the design and may include field notes, data, cross-sections, horizontal and vertical alignments, and plans.

Field notes are produced by survey crews and provide details of existing surface features on the main roadway, sideroads and entrances, and data.

C. Soils Profile

The Soils Profile, when available, shows the existing ground line, proposed vertical alignment, existing drainage data, and relevant soils data.

Page 198: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 6 of 27 B206-2

D. Reports

A number of reports contain data needed to establish cross-sections upon which cut and embankment (fill) quantities will be based. These reports are:

Environmental Assessment Report (various names) Foundation Investigation and Design Report Geotechnical Report Hydrology Report Pavement Design Report Preliminary Design Report

E. Field Review A comprehensive field review at the start of the design phase, with plans to record

observations and notes, is invaluable to understand the work and design required.

A field review to verify the design should be carried out near the end of the design process.

206-2.7.2 Establishing the Rock Surface

Establishing the rock surface is essential to accurate earth and rock quantity estimates. The survey information, soils information and borehole data is used to establish the rock surface. The final interpretation should be reviewed with the geotechnical staff on the project. Information that can assist in establishing the rock surface is in The Recommended Practice For Establishing Rock Elevation For New Highway Construction, MERO-030.

206-2.7.3 Rock Grading Cut Section Options

The Rock Grading OPSDs show two options for the rock cut section from the bottom of the ditch to the top of cut. Typically, the vertical option is used. However, there are situations, such as high rock cuts, for uniformity, or to generate additional rock excavation quantity, where the sloped option is used. A project could have different options used at different locations. For high rock cuts, the standard design cross-section may need to be modified to mitigate for rock falls. For additional information, consult with the Pavements and Foundation Section, Materials Engineering and Research Office (MERO), the Pavement and Foundations Section (MERO), and the Geotechnical Section in the region.

Page 199: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 7 of 27 B206-2

Grading in shale has project specific requirements that are usually in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report.

206-2.7.4 Composite Earth and Rock Fills

A composite earth and rock fill embankment has an earth core and a rock shell. Embankment fills are typically either earth fill or rock fill. Circumstances may require consideration of a composite earth and rock embankment fill. These circumstances include:

1. Insufficient quantities of earth or rock fill. 2. Haulage distance. 3. Environmental.

Design guidelines for composite earth and rock fill embankments are available from the Pavements and Foundations Section, MERO.

206-2.7.5 Rock Materials from Surcharges, Stockpiles and Existing Rock Embankments Rock material (smaller than 1.0 m³) from surcharges, stockpiles, and existing rock embankments, that is excavated under the item Earth Excavation, Grading may be used in embankment construction. The use of the excavated rock material is determined based on the project needs. When the rock material is to be used in embankment construction, it is used under the item Rock Embankment.

206-2.7.6 Management of Excavated Materials Rock excavated from roadway cuts and bulked shatter is used in roadway embankments. Rock excavated from other sites such as drains, ditches and channels, when required and feasible, is used in roadway embankments. Guide rail may be eliminated by the use of slope flattening. Slopes behind guide rail may be flattened, even when the guide rail will still be required.

206-2.7.6.1 Surplus Materials A rock surplus quantity is an entitlement of the contractor and the responsibility of the contractor to manage. Contractors may rely on this quantity for production of granulars and other uses.

Page 200: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 8 of 27 B206-2

Potential uses of surplus rock by the contractor should be considered when optimizing or balancing quantities for rock excavation and rock embankment. When there is material quantity that is not used in the design, then the material is surplus. To accommodate the surplus material within the project limits, when feasible, there should be “optional” cross-sections and typical sections or locations or both provided for use of surplus material. The quantity that can be accommodated at each location is to be provided. Note that “optional” locations may not have material placed there, and such are not to be used for locations where construction is mandatory, such as but not limited to, locations where guide rail has been eliminated from the design with slope flattening. Whenever possible, use/disposal locations for surplus materials should be identified within the project limits. When this is not feasible, then potential locations within the highway right-of-way and not within the project limits can be used (i.e. slope flattening, interchange locations, etc.). This would cause the project limits to be changed.

206-2.7.6.2 Ownership of Designated Disposal Locations

Property designated as a disposal location for excavated material must be owned by MTO, or MTO must have a legal agreement in place. MTO ownership is preferred.

206-2.7.7 Information to be Provided to Bidders

The following document contains the requirements for the digital and data information and hard copy information to be provided to all contractors: Highway Design Bulletin 2010-001, Providing Digital Information to

Contractors, Special Provision SP 199F61 Notes: 1) Soils Data sheets as part of the Contract Drawings. 2) Do not provide a Mass Haul Diagram to bidders.

206-2.8 COMPUTATION

In computing rock quantities, for cut and embankment (fill), subtotal the figures every 350 m along the highway; and on service roads, sideroads, detours, ramps and entrances, where the length justifies such a breakdown. Each subtotal will constitute a single-line entry on the Quantity Sheets.

Page 201: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 9 of 27 B206-2

Separation of quantities may be required for left and right sides of a widening project. Drawings and cross-sections are used to establish the physical limits on which to base quantities. The determining the quantity of rock available for use, calculate the volume by taking the bulked item Rock Excavation, Grading quantity, and adding rock quantities from boulders, and rock from other items.

206-2.8.1 Stage Construction When stage construction is proposed, quantities must be determined for each separate stage, as material excavated in one stage may not necessarily be available for embankment/fill purposes in a later stage. In order to obtain accurate rock quantities the quantity calculations and quantity sheets must be prepared for each stage of the contract. After the initial determination of quantities for each stage, an analysis to determine a more cost effective staging strategy and other design changes is to be done when material is not balancing for each stage. Several iterations may be required to determine the most cost effective and best design for the project.

206-2.8.2 Bulking Factors The volume of in situ rock expands when it is excavated, placed, and compacted due to voids when using broken rock material in roadway embankments or as backfill. Computed rock quantities need to be adjusted to compensate for expansion by using a “bulking factor” that is applied to the in situ volume to determine the volume of rock after expansion. The bulking factors to be used in the calculations are stated in OPSS.PROV 206. For projects that have shale, the bulking factor is to be obtained from the Regional Geotechnical Section and is to be specified in the Contract Documents. This includes the situation when the factor is 1.0. When a project has shale and also other rock, the bulking calculations are done separately, when the bulking factors are different. The quantity of shatter computed is subject to the same bulking factor as rock cut. However, the volume of shatter material that is available consists of the expanded portion only, since the remaining volume of shatter is left in place in the roadbed. Therefore the factor stated is 0.35 instead of 1.35.

Page 202: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 10 of 27 B206-2

A bulking factor is not applied to the estimated quantity for: boulders, rock from surcharges, rock from existing rock fills, and rock from stockpiles.

206-2.8.3 Methods of Calculation

Grading quantities are usually determined with electronic computation. However, in instances of small minor areas, it may be efficient and appropriate to use manual methods. The use of manual calculations to determine quantities is to be approved by Ministry management staff in the Planning and Design Section. Excavation quantities are to be determined using the average end area method, except for intersections, roundabouts, parking lots, and other similar locations where other methods achieve better quantity estimates. Computer applications have many methods of calculating volumes and therefore it is important to ensure that the desired method is selected. The current version of the computer application in use with the Ministry for highway design is to be used for the design and determining grading quantities, when electronic computation is to be completed.

206-2.8.4 Cross Sections

The interval of cross-sections may vary depending upon the work and roughness of the terrain, up to the usual maximum interval. Closer intervals should be used for tight curves. Usual cross-section minimum intervals between sections are: 25 m, plus break points, for earth, rock embankment (fill), swamp, and borrow

areas 10 m, plus break points, for rock cut areas 20 m, plus break points, for possible rock areas

Cross-sections normally are plotted at a scale of 1:100 both horizontally and vertically.

Page 203: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 11 of 27 B206-2

The following details should be incorporated in the cross-section from input data: Original Ground Rock Surface Design Section including,

- top of pavement - top of granular - subgrade - grading limits - ditching limits - stripping limits - frost treatments - transition point treatment - shatter - swamp excavation limits - any other excavation below subgrade - optional construction sections, when optional areas for disposal of surplus

material are provided (this will require separate quantities to be determined and documented)

In addition the cross-section will include: cross-section station number offset distances and elevation for profile grade elevation offset distances and elevations for original ground surface

206-2.8.5 Mass Haul Diagram

Mass Haul diagrams are to be prepared for all major grading contracts. Mass Haul diagrams are to consider the stages of the project, including physical and environmental restrictions during the stages. A Mass Haul Diagram serves as a guide in the appraisal of moving materials and balancing quantities. The comparison of the availability and usage of the excavation quantities provides guidance as to the feasibility and economy of a grading project. When analyzing a mass haul diagram for rock excavation and embankment consider the possible use of rock materials for aggregate production and other similar uses. After analyzing the diagram, revisions to the set grades or other solutions may be required. Should a grade revision be required, it is necessary to amend the cross-sections accordingly, recalculate the pertinent grading quantities and revise the Mass Haul Diagram.

Page 204: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 12 of 27 B206-2

206-2.8.6 Rock Excavation, Grading This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is the cubic metre. The Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity must be determined for each stage of the work.

206-2.8.6.1 Components of Rock Excavation, Grading

A. Rock Cut for Roadways, Interchanges, Detours, Sideroads and Entrances

Rock cut is material classified as rock as per OPSS.PROV 206, and which is excavated from the rock surface down to the top of shatter (i.e. bottom of granular sub-base), as outlined in the theoretical section applicable to a particular project. Quantities are computed separately for roadways, interchanges, detours, etc., and subtotalled at 350 m intervals. Excavated rock is a fully usable material for embankment construction and backfilling. The total volume computed is considered available for use.

(a) Widening of Existing Roadbed

In order to maintain traffic during stage construction, cut sections may require widening beyond the limits set in the standards. Where widening to maintain traffic is necessary, it should be considered as a detour and the appropriate quantities should be included in the tender.

(b) Excavation for Widening in Cuts to Achieve a Project or Stage Balance In order to achieve a balance of cut and fill requirements for a grading contract when grade adjustment is not feasible, widening of cut sections beyond the limits set in the standards, or excavating within interchange loops, medians or similar operations are acceptable alternatives. When widening a rock cut to increase the rock excavation quantity and obtain rock for use, the entire length of the rock cut is to be widened a uniform width. The widening of a rock cut may lengthen the rock cut to reach the zero rock location. It is much more cost effective to widen deep cuts to achieve balance than to widen a series of small cuts, and it also enhances rock fall mitigation.

Page 205: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 13 of 27 B206-2

These possibilities should always be investigated and, if no conflict with design or soils recommendations is apparent, should be implemented, if the total cost of excavating, including the stripping quantity not usable for fill, the haul to the required fill area, and utility relocations is more economical than using the item Rock Supply and property is available.

B. Shatter

In a rock cut section, to provide drainage, the top 0.3 m of rock subgrade is shattered, since trapped water can cause poor pavement performance. To prevent such damage the top 0.3 m of rock grade is “shattered” and the resultant rock fragments left in place to a depth of 0.3 m to provide rock “matting” that will hold any granular materials placed. The bulked portion is excavated. Shatter is not required in a shale subgrade. It may be necessary to shatter deeper than 0.3 m in order to facilitate drainage of the pavement structure as shown in Fig. B206-2-1. Where this is the case, the total depth of shatter must be shown on the drawings. All shatter shown on the drawings, regardless of depth, is computed at full volume. Shatter quantities are subtotalled at the same breakdown intervals as those for rock cut quantities.

C. Frost Treatment Frost heaving is caused by freezing temperatures acting upon frost-susceptible soils and free water below the subgrade. The combination of these factors results in the formation of frost lenses, which, by expanding upward, cause substantial and costly damage to the pavement structure. Frost heave damage is particularly severe on roads in the northern part of the Province. Frost heave treatment is applied in areas specified by the geotechnical staff on the project and is done according to OPSD standard or as recommended in the Geotechnical Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report. Frost heaving of the roadbed may result from earth and water trapped in hollows formed between knobs of rock at shallow depths. Treatment to provide drainage may include rock shatter below subgrade, as shown in Fig. B206-2-2. Frost heave areas must be given drainage treatment by means of deepening ditches, if possible, or by installing subdrains or French drains. It is important to ensure drainage is provided to an adequate outlet so ponding in the excavated area

Page 206: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 14 of 27 B206-2

does not occur. Where the provision of drainage is very costly, the geotechnical staff on the project should be consulted for possible alternative treatments not requiring a drainage outlet. Approval of management staff in the Planning and Design Section is required when a drainage outlet is recommended to not be provided. To prevent future frost heaves, rock excavation to remove rock knobs below the subgrade may be required, usually to a specified depth, to eliminate potential pockets of frost susceptible earth between rock knobs and to provide good drainage.

D. Rock Excavation for Intake/Offtake Ditching and Water Course Correction (a) Intake/Offtake Ditching

Ditching in rock, other than side ditches in cut sections, usually means intake/offtake ditching at culvert locations. Interceptor ditches are not required on rock surfaces, except if they are a continuation of other ditches. Fig. B206-2-3 illustrates the cross section of a typical intake/offtake ditch in rock. The quantity of ditching is calculated from cross sections using depths from a set ditch profile. The material obtained from rock ditching is available for embankment construction. Shatter is not required for intake/offtake and interceptor ditching through rock.

(b) Watercourse Correction A watercourse correction is defined as an alteration to a natural watercourse, up to a culvert or apron face, if flowing through a culvert. Excavation within the limits of a culvert, and its aprons/end section is part of the work of other tender items and is paid for accordingly. The Hydrology Report will have information on the watercourse requirements for the computation of quantities and the incorporation of the final design into the contract drawings.

The excavated rock material resulting from watercourse correction although generally accepted as available for fill, is rarely used to fill in the old watercourse; it is more commonly used for embankment construction.

Page 207: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 15 of 27 B206-2

E. Boulders and Fragmented Rock, 1.0 m³ or larger Boulders and fragmented rock measuring 1.0 m³ or larger within earth excavation is regarded as rock and is not included in the earth quantities.

The geotechnical staff on the project, based on field investigations, may include in their report findings an evaluation of boulders (those measuring 1.0 m³ or larger) existing in some cuts. Because of the difficulty in determining their volume, a percentage factor to be used for calculation purposes may be recommended. After computing the volume of excavation based on an earth cut section, the following procedure should be implemented; Below is an example (fictional) calculation to show the process: Volume of Earth Cut section 10 000 m³ Less: Volume of Boulders (assuming 10% recommended by geotechnical staff on the project) 1 000 m³ Earth Cut available quantity 9 000 m³ The rock quantity from boulders will be 1 000 m³. The bulking factor is not applied to this quantity.

Page 208: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 16 of 27 B206-2

Page 209: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 17 of 27 B206-2

206-2.8.7 Rock Face

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is the square metre.

Rock Face is the surface area in square metres of the rock faces in each rock cut area. The vertical limits of the rock face are top of rock (rock surface) to the designated rock or ditch grade surface. Rock Face quantities are computed for each rock face, left and right sides separately, and are separate entries on the Quantity Sheets. At sideroads and entrances, the rock face will follow the flare to the end of the individual rock face. For rock cuts that are benched, the Rock Face item applies to all vertically oriented surfaces but not to the horizontally oriented surface. The Rock Face item is required when previous rock cuts are widened. The Rock Face item does not apply to slopes in shale. Areas of Rock Face are not computed for ditching. Areas of Rock Face are not computed for watercourse correction.

206-2.8.8 Rock Supply

This item is not a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is the cubic metre. The item quantity for Rock Supply shall be the larger of: 1.15 x (Rock Embankment item quantity - (Rock Excavation, Grading item

quantity x bulking factor)) Note: Not applicable if a negative number, or

10% of Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity, or

15% of Rock Embankment item quantity, or

300 cubic metres, or

1.15 x (total of the rock shortage quantities for each stage added together)

The staging of a project must be considered in the determination of the Rock Supply quantity.

Page 210: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 18 of 27 B206-2

In order to determine the Rock Supply quantity for the contract, a “rock shortage” quantity must be determined for each stage of the project. Rock that is not required in an earlier stage is available for use in a later stage, when determining a “rock shortage” for a stage. The calculated rock shortage quantities for each stage are not included in the Quantity Sheets however they are used in the calculation of the Rock Supply item quantity.

Sample Rock Supply Quantity Calculation (example fictional project) Rock shortage quantity for each stage = A - B - C. Where:

A = Rock Embankment item quantity, for the stage.

B = Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity x (times) bulking factor, for the stage.

C = Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity x (times) bulking factor, for previous stage(s) - (minus) the required Rock Embankment item quantity for the previous stage(s). Zero (0) if negative, as no material available from previous stages(s).

For a stage, when the quantity is a negative number there is no rock shortage for the

stage.

Stage 1 Stage 2 Stage 3 Project Total

A = Rock Embankment item quantity, for the stage. 2000 5000 2000 9000

B = Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity x (times) bulking factor, for the stage. 3000 2000 4000 9000

C = Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity x (times) bulking factor, for previous stage(s) - (minus) required Rock Embankment item quantity for the previous stage(s).

0 1000 0 N/A

Rock shortage quantity for the stage = A-B-C. Zero (0) if negative, as no material available from previous stages(s).

0 2000 0

Rock available for next stage(s). 1000 0 Rock surplus available to contractor. 0 0 2000 2000

Page 211: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 19 of 27 B206-2

Rock Supply quantity is the greater of: 1.15 x (Rock Embankment item quantity - (Rock Excavation, Grading item

quantity x bulking factor)) = 1.15 x (9,000-9,000) = 0

10% of Rock Excavation, Grading item quantity = 0.10 x 9,000 = 900

15% of Rock Embankment item quantity = 0.15 x 9,000 = 1,350

300 cubic metres = 300

1.15 x (total of the rock shortage quantities for each stage added together) = 1.15 x 2,000 = 2,300

Thus, the Rock Supply item quantity is 2,300 cubic metres. The project looks like a balanced job (A - B = 9000 - 9000 = 0). But in fact, there will be a rock surplus for the job of 2000 and rock excavated in stage 3 is not available for construction in stages 1 and 2. There is a rock shortage of 2000 in stage 2.

206-2.8.9 Rock Embankment

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is the cubic metre. The Rock Embankment item quantity is to be determined for each stage of the work. For additional information, refer to Section B209 for fill design and computation for embankments in swamp excavation locations. The work of compaction is included in the item and does not require any computation.

206-2.8.10 Utilization Excavated Materials

A. Embankments Construction (Rock Embankment)

Rock Embankment is the placing of rock material within the design section from the bottom surface of the design up to the subgrade elevation. Rock Embankment uses rock material from cuts, shatter (bulked amount), ditching watercourse corrections in rock, and other sources and includes boulders, all of which is placed in the embankment to the cross section of the applicable rock embankment design. Rock material may be placed in areas of swamp

Page 212: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 20 of 27 B206-2

backfill or any other area recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project, however, it is designated, calculated and detailed as “Rock Embankment”.

(a) Combination Fills (Rock and Earth) that are not Composite Earth and Rock Fills

Combination earth and rock fills are rare and not done as a matter of the usual design practice, but are sometimes done to use the material available. Ministry geotechnical staff is to be involved in the decision to use combination fills.

Embankments may consist of both earth and rock materials in varying proportions.

Earth fill should not be placed over rock fill due to the risk of future distortion due to earth moving into rock voids. Also the materials should be placed full width i.e., no longitudinal transitions between earth and rock. Transverse transitions are to be as per OPSD.

When earth is the predominant grading material, the earth fill section standard is applied even though the location contains some rock material.

Below is an example (fictional) calculation to show the process:

volume of fill (based on earth fill section) 10 000 m³ less: available rock fill (includes bulking factor) 2 000 m³ earth fill volume 8 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 9 200 m³

When rock is the predominant grading material, the rock fill section standard is applied even though the location contains some earth excavation. The method of calculation is as follows:

volume of fill (based on rock fill section) 10 000 m³ less: available rock fill (includes expansion factor) 9 000 m³ earth fill volume 1 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 1 150 m³

In these examples, note that in each case the total quantity of available rock material (major or minor) is utilized before computing earth fill requirements.

(b) Rock Fill (Boulders)

In earth embankments where boulders from adjacent cuts are used for fill, quantities are adjusted.

Page 213: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 21 of 27 B206-2

Below is an example (fictional) calculation to show the process: volume of fill 12 000 m³ less: rock fill (boulders)* 1 000 m³ earth fill volume 11 000 m³ earth fill required (assuming a 15% volume adjustment factor) 12 650 m³ *The rock bulking factor is not applied to boulders placed in fills. Boulders, cobbles, and fragments of rock and reclaimed materials should not be used or disposed of in areas where pile driving for future structures is envisaged. These materials and others can result in piles being “hung up” within this material and not reaching the designed tip elevations. Contract documents should demarcate areas where this option is prohibited i.e. those areas where structures are planned in the future.

B. Swamp Backfill (Rock) Rock may be used as backfill to swamp excavation. Geotechnical

Report/Pavement Design Report/Foundation Investigation and Design Report will contain specific excavation, backfill and embankment material recommendations to be used for each swamp.

Refer to Section B209 Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils for fill design and computation information.

C. Structure Backfill (Rock) Concrete structures may be backfilled with rock. When granular material is not

readily available, in order to reduce high granular costs, or to achieve consistency in the highway embankment construction, rock available for fill may be used as backfill material. Before opting for rock backfill, a cost comparison must be completed to determine the selection of the more economical alternative.

The structural staff on the project is to be involved in the decision of determining the selected structure backfill material.

D. Drainage Gap in Rock Embankments When surplus or unsuitable material is designated for flattening rock

embankments, gaps in the flattening material must be provided at the low point for cross drainage and at other strategic locations according to the OPSD standard.

Neglecting to provide drainage gaps may result in embankment failure due to

hydrostatic pressure or frost action.

Page 214: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 22 of 27 B206-2

The location of the drainage gaps should be indicated on the contract drawings by

station and standard number. E. Frost Heave Backfill Roadbeds excavated for frost heave treatment will be backfilled with granular

material in accordance with Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings, as set out in Section B314 of this Chapter.

F. Optional Locations for Surplus Materials

Refer to the section 206-2.7.5.1 Surplus Materials, for information on the use of surplus material in “optional” cross-sections, typical sections, and locations. Quantity calculations are required.

206-2.9 DOCUMENTATION 206-2.9.1 Contract Drawings Drawings are to show the embankment dimensions, including shape, grades and

limits. This is done with standard OPSDs, plans, profiles, cross-sections and typical drawings. Profiles show graphically information from the design cross-sections.

Modifications to standard drawings and project typical sections may be required for

the locations where material excavated is to be incorporated into the design, or used, or disposed of within the right-of-way.

Modifications to standard drawings and project typical sections may be required for the locations where additional fill material must be placed after expected displacement or settlement has occurred, to achieve the design profile and cross section. Material that is to be incorporated within the right-of-way must have its location shown on the plans. To accommodate the surplus material within the project limits there should be “optional” cross-sections and typical sections or locations or both specified for such material.

Where OPSDs do not reflect the project requirements typical design cross-sections are to be included in the contract drawings. Typicals are usually required to reflect the project requirements.

Page 215: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 23 of 27 B206-2

The elevations of solid rock formations must be plotted on cross sections and contract profiles. When extensive side cut occurs throughout a project, a typical section should be shown on the drawings. Typical cross sections are required for frost heave treatment areas (where the OPSD is not typical), and areas where excavation below subgrade is needed, showing the full extent of treatment necessary, including provision for drainage, where required.

When OPSDs for Transition Treatments are used, values for “t” (transition treatment depth) and “d” (depth granular base and subbase) and “Do” (depth of organic, leached and accumulate layers) are included in the drawings. This is shown on the Profile drawings. When OPSDs for Frost Heave Treatments are used, values for “d” (depth of granular base and subbase) and “k” (depth of frost treatment below profile grade) are included in the drawings. This is shown on the Profile drawings, in a table, or typical sections. Plans are to clearly show the full extent of drainage improvements to achieve positive drainage of the subgrade for frost heaves. When flared guiderail terminations are required, show the location of the widened embankment. This may mean that interpolated cross-sections have to be inserted at the termination points. When a particular type of material is to be used at a specific location, that material must be identified on the drawings or in a NSSP. Swamp must be plotted on profile and treatment (by OPSD No., or typical section) indicated. For each swamp, the total quantity of embedment, settlement and construction loss for material below the waterline quantities is to be included in the special provisions or the contract drawings. Refer to Section B209 for additional information. Any excavations below subgrade must be shown on the profile sheets. The location of the drainage gaps should be indicated on the contract drawings by station and standard number. When excavated materials have disposal sites, refer to Section B206-1 for required information.

Page 216: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 24 of 27 B206-2

Soils Data sheets as part of the Contract Drawings and contain, when applicable: title block (date(s) of investigation, name of firm, type of equipment used, and

disclaimers); soils borehole logs; soils and aggregates laboratory testing data; and other information as required.

206-2.9.1.1 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Quantity sheets are usually provided in 11X17 format. Information on Quantity sheets is contained in Chapter F of this manual. For the items: Rock Excavation, Grading Rock Embankment

These items have the quantities documented on the “Quantities - Grading” sheet. When stage construction is proposed, quantities must be documented for each separate stage. The quantities for the following locations are shown separately for 350 m intervals:

Highways Service Roads Ramps and Loops (when separate profiles are shown) Sideroads Detours

Separation of quantities may also be required for left and right sides where it will clarify the quantity information. This could apply to widening projects, reconstruction projects and other work as appropriate.

For the item Rock Face:

The item Rock Face has the quantities documented on the “Quantities - Miscellaneous” sheet. Rock Face entries, are shown for, each rock face, left and right sides separately, and are not subject to the 350 m breakdown. When there are only a few entries, Rock Face is shown on the “Quantities - Grading” sheet, within each 350 m breakdown.

Page 217: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 25 of 27 B206-2

For the item Rock Supply:

The item Rock Supply has the quantities documented on the “Quantities - Grading” sheet. Rock Supply is shown as a single entry as “Throughout Contract”. The quantities for Rock Excavation, Grading, Rock Embankment and Rock Face for the following locations are shown for the total contract:

Entrances Sidewalk (isolated locations not part of grading section)

The quantities for the following components of Rock Excavation, Grading are shown separately in individual rows for each location:

Cut Ditching/Sidewalk Swamp Frost Heaves (isolated locations not part of grading section) Watercourse Corrections Unusually large entrance quantities Shatter

Totals for each component location are entered in columns designated for:

Rock Excavation, Grading Rock Face Rock Supply Rock Embankment Rock From Boulders Rock From Other Items Optional Rock Fill

Rock required for structure backfill shall be identified as “Rock Backfill to Structure”, with a separate entry for each structure under the column for the item “Rock Embankment”. The totals of excavation quantities resulting from the work of culverts, structures, etc., that are to be used for the work under the item Rock Embankment, are transferred from their respective item quantity sheets to the quantity grading sheets and shown as materials for use when the quantities are significant. This is shown in the column for “Rock from Other Items”. Excavated rock material from rock fills, rock surcharges and rock stockpiles, that are to be used for work under the item Rock Embankment, are transferred from their

Page 218: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 26 of 27 B206-2

respective item quantity sheets to the quantity grading sheets and shown are shown in the column for “Rock from Other Items”.

The total computed volume of boulders (Rock) must be shown as a separate entry under the column for “Rock From Boulders”. Material that is in the design to be incorporated inside the right-of-way must have its location and quantity shown on the quantity sheet. Material that is “optional” for use inside the right-of-way must have its location and quantity shown on the quantity sheet. The item columns are totalled and the quantity for each item is transferred to the Tender documentation. All other columns on the quantity sheets are totalled and the tender item box is crossed out as they are non-tender item quantities.

206-2.9.2 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Write project and item specific requirements in a NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that require a NSSP are: Rock dumping locations permitted, when it is allowed.

Rock backfill to structures gradation or sizing, when rock to be used as structure backfill is a different gradation or size than stated in OPSS.PROV 206.07.06.

Areas where larger or interlocking materials, such as but not limited to boulders, rock, etc., are not to be used in the embankment or fills (i.e. where there are future structures or other areas where these materials are not to be placed).

The maximum limit of open excavation allowed adjacent to the travelled roadway, when the normal contract provisions will not suffice. Restrictions may be needed for stability of the existing roadway.

Excavation and embankment fill restrictions.

Embankment construction requirements that influence the use of designated disposal areas.

Disposal site requirements.

For each swamp, the total quantity of embedment, settlement and construction loss for material below the waterline quantities is to be included in the special provisions or the contract drawings. Refer to Section B209 for additional information.

Page 219: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCK GRADING

January 2014 Page 27 of 27 B206-2

When a particular type of material is to be used at a specific location, that material must be identified on the drawings or in a NSSP.

Staged embankment construction requirements over compressible soil.

When a material is stockpiled for use on a future job the details are to be provided including how hauling and placement is paid, and rock size restrictions.

Any work by a specialized person to be done regarding rock cuts after they have been excavated. Discuss the need with the ministry Geotechnical Section.

Detour and staging requirements.

Environmental considerations.

206-1.9.2.2 Operational Constraint for Mandatory Construction Sequence The sequence of excavation and embankment construction must be such that disposal

areas that are specified will be available when the associated material is excavated. A NSSP may be required to establish a mandatory construction sequence to ensure

the specified disposal areas are available when the associated material is excavated. 206-2.9.3 Documentation Accuracy

All quantities are rounded to whole numbers.

Page 220: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 221: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION FOR PAVEMENT WIDENING

January 2014 Page 1 of 3 B206-3

B206-3 - EXCAVATION FOR PAVEMENT WIDENING - OPSS.PROV 206 206-3.1 GENERAL

The item Excavation for Pavement Widening is used, when a long, narrow width of pavement widening, involving excavation, is required and cross-sectional measurement in the field would be impractical. This item could apply also to greater widths where excavation is required for the placing of pavement only (i.e. typically 0.23 m maximum depth), on an existing gravel shoulder and field measurement would be impractical. Excavation for Pavement Widening applies only to the main roadway. Excavation for construction of tapers, acceleration and deceleration lanes, and associated excavation for granular is be considered part of the general grading operation, and thus is under section B206-1 - Earth Grading, and section B206-2 - Rock Grading.

206-3.2 REFERENCES

Design Criteria - project specific Environmental Assessment Report (various names) - project specific Pavement Design Report - project specific

206-3.3 TENDER ITEMS

Excavation for Pavement Widening

206-3.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work are contained in OPSS.PROV 206 Grading.

206-3.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions.

206-3.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the OPSD 200 series.

Page 222: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION FOR PAVEMENT WIDENING

January 2014 Page 2 of 3 B206-3

It may be required to modify existing standard drawings for specific situations. 206-3.7 DESIGN

The Design Criteria represents a statement of the application of ministry policy and design standards for a project. The Design Criteria is a concise form for describing the geometric elements and standards that form the basis for the design of a new facility or improvements to an existing facility and the extent of the work to be completed on any project. The Environmental Assessment Report (various names) will discuss any environmental matters that need to be addressed in the project design and documents. The Pavement Design Report will contain information on the design of the pavement structure and the excavation depth required for the pavement widening. The specification for this item states that excavated material is to be spread on the adjacent shoulders and slopes. It is important to confirm that the adjacent shoulders and slopes can physically accommodate the excavated material, and that from an environmental perspective it is acceptable to place the material in those locations. When the excavated material is not to be spread on the adjacent shoulders and slopes, then the management of excavated material should be determined during design and specified in the Contract Documents, as it is best practice to not default to a Change in the Work during construction. This will also require a modification to the specification. The item does not include removal of existing pavement. The pavement widening could require the removal of a narrow width of asphalt (partial paved shoulder or deteriorated asphalt edge) and excavation of granular material. The removal of the existing asphalt can be done by a separate item or included in the Excavation for Pavement Widening item. This will need to be decided on a project by project basis. A NSSP is required if pavement removal is to be included in the item Excavation for Pavement Widening, and it must include the disposal requirements for the removed pavement.

206-3.8 COMPUTATION

Excavation for Pavement Widening is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is in linear measure in metres, along each edge of the existing pavement where widening is required. The measurement may be from field measurement or drawings.

Page 223: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION FOR PAVEMENT WIDENING

January 2014 Page 3 of 3 B206-3

The locations are determined and recorded by station to station, and left or right of centerline.

206-3.9 DOCUMENTATION

206-3.9.1 Contract Drawings A drawing showing a typical section is required defining the existing and new pavement widths, pavement structure, asphalt removal (if applicable), and excavation widths and depths.

206-3.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

The quantity is documented on the “Quantities - Miscellaneous 1” sheet. Locations are done on a station to station and left or right of centreline. A separate line is required for each location of excavation. The item total is transferred to the Tender document.

206-3.9.3 Documentation Accuracy

Stations and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number metre. 206-3.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Write project and item specific requirements in a NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that require a NSSP are: The maximum limits, for length and depth, of open excavation allowed adjacent to

the travelled roadway, where there is concern for potential drop-off beside travelled lanes or stability of the existing roadway.

Disposal of excavated material requirements, when the material is not to be spread on the adjacent shoulders and slopes.

Environmental requirements.

When the work is to include removal of existing pavement, this will need to be included in the work. The disposal of the existing pavement must be stated.

Page 224: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 225: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

B209 - EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS - OPSS 209

209.1 GENERAL

Embankments over swamps and compressible soils/soft ground can be designed with one or a combination of the following alternatives:

1. Excavation Method

2. Floatation Method

3. Displacement Method

Trucking of excavated swamp material is not included in work for the Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment items. The trucking cost is paid with equipment rental items on an hourly basis under CDED B299-1, Rental of Equipment.

209.1.1 Excavation Method

Excavation method means to remove the swamp material mechanically.

The excavation method is the most commonly used because it minimizes the risk of post construction embankment settlement. Excavation is most often used for shallower depths of swamp; however it is also used for deep swamps when appropriate. Backfill to the excavated swamp is usually by the items Rock Embankment, Select Subgrade Material or Granular B.

209.1.2 Floatation Method

Floatation method means to build the embankment directly on the swamp minimizing the displacement of the swamp material.

Floatation methods include use of wick drains, lightweight fill materials such as expanded polystyrene, slag and lightweight cementitious materials, geotexiles, other materials to aid in floatation and/or preloading or surcharging to promote consolidation of soils.

Floatation methods are most commonly used where swamp depths exceed 6 metres and suitable soil conditions exist. The application of wick drains with preloading or surcharging may offer environmental, cost and embankment performance advantages.

209.1.3 Displacement Method

Displacement method means to build the embankment directly on the swamp such that the underlying swamp material is displaced away from the embankment fill.

March 2012 Pg. 1 of 19 B209

Page 226: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

The displacement method is a higher risk option because some of the compressible material may not be displaced and hence becomes “trapped” beneath the embankment. This may cause post construction settlement. The decision to use this method must consider the effects of post construction settlements and the impacts to highway surface due to settlements. In cost estimates, the cost to repair settled areas in the years after initial construction needs to be considered.

A variation of the displacement method involves partial excavation and then displacement of remaining material. This combination method is sometimes used in deeper swamps.

The displacement method is rarely used in modern highway construction.

209.1.4 Use of Surcharges

Surcharges may be used to help minimize post construction settlements. A decision to use surcharges is made on a site specific basis.

A surcharge may be required by the foundation design.

A surcharge may be used when the swamp excavation depth exceeds 6 metres as it is difficult to ensure all soft material has been removed and a surcharge helps reduce or eliminate most post construction settlements that may occur do to soft material that has been left, despite all efforts to remove it. In this case, the foundation design may not theoretically require a surcharge but it is done to enhance the long term performance of the roadway and can be achieved at minimal cost.

209.2 REFERENCES

OPSS 201 OPSS 206 OPSS 1010

Foundation Investigation and Design Report – project specific.Pavement Design Report – project specific.

The above reports typically include a description of the behaviour and properties of the soil in the swamp, provides recommendations for the method of construction, units of measurement for payment, borehole locations and soil strata drawings.

The determination of which report is appropriate for a specific site is determined collectively by the Pavements and Foundation Section, Materials Engineering and Research Office (MERO) and the Geotechnical Section in the region.

These reports are referred to as “Design Reports” hereafter in this document.

March 2012 Pg. 2 of 19 B209

Page 227: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.3 TENDER ITEMS

Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Dragline (variation item) Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Hydraulic Backhoe (variation item) Geotextile for Swamp Treatment Select Subgrade Material Select Subgrade Material (End Area Method) Select Subgrade Material (Truck Box Method)

209.4 SPECIFICATIONS

OPSS 209 (April 2009); Construction Specification for Embankments Over Swamps and Compressible Soils

209.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

209.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the OPSD 200 series.

Notes:

1. OPSDs are only valid for where the depth of the swamp, d <= 6 metres.

2. For any swamp excavation exceeding 6 metres in depth, project specific recommendations and applicable drawings are required. Refer to the Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

209.7 DESIGN

Recommendations for the design and construction of embankments over swamps and compressible soils/soft ground are contained in the Design Reports. The Design Reports typically contain site-specific investigations and recommendations.

The project schedule may allow for a delay in the completion of the full pavement structure over embankments for a defined period of time (i.e. 2 to 6 months or longer)

March 2012 Pg. 3 of 19 B209

Page 228: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

capturing primary consolidation and limiting settlements once the remainder of pavement structure is placed.

When surcharges are used, the Contract Documents are to specify how the payment for the placement, removal and use of the surcharge material is to be paid. Surcharges are usually subsequently used on the project, however staging may preclude this.

The placement of a granular surcharge is done under the granular item(s) and a NSSP is needed to state this and that no compaction of the granular is required in the surcharge location. When the surcharge is granular, the subsequent surcharge removal and use of the granular elsewhere in the work must be described in a NSSP and is paid under the appropriate tender item, Granular from Stockpile (see OPSS 314).

209.7.1 Management of Excavated Swamp Material

The management of excavated swamp material must be determined and specified in the Contract Documents.

The Design Reports should address how the excavated swamp material may be used within the work, depending upon its physical characteristics. How the material will function over the long term should be considered before the material is determined to be used within the work.

Excavated swamp material that is excess may be disposed of at locations specified in the contract or the contractor may be required to arrange for the disposal locations.

Disposal of excess excavated swamp material within the Contract Limits can be the most cost effective option and should be investigated and considered.

Trucking of excavated swamp material is required when it cannot be placed adjacent to the excavation via side casting. Trucking of excavated swamp material is not part of the work done under OPSS 209.

The sequence of overall construction operations, including the swamp excavation and embankment construction, must be such that disposal areas that are specified will be available and accessible when the associated swamp is excavated.

Where excavated swamp material is suitable, it should be used as much as possible within the right-of-way, when property is available and when drainage is not impacted. This can be done by: � widening embankments, � flattening side slopes, including elimination of need for guide rail, however

consideration of stability for an errant vehicle must be made, � placing beside the highway embankment,

March 2012 Pg. 4 of 19 B209

Page 229: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

� constructing modified cross-sections, and � used for berms and at other locations.

Future settlement or sloughing of excavated swamp material is a key consideration when flattening slopes and only suitable material is to be used. Settlement or sloughing is to be avoided in providing a traversable roadside for errant vehicles.

Considerations for use and disposal locations for excavated swamp material:

1. The quantity of material that can be placed at a location needs to be determined. Factors to consider include material characteristic (maximum stable slope of excavated material, will the material flow) and area.

2. Disposal sites must be able to accept 110% of the quantity of material that is stated to go to the site. The extra 10% is not to be shown in the contract documents.

3. Property designated as a disposal location must be owned by MTO, or MTO must have a legal agreement in place. MTO ownership is preferred.

4. Where excavated material will be placed beside the excavation or beside the highway embankment, it is a requirement to have ownership of the land as highway right-of-way. With the disposal locations made part of the highway right-of-way and having the disposal part of the required work, the protocols for management of excess material should apply. In many instances, it will be necessary to acquire a wider right-of-way as part of the property needs for the project. This may involve purchasing from a private owner or acquiring crown land. It is recommended for MTO to own the adjacent crown lands as highway right-of-way, instead of obtaining permission to place the material on crown lands adjacent to the right-of-way, as this resolves any uncertainty about who controls the land.

5. The capability of underlying soils to support a new load and not fail to support the load.

6. Where any excavated material from any source is being considered for placement near any swamp or compressible soil areas, the Pavements and Foundations Section/Geotechnical Section must agree to the location, as the material weight could cause embankment instability.

7. Access to the disposal locations.

8. Any required haul and temporary roads for access to disposal locations and construction operation sequencing.

9. Double handling of material.

March 2012 Pg. 5 of 19 B209

Page 230: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

10. Dewatering and draining of disposal locations required before they can be used.

11. Retaining embankments needed to contain the material.

12. Impacts on drainage during and post construction.

13. Environmental considerations (i.e. excess material protocols, species at risk, etc.).

When disposal locations require retaining embankments and/or haul and temporary roads to be built, these are to be designed and quantities paid for under the appropriate items. They are not to be included in the swamp excavation items.

209.7.2 Backfill and Embankment Material

Backfill and embankment material is to be specified in the Contract Documents.

The Design Reports identify the backfill and embankment material to be used for each swamp.

Backfilling and embankment construction is in accordance with OPSS 206. References: CDED B206-1, CDED B206-2.

When Select Subgrade Material is used in backfilling swamp excavation it shall be according to OPSS 1010 and shall be placed according to OPSS 206.

209.7.3 Settlement and Embedment in the Embankment Underlying Founding Stratum

Settlement and embedment prediction is not an exact science. In general, if the founding soils are relatively competent, over-consolidated and unyielding, only negligible settlements or elastic recompression of the native soils will occur during construction. These cases form the vast majority of the embankments constructed, and do not require any further estimation for settlement or embedment. However, where the founding soils are weak or unconsolidated, there will be a need to estimate settlement and embedment in the founding material.

In cases of weak or unconsolidated founding material, a settlement and embedment quantity estimate for the founding material must be determined during detail design. The settlement estimate will reflect the project specific founding material, thickness and compressibility characteristics.

209.7.4 Excavation Method

Excavation can be administered as either an earth excavation (grading) tender item or as an hourly rental tender item.

March 2012 Pg. 6 of 19 B209

Page 231: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

In wetter deposits, where measurement by volume would be impractical, the swamp excavation is accomplished using hourly rental dragline or hydraulic backhoe equipment.

The Design Reports will recommend how the excavation is to be completed. It will identify swamps for excavation using an Earth Excavation tender item with a volume (m3) unit-of-measure, and excavation using Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment item(s) with a time (hour) unit-of-measure.

Different swamps can vary widely in depth, consistency, and groundwater conditions. However, the following general guidelines can be provided:

1. Where depth is less than or equal to 2m, swamps are usually administered by the Earth Excavation item, regardless of material consistency, however Design Reports should confirm.

2. Where depth is greater than 2m, a recommendation on the excavation method and item(s) to be used will be provided in the Design Reports.

Subsurface investigations conducted in accordance with the ministry engineering requirements provide a very comprehensive and accurate determination of the subsurface conditions. The investigation enables a specific expected depth of excavation to be determined and this gives accurate information for design purposes. Excavation depth may vary across a swamp.

A founding elevation for the embankment backfill and a practical excavation cut geometry is normally part of the Design Report. The Design Report will also address the stability and settlement characteristics of excavated material and its suitability for subsequent use.

Geotechnical/Foundation specialists are to ensure when specifying firm bottom that information supports the depths to firm bottom. Typically, firm bottom is the stratum for which the resistance measured by the Standard Penetration Test exceeds 100 blows per 0.3 m of penetration or the material that will provide resistance to settlement or instability for the proposed embankment.

209.7.4.1 Swamp Excavation by Equipment Rental

The work performed under the “Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment” tender items, includes the excavation of swamp material to the limits specified and its disposal as specified in the Contract Documents.

When excavated material cannot be side casted, the excavated material must be trucked to a disposal or re-use location and this must be specified in the Contract Documents. Payment for trucking of excavated swamp material is not included in work for the Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment tender items. The trucking cost

March 2012 Pg. 7 of 19 B209

Page 232: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

is paid with equipment rental tender items on an hourly basis. Reference: CDED B299-1 Rental of Equipment. The size and type of trucks to be used is dependant on the distance to distance to disposal locations. Typical trucks are tandem 18,000 kg and triaxle 32,000 kg. For longer hauls triaxle trucks are more efficient.

The equipment, including type and size, used to excavate the swamp is to be determined by the designer. The Estimating Section, Contract Management Office and Regional Operations Office should be contacted to assist in determining the type of equipment and rates of excavation. The Regional Geotechnical Section and Pavements and Foundations Section, MERO, can also provide information and advice.

For each excavation area, the selection of the appropriate excavation equipment and size is critical to ensuring the construction operation is efficient and cost effective.

The selection of equipment should also consider equipment availability and the amount of material to be excavated (i.e. duration of the operation).

As a guideline it has been found that: - For wet/soft material, a dragline with side casting is the most economical option. - When trucks are used to haul excavated material, a hydraulic backhoe is the most

cost effective and easiest to use.

Some swamps could require more than one type of equipment to have an efficient operation.- For example, a swamp could have depths that vary from a few metres to over 10

m. A backhoe would be used for the shallow depths and a dragline for the deeper areas.

- For example, a swamp could have ‘stiffer’ material near the edges and ‘softer’ material farther away from the edges. A backhoe would be used for the stiffer material and a dragline for the softer material.

Table 1 - Backhoe versus Dragline, compares some of the common equipment characteristics as they relate to the use of a hydraulic backhoe and the dragline in regards to swamp excavation. These characteristics are to be considered in the selection process for deciding on the type of equipment and size to be used to excavate the swamp material.

March 2012 Pg. 8 of 19 B209

Page 233: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

Table 1 – Backhoe versus Dragline

Features Hydraulic Backhoe Dragline

Ownership Commonly owned Few contractors own

Removal of Amorphous, Liquid Deposits

Not conducive to backhoe use Ideal for removal

Removal of stiff deposits Ideal , Low cycle times * High cycle times

Side casting ability Limited Reach ** Long Reach

Excavation Depth Limited Depth ** Depth is of no concern

Production Low cycle times * High cycle times

Truck Loading Ability Low cycle times but limited to height **

High cycle times

Restricted work environment (i.e.) Narrow Widening

Conducive to this type of equipment

Less efficient in restricted areas

Winter Operations Yes Yes

* Cycle time is the time for a complete excavation cycle, as determined by measuring the time from a bucket being empty to the time the next bucket of excavated material is emptied either by side casting or into a truck. Cycle time includes the time for trucks to manoeuvre into position for loading.

** Estimating Office should be consulted to determine achievable excavation depths, casting distances and loading heights for hydraulic backhoes.

The equipment must be capable of reaching the required depth of excavation (achievable excavation depth) when the slope of fill material and bucket rotation is taken into account.

The reach on a “long reach hydraulic backhoe” is the distance from the bottom of the tracks to the tip of the bucket teeth when measured vertically with the bucket at the lowest point of the bucket swing path. Note that this “reach” measurement is not the depth that can be excavated due to the slope of the fill material and the bucket rotation that causes the achievable excavation depth to be reduced. For example, a sample Long Reach Hydraulic Backhoe with a 14 m reach can only excavate to approximately 10.5 metres effectively when taking into account the 1.25H:1V slope of rock fill and the bucket rotation. The achievable excavation depth would be less for select subgrade material or earth that has a 2H:1V slope according to OPSDs.

Typical equipment configurations for excavating swamps are:

March 2012 Pg. 9 of 19 B209

Page 234: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

Typical Crawler Mounted Equipment Configurations for Excavating Swamps

Swamp Depth m

EquipmentMinimumOperating

Weight

MinimumBucket Size

m3

Side Casting Truck Loading

less than 2 m 26,500 kg hydraulic backhoe

1.5 yes yes

2 m to less than 8 m

26,500 kg hydraulic backhoe, 12 m reach

1.5 yes yes

8 m to less than 10 m

32,000 kg hydraulic backhoe, 14 m reach

1.0 yes yes

less than 6 m 40,000 kg dragline 1.15 yes yes

any depth 75,000 kg dragline 2.3 yes not used for truck loading

any depth 75,000 kg dragline 1.5 not used for side

casting yes

Notes:1. Hydraulic Backhoe Reach means the distance from the bottom of the tracks to the tip of the bucket

teeth when measured vertically with the bucket at the lowest point of the bucket swing path. 2. Reach measurement is not the depth that can be excavated due to the slope of the fill material and

the bucket rotation that causes the achievable excavation depth to be reduced.

Rates of excavation are influenced by the properties, behaviour and depth of the swamp material, the type and size of equipment, and whether the excavated material is trucked or managed beside the excavation (side-casted). Typical rates of excavation for the following types of equipment are: - 40,000 kg crawler mounted dragline with 1.15 m bucket – 40-55 cubic metres /

hour- 26,500 kg crawler mounted hydraulic backhoe with 1.5 m bucket – 85-100 cubic

metres / hour

Contact the Estimating Section, Contract Management Office, to discuss equipment configurations and excavation rates for the site specific conditions.

The contractor may propose to use larger equipment than that specified and if approved, during construction, the appropriate price adjustments are completed in accordance with the Contract Documents. Details of how this is done are in OPSS 209 and associated special provision.

March 2012 Pg. 10 of 19 B209

Page 235: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.7.4.2 Swamp Excavation by Earth Excavation (Grading)

The earth excavation method shall be carried out in accordance with OPSS 206 and the appropriate tender items. Refer to CDED Section B206-1 and the OPSD 200 series drawings for design information.

209.7.5 Floatation Method

Any surcharges that are used with the floatation method are removed as specified in the Contract Documents from above the subgrade.

With the floatation method any swamp waves are not to be excavated or otherwise disturbed.

209.7.5.1 Prefabricated Vertical Drains or Wick Drains

Prefabricated vertical drains or “wick drains” are commonly used in conjunction with preloading and surcharging to accelerate time rate consolidation settlements. The concept of floatation using wick drains is often very cost effective because it eliminates the requirement for excavation and backfilling of compressible soils. Peats and organics are routinely sub-excavated but the clayey silts, silty clays and clays are often left in place providing environmental advantages in addition to the cost effectiveness. Information on wick drains is available from Pavements and Foundations Section, MERO.

209.7.5.2 Geotextile for Swamp Treatment

Installation of geotextiles below embankments and over swamp materials separates fill materials or granulars from the underlying material. This will help to prevent cross-migration of soil particles and provide a stable road base and reduce differential settlement.

Geotextile recommendations are in the Design Reports and will include the following:

1. The strength of the fabric; - Woven or non-woven; - Class of fabric; - Thickness of material.

2. The Filtration Opening Size (FOS);

3. Type of soil to be protected; and

4. Depth and characteristics of underlying soil.

March 2012 Pg. 11 of 19 B209

Page 236: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

When geotextile is to be placed, the area where this is to be done is to be close cut cleared and cleared of objects that may damage the geotextile. The root mat is not to be damaged.

209.7.6 Displacement Method

With the displacement method there is usually excavation of swamp waves and displaced material, removal of surcharges and hauling and incorporating of this material into the work.

The Design Reports will recommend where and how the displacement method is to be completed. The report will include details of any surcharge requirements.

209.7.7 Other Related Work

Clearing and close cut clearing, where required, is to be completed in accordance with OPSS 201 and the associated tender items. Reference: CDED B201-1, B201-2.

209.8 COMPUTATION

209.8.1 Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Dragline Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Hydraulic Backhoe

These items are not Plan Quantity Payment items.

These items are paid by the hour.

To compute the hours (h) of rental excavation equipment time for each excavation location and type of equipment:

hours = estimated volume of swamp excavation (m3) rate of excavation (m3 /h) of the dragline or the hydraulic backhoe

The rate of excavation (m3/h) for each swamp is very important to estimating accurate quantities and hence an accurate cost estimate. Refer to Section 209.7.4.1.

To estimate volume of swamp excavation (m3), the volume of swamp excavation in cubic metres is computed as outlined in CDED Section B206-1-Earth Excavation (Grading) and also include any excavation of swamp material to ensure stable slopes, as in many swamps material will slide into the excavation and this must be accounted for in the volume of material to be removed, in order to have accurate time estimates for equipment rental.

The volume of swamp to be excavated by rental equipment is not included in the tender item “Earth Excavation (Grading)”.

March 2012 Pg. 12 of 19 B209

Page 237: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.8.1.2 Trucking Excavated Swamp Material

When trucking of excavated swamp material is required for the material excavated by Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment items, the trucking hours are required to be determined for the items under CDED B299-1 Rental of Equipment.

The number of trucks required must be sufficient so that there is always a truck available to be loaded. Factors to consider in determining the number of truck required are loading times, and round trip times from the excavation location to the dumping locations.

To compute the hours (h) for rental of truck for each excavation location and type of equipment:

hours (h) = number of hours for Rental of Swamp Equipment x number of trucks.

209.8.2 Earth Excavation (Grading)

Earth excavation is in cubic metres and is described in the CDED Section B206-1-Earth Excavation (Grading).

The volume of excavation in cubic metres is computed as outlined in Section B206-1.

209.8.3 Geotextile for Swamp Treatment

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

The unit of measure is by area, in place, in square metre, with no allowance for overlaps.

209.8.4 Select Subgrade Material

These items are not Plan Quantity Payment items.

The items and unit of measurement are: - Select Subgrade Material, t - Select Subgrade Material (End Area Method), m3

- Select Subgrade Material (Truck Box Method), m3

The preferred method of measurement is by the tonne. The m3 method may be used when the quantity is small and there is not a weigh scale on the project.

The volume of material is determined by considering the swamp excavation volume to be completed and the embankment design.

March 2012 Pg. 13 of 19 B209

Page 238: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.8.5 Embankment Quantities for Fill

Each fill material has its own unique quantity requirements that are dependent upon the material used.

For the each embankment fill item quantity, determine the quantity of material for backfill and embankment material by considering the following:

1. Neat lines of the embankment;

2. Embedment of fill material into the foundation material;

3. Settlement during construction in the underlying founding stratum;

4. Settlement during construction of fill material that is not compacted; and

5. Construction loss for material below the water line.

The Design Reports should have information about embedment and settlement during construction in the underlying founding stratum.

For each swamp, the total quantity for embedment, settlement and construction loss for material below the water line quantities is to be included in the contract documents in a special provision or the contract drawings. The table below provides a guideline for how to display the information.

Item: Fill Material: Embankment Fill Quantities for Embedment, Settlement, and

Construction Loss for Material Below the Water Line

Station to Station

Embedment of fill material into the foundation material, m3

Settlement during construction in the underlying founding stratum, m3

Settlement during construction of fill material that is not compacted, m3

Construction loss for material below the water line, m3

Total Quantity, m3

When completing the table: 1. Construction loss for material below the water line does not apply to all materials. Refer to the

construction specification for the material. 2. Total quantities are to be included in the appropriate fill material item.

March 2012 Pg. 14 of 19 B209

Page 239: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.9 DOCUMENTATION

209.9.1 Contract Drawings

Drawings are to show for each swamp the construction information for location, depth, cross-section and embankment material.

Modifications to standard drawings and project typical sections are required for the locations where material excavated from swamps is to be disposed of or used within the right-of-way.

When surcharges are used the drawings are to indicate: - surcharge material; - surcharge location; - surcharge thickness; and - cross-section including slopes.

Where excavated materials have disposal sites, the drawings are to show the disposal site design and generally are to indicate: - the area boundaries; - maximum height; - side slope angles; - setbacks from sensitive areas; - estimated capacity should be indicated on the contract drawings for each disposal

site (do not include the 10% extra allowance); - specify/label the sites for swamp material disposal closest to swamp excavations,

especially for hourly swamp excavation sites;- retaining embankment requirements; - drainage and dewatering requirements; - environmental protection; and - other information as required.

Drawings may be required for temporary haul roads, berms and other works required so that the disposal sites may be used.

209.9.1.1 Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Dragline Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Hydraulic Backhoe

Each area of swamp excavation is shown on the plan. Start and end chainage, maximum offset left and right and any other dimensions outlining the horizontal limits of the boundary are noted. This is labelled with the tender item name, and the OPSD number (if applicable).

When the depth of excavation exceeds 6 metres, a drawing showing the embankment construction requirement details is needed as OPSDs do not apply in this situation.

March 2012 Pg. 15 of 19 B209

Page 240: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

The limits of excavation must be clearly documented to avoid confusion with adjacent areas that may be excavated under other tender items. This is important to avoid double payment for the same work.

In most cases, the elevation of unyielding competent soil (firm bottom) can be predicted. This elevation should be determined during detail design and given on the drawings and on the highway design cross-sections.

Each area of swamp excavation is shown on the profile. Start and end chainage are noted. The profile shows the profile of the swamp excavation, including depth or bottom elevation, along the centerline. Where the elevations for the left and / or right limits of the excavation are different from the centreline elevation these should also be indicated. The locations of any preloading or surcharges are shown.

The profile drawings must indicate if the swamp is to be excavated to a firm bottom or a specific elevation. Include one of the following notes for each swamp; - “Excavate to Firm Bottom” - “Excavate to an Elevation of _______m”.

A note is to be added to the profile drawings for each location where a dragline or hydraulic backhoe operation is to be used, indicating that the swamp material is to be excavated with equipment rental and the type of backfill required. Include the following note for each swamp; - “Excavate Swamp by Rented Equipment and Backfill with __ (state the fill

material) __”.

209.9.1.2 Geotextile for Swamp Treatment

Each area of geotextile is shown on the plan. Start and end chainage, maximum offset left and right and any other dimensions outlining the horizontal limits are noted. This is labelled with the tender item name.

209.9.1.3 Select Subgrade Material

Each area of embankment construction using select subgrade material is shown on the plan. Start and end chainage, toe-of-slope left and right are noted. This is labelled with the tender item name and the applicable OPSD number.

Each area of embankment construction using select subgrade material is shown on the profile. Start and end chainage are noted. The profile shows the embankment, including bottom and top elevations, along the centerline.

March 2012 Pg. 16 of 19 B209

Page 241: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

209.9.2.1 Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Dragline Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment, Hydraulic Backhoe

For each area of swamp excavation show the following information on the Quantities-Miscellaneous Sheet: - type of equipment to be used, by selecting the appropriate tender item(s) - minimum operating weight of equipment and bucket size - tender quantity (hours) based on use of the specified equipment - start and end station limits of each area of swamp excavation - locations for the placement/disposal of swamp material and the quantity, m3, of

material to be placed at the location - when the contractor is required to truck the excavated material to a location found

by the contractor off the contract, enter the following: “Contractor to remove and manage excavated material off the right-of-way” and the quantity, m3, of material is also to be shown.

Where all of the above information cannot be accommodated on the quantity sheet some may be put in a NSSP or in a table in the Contract Drawings.

209.9.2.2 Geotextile for Swamp Treatment

Each area of Geotextile for Swamp Treatment installation is documented in one line of the Miscellaneous Quantities sheet. One column heading is the tender item. The start and end chainage are provided. The quantity in square metres is provided in the column.

Where multiple types of geotextile are required on one contract, this should be documented in the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet for each area of installation.

Specific requirements for geotextile should be documented for each different type of geotextile specified on the Quantity sheets.

Requirements include:- Woven or non-woven; - Class of fabric; - Filtration opening size (FOS); and - Thickness of material.

209.9.2.3 Select Subgrade Material

The unit of measure (tonne, m3 (end area method) or m3 (truck box method)) for select subgrade material is documented by selecting the appropriate tender item name.

When computed in m3, the quantity of Select Subgrade Material is entered on the Quantities - Grading sheet in a separate column.

March 2012 Pg. 17 of 19 B209

Page 242: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

When computed in tonnes, SSM is entered on the Quantities – Hot Mix and Granular sheet.

209.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Write any required project specific requirements in a NSSP. For example; - embankment construction requirements that influence disposal areas,- excavation restrictions, - backfilling requirements, - surcharge areas and surcharge requirements, - settlement monitoring, - time constraints before pavement is placed, - disposal site requirements, - restrictions on use of excavated swamp material, and - environmental considerations.

Where alternative materials are required or allowed in embankment construction (e. g. expanded polystyrene, wood chips, bark or granular blast furnace slag) this is documented in an NSSP.

209.9.3.1 Operational Constraint for Construction Sequence

The sequence of excavation and embankment construction must be such that disposal areas that are specified will be available when the associated swamp is excavated.

A NSSP may be required to establish a mandatory construction sequence to ensure the specified disposal areas are available when the associated swamp is excavated.

209.9.3.2 Surcharges

The removal of surcharges from above the subgrade or grade, depending upon the surcharge material, and hauling and incorporating of the surcharge material into the work is have the details specified in the Contract Documents.

When surcharges are used specify: - surcharge material; - surcharge thickness; - length of time and/or the condition to be met for surcharge removal; - if surcharge is to remain in place at end of the construction contract;- how removed surcharge materials are to be used;- how payment for surcharge material removal and reuse will be handled; and - any unique requirements related to the surcharge

March 2012 Pg. 18 of 19 B209

Page 243: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EMBANKMENTS OVER SWAMPS AND COMPRESSIBLE SOILS

209.9.4 Documentation Accuracy

All quantities are rounded to whole numbers.

209.9.5 Information to be Provided to Bidders

The following information is to be provided to Bidders: - Foundation Investigation Report (Note this is not the Foundation Investigation

and Design Report.). - Soils Data sheets as part of the Contract Drawings.

Soils Data sheets will contain, when applicable: - title block (date(s) of investigation, name of firm, type of equipment used, and

disclaimers), - soils borehole logs, - soils and aggregates laboratory testing data, and - other information as required for other work.

March 2012 Pg. 19 of 19 B209

Page 244: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 245: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH BORROW

January 2014 Page 1 of 3 B212

B212 - EARTH BORROW - OPSS.PROV 212 212.1 GENERAL

Earth materials taken from selected borrow pits and hauled to the contract site for embankment construction or backfilling are designated as “Earth Borrow”. The need for earth borrow occurs when the breakdown of item quantities indicates a difference in quantities between earth material available and fill required. Smaller differences might be eliminated by widening backslopes in cut sections or by revising the profile grade. With certain types of projects it will be evident in the planning stage, that insufficient fill material will be generated by the limited excavation opportunities and that a tender item for Earth Borrow will be required.

212.2 REFERENCES

Geotechnical Report - project specific Pavement Design Report - project specific Soils Profile - project specific

212.3 TENDER ITEMS

Earth Borrow

212.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work are contained in OPSS.PROV 212. 212.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions.

212.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings.

Page 246: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH BORROW

January 2014 Page 2 of 3 B212

212.7 DESIGN Locating borrow materials is the responsibility of the contractor, unless otherwise stated on a NSSP. Information on borrow sources and use of borrow materials could be included in the Geotechnical Report, Pavement Design Report, and Soils Profile.

212.8 COMPUTATION

This item is not a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure is the cubic metre. When stage construction is proposed, borrow quantities must be determined for each separate stage, as material excavated in one stage may not necessarily be available for fill purposes in a later stage. In order to obtain accurate quantities for material available, fill required, disposal, unsuitable, and borrow, both quantity calculation and quantity sheets must be prepared for each stage of the contract. The quantity of the required earth borrow in cubic metres is found by subtracting material available from fill required.

212.9 DOCUMENTATION

212.9.1 Contract Drawings The frost penetration depth must be specified and this is usually done on the Profile

drawings. 212.9.1.1 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

The quantity is detailed on the “Quantities - Grading” sheet. When stage construction is proposed, quantities must be documented for each separate stage.

The item total is transferred to the Tender document.

212.9.2 Documentation Accuracy Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number metre.

Page 247: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EARTH BORROW

January 2014 Page 3 of 3 B212

212.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Write project and item specific requirements in a NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that require a NSSP are: - When ministry owned sources of supply are provided, the details are required. - Any areas where frost-susceptible earth borrow material is not to be placed. - Any areas where stockpiling of earth borrow material is not permitted.

Page 248: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 249: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RENTAL OF EQUIPMENT

299-1 - RENTAL OF EQUIPMENT, OPSS 127

299-1.1 GENERAL

These tender items are used when the work cannot be adequately measured by the cross section method but is to be performed by motorized equipment on a rental basis. This principle, however, should be employed only with careful consideration. The equipment rental work shall not overlap work performed and paid for under another tender item. These tender items should not be used if such work can be made part of a grading item.

Equipment rental may be applied to the following work:

a) Grading existing roadways (no hauling of earth material is required).

b) Stripping of side slopes in areas of granular lifts at locations of minor widening.

c) Minor ditches - New or restoring existing ditches. d) Hauling material. e) Reshaping and excavating shoulders.

Work which cannot be sufficiently defined or is small in quantity may be included under Services (Sundry) or Force Account and Contingencies. (See Chapter "D" of this manual.).

299-1.1.1 Tender Items

Following are the current standard tender items.

Rental of Motor Grader - Rigid Frame, 4,500 kg. Minimum Operating Weight

Rental of Motor Grader - Rigid Frame, 10,500 kg. Minimum Operating Weight

Rental of Backhoe - Telescopic Boom Carrier Mounted, Remote Control, 18,000 kg. Minimum Operating Weight

Rental of Hydraulic Backhoe - Rubber tire with Wrist Action Bucket, 0.5 m3 - 12,000 kg.

Rental of Hydraulic Backhoe - Crawler Mounted, 20,000 kg. Minimum Operating Weight

Page 250: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RENTAL OF EQUIPMENT

Rental of Truck - Dump, Tandem Rear Axle, Diesel or Gas, 18,000 kg. Minimum Operating Weight

299-1.1.2 Specifications

The description of the equipment rental and rental rates are contained in OPSS 127

299-1.1.3 Special Provisions

The type of work to be performed under equipment rental is to be clearly defined in the special provision provided in Chapter "E" of the manual.

299-1.2 COMPUTATION

These Items are not Plan Quantity Payment items.

299-1.2.1 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for rental of equipment is measured in hours (h). The type of equipment to be used and the time required to perform the work are determined in consultation with the District Office and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

299-1.3 DOCUMENTATION

The station to station and the location of work to be performed by equipment rental is itemized on the Quantities 1 or 2 sheet. The number of hours for each location is not to be shown, however, the total number of hours is to be shown at the bottom of the Quantity Sheet. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the Tender document.

Stations and hours are recorded in whole numbers.

94 05 B299-1-2

Page 251: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DITCH CLEANOUT

April 2014 Page 1 of 4 B299-2

B299-2 - DITCH CLEANOUT - SSP 299F11 299-2.1 GENERAL

Construction activities frequently involve cleanout of existing earth and rock ditches. This is done to restore the flow characteristics intended when the ditches were originally constructed.

Ditch cleanout may be required in capital construction contracts when sediment has collected in ditches and is impeding stormwater runoff and/or the performance of the roadway.

Sediments, if not properly controlled, can be conveyed via runoff and channelized flow to impact sensitive receiving waters or other environmentally sensitive areas or features. Temporary erosion and sediment control measures are warranted on contracts that call for grading, drainage and other work that will disturb earth surfaces. Measures shall be employed to minimize erosion and to remove sediments from water flowing from the construction site. Administration of temporary erosion and sediment control measures is according to OPSS 805. Reference: CDED B805.

Stabilization of exposed soil surfaces is required after ditch cleanout operations to prevent erosion. Administration is according to OPSS 804 and/or OPSS 803. Reference: CDED B804 and B803.

299-2.1.1 Management of Excess Materials

Material removed from ditch cleanout may be impacted by salt from winter maintenance operations. It is desirable to manage these materials by reuse within the right-of-way to the greatest extent possible to reduce the generation of excess materials that must be managed outside the right-of-way.

The manner and location for management of materials from ditch cleanout within the contract limits and outside the right-of-way may be specified in the Contract Documents. Management of excess materials shall otherwise be according to OPSS 180.

299-2.2 REFERENCES

OPSS 206 OPSS 803 OPSS 804 OPSS 805

Page 252: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DITCH CLEANOUT

April 2014 Page 2 of 4 B299-2

MTO Best Management Practice: Ditch Maintenance Within 30 Metres of a Waterbody MTO/DFO/OMNR Fisheries Protocol for the Protection of Fish and Fish Habitat on Provincial Transportation Undertakings

299-2.3 TENDER ITEMS

Earth Ditch Cleanout Rock Ditch Cleanout

299-2.4 SPECIFICATIONS

None 299-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The requirements for Earth Ditch Cleanout and Rock Ditch Cleanout are contained in Standard Special Provision 299F11.

299-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

None 299-2.7 DESIGN

Ditches identified for cleanout are recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by MTO maintenance staff. Ditch cleanout is typically to a maximum depth of 0.5 m.

When the excavation will exceed 0.5 m or the ditch is to be excavated to a specified geometry, geodetic control is typically used and the work carried out according to OPSS 206 Earth Excavation, Grading. Note that excavations exceeding 0.5 m can have fore- and backslope stability, property, and utility impacts.

Where ditch cleanout is required in the vicinity of a waterbody it shall be assessed under the MTO/DFO/OMNR Fisheries Protocol. If the ditch is within 30 metres of a waterbody, a MTO Notification Form 1 referring to contract documentation including

Page 253: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DITCH CLEANOUT

April 2014 Page 3 of 4 B299-2

but not limited to SSP299F11, OPSS 805 and OPSS 804 as applicable shall be submitted in accordance with the MTO/DFO/OMNR Fisheries Protocol. At a minimum, temporary erosion and sediment control measures appropriate to the site conditions shall be selected for placement between the ditch cleanout location(s) and the receiving waterbody and 15 m further upgrade. Stabilization of exposed soil surfaces upon completion of ditch cleanout may be achieved as follows based on the site conditions:

1) On slopes 3H:1V or flatter specify a minimum thickness of 0.05 m of native

topsoil with local seed bank. Local seed bank means locally sourced soil material excavated (top 300mm)

from a donor site in the vicinity of a project that contains seeds and propagative materials for local species.

2) On slopes greater than 3H:1V use seed and bonded fibre matrix or seed and

biodegradable erosion control blanket, administered under OPSS 804.

3) On slopes of sensitive waterbodies or surfaces that may be subject to frequent wetting where there is a need to re-establish cover as quickly as possible, it may be appropriate to specify placement of sod, administered under OPSS 803.

299-2.8 COMPUTATION 299-2.8.1 Sources of Information

The main sources for information are field investigations, drainage plans, and fisheries and geotechnical staff on the project team.

299-2.8.2 Method of Calculation

Both Earth Ditch Cleanout and Rock Ditch Cleanout tender items are PQP. Lengths of ditch are measured in metres along the centreline of the ditch. Lengths may be scaled from the contract drawings or measured in the field.

299-2.9 DOCUMENTATION

Both tender items shall be recorded on the Quantities - Miscellaneous Sheets (see Chapter F). Each tender item requires a separate column. Lengths of ditch may be subdivided into segments in consideration of differing cross-sections or cleanout requirements. Each separate ditch segment should be entered in one line of the

Page 254: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DITCH CLEANOUT

April 2014 Page 4 of 4 B299-2

Q-sheet, including chainage and offset. Enter the total length of each segment of ditch to clean out. When the contract drawings include plan coverage, show the location of all ditches subject to cleanout under these tender items and all required temporary erosion and sediment control measures to be installed. For some locations, a separate drawing may be required to show sufficient detail. Include a note on plans to indicate exposed soil areas to be covered by sod, seed and cover or local seed bank material upon completion of ditch cleanout.

299-2.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded to the nearest metre. Offsets, if required, are recorded in 0.1 m. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest metre.

Page 255: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RESTORING UNPAVED ROADWAY SURFACES

301 - RESTORING UNPAVED ROADWAY SURFACES OPSS 301

301.1 GENERAL

The above work consists of loosening the roadway surface by blading or scarifying to a depth not exceeding 150 mm in order that the surface may be restored to the specified cross-section, profile and density. The material so gained in this operation is bladed to the low areas and any surplus disposed of. Materials to be disposed of shall not require loading, hauling or moving other than by blading. Imported materials, as required, will be calculated and included in the respective tender items. The cost of restoring roadway surfaces, built and restored under the same contract, is included in the unit price for the materials concerned. The item "Restoring Roadway Surfaces" will, therefore, be set up only for reshaping of surfaces built previously under another contract. Compaction of restored surfaces, with or without the use of imported materials, will not be estimated separately. Water for compaction will be included in the price bid for the appropriate tender items containing the material requiring compaction. When the contract does not include a separate tender item for dust suppression, then payment for water will be included in the price bid for the applicable tender items requiring dust control.

When the quantities to perform the work of Restoring Roadway Surfaces is undefinable then the work will be performed by Equipment Rental, as covered in Section B299-1 of this Manual.

301.1.1 Tender Item

Restoring Roadway Surfaces

301.1.2 Specifications

Information in regard to Restoring Unpaved Roadway Surfaces is contained in OPSS 301.

301.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

Standard Drawings

Applicable grading construction standards are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual in the 200 series.

96 05 B301-1

Page 256: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RESTORING UNPAVED ROADWAY SURFACES

301.2 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

301.2.1 Source of Information

Recommendations from the Regional Geotechnical Section, District Offices and Bituminous Section are the main source of information for this tender item.

301.2.2 Methods of Calculation

The unit of measurement of this tender item is square metre. The areas of surfaces to be restored are calculated for each location on the calculation sheets.

The surface widths of previously completed roadways to be restored are measured horizontally and computed as follows:

a) On Earth Sub-Grade or Granular Sub-Base surfaces the measurement is to be taken as the full surface width extending from slope to slope.

b) On Granular Base Surfaces, prior to placing asphalt pavement, the pavement including paved shoulders, when applicable plus 0.50 m on each side.

On Trans-Canada Highway projects, the width of restoring the surface of existing granular base prior to paving will be taken as the pavement width plus 1.5 m on each side.

301.3 DOCUMENTATION

Restoring Roadway Surfaces is not normally indicated in the contract plans and profiles.

The calculated quantities are transferred from the calculation sheets to the Quantities-Miscellaneous sheet of the contract drawings. Entries should be made for each area (station to station) where this work is to be carried out.

The entries are totalled. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the Tender document.

Documentation Accuracy

Stations and Quantities are recorded in whole numbers.

96 05 B301-2

Page 257: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SURFACE TREATMENT

304 - SURFACE TREATMENTS - OPSS 304

304.1 GENERAL

For economic reasons, roadways having low traffic volumes will often be selected for double surface treatment or prime and surface treatment in place of Hot Mix paving. Primed and surface treated roads are not as strong structurally as hot mix pavements.

The decision to use surface treatment is not based entirely on traffic AADT, but on many factors such as axle loading, surface type continuity, etc.

This work is carried out either as a separate contract or under the grading contract by means of tender items or funds provided under Services (Sundry Construction). See Chapter "D" of this manual.

The preferred length of projects for surface treatment is 10 km or greater.

A follow-up surface treatment application of treated roads may take place several years after the surface treatment has been applied.

304.1.1 Types of Surface Treatments

The following applications are available depending on traffic volumes, status of road and type of road surface.

a) Single Surface Treatment.

This type of surface treatment is to be applied to either a primed road, a roadway with a previous applied surface treatment or a paved roadway.

The work consists of a single application of binder followed by a single application of Class 1, 2, 4, or 6 aggregate. See table on page B304-6 for application rates.

b) Double Surface Treatment

Double surface treatment is to be applied to either a granular base or a primed road.

The work consists of:

(a) Two alternate applications of binder and Class 2 aggregate (placed over granular base). See application rates on page B304-6.

or

05 02 B304-1

Page 258: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SURFACE TREATMENT

(b) An application of binder and Class 1, 2, 4, or 6 aggregate followed by an application of binder and Class 1, 2, 4, or 6 aggregate (placed over primed road.) See application rates on page B304-6.

Class 3 and 5 Aggregates are generally only used by Municipalities.

304.1.2 Restoring Roadway Surfaces

A tender item for restoring a roadway surface may be required depending on the time elapsed between grading and the priming operation.

Refer to Section B-301 of this manual for detail estimating and documentation on Restoring Roadway Surface.

304.1.3 Stockpiling of Aggregates

For economic reasons in areas where commercial aggregates are not readily available, the aggregate material required for Surface Treatment may be stockpiled under a grading contract.

The stockpiling of this material is to be paid for under the appropriate tender item. Special Provisions listed in Chapter "E" of this Manual (Materials to be Stockpiled) should be completed indicating the quantity, type of material and location of the stockpile. An allowance of 10% should be added when calculating the required amount of stockpiled aggregates.

304.1.4 Tender Items

The tender items associated with the application of surface treatments are:

a) Single Surface Treatment, specify only one type of Aggregate.

- Binder - Class 1 Aggregate- Class 2 Aggregate- Class 4 Aggregate - Class 6 Aggregate - Traffic Convoy

b) Double Surface Treatment,

- Binder - Class 1 Aggregate - Class 2 Aggregate

05 02 B304-2

Page 259: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SURFACE TREATMENT

- Class 4 Aggregate - Class 6 Aggregate - Traffic Convoy

When required, these item descriptions may be expanded to include - "Stockpiled", or - "from Stockpile".

A non-standard Special Provision must be written against these items to designate "Stockpiled" or "From Stockpile".

304.1.5 Specifications

Information regarding surface treatments is contained in OPSS 304.

304.1.6 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to chapter `E' of this manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

A non-standard special provision is required to identify:

- the locations of the work when several highways are to be surface treated; - the length and width of the roadway; - the amount of Binder; - the amount and type of Aggregate to be used at individual locations; - location of stockpile and length of haul.

The Contractor is required to supply the binder.

When the Contractor must use Ministry supplied aggregate "from Stockpile", complete the general standard special provision "Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner" and identify the Class of aggregate supplied by the Ministry and required on the contract.

304.1.7 Standard Drawings

The designer must base his work on Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings. Cross section elements are illustrated in the 200 series.

304.2 COMPUTATION

304.2.1 Source of Information

Recommendations from the Regional Geotechnical Section, Regional/Area Offices and Regional Quality Assurance Section are the main source of information for these

05 02 B304-3

Page 260: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SURFACE TREATMENT

tender items. Traffic Convoy information may be obtained from the Regional Traffic Office.

304.2.2 Method of Calculation

a) Class 1, Class 2, Class 4, Class 6 Aggregate

The unit for these tender items is tonne (t). When a weigh scale is not available (such as on multi highway surface treatment contracts), the unit for these tender items is cubic metre (m3). Quantities are estimated on the recommended theoretical pavement width (plus 0.3 m on the inside of curves) times the length of the roadway. The application rates are shown on page B 304-6.

The density is 2.0 t/m3 for Class 2 and Class 4 aggregate.

The density is 2.6 t/m3-3.0 t/m3 for Class 6 aggregate.

Allowance (10%) should be made for loss due to stockpiling.

b) Traffic Convoy

The tender unit is by the hour. The number of hours required is to be determined in consultation with the Regional Traffic Office.

304.3 DOCUMENTATION

Contract drawings and quantity sheets are not required with the above tender items.

Tender quantities for individual tender items are transferred from the calculation sheet to the Tender Document.

304.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Calculated quantities in kilogram, tonnes and cubic metre are recorded to the nearest whole number, and by the hour for the Traffic Convoy item.

Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

304.4 APPLICATION RATES

The specified rate application for the binder, the class of aggregate, and the specified application rate for the aggregate are determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section, Quality Assurance and/or Area Offices.

05 02 B304-4

Page 261: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SURFACE TREATMENT

PRIME AND SURFACE TREATMENT APPLICATION RATES

Treatment AggregateType

Primer or Binder (5) Aggregate

Grade Range,kg/m2

Typical,kg/m2

Class Range,kg/m2

Typical,kg/m2

Prime Class 4 Primer 1.90+/- 1.9 4 10-12 12

SingleSurfaceTreatment

Class 1 Class 2 (1) (6) Class 4 (2) Class 5 Class 6

CRS-2 or RS-2 HF-150SCRS-2,HF-150SCRS-2 or RS-2 HFMS-2(ON) or HFMS-2P(ON)

1.65-1.901.35-1.551.20-1.401.15-1.451.50–1.80

1.81.451.31.31.7

12456

14-1716.5-19

8-1111-1316-20

1619111317

DoubleSurfaceTreatment

Class 2 (6)

Class 3 & 1

Class 3 & 4

Class 3 & 5

Class 2 & 6

HF-150S (3) HF-150S (4)

CRS-2,RS-2 (3) CRS-2,RS-2 (4)

CRS-2,RS-2(3)CRS-2,RS-2(4)

CRS-2,RS-2 (3) CRS-2,RS-2 (4)

HFMS-2P(ON)(3)HFMS-2P(ON)(4)

1.60-1.801.45-1.65

1.60-2.101.40-2.10

1.60-1.751.05-1.20

1.80-2.001.30-1.50

1.60–1.801.50-1.70

1.651.5

1.91.8

1.651.1

1.901.35

1.651.60

22

31

34

35

26

16-1816.5-19

15-1812-15

15-186.5-8

15-1711-13.5

13.5-1815-19

1819

1714

178

1713

1616

Notes:(1) Class 2 surface treatment may cause dust problems in urban areas. (2) Do not apply to flushed surface treatments, flushed pavements or where low friction values are

a concern. (3) Initial application. (4) Second application. (5) Decrease binder rates towards the lower limit of the range when there is heavy commercial

traffic. (6) The use of Granular "A" aggregate in a Single or Double Surface Treatment is not

recommended.

05 02 B304-5

Page 262: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 263: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRANULAR SEALING

B305 - GRANULAR SEALING - OPSS 305 305.1 GENERAL

Granular sealing is a method to control surface erosion of granular shoulders and roundings. The granular sealing is applied: - On granular shoulder, 100 mm inside the edge of pavement to the outside edge of

rounding, or as specified. - On paved shoulders with guide rail, 100 mm inside the edge of the narrowed

paved shoulder to the outside edge of rounding, or as specified. - On paved shoulders without guide rail, 100 mm inside the edge of paved shoulder

to the outside edge of rounding, or as specified. Alternatives such as shouldering materials more resistant to erosion (eg. 100% crushed aggregate or reclaimed asphalt pavement) may be cost effective and recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section on a project and location specific basis. Locations may include directly adjacent to waterbodies to mitigate the environmental risks associated with granular sealing.

305.2 REFERENCES - N/A

305.3 TENDER ITEMS Granular Sealing (variation, m2, PQP) Granular Sealing (variation, kg, non-PQP)

305.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for granular sealing are contained in OPSS 305.

305.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

December 2016 Page 1 of 4 B305

Page 264: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRANULAR SEALING

305.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Treatment of granular sealing for erosion control is shown on the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings in the 200 series.

305.7 DESIGN There are four sealant types: - Type I-a RC-30 and MTO primer according to OPSS 1102 - Type I-b Emulsified asphalt primer according to OPSS 1103 - Type II Solvent-free emulsified asphalt according to OPSS 1103 - Type III Tall oil pitch (TOP) emulsion according to OPSS 2510 The type of sealant (Type I, Type II, or Type III) to be used at each location is specified. When Type I is specified, the contractor chooses Type I-a or Type I-b. Type III should only be applied to Granular A, S, or M aggregates. Due to environmental concerns, Type I or Type II granular sealing may not be suitable for application in or directly adjacent to environmentally sensitive areas or within 30 m of waterbodies. Type III sealer may be more appropriate at such locations. The designer should determine the locations where a particular sealer type (i.e. I-a, I-b, II, or III) should be specified, and for locations where a particular sealer type is not required, specify all the sealer type options available to the Contractor. The designer may choose the appropriate sealer on the basis of the guidelines in this document and the expected number of years before the shoulder would need to be re-sealed, as follows:

Sealer Type Expected # of Years Before Re-Sealing I-a, I-b 4

II 3 III 2

Notes: 1. The expected # of years, with the exception of Type III, is based on only

occasional vehicle trafficking. 2. Type III should only be specified at locations with minimal risk of vehicle

trafficking. 3. All sealers should perform behind guiderail for at least 3 years when applied

according to the manufacturer’s requirements.

December 2016 Page 2 of 4 B305

Page 265: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRANULAR SEALING

Hand-spraying is required around guide rails, road markers, utility boxes, in or adjacent to environmentally sensitive areas and within 30 m of waterbodies, and any tight areas where spray from a machine’s nozzle bar could be blocked and where the application rate is likely to be inadequate. Machine-spraying may be used in all other areas. The use of and type of granular sealing to be used may be recommended in the Pavement Design Report, or may be determined in consultation with geotechnical and environmental project staff.

305.8 COMPUTATION This tender item can be either: - a Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) item with a unit of measure by the square metre; - an actual measured item with a unit of measure by the kilogram. When the unit of measure is by the square metre, the area to be treated is calculated by multiplying the length times the width as per applicable standards or typical sections measured horizontally. The width used in the calculation shall be kept constant if possible and, shall reflect the requirement that sealer applied beside an existing roadway wearing surface be overlapped 100 mm onto the wearing surface. When the unit of measure is by the kilogram then areas for machine spraying or hand spraying shall be determined as specified above. These areas will be multiplied by the specified application rates per square metre.

305.9 DOCUMENTATION 305.9.1 Contract Drawings

At locations where the standard drawings for granular sealing are not adequate, drawing details may be used to show the requirements.

305.9.2 Quantity Sheets When the unit of measure for this item is by the square metre, then the individual quantity entries are shown in square metres on the "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet. When the unit of measure for this item is by the kilogram, then the individual quantity entries are shown in kilograms on the "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet.

December 2016 Page 3 of 4 B305

Page 266: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GRANULAR SEALING

Locations are documented by station to station limits and offset left or right of the roadway centreline. Granular sealing is a variation item. Quantities are documented in separate columns for each type of sealant and method of application. By item variation, the sealer type or sealer type options (Type I, Type II, Type III, Type I or Type II, Type II or Type III, or Type I, II or III and method of spray (machine or hand) is specified in the column heading. The individual column entries are totaled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

305.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Quantities and Stations on the Quantity Sheet are recorded to the nearest whole number.

December 2016 Page 4 of 4 B305

Page 267: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PATCHING MATERIAL

B307 - STOCKPILING OF PATCHING MATERIALS AND PATCHING OF ASPHALT PAVEMENT - OPSS 307

307.1 GENERAL

These tender items cover the requirements for the supply, stockpiling and placement of Hot Mix Cold Laid mixture for patching operations.

SC-800 Patching, Emulsified Asphalt Patching and Proprietary Cold Patching materials are used primarily for maintenance programs and operations.

307.2 REFERENCES - None

307.3 TENDER ITEMS

SC-800 Patching Material Emulsified Asphalt Patching Material Proprietary Cold Patching Material

307.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Information dealing with these tender items is contained in OPSS 307.

307.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The Designer shall refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

307.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None

307.7 DESIGN – Not Applicable

307.8 COMPUTATION

The unit of measurement for these tender items is by the tonne.

307.9 DOCUMENTATION

Quantities are documented on Miscellaneous Quantity Sheet and totalled. This total is the tender total which is transferred to the Tender documentation. Stations and quantities are recorded in whole numbers.

June 2012 Pg. 1 of 1 B307

Page 268: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 269: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TACK COAT

B308 - TACK COAT - OPSS 308 308.1 GENERAL

The application of tack coat is used to provide adequate bond between a pavement surface or rigid object and an overlay of bituminous pavement.

308.2 REFERENCES - None

308.3 TENDER ITEM Tack Coat

308.4 SPECIFICATIONS Application details for the above tender item are contained in OPSS.PROV 308. The Regional Geotechnical Section should be contacted for additional requirements such as inclusion of the optional special provision fill-in.

308.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter ‘E’ of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

308.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - None

308.7 DESIGN Generally the following surface areas require the application of tack coat before surfacing with bituminous pavement. a) Curbs, curb and gutter, gutter outlets, setbacks and sidewalks.

b) Concrete base surfaces.

c) Concrete pavement surfaces.

d) Structure approach slabs.

February 2017 Page 1 of 2 B308

Page 270: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TACK COAT

e) Bituminous surfaces (as recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section). Vertical surfaces in contact with new bituminous pavement will be “joint painted” per OPSS.PROV 308. These areas are excluded from the tack coat item. Tack coating of concrete underneath the waterproofing membrane in association with bridge deck waterproofing is included in the bridge deck waterproofing tender item. Tack coating of the protection board shall be included in the tack coat item.

308.7.1 Materials The diluted SS-1 or SS-1HH emulsified asphalt is supplied by the Contractor.

308.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

308.8.1 Source of Information The main source of information for this tender item is the Regional Geotechnical Section.

308.8.2 Method of Calculation Horizontal dimensions of the surfaces to be tack coated are calculated in square metres.

308.9 DOCUMENTATION The areas to be tack coated are indicated on the “Quantities - Miscellaneous” sheet by station to station and location.

308.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Quantities and stations on the Quantity Sheet are recorded to the nearest whole number.

February 2017 Page 2 of 2 B308

Page 271: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT SIDEWALKS

91 10 B311-1

311 - ASPHALT SIDEWALK OPSS 311

311.1 GENERAL

The construction of ashalt sidewalks, is controlled by the following policy:

1. New Sidewalks

The Ministry may pay 100% of the cost of a new sidewalk across a King's Highway, Freeway or Expressway at an interchange, intersection or flyover, providing all of the following conditions are met:

(a) Sidewalk must be requested by the Municipality.

(b) Sidewalk must be recommended by the Regional Planning and Design Office as being required from a delineation and/or pedestrian safety point of view.

(c) Municipality must give a commitment to construct a municipal sidewalk to join at each end of that sidewalk to be constructed by the Ministry.

(d) Sidewalk must be located within the right-of-way and cross the Provincial Highway at an interchange or intersection.

(e) The Municipality must undertake to maintain and accept liability for any sidewalk constructed under the above conditions.

2. Replacement of Sidewalks Destroyed or Damaged by MTO Construction

The Ministry will pay 100% of the cost of replacing a sidewalk damaged or destroyed by Ministry construction projects.

3. Sidewalk Ramps

The construction of sidewalk ramps should be considered and the locations discussed with the Municipality.

311.1.1 Asphalt Sidewalk

The following work is associated with the construction of asphalt sidewalk, but is not included in the above tender item for placing the sidewalk.

a) Excavation required to construct the sidewalk and granular foundation. The excavation required above the bottom of sidewalk grade is to be included in the tender item "Earth Excavation (Grading)" and/or "Rock Excavation (Grading)".

Page 272: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT SIDEWALKS

91 10 B311-2

b) Granular quantities required for foundation work are to be included in the appropriate granular item. Normally, Granular A is used for foundation material.

The basic width of a new sidewalk is 1.5 metres. However, the local municipality should be contacted for confirmation.

311.1.2 Sidewalk Resurfacing

The work included with this tender item is the resurfacing of existing asphalt or concrete sidewalks. The hot mix used for resurfacing the sidewalk is usually of the same type as applied as surface course of the highway.

311.1.3 Tender Items

- Asphalt Sidewalk - *Asphalt Driveway - *Asphalt Boulevard - Sidewalk Resurfacing

* These two items are not to be used by MTO.

311.1.4 Specifications

The requirements for asphalt sidewalk and sidewalk resurfacing are contained in OPSS 311.

311.1.5 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter `E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

311.1.6 Standard Drawings

There are no standard drawings available for Asphalt Sidewalk and Sidewalk Resurfacing. A typical section is required to be included in the contract to illustrate the asphalt depth and width as well as detailed granular foundation dimensions.

311.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

311.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the above tender items are the ETR, Cross-sections, the local Municipality and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

311.2.2 Method of Calculation

Page 273: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT SIDEWALKS

91 10 B311-3

The unit of measurement for, Asphalt Sidewalk and Sidewalk Resurfacing is square metre and is calculated using the horizontal design dimensions.

The asphalt quantity in tonnes is calculated as described in Section 313 of this manual under the heading computation. The tonnage is then added to the appropriate Hot Mix tender item.

The type and depth of asphalt is determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

The usual depth of asphalt for sidewalks is 75 mm. This depth may be increased at the request of the Municipality providing the Municipality agrees to absorb the additional costs.

Grading required for sidewalks is calculated in cubic metres. The depth of excavation is to include the concrete or asphalt thickness. The grading quantity is to be added to the tender item Earth Excavation (Grading).

The granular foundation depth is normally 100 mm for asphalt sidewalk. The granular quantity in tonnes is added to the appropriate granular tender item.

311.3 DOCUMENTATION

The granular foundation quantity is added to the roadway granular item and identified as a separate entry on the quantity sheet.

The grading quantities for asphalt sidewalk are added to the tender item Earth Excavation (Grading) and shown as a separate entry on the Quantities - Grading sheet.

The hot mix quantities for asphalt sidewalk, and sidewalk resurfacing are shown as a separate entry with the appropriate Hot Mix tender item on the hot mix quantity sheet.

Sidewalk, driveway and boulevard quantities and the depth of asphalt are itemized on a Miscellaneous Quantity Sheet by Station to Station, Location and Offset. The quantities for each tender item are totalled. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the tender document.

311.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Quantity entries are recorded in whole number square metres.

Page 274: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 275: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

91 10 B312-1-1

312-1 - ASPHALT CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS OPSS 312

312-1.1 GENERAL

Asphalt curb and gutter serves the same purpose as concrete curb and gutter. The construction of asphalt curb is generally intended to fulfill a temporary need.

312-1.1.1 Asphalt Curb and Gutter

Asphalt curb and gutter used in conjunction with gutter outlets and spillways are used primarily to control erosion on shoulders and slopes. As with concrete curb and gutter, consideration should be given to paving the shoulders in lieu of using curb and/or gutter. It reduces maintenance costs and improves traffic safety operations.

Types of Asphalt Curb and Gutter

Types and general use of asphalt curb, asphalt gutter and asphalt curb and gutter are illustrated in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual in the 601 series.

(a) Gutter OPSD 601.01 Type "A"

- Applied primarily in areas where no curb is required such as a parking lot or patrol yard with minimum runoff.

- offers no interference with snow plowing. - permits cross-traffic.

(b) Curb and Gutter OPSD 601.01 Type "B"

- Used on highways with low traffic volume as an alternative to concrete gutter.

- Most often placed in areas where cross-traffic is prevalent but where a greater water carrying capacity is required.

- offers little interference with snow plowing.

(c) Curb OPSD 601.01

- Machine laid and used on major detours where guidance to traffic is required.

Page 276: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

91 10 B312-1-2

312-1.1.2 Asphalt Gutter Outlets

Gutter outlets are designed to discharge the waterflow from curb and/or gutter.

The warrants for the use of asphalt gutter outlets and types available are identical to concrete gutter outlets as described in Section B353 in this Manual.

312-1.1.3 Asphalt Spillways

Spillways are constructed to prevent washout of the granular shoulder and slope. They are placed from the end of the gutter outlet to the edge of subgrade or depending on conditions to the bottom of earth fill slope.

The requirement for placing a spillway at the gutter outlet will depend on the type of side-slope at the gutter outlet. Rip rap treatment in the form of a spillway may also be considered.

312-1.1.4 Tender Items

- Asphalt Curb and Gutter - Asphalt Gutter Outlets - Asphalt Spillways

312-1.1.5 Specifications

The requirements for asphalt curb and gutter, asphalt gutter outlets and asphalt spillways, are contained in OPSS 312.

312-1.1.6 Special Provisions

The Designer should refer to Chapter `E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

312-1.1.7 Standards

Applicable standards are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual in the 601 series.

312-1.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

Page 277: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

91 10 B312-1-3

312-1.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of these tender items are the Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books, Pavement Elevations, Design Cross-Sections, the MTO Drainage Manual (Chapters C and E) and Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual.

312-1.2.2 Method of Calculation

1. Asphalt Curb and Gutter

The unit of measurement for asphalt curb and/or gutter is the metre. The length is measured along the flow line of the gutter, with no deductions made for gutter outlets. The types and lengths of curb and gutter to be placed will include bullnose and transition sections, and straight and circular curb and/or gutter. The various lengths are scaled from the plan.

2. Asphalt Gutter Outlets

The unit of measurement for asphalt gutter outlets is each. The location of gutter outlets is scaled from the plan or determined from the profiles. The lengths of gutter outlets will not be deducted from the lengths of curb and gutter.

3. Asphalt Spillways

The unit of measurement for asphalt spillways is the metre. The length is taken from the cross-section and is measured along the contour flow line of the spillway from the end of the gutter outlet to the end of the spillway.

312-1.2.3 Asphalt Requirement

Asphalt required for the above tender items is the same hot mix type as used for the surface course of the roadway. The quantity is calculated in cubic metre by the end area method from the appropriate standard and converted to tonnes based on the following rates:

Hot Mix HL1 - 2.56 tonnes per cubic metre All Other Hot Mix - 2.45 tonnes per cubic metre

The calculated tonnes of hot mix are added to the appropriate Hot Mix roadway quantities.

312-1.3 DOCUMENTATION

Page 278: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

91 10 B312-1-4

The documentation procedure for Asphalt Curb and Gutter, either straight or circular, Asphalt Gutter Outlets and Asphalt Spillways is identical to that for the Concrete Curb System and is itemized in Section B353 of this manual.

Hot Mix quantities for the above tender items are entered as separate quantities on the appropriate quantity sheet under the column for Hot Mix and totals transferred to the tender document.

312-1.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Quantity entries are recorded in whole number metres of linear measurement.

Hot mix quantities are recorded in whole numbers in tonnes.

Page 279: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT SURFACING OF GUTTER

92 11 B312-2-1

312-2 ASPHALT SURFACING OF GUTTER OPSS 312

312-2.1 GENERAL

Surfacing of existing curb and/or gutter is carried out primarily on road resurfacing contracts or when the profile is raised and the existing curb and gutter is in good condition. The Regional Geotechnical Section will determine if the existing curb and gutter system is in good enough condition to warrant surfacing.

The Project Manager should compare the economics of surfacing curb and gutter to removing and replacing the curb system with new curb and gutters.

When asphalt surfacing of gutter is carried out the existing catchbasins or manholes encountered within the curb system will be subject to either of the following treatments.

(a) Catchbasins or manholes will require adjustments and are paid under the tender item "Adjusting and Rebuilding Manholes, Catchbasins and Ditch Inlets", (see Section B407-1 of this manual for estimating and documentation).

(b) the asphalt material used for surfacing curb and gutter may be feathered out at the manhole or catchbasin location.

The application to use either of the above treatment will depend on the type of curb and gutter and on the depth of asphalt to be placed. Traffic safety, due to the depressions in the gutter makes treatment (b) undesirable. Consideration should therefore be given to treatment (a).

312-2.1.1 Tender Items

- Asphalt Surfacing of Gutter

312-2.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for asphalt surfacing of gutter are contained in OPSS 312.

312-2.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter `E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

312-2.1.4 Standards

Applicable standards are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual in the 600 series.

Page 280: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ASPHALT SURFACING OF GUTTER

92 11 B312-2-2

312-2.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

312-2.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of these tender items are the Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

312-2.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for asphalt surfacing of gutter is the metre. The lengths of existing curb and gutter to be surfaced are to be scaled along the flowline fromthe plan to the nearest metre. No deductions or allowances are to be made for existing gutter outlets or manhole and catchbasin grates. The minimum depth asphalt surfacing is indicated on the drawing "Surfacing of Existing Curb and Gutter" in the Standard Drawings Manual.

The asphalt required to surface existing gutter will be calculated in tonnes. The quantity is added to the appropriate Hot Mix tender item. Asphalt material used for surfacing curb and gutter will be the same type as used for resurfacing the roadway.

312-2.3 DOCUMENTATION

Typical sections or cross sections are required to be included into the construction plans to illustrate the depth of surfacing.

Curb and gutter to be surfaced are documented on the Miscellaneous Quantity Sheet and itemized by station to station, location and left and right designation.

The quantities are totalled. This total is the tender total that is transferred to the Tender Document.

Accuracy

Stations and quantities are recorded to the nearest whole number.

Page 281: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

B313-1 – HOT MIX ASPHALT – OPSS.PROV 313 313-1.1 GENERAL

Hot mix asphalt consists of several mix types, which are grouped into two categories: Stone Mastic Asphalt and Superpave as detailed below. The type of hot mix asphalt and location is recommended in the Pavement Design Report and/or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Further design information for SMA and Superpave is available in the Superpave and SMA Design Guide. The option now exists for hot mix asphalt courses to be paid by the square metre rather than tonnage. Hot mix asphalt (HMA) measured by the square metre is paid based on the horizontal area of the hot mix lift placed. Payment is decreased when lifts on average are placed thinner than the specified lift thickness. There is no incentive for HMA courses placed thicker than what was specified in the Contract Documents as overruns for square metre items are not possible unless there is a change or error in the plan quantity. Payment by square metres is an effective alternative to tonnage that should be considered for contracts which do not require tolerance corrections in the HMA courses or provide the contractor with an opportunity to make tolerance corrections under a separate operation.

313-1.1.1 Stone Mastic Asphalt Mix Stone Mastic Asphalt (SMA) is a heavy-duty gap-graded hot mix asphalt with a relatively large proportion of stones and an additional amount of mastic-stabilized asphalt cement. The SMA mixture has an aggregate skeleton with coarse aggregate stone-on-stone contact to withstand loading due to heavy commercial traffic loads. SMA is considered for use on Traffic Category D and E roads. The additional amount of asphalt cement binder is required primarily to provide increased durability and resistance to aging and cracking to a mix. The use of durable aggregates and the gap-gradation provide superior rutting resistance. The stabilization of the extra asphalt cement and in particular, prevention of binder draindown during construction, are achieved by: 1) an increase in fines and filler, 2) addition of organic or mineral fibre, 3) polymer-modification, or 4) a combination of all three. All SMA placed requires the application of a hot grit coated with asphalt cement (about 1%) during mix placement to increase early age friction. SMA designates hot mix types by the nominal maximum aggregate size, which represents the sieve size, in mm, through which at least 90 % of the aggregate passes. There are currently three designations of SMA mixes.

April 2016 Page 1 of 15 B313-1

Page 282: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

a) SMA 19.0 SMA 19.0 is a premium binder course mix with enhanced rutting resistance for Traffic Category D and E roads.

b) SMA 12.5 SMA 12.5 is a premium surface course with enhanced rutting resistance, water spray reduction, and potential noise reduction for Traffic Category D and E roads. It is the most common SMA surface course type on Ontario highways.

c) SMA 9.5 SMA 9.5 is a premium surface course with enhanced rutting resistance, water spray reduction, and potential noise reduction for Traffic Category D and E roads. The smaller nominal maximum size results in a tighter surface texture and may also make it suitable where a thinner lift is desired.

313-1.1.2 Superpave Mixes The Superpave methodology incorporates a performance-based asphalt materials characterization system to improve the long-term pavement performance under diverse environmental conditions. Superpave designates hot mix types by the nominal maximum aggregate size, which represents the sieve size, in mm, through which at least 90 % of the aggregate passes. The following Superpave mixes are specified: a) Superpave 37.5

Superpave 37.5 is a large stone binder course mix for use when thicker binder lifts are required.

b) Superpave 25.0 Superpave 25.0 is a large stone binder course mix for use when thicker binder lifts are required.

c) Superpave 19.0 Superpave 19.0 is a binder course mix for all traffic categories. It has replaced HL 4, HL 8, and HDBC mixes.

April 2016 Page 2 of 15 B313-1

Page 283: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

d) Superpave 12.5 Superpave 12.5 is a surface course mix for Traffic Category B and C roads. It has replaced HL 3, HL 3 Fine and HL 4 mixes.

e) Superpave 12.5FC 1 Superpave 12.5FC 1 is a surface course mix for Traffic Category C roads that provides superior rutting resistance and skid resistance through aggregate selection. It has replaced HL 1 mix.

f) Superpave 12.5FC 2 Superpave 12.5FC 2 is a surface course mix for Traffic Category D and E roads which replaces DFC mix. It provides better rutting and skid resistance than Superpave 12.5FC 1 due to the requirement for premium coarse and fine aggregate.

g) Superpave 9.5 Superpave 9.5 is a fine surface course mix for Traffic Category A and B roads and driveways. It can also be used as a padding or levelling course for all traffic category roadways.

h) Superpave 4.75 Superpave 4.75 is a fine surface or levelling course mix used for miscellaneous applications.

i) Temporary Hot Mix This mix is used for seasonal asphalt applications, usually on secondary highways/temporary detours, and not to be used on freeways.

313-1.2 REFERENCES Commercial Site Access Policy and Standards Manual Directive PHM-C-001, The Use of Surface Course Types on Provincial Highways Designated Sources for Material (DSM) - Prequalified Products List - MTO Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways Manual, Chapter D MERO-033, Construction of Longitudinal Joints in Flexible Pavements – Design

Guidelines Pavement Design Report – project specific MTO Superpave and SMA Guide

April 2016 Page 3 of 15 B313-1

Page 284: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

313-1.3 TENDER ITEMS Unit of Measure: Square Metres SMA 9.5 - (25, 30, 35) mm Lift Thickness SMA 12.5 - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness SMA 19.0 - (50, 60, 70) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 9.5 - (25, 30, 35) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5 - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5FC 1 - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5FC 2 - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 19.0 - (50, 60, 70) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 25.0 - (80, 90, 100, 110) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix - (40, 50, 60) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix - (50, 60, 70) mm Lift Thickness Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix - (80, 90, 100, 110) mm Lift Thickness Unit of Measure: Tonnes SMA 9.5 SMA 12.5 SMA 19.0 Superpave 4.75 Superpave 9.5 Superpave 12.5 Superpave 12.5FC 1 Superpave 12.5FC 2 Superpave 19.0 Superpave 25.0 Superpave 37.5 Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix Superpave 12.5FC 1 - Warm Mix Superpave 12.5FC 2 - Warm Mix Superpave 19.0 - Warm Mix Superpave 25.0 - Warm Mix When the unit of measure is square metre, the tender item name will include a reference to the design lift thickness specified for all hot mix included under that tender item. When more than one design lift thickness is specified for a square metre hot mix type, the mix quantity will be split into different tender items to reflect the quantities for each design lift thickness.

April 2016 Page 4 of 15 B313-1

Page 285: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

Some items include the term “Warm Mix”. These are mixes that require the use of warm mix technology in production. This technology allows the mix to be produced at a lower temperature and provides environmental, safety, and performance benefits compared to conventional hot mix asphalt. The warm mix items are used when recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project team. The design, estimating, and documentation requirements for the various mix type items also apply to the equivalent warm mix item eg. the requirements for Superpave 12.5 item apply also to the Superpave 12.5 - Warm Mix item.

313-1.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work of production, placing and compaction of Hot Mix are contained in OPSS.PROV 313. Material requirements are contained in OPSS.PROV 1151.

313-1.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items.

313-1.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS The designer must base his work on highway engineering standards pertaining to the above tender items. Pavement design related standards are contained in the OPSD 500 series. Cross section elements are illustrated in the 200 series.

313-1.7 DESIGN 313-1.7.1 Surface Courses

The policy to ensure consistent application of standards for selecting surface course types for all highway improvement projects in Ontario is outlined in Directive PHM-C-001, The Use of Surface Course Types on Provincial Highways. Under the Superpave system, the most common surface course type on Ontario highways is expected to be a Superpave 12.5 mix. The Ministry has added two premium mix types to the Superpave suite of mixes: Superpave 12.5FC 1 and Superpave 12.5FC 2. The "FC" stands for friction course. The "1" requires that the coarse aggregate fraction for this mix type must be obtained from a Designated Sources for Materials (DSM) list. The "2" requires that the coarse and fine aggregates for this mix type must be obtained from a source listed on the DSM. In addition to Superpave mixes, there are two SMA surface courses: SMA 9.5 and 12.5

April 2016 Page 5 of 15 B313-1

Page 286: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

are premium mixes that require the coarse and fine aggregates for the mix to be obtained from a source listed on the DSM.

313-1.7.2 Non-Driving Pavement Asphalt Applications In addition to the use of mixes in the pavement structure, some of the above-mentioned types of hot mixes are also employed for the paving of shoulders and ditches and median strips, construction of asphalt curb and gutters, gutter outlets, spillways, sidewalks and repairs to, or patching of, the existing pavement.

313-1.7.3 Paving of Private Entrances and Side Roads The limits of paving of entrances and side roads shall be established by the designer, and the depth of paving as specified in the Pavement Design Report and/or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Previously paved private entrances are to be restored to their former condition. Gravel entrances in urban areas are paved between the curb and gutter and sidewalk. In rural areas where curb and gutter is used, gravel entrances may be paved at the discretion of the designer.

313-1.7.3.1 Policy of Local Municipality The designer shall contact the local Municipality with regard to local established policies on paving of private entrances. The Ministry will normally apply the policy of that Municipality provided the extent of the work does not exceed the normal Ministry cost. If the Municipality insists on the application of their policy and standards, then they must agree to accept any additional costs before the work is carried out.

313-1.7.4 Paving of Commercial Entrances Commercial entrances should be paved according to the “Commercial Site Access Policy and Standards Manual” and should be approved by the designer and Regional Geotechnical Section. The limits of paving will sometimes be determined by alignment, grade and cross-section. For paving of entrances behind curb and gutter refer to CDED section B313-10 “Hot Mix Miscellaneous”.

April 2016 Page 6 of 15 B313-1

Page 287: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

313-1.7.5 Deferral of Hot Mix Paving Operations Hot mix pavement is not to be placed before it is required for vehicular traffic because: a) The pavement is vulnerable to be damaged by construction vehicles, b) Capital is tied up unnecessarily, c) Hot mix pavements depreciate in the absence of traffic. On contracts where the fine grading is completed but the roadway will not be placed into service for some time, no paving operation shall commence until needed. A note on the plans on complex freeway staging work or direction by special provision is necessary to prevent the premature paving operation.

313-1.7.6 Padding Padding of the existing roadway is sometimes required to restore the roadway or superelevation or crossfall or to remove other pavement distortions prior to resurfacing. Pavement types and maximum lift thicknesses are recommended in the Pavement Design Report and/or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Actual depths are determined by design cross-sections during detailed design.

313-1.7.7 Pavement Widening on Curves An additional amount of hot mix is to be considered when calculating the required paving on curves. The widths and details of the pavement widening on curves are to be obtained from the “Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways” Manual, Chapter “D”.

313-1.7.8 Paved Shoulders

The warrant and design of fully or partial paved shoulders are documented in the Geometric Design Manual Chapter “D”. The depth and width of paved shoulders should be clearly shown on a typical section or in a table.

313-1.7.9 Asphalt Cement The Pavement Design Report and/or by the Regional Geotechnical Section should be referenced for the selection of performance graded asphalt cement (PGAC) grade(s). The designer should be aware that for the purpose of PGAC grade designation, Ontario has been divided into three zones as follows: Zone 1: The area north of the boundary formed by the French River, Lake Nipissing,

and the Mattawa River.

April 2016 Page 7 of 15 B313-1

Page 288: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

Zone 2: The area south of Zone 1, and north of a line from Honey Harbour, to

Longford, Taylor Corners, Cavan, Campbellford, and Mallorytown. Zone 3: The area south of Zone 2. For design purposes, the designer shall ensure: a) Towns located along a zone boundary line are to be included in the zone south of

the boundary line. b) Projects located within 10 km of zone boundary lines may be included in either

zone at the discretion of the designer so that they may be considered within one zone only.

The designer shall consider the following when selecting PGAC grades: a) The location of the contract, i.e., the geographical zone in which it is located,

noting that some discretion is allowed. b) The type of hot mix, new versus recycled hot mix. c) Upgrades for heavy commercial traffic, frequent starts and stops, and vehicle

speeds. See Table 2. Table 1 provides the basic performance grades for each Ontario zone. Note that MTO currently does not specify a recycling ratio and therefore grades are only provided for 0 to 20 % RAP. If the contractor is permitted and chooses to modify the composition of the mix by including more recycled content, OPSS.PROV 1101 and OPSS.PROV 1151 specifies how grade selection is also modified.

Table 1 OPSS.PROV 1101 - Grade Selection for Ontario

PGAC Zones

Zone 1 Zone 2 Zone 3

New Hot Mix or up to 20% RAP 52 – 34 58 - 34 58 - 28

April 2016 Page 8 of 15 B313-1

Page 289: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

Table 2 OPSS.PROV 1101 - Guidelines for the Adjustment of PGAC High Temperature

Grade Based on Roadway Classification and Traffic Conditions Highway Type Increase from Standard Optional Additional Grade

Increase (Note 2)

Urban Freeway 2 Grades N/A

Rural Freeway Urban Arterial 1 Grade 1 Grade

Rural Arterial Urban Collector

Consider increasing by 1 grade if heavy commercial traffic is greater than 20% of AADT

1 Grade

Rural Collector Rural Local

Urban/Suburban Collector No Change 1 or 2 Grades

Notes: 1. Upgrading of the high temperature grade is recommended for use in both surface and

top binder courses, i.e., top 80 to 100 mm of hot mix. 2. Consideration should be given to an increase in the high temperature grade for roadways

which experience a high percentage of heavy truck or bus traffic at slow operating speeds, frequent stops and starts, and historical concerns with instability rutting.

313-1.7.10 Anti-stripping Treatment

For East, Central and West Regions; the Regional Quality Assurance Section shall be contacted and the mandatory anti-stripping treatment requirements special provision option shall only be included on the recommendation of Regional Head of Quality Assurance. The Regional Head of Quality Assurance in East, West and Central Region will consider adding the option if there is limited information available to contractors prior to contract tender opening on the moisture sensitivity of mixes containing aggregates that may be selected by the contractor for use on the contract. This is generally the case where the hot mix aggregate source(s) for the contract is NOT likely to be an active commercial source(s). This is generally not the case for the East, West and Central Regions and the mandatory option is not normally chosen.

313-1.7.11 Temporary Hot Mix Pavement Whenever a temporary hot mix pavement (detours, widenings, etc.), which is intended to be removed within the same construction season, is included into a contact package, the use of special provision for Temporary Hot Mix Pavement should be considered. This special provision offers the contractor the option to construct and repair hot mix used for Temporary Hot Mix Pavement which is not subject to the normal payment adjustments for asphalt cement content, aggregate gradation and pavement compaction. It is inserted into a contract package in consultation with the Regional Operations Office, and should not be used for detours

April 2016 Page 9 of 15 B313-1

Page 290: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

or other temporary placement if it is expected that the time frame for the temporary pavement will extend beyond the same construction season. The Regional Geotechnical Section is to be consulted in the selection of the type of mix for the temporary hot mix pavement from the following mix types: a) Superpave 12.5 and Superpave 19.0

313-1.7.12 Minimum Lift Thicknesses

A suitable lift thickness for hot mix asphalt layer is primarily dependent on two factors: the mix type, since this results in a different nominal maximum aggregate size, and on whether the mix is coarse-graded or fine-graded. In general terms, the smaller the nominal maximum size and the finer the mix gradation is, the smaller the lift thickness which can be constructed satisfactorily. Recommended lift thicknesses for various mix types are provided in the Superpave and SMA Design Guide.

313-1.7.13 Paving in Echelon

Paving in echelon shall be as recommended by the designer in consultation with the Regional Geotechnical Section and the Regional Operations Office. The Construction of Longitudinal Joints in Flexible Pavements – Design Guidelines, MERO-033 is a valuable resource for the designer on when echelon paving is suitable and how to maximize the opportunities for paving in echelon and when it is not an option. The fill in statement specifies whether paving in echelon shall not be used, shall be used, or may be used at the contractor’s option. Wording shall also be provided to describe the extent of paving in echelon such as the entire contract, contract specific limits, specific lanes, or staging.

313-1.7.14 HMA Tender Items with Small Quantities

In many cases, it is desirable to eliminate tender items with small estimated quantities. In most of Northeast and Northwest Regions and parts of East Region there are no commercial hot mix asphalt plants and contractors commonly use portable plants instead. In these areas, mix designs for small items are more costly and time consuming. The search for a suitable aggregate source in some areas in these regions can pose a potential to delay the contract. Producing small quantities of aggregates will have a large unit cost. Commercial hot mix plants serve most of Central and West Regions. Areas served by commercial plants can be determined by reviewing hot mix plant locations shown on the Ontario Hot Mix Producers Association website www.ohmpa.org and in

April 2016 Page 10 of 15 B313-1

Page 291: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

consultation with the Regional Geotechnical Section and the Regional Quality Assurance Section. In all regions, there is a considerable amount of QC/QA paperwork and administrative work associated with each different source, aggregate and mix design. To determine if a tender item is required, review the potential tender items with less than: a) 2000 tonnes for contracts not in areas served by commercial hot mix plants, and b) 500 tonnes for contracts in areas served by commercial hot mix plants. A reasonable haul distance to anticipate supply from a commercial plant would be 100 km. The above quantities are considered to be the dividing line between “large” and “small” hot mix tender items. If the potential small tender item is for a binder course and there is a larger quantity hot mix tender item, combine the quantity with the larger quantity item except when the larger quantity item is Superpave 12.5FC 2 or SMA. If the potential small tender item is for a surface course, and there is a large tender item for a surface course with equivalent or better quality combine the quantity with the surface course tender item with equivalent or better quality, except when the large tender item is SMA Combine 2 small tender items into one item when the combined item will satisfy the pavement design requirement for the project. Guidelines for optimising the number of mix types and traffic categories are provided in the MTO Superpave and SMA Guide. MERO-033, Construction of Longitudinal Joints in Flexible Pavements – Design Guidelines also provides information to the designer on the benefits of optimizing the number of mix types. Exceptions where small tender items are appropriate:

• Small tender items for binder course mix when there is no other binder course

tender item and the surface course is Superpave 12.5FC 2 or SMA. • Small tender items for surface course when the other surface course tender item is

Superpave 12.5FC 2 or SMA.

• Superpave 12.5FC 2 and SMA items where these mix types are required by MTO surface course policy.

• Non-Standard Tender Items for trial areas of new/innovative mixes

April 2016 Page 11 of 15 B313-1

Page 292: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

• Contracts such as:

1) Bridge rehabilitation contracts where the only HMA is for paving the

approaches and deck 2) Culvert/sewer replacement contracts where the only HMA is for paving at the

culvert/sewer location 3) Intersection improvement, electrical contracts and other contracts where the

only HMA is used for paving small areas. 4) Patching contracts where the surface friction must be similar to the existing

surface for safety reasons. 313-1.7.15 Surface Smoothness

Acceptance criteria for surface smoothness, which includes payment adjustments, is included in the smoothness special provision. The designer shall include this special provision in all hot mix contracts according to its warrant.

313-1.7.16 Measurement by Square Metres

Multiple courses of HMA or surface course may be measured by square metres rather than by tonnage. The decision to measure an HMA course by square metres is based upon the direction of the Manager, Regional Operations Office in consultation with Head, Regional Geotechnical Section and the Head, Regional Quality Assurance. Preferably, the decision to measure by square metre should be considered at the 30 % design review stage. It is to be considered for contracts that include an additional underlying machine pass completed on the same contract that is not measured under a HMA square metre item. For example, one or more of the following should underlay the HMA square metre item: - milled pavement, - concrete pavement, - full depth reclamation - graded granular base - in-place recycling processes (HIR, CIR, CIREAM) or a - binder course or levelling course measured by tonnes. Measurement by square metres is not recommended for the following cases: - when HMA is to be placed directly on an existing surface (may be considered if the

surface is not older than 3 years or is in good condition and resurfacing is not to correct for surface tolerances or crossfall issues),

- the HMA will be required to correct for crossfall,

April 2016 Page 12 of 15 B313-1

Page 293: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

- the HMA will be required to correct existing poor pavement surface tolerance, - the HMA will be used for padding, - hot mix miscellaneous (i.e. spillways and commercial entrances) and hot mix

placed at an unspecified thickness, - for Superpave 4.75 or Superpave 37.5 courses, or - the contract consists mainly of HMA that cannot be cored (bridge decks). The designer should consider measurement by square metres separately for the surface course and underlying binder courses. A decision should be made for the surface course first. When the decision is made for the surface course to be measured by square metre, the designer should determine what lower most course may also be measured by square metre and that course and all overlying hot mix courses shall be measured by square metres. The designer may consider not using square metre items when the design lift thickness varies or changes throughout the contract.

313-1.8 COMPUTATION 313-1.8.1 Source of Information

All paving requirements with respect to hot mix types and depths including the paving of shoulders are as recommended in the Pavement Design Report and/or by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

313-1.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for hot mix types is the tonne unless the Regional Head of Quality Assurance recommends that square metre measurement be used. Each type of hot mix asphalt used on a project will be administered by a separate tender item. When the unit of measurement is the tonne, the computed tonnage for each mix type is the product of the calculated area of paving in square metres, the depth in millimetres and the mix density in kg/m²/mm; divided by 1000 kg/t. The applicable mass in kg/m²/mm for the various mix types is shown in the following table “Recommended Mix Densities for Determining Tender Tonnages”. The tender items are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items when the unit of measurement is the square metre. When the unit of measurement is the square metre, the computed area of paving for each mix type is the product of the lengths and widths of paving detailed in the contract drawings. To determine quantities for a lane that adjoins existing paving which is outside of the scope of the contract, the designer should add 50 mm to the width of paving to account for offsetting the lane demarcation 50 mm from the longitudinal joint.

April 2016 Page 13 of 15 B313-1

Page 294: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

313-1.8.3 Recommended Mix Densities for Determining Tender Tonnages

Hot Mix Asphalt Type Recommended Mix Densities unless otherwise specified by the Regional Geotechnical Section

kg/m²/mm deep (tonnes/m³) (see Note 1)

Superpave 4.75 Contact Regional Geotechnical Section

Superpave 9.5 2.410

SMA 9.5 Contact Regional Geotechnical Section

Superpave 12.5 2.460

Superpave 12.5FC 1, Superpave 12.5FC 2, and

SMA 12.5

2.390 for East Region 2.530 for West Region

2.520 for Central, North Region

Superpave 19.0 2.460

Superpave 25.0 2.500

Superpave 37.5 Contact Regional Geotechnical Section

SMA 19.0 Contact Regional Geotechnical Section

Note 1: The above densities are based on local coarse and fine aggregates except for SMA mixes, Superpave 12.5FC 1, and Superpave 12.5FC 2, which are based on typical aggregates used in that region.

313-1.9 DOCUMENTATION

The type of each hot mix used and the recommended depths (thickness) of the appropriate paving course shall be indicated on typical sections. When the unit of measure is square metres, each hot mix type will require a different tender item for each depth (lift thickness) specified. The tender item name will include a reference to the thickness specified for the lift of the hot mix type to be placed. When padding, temporary hot mix pavement or superelevation correction is required for a project, the locations and required quantities for each location where this work is to be carried out must be indicated in the contract drawings. In the case of superelevation correction, the rate of proposed superelevation must also be shown.

April 2016 Page 14 of 15 B313-1

Page 295: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT

The hot mix quantities computed for the various parts of a project are summarized on the “Quantities – Hot Mix and Granular” sheet with separate entries under the appropriate Hot Mix heading as follows: - Roadway (incl. Partial Paved Shoulders) - Commercial Entrances - Interchange Ramps - Private Entrances - Channelization Legs - Patrol Yards - Side Roads - Fully Paved Shoulders - Detours - Medians, Islands - Longitudinal Pavement Ramp Downs - Paving Under Guiderails When any of the following tender items are being used on a project, the asphalt material designated for this work must be calculated in the applicable unit of measurement and indicated under the appropriate Hot Mix item as a separate line entry on the Quantities – Hot Mix and Granular Sheet. - Asphalt Curb and Gutter - Asphalt Surfacing of Gutter - Asphalt Spillways - Asphalt Gutter Outlets - Asphalt Sidewalks - Sidewalk Resurfacing - Full Depth Crack Repair - Miscellaneous Hot Mix The calculated quantities are recorded on the “Quantities – Hot Mix and Granular” Sheets in the applicable unit of measurement, and totalled.

313-1.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Calculated hot mix quantities are recorded in tonnes or square metres to the nearest whole number. Stations are recorded to the nearest whole metre.

April 2016 Page 15 of 15 B313-1

Page 296: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 297: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT MISCELLANEOUS

B313-10 – HOT MIX ASPHALT MISCELLANEOUS – OPSS.PROV 313 313-10.1 GENERAL

The tender item Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous will apply only when areas, which require placing hot mix paving, cannot be performed by a machine and requires manual placement.

Local conditions, the type and the amount of Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous paving required should be taken into consideration to justify the use of this item.

313-10.2 REFERENCES – None 313-10.3 TENDER ITEM

Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous 313-10.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work to be performed such as placing and compacting of Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous are contained in OPSS.PROV 313.

313-10.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provision.

313-10.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS The designer should refer to the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings pertaining to this tender item.

313-10.7 DESIGN

The work of "Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous" may include the paving of the following areas. a) Ditches and side slopes

December 2014 Page 1 of 3 B313-10

Page 298: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT MISCELLANEOUS

b) Raised medians and commercial entrance islands c) Channelization islands up to a maximum of 1.50 m width from face to face of

curb and gutter d) Raised medians on expressways and high volume arterials are treated the same

way as channelization islands. e) Behind the bullnose on converging and diverging lanes on secondary highways,

high volume arterials and expressways as indicated in the Engineering Standard Drawings.

f) Paved boulevards behind curb and/or curb and gutter up to a maximum of 1.50 m

in width. g) The paving of areas unsuited to mechanical paving due to utility poles, hydrants,

signs, narrow widths etc. If the total area of miscellaneous paving on a contract is 100 m² or less, a separate tender item for Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous is not warranted. These small areas to be paved should be included in other appropriate hot mix items, by the use of a non-standard special provision. The Geotechnical Section should be contacted to specify an appropriate mix type.

313-10.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The areas to be calculated are usually scaled from the plans. The basic unit of measurement for the above tender item is square metre.

313-10.9 DOCUMENTATION

The areas of Hot Mix Asphalt Miscellaneous are to be indicated on the contract plans using the symbol as specified in the OPSD Manual. The type of Hot Mix used for miscellaneous paving and the depth of application shall be indicated on the contract plans on a typical section.

Each area is to be identified on the "Quantities - Hot Mix and Granular" sheet as a separate line entry. The calculated areas are recorded in one column under the tender

December 2014 Page 2 of 3 B313-10

Page 299: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT MIX ASPHALT MISCELLANEOUS

item and totalled. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the tender document. The tonnage of the asphalt material for this work is included under the appropriate Hot Mix item.

313-10.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Calculated areas are recorded in whole square metres. Calculated Hot Mix quantities in tonnes are recorded in whole numbers. Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

December 2014 Page 3 of 3 B313-10

Page 300: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 301: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

B314 – UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, AND STOCKPILING – OPSS.PROV 314

314.1 GENERAL

Granular materials meeting the requirements of OPSS.PROV 1010 are obtained from pits and quarries, and recycled materials. Granular A and Granular B, Type I are the materials commonly used for base and subbase, respectively. Granular O and Granular M are two alternatives for Granular A. Granular O has increased permeability and is specified where improved pavement base drainage is required. Granular M has a finer gradation and is typically used for gravel road and shoulder maintenance, and the base layer for gravel roads. Granular B, Type II and Granular B, Type III are two alternatives for Granular B, Type I. Granular B, Type II is a 100% crushed high stability material that is primarily specified for use in conjunction with rock grading. Granular B, Type III is specified where it is cost effective to avoid the use of problematic local uniformly-graded fine sands.

314.2 REFERENCES OPSS.PROV 1010, Aggregates - Base, Subbase, Select Subgrade, and Backfill Material OPSS 405, Pipe Subdrains Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways CDED B206-1, Earth Grading CDED B206-2, Rock Grading

314.3 TENDER ITEMS Unit of Measure (t) Granular A by t, Variation Granular B, Type I by t, Variation Granular B, Type II by t, Variation Granular B, Type III by t, Variation Granular M by t, Normal Granular O by t, Normal Select Subgrade Material, Compacted by t, Normal

June 2016 Page 1 of 13 B314

Page 302: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Unit of Measure (m³) - (End Area Method) Granular A (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular M (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular O (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Select Subgrade Material, Compacted (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Unit of Measure (m³) - (Truck Box Method) Granular A (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular M (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular O (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Select Subgrade Material, Compacted (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Unit of Measure (t) - Stockpiled Granular A, Stockpiled by t, Normal Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled by t, Normal Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled by t, Normal Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled by t, Normal Granular M, Stockpiled by t, Normal Granular O, Stockpiled by t, Normal Unit of Measure (m³) - Stockpiled (End Area Method) Granular A, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular M, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular O, Stockpiled (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Unit of Measure (m³) - Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) Granular A, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular M, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular O, Stockpiled (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal

June 2016 Page 2 of 13 B314

Page 303: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Unit of Measure (t) - from Stockpile Granular A, from Stockpile by t, Normal Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile by t, Normal Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile by t, Normal Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile by t, Normal Granular M, from Stockpile by t, Normal Granular O, from Stockpile by t, Normal Unit of Measure (m³) - from Stockpile (End Area Method) Granular A, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular M, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Granular O, from Stockpile (End Area Method) by m³, Normal Unit of Measure (m³) - from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) Granular A, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type I, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular B, Type III, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular M, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Granular O, from Stockpile (Truck Box Method) by m³, Normal Select Subgrade Material used to backfill swamp excavations is a different tender item. Refer to Section B209 for details.

314.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for untreated subbase, base, surface, shoulder, selected subgrade, and stockpiling are contained in OPSS.PROV 314.

314.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

314.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the OPSD 200 series.

June 2016 Page 3 of 13 B314

Page 304: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

314.7 DESIGN Typical applications for the materials are indicated in the table below. Material Typical Applications

Granular A

- Granular base for pavement structure - Shouldering - Bedding for sidewalk, curb and gutter, culvert, sewer,

gabion - Frost heave treatment

Granular B, Type I Granular B, Type II Granular B, Type III

- Granular sub-base for pavement structure - Culvert and sewer embedment / cover - Structure approach treatment backfill - Frost heave treatment - Subdrains - Drainage layer

Granular M

- Shoulder maintenance - Gravel road maintenance - Surface course (gravel roads) - Restoring unpaved roadway surfaces

Granular O - Granular base for pavement structure - Drainage layer

Select Subgrade Material, Compacted

- Backfill to excavations below subgrade for frost mitigation

- Embankment fill where local earth materials unsuitable The required thickness of roadbed granular is determined using current Ontario pavement design practices and regional experience. The type of roadbed granular is project and location specific. In some areas of the province, certain types of granular materials are used in order to avoid problem materials or to conserve materials that are in short supply for local development. In Ontario’s wet-freeze-thaw climate, pavement design for frost action is critical. Refer to Section B206-1 for typical grading practices used to mitigate frost action risk. An increase in roadbed granular depth, beyond the depth required for strength, may be necessary for some projects/locations to further mitigate frost action. Refer to the other sections of this Chapter for information on the use of granular for other applications.

June 2016 Page 4 of 13 B314

Page 305: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

314.8 COMPUTATION 314.8.1 General

These items are measured items. On most projects, the unit of measurement for all granulars is the tonne. On projects where the total quantity of granular materials is less than 5,000 tonnes, weigh scales may not be practical and the unit of measurement is the cubic metre. When computing quantities of granular subbase, base, surface, shoulder, and selected subgrade, subtotal the quantities every 350 m along the highway, service roads, sideroads, detours, ramps and entrances. For divided highways, quantities are calculated separately for each direction of travel. For projects with stage construction, granular quantities are to be determined separately for each stage of the work. Separation of quantities may also be required for left and right sides where it will clarify the quantity information. This could apply to widening projects, reconstruction projects and other work as appropriate. Drawings and cross-sections are used to establish the physical limits on which to base quantities.

314.8.2 Components of Granular Items

A. Roadbed

The three components of roadbed granular to be computed are:

1) Granular Base Granular Base is a layer of granular material generally composed of high stability graded crushed gravel or stone. It is a load bearing layer, provides drainage, a smooth riding surface for paving, and reduces frost action.

2) Granular Subbase Granular Subbase is normally a non-processed material obtained from local gravel or sand pits and is placed on the subgrade. It performs the same function as a granular base except that it can be of lower quality. In some cases, it is processed from quarries.

June 2016 Page 5 of 13 B314

Page 306: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

3) Shouldering Shouldering is the layer of granular material placed on top of the granular base material and adjacent to the pavement.

B. Backfill Refer to the respective sections of this Chapter for the computation requirements for granular backfill to structure excavations, frost heave treatments, and other applications.

C. Stockpiles Granular materials may be stockpiled for future use, or may be available for use on the project. The amount of granular material to be stockpiled, or available for use, is based on information from the regional maintenance and geotechnical staff.

314.8.3 Methods of Calculation To compute quantities, the first step is to compute the volume of compacted material required. Granular quantities are usually determined with electronic computation. However, in instances of small minor areas, it may be efficient and appropriate to use manual methods. The use of manual calculations to determine quantities is to be approved by Ministry management staff in the Planning and Design Section. Quantities are to be determined using the average end area method, except for intersections, roundabouts, parking lots, and other similar locations where other methods achieve better quantity estimates. Computer applications have many methods of calculating volumes and therefore it is important to ensure that the desired method is selected. The current version of the computer application in use with the Ministry for highway design is to be used for the design and determining granular quantities, when electronic computation is to be completed.

June 2016 Page 6 of 13 B314

Page 307: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

314.8.3.1 Tonne

If the unit of measurement is the tonne, the volume of compacted material is multiplied by the appropriate conversion factor to obtain tonnes. The geotechnical staff on the project should always be requested to confirm the conversion factors for each contract. However, default conversion factors are: Granular A Granular M Granular O

2.2 t/m3 Multiply volume (m3) of compacted granular by 2.2 to obtain tonnes(t)

Granular B, Type I Granular B, Type II Granular B, Type III

2.0 t/m3 Multiply volume (m3) of compacted granular by 2.0 to obtain tonnes(t)

Select Subgrade Material, Compacted 1.8 t/m3 Multiply volume (m3) of compacted SSM,

compacted by 1.8 to obtain tonnes(t) 314.8.3.2 Cubic Metre

If the unit of measurement is the cubic metre, the volume of material is measured in the field by either the End Area Method (i.e. volume of material in the original position in the pit), or by the Truck Box Method, as outlined in OPSS.PROV 314. These methods measure the volume of uncompacted material. To establish the volume of uncompacted material required, the designer increases the volume of the compacted material by the amounts shown below, unless otherwise specified by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Measurement Method Material Increase for Uncompacted Volume

End Area Granular 15%

Selected Subgrade 10%

Truck Box Granular 20%

Selected Subgrade 15% Granular for shoulders for resurfacing contracts are commonly overrun. A careful assessment shall be made of existing shoulder width, cross-fall, and edge of pavement drop off to obtain an accurate estimate. When the design precedes the construction by a considerable length of time, the shoulder conditions should be reviewed again just prior to award of the contract and the estimated quantities adjusted as required.

June 2016 Page 7 of 13 B314

Page 308: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

314.8.4 Contingencies and Allowances Refer to B999-A - APPENDIX “A” in this Chapter for information on the “Contingencies and Allowances” to be applied to computed quantities.

314.8.5 Source of Information The recommended depth and selection of type of granular materials to be used is the responsibility of the geotechnical staff on the project and may be found in the Pavement Design Report, Geotechnical Report and/or Soils Profile. The crossfall of granular courses and shouldering is governed by the Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways. The roadway configuration is governed by the Design Criteria.

314.9 DOCUMENTATION 314.9.1 Contract Drawings

Profiles Profile grade is preferred for identifying grade control. The types and depths of granular are shown (see below). The depths should appear at least once on each profile sheet, and at every location where there is a change in thickness. When there is a change in design granular depth due to subgrade condition, traffic loading, interchange/intersection, or other reason, the transition rate between the change in depth is to be shown. The transition rate is typically 10H:1V or as recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project.

June 2016 Page 8 of 13 B314

Page 309: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Profile Grade 150 mm Granular A Base 600 mm Granular B, Type I Subbase Subgrade

Refer to Section B206-1 and B206-2 for documentation requirements for transition treatments due to change in subgrade (eg. earth fill to rock fill transition). When it is necessary to show “top of pavement” for grade control, the types and depths of granular are shown along with the total depth of pavement, e.g.

Top of Pavement 160 mm HMA 150 mm Granular A Base 600 mm Granular B, Type I Subbase Subgrade

June 2016 Page 9 of 13 B314

Page 310: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Other methods of showing granular requirements on profile sheets are permitted, with MTO project manager approval. The types and depths of granular base and subbase are to be shown on typical sections. When standard drawings are used to indicate granular base requirements, then the types and depths are to be shown in a tabular format in the contract drawings. References to granular material on contract drawings should, where applicable, include the term ‘base’, ‘subbase’, ‘surface’, ‘shoulder’, ‘selected subgrade’, and ‘stockpiling’, consistent with the specification terminology.

314.9.2 Quantity Sheets – Roadbed Quantities Roadbed granular quantities are broken down into the following components: Main Highway Service Roads Side Roads Ramps Detours Commercial Entrances Private Entrances These quantities are included as separate entries on the Quantities - Hot Mix and Granular sheet. The quantities are to include backfill quantities to transition treatments. The quantity interval is work type specific and is to be established by the MTO project manager, based on the following: a) New Construction / Pavement Reconstruction - quantities are entered every 350 m

(or less, where applicable) road length, by station limits, matching the interval used on Grading Q-sheets.

b) Pavement Rehabilitation - quantities are entered every 700 m (or less, where

applicable) road length, by station limits. c) Pavement Resurfacing - granular is typically required for shouldering only. At

least one shouldering granular quantity is entered for each direction of travel. Where the project has multiple work types, the interval may vary for different areas of the project depending on the work type. Quantity separation may be required for left and right sides to clarify the quantity information. This could apply to widening projects and other work as appropriate.

June 2016 Page 10 of 13 B314

Page 311: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Granular A and Granular B, Type I, Type II, and Type III, when paid by the tonne, are variation items. The variation is the type of application. The variations and the application description are selected by the designer. Typical application descriptions include Base, Subbase, Surface, Shoulder, Backfill, Bedding. The quantities for each variation are entered on separate Q-sheet columns. If the unit of measurement is in cubic metres, then the item containing "(End Area Method)" or "(Truck Box Method)" as appropriate is selected. See CPS item master file for exact item description. If a portion of the granular material will be supplied by the Ministry from an existing stockpile(s), the quantity is included in the Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Ministry, and the designer will choose a general granular item description (e.g: Granular B, Type II). If all of the granular material will be supplied by the Ministry, from an existing stockpile(s), the quantity is included in the Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Ministry, and the designer should use a "... from Stockpile" item (e.g: Granular B, Type II, from Stockpile). “Granular…, Stockpiled” items require a separate entry per stockpile location. Select Subgrade Material, Compacted is entered on the Quantities - Hot Mix and Granular sheet in its own column(s) separate from the others. Where the existing driving lanes are to be excavated for the installation of pipes etc., the roadbed must be reinstated with appropriate granular subbase and base depths and types as recommended by the geotechnical staff on the project. The work is further detailed in the applicable sections of this chapter. The granular quantities, above subgrade only, required for the roadbed reinstatement are included with the roadbed quantities. The tender totals for each of the granular items listed in this section are transferred to the tender documentation.

314.9.3 Quantity Sheets – Other Granular When granular quantities for other components of the work are to be included, the quantity is first entered in a granular quantity column on the quantity sheet for the work component, and the total transferred to the Quantities - Hot Mix and Granular sheet. Refer to the CDED sections listed for further information.

June 2016 Page 11 of 13 B314

Page 312: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

Other granular quantities are to be entered on the Quantities - Hot Mix and Granular sheet as follows: Work Component / Item Ref Q-Sheet Description Column Note

Drainage Gaps B206-1 Drainage Gaps Backfill One line entry / contract

Frost Heave Treatment B206-1 Frost Heave Treatment Backfill, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / treatment

Swamp Backfill B209 Backfill to Swamp, Sta. to Sta. One line entry / swamp

Wick Drains B209 Wick Drains Granular Blanket, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / wick drains area

Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment

B316 Expanded Polystyrene Treatment Backfill, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / treatment

Asphalt Sidewalk B311 Asphalt Sidewalk Base One line entry / contract

Concrete Sidewalk B351 Concrete Sidewalk Base One line entry / contract

Subdrains (Note 1) B405 Subdrain Bedding, Embedment, and Backfill

One line entry / contract

Precast Box Culvert B422 Precast Box Culvert Bedding and Backfill, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / culvert

Precast Box Sewer B422 Precast Box Sewer Bedding and Backfill, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / sewer

Removals B510 Removals Backfill One line entry / contract

Gabion Structures B512 Gabion Structure Bedding, Sta. to Sta.

One line entry / structure

Concrete Barrier B740 Separated Concrete Barrier, Granular Fill

One line entry / contract

Earth Excavation for Structure

B902 “Structure Name”, Bedding and Backfill

One line entry / structure

Rock Excavation for Structure

B902 “Structure Name”, Bedding and Backfill

One line entry / structure

Note: 1. When the specified granular embedment and backfill material for the subdrain is

different from the granular items in the contract, the granular embedment and backfill material is included with the subdrain item. Refer to OPSS 405.

June 2016 Page 12 of 13 B314

Page 313: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

UNTREATED SUBBASE, BASE, SURFACE, DETAIL ESTIMATING SHOULDER, SELECTED SUBGRADE, & STOCKPILING

314.9.4 Documentation Accuracy All quantities are rounded to whole numbers.

314.9.5 Non-Standard Special Provisions Write project and item specific requirements in a NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that may require a NSSP include: • Details on locations for granular to be stockpiled or to be taken from stockpiles,

including contact names, advance notification, etc • Granular surcharge placement and compaction, timing, and removal requirements • Changes to compaction requirements eg. over soft ground • Where alternative materials are required or allowed (e.g. lightweight granular

blast furnace slag) • Re-use of existing granular that is to be excavated • Staged construction and traffic management using granular materials • Gradation changes required for specific applications

June 2016 Page 13 of 13 B314

Page 314: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 315: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXTRUDED EXPANDED POLYSTYRENE TREATMENT

May 2008 Pg. 1 of 3 B316

B316 - EXTRUDED EXPANDED POLYSTYRENE TREATMENT - OPSS 316

316.1 GENERAL

Frost heaving is caused by freezing temperatures acting on frost susceptible soil and free water below subgrade. The combination of these factors results in the formation of frost lenses which by expanding upward may cause substantial and costly damage in the pavement structure. Frost heave damage is particularly severe on roads in the northern part of the Province.

The placing of extruded expanded polystyrene sheets over frost susceptible soil prevents the penetration of frost beyond a predetermined depth. When it is decided to treat a frost heave without excavating, polystyrene is placed right on the surface of the existing pavement and covered with granular.

While polystyrene may not completely correct the frost heave problem, it should provide an improved ride as well as reduce the incidence of differential icing.

To reduce the effects of frost heaving in the area of the shoulder, the insulation is placed beyond the pavement width on to the shoulder.

316.2 REFERENCES – None

316.3 TENDER ITEM

Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment

316.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment are contained in OPSS 316.

316.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The Designer shall refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

316.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Standard drawings giving details of Polystyrene Treatment are contained in the OPSD 500 series.

316.7 DESIGN

The designer shall specify the following in the Contract Documents:

- Grade and compressive strength of the insulation

Page 316: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXTRUDED EXPANDED POLYSTYRENE TREATMENT

May 2008 Pg. 2 of 3 B316

- Excavation limits - Insulation thickness and area to be treated - Minimum depth of cover of granular base or subbase material to be placed over the extruded expanded polystyrene to allow for construction traffic

Typical treatments are 25 mm in Southern Ontario and 40 mm in Northern Ontario. Increasing the thickness of insulation may result in an increased risk of differential icing.

Due to differential icing concerns with extruded expanded polystyrene frost heave treatments, the designer should consider limiting this type of treatment to tangent sections avoiding curves, crests of hills, and intersections. Regional Geotechnical section should be consulted for alternative treatment recommendations.

316.7.1 Source of Information

The Regional Geotechnical Section will recommend locations where Extruded Expanded Polystyrene for frost heave treatment is to be placed. The type of polystyrene as well as the depth of granular cover will also be directed by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

316.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

316.8.1 Methods of Calculation

The unit for this tender item is square metre.

The area to be treated is based on the total length and width, measured horizontally, as per applicable standard.

316.9 DOCUMENTATION

All locations of extruded expanded polystyrene treatments are to be indicated on the contract drawings by stations.

The depth to the bottom of polystyrene below profile grade should be indicated by a note on the contract drawings.

The neat calculated quantities are transferred from the calculation sheets to the Quantities - Miscellaneous Sheet. Separate columns with the applicable standard number are required for individual polystyrene thicknesses. Quantity entries are made for each area (station to station) to be treated. Entries in each column are totalled. All column totals are combined to one total. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the tender documentation.

Page 317: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXTRUDED EXPANDED POLYSTYRENE TREATMENT

May 2008 Pg. 3 of 3 B316

The following tender items may be required with the placing of Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Treatment.

(a) Earth Excavation (Grading) (b) Granulars (c) Hot Mix or other pavement materials (d) Removal of Asphalt Pavement

The computation and documentation procedure of these tender items can be found in the appropriate sections in Chapter "B" of this manual.

316.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Quantities are recorded to the nearest whole number.

Page 318: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 319: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING OPEN GRADED DRAINAGE LAYER

B320 - OPEN GRADED DRAINAGE LAYER - OPSS.PROV 320 320.1 GENERAL

Open Graded Drainage Layer is a highly permeable layer which is covered by a concrete pavement, concrete base or a hot mix asphalt pavement, and overlies a granular base course.

The design of all composite and concrete pavements should utilize an OGDL. OGDLs should be reviewed for use on all major arterial and expressway projects with composite and concrete pavements and may be considered for deep strength flexible pavements.

The thickness of the OGDL should be 100 mm. The unit weight of OGDL is 1.7 t/m³. The OGDL is assigned the same structural value as a granular base.

320.2 REFERENCES

CDED B405 – Pipe Subdrain 320.3 TENDER ITEM

Open Graded Drainage Layer by m², normal, PQP 320.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the above tender item are contained in OPSS.PROV 320. 320.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

320.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 200 series.

April 2016 Page 1 of 2 B320

Page 320: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING OPEN GRADED DRAINAGE LAYER

320.7 DESIGN

OGDL must be drained by an edgedrain collector system, such as a conventional pipe subdrain backfilled with OGDL aggregate, wrapped in geotextile, which is in direct contact with the OGDL. Refer to CDED B405 for design and documentation requirements for pipe subdrain.

320.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. 320.8.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender item is in the Pavement Design Report.

320.8.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for Open Graded Drainage Layer is by the square metre. Quantities are calculated based on area calculations using the OGDL station to station limits and edge to edge widths.

320.9 DOCUMENTATION

OGDL locations are documented by station to station limits on Quantities – Hot Mix and Granular quantity sheet(s). The calculated square metre quantity is entered in the appropriate column. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

320.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Areas are recorded in whole metres. Stations are recorded to the nearest whole metre.

April 2016 Page 2 of 2 B320

Page 321: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAMATION OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT

B330 - IN PLACE FULL DEPTH RECLAMATION OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT AND UNDERLYING GRANULAR - OPSS 330

330.1 GENERAL

The work of in-place full depth reclamation consists of pulverizing the existing pavement, mixing the processed material with the underlying granular base, shaping and compacting the material to the final grades specified in the contract.

The processed depth shall be such that the blended material shall contain a maximum of 50% by mass of asphalt coated aggregate.

In locations where the bituminous pavement depth is equal to or greater than 150 mm, the total maximum processing depth shall be 300 mm, which includes the portion of granular base. This process thoroughly mixes the individual pavement layers into a relatively homogeneous mixture that is compacted as granular base. An appropriate pavement surface can then be applied.

Appearance and performance for the in-place processed material is similar to conventional granular base course material. The operation of full depth reclamation shall ensure that all of the mixed material passes the 26.5 mm sieve and not more than 75% passes the 4.75 mm sieve.

330.2 REFERENCES - None

330.3 TENDER ITEM

In-Place Full Depth Reclamation of Bituminous Pavement and Underlying Granular

330.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for in-place full depth reclamation of bituminous pavement and underlying granular are contained in OPSS 330.

330.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

February 2012 Pg. 1 of 4 B330

Page 322: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAMATION OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT

330.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no Ministry standard drawings directly applicable to this type of work however the 200 series OPSD's may be used to determine roadway crossfalls, etc.

330.7 DESIGN

This item is used when the existing pavement or portion of existing pavement depth is not required or suitable for recycling purposes, as well as achieving current material management procedures.

This item may also be used in conjunction with reclaiming existing pavement required for use in recycling. In this case, the depth of existing pavement to be reclaimed to a partial depth must be specified and the residual depth will be in-place processed to its full depth.

Cold mix widening and asphalt curb and gutter may be included and reclaimed with the underlying granular to the widths specified in the contract.

330.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

This is a variation item.

330.8.1 Source of Information

The source of information for the above tender item is the Regional Geotechnical Section, Pavement Design Report, soils borings and asphalt pavement core logs, and original cross sections.

330.8.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for new pavement, including the existing partially paved and fully paved shoulders, being in-place processed is the area in square metres based on horizontal measurements.

February 2012 Pg. 2 of 4 B330

Page 323: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAMATION OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT

330.9 DOCUMENTATION

The station to station limits and offsets for this work are to be shown on the quantity sheets together with the appropriate areas in square metres.

In complicated layout locations the areas may be symbolized on the detailed drawings.

A typical section is required indicating the road widths to be in place processed. On projects with no new full or partially paved shoulders, the roadway widths to be processed should be such that the minimum width is equal to the new pavement width or as specified by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

On projects with existing full or partially paved shoulders, or where full or partially paved shoulders are being introduced, the roadway widths to be processed should be such that the minimum width is equal to the new pavement width including partially paved and fully paved shoulder, or as specified by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

The existing pavement depth must also be included in the documents in the form of soils borings for bidder information, in order to determine the processing depths. In the absence of available soils borings, pavement cores, or ground penetrating radar graphs, a table must be included in the drawings denoting the various pavement depths throughout the work area. This table may also be used to illustrate road widths to be processed. When reclaiming asphalt pavement partial depth is required, then only the residual pavement depth to be in-place processed to its full depth will be specified.

The existing asphalt pavement may be reclaimed full depth in lieu of in place full depth reclamation at identified locations in the contract. This is identified by notes on the q-sheet

At the identified option locations, the existing asphalt pavement shall be reinstated with Granular ‘A’ at the Contractor's expense. Reinstatement shall not be required within excavation locations.

Following full depth reclaiming of the existing asphalt pavement, the roadway granular and reinstated shoulders shall be restored according to the requirements of OPSS 301.

Payment and measurement for reclaiming asphalt pavement full depth in lieu of in place full depth reclamation and restoring of shoulders shall be made at the bid price for In Place Full Depth Reclamation of Bituminous Pavement and Underlying Granular.

February 2012 Pg. 3 of 4 B330

Page 324: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAMATION OF BITUMINOUS PAVEMENT

330.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Station locations are required to the nearest metre accuracy, and offsets to the nearest 0.1 metre.

Areas are calculated to the nearest whole metre.

February 2012 Pg. 4 of 4 B330

Page 325: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION

B331 - FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION - OPSS.PROV 331

331.1 GENERAL

The work of Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization consists of in-place full-depth reclamation of the existing hot mix asphalt (HMA) and underlying granular base. The reclaimed material is shaped, compacted and then stabilized in-place by the addition of expanded asphalt. The stabilized material is then graded to the required profile and compacted. Following a minimum three-day curing period, the stabilized base is overlaid with HMA. Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization should be considered for roads that are severely cracked and structurally inadequate.

331.2 REFERENCES - None 331.3 TENDER ITEM

Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization 331.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work are contained in OPSS 331. 331.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of the CDED Manual to review the applicable special provisions.

331.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings directly applicable to this type of work.

November 2015 Page 1 of 5 B331

Page 326: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION

331.7 DESIGN 331.7.1 Geotechnical Design Considerations

The processing depth should target approximately 50% by mass of asphalt coated particles. The extent that the existing granular material contains asphalt coated particles should be considered when determining the processing depth. Where project conditions will result in a blended material significantly greater than 50% by mass of asphalt coated particles, the designer should reduce adjust the minimum amount of expanded asphalt to be added. The amount of expanded asphalt to be added (design rate) is calculated using the following formula: Design rate of expanded asphalt = 0.04 x uncoated aggregate particles (% by mass) + 0.015 x asphalt coated particles (% by mass) For example, the design rate for a mix with 50% uncoated particles and 50% asphalt coated particles is 0.04 x 50% + 0.015 x 50% = 2.75%. Typical reclamation equipment has a total maximum processing depth of 300 mm. A maximum of 50% of the total maximum processing depth may be existing asphalt. This means that, in locations where the bituminous pavement depth is greater than 150 mm, milling of the existing asphalt pavement to a thickness of 150 mm or less is required prior to in-place full-depth reclamation. Alternatively, larger pavement thicknesses may be more suited to cold in-place recycling (CIR) or cold in-place recycling with expanded asphalt (CIREAM). Refer to CDED B510-5 for documentation requirements for milling (asphalt pavement removal, partial-depth). For projects with variation in existing asphalt pavement thicknesses, different pulverizing depths should be considered by clustering the pavement into segments of similar asphalt pavement thickness, and the design rate of expanded asphalt calculated for each segment accordingly. Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization is meant to be a two-step process so that road profile and cross-fall can be corrected in the first pass, i.e. pulverizing and reshaping the road profile. In the second pass, expanded asphalt is added to stabilize the granular base and reclaimed material. A one step process using recycling train similar to CIR or CIREAM process is available and is commonly used, however it allows only minor cross-fall correction (<0.5%). The widths required for in-place processing are often wider than the widths required for stabilization with expanded asphalt. The Geotechnical section may recommend and designers should consider processing without stabilization existing tapers or

November 2015 Page 2 of 5 B331

Page 327: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION

paved shoulders, or where tapers or paved shoulders are being introduced. In some cases, granular shoulders are also processed without stabilization. Full width processing will ensure similar performance and drainage of the granular material. Following the in-place processing, expanded asphalt stabilization is typically only performed for full-lane pavement widths. Any required grading should be carried out as part of the in-place processing operation and not during the expanded asphalt stabilization process. Cold mix widening, full-depth curve widening, and asphalt curb and gutter may be processed with the underlying granular. The stabilized layer will gain strength over time and will perform similar to an asphalt binder layer, and one layer of hot mix overlying as wearing course may be sufficient, depending on traffic loading and design parameters To date, surface treatment and micro-surfacing have not been used as the wearing surface. Heavy traffic is not recommended on the processed surface before it has cured and been sealed with a wearing course. The wearing surface must be placed during the same construction season. The designer should be aware that the length of the recycling operation may affect traffic management. A typical recycling train may extend up to 80m long.

331.7.2 Pre-Engineering Investigation This section describes procedures and tests to be carried out during pre-engineering investigations on potential Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization projects. Adequate pre-engineering must be carried out to establish existing pavement thicknesses and composition. Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR) is a useful method of providing more frequent measurement for the thicknesses of the asphalt and the underlying granular layers. This information is required for the designer to determine the processing depth, and the blend proportion of uncoated and asphalt coated particles, and to determine whether pre-milling is required. Field investigation is required to determine the pavement condition and distress manifestations. The borehole layout and drilling protocol should follow the applicable regional geotechnical investigation guideline.

November 2015 Page 3 of 5 B331

Page 328: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION

331.7.3 Other Design Considerations The work requires the use of a pilot vehicle as part of the process. The regional traffic section should be consulted regarding the deletion of the pilot vehicle requirement if the work is on a freeway. A pre-engineering mix design is recommended during the pre-engineering investigation stage to confirm the in-situ materials are suitable for stabilization, and to determine whether corrective aggregate or additive would be required for the mix to meet the minimum tensile strength requirement.

331.7.4 Information to be Provided to Bidders The existing pavement depth must be included in the documents in the form of soils borings, pavement cores, or ground penetrating radar graphs. In the absence of soils borings, pavement cores, or ground penetrating radar graphs, a table shall be included in the drawings denoting the existing pavement depths throughout the work area.

331.8 COMPUTATION 331.8.1 Source of Information

Requirements are as recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

331.8.2 Method of Calculation

Full-Depth Reclamation with Expanded Asphalt Stabilization This is a plan quantity payment item. Areas in square metres may be measured or scaled from plans.

331.9 DOCUMENTATION 331.9.1 Contract Drawings

In complicated layout locations, the areas may be symbolized on the contract drawings. Drawing details may be required, for example where the limits of reclamation (in-place processing) and stabilization do not coincide. Typical sections are required indicating the road widths and depths to be in-place processed and the widths and depths of expanded asphalt stabilization. Staged typical sections may be required to fully detail the work, for example when the addition of granular is required to correct crossfall and/or superelevation.

November 2015 Page 4 of 5 B331

Page 329: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FULL-DEPTH RECLAMATION WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT STABILIZATION

331.9.2 Q-Sheets

The station to station limits and offsets for this work is to be shown on the ‘Quantities – Hot mix and Granular’ sheets together with the corresponding areas in square metres. A separate line entry should be initiated in any location where the stabilization depth changes.

331.9.3 Documentation Accuracy

Station locations are required to the nearest metre accuracy, and offsets to the nearest 0.1 metre. Areas are calculated to the nearest whole square metre.

November 2015 Page 5 of 5 B331

Page 330: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 331: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

B332 - HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING - OPSS 332 332.1 GENERAL

Use of Hot In-Place Recycled Mix (HIR) is recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section on a work project specific basis. The HIR process involves heating and partial depth hot milling the existing asphalt pavement; sizing; mixing with beneficiating hot mix asphalt (HMA) or rejuvenating agent or both; relaying; and compacting the recycled hot bituminous mixture in-place in one single operation. HIR is limited to resurface pavements exhibiting only surficial distresses. HIR should be considered for roads with the following distress manifestations: - very slight to moderate ravelling / coarse aggregate loss, segregation, very slight

to moderate flushing, and/or distortions - few to frequent very slight to moderate non-working cracks - for 2 lane highways up to 1.0% correction in crossfall can be achieved across a

single lane width using HIR, provided there are no bridge clearance or grade raise restrictions

- for multi-lane highways correction of crossfall with HIR is not recommended HIR is not suitable for pavements exhibiting structural distresses, i.e. alligator cracking, lack of structural capacity, working cracks, severe distortions, and/or instability rutting. HIR is not suitable for pavements exhibiting severe or very severe ravelling / coarse aggregate loss due to stripping. HIR is not permitted for use on bridge decks; therefore, if the contract contains multiple bridges that require paving, the designer should consider whether stopping and starting the HIR process at each bridge is acceptable for the contract. HIR is recommended only for existing flexible pavements, excluding SMA, with a minimum asphalt pavement thickness of 70 mm. The specified HIR lift thickness is 40 mm to a maximum of 50 mm (including any beneficiating HMA). The measured lift thickness is the actual lift thickness of the HIR placed and may or may not be equal to the hot milling depth. A minimum of 25 mm of existing asphalt pavement should be maintained below the HIR. The HIR process shall not be used to recycle SMA or composite pavements.

November 2016 Page 1 of 10 B332

Page 332: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

HIR must be placed in warm, dry weather; and therefore, HIR contracts should be tendered such that the HIR work can be carried out between May 15th and October 15th, inclusive. The designer should note that HIR equipment may be restricted to a specific processing width. The equipment is usually able to process a width of up to 4.0 m. This could restrict the use of HIR with partially paved shoulders. However, the placement width is similar to that of a conventional paver, and partially paved shoulders that cannot be removed along with the lane, due to the restricted processing width, could be removed conventionally ahead of the HIR operation to allow the new partially paved shoulder to be placed in conjunction with the lane. Partially paved shoulders that cannot be accommodated as part of the lane placement width and fully paved shoulders, if these are to be HIR, require a separate pass of the HIR equipment. HIR is usually considered for projects at least 20 lane-kilometres, including fully paved shoulders. Partially paved shoulders and pavement widening can be retrofitted using this process. Advance grading and compaction of the shoulders is required as well as beneficiating HMA to make up the extra being placed on the shoulders or in pavement widening. Refer to CDED B206-3 for design and documentation requirements for excavation for pavement widening. A properly designed and constructed HIR resurfacing has a minimum life expectancy of approximately 9-10 years on a non-freeway and 8-9 years on a freeway. Until sufficient cost data is available in the MTO HiCo database, when estimating the cost of the HIR item, it is recommended to use a value 10% lower than the equivalent HMA item (i.e., if specifying 40 mm of HIR that must meet Superpave 12.5FC 1 requirements use a unit cost 10% lower than that of the 40 mm of Superpave 12.5FC 1 square metre item).

332.2 REFERENCES CDED B206-3, Excavation for Pavement Widening CDED B308, Tack Coat CDED B313-1, Hot Mix Asphalt CDED B510-5, Removal - Pavement Work

332.3 TENDER ITEMS Hot In-Place Recycled Mix (normal, m², PQP)

November 2016 Page 2 of 10 B332

Page 333: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

332.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for Hot In-Place Recycling are contained in OPSS 332.

332.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter E of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

332.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - none

332.7 DESIGN 332.7.1 Information to be provided to Bidders

• Asphalt core test results and analysis (see Pre-Engineering Section 332.7.3) • Geotechnical borehole data • ARAN Pavement Condition Report (in one direction, for the lane on which the

ARAN survey was conducted). The ARAN Pavement Condition Report should include: o Average International Roughness Index (IRI) o Average rut depth o Average crossfall o Measurements of longitudinal, transverse, and alligator cracking

• Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR), if available • Estimated quantities of:

o Crack sealant in linear metres o Cold mix in square metres, and o Spray patch in square metres, if available.

When the work includes pavement crossfall and/or superelevation correction, cross section templates for the areas to be corrected shall be provided.

332.7.2 Geotechnical Design Considerations If a pavement crossfall correction > 1.0% is required at only a few localized areas, it should be adjusted by patching or milling methods instead of during the HIR operation. Generally, milling should be kept to a minimum to avoid the existing binder course pavement materials being hot milled and added to the HIR mix, since the existing binder course may not always be of the same quality as the existing surface course, and for this reason, HIR is not recommended when crossfall correction is required at more than a few locations.

November 2016 Page 3 of 10 B332

Page 334: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

Tack coat is required prior to HMA paving of HIR surfaces. Refer to CDED B308 for design and documentation requirements for tack coat. HIR of pavement with crack sealant and/or surface maintenance treatments may result in excess smoke generation. The following guidelines are suggested for addressing sealed and treated pavements: - Generally, crack sealant and cold mix patches should be removed prior to HIR. A

small amount of crack sealant may not affect the HIR. The Regional Geotechnical Section should provide removal recommendations.

- Localized surficial maintenance treatments, such as chip seal and spray patches,

greater than 4 m² in area should be removed prior to HIR. In urban areas, the designer should be aware of appurtenance and adjustment requirements, curb heights, and accessibility concerns to accommodate the HIR equipment train and the requirement for traffic detours. At intersections, the main lanes and turn lanes of significant length (greater than 300 m) should be HIR. Different treatments (i.e., removal and replace with acceptable surface course HMA) may be applied to shorter turn tapers, irregularly shaped pavement areas, entrances, etc. The designer should be aware that the length of the HIR operation may affect traffic management. A 1 kilometre rolling closure is typical for the HIR operation. While HIR should be limited to pavements with only surficial distresses, if any full depth repairs are required for frost heave and/or distortion corrections, these should be repaired with HMA prior to HIR. To avoid having a new pavement with a patched appearance, HIR through these repairs after they are completed, unless a repair is greater than 100 m long, in which case these large repairs should be skipped during the HIR operation. Full depth repairs are to be managed elsewhere in the contract. For design purposes, HIR should be compared to the following conventional technique to address non-structural surficial distresses: 1) 50 mm HIR vs. mill 30 mm, and place 50 mm surface course 2) 40 mm HIR vs. place 40 mm surface course

November 2016 Page 4 of 10 B332

Page 335: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

332.7.3 Pre-Engineering Investigation 332.7.3.1 General

This section describes procedures and tests to be carried out during pre-engineering contract investigations on potential Ministry HIR projects. It is recommended that adequate pre-engineering be carried out to establish existing pavement thicknesses and composition. Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR) is a useful method of providing more frequent measurement of the asphalt thickness during the pavement investigation phase. Additional investigation should be carried out where pavement composition changes, such as patched areas. This information is required for the designer to determine whether the existing pavement, on potential projects, meets the minimum thickness requirements, if HIR can be used to meet the acceptance criteria, and to assist the designer in selecting the thickness of HIR. A field investigation is required to determine the existing pavement condition, crossfall, IRI, distress manifestations, and the presence of crack sealant and/or patches.

332.7.3.2 Selection of Coring Locations 1. A minimum of one sampling location per kilometre plus a minimum of one

sampling location wherever the existing surface course is known or suspected of having mixes which are different or have significantly differing properties (i.e. a separate core should be taken for patches that will be incorporated into the HIR mix).

2. It is recommended that a minimum of five 150 mm cores be taken at each

sampling location in order to obtain enough material to complete the core testing requirements. Alternatively, more than five smaller cores or a slab of surface course may be taken as long as an equivalent amount of material is obtained at each core location.

3. Cores shall be taken not less than 0.5 m from the edges of the pavement of the

main lanes and in areas representative of the overall pavement condition. Sampling locations should be random.

4. Cores should extend to a minimum depth of one lift of HMA below the

anticipated HIR depth. 5. Where additional asphalt pavement is required for testing purposes, the additional

material shall be obtained from adjacent cores taken at the same locations.

November 2016 Page 5 of 10 B332

Page 336: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

6. Testing of cores should be conducted to determine the requirements of core

testing as listed below. 332.7.3.3 Requirements of Core Testing

For each asphalt pavement core the following in-situ quantities should be provided for the depth of the existing asphalt pavement which is to be HIR: - existing lift thicknesses (LS-294), - existing aggregate gradation and AC content (LS-282, LS-291, or LS-292), - actual recovered asphalt cement (RAC) performance grade (LS-284, AASHTO

M 320, and AASHTO R 29), - mass per cubic metre (AASHTO T 166, T 312, LS-264), and - air voids (LS-265). The asphalt core test results documentation shall include the location and date of coring.

332.7.3.4 Analysis of Core Data The following information is given for estimating purposes only. HIR can be considered a suitable resurfacing treatment for a project where the tested cores meet the following guidelines: 1. The existing aggregate gradation should meet the gradation requirements of a

Superpave 12.5, Superpave 12.5FC 1, Superpave 12.5FC 2, or be close enough that a reasonable amount of beneficiating HMA could be added to meet these requirements.

2. The RAC performance grade from the extracted AC of the existing asphalt

pavement can achieve the target performance grade using the blending calculations in AASHTO M 323 for rejuvenator products and new PGAC added to a beneficiating HMA. Consult with the Bituminous Section as required.

3. Average in-situ air voids of: > 4.5% beneficiating HMA is normally not required, ≤ 4.5% and > 2.0% beneficiating HMA may be required, and ≤ 2.0% expect beneficiating HMA to be required.

November 2016 Page 6 of 10 B332

Page 337: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

Generally in-situ air voids are between 2.0 and 2.5% for asphalt pavements 10 to 15 years old.

4. The existing pavement conditions should not vary greatly from one core to the next. As a guideline, the existing pavement properties in each lot (approximately 5 km) should be within 1 Standard Deviation (both on +/- sides) of the specified tolerances for AC content, gradation (payment sieve sizes), etc. (cores taken in patches should be excluded).

For example, consider the following as the first lot of core test results:

Sample Station

DLS 4.75 mm 75 µm Air Voids

Lift Thickness

AC Content

RAC Performance Grade

XX -YY

1+000 85.2 54.1 6.0 1.1 57.6 5.26 63.1 -25.1

2+000 82.7 49.0 5.4 2.5 39.0 5.00 65.5 -25.5

3+000 77.1 40.5 5.3 1.4 50.0 3.66 55.2 -14.9

4+000 83.2 52.8 5.3 2.6 38.7 5.08 64.2 -30.8

5+000 84.8 47.8 5.0 1.3 31.9 4.81 72.9 -17.5

Average 82.6 48.8 5.4 1.8 43.4 4.76 64.2 -22.8

Standard Deviation

3.25 5.34 0.37 0.71 10.23 0.637 6.32 6.46

Specified Tolerances

40 to 95 40 to 65 2 to 13 2.0 to 5.5 Design Thickness - 10

ACspec - 0.2 to ACspec + 0.5

≥ XX - 3 ≤ -YY + 6

In this example the first lot’s existing pavement conditions can meet the specified tolerances for HIR as explained below: The DLS sieve’s lot average gradation is 82.6 which is within the 40-95 specified. The 4.75 mm sieve’s average gradation is 48.8 which is within the 40-65 specified. The 75 µm sieve’s average gradation is 5.4 which is within the 2-13 specified. The air voids lot average is 1.8% which does NOT meet the 2.0-5.5 specified, BUT the average is within 1 standard deviation of the specified tolerances (1.8 + 0.71 = 2.51). Therefore, the air voids are close enough for the HIR process with beneficiating HMA to bring them back within the specified tolerances. The lift thickness lot average is 43.4 mm which would indicate a 40 mm HIR design lift thickness would be appropriate. Individual results should be more than the design thickness - 10 mm (40 - 10 = 30 mm). One or two results below the minimum may still be acceptable with the use of beneficiating HMA. In this example, the lowest value was 31.9 mm, which is still above the minimum 30 mm; however, if the design thickness was 50 mm, then over half the lot

November 2016 Page 7 of 10 B332

Page 338: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

(3 cores) would be below the minimum 40 mm, and if 50 mm is required, a grade raise with beneficiating HMA or another strategy other than HIR should be considered. The AC content lot average is 4.76%, if the AC specified was 4.2 then the lower limit would be 4.0 and the upper limit would be 4.7 and this AC content would NOT be within the specified tolerances, BUT the average is within 1 standard deviation (4.76 - 0.637 = 4.123). Therefore, the AC content is close enough for the HIR process with rejuvenating agent or beneficiating HMA to bring it back within the specified tolerances. The RAC performance grade lot average is 64.2-22.8, if the RAC performance grade specified was 58-28 then the specified tolerances for the high temperature would be ≥ XX-3 (58 - 3 = 55) and for the low temperature ≤ -YY+6 (-28 + 6 = -22). Since the high temperature grade (64.2) is higher than the specified 58 it is already acceptable as is. The low temperature grade (-22.8) is less than the specified -28, BUT greater than the tolerance of -22 and the average is within 1 standard deviation of the specified low temperature (-22.8 - 6.46 = -29.3). Therefore, the RAC performance grade is close enough for the HIR process with rejuvenating agent or beneficiating HMA to bring it back within the specified acceptance criteria. Each lot’s average existing pavement properties should be checked, as shown above, to be within 1 standard deviation of the specified tolerances.

When the RAC performance grade of the existing pavement is close to the required performance grade, only small quantities (if any) of rejuvenating agent will be required. The quantity of rejuvenating agent added to the mix decreases the existing air voids proportionally; therefore, the lower the RAC performance grade and air voids in the existing pavement, the more likely beneficiating HMA will be required to get the HIR mix to meet the contract specifications.

332.8 COMPUTATION 332.8.1 Source of Information

Project requirements with respect to patch or sealant removal, mix requirements, HIR depths, asphalt core analysis, and treatment of shoulders are recommended in the Pavement Design Report.

332.8.2 Method of Calculation Hot In-Place Recycled Mix is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

November 2016 Page 8 of 10 B332

Page 339: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

The unit of measurement for HIR is square metres. The computed square metre quantity is the product of the lengths and widths of paving. Base plans, previous contracts, survey data, or other suitable information may be used to calculate quantities. The item includes the following work: completing the HIR mix design(s) and the supply of rejuvenating agent and/or beneficiating HMA as required for the HIR mix. No quantity calculations are required by the designer for the rejuvenating agent and beneficiating HMA materials.

332.9 DOCUMENTATION 332.9.1 Contract Drawings

Paving limits and the thickness of HIR courses, including for shoulders, shall be clearly indicated on the plans and typical sections, as applicable. Partial depth asphalt removal and HMA thicknesses shall be noted on the drawings for all areas considered inaccessible or impractical for HIR, such as private and commercial entrances, side roads, tapers, ramps, channelization, shoulders, and miscellaneous areas to be paved. Refer to CDED B510-5 and B313-1 for the design and documentation requirements for partial depth asphalt removal and HMA, respectively. Lane and paved shoulder widths shall be indicated on the plans and typical sections. When pavement widening is required, the existing lane, new lane, and paved shoulder widths shall be indicated. A detail of the widening may be required. Where crossfall and superelevation are being corrected, the surface course crossfall and superelevation shall be shown on the typical sections. A note should be added to the typical sections stating that crossfall corrections are to be done with the HIR operation. Where the crossfall and superelevation is being maintained, the crossfall shall be shown as “1.5% – 3.0%” on tangent typical sections and “Existing Superelevation” on superelevation typical sections.

332.9.2 Quantity Sheets The Quantities-Miscellaneous breakdown sheet shall be used to record quantities. Each area quantity of HIR is shown on one row. For each area, indicate the start and end chainage in the location column.

November 2016 Page 9 of 10 B332

Page 340: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HOT IN-PLACE RECYCLING

Areas that may be inaccessible to the HIR equipment are still included in the HIR quantity. In inaccessible areas, the specification requires removal of the existing pavement and replacement with hot mix, and work is paid for under the HIR item.

332.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Calculated HIR quantities in square metres are recorded to the nearest whole number. Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

332.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions The following non-standard special provisions shall be included with the Contract Documents: A non-standard special provision is required detailing the additional sampling, testing, and requirements for RAC (modified version of SSP 111F09 – consult with MERO Bituminous Section). A non-standard special provision is required detailing the requirements for the materials, equipment, and processes for proportioning and mixing HIR according to the Superpave and SMA mix design methodology (modified version of OPSS.PROV 1151 – consult with MERO Bituminous Section).

November 2016 Page 10 of 10 B332

Page 341: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

B333 - COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING - OPSS.PROV 333 333.1 GENERAL

The Cold In-place Recycling (CIR) process involves partial depth milling of the existing asphalt pavement, sizing, mixing with emulsified asphalt and water (if required), relaying and compacting the recycled cold bituminous mixture in-place in one single operation.

CIR can rehabilitate pavement exhibiting age, thermal, fatigue and reflective cracking. CIR should be considered for roads that are severely cracked but structurally sound. It is not limited to pavements exhibiting surficial distresses. The existing pavement thickness should be at least 100 mm.

CIR helps to retard reflection cracking and localized roughness.

CIR is not suitable for pavements with extensive base or subbase problems, or structurally deficient pavements, i.e. lack of structural capacity, severe distortions and/or instability rutting.

CIR processing should avoid reaching to pavement layers that contain asbestos, geogrid, glasgrid, or layers with rich asphalt content, high recovered penetration, or fine mixes such as HL-2.

CIR process is more appropriate for roads with low to moderate traffic volumes (AADT < 15,000/2 lanes).

CIR must be placed in warm, dry weather and therefore is limited to the summer months for construction, and all CIR treatment should be completed prior to September 1st. CIR treatment cannot be carried out when the temperature is below 10 °C or the overnight forecast is less than 2 °C.

Pavements that have the following maintenance treatments may be considered since they have no detrimental effects on the CIR mix design. - cold mix patching - spray patching - chip seal

The benefits of CIR mix are: - The mix is flexible with high air voids, so reflection cracking is notably reduced - 100 % of the material is reclaimed - Traffic is allowed back on within one hour of its placement

November 2015 Page 1 of 7 B333

Page 342: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

333.2 REFERENCES

CDED Section B206-3, Excavation for Pavement Widening CDED Section B308, Tack Coat CDED Section B313, Hot Mix Asphalt CDED Section B510, Removal

333.3 TENDER ITEMS

Cold In-Place Recycled Mix 333.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work are contained in OPSS 333. 333.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter E of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

333.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - none 333.7 DESIGN 333.7.1 Geotechnical Design Considerations

The CIR mix is susceptible to moisture intrusion and abrasion. It requires that a separate wearing surface such as hot mix overlay, surface treatment, or micro-surfacing be placed to seal the CIR mix. The wearing surface must be placed during the same construction season. To date, surface treatment or micro-surfacing has not been used as the separate wearing surface.

CIR treatment depths typically range from 75 mm to 125 mm. For projects with variation in existing asphalt pavement thicknesses, different treatment depths should be considered by clustering the pavement into segments of similar asphalt pavement thickness. The depth of CIR treatment shall be selected to avoid disturbance of the underlying granular base (so called ‘breaking through’). The treatment depth shall be selected to avoid ‘breaking through’ during CIR processing that could lead to potential claims and performance issues. In no case shall the remaining residual asphalt be less than 25 mm. When the residual asphalt requirement cannot be met, a different rehabilitation strategy should be considered.

November 2015 Page 2 of 7 B333

Page 343: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

A typical recycling train is installed with milling drum(s) of up to 3.8 m in width and paver with extending screed of up to 4.25 m in width. Typically, CIR process extends to the existing pavement edge (edge of lane) only. It is not recommended to process the pavement beyond the pavement edge as it will incorporate shoulder granular into the CIR mix.

After processing, CIR mix will be fluffed up 10 to 15% of the original volume of pavement due to an increase in air voids. As a result, 10 to 15% raise in grade is expected if the width of CIR mat does not change. If grade raise restriction applies on the geometric design of pavement, the CIR mix can be spread out to avoid the grade raise, resulting in increase in mat’s width.

Pavement widening using CIR is not recommended. However when it is required, the Excavation for Pavement Widening standard item may be used to prepare the shoulder area. Refer to CDED B206-3 for documentation requirements. An asphalt base should be considered along the widening strip if the thickness difference between the existing asphalt pavement and the widening pavement is large. It is not recommended to incorporate shoulder granular into CIR mix for the purpose of pavement widening.

A tack coat is required prior to Hot Mix Asphalt (HMA) paving over all areas of CIR. Use the tender item ‘Tack Coat’. The Tack Coat rate of application for cold in-place recycled surfaces is specified in OPSS 308. Reference is made to CDED Section B308, Tack Coat, for administration of this tender item.

All crack sealants must be removed prior to CIR processing, as part of the item. Estimation of crack sealant quantity to be removed should be included in Pavement Design Report.

In urban areas, the designer should be aware of appurtenance and adjustment requirements, curb heights, and accessibility concerns to accommodate the CIR equipment train and the requirement for traffic detours. At intersections, the main lanes and turn lanes of significant length (greater than 300 m) should be CIR. Different treatments (i.e., remove and replace with acceptable binder course HMA) may be applied to shorter turn tapers, irregularly shaped pavement areas, entrances, etc.

CIR should be considered for daylight operations only due to traffic control and safety concerns.

The designer should be aware that the length of the CIR paving operation may affect traffic management. A typical CIR train may extend up to 80m long. A one kilometer rolling closure is typical for the CIR operation.

November 2015 Page 3 of 7 B333

Page 344: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

Full depth repair zones such as frost treatment, distortion/distress and culvert replacement should be excavated and replaced in accordance with the designed subbase and base materials, then reinstated with HMA prior to CIR operation. The depth for the overlying HMA should be the processing depth of CIR plus 25mm. Alternatively, reclaimed asphalt pavement (RAP) can be considered instead of HMA. To avoid bumps and inconsistent transition of materials, CIR operation should continue through the full depth repair zone when its length is less than 50 m; otherwise, the zone will be skipped for CIR operation.

Pre-milling on the existing pavement surface should only be specified at selective locations when crack sealants are closely spaced, the pavement surface is severely oxidized, or where the longitudinal and/or transverse profile must be corrected. Pre-milling should be kept to a minimum.

A single pass of recycling train allows a minor cross-fall correction of up to 0.5% only. If a pavement section requires a cross-fall correction of larger than 0.5%, it should be adjusted using a patching or milling method prior to CIR operation instead of using the CIR recycling train.

For design purposes CIR with an overlay should be compared to the following conventional technique to address non-structural surficial distresses:

40 mm Superpave 12.5 over 100 mm CIR

Vs. Full depth reclamation, (FDR), 40 mm Superpave 12.5

over two 50 mm lifts of Superpave 19.0 333.7.2 Pre-Engineering Investigation

General:

This section describes procedures and tests to be carried out during pre-engineering investigations on potential CIR projects.

Adequate pre-engineering must be carried out to establish existing pavement thicknesses and composition. Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR) is a useful method of providing more frequent measurement of the asphalt thickness. Additional investigation should be carried out where pavement composition changes, such as patched areas.

This information is required for the designer to determine whether the existing pavement on potential projects meets the minimum thickness requirement in addition to assisting the designer in selecting a depth of CIR.

Field investigation is required to determine the pavement condition, distress manifestations, and estimated sealant removal quantities.

November 2015 Page 4 of 7 B333

Page 345: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

Selection of Coring Locations:

1. A minimum of one core location per kilometre.

2. Cores shall be taken not less than 0.5 m from the edges of the pavement of the

main lanes and in areas representative of the overall pavement condition. Core location should be random.

3. Cores should extend to the bottom of the lower hot mix lift.

4. Testing on cores should be conducted to determine extracted gradation, existing

asphalt cement content and recovered penetration

This information does not relieve the Contractor from obtaining cores to complete a CIR mix design.

A mix design is recommended during the pre-engineering investigation stage to confirm the in-situ materials are suitable for CIR processing, and to determine whether active filler would be required for the mix.

When Portland cement is used as active filler, the maximum addition rate is 1%.

333.7.3 Other Design Considerations

The work requires the use of a pilot vehicle as part of the process. The regional traffic section should be consulted regarding the deletion of the pilot vehicle if work is on a freeway.

333.7.4 Information to be Provided to Bidders

The existing pavement depth must be included in the documents in the form of soils borings, pavement cores, or ground penetrating radar graphs, along with the results of the pre-engineering core testing.

333.8 COMPUTATION 333.8.1 Source of Information

All requirements of a project with respect to hot mix , CIR depths, asphalt core analysis and test results including treatment of shoulders are stated in the Pavement Design Report.

November 2015 Page 5 of 7 B333

Page 346: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

333.8.2 Method of Calculation

Cold In-Place Recycling Mix is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

The unit of measurement for CIR is square metres.

The Contractor is responsible for the CIR mix design and will supply emulsified asphalt on all contracts for the CIR mix. No quantity calculations are required by the designer for this material.

The estimated bulk relative density of CIR is 2.20 t/m³.

333.9 DOCUMENTATION

It is necessary to ensure that this information is indicated for all CIR to be carried out on a project. It must include the depths of CIR and the hot mix overlays for the roadway, private and commercial entrances, side roads, tapers, interchange ramps, pavement widening, paved shoulders, partial paved shoulders, and any other miscellaneous areas to be paved.

The designer is to specify the hot mix required to be used in areas inaccessible to the CIR equipment.

The designer shall specify the following in the Contract Documents:

1. For the item Cold In-Place Recycled Mix, typical cross sections which show

normal sectional requirements are to be included. Include on sections the required widths and depths of cold in-place recycling.

2. Each area quantity of CIR is shown on one row of the Miscellaneous Quantity

Sheet. For each area, indicate both start and end chainage in the location and position column.

3. Sealant removal is included with the CIR tender item.

4. For areas considered by the designer to be inaccessible to the CIR equipment, hot

mix is required, and is paid for under the applicable hot mix asphalt item(s). Refer to B313 for documentation requirements.

Partial depth asphalt removal and overlying HMA thicknesses shall be noted on the drawings for all areas considered inaccessible or impractical for CIR, such as private and commercial entrances, side roads, tapers, ramps, channelization, shoulders, irregularly shaped pavement areas and miscellaneous areas to be paved. Refer to CDED B510 and B313 for the design and documentation requirements for partial depth asphalt removal and HMA, respectively.

November 2015 Page 6 of 7 B333

Page 347: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING

333.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Calculated CIR quantity in square metres is recorded to the nearest whole number. Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

November 2015 Page 7 of 7 B333

Page 348: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 349: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

B335 - COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT – OPSS.PROV 335 335.1 GENERAL

The Cold In-placed Recycled Expanded Asphalt Mix (CIREAM) process involves partial depth milling of the existing asphalt pavement, sizing, mixing with expanded (foam) asphalt, re-laying and compacting the recycled cold bituminous mixture in-place in one single operation. CIREAM can rehabilitate pavement exhibiting age, thermal, fatigue and reflective cracking. CIREAM should be considered for roads that are severely cracked but structurally sound. It is not limited to pavements exhibiting surficial distresses. The existing pavement thickness should be at least 100 mm. CIREAM helps to retard reflection cracking and localized roughness. CIREAM is not suitable for pavements with extensive base or subbase problems, or structurally deficient pavements, i.e. lack of structural capacity, severe distortions and/or instability rutting. CIREAM processing should avoid reaching to pavement layers that contain asbestos, geogrid, glasgrid, or layers with rich asphalt content, high recovered penetration, or fine mixes such as HL-2. CIREAM is more appropriate for roads with low to moderate traffic volumes (AADT < 15,000 / 2 lanes). CIREAM must be placed in warm, dry weather and therefore is limited to the summer months for construction, and all CIREAM treatment should be completed prior to September 1st. CIREAM treatment cannot be carried out when the temperature is below 15 °C. Pavements that have the following maintenance treatments may be considered since they have no detrimental effects on the CIREAM mix design. - Cold mix patching - Spray patching - Chip seal The benefits of CIREAM are: - The mix is flexible with high air voids, so reflection cracking is notably reduced - The mix curing time is significantly shorter than CIR - 100% of the material is reclaimed - Traffic is allowed back on within one hour of its placement

November 2015 Page 1 of 7 B335

Page 350: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

335.2 REFERENCES

CDED Section B206-3, Excavation for Pavement Widening CDED Section B308, Tack Coat CDED Section B313, Hot Mix Asphalt CDED Section B510, Removal

335.3 TENDER ITEMS

Cold In-Place Recycled Expanded Asphalt Mix 335.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work are contained in OPSS 335. 335.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter E of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

335.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - none 335.7 DESIGN 335.7.1 Geotechnical Design Considerations

The CIREAM is susceptible to moisture intrusion and abrasion. It requires that a separate wearing surface such as hot mix overlay, surface treatment, or micro-surfacing be placed to seal the CIREAM. The wearing surface must be placed during the same construction season. To date, surface treatment or micro-surfacing has not been used as the separate wearing surface. CIREAM treatment depths typically range from 75 mm to 125 mm. For projects with variation in existing asphalt pavement thicknesses, different treatment depths should be considered by clustering the pavement into segments of similar asphalt pavement thickness. The depth of CIREAM treatment shall be selected to avoid disturbance of the underlying granular base (so called ‘breaking through’). The treatment depth shall be selected to avoid ‘breaking through’ during CIREAM processing that could lead to potential claims and performance issues. In no case shall the remaining residual asphalt be less than 25 mm. When the residual asphalt requirement cannot be met, a different rehabilitation strategy should be considered.

November 2015 Page 2 of 7 B335

Page 351: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

A typical recycling train is installed with milling drum(s) of up to 3.8 m in width and paver with extending screed of up to 4.25 m in width. Typically, CIREAM process extends to the existing pavement edge (edge of lane) only. It is not recommended to process the pavement beyond the pavement edge as it will incorporate shoulder granular into the CIREAM. After processing, CIREAM will be fluffed up 10 to 15% of the original volume of pavement due to an increase in air voids. As a result, 10 to 15% raise in grade is expected if the width of CIREAM mat does not change. If grade raise restriction applies on the geometric design of pavement, the CIREAM can be spread out to avoid the grade raise, resulting in increase in mat’s width. Pavement widening using CIREAM is not recommended. However when it is required, the Excavation for Pavement Widening standard item may be used to prepare the shoulder area. Refer to CDED B206-3 for documentation requirements. An asphalt base should be considered along the widening strip if the thickness difference between the existing asphalt pavement and the widening pavement is large. It is not recommended to incorporate shoulder granular into CIREAM mix for the purpose of pavement widening. A tack coat is required prior to Hot Mix Asphalt (HMA) paving over all areas of CIREAM. The Tack Coat rate of application that corresponds to cold in-place recycled surfaces shall be used. Reference is made to CDED Section B308, Tack Coat, for administration of this tender item. All crack sealants must be removed prior to CIREAM processing, as part of the item. Estimation of crack sealant quantity to be removed should be included in Pavement Design Report. In urban areas, the designer should be aware of appurtenance adjustment requirements, curb heights, and accessibility concerns to accommodate the CIREAM equipment train and the requirement for traffic detours. At intersections, the main lanes and turn lanes of significant length (greater than 300 m) should be CIREAM. Different treatments (i.e., remove and replace with acceptable binder course HMA) may be applied to shorter turn tapers, irregularly shaped pavement areas, entrances, etc. CIREAM should be considered for daylight operations only due to traffic control requirements and safety concerns. The designer should be aware that the length of the CIREAM paving operation may affect traffic management. A typical CIREAM train may extend up to 80m long. A one kilometer rolling closure is typical for the CIREAM operation.

November 2015 Page 3 of 7 B335

Page 352: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

Full depth repair zones such as frost treatment, distortion/distress and culvert replacement should be excavated and replaced in accordance with the designed subbase and base materials, then reinstated with HMA prior to CIREAM operation. The depth for the overlying HMA should be the processing depth of CIREAM plus 25mm. Alternatively, reclaimed asphalt pavement (RAP) can be considered instead of HMA. To avoid bumps and inconsistent transition of materials, CIREAM operation should continue through the full depth repair zone when its length is less than 50 m; otherwise, the zone will be skipped for CIREAM operation. Pre-milling on the existing pavement surface should only be specified at selective locations when crack sealants are closely spaced, the pavement surface is severely oxidized, or where the longitudinal and/or transverse profile must be corrected. Pre-milling should be kept to a minimum. A single pass of recycling train allows a minor cross-fall correction of up to 0.5% only. If a pavement section requires a cross-fall correction of larger than 0.5%, it should be adjusted using a patching or milling method prior to CIREAM operation instead of using the CIREAM recycling train. For design purposes, CIREAM with an overlay should be compared to the following conventional technique to address nonstructural surficial distresses:

40 mm Superpave 12.5 over 100 mm CIREAM

Vs. Full depth reclamation, (FDR), 40 mm Superpave 12.5

over two 50 mm lifts of Superpave 19.0 335.7.2 Pre-Engineering Investigation

This section describes procedures and tests to be carried out during pre-engineering investigations on potential CIREAM projects. Adequate pre-engineering must be carried out to establish existing pavement thicknesses and composition. Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR) is a useful method of providing more frequent measurement of the asphalt thickness. Additional investigation should be carried out where pavement composition changes, such as patched areas. This information is required for the designer to determine whether the existing pavement on potential projects meets the minimum thickness requirement in addition to assisting the designer in selecting a depth of CIREAM. Field investigation is required to determine the pavement condition and distress manifestations, and estimated sealant removal quantities.

November 2015 Page 4 of 7 B335

Page 353: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

Selection of Coring Locations:

1. A minimum of one core location per kilometer.

2. Cores shall be taken not less than 0.5 m from the edges of the pavement of the main lanes and in areas representative of the overall pavement condition. Core location should be random.

3. Cores should extend to the bottom of the lower hot mix lift.

4. Testing on cores should be conducted to determine extracted gradation, existing

asphalt cement content and recovered penetration.

The information does not relieve the Contractor from obtaining cores to complete a CIREAM mix design.

A mix design is recommended during the pre-engineering investigation stage to confirm the in-situ materials are suitable for CIREAM processing, and to determine whether active filler would be required for the mix to meet the minimum tensile strength requirement. When Portland cement is used as active filler, the maximum addition rate is 1%.

335.7.3 Other Design Considerations

The work requires the use of a pilot vehicle as part of the process. The regional traffic section should be consulted regarding the deletion of the pilot vehicle requirement if the work is on a freeway.

335.7.4 Information to be Provided to Bidders

The existing pavement depth must be included in the documents in the form of soils borings, pavement cores, or ground penetrating radar graphs, along with the results of the pre-engineering core testing.

335.8 COMPUTATION 335.8.1 Source of Information

All requirements of a project with respect to hot mix, CIREAM depths, asphalt core analysis and test results including treatment of shoulders are stated in the Pavement Design Report.

November 2015 Page 5 of 7 B335

Page 354: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

335.8.2 Method of Calculation Cold In-Place Recycled Expanded Asphalt Mix is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measurement for CIREAM is square meters. The Contractor is responsible for the CIREAM mix design and will supply asphalt cement, as required, on all contracts for the CIREAM. No quantity calculations are required by the designer for this material. The estimated bulk relative density of CIREAM is 2.20 t/m³.

335.9 DOCUMENTATION

It is necessary to ensure that this information is indicated for all CIREAM to be carried out on a project. It must include the depths of CIREAM and the hot mix overlays for the roadway, private and commercial entrances, side roads, tapers, interchange ramps, pavement widening, paved shoulders, partial paved shoulders, and any other miscellaneous areas to be paved.

The designer shall specify the following in the Contract Documents:

1. For the item CIREAM, typical cross sections which show normal sectional

requirements are to be included. Include on sections the required widths and depths of CIREAM.

2. Each area quantity of CIREAM is shown on one row of the Miscellaneous

Quantity Sheet. For each area, indicate both start and end chainage in the location and position column.

3. Sealant removal is included with the CIREAM tender item.

4. For areas considered by the designer to be inaccessible to the CIREAM

equipment, hot mix is required, and is paid for under the applicable hot mix asphalt item(s). Refer to B313 for documentation requirements.

Partial depth asphalt removal and overlying HMA thicknesses shall be noted on the drawings for all areas considered inaccessible or impractical for CIREAM, such as private and commercial entrances, side roads, tapers, ramps, channelization, shoulders, irregularly shaped pavement areas and miscellaneous areas to be paved. Refer to CDED B510 and B313 for the design and documentation requirements for partial depth asphalt removal and HMA, respectively.

November 2015 Page 6 of 7 B335

Page 355: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING COLD IN-PLACE RECYCLING WITH EXPANDED ASPHALT

335.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Calculated CIREAM quantity in square metres is recorded to the nearest whole number. Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

November 2015 Page 7 of 7 B335

Page 356: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 357: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 1 of 7 B336

MICRO-SURFACING - OPSS 336

336.1 GENERAL

Micro-surfacing is recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section on a work project specific basis. It is generally used as a preventive maintenance treatment or surface seal for an existing pavement with an asphaltic concrete surface. Micro-surfacing provides a skid resistant durable surface, reduces the permeability of the asphalt surface and may also be used to fill ruts. Micro-surfacing does not prevent working cracks from reflecting.

336.1.1 Definitions

1. Micro-surfacing

Means a pavement surfacing composed of polymer-modified asphalt emulsion, high quality aggregate, mineral filler, and water.

2. Polymer Modified Emulsion

The emulsion is a proprietary product that keeps the asphalt droplets in a stable suspension and permits breaking at the proper time. The residual asphalt content varies from 5.5 to 9.5 percent of the dry weight of aggregate. Polymers are added to improve its temperature susceptibility.

3. Mineral Filler

Portland cement is used as mineral filler for micro-surfacing. Its main purpose is to speed up or slow down the rate at which the system breaks and sets.

336.2 REFERENCES

Project-specific Pavement Design Report

336.3 TENDER ITEMS

The following tender items are used:

Micro-Surfacing - Type II Micro-Surfacing – Type III Modified Micro-Surfacing - Type III

Page 358: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 2 of 7 B336

336.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the work are contained in OPSS 336.

336.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of the CDED Manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Designer options for micro-surfacing are contained in special provision 336F01. The designer includes options that are applicable, based on recommendations from the Regional Geotechnical Section.

336.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings directly applicable to this type of work.

336.7 DESIGN

336.7.1 Geotechnical Design Considerations

336.7.1.1 Placement:

Micro-surfacing is primarily used to address surface defects such as ravelling and flushing. Micro-surfacing can also be used to correct low surface friction caused by polishing of aggregate. In addition, micro-surfacing can be used to fill ruts that have stabilized.

Micro-surfacing is not suitable for pavements exhibiting structural distresses, i.e. alligator cracking, lack of structural capacity, working cracks, severe distortions and/or instability rutting.

Micro-surfacing is not dependent on traffic volumes and can be used on all classes of roadways including freeways.

When deciding if micro-surfacing is an acceptable and cost effective treatment the life-cycle costing of various appropriate treatments should be reviewed using 7 to 10 years as the expected service life, depending on the existing pavement condition. Costs will vary depending on the location and size of the project.

Micro-surfacing, like other thin treatments and overlays, offers no long term resistance to the development of reflective cracks.

The slurry is sensitive to weather conditions and must be placed during warm dry

Page 359: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 3 of 7 B336

weather. Operational constraints are provided in OPSS 336 that require an atmospheric temperature of at least 10o C, no fog or rain, and no forecast of temperatures below 0o C within 24 hours of the time of application. In addition, micro-surfacing shall commence no earlier than May 15th and shall be completed no later than September 30th.

Partially paved shoulders (0.5 m) should be micro-surfaced. Micro-surfacing of fully paved shoulders is left to the discretion of the designer. In some cases, micro-surfacing from the inside of the white edge line to the inside of the white edge line is performed to eliminate the cost of line painting.

Typically, continuous placement is specified for Ministry micro-surfacing work. Continuous placement reduces the number of joints, improves overall ride quality, and typically increases operating speed of the micro-surfacing. Non-continuous placement by an individual truck mounted box should be considered for work on lower volume facilities, intersection work, or maintenance patching. Non-continuous placement is specified through a special provision fill-in deleting the requirement in OPSS 336 for continuous placement. Micro-surfacing contracts often involve re-grading of the shoulder with granular materials. Since, micro-surfacing operations often result in traffic travelling on the gravel portion of the shoulder during construction, designers should consider requiring the contractor to perform shoulder grading prior to micro-surfacing to facilitate traffic movement.

Any localized pavement failures, such as potholes (300 mm2), etc., must be repaired using standard repair procedures prior to any micro-surfacing application.

Typically, a double application (i.e. scratch and surface coats) micro-surfacing is specified to address severe surface defects. The micro-surfacing application is specified through a special provision fill-in.

336.7.1.2 Material Requirements

Aggregates

The gradation and quality requirements of the aggregates are dependent on the type of Micro-surfacing specified and are provided in OPSS 336.

Emulsion

Micro-surfacing requires a polymer modified quick set cationic CSS-1H emulsion. The emulsifier used to produce the emulsion is a proprietary product. The manufacturer/contractor is usually licensed by the manufacturer of the emulsifier to produce the emulsion and place the micro-surfacing.

Page 360: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 4 of 7 B336

Polymer Modifier

A minimum of 3 % polymer modifier by mass of asphalt residue is required.

Mineral Filler (Cement)

The mineral filler, which is required to complete the chemical reaction in the mix, is a Portland Cement type GU.

336.7.1.3 Scratch Coat to fill rut:

The scratch coat mixture should be spread to fill minor cracks and shallow potholes and leave a uniform surface. The application rate for the scratch course and rut filling application will vary depending on surface irregularities and the depth of rutting. If rut filling is required, a quantitative estimate of the amount of rutting or a copy of the ARAN rut survey should be provided to help determine quantities. The surface coat is placed over the scratch coat in a fairly consistent thickness of 9 - 12 mm.

Use of a rut box should be specified when there is rutting over 50 % of the project that is an average of 10 mm or greater in depth, in one wheel path. Micro-surfacing should not be used for ruts greater than 50 mm in depth.

If the depth of rutting exceeds 13 mm, a rut box must be used to fill the ruts prior to apply a scratch and surface coat. The maximum depth of rut that can be filled with the rut box is 25 mm per pass. The minimum width of a rut filling application is 1.5 m. The requirement to use a rut box is specified through a special provision fill-in.

336.7.1.4 Crack Sealant:

Crack sealant is typically removed prior to micro-surfacing as required by OPSS 336. Crack sealant that shows signs of deterioration or debonding and crack sealant that has been in place less than 1 year can interfere with the micro-surfacing operations. The requirement to leave crack sealant in place prior to micro-surfacing should be based on the recommendation of the pavement design report or Regional Geotechnical Section. Crack sealing should not be performed prior to micro-surfacing. The option to leave crack sealant in place prior to micro-surfacing is specified through a fill-in to the micro-surfacing special provision.

336.7.1.5 Pavement Marking:

Micro-surfacing does not adhere well to thermoplastic pavement markings, stop blocks and turning arrows. Durable pavement markings are required to be

Page 361: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 5 of 7 B336

removed prior to micro-surfacing as specified in OPSS 336. Durable pavement markings should only be left in place based on the recommendation of the pavement design report or Regional Geotechnical Section. The Regional Traffic Section should also be consulted about impacts to traffic created by removing pavement markings during construction. The option to leave durable pavement markings in place prior to micro-surfacing is specified through a fill-in to the micro-surfacing special provision.

336.7.1.6 Tack Coating:

Tack coating of existing pavement surfaces is typically required. New pavements or flushed pavements to be micro-surfaced may not require tack coating. When a thick scratch coat micro-surfacing is anticipated, tack coating may not be required. Tack coating should be as recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Tack coating is required as part of the micro-surfacing item and therefore an item for tack coat is not required. When tack coating is not required it should be specified through a fill-in portion of the micro-surfacing special provision.

336.7.1.7 Different types of Micro-surfacing:

Typically, the different micro-surfacing types are used for the following applications as recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. Type II micro-surfacing with Superpave 12.5 quality aggregate is used on local residential streets and low volume arterial and collectors. Type II micro-surfacing with Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality aggregate is used on higher volume arterials and collectors. The aggregate requirements provided in the surface course directive provide direction on aggregate to specify for Type II micro-surfacing. Pavements with AADT greater than 2500 per lane require a Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality aggregate. Type III micro-surfacing is used on freeways and other high speed, high volume roads. Type III Modified micro-surfacing is used in lieu of Type III micro-surfacing to reduce traffic generated noise. Type III Modified and Type III micro-surfacing both require Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality aggregate.

Where Type II micro-surfacing is required, the designer must specify the aggregate requirements as either Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality aggregate or Superpave 12.5 quality aggregate. The default requirements of OPSS 336 specify Type II Micro-surfacing shall meet the requirements of a high traffic volume application (i.e. Superpave 12.5 FC1 aggregates). Where Type II micro-surfacing with Superpave 12.5 quality aggregate is required on a project, the aggregate requirements of OPSS 336 must be changed through a fill-in portion of the micro-surfacing special provision.

Some Type II micro-surfacing and all Type III and Type III Modified micro-surfacing require aggregates that meet Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality requirements. In Southern Ontario, the aggregates meeting Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality should

Page 362: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 6 of 7 B336

come from a source listed on the DSM list as required in OPSS 336. In Northern Ontario, the requirement for Superpave 12.5 FC1 quality aggregates to come from the DSM should be reviewed based on if the highway is designated as a Superpave 12.5 FC1 or Superpave 12.5 Modified pavement. If it is determined, that the aggregate does not need to come from the DSM, the aggregate can also be obtained from a quarry consisting of 100 percent siliceous aggregate determined according to LS-609. If aggregates are not required to come from the DSM, a fill-in portion of the micro-surfacing special provision should be used. Aggregate requirements should be as recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by the Regional Geotechnical Section and should be specified through a fill-in portion of the micro-surfacing special provision.

336.7.2 Other Design Considerations

The micro-surfacing specification requires the use of a pilot vehicle as part of the micro-surfacing process. There may be highway sections such as a freeway, where the regional traffic section should be consulted regarding the deletion of the pilot vehicle requirement. The pilot vehicle requirement can be deleted through a special provision fill in.

The contractor must be on the list of pre-qualified contractors, having satisfied Ministry competency requirements in order to bid on micro-surfacing contracts.

336.8 COMPUTATION

336.8.1 Source of Information

All paving requirements of a project with respect to micro-surfacing as recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section are stated in the Pavement Design Report.

336.8.2 Method of Calculation

Micro-surfacing tender items are all Plan Quantity Payment items, as may be revised by Adjusted Plan Quantity of the horizontal areas (square metres).

In the case where two lifts are required the total area in square metres (m2 )would remain the same. The unit price would be based on a two lift thickness.

336.9 DOCUMENTATION

Contract drawings are not required with the above tender items.

Each area of microsurfacing is documented on one line of the Quantities

Page 363: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MICRO-SURFACING

January 2009 Pg. 7 of 7 B336

Miscellaneous sheet. The start and end chainages of each area are provided. The width of microsurfacing is delineated by providing both the left and right offsets of the edge of microsurfacing. The edges would typically correspond to the edges of pavement. The area is typically the width of pavement multiplied by the length of pavement that is to receive microsurfacing.

One or more columns is/are headed by the tender item name(s). The area of microsurfacing (m2) is entered in the line, corresponding to each area of microsurfacing, in the appropriate column that corresponds to the appropriate tender item name.

If rut filling is required, information on rut depths should be provided such as a copy of ARAN data on typical rut depths. ARAN data may be either included in the Quantities Miscellaneous sheet, via Non-standard special provision or by information to bidders.

336.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Calculated areas in square metres are recorded to the nearest whole number.

Page 364: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 365: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SLURRY SEAL

November 2013 Page 1 of 4 B337

B337 - SLURRY SEAL - OPSS 337 337.1 GENERAL

Slurry seal is a homogeneous mixture of emulsified asphalt, fine aggregate, water, mineral filler (Portland cement) and, if required, additive, that is applied in a cold fluid state as a pavement preservation treatment on an existing road surface that is in fair to good condition. It seals road surfaces providing protection from water penetration and it limits further oxidation of existing pavements. It is used to fill surface voids and can correct moderate ravelling and loss of matrix. Slurry seal does not increase the structural strength of a road surface, it is not intended to improve friction, it cannot correct cracking, and it does not correct deformations, such as rutting.

337.2 REFERENCES Pavement Design Report or Memorandum 337.3 TENDER ITEMS

Slurry Seal - Type I Slurry Seal - Type II Slurry Seal - Type III

337.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 337. 337.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

337.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

At present there are no standard drawings associated with these tender items.

Page 366: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SLURRY SEAL

November 2013 Page 2 of 4 B337

337.7 DESIGN

337.7.1 Geotechnical Design Considerations 337.7.1.1 Placement:

There are three types of slurry seal. Typically, the type used is recommended in the Pavement Design Report or by the Regional Geotechnical Section. The most commonly used is Type II, which is a medium gradation mix. If a road surface has distresses of a higher severity and/or density Type III would be used because its coarser gradation permits thicker placement. Also, Type III may be chosen over Type II for road surfaces that carry heavier traffic (i.e. logging trucks). Type I is a fine gradation mix that is used for light-wear surfaces, such as parking lots, and is not expected to be used by MTO. Slurry seal is not typically used in Southern Ontario. Slurry seal cannot treat rutting. If it is desired to correct rutting (i.e. rutting greater than 13 mm) micro-surfacing should be selected as the treatment type as it can correct rutting up to 50 mm. Slurry seal is typically only used for roadways with an AADT less than 5000, less than 10% commercial vehicles, and posted speed of 80 km/hr or less. In addition, if there are concerns regarding any of the following: friction, percentage of commercial trucks, and operating speed then slurry seal should not be used, and micro-surfacing should be the preferred treatment. A detailed pavement condition investigation should be carried out to determine the appropriateness of specifying slurry seal. All surface preparation, material application including handwork, joints, protection while curing, appurtenance protection, clean up and provision for a trial area are included with the tender items for slurry seal. Traffic must be prohibited from the finished surface for a period of up to four hours to permit the slurry seal to cure. This may necessitate a separate pay item for traffic convoy. For higher volume roadways, requiring a faster opening time, curing time can be reduced to as low as 1 hour. However, reducing the curing time may also reduce the number of bidders for a contract. The Regional Geotechnical and Traffic Sections should be consulted on this matter. A reduction to the time specified in OPSS 337 shall be specified in SSP 337F01. Partially paved shoulders (0.5 m) should be slurry sealed. Slurry sealing of fully paved shoulders is left to the discretion of the designer. In some cases, slurry sealing from the inside of the white edge line to the inside of the white edge line is performed to eliminate the cost of line painting. If there is a paving joint on the shoulder side of the white line, it should be slurry sealed.

Page 367: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SLURRY SEAL

November 2013 Page 3 of 4 B337

The slurry is sensitive to weather conditions and must be placed during warm dry weather. Operational constraints are provided in OPSS 337 that require an atmospheric temperature of at least 10 °C, no fog or rain, and no forecast of temperatures below 0 °C within 24 hours of the time of application. In addition, slurry sealing shall commence no earlier than May 15th and shall be completed no later than September 30th.

337.7.1.2 Material Requirements Aggregates The gradation and quality requirements of the aggregates are dependent on the type of slurry seal specified and are provided in OPSS 337. Mineral Filler (Cement) The mineral filler, which is required to complete the chemical reaction in the mix, is a Portland Cement type GU, according to OPSS 1301.

337.7.1.3 Crack Sealant:

Crack sealant is not typically removed prior to slurry sealing. Only loose, isolated crack sealant should be removed prior to slurry sealing. Crack sealing should not be performed prior to slurry sealing. Pavements with significant amounts of loose crack sealant are not candidates for slurry seal

337.7.1.4 Pavement Marking: Slurry seal does not adhere well to thermoplastic pavement markings, stop blocks and turning arrows. Durable pavement markings are required to be removed prior to slurry seal application as specified in OPSS 337. Durable pavement markings should only be left in place based on the recommendation of the pavement design report or Regional Geotechnical Section. The Regional Traffic Section should also be consulted about impacts to traffic created by removing pavement markings during construction. The option to leave durable pavement markings in place prior to slurry sealing is specified in SSP 337F01.

337.7.1.5 Tack Coating:

Tack coat should not be used for slurry seal.

337.8 COMPUTATION Slurry Seal items are Plan Quantity Payment items.

Page 368: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SLURRY SEAL

November 2013 Page 4 of 4 B337

337.8.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender items is the recommendations of the Regional Geotechnical Section, typically found in a Pavement Design Report or Memorandum.

337.8.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measure is square metres, and the quantity is calculated as the plan area of the pavement surface(s) to be slurry sealed.

337.9 DOCUMENTATION

Each area is entered as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading on a "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet. Where multiple pavement sections are to be slurry sealed, the location of each section is detailed on a separate row on the “Quantities – Miscellaneous” sheet. Each column is totalled and transferred to the tender document.

337.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number.

Page 369: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROUTING & SEALING CRACKS IN ASPHALT

08 02 B341-1

B341 - ROUTING AND SEALING AND/OR SEALING CRACKS IN ASPHALT PAVEMENT - OPSS 341

341.1 GENERAL

This work serves as a preventative maintenance measure whereby cracks in the existing surface course of asphalt pavements which are up to 15 mm in average width or greater than 15 and less than or equal to 30 mm in average width are respectively, routed and cleaned or cleaned without routing. All of the cleaned routs or unrouted cracks are then sealed with a hot-poured rubberized asphalt sealant, thereby preventing the entry of water and/or debris thereby mitigating any further damage to the pavement and underlying base structure.

Undertaking this operation, in a timely manner, will add years to the life of the pavement.

341.2 REFERENCES – None

341.3 TENDER ITEMS

Routing and Sealing Cracks in Asphalt Pavement Sealing Cracks in Asphalt Pavement

341.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for routing and sealing cracks and/or sealing cracks without routing in asphaltic concrete pavement surfaces are detailed in OPSS 341.

341.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

341.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Routing and sealing cracks and/or sealing cracks without routing in asphalt pavement is identified on the appropriate 500 series OPSD's.

341.7 DESIGN

All information pertaining to the extent of work under the tender item(s) is recommended by the Designer and approved by the Regional Geotechnical section.

The selection of the appropriate treatment is based on the average width of the crack. For cracks where the average width is:

Page 370: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROUTING & SEALING CRACKS IN ASPHALT

08 02 B341-2

i) Less than or equal to 15mm, the remedial measure may be to rout, clean and seal the crack; ii) Greater than 15mm but less than or equal to 30mm, the remedial measure may be to clean and seal the crack without routing.

If the depths or widths of the cracks are excessive and it is determined that excessive sealant is required, then this situation will have to be addressed by the appropriate Regional Geotechnical Section’s (i.e.) interim remedial measures, in order to avoid claims for payment of the excessive sealant quantities. On projects where the depths of cracks are excessive and particularly when their average widths are greater than 30 mm, then recommendations for remedial measures should be determined and detailed by the Designer, for review by the Regional Geotechnical Section, and documented in a non - standard special provision along with a drawing detailing the treatment.

341.8 COMPUTATION

These items are not administered under Plan Quantity status due to their variable nature.

341.8.1 Method of Calculation

The unit of measure for these tender items is linear metres of cracks treated.

341.9 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each crack treatment is documented by the appropriate station to station limits, together with the lengths of both longitudinal and transverse cracks (i.e. usually estimated by the applicable Regional Geotechnical and/or Operational Services Sections from detailed evaluations of representative sections) and their appropriate treatments within those limits, and are to be shown on the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheets.

The individual entries are totalled and become the tender quantity for the appropriate tender item.

341.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

The lengths of cracks to be treated in each area are to be shown in metres.

Quantities and stations are to be shown in whole numbers.

Page 371: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CENTRELINE AND SHOULDER RUMBLE STRIPS IN ASPHALT

B342 - CENTRELINE AND SHOULDER RUMBLE STRIPS IN ASPHALT - OPSS.PROV 342 342.1 GENERAL

A rumble strip is a grooved formation that is installed into the asphalt paved surface. The intent of shoulder rumble strips (SRS) and centreline rumble strips (CRS) is to provide an audible and tactile warning to drivers that they are departing from the roadway. This audible and tactile warning is generated by the vehicle tires passing over the rumble strips.

342.2 REFERENCES Ministry Directive, PLNG-B-004, Highway Shoulder Rumble Strip Application and Installation Policy MTO Memorandum, Highway Design Bulletin 2010-002, Centreline Rumble Strip Application and Installation Policy MTO Bikeway Design Manual (2014)

342.3 TENDER ITEMS Centreline Rumble Strips - Asphalt (variation item) Shoulder Rumble Strips - Asphalt (variation item) Shoulder Rumble Strips for Bicycle Buffer Zones - Asphalt (variation item)

342.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for SRS and CRS are contained in OPSS.PROV 342.

342.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter E of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

342.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 500 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

February 2016 Page 1 of 3 B342

Page 372: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CENTRELINE AND SHOULDER RUMBLE STRIPS IN ASPHALT

342.7 DESIGN Design considerations for SRS are found in Ministry Directive, PLNG-B-004, Highway Shoulder Rumble Strip Application and Installation Policy. Design considerations for CRS are found in MTO Memorandum, Highway Design Bulletin 2010-002, Centreline Rumble Strip Application and Installation Policy Design considerations for SRS in bicycle buffer zones are found in the MTO Bikeway Design Manual (2014).

342.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. Quantities are computed in metres, and measured horizontally from end to end along the centreline of the installation. Gaps in the rumble strip installation are not included in the measured length. Gaps include, but are not limited to: entrance and intersection locations; entrance and exit terminal locations; and right turn lane and taper locations. The standard gaps (i.e. 3.6 m) provided in SRS installations within bicycle buffer zones are included in the measured length. Example: SRS are installed on both sides of a 2 km section of a two-lane undivided highway. There are four entrances and one side street on the left side of the highway while there are three entrances and one side street on the right side of the highway. SRS (left) = 2000 – (4x60 + 4x30 + 1x60 + 1x30) = 1550 m SRS (right) = 2000 – (3x60 + 3x30 + 1x60 + 1x30) = 1640 m SRS (total) = 1550 m + 1640 m = 3190 m

342.8.1 Sources of Information Locations for rumble strip installation are determined in accordance with the directives, policies, and guidelines listed in Section 342.2.

February 2016 Page 2 of 3 B342

Page 373: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CENTRELINE AND SHOULDER RUMBLE STRIPS IN ASPHALT

342.9 DOCUMENTATION CRS quantities and locations are indicated on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets under the appropriate column heading, showing station to station and location along centreline. Include the applicable MTOD number in the column heading. SRS quantities and locations are indicated on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets under the appropriate column heading, showing station to station limits and location, left or right of centreline. Include the applicable MTOD number in the column heading. For SRS in bicycle buffer zones, additional quantities for the outer pavement marking edge line beyond the SRS will need to be calculated and included under the appropriate pavement marking item.

342.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole metre.

February 2016 Page 3 of 3 B342

Page 374: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 375: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

350 - CONCRETE BASE AND CONCRETEPAVEMENT - OPSS 350

350.1 GENERAL

The selection of the pavement design types is the responsibility of the Regions. Approval of certain designs, including all rigid pavement designs, however, will still be required by the Director of Construction and Operations.

A Pavement Advisory Committee has been established at Downsview to initiate when necessary, the development of policies, standards and procedures with respect to pavement structures; provide technical assistance to the Heads of the Regional Geotechnical Sections and, with the agreement of the Regional Director, submit Pavement Selection Reports containing the recommended pavement design to the Director of Construction and Operations for approval.

The Heads of each Regional Geotechnical Section will be invited to attend the Pavement Advisory Committee meetings for each project under consideration from their Region. If unable to attend, the Secretary will assist in processing the Reports through the Pavement Advisory Committee during their scheduled meetings.

The unit price for Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement includes the forming, placing, finishing, texturing, & curing of the material, the placing of tie bars, load transfer devices and the cutting, preparing and sealing of joints.

A price adjustment will be based on the average of pay factors for strength and thickness.

Where the road surface to receive concrete pavement or concrete base has been prepared under a previous contract, the tender item “Restoring Roadway Surfaces” is added as a separate tender item.

Tender Items

1. Concrete Base 2. Concrete Pavement

350.1.2 Specifications

Information for the above tender items is indicated in OPSS 350.

350.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter AE@ of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

Rev. Date: 04/99 Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement B350-1

Page 376: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

350.1.4 Standard Drawings

Standard drawings applicable to the construction of Concrete Base or Concrete Pavement are contained in the OPSD 200, and 500, series.

350.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

350.2.1 Source of Information

It is important that the Pavement Selection Report for any project be submitted for approval at the time of preparation of the Preliminary Design Report after approval of the Design Criteria. To facilitate the processing and approval of any design with special features or one which has not been used before by the Ministry, a full explanation of the non-standard elements should accompany the Report.

The thickness of the Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement is established by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

350.2.2 Methods of Calculation

The unit of measurement for Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement is the square metre.

The areas of proposed work are calculated from design drawings and typical sections (including all tapers-ramps-radii, etc.,) and shown on the calculation sheets. The summarized quantities are transferred from the calculation sheet to the Quantities-Miscellaneous Sheet.

Lengths are to be calculated, on appropriate quantity calculation sheets, from design drawings, typical sections and/or cross sections.

Individual lengths are to be calculated to 2 decimal places along the longitude axis of the load transfer device, (placed on a skew), from edge of concrete pavement to edge of concrete pavement.

The summarized quantities are transferred to the Quantities Miscellaneous Sheet.

350.3 DOCUMENTATION

Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base are to be detailed on any Quantities-Miscellaneous sheets. Concrete Pavements of different depths are to be detailed

Rev. Date: 04/99 Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement B350-2

Page 377: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

in separate columns and combined into one tender item. Concrete Base of different depths are to be detailed in separate columns and combined into one tender item.

350.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Summarized Concrete quantities are recorded in whole number square metres.

Stations are recorded in whole numbers, and may be recorded to 0.1 m where necessary.

Rev. Date: 04/99 Concrete Base and Concrete Pavement B350-3

Page 378: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 379: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE SIDEWALK

B351 - CONCRETE SIDEWALK - OPSS 351 351.1 GENERAL

The design and construction of concrete sidewalks, when justified and approved in accordance with Provincial Engineering Memorandum, Director’s Office #2011-01 (February 2011), Revision June 2015, should be in accordance with Section D.8.4 of the Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways. The design and construction of sidewalk ramps should be in accordance with Provincial Engineering Memorandum, Design & Contract Standards Office #2014-01, May 15, 2014. The Ministry may pay 100% of the cost of a new sidewalk across a King's Highway, Freeway or Expressway at an interchange, intersection or flyover, provided the following conditions are met: (a) Sidewalk must be requested by the Municipality. (b) Sidewalk must be recommended by the Regional Planning and Design Section as

being required from a delineation and/or pedestrian safety point of view. (c) Municipality must give a commitment to construct a municipal sidewalk to join at

each end of that sidewalk to be constructed by the Ministry. (d) Sidewalk must be located within the right-of-way and cross the Provincial

Highway at an interchange or intersection. (e) The Municipality must undertake to maintain and accept liability for any sidewalk

constructed under the above conditions. The Ministry will pay 100% of the cost of replacing an existing sidewalk that will be damaged or destroyed by the work.

351.1.1 Concrete Sidewalk The following work is associated with the construction of concrete sidewalk, but is not included in the Concrete Sidewalk tender item. a) Excavation required to construct the sidewalk and granular foundation. The

excavation required above the bottom of sidewalk grade is to be included in the tender item "Earth Excavation (Grading)" and/or "Rock Excavation (Grading)".

January 2016 Page 1 of 5 B351

Page 380: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE SIDEWALK

b) Granular quantities required for foundation work are to be included in the appropriate granular item. Normally, Granular A is used for foundation material.

Normal sidewalk width is 1.5 metres which is also the minimum width requirements in accordance with Ontario Regulation 413/12. Wider sidewalk widths should be considered in areas of high pedestrian traffic in accordance with guidance in the Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways.

351.1.2 Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps Construction of new or replacement sidewalks and/or curbs adjacent to controlled pedestrian crossings where the concrete is placed adjacent to the pedestrian crossing require sidewalk ramps and Tactile Walking Surface Indicator Plates to be in compliance with Ontario Regulation 413/12.

351.2 REFERENCES Provincial Engineering Memorandum, Director’s Office #2011-01 (February 2011), Revision June 2015 Provincial Engineering Memorandum, Design & Contract Standards Office #2014-01, May 15, 2014 Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways Ontario Regulation 413/12

351.3 TENDER ITEMS Concrete Sidewalk (variation item) Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps

351.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 351.

351.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

January 2016 Page 2 of 5 B351

Page 381: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE SIDEWALK

351.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings for concrete sidewalks are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings Manual in the 300 Series.

351.7 DESIGN Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps shall only be included adjacent to controlled pedestrian crossings when: - new sidewalk and/or curb is required at a new intersection, - an existing intersection is being reconstructed or widened which impacts the

existing curb ramps, - the existing sidewalk and/or curb requires replacement due to condition, or - the existing sidewalk and/or curb must be removed and replaced due to new

traffic signal installation or other work. In all other cases, existing sidewalk ramps in accordance with OPSD 310.030 (October 1, 1993) in each quadrant of an intersection may remain in place and should not be retrofitted with tactile walking surface indicator plates.

351.8 COMPUTATION This is Plan Quantity Payment item.

351.8.1 Source of Information The main sources of information for Concrete Sidewalk are the B-Plans, Cross-sections, the local Municipality and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

351.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for Concrete Sidewalk is the square metre and is calculated using the horizontal design dimensions. The typical depth of concrete for sidewalks is 125 mm, increased to 150 mm across residential driveways, and 200 mm across commercial and industrial driveways. The depth may be increased at the request of the Municipality providing the Municipality agrees to absorb the additional costs.

January 2016 Page 3 of 5 B351

Page 382: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE SIDEWALK

Grading required for sidewalks is calculated in cubic metres. The depth of excavation is to include the concrete thickness. The grading quantity is to be added to the tender item Earth Excavation (Grading). The granular foundation depth is normally 100 mm for concrete sidewalk. The granular quantity in tonnes is added to the appropriate granular tender item. Unsuitable soils below the granular foundation are typically sub-excavated and replaced with suitable earth or select subgrade material.

351.8.3 Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps Quantities are computed for each set of Tactile Walking Surface Indicator Plates installed at each sidewalk ramp. A set of two Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps at each ramp location is counted as a quantity of 1.

351.9 DOCUMENTATION The location for placing sidewalks is to be indicated on the construction plans of the contract drawings. Concrete sidewalks and sidewalk ramps require the indication of the appropriate standard drawing number on the plans. The width of sidewalk is indicated on the plans. Quantities for earth excavation, granular and concrete sidewalk constructed at the expense of a Municipality are to be clearly defined by Station to Station on the appropriate Quantity Sheet. The granular foundation quantity is added to the roadway granular item and identified as a separate entry on the quantity sheet showing the depth of granular on the same line. The grading quantities for concrete sidewalk are added to the tender item Earth Excavation (Grading) and shown as a separate entry on the Quantities - Grading sheet. Concrete Sidewalk is a variation item. The variation is the sidewalk depth, with typical values of 125 mm, 150 mm, and 200 mm. Each variation requires a separate column on the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet. Sidewalk locations are documented by station to station limits and offsets right or left of the roadway centreline on the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender. Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps locations are depicted on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD number shown. The applicable Standard Drawings shall be included in the contract.

January 2016 Page 4 of 5 B351

Page 383: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE SIDEWALK

Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps quantities are computed and entered on the Quantities-Miscellaneous sheet under the appropriate column heading, showing station and location, left or right of centreline. The column entries are totalled and transferred to the Form of Tender.

351.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Quantity entries for Concrete Sidewalk are recorded in whole number square metres. Quantity entries for Tactile Walking Surface Indicators for Concrete Sidewalk Ramps are recorded in whole numbers.

January 2016 Page 5 of 5 B351

Page 384: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 385: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

B353 - CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS - OPSS 353 353.1 GENERAL

The primary function of curb and gutter and concrete gutter outlets in the design of paved roads, is to facilitate the channelling of surface runoff from the roadway, to control erosion of shoulders and slopes.

353.2 REFERENCES MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards Roadside Safety Manual (RSM) Geometric Design Standards for Ontario Highways (GDSOH)

353.3 TENDER ITEMS Concrete Curb and Gutter (variation) Concrete Gutter Outlets (variation)

353.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for concrete curb and gutter are contained in OPSS 353.

353.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

353.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 600 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs) and the 600 series of Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTODs).

March 2016 Page 1 of 5 B353

Page 386: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

353.7 DESIGN

353.7.1 Concrete Curb and Gutter

353.7.1.1 General Roadside ditches are generally the most cost effective solution for channelling surface runoff from roadways. The designer should consider curb and gutter only when a ditch is infeasible due to property constraints, topography, etc. In addition, curb and gutter is used to provide traffic guidance and control. The designer should refer to Sections C.4.2.2 and D.8.1 of the GDSOH, Section 2.7.3 of the RSM and Standard SD-2 of the MTO’s Highway Drainage Design Standard for guidance on curb and gutter type. Where guiderail is required adjacent to curb and gutter, the appropriate MTOD shall be used. When curb and gutter is selected, drainage by gutter outlets and spillways is preferred over catch basins and sewers as this is more cost effective. Excavations required for construction of curb and gutter are considered part of the work and are not documented separately. Granular quantities required for curb and gutter construction are included with the appropriate granular item and are not documented separately.

353.7.1.2 Erosion Protection on Gradients The designer should follow Section D.5.2.2 of the GDSOH for shoulder erosion protection on gradients. The designer should consider shoulder paving to mitigate shoulder and slope erosion on gradients whenever possible.

353.7.1.3 Intersections at Grade The designer should follow section E.4.4.2 of the GDSOH when determining whether curb and gutter is required at intersections to mitigate gravel tracking. Shoulder treatment options are shown in OPSD 304.010.

353.7.1.4 Interchange Ramps The designer should consider open ditch drainage for interchange ramps whenever possible. Curb and gutter may be considered where property or other constraints make such construction more cost effective than drainage by open ditch.

March 2016 Page 2 of 5 B353

Page 387: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

353.7.1.5 Structure Approaches Roadside erosion protection is required at structure approaches. The designer should consider paved shoulders as the primary method of erosion control wherever practical. Where curb and gutter is necessary to provide adequate erosion protection, the minimum length should be 20 m beyond the structure where the curb and gutter is not present on the roadway.

353.7.1.6 Bullnoses and Raised Medians Bullnose areas should consist of pavement markings only, unless substantial grade differentials, subsequent drainage needs and/or traffic guidance require the use of curb and gutter. The designer should follow Section F.5.3.5 of the GDSOH when placing curb and gutter at bullnose areas. All raised medians and permanent channelization islands are to be bounded by curb and gutter.

353.7.1.7 Transitions In order to achieve a smooth transition of varying types of curb and/or curb and gutter, a transition section is employed. The transition length is included on the curb and gutter standard drawings. Where a concrete curb and gutter changes from one type to another, the designer should indicate the midpoint of the transition on the plan drawings. A transition detail drawing is not required.

353.7.2 Concrete Gutter Outlets Gutter outlets discharge surface runoff from concrete curb and gutter. The type and spacing of gutter outlets shall be according to Standard SD-8 in the MTO Drainage Design Standards.

353.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

March 2016 Page 3 of 5 B353

Page 388: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

353.8.1 Source of Information The main sources of information for the computation of these tender items are the Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books, Design Cross-Sections, the MTO Drainage Design Standards and Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual.

353.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for Concrete Curb and Gutter is the metre. The length is measured along the flow line of the gutter, with no deductions made for the length of gutter outlets or catchbasins. The types and lengths of curb and gutter to be placed will include bullnose and transition sections, and straight and circular curb and gutter. The various lengths are scaled from the plan. Curb termination lengths are included with the length of straight and circular sections, where applicable. The unit of measurement for Concrete Gutter Outlets is each. The location of gutter outlets is determined from the profiles.

353.9 DOCUMENTATION 353.9.1 Straight and Circular Construction

Curb and/or curb and gutter to be installed on tangent and curves with radii of 15.0 m and greater are documented as straight. Curves with radii of less than 15.0 m are documented as circular.

353.9.2 Drawings Curb and gutter is shown on the plans by the appropriate symbol and the appropriate OPSD or MTOD number e.g. (OPSD 600.010). Where the curb and gutter changes from one type to another the transition midpoint station is identified. Termination sections are specified on the drawings by the appropriate OPSD number. Concrete gutter outlets are indicated on the construction plans of the contract drawings. The appropriate OPSD number and type is identified.

March 2016 Page 4 of 5 B353

Page 389: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CURB AND GUTTER SYSTEMS

353.9.3 Quantity Sheet Concrete Curb and Gutter is a variation item. There are two variations, the OPSD or MTOD # that applies, and the type of construction, straight or circular. Each variation requires a separate column on the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet. Locations are documented by station to station limits and location right or left of the roadway centreline. Transition and termination sections are included with the measured curb quantity and are not documented separately. The quantities in each column are sub-totalled. These sub-totals are combined into one total which is the tender total. The tender total is transferred to the tender documentation. Concrete Gutter Outlets is a variation item. There is one variation, the OPSD # that applies. Each variation requires a separate column on the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet. Locations are documented by station and location right or left of the roadway centreline. The quantities in each column are sub-totalled. These sub-totals are combined into one total which is the tender total. The tender total is transferred to the tender documentation.

353.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Stations are recorded to the nearest whole number metre. Quantity entries for Concrete Curb and Gutter are recorded to the nearest whole number metres of linear measurement. Quantity entries for Concrete Gutter Outlets are recorded in whole numbers.

March 2016 Page 5 of 5 B353

Page 390: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 391: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVERS

B355 - INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVERS - OPSS 355

355.1 GENERAL

Interlocking concrete pavers are used in the construction of pedestrian and vehicular traffic locations in lieu of concrete and/or asphalt pavement. Manual or mechanical installation of pavers on granular base or subbase, concrete or asphalt base, overlain with bedding sand, finished with joint sand is used in vehicular traffic areas and non-vehicular traffic areas.

The structural behaviour of interlocking concrete pavers is similar to an equivalent thickness of asphalt.

Current principle pavement applications include residential, urban, rural roads, bus terminals, bus routes, car park lanes, commercial and private entrances, bike paths, crosswalks and parking and service lots.

Application is to be restricted to facilities where traffic speeds do not exceed 70 km/h. A herringbone pattern at 45 degrees to the vehicular traffic direction is recommended for roadway pavements. They are also used in non vehicular areas such as sidewalks, boulevards, medians and streetscape applications. When the application is subject to pedestrian use, only a minimum 60 mm thick paver is recommended, otherwise 80 to 100 mm thick pavers shall be specified.

All grading, subsurface drainage, granular subbase, base, bedding, joint sand and edge restraints are included in the unit price.

355.2 REFERENCES

Related technical publications for designers’ use are available from the Interlocking Concrete Pavement Institute (ICPI) at www.icpi.org.

355.3 TENDER ITEM

Interlocking Concrete Pavers.

355.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for interlocking concrete pavers are contained in OPSS 355.

November 2011 Pg. 1 of 3 B355

Page 392: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVERS

355.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

355.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are illustrated in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawing Manual in the 500 series.

355.7 DESIGN

Edge restraints are typically precast concrete cut stone or concrete and walls, which are both required to be installed at the base or subbase.

Subsurface drainage of the bedding sand is achieved by selecting proper aggregate gradation. Subsurface drainage is achieved by installing pipe subdrain at the base/subbase, under separate tender items.

The designer may require a surface sealer to protect the paver surface from staining, fading and to intensify colour. A reduction in frictional resistance may result with the use of a surface sealer. See ICPI Specifications, Technical Specification 5, for further details.

Various typical laying patterns are available in many forms and designs. Selection is the responsibility of the designer.

355.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

This is a variation item.

355.8.1 Source of Information

All interlocking paver requirements with respect to paver types and depths are to be recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section, as stated in the Pavement Design Report.

November 2011 Pg. 2 of 3 B355

Page 393: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVERS

355.8.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for interlocking concrete pavers is the square metre.

The areas of proposed work are calculated from design drawings and typical sections and shown on the calculation sheets.

355.9 DOCUMENTATION

Interlocking concrete pavers are detailed on the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet in separate columns for each different type of installation. The columns are totalled and totals combined into the tender quantity. Different types of Interlocking Concrete Pavers, including variations in size, shape, colour, thickness, texture and pattern are identified by column heading. Alternatively, designers may place some of this specific information in a NSSP, if necessary, for clarification of presentation. Lateral limits or offsets (left and right) of the edges of each installation are provided in the reference column of the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet.

The designer may consider including a sketch showing the layout patterns of Interlocking Concrete Pavers as it may prove difficult to describe some layouts.

If a Surface Sealer is required, it may be specified in a NSSP.

Each area of Interlocking Concrete Pavers is to be identified on the Contract Drawings, showing start and end chainage and width of installation, along with the applicable OPSD number. Where edge restraint is provided under the Interlocking Concrete Pavers tender item, it shall be labelled ‘Edge Restraint’. The type and depth of base and sub-base shall also be noted.

355.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Column totals on the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet of Interlocking Concrete Paver quantities are rounded to the nearest whole number.

November 2011 Pg. 3 of 3 B355

Page 394: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 395: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

360 - FULL DEPTH REPAIR OF CONCRETEPAVEMENT OR CONCRETE BASE

- OPSS 360

360.1 GENERAL

Full depth concrete placement or concrete base slab repairs are typically used to repair severe distress associated with slab cracking (transverse or longitudinal), joint spalling when the spalling extends 75 mm below the surface of the slab, D-cracking corner breaks and joint faulting.

Investigation of surface and/or full depth defects in the existing concrete pavement structure should be carried out prior to the design. Estimated quantities for repair areas are to be provided for bidding purposes with adjustments made in the field, as required.

Existing pavement details and areas to be repaired are to be shown on the contract drawings. Consideration for combining repair areas should be given, where the frequency and spacing of repair areas may impact on performance.

It should be indicated in the contract when transverse expansion joints are not to replace existing expansion joints. (Tie bar and dowel bar requirements are shown on the OPSD drawings.)

360.1.1 Tender Item

Full Depth Concrete Slab Repair.

360.1.2 Specifications

Information in regard to Full Depth Concrete Slab Repair is contained in OPSS 360.

360.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

360.1.4 Standard Drawings

Standard drawings giving details of Full Depth Concrete Slab Repair are contained in the OPSD 500 series.

360.2 COMPUTATION

360.2.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender item is field note books, plans,

Rev. Date: 01/99 Full Depth Repair of Concrete Pavement or Concrete Base B360-1

Page 396: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

profiles, standard cross sections, Pavement Design Report and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

Thicknesses of existing concrete pavement and concrete base are established/confirmed by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

360.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for Full Depth Repair of Concrete Pavement or Concrete Base is the surface area of the concrete repair placed in square metres.

The type and depth of concrete is determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

360.3 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each repair area is indicated on the contract plans by station and is detailed on any Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet.

360.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Summarized concrete quantity repair areas are recorded in whole number square metres.

Rev. Date: 01/99 Full Depth Repair of Concrete Pavement or Concrete Base B360-2

Page 397: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

362 - FAST TRACK FULL DEPTH REPAIRSTO CONCRETE PAVEMENT - OPSS 362

362.1 GENERAL

This item covers the requirements for full depth concrete pavement repairs where early opening to traffic is essential.

A preconstruction meeting is required to ensure removal, placement, curing and contingency plans are in place to accommodate early opening to traffic.

There is a requirement for certified testing staff during concrete placement and curing to verify concrete strength prior to opening.

Investigation of the existing concrete pavement structure should be carried out prior to the design and estimated quantities of repair areas are to be provided for bidding purposes, with adjustments made in the field, as required. Existing pavement details are to be shown on the contract drawings. Tie bar and dowel bar requirements are shown on OPSD drawings.

Consideration should be given to specifying a trial repair area away from traffic to verify the performance of the concrete mix and the contractor's operations, as fast track repairs require specially designed concrete mixes.

362.1.1 Tender Item

Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement.

362.1.2 Specifications

Information in regard to the above tender item is contained in OPSS 362.

362.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review any applicable special provisions.

362.1.4 Standard Drawings

Presently there are no standard drawings of Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement at this time, however, associated drawings are contained in the 500 series.

Rev. Date: 01/99 Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement B362-1

Page 398: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

362.2 COMPUTATION

362.2.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender item is field note books, plans, profiles, standard cross sections, Pavement Design Report and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

Thicknesses of existing concrete pavement and concrete base are established and confirmed by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

362.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement is the square metre.

362.3 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each repair area is indicated on the contract plans by station and detailed on any Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet.

362.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Concrete quantity entries are recorded in 0.1 m2.

Summarized concrete quantity repair areas are recorded in whole number square metres.

Rev. Date: 01/99 Fast Track Full Depth Repairs to Concrete Pavement B362-2

Page 399: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REPAIRING RIGID PAVEMENT WITH PRECAST CONCRETE SLABS

B363 - REPAIRING RIGID PAVEMENT WITH PRECAST CONCRETE SLABS - OPSS.PROV 363

363.1 GENERAL

Repairing rigid pavement with precast concrete slabs is recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section on a work project specific basis. It is generally used as a repair when traffic impacts require an overnight or short duration repair method for rigid pavement. The repair of rigid pavement with precast concrete slabs is based on using either the Fort Miller Super-Slab® Method or the Michigan Method. The work may involve both continuous and intermittent slab repairs.

363.1.1 Definitions Continuous Precast Concrete Slab Repair means the continuous replacement of multiple consecutive slabs of concrete pavement with inter-connecting precast concrete slabs. Intermittent Precast Concrete Pavement Slab Repair means a 2 to 4.5 m long repair carried out using a single precast slab.

363.2 REFERENCES N/A

363.3 TENDER ITEM Precast Concrete Slab Repair (normal, m2, PQP)

363.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for repairing rigid pavements with precast concrete slabs are found in OPSS.PROV 363.

363.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of the CDED Manual to review the special provisions applicable to this tender item.

August 2016 Page 1 of 3 B363

Page 400: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REPAIRING RIGID PAVEMENT WITH PRECAST CONCRETE SLABS

363.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings directly applicable to this type of work.

363.7 DESIGN Precast concrete slab repairs can be applied to composite pavement (i.e. with HMA overlay) or rigid pavement. Precast concrete slab repairs are typically used in areas where overnight or short duration repairs are required. All precast concrete slab repair requirements of a project as recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section are stated in the Pavement Design Report. Precast concrete slab repairs can be performed through either intermittent or continuous slab repairs. Typically 3 to 4 hours is required for proprietary concrete repair material and bedding grout, where applicable, to reach the minimum strength requirements. These times can be longer in cold weather.

363.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item, with a square metre unit of measure. Quantities are based on the length by width area of repair.

363.9 DOCUMENTATION Contract drawings and quantity sheets are required with the above tender item. The contract drawings are to show the location of each repair, including station limits and repair widths, and any other necessary details of the work. Each slab repair location is a separate row on the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets, showing location information such as station to station limits, lane, offsets, and traffic direction as required to relate the quantity to the location shown on the drawings. The quantity for each location is entered in the item column. The column entries are totalled and transferred to the tender document. The designer should provide pavement and base thickness and condition information from the pre-engineering investigations.

August 2016 Page 2 of 3 B363

Page 401: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REPAIRING RIGID PAVEMENT WITH PRECAST CONCRETE SLABS

The contract documents must specify the permitted lane closure times to carry out the repairs. This may require a non-standard special provision.

363.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Stations are shown to the nearest whole metre. Offsets are shown to 0.1 m accuracy. Calculated areas in square metres are recorded to the nearest 0.1 m2.

August 2016 Page 3 of 3 B363

Page 402: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 403: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

364 - PARTIAL DEPTH REPAIRS INCONCRETE PAVEMENT - OPSS 364

364.1 GENERAL

The work of partial depth repairs in concrete pavement covers spalling, scaling and other surface defects that are limited to a maximum depth of 1/3 the thickness of the existing concrete slab.

Spalls or other defects which extend below 1/3 the thickness of the slab or intersect dowel bars should not be repaired using this method. If in doubt, designers are recommended to use the full depth repair method.

Investigation of surface defects in the existing concrete pavement structure should be carried out prior to the design. Estimated quantities to repair areas are to be provided for bidding purposes with adjustments made in the field, as required.

Consideration for combining repair areas should be given, where the frequency and spacing of repair areas may impact on performance. Designers may specify milling machines if the areas to be patched are large.

Normal concrete accelerated concrete, polymer concrete, epoxy concrete or quick set materials may be specified, per manufacturer's instructions.

Existing shoulders are to be repaired and restored with similar shoulder material.

364.1.1 Tender Items

Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement.

364.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement are contained in OPSS 364.

364.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review applicable special provisions.

364.1.4 Standard Drawings

Applicable standards for Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement are illustrated in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual in the 500 series.

Rev. Date: 01/99 Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement B364-1

Page 404: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

Rev. Date: 01/99 Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement B364-2

364.2 COMPUTATION

364.2.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender item is found in field note books, plans, profiles, standard cross sections and the Pavement Design Report in consultation with the Regional Geotechnical Section.

364.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement is the square metre.

The type and depth of concrete is determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

364.3 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each repair area is detailed on any Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet.

364.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Summarized repair area quantities are recorded in whole number square metres.

Page 405: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CROSS-STITCHING LONGITUDINAL CRACKS

B365 - CROSS-STITCHING LONGITUDINAL CRACKS IN CONCRETE PAVEMENT AND CONCRETE BASE - OPSS.PROV 365

365.1 GENERAL

Cross-stitching is a method used to tie across longitudinal cracks in concrete pavement. It uses deformed epoxy-coated tie bars that are epoxied into holes drilled at an angle across the crack (see OPSD 560.025). Cross-stitching can apply to longitudinal cracks where the concrete is in reasonably good condition. Cross-stitching is used to tie the longitudinal cracks in concrete pavement to restrict movement and prevent further widening of the crack. It is not used for transverse cracks in concrete pavement because transverse cracks serve as a joint by allowing movement to relieve concrete contraction and expansion stresses. The advantage of cross-stitching is to maintain aggregate interlock and provide added reinforcement to cracks, and the tie bars restrict relative horizontal and vertical movement of the concrete slab or widening of the crack.

365.1.1 Dimension and Location of Drilling Holes The tie bar length, drilling angle and drilling depth depends on slab thickness as shown in OPSD 560.025. The horizontal distance from crack to the drilling hole also depends on the slab thickness.

365.2 REFERENCES N/A

365.3 TENDER ITEM Cross-Stitching Longitudinal Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base (variation, each, non-PQP)

365.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender item are contained in OPSS.PROV 365.

365.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter E to review standard special provisions that may be required for inclusion in the contract.

August 2016 Page 1 of 3 B365

Page 406: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CROSS-STITCHING LONGITUDINAL CRACKS

365.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 500 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) Manual.

365.7 DESIGN Premature failure of concrete pavement with longitudinal cracks that are along the wheelpath or mid-slab should be tied with cross-stitching to prevent further widening of the cracks and to help preserve aggregate interlock. Cross-stitch tie bars are installed alternately on each side of the crack so that the concrete slab is fully tied together. Upon completion of the cross-stitching, the longitudinal crack shall also be sealed as specified in OPSS 369, Sealing or Resealing of Joints and Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base. See CDED B369 for details. Cross-stitching is done on the recommendation of the Regional Geotechnical Section. Often a representative of the Regional Geotechnical Section will be present when locations for cross-stitching are identified or verified by the Contract Administrator.

365.8 COMPUTATION

365.8.1 Source of Information The main source of information for the above tender item is in field note books, plans, profiles, standard cross sections, Pavement Design Reports and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

365.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for cross-stitching longitudinal cracks in Concrete Pavement is “each”, based on the number of bars installed. The number of bars is determined based on the length of cracks and the cross-stitching spacing interval specified in the standard drawing for the work. Consideration is also given to the required distance from any transverse joint, longitudinal joint or edge of concrete pavement.

August 2016 Page 2 of 3 B365

Page 407: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CROSS-STITCHING LONGITUDINAL CRACKS

365.9 DOCUMENTATION 365.9.1 Contract Drawings

The contract drawings shall show the locations requiring cross-stitching. Individual cracks may be illustrated provided that their locations are known to a reasonable accuracy. Each separate location of cross-stitching shall have only one slab thickness, with variation not greater than ± 10 mm.

365.9.2 Quantity Sheets The location of each repair area is shown on the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet. Each line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet shall represent a grouping of cross-stitching bars. The start and end chainage shall be provided to identify the area covered by each grouping. The length of each grouping typically represents the repair of one cracked slab. However, the length may be up to 100 m, at the designer’s discretion, provided that the slab thickness, T, remains constant throughout. Where appropriate, groupings of cross-stitching bars are shown as left or right of the road centreline. Cross-Stitching Longitudinal Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base is a variation item, with the variation being the slab thickness, T. The entered variation value shall be one of the T depth values shown on OPSD 560.025. Each variation requires a separate column on the quantity sheet. The quantity (estimated number of cross-stitching bars for the location) for each repair location is entered in the appropriate variation column. The individual column entries are totaled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

365.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations limits are shown to the nearest metre.

August 2016 Page 3 of 3 B365

Page 408: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 409: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEALING OR RESEALING OF JOINTS AND CRACKS IN CONCRETE PAVEMENT AND CONCRETE BASE

January 2009 Pg. 1 of 3 B369

B369 - SEALING OR RESEALING OF JOINTSAND CRACKS IN CONCRETE PAVEMENT AND CONCRETE BASE

- OPSS 369

369.1 GENERAL

The work of sawing, cleaning and sealing or resealing of joints and working cracks in existing concrete pavement and concrete base to prevent the infiltration of surface water and incompressible materials is covered under the tender item: ‘Resealing of Joints and Sealing or Resealing of Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base’. Resealing of joints includes removal of existing sealant and no sealants shall be installed until all grinding or milling has been completed. Joints in concrete base do not need to be sealed, but any cracks in concrete base should be sealed.

The need for crack sealing is usually initiated by the Regional Geotechnical Design Section and recommendations are typically contained within the Regional Geotechnical Design Report.

When concrete pavement is placed according to OPSS 350, all joints and sealing are paid for as part of the work of placing new concrete pavement.

369.2 REFERENCES - None

369.3 TENDER ITEM

Resealing of Joints and Sealing or Resealing of Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base.

369.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the above tender item are contained in OPSS 369.

369.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

There are no special provisions for this tender item.

369.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are illustrated in the Ontario Provincial Standard

Page 410: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEALING OR RESEALING OF JOINTS AND CRACKS IN CONCRETE PAVEMENT AND CONCRETE BASE

January 2009 Pg. 2 of 3 B369

Drawings Manual in the 500 series.

369.7 DESIGN

The specification is appropriate for use on cracks and joints up to 25 mm in width. For widths greater than 25 mm, the designer should consider alternative remedial treatment such as full depth repair, using other tender items.

This tender item may be used for two cases:

1/ Composite pavement (asphalt over concrete). The quantity of crack lengths (m) in the underlying concrete are estimated in the Pavement Design Report. Actual cracks to repair are identified during construction after asphalt is removed.

2/ Concrete pavement. An accurate quantity (m) of crack lengths may be estimated during a field visit by geotechnical staff and reported in the Pavement Design Report.

The designer should estimate tender quantities for resealing of cracks and joints and sealing of cracks required under this item. The tender quantity should not include the sealing of joints in new concrete pavement. (reference: CDED B350)

A pavement condition survey is recommended to estimate the extent of the joint and crack sealing or resealing required.

The ministry now only specifies hot pour liquid sealant.

369.8 COMPUTATION

This is a PQP item.

369.8.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for this tender item is field note books, standard cross sections, Pavement Design Reports and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

369.8.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for “Resealing of Joints and Sealing or Resealing of Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base” is made in linear metres.

Page 411: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEALING OR RESEALING OF JOINTS AND CRACKS IN CONCRETE PAVEMENT AND CONCRETE BASE

January 2009 Pg. 3 of 3 B369

369.9 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each repair area is indicated on the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet. Note the start and end chainage of each area of repair in one line. A single column is titled with the tender item name. The quantity of crack length of repair for each area is entered in this column in the corresponding line.

The length of repair area may be 350m or other suitable interval.

369.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Summarized repair lengths are recorded to the nearest whole number of metres.

Page 412: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 413: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 05 B399-2-1

399-2 - RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

INDEX

399-2.1 GENERAL

399-2.1.1 Tender Items

399-2.1.2 Traffic Warrant

399-2.1.3 Reference Publication

399-2.1.4 Warrant for Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth

399-2.1.5 Warrant for Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth

399-2.1.6 Reclaimed Material

399-2.1.7 Contaminated Existing Pavement

399-2.1.8 Design Alternatives

399-2.1.9 Specifications

399-2.1.10 Special Provisions

399-2.1.11 Standard Drawings

399-2.2 COMPUTATION

399-2.2.1 Source of Information

399-2.2.2 Method of Calculation

399-2.2.3 Loss Allowance for Reclaimed Asphalt Pavement

399-2.3 DOCUMENTATION

399-2.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Page 414: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 01 B399-2-2

399-2 RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

399-2.1 GENERAL

Reclaimed Asphalt Pavement (RAP): means removed asphaltic concrete material, consisting of aggregates and asphalt cement, which is processed for and used in asphaltic concrete.

Reclaiming asphalt pavement to its full depth applies when the total thickness of asphalt pavement is to be removed and the material is re-used in recycled hot mix.

Reclaiming asphalt pavement to a partial depth applies when the top portion of the asphalt pavement is to be removed by cold milling or cold planing and the material is re-used in recycled hot mix.

399-2.1.1 Tender Items

The following items are associated with reclaiming asphalt pavement.

Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth. Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth Reclaim Asphalt Pavement, Full Depth over Concrete

Non - PQP item Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth

PQP item Reclaim Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth Reclaim Asphalt Pavement, Full Depth over Concrete

399-2.1.2 Traffic Warrant

Recycled Hot Mix may be used in any paving course except in surface courses carrying in excess of 5000 AADT/2 Lanes.

399-2.1.3 Reference Publication

1. A comprehensive write-up on Hot Mix Recycling information is contained in the publication prepared by the MTO Pavement and Foundation Design Section entitled "TASK FORCE REPORT II ON HOT MIX RECYCLING", May 1981.

2. Conventional hot mix paving is covered in this manual in Section B313-1 - Hot Mix.

Page 415: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 01 B399-2-3

399-2.1.4 Warrants for Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth

(a) Existing asphalt pavement depth of 65 mm or more which is not badly distorted or cracked.

(b) When a minimum thickness of 40 mm can be left in place.

399-2.1.5 Warrants for Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth

(a) When deep cracks in the existing asphalt pavement are present which would reflect through the overlay.

(b) Broken pavement, heavy distortions and/or wheel rutting of the existing asphalt.

(c) Thin pavement which is badly distorted.

399-2.1.6 Surplus Reclaimed Material

It is advisable to achieve a balance between the reclaimed asphalt pavement available and the recycled hot mix required. If surplus reclaimed material is available, then the following steps should be taken:

a) Reduce the amount of reclaimed asphalt pavement.

b) Stockpile the material for use on a future contract. (To be confirmed by Regional Geotechnical Section.)

c) Excess amount to become the property of the contractor for use as recycled material elsewhere at this discretion.

d) Milled or crushed material may be used as Granular 'A' for roadway construction, when the surplus amount is small and a proper placement area is available.

399-2.1.7 Contaminated Existing Pavement

Existing Asphalt waterproofing material from bridge decks is not to be included with the reclaimed material. This material is not acceptable for recycling.

399-2.1.8 Design Alternatives

The following main design alternatives should be considered for any construction project requiring hot mix paving.

Page 416: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 01 B399-2-4

- Conventional paving;

- paving with conventional and/or recycled hot mix;

- full depth removal and paving with conventional and/or recycled hot mix;

- partial depth removal and paving with conventional and/or recycled hot mix;

- any combination of the above.

Reclaiming and recycling of asphalt pavement should be considered for all projects. It is preferable that salvageable asphalt pavement be utilized on that particular contract rather than stockpiling it for future work.

The design alternative chosen should be the most economical or cost effective.

399-2.1.9 Specifications

There is no Ministry construction specification for these tender items.

399-2.1.10 Special Provision

The work of reclaiming asphalt pavement is governed by special provision. The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions. Options regarding surplus material are noted on the special provisions. The average reclaiming depth for the tender item "Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement-Partial Depth" is to be recorded in the appropriate standard special provision.

399-2.1.11 Standard Drawings

There are no Ministry standard drawings directly applicable to this type of work.

Granular construction standard drawings in the 200 series should be referenced for roadway restoration.

Page 417: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 01 B399-2-5

399-2.2 COMPUTATION

399-2.2.1 Source of Information

Source of information for the above tender items are the Regional Geotechnical Section, Pavement Design Report, the original cross-section data, soil borings and asphalt pavement core logs.

399-2.2.2 Method of Calculation

The quantity of partial depth reclaimed asphalt is initially calculated in cubic metres by establishing the volume to be removed. This volume is converted to tonnes. The conversion factor is determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section on a Project specific basis as this will vary depending on the composition of the existing asphalt pavement.

The quantity of full depth reclaimed asphalt is calculated and documented in square metres.

Where excavation is required in areas of full depth reclaiming of asphalt pavement, the volume of the reclaimed asphalt pavement overlying the excavation will be included in the excavation quantity for payment purposes.

399-2.2.3 Loss Allowance for Reclaimed Asphalt Pavement

a) Partial Depth Reclaiming Projects A loss allowance factor of 10% should be included in the design

calculations. This factor includes transportation, stockpile, moisture and hot mix production loss.

e.g. Reclaimed Material Available for Recycling - 1000 t 10% loss - 100 t Material to be Milled - 1100 t

b) Full Depth Reclaiming Projects No loss allowance factor is applied. Any volume losses due to

transportation, stockpiling and hot mix production are assumed balanced by granular pickup during the full depth removal operation.

399-2.3 DOCUMENTATION

Reclaiming asphalt pavement is identified on the removal drawings by using the pavement removal symbol.

Page 418: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RECLAIM ASPHALT PAVEMENT

01 01 B399-2-6

Documentation of reclaimed asphalt pavement is complicated by requiring that some locations have full depth reclaiming or removal in square metres, whereas others have partial depth reclaiming by the tonne. It is important that the quantity sheets show sufficient detail by station to station and offset to clearly define the reclaiming and removal areas. This also applies to removal drawings, which should be labelled appropriately when the pavement removal symbol is used.

When a portion of a roadway cross section requires reclaiming asphalt pavement, a typical section should be included in the contract drawings to identify the location and extent of reclaiming.

The limits of reclaiming on side roads, entrances etc. must be specified on either the plan or the quantity sheet.

Quantities for reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Partial Depth are documented on the Quantities -1 or -2 sheet. The average reclaiming depth is documented on the applicable standard special provision.

Quantities for Reclaiming Asphalt Pavement - Full Depth are documented on any miscellaneous Quantity Sheet. Existing asphalt pavement depths are usually available to the contractor through the soils information bore hole data. If these are not available the depth should be obtained from the Regional Geotechnical Section and the average depth documented on the quantity sheet. The station to station and location is specified on the quantity sheet. In complicated configurations the offsets are recorded. Quantities for each tender item are totalled. These totals are the tender totals and are transferred to the tender document.

399-2.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Quantity entries are recorded in whole numbers.

Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

Spot checking is required.

Page 419: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 1 of 6 B405

405 - PIPE SUBDRAINS - OPSS 405

405.1 GENERAL

Subdrains are small diameter pipes, perforated or non-perforated, which are placed for the purpose of collecting sub-surface water and conveying it to a proper outlet.

Guidelines on the engineering principles and practices for the detail design of sub-drainage are contained in MTO Drainage Management Manual 1997 Edition.

405.1.1 Types and Sizes of Subdrains

Subdrain pipes are produced from the following materials � corrugated steel (CSP) � plastic (polyethylene and polyvinyl chloride)

Perforations are either small holes (CSP) or small slots (plastic pipes).

Perforated plastic subdrain pipes may be factory-wrapped with geotextile of a specific type.

Perforated plastic pipe subdrains are also available from the manufacturer without geotextile wrapping.

Subdrains are produced in 100 and 150 mm diameters.

405.2 REFERENCES

MTO Drainage Management Manual (1997) Geotechnical Design Report – project specific

405.3 TENDER ITEMS

Pipe Subdrains Closed-Circuit Television Inspection

The “Pipe Subdrains” tender item may contain a number of components of highway subdrains and field subdrains with differing requirements, depending on the applicable variables.

Page 420: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 2 of 6 B405

“Closed-Circuit Television Inspection” is not required for new construction less than 1000 metres.

405.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of the construction of pipe subdrains are contained in OPSS 405.

405.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Standard Special Provisions of the CDED Manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items.

405.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Details of subdrain installation are contained in the 200 series for grading, 800 series for sewers, and 3000 series for bridge structures of the OPSD manual.

405.7 DESIGN

405.7.1 Pipe Selection

Unless otherwise specified there is no restriction as to pipe material and type of installation to be used on a contract. The specification gives the Contractor the option of pipe material.

When significant subdrainage flow is expected (e.g. high water table) 150 mm pipe plastic subdrains are recommended. Otherwise 100 mm pipe plastic subdrains are used. The minimum CSP subdrain size manufactured is 150 mm and these are placed only when recommended by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

Subdrain trenches shall be designed to allow the pipe subdrain to sit on a minimum of 50 mm pipe bedding as specified in the specification.

The recommended pipe size, geotextile type (class, Filtration Opening Size) wrap, and embedment material for subdrain trench shall be determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

Clear stone (19mm) should be specified unless the pavement consists of Open Graded Drainage Layer, then open graded drainage layer aggregate shall be considered as subdrain and outlet embedment. Usually 19 mm clear stone should be specified for

Page 421: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 3 of 6 B405

subdrain embedment, unless the construction of the road involves OGDL. Not all road structure consists of OGDL, but when the road structure has OGDL, then the designer can specify OGDL aggregate to replace 19 mm clear stone for the subdrain embedment (one less item for the contract).

The subdrain trench and outlet shall be wrapped with geotextile unless otherwise specified by the Regional Geotechnical Section.

Outlets

Outlets are 2.5 m long, fitted with rodent gates, which are placed at the end of outlet pipes, regardless of the subdrain material.

405.7.2 Types of Installations

Perforated subdrains are commonly installed at the following locations:

� as collector drains in the roadbed at the outer edges of the granular sub-base, or at the edges of pavement;

� as collector drains alongside edges of pavement in retrofit situations.

� as collector drains behind structures or retaining walls, in the lower part of the granular embedment;

� as collector drains in sewer trenches which are backfilled with granular material. This is usually accomplished by placing a 6 m section of perforated subdrain alongside the downstream end of a sewer pipe, which outlets into a drainage structure. This applies to the main sewer run. It may apply to branch sewers, if the main sewer is backfilled with native material. It however does not apply to short lateral sewer connections.

� as interceptor drains in the roadbed or in interceptor ditches;

� as drawdown drains in the roadbed or in side ditches;

� as field subdrains when restoring field drainage disturbed by highway construction. These drains may be ploughed-in.

Non-perforated subdrains are used in conjunction with perforated subdrains in the following locations:

� generally, to carry water collected by perforated subdrain to an outlet;

Page 422: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 4 of 6 B405

� as outlets in continuous installations of roadbed subdrains or bridge structure subdrains;

� to connect perforated subdrain systems in roadbeds outletting into a drainage structure.

� as outlets with rodent gates at the termination of outlet pipes;

� in the vicinity of large trees, within 5 m of the trunk.

405.7.3 Trench Reinstatement

Where existing driving lanes must be cut to allow the construction of subdrains, the affected roadbed must be rebuilt to acceptable standards to maintain the continuity of the pavement. This is particularly important where there is to be no resurfacing of the highway. Trench reinstatement is not often done. When done, it is to address a subgrade drainage problem, independently of other work. Most work involving pipe subdrains involves some grading.

405.8 COMPUTATION

“Pipe Subdrains” is a Plan Quantity Payment item. “Closed-Circuit Television Inspection” is not a Plan Quantity Payment item.

405.8.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of the “Pipe Subdrains” tender item are field note books, plans, contour plans, profiles, standard cross-sections and the Pavement Design Report.

405.8.2 Method of Calculation

For the “Pipe Subdrains” tender item, each combination of pipe diameter, pipe material, excavation and backfill requires individual length calculation. These lengths are calculated/measured from plans, horizontally, from end to end of the pipe, including outlets; or from end of pipe to the centre of the adjacent drainage structure to which the pipe is connected. The unit of measurement is the metre.

The “Closed-Circuit Television Inspection” tender item is measured based on the linear metres of subdrains, outlet pipes and outlets that are inspected by Closed-Circuit

Page 423: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 5 of 6 B405

Television (CCTV) Inspection. CCTV Inspection shall be based on random sampling to include 5% of the entire length of the subdrain system and 100% of all outlet pipes.

405.9 DOCUMENTATION

405.9.1 Pipe Subdrains

Drawings

Subdrains, including the direction of flow, are to be symbolized on the contract drawings in accordance with the appropriate 100 series drawing of the OPSD Manual and MTO Drawings. Include grade and show alignment of the trench excavation.

A typical section is usually provided due to the number of variables involved. Subdrains on a typical section shall be labelled "Pipe Subdrain" not CSP subdrain or plastic subdrain unless these are specifically required. Include the following details on the typical section, as applicable:

� Pipe diameter, metal thickness, corrugation profile, and coating requirements of corrugated steel pipe.

� Pipe diameter, type, and stiffness requirements of polyethylene and polyvinyl chloride pipe products.

� Wrapping of the subdrain pipe with a knitted sock geotextile � The width (cross-section) of trench excavation.� Bedding depth � Type, Class, Filtration Opening Size (FOS) and installation details of geotextile

trench wrap, if required. � Open graded drainage layer aggregate or clear stone type for embedment of

subdrain and outlet pipes.

Where “Trench Reinstatement” is used, a typical section, labelled as "trench reinstatement", must be shown on the contract plans. The drawing should show cross-section dimensions and refer to the applicable standard drawings for bedding and backfill up to subgrade. Above subgrade, the drawing should specify the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity.

Quantity Sheets

Each length of pipe subdrain is entered in one line in the Quantities Miscellaneous sheet. Start and end chainages are provided. The offset, left or right, is stated in the location and position column.

Pipe Subdrains is a variation tender item that has a number of variables, as shown in the bullet list above. Multiple combinations of variables apply to each pipe subdrain

Page 424: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SUBDRAINS

June 2009 Pg. 6 of 6 B405

installation. Such variables may be addressed in the ‘typical sections’. Column headings in the Quantities Miscellaneous sheet will address these variables. Each column will include the title: ‘pipe subdrains’ followed by the applicable variations. Each length of pipe subdrain is entered in the column with the appropriate column heading. If there are too many different combinations of variables to be accommodated within the typical section(s) or Quantities Miscellaneous sheet, a Non-standard Special Provision may be required to address one or more of the variables.

Non-Standard Special Provisions

A non-standard special provision is required if pipe bedding is not required.

When trench reinstatement is provided, a non-standard special provision may be required to modify OPSS 405.10.01 to clarify that payment of all excavation and granular backfill is included in the Pipe Subdrains tender item. Where pavement is removed and/or the excavation area is subsequently repaved, any pavement cutting, removal and paving should be done using appropriate tender items.

405.9.2 Closed Circuit Television Inspection

Quantity Sheets

The Quantities Miscellaneous sheet is used to document CCTV Inspection. One column has the title “Closed Circuit Television Inspection”. The estimated total quantity of Closed Circuit Television Inspection (m) is entered in one line of the Quantities Miscellaneous sheet. If there is a need to allocate where locations of CCTV Inspection are to occur, multiple lines in the Quantities Miscellaneous sheet may be used, each with the appropriate start and end chainage.

Entry Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole number metres. Offsets are shown to 0.1 m accuracy, as required.

Page 425: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-1 - MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCHBASINS AND DITCH INLETS

- MTC FORM 407

INDEX

407-1.1 GENERAL

Tender Items SpecificationsSpecial Provisions Standard Drawings

407-1.1.1 Frame and Grate Selection

407-1.1.2 Selection of Structure

407-1.2 COMPUTATION

407-1.2.1 Source of Information

407-1.2.2 Method of Calculation

407-1.3 DOCUMENTATION

407-1.4 BREAKING INTO MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH BASINS AND DITCH INLETS, CONCRETE CULVERTS & SEWERS

407-1.4.1 GENERAL

Tender Items SpecificationSpecial Provisions

407-1.4.2 COMPUTATION

407-1.4.3 Source of Information

407-1.4.4 Method of Calculation

407-1.4.5 DOCUMENTATION

407-1.5 ADJUSTING MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH BASINS AND DITCH INLETS

407-1.5.1 GENERAL

Tender Items SpecificationsSpecial Provisions Standard Drawings

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-1

Page 426: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-1.5.2 COMPUTATION

407-1.5.3 Source of Information

407-1.5.4 Method of Calculation

407-1.5.5 DOCUMENTATION

407-1.1 GENERAL

Maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are structures of varying design characteristics employed in the drainage system of roads and highways in order to intercept surface water runoff and also provide access to sewer pipes and junctions for maintenance purposes.

For the purpose of these guidelines the term "structures" is used when reference is made to maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets collectively.

Maintenance Holes

A maintenance hole is any structure large enough to allow entry for maintenance purposes, usually 1200 mm diameter minimum. Maintenance holes may be catch basins and/or access structures by function, depending on whether a grate or solid cover is placed on the top.

Maintenance holes are placed at intermediate locations in a sewer run.

Catch Basins

Generally, all structures which are designed to allow water to enter into through a grate, are catch basins.

Specifically, a catch basin is a small structure, usually 600 mm x 600 mm in opening size which is designed to be placed at the beginning of a sewer run in the gutter line. The small size of the catch basin does not allow entry for maintenance purposes.

Ditch Inlets

Ditch inlets are specifically designed to be placed in ditches to intercept ditch flow. They may be non-accessible small size (600 mm x 600 mm) or any of the accessible larger sizes.

Ditch inlets are designed to be placed either in the bottom of a ditch, or to fit into the ditch slopes.

Spacing

The spacing of structures is dependent on two requirements:

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-2

Page 427: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

- hydrological (i.e. inlet capacities, outlet locations, etc.) - maintenance

The maximum spacing based on maintenance requirements are:

a) 30 m between a 600 mm x 600 mm catch basin or ditch inlet at the beginning of a sewer run and the next downstream structure.

b) 150 m between any two consecutive structures in a sewer run other than under a) above.

Inlet spacing based on hydraulic requirements are detailed in the Drainage Design Manual. Usually the maintenance requirements govern the maximum structure spacing.

Where it is necessary to remove pavement in order to construct the above structures, the necessary removals will be included in the maintenance hole item, except if there is overlap of removals for grading purposes. Removal of curb & gutter is always a separate tender item.

Designs will be based on precast concrete catch basin and maintenance hole standards. Form 407 gives the contractor the option to build poured-in-place units.

When Corrugated Steel Pipe (CSP) sewers are called for in the contract, Form 407 also provides the option to the contractor to construct CSP catch basins and maintenance holes.

Tender Items

Tender items for maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are all inclusive, with the exception of rock excavation and the installation of frames and grates if they form part of the curb & gutter system - OPSS 353.

Item Descriptions

Each size requires a separate tender item as follows:

600 mm x 600 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 600 mm x 1200 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 600 mm x 1450 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 1200 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 1200 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m 1500 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 1500 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m 1800 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 1800 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m 2400 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 2400 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m 3000 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 3000 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-3

Page 428: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

3600 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets 3600 mm Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets, Over 4 m

When large diameter sewers are required. the designer may wish to specify maintenance hole tees instead of standard maintenance holes. In this case the tee sections will be part of the sewer, whereas the riser sections will be part of the maintenance hole items with the appropriate diameter. This requires a special provision.

Rock excavation for maintenance holes will be part of the item Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets. (See Section B407-2)

Specifications

All information regarding the construction of maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets is indicated in MTC Form 407.

Information regarding the installation of frames and grates, if part of the construction of curbs and gutters, is indicated in OPSS 353.

Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

Standard Drawings

The standard drawings applicable to the construction of maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual (OPSD). Only precast maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlet standard drawings and their CSP options are referenced in the contract.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-4

Page 429: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

INFORMATION REGARDING MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH BASINS AND DITCH INLETS

StructureSize(mm)

Type of Structure

PrecastConcret

e(OPSD)

Corrugated

Steel(OPSD)

Maximum

Structure

Depth(mm)

Maximum Sewer Dia.(Straight)

(mm)

Maximum Sewer Dia. (Rt. Angle)

(mm)

Sump Depth(mm)

Benching

TwinInlets

Other Std'sUsed in

Conjunction

600 x 600 C.B. 705.010 N/A 4.0 525 525 600 NO NO600 x 600 D.I. 705.030 N/A 4.0 525 525 600 NO NO

600 x 1200

D.I. 705.040 N/A 4.0 600ww375nw

600ww375nw

600 NO NO

600 x 1450

TWININLET

C.B.

705.020 N/A 4.0 600ww375nw

600ww375nw

600 NO YES

1200 x 1200

D.I.Type A

702.040 N/A 3.6 600 600 300 YES NO

700 DIA. C.B. N/A 709.030 4.0 2 STD SIZES< 700

2 STD SIZES< 700

600 YES NO

1000DIA.

C.B. N/A 709.030 4.0 2 STD SIZES < 1000

2 STD SIZES< 1000

600 YES NO

1200DIA.

M.H. 701.010 709.010709.020

4.0 P.C. - See 701.021CSP-2

STD SIZE < 1200

P.C. - See 701.021CSP - 2

STD SIZE < 1200

300 YES NO

1500DIA.

M.H.TWIN

OPTION

701.011 N/A 10.0 SEE701.021

SEE701.021

300 YES YES 701.021701.040703.010

1800DIA.

M.H.TWIN

OPTION

701.012 N/A 10.0 SEE701.021

SEE701.021

300 YES YES 701.021701.050703.020

2400DIA.

M.H.TWIN

OPTION

701.013 N/A 10.0 SEE701.021

SEE701.021

300 YES YES 701.021701.060703.030

3000DIA.

M.H.TWIN

OPTION

701.014 N/A 10.0 SEE701.021

SEE701.021

300 YES YES 701.021701.070703.040

3600DIA.

M.H.TWIN

OPTION

701.015 N/A 10.0 SEE701.021

SEE701.021

300 YES YES 701.021701.070703.050

Remarks: Caps, grates, tees, ladder rungs, safety grates, connections, supports and adjustment units apply as required (see OPSD's). Where depths exceed 4.0 m CSP Maintenance Holes cannot be specified. CSP's to be specified as alternatives only when all pipes at structures are CSP pipes. All references to "Conc" and "CSP" in above chart refer to structures only, not CSP's.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-5

Page 430: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

TABLE 407-1

MAXIMUM PIPE SIZES FOR PRECAST MAINTENANCE HOLES (mm)

CIRCULAR PRECAST MAINTENANCE HOLES

MAINTENANCE HOLE INSIDE DIAMETER

MAXIMUM CONCRETE PIPE SIZE FOR STRAIGHT

THROUGH INSTALLATION

MAXIMUM CONCRETE PIPE SIZE FOR RIGHT ANGLE

INSTALLATION1200 600 4501500 825 6001800 1050 8252400 1500 10503000 1950 15003600 2400 2100

RECTANGULAR PRECAST MAINTENANCE HOLES

CIRCULARPRECAST SIZE

DIAMETER

EQUIVALENTRECTANGULAR

SIZE

MAXIMUM CONCRETE PIPE SIZE FOR

STRAIGHT THROUGH INSTALLATION

MAXIMUM CONCRETE PIPE SIZE FOR

RIGHT ANGLE INSTALLATION

1200 1200 x 1200 900 450 & 450 1500 1500 x 1800 1050 & 1350 600 & 750 1800 1650 x 2400 1200 & 1800 750 & 1200 1800 1650 x 3000 1200 & 2400 750 & 1500 2400 2400 x 2400 1800 & 1800 1200 & 1200

-- 2400 x 3000 1800 & 2400 1200 & 1500 -- 2400 x 3800 1800 & 3000 1200 & 1950 -- 3000 x 3800 2400 & 3000 1500 & 1950

3000 -- -- --3600 -- -- --

TABLE 407-2

407-1.1.1 Frame and Grate Selection

The selection of frames and grates depends on the location of the inlet and the size of opening required. Both aspects are adequately covered in the Drainage Design Manual.

407-1.1.2 Selection of Structure

The selection of the type and size of structure is dependent on the type and number of grates required, on the size of the sewer pipes entering and leaving the structure, on the angle at which the pipes meet at the structure and on whether or not access is required for maintenance purposes. Tables 407-1 and 407-2 are a guide to the selection of maintenance holes.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-6

Page 431: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-1.2 COMPUTATION

These items are Plan Quantity Payment items.

407-1.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of the above items are:

a) Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings for the type and size of structure and for frames and grates;

b) Storm Sewer Design for the type, size, spacing and locations of the structures;

c) Regional Geotechnical Section to determine the presence of rock on the contract;

d) Photogrammetric Drainage Information.

407-1.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for the drainage structures is "each".

The number of drainage structures is dependent on the hydraulic design (i.e. run-off, inlet capacity, allowable spread, pavement design, etc.), sewer alignment and maximum spacing for clean out purposes. The depths of structures have to be determined in order to separate the tender items of certain sizes into those less than and those over 4 m depth.

The depth of structure is the difference between the top of grate elevation at the centre of the grate and the elevation of the inside bottom of the structure at the centre (sump or flow line).

Maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are to be designed with a minimum sump depth of 300 mm.

Where precast structures are not feasible, special design structures may be required. Each special design structure will be a separate item, by each, with concrete volumes and steel quantities detailed separately.

Maintenance holes exceeding the depth of 5.0 m require installation of safety gratings.

All items require 100% checking.

407-1.3 DOCUMENTATION

Details of all structures are to be documented on the "Quantities - Drainage, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets" sheet.

Tender totals, are to be transferred to the tender document.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-7

Page 432: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

All applicable standard drawing numbers, including the numbers for optional CSP application, frames and grates, ladder rungs and safety grates, are to be listed by number and revision number. Cast-in-place standard drawing numbers are not to be listed.

Precast concrete ditch inlet maintenance holes OPSD 702.040 and 702.050 are alternatives to other standard precast maintenance holes.

Offsets are determined from centre line (or control line) to the centre of the grate or cover. Offsets are recorded to 0.01 m accuracy.

Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

Special design structures are separate tender items by "each". They require design drawings for inclusion in the contract and listing on the quantity sheet including separate columns for concrete volumes and reinforcing steel tonnage.

Rock excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets may be summarized on either the Maintenance Holes Quantity Sheet or the Sewers Quantity Sheet before transferring to the tender document.

407-1.4 BREAKING INTO MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH BASINS, DITCH INLETS, CULVERTS & SEWERS - MTC FORM 407

407-1.4.1 GENERAL

This item consists of providing whatever size openings are necessary in the walls of the above existing structures, rigid or flexible, in order to install and secure the required pipe connection. This includes all rigid pipes, flexible pipes and subdrains.

Tender Item

Breaking into Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets, Culverts and Sewers.

Specification

All information regarding the above item is indicated in MTC Form 407.

Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter E of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

407-1.4.2 COMPUTATION

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

407-1.4.3 Source of Information

The main source of information for the computation of this item are the field note books, Plans, Contour Plans and the sewer drawings.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-8

Page 433: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-1.4.4 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for this item is "each", based on the number of pipe connections required regardless of size and type and distance from any adjacent openings. It is possible to have more than one opening at any given structure. 100% checking is required for this item.

407-1.4.5 DOCUMENTATION

Any of the above types of structures which are affected by this item are to be indicated on the contract drawing sewer profile sheets. Entries are required on the Quantities - Drainage, Maintenance Hole, Catch Basin and Ditch Inlets sheet for each location where "Breaking Into" is required and the number of openings required is to be listed under a separate column. Usually these structures are numbered sequentially as an integral part of the drainage design.

Breaking into culverts and sewers will be listed on the appropriate Quantity Sheet (Quantities - Culverts or Quantities - Sewers) by station and location. The totals will be transferred to the maintenance hole quantity sheet and summarized for a combined tender total.

The tender total is then transferred to the tender document.

407-1.5 ADJUSTING AND REBUILDING MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH BASINS AND DITCH INLETS - MTC FORM 407

407-1.5.1 GENERAL

Work to be carried out under this item consists of changing the elevation of any of the above structures by either raising or lowering the top of the existing structure according to the design requirements of the contract regardless of type or size. This item also includes all necessary excavation and backfill required to adjust or rebuild the existing structure.

Removal of bituminous or concrete pavement is also part of the item, unless the project includes separate removal items which cover such work in the same location as the adjustment. Removal of curb & gutter will always be a separate item.

The existing frame and grate is to be salvaged and reused if suitable. When the existing frames and grates are not to be reused, due to their condition or type, disposal instructions are to be set out in a special provision (e.g. delivery to MTO yard or disposal arranged for by contractor).

Tender Item

Adjusting and Rebuilding Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets.

This tender item will be used regardless of the amount of change in elevation, type or size of drainage structure.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-9

Page 434: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

Specifications

All information regarding the item is indicated in MTC Form 407.

Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

Standard Drawings

The standard drawings applicable to this tender item are contained in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual (Frames and Grates and Adjustment Units).

407-1.5.2 COMPUTATION

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

407-1.5.3 Source of Information

The main source of information for the computation of this item are the field note books, B-Plans, Contour Plans and the drainage design.

407-1.5.4 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement is "each". When existing maintenance holes are to be adjusted more than once (because of staging, etc.) only one adjustment will be considered for payment.

The adjustment of a double inlet maintenance hole or catch basin is considered one adjustment, requiring two frames and grates or covers, new or existing.

New maintenance holes or catch basins, which have to be partially built and later adjusted under the same contract, are not considered under this tender item.

100% checking is required for this item.

407-1.5.5 DOCUMENTATION

All types of existing structures affected by this item will be numbered and listed on the Quantities - Maintenance Holes ... sheet by station and location, showing type (straight or domed), existing top of grate and new top of grate elevations. Also the type of frame and grate to be placed will be shown.

When an existing structure requires more than one adjustment either due to staging or other construction requirements, interim top of grate elevation(s) and interim type(s) of grate must be shown in addition to the final elevation and type. The item column will reflect one adjustment only, regardless of the number of interim adjustments.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-10

Page 435: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

When new frames and grates are required, the standard number is required in the "grate" column. When the existing frames and grates are to be re-used, the word "existing" is to be written in the same column. For double inlet maintenance holes and catch basins, the grate column should show (2) behind the type.

Stage construction of new maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are not considered to be adjustments for payment purposes.

If temporary covers are required they should also be indicated on the quantity sheet along with the final frame and grate to be used.

Stations are recorded in whole number metres. Offsets are recorded to 0.1 m accuracy.

The tender total is the number of structures to be adjusted, which is transferred to the tender document.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-1-11

Page 436: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 437: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-2 - ROCK EXCAVATION FORSEWERS, MAINTENANCE HOLES, CATCH

BASINS AND DITCH INLETS- MTC FORM 407

407-2.1 GENERAL

This item includes the rock excavation from within the standard excavation limits for sewers, maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets. Since sewer and maintenance hole items are all inclusive, except for rock excavation, this will provide the contractor with payment for the work involved over and above a normal sewer construction in earth.

If the amount of rock is a known quantity, i.e. if the designer is confident that the rock excavation may be included in the maintenance hole/sewer items, provided the quantity is stated on the quantity sheets and a special provision included to change the basis of payment.

407-2.1.2 Tender Item

The item description for this work is Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets.

407-2.1.3 Specifications

All information regarding the above item is indicated in MTC Form 407.

407-2.1.4 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

407-2.2 COMPUTATION

This item is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

407-2.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for this tender item are the Soils/Foundation Reports and the soils profile for the earth/rock excavation; the standard drawings for maintenance hole and sewer dimensions; the drainage design for types of drainage structures and sewer sizes, and the roadway cross sections.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-2-1

Page 438: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

407-2.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement is the cubic metre. Usually rock quantities are computed separately for maintenance holes and sewers before they are combined into one tender item.

a) Excavation for maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets.

The computation of the rock quantity will be based on:

i) The outside horizontal dimensions of the structure as indicated on the standard drawings, plus 0.3 m.

ii) The depth will be the difference between the rock surface, or the lowest excavation limit prior to sewer excavation, and the underside of the base of the structure.

Within the roadbed the upper limit is the top of shatter.

b) Excavation for Sewers.

The computation of the rock quantity will be based on:

i) The maximum allowable width indicated on the standard drawings for the different bedding types, trench conditions and pipe material (flexible/rigid).

ii) The length between excavations for maintenance holes, as described in i) above, or between the excavation for the last maintenance hole and the outlet.

iii) The depth between the rock surface, or lowest excavation limit before sewer excavation, and the underside of the bedding (bottom of trench).

Within the roadbed the upper limit is the top of shatter. 100% checking of quantities is required for this item.

407-2.2.3 DOCUMENTATION

Rock excavation quantities for maintenance holes, catch basins and ditch inlets are to be computed at each location and indicated in a separate column on the maintenance hole quantity sheet.

Rock excavation for sewers is to be computed for each sewer run and indicated in a separate column on the sewer quantity sheet.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-2-2

Page 439: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

For a combined total the sub-total on the sewer quantity sheet is transferred to the Quantities - Maintenance Holes ... etc. sheet. Quantity entries will be in whole number cubic metres.

Where the excavated material is available for embankment construction, the quantities must appear on the Quantities -Grading sheet under rock material available.

Rev. Date: 09/99 Rock Excavation for Sewers, Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets B407-2-3

Page 440: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 441: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

B410 - PIPE SEWERS – OPSS.PROV 410 410.1 GENERAL

A sewer network is required in an urban setting or where open ditches in combination with pipe culverts cannot accomplish drainage of a roadway system, due to restricted property limits or susceptibility of a terrain to erosion. A sewer is an installation designed for the conveyance of storm water using preformed or pre-cast pipe sections, circular in cross section, laid end to end using suitable jointing material and connected by maintenance holes, catchbasins, ditch inlets or other appurtenances. All design assumptions and calculations required to design a sewer network shall be retained as part of the design documentation.

410.2 REFERENCES MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards MTO Drainage Management Manual MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines Ontario Provincial Standards Specifications Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings Drainage Guidelines available on the MTO public web site All references noted are available through the Contract Preparation System (CPS) or through the ministry’s public web site or through the MTO Online Catalogue library. The designer shall also reference other design manuals (i.e. MTO Roadside Safety Manual) as required for design assistance of other roadside features associated with the pipe sewer network design.

410.3 TENDER ITEMS Pipe Sewer Concrete Appurtenances Rock Excavation for Sewers Clay Seal

November 2015 Page 1 of 24 B410

Page 442: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

410.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the pipe sewer tender items are specified in OPSS 410. The designer shall also reference or note other OPSS documents for construction and materials as identified or required when packaging a contract.

410.5 APPENDICES Appendix A - Pipe Sewer Tender Item This appendix describes the pipe sewer tender item and is to be followed by the designer to itemize the pipe sewer tender item entries, complete with size, type and class specifications, in the “Quantities – Sewer” sheets for all ministry contracts with pipe sewer designs. Appendix B - CPS Master List of Pipe Sewer Tender Items This appendix provides a complete list of all pipe sewer tender items available.

410.6 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' to review standard special provisions that may be required for inclusion in the contract.

410.7 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 800 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual; however, other OPSD or MTOD series may also apply.

410.8 DESIGN

410.8.1 Pipe Sewer The general pipe layout, size, type and class of a pipe sewer network are established by the designer based on acceptable drainage theory. The designer shall use accepted drainage design methods by which to define the pipe sewer layout that satisfies required drainage standards and criteria for the highway project. Gravity pipe drainage design standards are applicable to sewers and are available in the MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards. Gravity pipe design requirements,

November 2015 Page 2 of 24 B410

Page 443: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

analysis methods and other information are available in the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines and the MTO Drainage Management Manual. A. Size

The design of a pipe sewer network involves determining the sizes of pipes, in conjunction with pipe type and class availability, which will permit the pipe sewer network to function within set design requirements and standards. The designer will also determine the maximum increase or tolerance range in the pipe size, in conjunction with pipe type and class availability, which will still permit the pipe sewer to function within the design parameters set. The designer shall also keep in mind the following basic guidelines in laying out the pipe sewer network:

1. Wherever possible, the invert elevation of a pipe sewer run entering a catch

basin should be slightly higher (30 mm) than the invert elevation of the pipe leaving the structure.

2. Pipe culverts should never flow into a pipe sewer network but the reverse is

permitted. 3. The spacing of the catch basins is detailed in Section B407-1, "Manholes,

Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets", such that the length of the pipe sewer may be calculated.

B. Type

Pipe type refers to a pipe’s inside wall design, which can be smooth or corrugated. A separate hydraulic analysis of each pipe type to determine hydraulic acceptability is required to determine if both pipe types are to be specified in a contract as alternative pipe type choices. The designer will use hydraulic flow parameters characteristic of each pipe type during the hydraulic analysis work. In some cases, only one pipe type may be achievable or conducive for the site conditions. The designer will analyze a sewer network for hydraulic acceptance based on one pipe type for the entire sewer network. Two separate hydraulic design analysis runs are required to determine if both pipe types are hydraulically acceptable. Where site circumstances are found that requires a sewer network that is pipe type sensitive, the designer need only perform the hydraulic analysis of the pipe sewer network for the one pipe type identified as suitable for the site conditions.

November 2015 Page 3 of 24 B410

Page 444: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

C. Class

Pipe class refers to the material specifications of the pipe products. These specifications include load and pressure ratings, pipe wall thickness, protective coatings, corrugations and reinforcement. Acceptable material specifications of a pipe sewer network are established based on structural loading and material durability requirements. The designer shall use accepted structural and durability assessment methods by which to establish the pipe class that satisfies both structural and material durability criteria.

1. Structural Assessment

Pipe sewers, due to the fact that they are installed underground, are subject to ‘dead’ and ‘live’ loads. The loading requirements are addressed through placement of fill material on top of the pipe culvert. Bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, backfill, subgrade, and pavement are to be considered in the structural loading assessment. The height of fill available will define acceptable pipe sizes, types and classes.

2. Durability Assessment

Pipe sewer networks, for the different functional highway classifications, must be designed to specified Design Service Life (DSL) criteria. Every pipe material has an Estimated Material Service Life (EMSL) based on its material properties and the site environment. Acceptable pipe materials are those that have an EMSL greater than or equal to the DSL criteria. Pipe materials with an EMSL less than the DSL criteria may only be considered in a strategic pipe replacement context. A Life Cycle Cost Analysis (LCCA) must be performed to support a pipe replacement design. Highway Standards Branch approvals are required to use a pipe replacement design approach.

D. Joints

The designer, through hydraulic analysis of surface flow or through subsurface information as provided in a foundations or geotechnical report, shall make an assessment of the type of pipe joints required for the pipe sewer. The designer shall refer to the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines for further information on pipe joint selection requirements.

November 2015 Page 4 of 24 B410

Page 445: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

E. Outlet Pipe End Finish

The end finishes on a pipe sewer outlet may be cut end finishes to the outlet pipe or attached prefabricated end sections. The end finish is to be decided by the designer through hydraulic analysis and final embankment slopes. Where traffic safety is an issue, the designer may select a prefabricated safety slope end treatment section specifically designed to address the safety concern at the pipe sewer outlet. Grating may be installed over the ends of pipe sewer outlets to prevent access by animals or children if deemed to be a concern.

The designer shall refer to relevant design manuals and/or any associated OPSD’s or MTOD’s for further information on warrants and design of end finishes.

F. Treatment

In most cases, pipe sewers are constructed below the frost line and would not require any special treatments for frost. In rock fills, frost tapers are not required, but fill material must be provided. When the pipe sewer cannot be constructed below the frost line, special treatment will be required. Foundations or geotechnical reports shall contain information regarding recommended pipe fill materials and the configuration and extent of frost taper excavations. Where pipe fill material cannot protect the pipe sewer or frost tapers cannot be constructed, other frost protection options need to be considered. Designers may consider using extruded expanded polystyrene or other insulation materials to prevent the frost line from penetrating into the pipe sewers’ critical zone. Flow sources entering the pipe sewer carrying sediment loads under certain velocity conditions may require lining of the pipe sewer invert to prevent abrasion of the pipe material. Lining the pipe sewer invert can be done with concrete or shotcrete material. Bituminous products shall not be used to line the invert of the pipe sewer. In lieu of a lined invert, the designer may also consider pipe products with thicker walls and/or protective coatings to provide additional protection against abrasive forces.

G. Concrete Appurtenances

The flow out of a pipe sewer may need to be controlled to prevent erosion damage to the area around it or to the pipe structure itself. Concrete appurtenances such as

November 2015 Page 5 of 24 B410

Page 446: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

headwalls, wingwalls, energy dissipators, aprons, collars or other such types of structures are used to direct outflow, slow velocities to prevent erosion, offset buoyancy forces, etc. Concrete structures covered by OPSS 904 do not include the aforementioned concrete appurtenances.

410.8.2 Trench

A. Excavation

Excavated material may be used for embankment construction or used as native backfill to the excavated pipe sewer trench as determined by the designer based on foundation or geotechnical reports. Earth and rock excavation material not used as native backfill should be managed as outlined in Section B206 of this chapter. In view of the high unit cost for rock excavation, the designer shall endeavour to reduce the volume of excavation by relocating, pipe skewing, etc., wherever possible.

B. Dewatering

Dewatering refers to pumping, bailing, groundwater lowering, temporary ditching or vacuum removal of uncontaminated groundwater, rain water, melt water, surface runoff, water pipe leakage from excavations and trenches or within sheeted cofferdams to improve the soil stability or for other construction purposes. Where dewatering is required for the installation of a pipe sewer, the details of the operation shall comply with the requirements of OPSS 517. When recommended by the foundation engineer, a separate item for dewatering according to OPSS 902 is to be included. Although the Contractor is responsible for dewatering, the designer shall note any recommendations included in the foundation investigation and design report. The designer shall also refer to SP 100S59, Amendment to MTO General Conditions of Contract, Permits to Take Water, for additional requirements that may need to be specified in the contract.

C. Fill Material

Pipe fill material for rigid pipe installations is placed in distinct bedding, cover and backfill layers. Flexible pipe installations require pipe fill material to be placed as distinct embedment, which is from the bottom of the bedding layer to the bottom of the backfill layer, and backfill layers.

November 2015 Page 6 of 24 B410

Page 447: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Applicable minimum or maximum height of pipe fill material limits are placed in accordance with OPSD or MTOD Height of Fill tables for the pipe materials identified. A foundation or geotechnical report will include recommendations for the supply, placement, and specifications of pipe fill material or any special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, and backfill layers. In addition, special consideration for scour protection at the pipe sewer outlet may be required. The designer shall, based on the recommendations of the foundation or geotechnical report, specify the pipe fill materials required for the installation. The designer should be familiar with the various installation methods available as referenced in the 800 series of the OPSD for the pipe sewer installation so that the pipe fill materials recommended are appropriately specified. The contractor, not the designer, is responsible for selecting the appropriate pipe sewer installation method, including excavation geometry, at the time of installation based on the soil types found on the construction site in accordance with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations for Construction Projects.

D. Reinstatement

Where existing driving lanes must be excavated to allow the construction of the pipe sewer network, the affected roadbed must be rebuilt to acceptable standards to maintain the continuity of the pavement. This is particularly important where there is to be no resurfacing of the highway. The designer shall determine and specify bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipe, and backfill depths and materials up to subgrade. Above subgrade, the designer shall determine the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity.

E. Protection Systems

In general, the contractor determines the need for protection systems, except when the stability, safety or function of an existing roadway, railway, etc. may be threatened or impaired due to the construction of a pipe sewer or in cases where the pipe sewer will be installed at depth. In such cases the foundation engineer may recommend that the installation of protection systems be specified and paid by separate item. The design, installation, monitoring of protection systems is the Contractor’s responsibility and the Contractor should base his plan on information as found in the soils data and/or foundation reports. Problematic soils, high groundwater

November 2015 Page 7 of 24 B410

Page 448: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

tables or other installation issues, if identified, will give rise to recommendations regarding the design, installation and removal and would be provided in the foundation report. Recommendations for performance levels can also be found in foundation investigation and design reports. Requirements for field investigation, laboratory testing and engineering recommendations for protection systems are to be specified in the foundation engineering terms of reference for any specific project such that appropriate information for the Contractor is provided.

F. Clay Seals

Warrants for clay seals to be installed on pipe sewers can be found in the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines. Other physical flow control barrier options are in the GPDG April 2014. Recommendations may also be found in a foundation or geotechnical investigation and design report.

410.9 COMPUTATION 410.9.1 Item Payment Basis

Pipe Sewer items are Plan Quantity Payment items. Concrete Appurtenances are Plan Quantity Payment items. Rock Excavation for Pipe Sewers is a Plan Quantity Payment item Clay Seal is a Lump Sum item

410.9.2 Sources of Information The main sources of information for pipe sewer items are:

a) Photogrammetric or survey plans to provide drainage areas, existing natural

watercourses and other features that may impact drainage. b) MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards provides the overall design criteria

requirements of gravity pipe installations. c) MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines provide DSL criteria, water chemistry

testing and pipe material selection procedures and requirements. d) MTO Drainage Management Manual provides the overall guidance on the design

of pipe sewers and other drainage systems.

November 2015 Page 8 of 24 B410

Page 449: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

e) Foundation or geotechnical reports provide guidance and recommendations on

subsurface and groundwater conditions, backfilling requirements, special foundation treatments, articulation and scour protection at the sewer outlets. The foundation or geotechnical reports should also provide recommendations regarding dewatering requirements.

410.9.3 Methods of Calculation

The unit of measurement for pipe sewers is the metre. The price per metre for placing pipe sewers includes the following operations:

a) Supplying, placing and joining pipe lengths; b) Supplying and installing access prevention grates, if required c) Finishing or supplying and installing sewer outlet pipe end sections, as required b) Earth excavations for trenches, frost tapers, etc. for pipes and concrete

appurtenances; c) Supplying, placing and compacting all bedding, cover, embedment in the case of

flexible pipes, and backfill materials for pipe sewers; d) Dewatering operations, unless otherwise specified; e) Design, installation and removal of protection systems, unless otherwise

specified; f) Reinstating or constructing any highway ancillary features, not covered under

other required works in the contract, as part of the pipe sewer installation; and g) Disposing of all surplus excavated materials.

410.9.4 Pipe Sewer A. Length

Measurement for the length of the pipe sewer will be made along the invert of the pipe sewer from centre to centre of the catch basins, and no deduction in length will be made for the catch basin. When designing a pipe sewer network, the catch basins should be placed such that the length of pipe sewer from centre to centre of the catch basins is in whole

November 2015 Page 9 of 24 B410

Page 450: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

numbers. When the space is restricted or short lengths are required, the metric design length of pipe sewers may be determined as the next larger 0.1 metres. Where a pipe sewer pre-fabricated end section, other than safety slope end treatments, is to be installed on pipe sewer outlets, they are to be added to the pipe sewer length without rounding. Slope flattening should also be considered when calculating the length of pipe sewers. The length of a pipe sewer is measured horizontally, except when the pipe grade is 10% or steeper, in which case the length is measured along the slope.

B. Joints

Pipe joints are inclusive with the work to be done when installing a pipe sewer.

C. Concrete Appurtenances

The unit of measurement for concrete appurtenances is the cubic metre. The volume of each structure is computed and the payment in cubic metre covers the cost of supplying and placing both concrete and reinforcing steel. Payment for excavation and backfilling, including the supply of granular material, is included with the associated pipe sewer tender item.

D. Manholes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets

The above are covered in Section B407-1 of this chapter. E. Connections to Existing Pipe Sewers, Drains and Service Connections

The unit of measurement for service connections is "each". F. Pipe Culverts

Pipe culverts are covered in Section B421-2 "Pipe Culverts" of this chapter.

410.9.5 Trench A. Excavation

Earth excavation required to place pipe sewers is part of the cost of the pipe sewer item. Excavation in rock for placing pipe sewers is done according to OPS Drawings.

November 2015 Page 10 of 24 B410

Page 451: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Unlike excavation in earth, which is included in the bid price of the pipe, rock excavation is tendered as a separate item. Rock excavation uses information for the computation of rock excavation quantities from the foundations or geotechnical reports and soils profile and field survey notes. The unit of measurement for this tender item is the cubic metre. Rock excavation quantities are computed as outlined in Section B407-2 of this manual. Rock excavation operations shall be according to OPSS 403 when specified.

B. Dewatering

Dewatering operations are according to OPSS 517 or OPSS 902, when specified. The designer shall ensure the requirements of SP100S59 are accounted for. Should a rare situation occur where it would be unfair to the Contractor to include an expensive dewatering operation in his pipe sewer bid price, using a non-standard tender item should be considered. Consultation with the Ministry’s foundation or geotechnical staff is required prior to use of the non-standard dewatering item.

C. Fill Material

Granular volumes for frost tapers, bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, and backfill material for pipe sewers are computed as shown in Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings or from detail drawings when applicable. Granular materials for concrete appurtenances are included in the pipe sewer granular quantities. The total granular requirement for each pipe sewer run is computed in cubic metres, and may be converted to tonnes using the conversion factor determined according to Section B314 of this manual. This quantity is used for Geotechnical ASL purposes only.

410.10 DOCUMENTATION 410.10.1 Drawings

A. Pipe Sewer

1. Location

All pipe sewers, either with or without end sections, are to be indicated on the construction plans of the contract drawings. Pipe sewer profiles, drainage structure number, rock line, sub grade and original ground must be indicated

November 2015 Page 11 of 24 B410

Page 452: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

where applicable on the contract drawings. The pipe configuration, but not the size, type or class, and a direction of flow arrow are to be indicated.

2. Connections to Existing Pipe Sewers, Drains and Service Connections

Locations of connections to existing pipe sewers, drains and other service connections are to be indicated on the construction plans of the contract drawings.

3. End Finish, Grates and End Sections

The applicable drawings for sewer outlet pipe end finishes are shown in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings. In addition, any pipe sewers with end finishes or end sections are to be indicated on the new construction plans and profiles of the contract drawings. Access prevention grates at pipe sewer outlets are to be indicated on the construction plan sheets of the contract drawings. The types of safety slope end treatments are listed in the CPS Master Item list and will be listed as separate tender item in a column on the “Quantities – Sewers” sheets.

4. Concrete Appurtenances

Concrete Appurtenances are identified on the contract plans by means of an arrowed note (e.g. - Concrete Apron), and specifying the OPSD number, or a special drawing, if required, showing the layout.

B. Trench

1. Fill Material

Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings in the 800 series depict dimensions, classes or types of bedding requirements for circular pipes, of which the pipe can be either flexible or rigid. Typical cross-sections must be included in the contract drawings, giving dimensions of frost depth, slope of frost tapers and depth of fill material layers. Because of the variety of possible treatments, standard drawings are not considered appropriate. If special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, or backfill materials are required, the appropriate dimensions must be

November 2015 Page 12 of 24 B410

Page 453: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

shown on applicable Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings or on detail drawings when applicable.

2. Reinstatement

A typical section, traditionally known as "trench reinstatement," must be shown on the contract plans. The drawing should refer to the applicable OPSD numbers for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipe, and backfill up to subgrade specifying the types and depths of pipe fill material necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. Above subgrade, the drawing should specify the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. These types and depths may be shown in table format adjacent to the trench reinstatement typical section. When the contract is for standalone pipe sewer replacements (i.e. no other pavement rehabilitation or resurfacing work), all of the work to reinstate the roadway, including granular and pavement layers above subgrade, may be included with the pipe sewer item, as per OPSS 492. In this case, the required attributes of the pavement and granular layers (e.g. Superpave traffic category, PGAC grade) shall be shown with the trench reinstatement typical section.

3. Special Foundation Treatment A detailed typical drawing and/or a modified OPSD will be necessary to show the depth of bedding and location if any special foundation treatment such as articulation, soil mixing, ground improvement, etc is required as noted in the foundation investigation and design report.

4. Protection Systems Where a separate item for protection systems is required, as recommended by the foundation engineer, the line of protection or a protection system shall be shown on the contract drawings depending on the magnitude of the protection required. Performance levels shall be included on the Contract Drawings. These are only approximate lengths or locations and it is up to the contractor to design, install and remove with actual lengths and locations defined.

410.10.2 Documents Quantities Sheet The "Quantities - Sewers" sheet shall show details such as: 1. Structure Number to Structure Number: identifies the starting structure to the

connecting end structure/outlet for each pipe run in the pipe sewer network.

November 2015 Page 13 of 24 B410

Page 454: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

2. Location and position: the relevant alignment control line (e.g. highway

centreline) with offset positions of start structure grate and end structure grate defined as the distance in metres left (LT) and/or right (RT) from the alignment control line (e.g. C/L 0.85 LT - 1.0 LT).

3. Upstream and downstream inverts: elevation entries of pipe sewer invert at the

upstream and downstream structure locations. 4. Depth to Pipe: measured from highway or ground surface directly above the

upstream pipe sewer invert down to top of base pipe opening. 5. Pipe Fill Material:

Where there are no recommendations from a foundations or geotechnical report to specify any particular pipe fill material, the pipe fill materials will be specified, by default, as “G” for bedding and by extension embedment, and “N” for backfill and cover. The designer does not have to enter any material specifications in the columns to have the default material specifications apply. However, specific pipe fill material for bedding, cover or backfill, if recommended in a foundations or geotechnical report, shall be specified in the appropriate pipe fill material column. Pipe fill materials shall be specified as follows:

• N – native material, which applies to cover and backfill layers only, and

permits Granular B Type I, II or III, or Granular A to be used; • G – only Granular B Type I, II or III, or Granular A may be used; • B – only Granular B Type II or Granular A may be used; • A – only Granular A may be used; and • C – Unshrinkable Fill. A single letter code is used to indicate the same pipe fill material for a pipe fill layer if it is suitable for both rigid and flexible pipe options. If using the same pipe fill material is not suitable, two letter codes are used such that the first letter specifies the pipe fill material for rigid pipes while the second letter specifies the pipe fill material for flexible pipes for a pipe fill layer. The pipe fill material codes are structured in an ascending order of quality. All higher level codes above the code that is selected are deemed to be satisfactory for the installation. In cases where the higher level pipe fill materials are not suitable (i.e. different frost susceptibility characteristics), a designer shall insert a contract note to alert the contractor that only the specified pipe fill material is acceptable.

November 2015 Page 14 of 24 B410

Page 455: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Embedment for flexible pipes is from the bottom of bedding layer to bottom of backfill layer and is specified in the bedding material column. When only flexible pipes are specified, the pipe fill material cover column is not applicable. Clear stone may be used as bedding or embedment fill material, if groundwater conditions warrant the need. Refer to the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines for details.

6. Pipe Joints: Types of joints required are to be specified in the appropriately

labeled column on the "Quantities – Pipe Sewer" sheet. “S” denotes a joint that is soil tight while “F” denotes a joint that is silt or fines tight and “L” denotes a joint that is water tight. Pipe joints are specified by default as “S” regardless of whether or not the “S” code is entered into the “Pipe Joints” column. Joint classification is hierarchal in nature so that if an “S” joint is specified, the “F” and “L” joints are also acceptable, unless otherwise stated.

7. Pipe Sewer Tender Items: are shown using a separate column for each pipe sewer

tender item. Each pipe sewer tender item is a composite tender item and is to be entered as shown below:

Size mm Pipe Sewer Size + mm range S xxxxxx Size + mm range C xxxxxx

Different pipe sewer sizes will necessitate entry of separate tender items. Same

pipe sewer sizes with different size tolerance ranges and pipe material codes will necessitate entry as a separate composite tender item (e.g. more than one column is required to specify the pipe sewer tender item).

Refer to Appendix A - Pipe Sewer Tender Item for information and guidance of

how to define pipe sewer tender items for entry into the Quantities – Sewers sheets.

8. Notes that may be required on the “Quantities – Sewers” sheet

A contract note can be a tender item note, which makes the note applicable to all sewer locations of that pipe size category, or can be a quantity item note if it is only applicable to certain sewer locations.

i) Identified locations where the non-reinforced concrete pipe material is

acceptable must be noted. ii) When corrugated steel pipes are specified and there are two different products

permitted of the same size, the product with the greater material specifications

November 2015 Page 15 of 24 B410

Page 456: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

must be noted at the locations where permitted since minimum material specifications have been identified in the pipe sewer tender item.

iii) The locations of physical flow control barriers other than clay seals are to be indicated through a note.

iv) When pipe sewer end finishes or end sections are required, a note shall be

provided indicating the sewer end finish or section requirement. v) Wherever possible, tee and wye connections and the degree of elbows used for

pipe sewer construction shall be indicated through the use of notes. vi) If frost treatment is different than standard 10 (k-d), a note shall be provided

indicating the different treatment requirements.

vii) When higher level pipe fill materials are not acceptable, a note shall be provided indicating that only the specified pipe material is acceptable.

9. Other Associated Pipe Sewers quantity items.

To specify other pipe sewer quantity items as discussed below, the designer shall use CPS functional capabilities to enter the requirements into the contract package. Options may include creation of appropriate tender item columns on specific identified contract quantity sheets, attachment of standard or non-standard special provisions, or other suitable contract documentation methods.

i) Where the installation of a pipe sewer is in a contract that includes other

highway work (i.e. asphalt pavement removal, sidewalk removal, earth excavation, granular and pavement placement), the works above subgrade required in the pipe sewer installation area is included in the tender item for the other highway work. If the contract has no other highway work, that above subgrade work may be included in the pipe sewer item.

ii) Rock excavation for pipe sewers is a separate tender item in accordance with

OPSS 403. iii) On contracts where the excavated material is to be used for the construction

of earth embankments, the quantity for pipe sewer excavation is to be calculated and the appropriate quantity indicated on the "Quantities - Grading & Granular" sheet under the "Material Available" column.

iv) Granular and pavement to be supplied and placed for trench reinstatement

would be included with the granular and pavement materials as part of the highway works.

November 2015 Page 16 of 24 B410

Page 457: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

v) Service connection locations are to be listed under an appropriately labeled column.

vi) When concrete appurtenances are to be placed on pipe sewers, they are

treated as a separate item of work. Concrete appurtenances must be listed for each individual location on the "Quantities – Miscellaneous” sheet, or, if there are no other concrete items, they should be listed on the "Quantities - Sewers" sheet.

vii) If dewatering is tendered as a separate non-standard item, it shall be entered

as a lump sum in the contract. Ensure that any requirements as specified by SP100S59 are accounted for in the contract.

viii) Where recommended by the foundation engineer, protection systems are

entered as a separate tender item. ix) Safety slope end treatments, if required, shall be entered into a separate

column. x) Access prevention grates, end finishes and/or end treatment sections shall be

noted to the quantity affected.

10. Post Installation Inspections

Pipe sewers on ministry contracts may be subject to post installation inspections. The following criteria shall be applied to determine if this work is necessary.

1. The total combined pipe sewer length of all pipe sewer tender items is greater

than or equal to 500 m; or 2. If the total pipe sewer length of all pipe sewer tender items is less than 500 m,

at least one sewer pipe run will be constructed with a pipe diameter greater than or equal to 450 mm and is greater than or equal to 100 m in length.

Should post installation inspections for pipe sewers be required, SSP 104S03 shall be included. Payment for post installation inspection work is detailed in SSP 104S03.

410.10.3 Documentation Accuracy

Pipe sewers are to be measured by the metre. When the space is restricted, the metric design length of pipe sewers may be determined as the next larger 0.1 metres. Invert elevations are recorded in 0.01 m.

November 2015 Page 17 of 24 B410

Page 458: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Concrete Appurtenances should have concrete quantities and tender totals recorded to 0.1 m³.

November 2015 Page 18 of 24 B410

Page 459: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Appendix A – Pipe Sewer Tender Item Pipe sewer is a variation tender item to be entered into a contract and has been structured to identify the acceptable circular pipe product based on size, type and class. The tender item follows the descriptive format as noted below:

Size mm Pipe Sewer base pipe diameter Size + mm range S xxxxxx minimum smooth pipe diameter + tolerance range, type and

material code Size + mm range C xxxxxx minimum corrugated pipe diameter + tolerance range, type and

material code The pipe sewer material code element in the pipe sewer tender item is a 6 digit code that specifies the minimum material specifications for all acceptable pipe materials identified through design. Each digit represents a pipe material and has different values that specify pipe requirements. The Pipe Sewer Material Code is illustrated in Figure 1.0.

Figure 1.0: Pipe Sewer Material Code

November 2015 Page 19 of 24 B410

Page 460: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

The Pipe Sewer Material Code is interpreted in the following manner: 1. The 1st digit represents concrete pipe. For concrete pipe, there are two product types for

consideration. They are manufactured with reinforcing steel or without.

To define the required reinforced concrete pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate values as:

• 1 for Class 50 D-Load; or • 2 for Class 65 D-Load; or • 3 for Class 100 D-Load; or • 4 for Class 140 D-Load.

The final concrete pipe class selection shall be dependent on the bedding class that is appropriate for the type of soils encountered at the site. When specifying any concrete pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and load rating.

Exception The designer shall note the acceptability of non-reinforced concrete pipe products on the Quantities – Pipe Culvert sheet in the Contract. This will be done as a note to the tender item to indicate the suitability of this pipe product in all locations or as a note to a quantity if the suitability of non-reinforced concrete pipe only applies to one pipe location.

2. The 2nd digit represents PVC and PP (polypropylene) pipes.

There are two PVC product types for consideration. They are manufactured with a smooth inside and a ribbed outside (profile) wall or with a smooth inside and outside (solid) wall. To define the required PVC pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 1 for all classes (Class 210 kpa (equivalent to SDR 41) or Class 320 kpa (equivalent to SDR 35)) which defines the strength requirement for either product type. When one of the PVC pipe products is not suitable for a given site, the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the unsuitable PVC pipe product. PP pipe product types are manufactured as dual (open profile) and triple wall (closed profile) pipes available in 320 kPa material specifications. To define the required PP pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 2 for both product types which define the strength requirements for either product type.

November 2015 Page 20 of 24 B410

Page 461: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

The designer should be aware that the 750 mm PP pipe is available in both an open and closed profile. If one of the PP pipe products is not suitable for a given site, the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the unsuitable PP pipe product. PP pipe products are automatically specified when the 2nd digit pipe material code is 1. If this is not the case for a given site, then the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of PP pipe at the site. When specifying any PVC or PP pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and pipe stiffness rating.

3. The 3rd digit represents HDPE pipes. There are two product types for consideration. They are manufactured with a smooth inside and a corrugated outside wall (open profile) or with a smooth inside and outside wall with a corrugated inner wall (closed profile).

To define the required HDPE pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 1 for open profile pipes and 2 for closed profile pipes.

Closed profile HDPE pipe products are automatically specified when the 3rd digit pipe material

code is 1. If this is not the case for a given site, then the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the closed profile HDPE pipe at the site. When specifying any HDPE pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and pipe stiffness.

4. The 4th, 5th and 6th digits all represent steel and aluminum alloy pipe products. There are three pipe product lines for consideration. They are manufactured as spiral rib steel pipe (SRSP), corrugated steel pipe (CSP), and structural plate pipe (SPP). SRSP is a smooth pipe while CSP and SPP are corrugated pipes. SRSP and CSP pipe products come in three coatings; galvanized, aluminized type II and polymer laminated. Steel SPP is available with a galvanized coating and a polymer coating. SPP is also manufactured from aluminum alloy materials. The 4th digit is used for specifying required galvanized SRSP, CSP and SPP products. To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

November 2015 Page 21 of 24 B410

Page 462: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.0 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 4.0 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 5.0 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 6.0 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 7.0 mm thick walls.

The 5th digit is used for specifying aluminized type II SRSP and CSP pipe products and for specifying aluminum alloy SPP products. To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required aluminum alloy SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.18 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.81 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.45 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 5.08 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 5.72 mm thick walls; or • 8 representing 6.35 mm thick walls.

The 6th digit is used for specifying polymer laminated or coated SRSP, CSP and SPP products.

November 2015 Page 22 of 24 B410

Page 463: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.0 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 4.0 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 5.0 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 6.0 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 7.0 mm thick walls.

When specifying any steel or aluminum alloy pipe materials, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size, protective coating and wall thickness. Exception For some diameters, CSP is available with two corrugation profiles. The pipe material durability analysis may determine a single wall thickness for both CSP product lines while the structural analysis of the pipe materials determines a different wall thickness for each CSP product lines.

The designer shall identify the minimum wall thickness through the Pipe Material Code and note the greater wall thickness requirement of the other pipe product on the Quantities – Pipe Culverts sheet in the Contract. This shall be done as a note to the tender item to indicate the greater wall thickness requirement of this pipe product in all locations on the contract or as a note to a quantity if the greater wall thickness requirement of this pipe product only applies to one pipe location.

Note: Non-circular pipe sewer networks shall be specified through the use of a non-standard special

provision. Pipe material codes will be similar to those used for non-circular pipe culvert installations.

November 2015 Page 23 of 24 B410

Page 464: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE SEWERS

Appendix B – CPS Master Items List of Pipe Sewer Tender Items The CPS Master Items List, lists all pipe sewer tender items and has been reproduced below.

Contract Preparation System (CPS) Pipe Tender Item

Sewer Pipe Size Range (mm)

100 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 100 mm < 200 mm 200 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 200 mm < 300 mm 300 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 300 mm < 400 mm 400 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 400 mm < 500 mm 500 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 500 mm < 600 mm 600 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 600 mm < 700 mm 700 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 700 mm < 800 mm 800 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 800 mm < 900 mm 900 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 900 mm < 1000 mm

1000 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1000 mm < 1200 mm 1200 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1200 mm < 1300 mm 1300 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1300 mm < 1400 mm 1400 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1400 mm < 1500 mm 1500 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1500 mm < 1600 mm 1600 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1600 mm < 1800 mm 1800 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1800 mm < 1900 mm 1900 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 1900 mm < 2000 mm 2000 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2000 mm < 2100 mm 2100 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2100 mm < 2200 mm 2200 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2200 mm < 2400 mm 2400 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2400 mm < 2500 mm 2500 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2500 mm < 2600 mm 2600 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2600 mm < 2700 mm 2700 mm Pipe Sewer ≥ 2700 mm < 3000 mm 3000 mm Pipe Sewer = 3000 mm

November 2015 Page 24 of 24 B410

Page 465: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TUNNELLING

91 10 B415-1

415 - TUNNELLING - OPSS 415

415.1 GENERAL

This item covers the requirements for the construction of sewers by the method of tunnelling. In addition to sewers, this shall also apply, but not be limited to culverts, electrical ducts and other conduits installed by this method.

Occasionally it is necessary to place sewers (and culverts) under a roadway or railway without disrupting traffic. This can be accomplished by tunnelling. As the volume of traffic on the affected roadway is a prime consideration in choosing to tunnel, bore or open cut, close liaison with the Regional Traffic Office is essential.

415.1.1 Tender Items

- Tunnel - Rock Excavation in Tunnelling

This operation normally is carried out for very large pipes. The following steps will give the designer a basic understanding of tunnelling.

An earth tunnel is bored as closely as possible to the outside diameter of the primary liner.

A primary liner is constructed around the inside of the excavated surface of the tunnel. The voids behind the liner are pumped full of grout.

Page 466: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TUNNELLING

91 10 B415-2

A second liner (or form) is constructed and concrete is pumped between the two liners to form the concrete pipe.

The second liner or form is removed after the new concrete is set.

415.1.2 Specification

The requirements for the tunnelling methods are described in OPSS 415

415.1.3 Special Provisions

The Designer should refer to Chapter `E' of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions.

415.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

415.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the computation of these tender items are the Regional Geotechnical and Regional Traffic Offices and the cross-sections.

415.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for the tender item "Tunnel" is the metre, measured along the centre of the tunnel from centre to centre of the end catchbasins, manholes or ditch inlets or from the end of the tunnel if no manhole is installed. There is no deduction in length for intermediate manholes, catchbasins or ditch inlets.

The price per metre will include all other work such as earth excavation, grouting, sheathing and shoring and dewatering, including the connection of existing sewers, drains and service connections, if shown on the contract drawings.

Page 467: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TUNNELLING

91 10 B415-3

The unit of measurement for the tender item "Rock Excavation in Tunnelling" is the cubic metre. The volume calculation indicates the quantity of rock within the neat lines of the excavation required to place the primary lining as indicated in the contract. The rock volume calculation excludes any rock excavation quantity contained in the item "Rock Excavation for Sewers, Manholes, Catch basins and Ditch Inlets."

Digital Rounding is not to be applied to the above tender items.

415.3 DOCUMENTATION

Contract Drawings

The above type installation with or without end sections are to be indicated on the new construction plan and profile sheets of the contract drawings with the appropriate symbol. A profile should be drawn to indicate the station, diameter, length, offset and invert elevation left and right of centreline of highway construction, catchbasin numbers and the original ground and proposed cross-section over the pipe.

Contract Documents

The required different diameters of tunnels should be recorded on the quantity sheet in separate columns. The quantities in each column are totalled. These totals when combined become the tender total that is transferred to the tender document.

No tender rounding is applied to this item.

Documentation of connections to existing sewers, drains, etc. headwalls, grating and end finish shall be as indicated in Section 406.3 E, F and G of this chapter.

Rock excavation quantities for the item "Rock Excavtion in Tunnelling" are to be computed for each tunnel location and shown on a separate line entry under the column heading for this item. This item should be shown on the same quantity sheet used for the item "Tunnel".

Where the excavated material is available for embankment construction, the quantity must appear on the Quantities-Grading sheet under the appropriate heading of rock material available.

415.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

- Volume calculations to 0.1 m3

- Length calculations to 0.1 m. - Stations - nearest whole meter or more accurate if required for layout - Offsets - 0.01 m.

Page 468: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 469: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING JACKING AND BORING

94 11 B416-1

416 - JACKING AND BORING - OPSS 416

416.1 GENERAL

This item covers the requirements for the construction of sewers and culverts by the method of jacking and boring.

Occasionally it is necessary to place sewers and culverts under a roadway or railway without disrupting traffic. This can be accomplished by jacking and boring. As the volume of traffic on the affected roadway is a prime consideration in choosing to tunnel (see B415) or to jack and bore rather than to open cut, close liaison with the Regional Traffic office is essential.

Pipe Sewer and Culvert Materials

Pipe sewer and culverts may be designed using either smooth walled steel pipe or concrete pipe with consideration of the design objectives of the system.

416.1.1 Tender Item

Jacking and Boring

a) The illustration shows a pipe being jacked into a fill. The earth material ahead of the pipe is excavated by "hand" and drawn back through the pipe for disposal.

b) Another method is used for smaller pipes where a man cannot enter to perform excavation work. An auger drills out the earth as the pipe is jacked through the augured hole. Another variation would be to drill the hole in its entirety and then push the pipe through.

The choice of one of the described methods is to be made by the designer based on soils data provided by Regional Geotechnical Section.

416.1.2 Specification

The requirements for the jacking and boring are described in OPSS 416.

Page 470: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING JACKING AND BORING

94 11 B416-2

416.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable specialprovisions.

416.2 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

416.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for this tender item are the Regional Geotechnical Office, the Regional Traffic Office and the design cross-sections.

416.2.2 Method of Calculation

Measurement of this tender item is in metres, measured along the centre of the pipe from centre to centre of the end catchbasins, manholes or ditch inlets with no deduction in length for intermediate manholes, catchbasins or ditch inlets.

The unit price includes other work such as excavation, grouting, sheathing and shoring, dewatering, etc., including the connection of existing sewers, drains and service connections, if shown on the contract drawings.

Digital Rounding is not to be applied to the above tender item.

416.3 DOCUMENTATION

Contract Drawings

The above installation with or without end sections is to be indicated on the new construction plan and profile sheets of the contract drawings with the appropriate symbol. A profile should be drawn to indicate the station, diameter, length, offset and invert elevation left and right of centreline of highway construction, catchbasin numbers and the original ground and proposed cross-section over the pipe.

Contract Documents

Pipe sewers will be shown on the Quantities - Sewers Sheet. Pipe culverts will be shown on the Quantities - Pipe Culverts Sheet. The different diameters of pipe together with their respective lengths are recorded on the quantity sheet in separate columns. The type of pipe whether concrete or steel must also be identified on the Quantity Sheet. The quantities in each column are totalled. These totals when combined become the tender total that is transferred to the tender document. The wall thicknesses for smooth wall steel pipe must not be shown on the Q-Sheets unless they are to vary from those shown in OPSS 1802.

Documentation of connections to existing sewers, drains, etc. headwalls, grating and end finish shall be as indicated in Section B406.

Page 471: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING JACKING AND BORING

94 11 B416-3

416.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Length calculations to 0.1 m.

Stations to the nearest whole metre or more accurate if required for layout.

Offsets shown to 0.01 m.

Page 472: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 473: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

B421-2 – PIPE CULVERTS – OPSS.PROV 421 421.1 GENERAL

Pipe culverts are installations designed to provide for the conveyance of surface water, pedestrians or livestock using preformed or pre-cast pipe sections, circular or non-circular in cross-section, laid end to end using suitable joint materials. All design assumptions and calculations required to design a pipe culvert shall be retained as part of the design documentation.

421.2 REFERENCES MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards MTO Drainage Management Manual MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines MTO Guide for Preparing Hydrology Reports for Water Crossings Ontario Provincial Standards Specifications Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings Drainage Guidelines available on the MTO public web site All references noted are available through the Contract Preparation System (CPS), through the ministry’s public web site, or through the MTO Online Catalogue library. The designer shall also reference other design manuals (i.e. MTO Roadside Safety Manual) as required for design assistance of other roadside features associated with the pipe culvert design.

421.3 TENDER ITEMS Pipe Culvert Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Pipe Culvert Extension Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Concrete Appurtenances Clay Seal

421.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the pipe culvert, non-circular pipe culvert, pipe culvert extension, non-circular pipe culvert extension and concrete appurtenance tender items

November 2015 Page 1 of 35 B421-2

Page 474: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

are contained in OPSS 421. Trenching, backfilling and compaction requirements are specified in OPSS 401 while rock excavation requirements are specified in OPSS 403. The designer shall also reference or note other OPSS documents for construction and materials as identified or required when packaging a contract.

421.5 APPENDICES Appendix A - Pipe Culvert Tender Item This appendix describes the pipe culvert tender items and is to be followed by the designer to itemize the pipe culvert tender item entries, complete with all pipe material specifications, in the Quantity – Pipe Culvert sheets for all ministry contracts. Appendix B - Additional Pipe Culvert Design Factors This appendix describes some additional components in pipe culvert designs and is to be used by the designer to accurately identify the pipe culvert installation work in the Quantity – Pipe Culvert or other quantity sheets for all ministry contracts, as appropriate. Appendix C - CPS Master List of Pipe Culvert Tender Items This appendix provides a list of all available pipe culvert tender items for circular and non-circular pipes.

421.6 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' to review standard special provisions that may be required for inclusion in the contract.

421.7 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 800 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual; however, other OPSD or MTOD series may also apply.

421.8 DESIGN 421.8.1 Pipe Culvert

The general alignment, size, type and class of a pipe culvert are established, based on

November 2015 Page 2 of 35 B421-2

Page 475: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

acceptable drainage theory, by the designer. The designer shall use accepted drainage design methods by which to establish the pipe culvert design that satisfies required drainage standards or criteria for the highway project. As a general rule, pipe culverts, if embedment depths have not been defined through the design process, other than entrance pipe culverts should be embedded to a depth equal to one tenth of the height or diameter of the pipe culvert below the bottom of ditch, unless there are reasons for deviating from this rule. Gravity pipe drainage standards are available in the MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards. Gravity pipe design requirements, analysis methods and other information are available in the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines, the MTO Drainage Management Manual and the MTO Guide for Preparing Hydrology Reports for Water Crossings A. Size

The design of a pipe culvert involves determining the size of a pipe, in conjunction with pipe type and class availability that will permit the pipe culvert to function within set design requirements and standards. The designer will also determine the maximum increase or tolerance range in pipe culvert size, of like pipe type and class availability that will still permit the pipe culvert to function within the design parameters set. For crossings where multiple pipe culverts are required, refer to Appendix B – Additional Pipe Culvert Design Factors for additional information on how to determine spacing and other requirements.

B. Type

Pipe type refers to a pipe’s inside wall design, which can be smooth or corrugated. A separate hydraulic analysis of each pipe type to determine hydraulic acceptability is required to determine if both pipe types should be specified in a contract as alternative pipe type choices. The designer will use hydraulic flow parameters, characteristic of each pipe type, during the hydraulic analysis work. For some sites, only one pipe type may be appropriate for the site conditions. The designer will analyze a pipe culvert for hydraulic acceptance based on one pipe type for the entire pipe culvert length. Two separate hydraulic design analysis runs are required to determine if both pipe types are hydraulically acceptable. Only where site circumstances are found to be pipe type sensitive, will it not be necessary for a designer to perform the hydraulic analysis separately for both pipe types.

November 2015 Page 3 of 35 B421-2

Page 476: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Circular or non-circular pipe culverts greater than 3000 mm in diameter or span are classified as structures and are designed from first principles in conjunction with structural engineers following the requirements of the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code and the MTO Structural manual.

C. Class

Pipe class refers to the material specifications of the pipe products. These specifications include load and pressure ratings, pipe wall thickness, protective coatings, corrugations and reinforcement. Acceptable material specifications of a pipe culvert are established, based on structural loading and material durability requirements, by the designer. The designer shall use accepted structural and durability assessment methods to establish the pipe class that satisfies both structural and material durability criteria.

1. Structural Assessment

Pipe culverts, due to the fact that they are installed underground, are subject to ‘dead’ and ‘live’ loads. The loading requirements are addressed through placement of fill material below, around and on top of the pipe culvert. Bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, backfill, subgrade, and pavement are to be considered in the structural loading assessment. The height of fill available will define acceptable pipe sizes, types and classes in terms of structural strength.

2. Durability Assessment

Pipe culverts, for the different functional highway classifications, must be designed to the specified Design Service Life (DSL) criteria. Every pipe material has an Estimated Material Service Life (EMSL) based on its material properties and the site environment. Acceptable pipe materials are those that have an EMSL greater than or equal to the DSL criteria, unless otherwise determined during the design criteria setting for the project. Pipe materials with an EMSL less than the DSL criteria may only be considered in a strategic pipe replacement context. A Life Cycle Cost Analysis (LCCA) must be performed to support any pipe replacement design. Highway Standards Branch approvals are required to use a pipe replacement design approach.

D. Joints

The designer, through hydraulic analysis of surface flow or through subsurface information as provided in a foundations or geotechnical report, shall make an assessment of the type of pipe joints required for the pipe culvert.

November 2015 Page 4 of 35 B421-2

Page 477: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

The designer shall refer to the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines for further information on pipe joint selection requirements.

E. End Finish and Safety

The use of bevels, end finishes or safety grates on a pipe culvert is determined by the designer based on hydraulic analysis and the final embankment slopes. When corrugated steel pipe is used for a pipe culvert, the protruding end may be cut to more aesthetically blend with the surrounding slopes. Where traffic safety is an issue, the designer may also consider a safety end treatment on the pipe culvert ends. The designer shall refer to relevant design manuals and any associated OPSD’s for information on warrants and design of safety end treatments.

F. Treatment

Frost treatment is required if the frostline falls below the top of the pipe culvert, within the bedding layer or below the bedding layer. Foundations or geotechnical reports shall contain information regarding recommended pipe fill materials and the configuration and extent of frost taper excavations. Frost tapers are not required when the frostline falls above the pipe culvert. In rock or granular fills, frost tapers are not required. Pipe culverts being placed on sideroads and entrances that are paved or will be paved, either under the current project or in the foreseeable future, must be provided with frost tapers, where required, regardless of the length of paving (pipe culvert within the limits of paving or future paving). Information on future sideroad requirements should be obtained from municipalities. On gravel roads, pipe culverts should not be provided with frost tapers unless specifically identified in a foundations or geotechnical report or requested by the municipality. Flow sources carrying sediment loads under certain velocity conditions may require lining the pipe culvert invert to prevent abrasion of the pipe material. Lining the pipe culvert invert can be done with concrete or shotcrete material. Bituminous products shall not be used to line the invert of the pipe culvert. In lieu of a lined invert, the designer may also consider pipe products with thicker walls and/or protective coatings to provide the required protection against

November 2015 Page 5 of 35 B421-2

Page 478: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

abrasive forces. Fish bearing streams may require channel substrate or baffles to provide suitable conditions for fish to travel through the pipe culvert. The pipe culvert size may need to be larger to properly embed the pipe culvert and provide suitable substrate depth in which to form the low flow channel for fish passage or to accommodate baffle block heights and provide suitable resting zone water depths and lengths. Baffle configurations and heights may also dictate a larger pipe size to maintain the flow capacity requirements for larger storm events. The designer shall also refer to the MTO Drainage Management Manual for further information on design of low flow channels and baffles.

G. Concrete Appurtenances

The flow through a pipe culvert may need to be controlled to prevent erosion damage to the area around it or to the pipe structure itself. Concrete appurtenances such as headwalls, wingwalls, energy dissipators, aprons, collars or other such types of structures are used to direct flow, slow velocities to prevent erosion, offset buoyancy forces, etc. Concrete structures covered by OPSS 904 do not include the aforementioned concrete appurtenances.

421.8.2 Trench

A. Excavation

Excavated earth material may be used for embankment construction or used as native backfill to the excavated pipe culvert trench as determined by the designer based on foundation or geotechnical reports. Surplus or unsuitable excavation material should be managed as outlined in B206 of this manual. In view of the high unit cost of rock excavation, the designer shall endeavour to reduce the volume of excavation by relocating, pipe skewing, etc., wherever possible. Excavation in rock for placing pipe culverts is also done according to OPS Drawings.

B. Tunnelling, Jacking and Boring Pipe Culverts

In addition to the open-cut method of installing pipes, there are three other methods employed where trenching is not cost-effective: a) Tunnelling; b) Jacking and boring; and c) Pipe lining (non-standard special provisions are required)

November 2015 Page 6 of 35 B421-2

Page 479: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Details of the first two methods of installation are discussed in Sections B415 and B416 of this manual.

C. Dewatering

Dewatering refers to pumping, bailing, groundwater lowering, temporary ditching or vacuum removal of uncontaminated groundwater, rain water, melt water, surface runoff, water pipe leakage from excavations and trenches or within sheeted coffer dams to improve the soil stability or for other construction purposes. Where dewatering is required for the installation of a pipe culvert, the details shall comply with the requirements of OPSS 517 or OPSS 902 when specified. Although the Contractor is responsible for a dewatering plan, the designer shall note any recommendations included in the foundation investigation and design report. The designer shall also refer to SP100S59, Amendment to MTO General Conditions of Contract, Permits to Take Water, for additional requirements that may need to be specified in the contract.

D. Fill Material

Pipe fill material for rigid pipe installations is placed in distinct bedding, cover and backfill layers. Flexible pipe installations require pipe fill material to be placed as distinct embedment, which is from the bottom of the bedding layer to the bottom of the backfill layer, and backfill layers. Applicable minimum or maximum height of pipe fill material limits are placed in accordance with OPSD or MTOD Height of Fill tables for the pipe materials identified. The minimum depth of cover for entrance pipe culverts is 300 mm. In rock cuts, this may require lowering of the ditch grade, using pipe arches or excavating the shatter below the ditch bottom. A foundation or geotechnical report will include recommendations for the supply, placement, and specifications of pipe fill material or any special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, and backfill layers. In addition, special consideration for scour protection at the pipe culvert inlet or outlet may be required. The designer shall, based on the recommendations of the foundation or geotechnical report, specify the pipe fill materials required for the installation. The designer should be familiar with the various installation methods available as referenced in the 800 series of the OPSD for the pipe culvert installation so that

November 2015 Page 7 of 35 B421-2

Page 480: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

the pipe fill materials recommended are appropriately specified. The contractor, not the designer, is responsible for selecting the appropriate pipe culvert installation method, including excavation geometry, at the time of installation based on the soil types found on the construction site in accordance with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations for Construction Projects.

E. Reinstatement

Where existing driving lanes must be excavated to allow the construction of the pipe culvert crossing, the affected roadbed must be rebuilt to acceptable standards to maintain the continuity of the pavement. This is particularly important where there is to be no resurfacing of the highway. The designer shall determine and specify bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipe, and backfill depths and materials up to subgrade. Above subgrade, the designer shall determine the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity.

F. Protection Systems

These systems will be applicable where the stability, safety or function of an existing roadway, railway, etc. may be threatened or impaired due to the construction of a pipe culvert or in cases where the pipe culvert will be installed at a depth where protection schemes are required. The design, installation, monitoring of protection systems is the Contractor’s responsibility and the Contractor should base his plan on information as found in foundation reports. Problematic soils, high groundwater tables or other installation issues, if identified, will give rise to recommendations regarding the design, installation and removal and would also be provided in this report. Recommendations for performance levels can also be found in foundation investigation and design reports. Requirements for field investigation, laboratory testing and engineering recommendations for protection systems are to be specified in the foundation engineering terms of reference for any specific project such that appropriate information for the Contractor is provided.

G. Clay Seals

Warrants for clay seals to be installed on pipe culverts can be found in the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines.

November 2015 Page 8 of 35 B421-2

Page 481: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Other physical flow control barrier options are in the GPDG April 2014. Recommendations may also be found in a foundation or geotechnical investigation and design report.

H. Camber

A foundations or geotechnical report will contain information and design requirements for the camber depths needed for flexible pipe installations. Also refer to Appendix B – Additional Pipe Culvert Design Factors for additional information on how to determine the amount of camber depth is required.

421.9 COMPUTATION 421.9.1 Item Payment Basis

Pipe Culvert items are Plan Quantity Payment items. Non-Circular Pipe Culvert items are Plan Quantity Payment items. Pipe Culvert Extension items are Plan Quantity Payment items. Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension items are Plan Quantity Payment items. Concrete Appurtenances are Plan Quantity Payment items. Rock Excavation for Trenches and Associated Structures is a Plan Quantity Payment item. Clay Seal is a Lump Sum item.

421.9.2 Sources of Information The main sources of information for pipe culvert items are: a) Survey notes and plans that provide profiles along the drainage course at both

existing and new pipe culvert locations and drainage courses in addition to drainage areas, mosaic studies, soil types, etc, that provide information to assist in the calculation of pipe culvert sizes.

b) MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards provides the overall design criteria requirements of pipe culvert installations.

c) MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines provides DSL criteria, water chemistry

testing and pipe material selection procedures and requirements. d) MTO Guide for Preparing Hydrology Reports for Water Crossings provides an

overview to the design issues associated with culverts on water crossings. e) MTO Drainage Management Manual provides the overall guidance on the design

of pipe culverts and other storm drainage systems.

November 2015 Page 9 of 35 B421-2

Page 482: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

f) Foundation or geotechnical reports provide guidance and recommendations on

subsurface and groundwater conditions, backfilling requirements, special foundation treatments, camber, articulation, scour protection at the culvert inlets/outlets and the need for placing clay seals. The foundation or geotechnical reports should also provide recommendations regarding dewatering requirements.

421.9.3 Methods of Calculation

The unit of measurement for circular and non-circular pipe culverts is the metre. The price per metre for placing pipe culverts includes the following operations: a) Supplying, placing and joining pipe lengths; b) Earth excavations for trenches, frost tapers, etc. for pipes, culvert treatments, end

finishes and concrete appurtenances; c) Supplying, placing and compacting all bedding, cover, embedment in the case of

flexible pipes, and backfill materials for pipe culverts; d) Dewatering operations, unless otherwise specified; e) Design, installation and removal of protection systems, unless otherwise

specified; f) Reinstating or constructing any highway ancillary elements, not covered under

other required works in the contract, as part of the pipe culvert installation; and g) Disposing of all surplus excavated materials.

421.9.4 Pipe Culvert

A. Length

The design length (L) of pipe culverts is the distance between the toes of embankment slopes where they meet the streambed profile measured to the nearest full metre. When the space is restricted or short lengths are required, the metric design length of pipe culverts may be determined as the next larger 0.1 metre. Where pipe culvert end treatment sections are used the length of the end treatment sections added. While the standard rock slope is 1¼:1, the length of pipe culvert should be based on a rock slope of 1½:1.

November 2015 Page 10 of 35 B421-2

Page 483: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Slope flattening should also be considered when calculating the length of pipe culverts. The length of a pipe culvert is measured horizontally, except when the pipe grade is 10% or steeper, in which case the length is measured along the slope.

B. Joints

Pipe joints are inclusive with the work to be done when installing a pipe culvert. C. Concrete Appurtenances

The unit of measurement for concrete appurtenances is the cubic metre. The volume of each appurtenance is computed and the payment in cubic metre covers the cost of supplying and placing both concrete and reinforcing steel. Payment for excavation and backfilling, including the supply of granular material, is included with the associated pipe culvert tender item.

421.9.5 Trench

A. Excavation

Earth excavation required to place pipe culverts is part of the cost for placing the pipe culvert. Excavation in earth for placing pipe culverts is done according to OPS Drawings. Unlike earth excavation, which is included in the bid price of the pipe, rock excavation is tendered as a separate item. Rock excavation uses information for the computation of rock excavation quantities from the foundations or geotechnical reports and soils profiles and field survey notes. The unit of measurement for this tender item is the cubic metre. Rock excavation is computed as outlined in Section B407-2 of this manual. Rock excavation operations shall be according to OPSS 403 when specified. Usually, the field survey drainage information contains a profile along the centreline of the pipe culvert, which is used to compute both pipe culvert length and volume of excavation. When the only information available is a profile along the centreline of the pipe culvert, the excavation is computed as shown in Figure B421-4, which can be found in Appendix B. However, when cross-sections are taken normal to the axis of the projected pipe culvert location, a more accurate computation of the quantity of excavation is obtained.

November 2015 Page 11 of 35 B421-2

Page 484: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Where a pipe culvert is installed in a rock cut, the volume of excavation is measured from the top of the shatter.

B. Swamp Excavations

In swamp areas where existing embankments are being widened, excavate existing embankment and swamp as per the appropriate Ontario Provincial Standard drawings, and apply swamp excavation quantities to Earth Excavation (Grading) or Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment.

C. Dewatering

Dewatering operations are according to OPSS 517 or OPSS 902 when specified. The designer shall ensure the requirements of SSP 100S59 are accounted for. Should a rare situation occur where it would be unfair to the Contractor to include an expensive dewatering or unwatering operation in his pipe bid price, consideration shall be given to using a separate non-standard tender item for the dewatering. Consultation with the Ministry’s foundation or geotechnical staff is required prior to use of the non-standard dewatering item.

D. Fill Material

Granular volumes for frost tapers, bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, and backfill material for pipe culverts are computed as shown in Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings or from detail drawings when applicable. Granular materials for concrete appurtenances are included in the pipe culvert granular quantities. The total granular requirement for each pipe culvert location is computed in cubic metres, and may be converted to tonnes using the conversion factor determined according to B314 of this manual. This quantity is used for Geotechnical ASL purposes only.

E. Clay Seal

The unit of measurement for this tender item is lump sum, which covers excavation and the supply and placement of all materials to provide an effective seal. No volume calculations for clay seals are needed.

November 2015 Page 12 of 35 B421-2

Page 485: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

421.10 DOCUMENTATION 421.10.1 Drawings

A. Pipe Culvert

1. Location

New pipe culverts, and existing pipe culverts requiring extensions or end-sections, are shown on the contract drawings, numbered sequentially in the direction of chainage. Pipe culverts to be removed are not numbered, however details regarding elevation and length of existing pipe culverts are shown crossed out on the drawings.

2. End Finishes and Safety End Treatments

The applicable drawing for such end finishes are shown in the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings. The types of safety slope end treatments are listed in the CPS Master Item list and will be listed as separate tender item in a column on the Quantities – Pipe Culverts sheets.

3. Concrete Appurtenances

Concrete Appurtenances are identified on the contract plans by means of an arrowed note (e.g. - Concrete Collar), and specifying the OPSD number, or a special drawing, if required, showing the layout.

4. Treatment

Typical cross section drawings must be included in the contract drawings giving dimensions and shape of channel substrate materials or fish baffles. Locations of baffles must be shown on a typical profile drawing.

B. Trench

1. Fill Material

Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings in the 800 series depict dimensions, classes or types of bedding requirements for circular and non-circular pipes, of which the pipe can be either flexible or rigid.

November 2015 Page 13 of 35 B421-2

Page 486: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Typical cross-sections must be included in the contract drawings, giving dimensions of frost depth, slope of frost tapers and depth of fill material layers. Because of the variety of possible treatments, standard drawings are not considered appropriate. If special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes, or backfill materials are required, the appropriate dimensions must be shown on applicable Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings or on detail drawings when applicable.

2. Reinstatement

A typical section, traditionally known as "trench reinstatement," must be shown on the contract plans. The drawing should refer to the applicable OPSD numbers for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipe, and backfill up to subgrade specifying the types and depths of pipe fill material necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. Above subgrade, the drawing should specify the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. These types and depths may be shown in table format adjacent to the trench reinstatement typical section. When the contract is for standalone pipe culvert replacements (i.e. no other pavement rehabilitation or resurfacing work), all of the work to reinstate the roadway, including granular and pavement layers above subgrade, may be included with the pipe culvert item, as per OPSS 492. In this case, the required attributes of the pavement and granular layers (e.g. Superpave traffic category, PGAC grade) shall be shown with the trench reinstatement typical section.

3. Special Foundation Treatment

A detailed typical drawing and/or a modified OPSD will be necessary to show the depth of bedding and location if any special foundation treatment such as cambering, articulation, soil mixing, ground improvement, etc is included in the foundation investigation and design report.

4. Protection Systems

When protection systems are required, the line of protection or a protection system shall be shown on the contract drawings. Performance levels shall be included on the Contract Drawings. These are only approximate lengths or locations and it is up to the contractor to design, install and remove with actual lengths and locations defined.

November 2015 Page 14 of 35 B421-2

Page 487: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

5. Clay Seal

A detailed dimensioned sketch must be shown on the contract drawings for each location, based on information from foundations or geotechnical report.

421.10.2 Documents 421.10.2.1 Quantities Sheet

The "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" sheet shall show details such as: 1. Culvert Number: numerical identifier of pipe culverts in the contract. 2. Station: chainage measurement on the contract. 3. Location: For cross culverts, the relevant alignment control line (e.g. highway

centreline) at the identified station with offset positions of pipe culvert upstream and downstream ends designated as the distance in metres left (LT) and right (RT) from the alignment control line (e.g. C/L 31.5 LT - 83.5 RT). For non-cross culverts, the relevant alignment control line at the identified station coincident with the culvert midpoint by length with offset position of pipe culvert upstream and downstream ends designated as the distance in metres left (LT) and/or right (RT) as applicable from the alignment control line (e.g. EB Alignment 25.8 LT - 27.8 LT)..

4. Extension: identifies placement of pipe culvert extensions by entering the length

of the extension into the appropriate right or left extension column of the “Quantities – Pipe Culverts” sheet. The total length of the extension must also be entered into the appropriate Pipe Culvert Extension tender item column of the “Quantities – Pipe Culverts” sheet.

If an existing culvert is to have both a left and right extension added, each

extension is to be entered as a separate record entry with reference to the same culvert number.

5. Skew number: Refer to Appendix B – Pipe Culvert Design Factors for

information on how to determine skew number. 6. End Finish: type of end finish to be applied to the pipe culvert which can be

Square or protruding ends which are applicable to any accepted pipe material. When corrugated steel structural plate pipe is used the protruding end may be cut or bevelled to more aesthetically blend with the surrounding slopes. Steel toe sections may be attached to the end of a smooth or corrugated steel pipe, if required. Refer to relevant OPSD for available end finish options for pipe culverts.

November 2015 Page 15 of 35 B421-2

Page 488: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

7. Depth to Pipe: from the surface downward to top of base pipe opening at the

midpoint by length of the culvert. 8. Pipe Fill Material: Where there are no recommendations from a foundations or

geotechnical report to specify any particular pipe fill material, the pipe fill materials will be specified, by default, as “G” for bedding and by extension embedment, and “N” for backfill and cover. The designer does not have to enter any material specifications in the columns to have the default material specifications apply.

However, specific pipe fill material for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of

flexible pipes, or backfill, if recommended in a foundations or geotechnical report, shall be specified in the appropriate pipe fill material column. Pipe fill materials shall be specified as follows:

• N – native material, which applies to cover and backfill layers only, and

permits Granular B Type I, II or III, or Granular A to be used; • G – only Granular B Type I, II or III, or Granular A may be used; • B – only Granular B Type II or Granular A may be used; • A – only Granular A may be used; and • C – Unshrinkable Fill (Concrete).

A single letter code is used to indicate the same pipe fill material for a pipe fill

layer is suitable for both rigid and flexible pipe options. If using the same pipe fill material is not suitable, two letter codes are used such that the first letter specifies the pipe fill material for rigid pipes while the second letter specifies the pipe fill material for flexible pipes for a pipe fill layer.

The pipe fill material codes are structured in an ascending order of quality. All higher level codes above the code that is selected are deemed to be satisfactory for the installation. In cases where the higher level pipe fill materials are not suitable (i.e. different frost susceptibility characteristics), a designer shall insert a contract note to alert the contractor that only the specified pipe fill material is acceptable.

Embedment for flexible pipes is from the bottom of bedding layer to bottom of

backfill layer and is specified in the bedding material column. When only flexible pipes are specified, the pipe fill material cover column is not applicable.

Clear stone may be used as bedding or embedment fill material, if groundwater

conditions warrant the need. Refer to the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines for details.

9. Pipe Joints: Types of joints required are to be specified in the appropriately

labeled column on the "Quantities – Pipe Culvert" sheet. “S” denotes a joint that

November 2015 Page 16 of 35 B421-2

Page 489: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

is soil tight while “F” denotes a joint that is silt or fines tight and “L” denotes a joint that is water tight. Pipe joints are specified by default as “S” regardless of whether or not the “S” code is entered into the “Pipe Joints” column. Joint classification is hierarchal in nature so that if an “S” joint is specified, the “F” and “L” joints are also acceptable, unless otherwise stated.

10. Treatment: Type or types of treatment that a pipe culvert will require are to be

specified in the appropriately labelled column on the "Quantities – Pipe Culvert" sheet where “F” specifies frost treatment, “P” specifies paved invert, “S” specifies channel substrate placement and “B” specifies baffle placements. All appropriate treatment letters shall be entered in the column.

Up to 2 letters may be specified in the column of the "Quantities – Pipe Culvert" sheet. Should a 3rd treatment letter be required, a contract note is to be used.

11. Upstream and downstream inverts: elevation entries of pipe culvert invert at the

upstream and downstream locations. Refer to Appendix B – Pipe Culvert Design Factors for information on how to determine grades and elevations.

12. Pipe Culvert Tender Items: Pipe culverts are shown on the "Quantities – Pipe

Culverts" sheet using a separate column for each pipe culvert tender item. Each pipe culvert tender item is formatted as shown below: Circular Pipe Culverts Size mm Pipe Culverts Size + mm range S xxxxxx Size + mm range C xxxxxx Non-circular Pipe Culverts Size mm Non-Circular Pipe Culverts Size + mm S xxxxxx Size + mm C xxxxxx Pipe Culvert Extensions Size mm Pipe Culvert Extensions Size S xxxxxx Size C xxxxxx Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extensions Size mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extensions Size S xxxxxx Size C xxxxxx

November 2015 Page 17 of 35 B421-2

Page 490: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Different pipe culvert, non-circular pipe culvert, pipe culvert extension and non-circular pipe culvert extension sizes will necessitate entry of separate tender items. Same pipe culvert, non-circular pipe culvert, pipe culvert extension and non-circular pipe culvert extension sizes but with different size tolerance ranges and pipe material codes for different locations will necessitate entry as a composite pipe culvert tender item (e.g. more than one column is required to specify the pipe culvert tender item).

Refer to Appendix A - Pipe Culvert Tender Item for information and guidance of

how to define pipe culvert, non-circular pipe culvert, pipe culvert extension and non-circular pipe culvert extension tender items for entry into the “Quantities – Pipe Culverts” sheets.

Refer to Appendix C - CPS Master List of Pipe Culvert Tender Items for a

complete list of all pipe culvert, non-circular pipe culvert, pipe culvert extension and non-circular pipe culvert extension tender items to be used in MTO contracts.

13. Pipe Culvert length: The pipe length for each pipe culvert tender item must be

entered in the appropriate columns at each pipe culvert location. 14. Frost penetration depth must be entered on the “Quantities – Pipe Culverts” sheet. 15. Notes that may be required on the “Quantities – Pipe Culverts” sheet

A contract note can be a tender item note, which makes the note applicable to all culvert locations of that pipe size category, or can be a quantity item note if it is only applicable to certain culvert locations. i) Identified locations where the non-reinforced concrete pipe material is

acceptable must be noted. ii) When corrugated steel pipes are specified and there are two different

products permitted, the product with the greater material specifications must be noted at the locations where permitted since minimum material specifications have been identified in the pipe culvert tender item.

iii) All culverts, other than entrance culverts, shall have the non-designed

embedment depth equal to one tenth of the height or diameter of the pipe culvert specified through an attached tender item note. Any culvert embedment depths, as determined through design, require a note specifying the embedment depth requirement.

iv) When special culvert end treatments are required, a note shall be provided

indicating the culvert end treatment requirement.

November 2015 Page 18 of 35 B421-2

Page 491: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

v) The locations of clay seals or other types of physical flow control barriers are to be indicated through a note.

vi) If frost treatment is different than standard 10 (k-d), a note shall be provided

indicating the different treatment requirements. vii) Where camber is required, the pipe culvert number and camber distances

must be noted. viii) When more than two culvert treatments are required, the additional

treatments require a note indicating the treatment requirement. ix) When higher level pipe fill materials are not acceptable, a note shall be

provided indicating that only the specified pipe material is acceptable.

16. Other Associated Pipe Culvert quantity items.

To specify other pipe culvert quantity items as discussed below, the designer shall use CPS functional capabilities to enter the requirements into the contract package. Options may include creation of appropriate tender item columns on specific identified contract quantity sheets, attachment of standard or non-standard special provisions, or other suitable contract documentation methods.

i) Where the installation of a pipe culvert is in a contract that includes other

highway work (i.e. asphalt pavement removal, sidewalk removal, earth excavation, granular and pavement placement), the works above subgrade required in the pipe culvert installation area is included in the tender item for the other highway work. If the contract has no other highway work, that above subgrade work may be included in the pipe culvert item.

ii) Swamp excavation is included in either "Earth Excavation (Grading)" or

"Rental of Swamp Excavation Equipment". iii) Rock excavation for trenches and associated structures requires a separate

entry for each pipe culvert in rock to be shown in the Rock Excavation column of the "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" sheet, and the total quantity transferred to the Tender document. Rock material from trenches and associated structures excavations is shown as "Material Available for Fill" on the "Quantities - Grading" sheet. Rock shatter that must be excavated to place pipe culvert bedding is quantified for payment under this item.

iv) Granular and pavement to be supplied and placed for trench reinstatement

would be included with the granular and pavement materials as part of the highway works.

November 2015 Page 19 of 35 B421-2

Page 492: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

v) When concrete appurtenances are to be placed on pipe culverts, they are treated as a separate item of work. Concrete appurtenances must be listed for each individual location on the "Quantities – Miscellaneous” sheet, or, if there are no other concrete items, they should be listed on the "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" sheet.

vi) Clay Seal is a lump sum item and is identified as a separate tender item

without quantity on the "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" Sheet. The designation of 100% is recorded for each location and is entered in the tender totals column while the designation LS is entered into the unit column of the quantity sheet.

vii) If dewatering is tendered as a separate item, it shall be entered as a lump

sum in the contract. Ensure that any requirements as specified by SP100S59 are accounted for in the contract.

viii) Elaborate protection systems require separate tender items. ix) Safety slope end treatments shall be entered into a separate column, if

required, on the "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" Sheet.

17. Post Installation Inspections

Pipe culverts on ministry contracts may be subject to post installation inspections. The following criteria shall be applied to determine if this work is necessary.

1. The total combined pipe culvert length of all pipe culvert tender items,

excluding entrance culverts and culvert extensions, is greater than or equal to 200 m; or

2. The total combined pipe culvert length of all pipe culvert tender items, excluding entrance culverts and culvert extensions, is less than 200 m, however, at least one pipe culvert is greater than or equal to 450 mm in diameter and is greater than or equal to 40 m in length.

Should post installation inspections for pipe culverts be required, SSP104S02 shall be included. Payment for post installation inspection work is detailed in SSP104S02.

421.10.3 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded to the nearest metre except for unusual circumstances, when 0.1 m may be required. Offsets are usually recorded to the nearest metre, or 0.1 m where required.

November 2015 Page 20 of 35 B421-2

Page 493: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Individual pipe design lengths are recorded in whole metres (except 0.1 m where space is restricted and when steel end-sections are used), and placed on the "Quantities - Pipe Culverts" sheet in suitably headed columns. Pipe culvert extension size, type, and class, for both circular and non-circular, require separate columns based on individual pipe extension sizes, types and pipe material codes. Individual pipe extension design lengths are recorded in whole metres (except 0.1 m where space is restricted). Invert elevations are recorded in 0.01 m. Concrete Appurtenances should have concrete quantities and tender totals recorded to 0.1 m3. Clay Seal is a lump sum tender unit of measurement.

November 2015 Page 21 of 35 B421-2

Page 494: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Appendix A – Pipe Culvert Tender Item The pipe culvert item is a variation tender item to be entered into a contract and for circular pipe has been structured to identify: a base pipe diameter; the minimum smooth inner wall diameter plus the upper size range tolerance in mm with associated pipe material code; and, if appropriate, the minimum corrugated inner wall diameter plus the upper size range tolerance in mm with associated pipe material code. This tender item format can fully specify the acceptable pipe products based on size, type and class. The tender item follows the descriptive format as noted below:

Size mm Pipe Culvert base pipe diameter Size+mm range S xxxxxx minimum smooth pipe diameter + tolerance range, type and

material code Size+mm range C xxxxxx minimum corrugated pipe diameter + tolerance range, type and

material code The need to insert the pipe diameter for the circular pipe in the item description necessitates a separate tender item for each size of circular pipe culvert. Non-circular pipe culvert tender items have been structured to identify: the equivalent circular base pipe diameter to the span and rise dimensions required; the minimum circular equivalent smooth inner wall diameter plus the upper size range tolerance in mm with associated pipe material code; and, if appropriate, the minimum circular equivalent corrugated inner wall diameter plus the upper size range tolerance in mm with associated pipe material code. The designer uses the equivalent circular diameter to identify the appropriate non-circular pipe span and rise dimensions that the non-circular pipe culvert design requires. This tender item format can fully specify the acceptable pipe products based on size, type and class. The tender item follows the descriptive format as noted below:

Size mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert base pipe span x rise Size+mm range S xxxxxx minimum smooth pipe diameter + tolerance range, type

and material code Size+mm range C xxxxxx minimum corrugated pipe diameter + tolerance range,

type and material code The need to insert the equivalent pipe diameter for the non-circular pipe in the item description necessitates a separate tender item for each size of non-circular pipe culvert. A pipe culvert extension is essentially a pipe, circular or non-circular, that is fitted onto the end of an existing culvert in order to lengthen the existing culvert to the desired length. Circular pipe culvert extension tender items have been structured to identify diameter, type and the required material specifications. The tender item follows the descriptive format as noted below:

November 2015 Page 22 of 35 B421-2

Page 495: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Size mm Pipe Culvert Extension base pipe diameter Size S xxxxxx diameter, smooth pipe type and material code Size C xxxxxx diameter, corrugated pipe type and material code

The need to insert the pipe diameter for pipe culvert extensions in the item description necessitates a separate tender item for each size of pipe culvert extension. Non-circular pipe culvert extension tender items have been structured to identify the equivalent diameter, type and the required material specifications. The tender item follows the descriptive format as noted below:

Size mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension base pipe diameter Size S xxxxxx equivalent diameter, smooth pipe type and

material code Size C xxxxxx equivalent diameter, corrugated pipe type and

material code The need to insert the equivalent pipe diameter for non-circular pipe culvert extensions in the item description necessitates a separate tender item for each size of non-circular pipe culvert extension. The pipe culvert material code is a 6 digit code that specifies the minimum material specifications for all acceptable pipe materials identified through design. Each digit represents a pipe material and in turn each digit has different values that specify the material specifications of that pipe material.

November 2015 Page 23 of 35 B421-2

Page 496: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

The Pipe Culvert Material Code is illustrated in Figure 1.0.

Figure 1.0: Pipe Culvert Material Code

The Pipe Culvert Material Code is interpreted in the following manner: 1. The 1st digit represents concrete pipe, both circular and non-circular. For circular concrete pipe,

there are two product types for consideration. They are manufactured with reinforcing steel or without. To define the required reinforced circular concrete pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate values as:

• 1 for Class 50 D-Load; or • 2 for Class 65 D-Load; or • 3 for Class 100 D-Load; or • 4 for Class 140 D-Load.

November 2015 Page 24 of 35 B421-2

Page 497: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

To define the required reinforced non-circular concrete pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate values as:

• 1 for HE-A; or • 2 for HE-I; or • 3 for HE-II; or • 4 for HE-III; or • 5 for HE-IV.

The final concrete pipe class selection shall be dependent on the bedding class that is appropriate for the type of soils encountered at the site. When specifying any concrete pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and load rating.

Exception The designer shall note the acceptability of non-reinforced concrete pipe products on the Quantities – Pipe Culvert sheet in the Contract. This will be done as a note to the tender item to indicate the suitability of this pipe product in all locations or as a note to a quantity if the suitability of non-reinforced concrete pipe only applies to one pipe location.

2. The 2nd digit represents PVC and PP (polypropylene) pipes.

There are two PVC product types for consideration. They are manufactured with a smooth inside and a ribbed outside (profile) wall or with a smooth inside and outside (solid) wall. To define the required PVC pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 1 for all classes (Class 210 kpa (equivalent to SDR 41) or Class 320 kpa (equivalent to SDR 35)) which defines the strength requirement for either product type. When one of the PVC pipe products is not suitable for a given site, the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the unsuitable PVC pipe product. PP pipe product types are manufactured as dual (open profile) and triple wall (closed profile) pipes available in 320 kPa material specifications. To define the required PP pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 2 for both product types which define the strength requirements for either product type. The designer should be aware that the 750 mm PP pipe is available in both an open and closed profile. If one of the PP pipe products is not suitable for a given site, the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the unsuitable PP pipe product.

November 2015 Page 25 of 35 B421-2

Page 498: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

PP pipe products are automatically specified when the 2nd digit pipe material code is 1. If this is not the case for a given site, then the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of PP pipe at the site. When specifying any PVC or PP pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and pipe stiffness rating.

3. The 3rd digit represents HDPE pipes. There are two product types for consideration. They are manufactured with a smooth inside and a corrugated outside wall (open profile) or with a smooth inside and outside wall with a corrugated inner wall (closed profile).

To define the required HDPE pipe, the designer will specify the appropriate value as 1 for open profile pipes and 2 for closed profile.

Closed profile HDPE pipe products are automatically specified when the 3rd digit pipe material

code is 1. If this is not the case for a given site, then the designer, through a contract note, shall restrict the use of the closed profile HDPE pipe at the site. When specifying any HDPE pipe material, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size and pipe stiffness.

4. The 4th, 5th and 6th digits all represent steel and aluminum alloy pipe products. There are three pipe product lines for consideration. They are manufactured as spiral rib steel pipe (SRSP), corrugated steel pipe (CSP), and structural plate pipe (SPP). SRSP is a smooth pipe while CSP and SPP are corrugated pipes. SRSP and CSP pipe products come in three coatings; galvanized, aluminized type II and polymer laminated. Steel SPP is available with a galvanized coating and a polymer coating. SPP is also manufactured from aluminum alloy materials. The 4th digit is used for specifying required galvanized SRSP, CSP and SPP products. To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

November 2015 Page 26 of 35 B421-2

Page 499: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.0 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 4.0 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 5.0 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 6.0 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 7.0 mm thick walls.

The 5th digit is used for specifying aluminized type II SRSP and CSP pipe products and for specifying aluminum alloy SPP products. To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required aluminum alloy SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.18 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.81 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.45 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 5.08 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 5.72 mm thick walls; or • 8 representing 6.35 mm thick walls.

The 6th digit is used for specifying polymer laminated or coated SRSP, CSP and SPP products.

November 2015 Page 27 of 35 B421-2

Page 500: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

To define the required SRSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; or • 2 representing 2.0 mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls.

To define the required CSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 1 representing 1.6 mm thick walls; • 2 representing 2.0mm thick walls; or • 3 representing 2.8 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 3.5 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 4.2 mm thick walls.

To define the required SSP products, the designer will specify the appropriate value as:

• 3 representing 3.0 mm thick walls; or • 4 representing 4.0 mm thick walls; or • 5 representing 5.0 mm thick walls; or • 6 representing 6.0 mm thick walls; or • 7 representing 7.0 mm thick walls.

When specifying any steel or aluminum alloy pipe materials, the designer should reference the pipe availability tables in Appendix C of the MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines to ensure that the pipe products specified are indeed commercially available in size, protective coating and wall thickness. Non-circular steel pipe products shall have the material requirements specified in the same fashion as for circular steel pipe products. Exception For some diameters, CSP is available with two corrugation profiles. The pipe material durability analysis may determine a single wall thickness for both CSP product lines while the structural analysis of the pipe materials determines a different wall thickness for each CSP product lines. The designer shall identify the minimum wall thickness through the Pipe Material Code and note the greater wall thickness requirement of the other pipe product on the Quantities – Pipe Culverts sheet in the Contract. This shall be done as a note to the tender item to indicate the greater wall thickness requirement of this pipe product in all locations on the contract or as a note to a quantity if the greater wall thickness requirement of this pipe product only applies to one pipe location.

November 2015 Page 28 of 35 B421-2

Page 501: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Appendix B – Additional Pipe Culvert Design Factors Pipe Culvert Alignment Pipe culvert location and alignment is discussed in detail in the MTO Drainage Management Manual. The crossing often is oblique to the highway centreline, and is referred to as being skewed. Referring to Figure B421-1 "Skew Diagram for Pipe culverts", the designer will determine the angle of crossing and, from it, assign a "Skew Number".

The SKEW NUMBER is obtained by measuring CLOCKWISE, to the nearest degree, the angle between the centreline of the highway and the centreline of the pipe culvert.

Figure B421- 1

November 2015 Page 29 of 35 B421-2

Page 502: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Multiple Pipe Culvert Installations Figure B421-2 "Spacing for Multiple Pipe Culvert Installations" gives the minimum spacing allowed between pipe culverts when placing two or more circular or non-circular pipes in a multiple installation.

November 2015 Page 30 of 35 B421-2

Page 503: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Pipe Culvert Camber Flexible pipes on compressible soils, especially under high embankments, should be longitudinally cambered (Fig. B421-3). This will counteract the effects of differential settlement, to avoid ponding inside the pipe culvert. A geotechnical report shall contain information and recommendations as to the amount of camber required.

Steel / PVC / HDPE Pipe Camber

Streambed Camber

Final Grade after Settlement Cambered Grade

Figure B421-3

November 2015 Page 31 of 35 B421-2

Page 504: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Rock Excavation for Trenches and Associated Structures Calculations of rock removal are quantified based on the dimensional parameters shown below in Figure B521-4.

Bottom of Subgrade

Bottom of Backfill Layer

Original Ground

New Cross Section

Existing Cross Section

Excavation for Culvert

Placing of Culvert in Existing Roadbed Under a Reconstruction Project

Figure B421-4

For actual dimensions refer to the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings

November 2015 Page 32 of 35 B421-2

Page 505: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

Appendix C – CPS Master List of Pipe Culvert Tender Items In the CPS master list are the pipe culvert tender items and the sizes of pipe that each category represents. The list has been reproduced below for clarity to the designer. 1. Circular Pipe Culverts Contract Preparation System (CPS) Culvert Pipe Pipe Culvert Tender Item Size Range (mm) 100 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 100 mm < 200 mm 200 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 200 mm < 300 mm 300 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 300 mm < 400 mm 400 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 400 mm < 500 mm 500 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 500 mm < 600 mm 600 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 600 mm < 700 mm 700 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 700 mm < 800 mm 800 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 800 mm < 900 mm 900 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 900 mm < 1000 mm 1000 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1000 mm < 1200 mm 1200 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1200 mm < 1300 mm 1300 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1300 mm < 1400 mm 1400 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1400 mm < 1500 mm 1500 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1500 mm < 1600 mm 1600 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1600 mm < 1800 mm 1800 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1800 mm < 1900 mm 1900 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 1900 mm < 2000 mm 2000 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2000 mm < 2100 mm 2100 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2100 mm < 2200 mm 2200 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2200 mm < 2400 mm 2400 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2400 mm < 2500 mm 2500 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2500 mm < 2600 mm 2600 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2600 mm < 2700 mm 2700 mm Pipe Culvert ≥ 2700 mm < 3000 mm 3000 mm Pipe Culvert = 3000 mm The pipe size required is selected by the pipe culvert tender item category that it falls into. All circular pipe culvert tender items are selected in this fashion.

November 2015 Page 33 of 35 B421-2

Page 506: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

2. Non-Circular Pipe Culverts Contract Preparation System (CPS) Actual Non-Circular Culvert Pipe Specified Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Tender Item Span x Rise Dimensions (mm) 400 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 500 x 410 mm SRSP arch pipe 500 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 560 x 420 mm CSP arch pipe 580 x 490 mm SRSP arch pipe 600 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 680 x 500 mm CSP arch pipe 680 x 540 mm SRSP arch pipe 700 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 800 x 580 mm CSP arch pipe 830 x 660 mm SRSP arch pipe 800 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 910 x 660 mm CSP arch pipe 900 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1030 x 740 mm CSP arch pipe 1010 x 790 mm SRSP arch pipe 1150 x 730 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1000 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1150 x 820 mm CSP arch pipe 1160 x 920 mm SRSP arch pipe 1100 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1345 x 855 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1200 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1390 x 970 mm CSP arch pipe 1330 x 1030 mm CSP arch pipe 1340 x 1050 mm SRSP arch pipe 1535 x 975 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1300 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1520 x 1200 mm SRSP arch pipe 1730 x 1095 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1400 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1630 x 1120 mm CSP arch pipe 1550 x 1220 mm CSP arch pipe 1500 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1670 x 1300 mm SRSP arch pipe 1920 x 1220 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1600 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 1880 x 1260 mm CSP arch pipe 1780 x 1360 mm CSP arch pipe 1850 x 1400 mm SRSP arch pipe 1700 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2110 x 1340 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 1800 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2130 x 1400 mm CSP arch pipe 2010 x 1530 mm CSP arch pipe 2305 x 1465 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 2080 x 1520 mm SSP arch pipe 1900 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2495 x 1585 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 2240 x 1630 mm SSP arch pipe 2000 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2230 x 1700 mm CSP arch pipe 2100 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2690 x 1705 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe 2440 x 1750 mm SSP arch pipe 2200 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2500 x 1830 mm CSP arch pipe 2400 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2800 x 1950 mm CSP arch pipe 3070 x 1950 mm Horizontal elliptical concrete pipe

November 2015 Page 34 of 35 B421-2

Page 507: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PIPE CULVERTS

2590 x 1880 mm SSP arch pipe 2500 mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert 2690 x 2080 mm SSP arch pipe The pipe size required is selected by the pipe culvert tender item category that it falls into. All non-circular pipe culvert tender items are selected in this fashion. 3. Pipe Culvert Extensions Contract Preparation System (CPS) Pipe Culvert Extension Tender Item xxx mm Pipe Culvert Extensions xxx S xxxxxx xxx C xxxxxx The designer selects the pipe culvert tender item and enters the pipe size required for the pipe culvert extension. All pipe culvert extension tender items are selected in this fashion. 4. Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extensions Contract Preparation System (CPS) Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extension Tender Item xxx mm Non-Circular Pipe Culvert Extensions xxx S xxxxxx xxx C xxxxxx The designer selects the pipe culvert tender item and enters the equivalent pipe diameter required for the pipe culvert extension. All non-circular pipe culvert extension tender items are selected in this fashion.

November 2015 Page 35 of 35 B421-2

Page 508: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 509: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

B422 - PRECAST REINFORCED CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS - OPSS 422

422.1 GENERAL The work under these tender items consists of the fabrication and installation in open

cut of precast reinforced concrete box culverts with a standard-sized opening.

This section refers solely to box culverts, but the content is equally applicable to box sewers.

The designer selects the appropriate opening size that accommodates the design flow

from the available sizes listed in OPSS 1821, within the allowable fill covers specified. For fill cover depths outside those shown in OPSS 1821, the Regional Structural Section shall be consulted.

Manufacture of precast box culverts typically requires eight weeks. Adequate time must be allocated to the project schedule for manufacture and for late season work the box culverts may need to be pre-ordered under a separate tender.

422.2 REFERENCES MTO Drainage Management Manual Ontario Provincial Standards Specifications Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings Drainage Management Technical Guidelines Roadside Safety Manual 422.3 TENDER ITEMS 422.3.1 1800 mm x 900 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 1800 mm x 1200 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 2400 mm x 1200 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 2400 mm x 1500 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 2400 mm x 1800 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 2500 mm x 1830 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 3000 mm x 1500 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 3000 mm x 1800 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 3000 mm x 2100 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert 3000 mm x 2400 mm Precast Concrete Box Culvert

April 2016 Page 1 of 9 B422

Page 510: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

Standard sizes, as listed above, should be specified whenever possible. Designers should choose the next largest size meeting the hydraulic opening requirements.

The use of a non-standard tender item may be considered when non-standard dimensions must be used, such as to match and extend existing culverts. Any conflicts with OPSS 1821 must be addressed, and reinforcement requirements must be detailed.

422.3.2 Associated Tender Items The designer should be aware of the following tender items that are used in

conjunction with precast concrete box culverts: Earth Excavation for Structure (for box culvert and appurtenances) Rock Excavation for Structure Dewatering Structure Excavations Clay Seal OPSS 902 governs the above tender items. Design guidelines, documentation

requirements and quantity calculations are found in section B902 of this manual. Earth and rock excavation required for appurtenances are included under the tender

items, Earth Excavation for Structure or Rock Excavation for Structure, as applicable. Granular A, B Type I, B Type II, B Type III, SSM Compacted The appropriate tender item(s) in the contract for granular material covers the supply,

placement and compaction of the granular bedding, levelling course, cover and backfill required. Design guidelines, documentation requirements and quantity calculations are found in section B902 of this manual. A levelling course is required at each culvert installation.

Concrete Appurtenances

The flow through a box culvert may need to be controlled to prevent erosion damage to the area around it or to the box culvert structure itself. Concrete appurtenances such as headwalls, wing walls, energy dissipators, aprons, collars or other such types of structures are used to direct flow, slow velocities to prevent erosion, offset buoyancy forces, etc. The designer shall consider the need for a cut off wall to prevent scour and undermining of each end.

Concrete and steel for concrete appurtenances are according to OPSS 904 and OPSS 905, respectively. The following tender items are used in conjunction with concrete appurtenances for precast concrete box culverts:

April 2016 Page 2 of 9 B422

Page 511: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

OPSS 904, Concrete in Culverts OPSS 905, Reinforcing Steel Bar

422.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for fabrication and installation of precast concrete box culverts are

covered by OPSS 1821 and OPSS 422 respectively. 422.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable standard special

provisions. 422.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings available for use with these

tender items. Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawing (MTOD) 803.021 entitled "Bedding and Backfill for Precast Concrete Box Culverts" is to be included.

422.7 DESIGN 422.7.1 General The designer shall verify whether there are significant environmental, hydrological

and geotechnical concerns and determine the criteria and/or standards to which the culvert will be designed.

The general alignment, size and type of culvert are established by the designer, based

on acceptable drainage theory, environmental constraints, including possible fish passage and structural and foundations concerns. The designer shall use accepted drainage design methods by which to establish the culvert design that satisfies required drainage standards or criteria for the highway project.

The MTO Drainage Management Manual shall be used in the design of box culvert,

grades and the setting of upstream invert elevations. Complete requirements for design, analysis methods and other information are available in the MTO Drainage Management Manual.

April 2016 Page 3 of 9 B422

Page 512: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

422.7.2 Advantages of Precast Box Culverts versus Cast-in–place Open Footing Culverts Where feasible, consideration should be given to a precast concrete box culvert

installation instead of a cast in-place open footing culvert. Advantages of using a precast concrete box culvert include:

1) Relatively short construction time resulting in reduced environmental impact; 2) Feasibility for installation during cold weather conditions; 3) Relatively short period of use and maintenance of detours and subsequently

quicker roadway reinstatement; 4) Reduced dewatering duration. 5) Placing and curing concrete in shop conditions When articulation and/or cambering is required to accommodate predicted settlements, a precast concrete culvert is the preferred option.

Discussion of alternatives of precast concrete box culvert versus cast-in-place open

footing culvert and recommendations for the preferred alternative may be found in the geotechnical and foundation reports.

422.7.3 Trench A. Excavation

Excavated earth material may be used for embankment construction or used as native

backfill to the excavated trench as determined by the designer based on foundation or geotechnical reports. Surplus or unsuitable excavation material should be managed as outlined in B206-1 of this manual.

Due to the high unit cost of rock excavation, the designer shall endeavour to reduce

the volume of excavation by relocating the box culvert or skewing to optimize fit. B. Frost Protection

Special treatment of box culverts may be required for frost protection. Frost treatment is required if the frost line falls below the top of the box, within the bedding layer or below the bedding layer. Foundation or geotechnical reports shall contain information regarding recommended fill materials and the configuration and extent of frost taper excavations.

April 2016 Page 4 of 9 B422

Page 513: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

Frost tapers are not required when the frost line falls above the box culvert or when the box culvert is constructed in rock fill.

C. Dewatering

Dewatering refers to pumping, bailing, temporary ditching or vacuum removal of

uncontaminated groundwater, rain water, melt water, surface runoff, water pipe leakage from excavations and trenches or within sheeted coffer dams to improve the soil stability or for other construction purposes. Dewatering also refers to the lowering of the groundwater table in the excavation site area in a manner that enables completion of the construction work.

Where dewatering is required for the installation of a culvert, details shall comply

with the requirements of OPSS 517 and OPSS 902. Although the Contractor is responsible for a dewatering plan, the designer shall note

any recommendations included in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report, if available.

Information on subsurface conditions required for design of the dewatering system,

including Record of Borehole sheets and laboratory testing results, can be found in the foundation/geotechnical report included in the tender documents.

D. Fill Material

To prevent damage to the box culvert due to loads, fill materials are provided as

protective and support layers. Fill material for box installations is placed in distinct bedding, backfill and cover layers.

A foundation or geotechnical report will include recommendations for the

specification, supply and placement of fill material or any special conditions for bedding, backfill and cover layers. In addition, special consideration for scour protection at the box inlet or outlet may be required and the designer shall refer to the MTO Drainage Management Manual for assistance.

The designer shall specify the fill materials required for the installation, based on the

recommendations of the Foundation Investigation and Design Report or Geotechnical report.

The contractor, not the designer, is responsible for selecting the appropriate box

culvert installation method at the time of installation based on the soil types found on the construction site in accordance with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations for Construction Projects.

April 2016 Page 5 of 9 B422

Page 514: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

E. Protection Systems Protection systems shall be considered where the stability of excavation, safety or function of an existing roadway, railway or any structure or slope may be threatened or impaired due to the construction of a box culvert.

The design, installation, monitoring, and removal of protection systems are the Contractor’s responsibility and the Contractor should base his plan on information provided in the Foundation Investigation Report or Geotechnical Report. Complex soil conditions, high groundwater tables or other installation issues, if identified, would give rise to recommendations regarding the design, installation and removal of protection systems. Conceptual recommendations for design as well as recommendations for performance levels could be found in Foundation Investigation and Design Reports.

Where protection system is required for installation of culvert, details shall comply

with OPSS 539. When required, a protection system shall be paid for under a separate tender item.

F. Clay Seals

Warrants for clay seals to be installed at the culvert sites may include: 1) The natural sub-base and culvert foundation materials are of a granular nature; 2) The embankment material is of a non-cohesive nature; or 3) There is significant hydraulic head differential between the upstream and

downstream ends of the box culvert.

Recommendations are found in a Foundation Investigation and Design Report or Geotechnical Report.

G. Camber A Foundation Investigation and Design Report or Geotechnical Report will contain

information and design requirements for the camber depths needed for a box culvert installation.

422.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

April 2016 Page 6 of 9 B422

Page 515: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

422.8.1 Sources of Information 1. Regional Geomatics Section Survey information The survey information provides profiles along the drainage course at both existing

and new culvert locations and other drainage courses. Drainage and Hydrology Information Provides information to assist in the calculation of culvert sizes by providing drainage

areas, mosaic studies, soil types, etc. 2. Regional Geotechnical Section Provides advice on backfill requirement and the need for placing clay seals for non-

structural (typically less than 3 m span) culverts and at sites where subsurface conditions are not complex. However, for non-structural culverts located in areas of highly complex subsurface conditions such as soft, sensitive soils and saturated cohesionless soils, the recommendations for design shall be available in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

3. Foundation Investigation and Design Report For all culverts larger than 3 m, and for non-structural culverts (less than 3 m), located

at sites where complex subsurface conditions are present, recommendations for design, including excavation, dewatering, bedding, backfilling, cover, clay seals, treatments at inlet/outlet for scour protection shall be provided in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

The Foundation Investigation and Design Report shall address any issues related to

complex subsurface conditions, including requirements for camber, articulation and construction staging. This includes use of a temporary culvert during embankment preload/surcharge and then proceeding to a permanent precast concrete box installation.

4. Drainage Management Manual

The Drainage Management Manual provides overall guidance on the design of

culverts and storm drainage systems. It should be used together with the MTO Drainage Management Technical Guidelines.

In design of the culvert sizes, the foundation requirements provided in the Foundation

Investigation and Design Report or Geotechnical Report shall be considered.

April 2016 Page 7 of 9 B422

Page 516: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

422.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for length of the precast concrete box culvert is the metre. Working with design cross-sections, standard drawings, drainage profiles and the size

of culvert previously determined, the designer calculates the box length. The design length (L) of the box is the distance between the toes of embankment slopes where they meet the streambed profile measured to the nearest 0.1 metre.

422.9 DOCUMENTATION a) Contract Drawings New precast concrete box culverts and existing culverts requiring extension are

numbered and shown on the plans and profiles of the contract drawings. Culvert alignment and skew is shown on the plans (refer to B421 to determine skew). Locations and details of culvert appurtenances are shown on the plans and labelled. Appropriate invert elevations are to be shown.

Any requirements for cambering shall be illustrated on the contract drawings. Bedding, backfilling and cover requirements shall be illustrated and noted on the

contract drawings. Requirements for the inspection of the founding soil prior to placement of the bedding

shall be noted on the contract drawings. b) Quantity Sheets Information is entered on the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. Information

includes culvert number, station and location. Offset is included when required. The length of each culvert is entered under the appropriate column heading labelled with the tender item name, indicating the box opening size.

Granular material quantities used for bedding and levelling courses, cover, backfill

and frost tapers shall be shown under the appropriate column headings for granular material tender items, when applicable.

Concrete and reinforcing steel quantities for concrete appurtenances are included in the Quantities – Structures sheet, with location and description details sufficient to link the quantities to the box culvert locations.

April 2016 Page 8 of 9 B422

Page 517: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRECAST CONCRETE BOX CULVERTS AND BOX SEWERS

c) Non-standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) An NSSP to alert the Contractor of subsurface and groundwater conditions is included

on a project specific basis, when recommended in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

In some cases, a levelling slab may be required using mass concrete, clear stone, or other material. The requirement would be shown by non-standard detail in the contract drawings. An NSSP is used to include payment with the box culvert item. When a non-standard precast box culvert size is required, a non-standard drawing detail and NSSP is typically required.

422.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Length of culvert rounded to the nearest 0.1m. Stations are recorded in whole

numbers.

April 2016 Page 9 of 9 B422

Page 518: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 519: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

B441 - WATERMAINS - OPSS 441 441.1 GENERAL

Watermains are a component of a water supply network. Watermains are a system of engineered hydraulic components designed for the conveyance of water from storage to consumption. Watermains come in a variety of materials including concrete, iron, PVC, polyethylene, polybutylene, steel and copper. Valves, hydrant sets, service connections pipes and connections comprise the watermain system. The ministry does not often do watermain projects independently of municipalities. A typical project may involve a municipal watermain crossing a highway right-of-way. Liaison with the local municipality is usually necessary and use of municipal documentation for watermains within ministry contracts is often done.

441.2 REFERENCES CDED B206-1 Earth Grading CDED B206-2 Rock Grading CDED B314 Untreated Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, Selected Subgrade, and

Stockpiling CDED B517 Dewatering CDED B902 Excavating and Backfilling - Structures SSP 100S59 Amendment to MTO General Conditions of Contract, Permits to

Take Water

441.3 TENDER ITEMS Watermains (variation, m, PQP) Valves (variation, each, PQP) Hydrant Sets (variation, each, PQP) Service Connection Pipe (variation, m, PQP) Service Connection Appurtenance Sets (normal, each, PQP) Connections to Existing Watermains (normal, each, PQP)

441.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for watermain and watermain related tender items are specified in OPSS 441. Trenching, backfilling and compaction requirements are specified in OPSS 401.

November 2016 Page 1 of 10 B441

Page 520: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

Where dewatering is required for watermain installation, the details of the operation shall comply with the requirements of OPSS 517. Where rock excavation is required for watermain installation, the details of the operation shall comply with OPSS 403.

441.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' to review standard special provisions that may be required for inclusion in the contract.

441.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 1100 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual; however, other OPSD or MTOD series may also apply.

441.7 DESIGN

441.7.1 General The designer should ensure that appropriate design documentation is made available for viewing by bidders at the tender stage or included in the tender documents. This includes but is not limited to soil boring data, geotechnical reports, foundation investigation and design report.

441.7.2 Watermain The general pipe layout, size, type and class of a watermain network are established, based on acceptable hydraulics theory by the designer. The designer shall use accepted hydraulics design methods by which to establish the watermain layout that satisfies required hydraulic standards and criteria for the highway project.

441.7.2.1 Size The design of a watermain network involves determining the sizes of pipes that will permit the watermain network to function within set design requirements and standards. The designer will determine the pipe size that will still permit the watermain network to function within the design parameters set.

November 2016 Page 2 of 10 B441

Page 521: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

441.7.2.2 Type and Class Pipe type and class refer to the material specifications of the pipe products. These specifications include load and pressure ratings, pipe wall thickness, protective coatings, and reinforcement. Acceptable material specifications of a watermain network are established, based on structural loading and material durability requirements, by the designer. The designer shall use accepted structural and durability assessment methods by which to establish the pipe type and class that satisfies both structural and material durability criteria.

441.7.2.3 Valves The designer shall make an assessment of the type of valve required for the watermain network.

441.7.3 Trench

441.7.3.1 Excavation Excavated earth material may be used for embankment construction or used as native backfill to the excavated watermain trench as determined by the designer based on foundation or geotechnical reports. Surplus or unsuitable excavation material should be managed as outlined in B206-1 and B206-2 of this manual. In view of the high unit cost for rock excavation, the designer should endeavour to reduce the volume of rock excavation by relocating, pipe skewing, etc., wherever possible. In most cases, watermains are constructed below the frost line and would not require any special treatments for frost. In rock fills, frost tapers are not required, but fill material must be provided. When the watermain cannot be constructed below the frost line, special treatment will be required. Foundations or geotechnical reports shall contain information regarding recommended fill materials and the configuration and extent of frost taper excavations. Where fill material cannot protect the watermain or frost tapers cannot be constructed, other frost protection options need to be considered. Designers may consider using styrofoam or other insulation materials to prevent frost from penetrating into the watermain critical zone.

441.7.3.2 Dewatering Dewatering refers to pumping, bailing, temporary ditching or vacuum removal of uncontaminated groundwater, rain water, melt water, surface runoff, water pipe leakage from excavations and trenches or within sheeted cofferdams to improve the

November 2016 Page 3 of 10 B441

Page 522: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

soil stability or for other construction purposes. Unwatering refers to lowering of the groundwater table in the excavation site area in a manner that enables completion of the construction work. Although the Contractor is responsible for any dewatering or unwatering plan, the designer shall note any recommendations included in the foundation investigation and design report. The designer shall also refer to SSP 100S59, Amendment to MTO General Conditions of Contract, Permits to Take Water, for additional requirements that may need to be specified in the contract.

441.7.3.3 Fill Material To prevent damage to the watermain network due to “live” and “dead” loads, fill material is provided as protective and support layers. Fill material for rigid pipe installations is placed in distinct bedding, cover and backfill layers. Flexible pipe installations require fill material to be placed as distinct embedment, which is from the bottom of the bedding layer to the bottom of the backfill layer, and backfill layers. The minimum or maximum height of pipe fill material is placed in accordance with Height of Fill tables (800 series OPSDs) for the materials identified. A foundation or geotechnical report will include recommendations for the supply, placement, and specifications of fill material or any special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes and backfill layers. The designer shall specify the fill materials required for the installation, based on the recommendations of the foundation or geotechnical report. The designer should be familiar with the various installation methods available as referenced in the 1100 series OPSDs for the watermain installation so that the fill materials recommended are appropriately specified. The contractor, not the designer, is responsible for selecting the appropriate watermain installation method at the time of installation based on the soil types found on the construction site in accordance with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations for Construction Projects.

441.7.3.4 Reinstatement Where existing driving lanes must be excavated to allow the construction of the watermain network, the affected roadbed must be rebuilt to acceptable standards to maintain the continuity of the pavement. This is particularly important where there is to be no resurfacing of the highway. The designer shall determine and specify bedding, cover and backfill depths and materials up to subgrade. Above subgrade, the

November 2016 Page 4 of 10 B441

Page 523: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

designer shall determine the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. Granular base and paving is not covered by OPSS 441, See CDED B206 and CDED B300 series.

441.7.3.5 Protection Systems These systems will be applicable where the stability, safety or function of an existing roadway, railway, etc. may be threatened or impaired due to the construction of a watermain or in cases where the watermain will be installed at a depth where protection schemes are required. When watermains are to be placed in deep installations or in areas of rock excavation or where an exceptionally large and complex watermain layout is to be constructed, the designer shall request that soils borings be taken along the actual watermain alignment for more precise data. The foregoing is also relevant to the selection of backfill materials and procedures. The design, installation and monitoring of protection systems is the Contractor’s responsibility and the Contractor should base his plan on information as found in foundation or geotechnical reports. Problematic soils, high groundwater tables or other installation issues, if identified, will give rise to recommendations regarding the design, installation and removal and would also be provided in these reports. Recommendations for performance levels can also be found in foundation investigation and design reports. Requirements for field investigation, laboratory testing and engineering recommendations for protection systems are to be specified in the foundation engineering terms of reference for any specific project such that appropriate information for the Contractor is provided.

441.8 COMPUTATION

441.8.1 Item Payment Basis The following items are Plan Quantity Payment items: Watermains Valves Hydrant Sets Service Connection Pipe Service Connection Appurtenance Sets Connections to Existing Watermains

November 2016 Page 5 of 10 B441

Page 524: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

441.8.2 Method of Calculation

441.8.2.1 Watermains The unit of measurement for watermains is the metre. Measurement for the length of the watermain will be made horizontally over the centreline of the pipe from the point of connection to a chamber, water treatment plant, or existing watermain to a point vertically above the end of the new watermain.

441.8.2.2 Valves The unit of measurement for valves is each. Measurement shall be by the number of units installed.

441.8.2.3 Hydrant Sets The unit of measurement for hydrant sets is each. Measurement shall be by the number of hydrant sets installed.

441.8.2.4 Service Connection Pipe The unit of measurement for service connection pipe is the metre. Measurement shall be horizontally from the point of connection to the watermain to a point vertically above the end of the service connections

441.8.2.5 Service Connection Appurtenance Sets The unit of measurement for service connection appurtenances is each. Measurement shall be by the number of units installed.

441.8.2.6 Connections to Existing Watermains The unit of measurement for connections to existing watermains is each. Measurement shall be by the number of units installed.

441.8.3 Accuracy The tender items Watermains and Service Connection Pipe are measured to an accuracy of 0.1 m. The tender item totals are rounded to the nearest metre.

November 2016 Page 6 of 10 B441

Page 525: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

441.8.4 Trench

441.8.4.1 Excavation Earth excavation required to place watermains is included in the tender item: ‘Watermains’..However, rock excavation is paid under a separate tender item, ‘Rock Excavation for Trenches and Associated Structures’, and administered under OPSS 403. Rock excavation quantities are based on information from the foundations or geotechnical reports, the soils profile and field survey notes.

441.8.4.2 Dewatering and Unwatering For further information, refer to CDED B517, Dewatering and CDED B902, Excavation and Backfill for Structures. Should a rare situation occur where it would be unfair to the Contractor to include an expensive dewatering or unwatering operation in the watermain bid price, then consideration could be given to using a separate tender item through a non-standard special provision. There is a non-standard item for “dewatering” and a standard item for “unwatering structure excavation”.

441.8.4.3 Fill Material Granular volumes for frost tapers, bedding, cover, embedment in the case of flexible pipes and backfill material for watermains are computed as shown in Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings or from detail drawings when applicable. The total granular requirement for each watermain is computed in cubic metres, and may be converted to tonnes using the conversion factor shown in Section B314 “Untreated Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, Selected Subgrade, and Stockpiling” of this manual. This quantity is used for Geotechnical ASL purposes only.

441.8.4.4 Protection Systems When the designer deems a protection system is required, the protection system is included using the “Protection System” tender item per OPSS 539.

November 2016 Page 7 of 10 B441

Page 526: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

441.9 DOCUMENTATION

441.9.1 Drawings

441.9.1.1 Watermain Location All watermains are to be indicated on the new construction plans of the contract drawings. Profiles, rock line, sub grade and original ground must be indicated where applicable on the contract drawings. The watermain configuration and a direction of flow arrow are to be indicated. Thrust restraints should be shown on the plan, with the applicable OPSD number. Connections to Existing Watermains, Hydrants and Service Connections Locations of connections to existing watermains, hydrants and other service connections are to be indicated on the new construction plans of the contract drawings. The plan should show locations of Gate valves and their end-configurations. Hydrants should be shown on the plan, with type noted. Valves should be shown on the plan, with type noted. Air release valve and air/vacuum valve locations should be shown on the plan and labeled. The location of service connections should be shown on the plan, with size noted.

441.9.1.2 Trench Fill Material Typical cross-sections must be included in the contract drawings, giving dimensions of frost depth, slope of tapers and depth of fill material layers. If special conditions for bedding, cover, embedment or backfill materials are required, the appropriate dimensions must be shown. Reinstatement A typical section, traditionally known as "trench reinstatement," must be shown on the contract plans. The drawing shall include bedding and backfill up to subgrade. Above subgrade, the drawing should specify the types and depths of granular and pavement courses necessary to achieve roadbed integrity. If no highway pavement resurfacing is to take place in the area of the reinstatement, all reinstatement works should be noted for the contractor to include in his watermain tender item bid.

November 2016 Page 8 of 10 B441

Page 527: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

Special Foundation Treatment A detailed typical drawing and/or a modified OPSD will be necessary to show the depth of bedding and location if any special foundation treatment such as articulation, soil mixing, ground improvement, etc is required as noted in the foundation investigation and design report. Protection Systems When protection systems are required, the line of protection or a protection system shall be shown on the contract drawings depending on the magnitude of the protection required. Performance levels shall be included on the Contract Drawings. These are only approximate lengths or locations and it is up to the contractor to design, install and remove with actual lengths and locations defined.

441.9.2 Quantity Sheets ‘Watermains’ is a variation tender item. Each length of watermain pipe is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. Start and end chainage are provided in the Station to Station column. Lateral offset, left or right, is provided in the Location and Position column. Each column is to be labelled with a combination of watermain pipe size (diameter), type and class. The quantity (meters) is entered in the appropriate column ‘Valves’ is a variation tender item. Each Valve is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. The location chainage is provided in the Station column. Lateral offset, left or right, is provided in the Location and Position column. Each column is to be labelled with a combination of valve type, pressure, class and end connection. The unit quantity (1) is entered in the appropriate column. For cases where a valve box is required, the words “valve box” shall be entered in the “Reference” column. ‘Hydrant Sets’ is a variation tender item. Each Hydrant Set is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. The location chainage is provided in the Station column. Lateral offset is provided in the Location and Position column. Each column is to be labelled with the type of hydrant. The unit quantity (1) is entered in the appropriate column. ‘Service Connection Pipe’ is a variation tender item, for connection pipe size. Each length of service connection pipe is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. The start chainage is provided in the Station to Station column. Lateral offset, left or right, is provided in the Location and Position column. Columns are labelled with the tender item name and the size of the pipe connection, typically 25 mm, 38 mm and 50 mm, as applicable. The quantity (meters) is entered in the column

November 2016 Page 9 of 10 B441

Page 528: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERMAINS

‘Service Connection Appurtenance Sets’ is a normal tender item. Each Service Connection Appurtenance is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. The location chainage is provided in the Station column. Lateral offset is provided in the Location and Position column. One column is to be labelled with the tender item name. The unit quantity (1) is entered in the column. Any additional notes required may be entered in the References column. ‘Connections to Existing Watermains’ is a normal tender item. Each Connection to Existing Watermains is entered in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet. The chainage is provided in the Station to Station column. Lateral offset, left or right, is provided in the Location and Position column. One Column is labelled with the tender item name.

441.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSP) The following information is required in a NSSP for Temporary Water Systems: - Temporary potable water supply systems connection requirements to buildings

other than single residential units. - Time requirements for restoring the temporary potable water system should it fail. - Temporary water services to buildings other than single residential units,

including flow to maintain fire protection systems. - Temporary hydrants and the necessary valves and fittings to be inserted and

maintained. Alignment and grade tolerances for watermain pipe installations should be provided as required in a NSSP. Other requirements to specify in an NSSP, if required, are: - Corrosion protection systems. - Tracer wire or tracer tape. - Special foundation treatment. - Protection systems.

November 2016 Page 10 of 10 B441

Page 529: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - GENERAL

February 2014 Page 1 of 3 B510-0

B510-0 - REMOVAL - OPSS 510 510-0.1 GENERAL

This section contains general information and applies to all removal tender items governed by OPSS 510. The term removal includes the removal and disposal or, the removal and salvage of materials. Removal tender items are grouped as follows and information pertaining specifically to their removal is found in the following chapters: 510-1 REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK - OPSS 510 510-2 REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK - OPSS 510 510-3 REMOVAL - FENCE AND NOISE BARRIERS WORK - OPSS 510 510-4 REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIER AND ENERGY

ATTENUATOR WORK - OPSS 510 510-5 REMOVAL - PAVEMENT WORK - OPSS 510 510-6 REMOVAL - CONCRETE WORK - OPSS 510 510-7 REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK - OPSS 510 510-8 REMOVAL - MISCELLANEOUS WORK This chapter should be read in conjunction with the above chapters. Information specific to removal tender items can be found in the chapters listed above.

510-0.2 REFERENCES

In general, the following project planning documents provide information on removals on detail design projects. These include but are not limited to: a) Preliminary Design Report b) Project Appraisal Report c) Highway Assessment Report d) Survey Notes d) Historical Drawings and Plans e) MTO Designated Substances Memorandum (pending)

510-0.3 TENDER ITEMS

Refer to subsection 510-X.3 TENDER ITEMS in each chapter for a list of removal tender items.

Page 530: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - GENERAL

February 2014 Page 2 of 3 B510-0

510-0.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work of demolition, salvage, removal and in-place abandonment of materials are contained in OPSS 510

510-0.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items.

510-0.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to provide such information to bidders. Refer to subsection 510-X.9 DOCUMENTATION in each Chapter B Section for information on determining whether an NSP is required.

510-0.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings that denote illustrations for symbolizing removal work on contract drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

510-0.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependant upon the specific project requirements as described in documents referenced in section 510-0.2 References. Refer to section 510-X.7 in each chapter for information on determining the use of specific removal tender items.

510-0.8 COMPUTATION All removal tender items with units-of-measure of m, m², m³ and each are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items. Lump Sum tender items are not PQP. Refer to section 510-X.8 in each chapter for information on the computation of removal tender items.

Page 531: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - GENERAL

February 2014 Page 3 of 3 B510-0

510-0.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-0.9.1 Contract Drawings

Removal drawings are to be included when required according to Directive PHY C-085. To indicate removal on drawings, apply cross out lines to the appropriate topography plan features. Refer to OPSD 100 series for examples on how to show various features for removal.

510-0.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Removal tender items are documented together on the "Quantities - Miscellaneous” sheet unless specified elsewhere. Detailed documentation instructions are outlined in Chapter 'F' of this manual. All removals shall be documented on the Quantity Sheets.

510-0.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Item specific information is documented in NSSPs, modified SSPs and fill-in SSPs. Use of NSSPs should be minimized, where possible. The use of existing contract documentation, including NSSPs that have been successfully used before, is usually preferable to drafting new NSSPs.

510-0.9.4 Documentation Accuracy Refer to sections 510-X.9 in each chapter for information on the documentation accuracy of removal tender items.

Page 532: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 533: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK

February 2014 Page 1 of 5 B510-1

B510-1 - REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK - OPSS 510 510-1.1 GENERAL

This section is for bridge work removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials.

510-1.2 REFERENCES

CDED B510-0 – Removal Structural Manual Bridge Office policy memos and guidelines Structural Design Report

510-1.3 TENDER ITEMS

Removal of Bridge Structure Removal of Bridge Footings Removal of Modular Bridge Removal of Modular Bridge Substructure

510-1.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of removing bridge work components are contained in OPSS 510.

510-1.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

510-1.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

Page 534: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK

February 2014 Page 2 of 5 B510-1

510-1.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

510-1.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependant upon the specific project requirements as described in Section 510-0.2 References.

510-1.7.1 Bridge Work Salvage Bridge material to be salvaged may be reused on the same contract or stockpiled for future use. Salvage requirements are to be specified in an NSSP and/or drawing as required.

510-1.7.2 Information to be Provided to Bidders

Information on bridges to be removed (eg..bridge drawings) are to be provided to bidders, if not included in the contract drawings. If existing drawings are not available for bidding purposes, consult with the MTO Regional Structural Section and Bridge Office.

510-1.8 COMPUTATION Some tender items have units of measure of LS/M, LS/M2, LS/M3 and LS/T. These are not PQP items and are mostly structural oriented. Quantities are provided for estimating purposes only. They are similar to lump-sum tender items but allow for tracking of unit prices on a length, area, volume or weight basis. In the tender document, the quantities for these items appear as 100% and the measured quantities do not appear.

a) Removal of Bridge Structures

This is a lump sum bid item. Concrete removal quantities are not shown on the "Quantities-Structures" sheet for this item. The structural designer will provide MTO Regional Planning and Design with removal volumes for submission to the MTO Estimating Office.

Page 535: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK

February 2014 Page 3 of 5 B510-1

b) Removal of Bridge Footings

This is a measured item (non-PQP). The unit of measure for this item is the cubic metre of concrete removed in the footings. This work also includes the cutting of any piles to the underside of the footings. The structural designer will provide concrete removal volumes to Planning and Design. Quantities may be calculated from field measurement, design cross-sections or contract drawings, etc.

c) Removal of Modular Bridges

This is a lump sum bid item. The existing bridge drawings for modular bridges, included with the bid documents, to be removed must specify the weight, in tonnes, of the modular bridge including its ramps, sidewalks and the launching nose.

d) Removal of Modular Bridge Substructures

This is a lump sum bid item. An estimate of all removals should be prepared on a "Complementary Summary Sheet for Tender Estimate” and provided to MTO Regional Planning and Design. This information should be forwarded to the MTO Estimating Office.

510-1.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-1.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9.1 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: N/A

510-1.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9.2 for general documentation information These items are documented on a Quantities – Structure sheet. The bridge name, site number, station limits, and offset from roadway centreline should be shown for each structure site.

Page 536: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK

February 2014 Page 4 of 5 B510-1

As applicable to the tender item, provide a line entry in the Q-sheet for each removal. Separate tender items should not be combined on one line of the Q-sheet. Information specific to each tender item is as follows. a) Removal of Bridge Structures

The '100%' reference is entered in the "Total" line and "Lump Sum" is entered in the "Unit" line on the Quantity sheet.

b) Removal of Bridge Footings

Individual entries are totalled to form the tender quantity which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

c) Removal of Modular Bridge

The '100%' reference is entered in the "Total" line and "Lump Sum" is entered in the "Unit" line on the Quantity sheet. The weight of the modular bridge is specified.

d) Removal of Modular Bridge Substructure

The '100%' reference is entered in the "Total" line and "Lump Sum" is entered in the "Unit" line on the Quantity sheet.

510-1.9.3 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions or other pertinent information. a) Salvage

When salvage requirements are known, the designer shall provide the following information in an NSP:

i) The type and quantity of material that is to be salvaged which is surplus to the

contract requirements. ii) Any requirements for restraining and protecting the salvaged material during

transport. ii) The salvage/stockpile site and any requirements to protect the stockpiled

material during storage. iii) Details on the re-use of acceptable salvageable materials, if any, on the

contract.

Page 537: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - BRIDGE WORK

February 2014 Page 5 of 5 B510-1

For more complex salvaging, drawing details may be required. Modular bridge structures are specified to be salvaged. If the structure or a portion of the structure is not to be salvaged, a non-standard special provision is required to override the specification requirement. b) Removal of Modular Bridge c) Removal of Modular Bridge Substructure

When existing Modular Bridge/ Modular Bridge Substructure drawings are not available, then a non-standard special provision or a drawing must be prepared documenting:

i) The type and length of the Modular Bridge; ii) Details of the Modular Bridge Substructure; iii) The modular bridge substructure components to be removed; iv) The elevation below river bed or final grade to which substructure is to be

removed.

510-1.9.4 Documentation Accuracy a) Removal of Bridge Structures b) Removal of Bridge Footings c) Removal of Temporary Modular Bridge d) Removal of Temporary Modular Bridge Substructures Stations and offsets are shown in whole number metres. Volumes when required are shown in whole number cubic metres. Modular Bridge tonnages are shown to one decimal accuracy.

Page 538: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 539: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

B510-2 - REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK - OPSS 510 510-2.1 GENERAL

This section is for drainage work removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials.

510-2.2 REFERENCES CDED B510-0 - Removal

510-2.3 TENDER ITEMS Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter (variation, m, PQP) Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter (variation, m, PQP) Removal of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers (normal, each, PQP) Abandonment of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers, Partial-Depth (variation, each, PQP) Capping of Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers (normal, each, PQP) Removal of Pipes and Culverts (variation, m, PQP) Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts (normal, m, PQP) Removal of Pipe Subdrains (normal, m, PQP) Removal of Hydrants (normal, each, PQP) Removal of Valves (normal, each, PQP) Removal of Watermain Appurtenances (normal, each, PQP)

510-2.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of removing drainage components are contained in OPSS 510.

510-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

October 2016 Page 1 of 8 B510-2

Page 540: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

510-2.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

510-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 and 700 series.

510-2.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependent upon the specific project requirements as described in Section 510-0.2 References.

510-2.7.1 Drainage Work Removals a) Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter

The above items include the removal of concrete, or asphalt curb, gutter, curb and gutter, gutter setbacks, bullnoses, gutter outlets and spillways.

b) Removal of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs

If imported granular is required to be used to backfill the excavation it shall be included in the tender quantity for the appropriate roadway granular item. When these structures are removed, the existing connecting sewer(s) or other conduit(s) should also be removed unless they are designated to be abandoned, extended or reconnected.

c) Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth If imported granular is required to be used to backfill the excavation it shall be included in the tender quantity for the appropriate roadway granular item.

d) Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs This item is used when existing utility systems intersecting these structures are to remain functional but the structures are no longer required. The dimensions of the concrete cap including reinforcement details shall be shown on the contract drawings.

October 2016 Page 2 of 8 B510-2

Page 541: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

e) Removal of Pipes and Culverts

This item includes removal of existing pipes or culverts with a diameter of 200 mm and greater as well as timber culverts. Pipes less than 200 mm in diameter are removed as part of the tender item for Earth Excavation, Grading when located within the excavation limits. These pipes shall be symbolized on the contract drawings including the type of pipe. If pipes less than 200 mm in diameter require removal but are located outside excavation limits, then they shall be included in the tender quantity for the item "Removal of Pipes and Culverts". Usually small diameter pipes (<200 mm) providing no drainage purpose are abandoned and plugged and noted as such on the plans. This item is used for the removal of circular concrete pipe. The Removal of Concrete item (see CDED B510-6) is used for the removal of concrete box and open footing culverts.

f) Removal of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Removal of Pipes and Culverts For the above items, the removal of asphaltic or concrete pavements, curbs, curb and gutters and sidewalks required to facilitate the removal or partial removal of maintenance holes, catch basins, ditch inlets, valve chambers, pipe, culverts, sewers, watermains and other utilities, will be included in the price bid for the appropriate tender item for removal of the under pavement component. Where however, there are separate tender items for removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk which overlaps the removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk necessary to remove the under pavement components, then payment for the removal of the surface feature will be made under the appropriate tender item(s) for removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk.

510-2.8 COMPUTATION

Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter Removal of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Removal of Pipes and Culverts Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts

October 2016 Page 3 of 8 B510-2

Page 542: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

Removal of Pipe Subdrains Removal of Hydrants Removal of Valves Removal of Watermain Appurtenances These are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items.

510-2.8.1 Sources of Information The main sources of information for these items are Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books, and Contour plans.

510-2.8.2 Method of Calculation a) Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter

Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter For removal of curb and gutter, no deductions are to be made for existing setbacks, gutter outlets or for the spaces occupied by maintenance holes and catch basins frames and grates located within the system. It is not necessary to differentiate between straight and circular curb and gutter. Where runs of curb and gutter converge to form bullnoses then each run will be measured. At bullnoses, removal of the concrete fillet is included for payment for removal of the curb and gutter. Where asphalt curb and gutter is located adjacent to roadway pavement, then asphalt curb and gutter area will be included with pavement removal area and will not be included under the asphalt curb and gutter removal item. The unit of measurement is the linear distance in metres.

b) Removal of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Removal of Hydrants Removal of Valves Removal of Watermain Appurtenances The unit of measurement for removal of these structures is each.

c) Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth The unit of measurement for abandonment of these structures is each.

d) Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs The unit of measurement for the number of structures capped is each.

October 2016 Page 4 of 8 B510-2

Page 543: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

e) Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts Removal of Pipes and Culverts The unit of measurement is by the linear metre, measured horizontally for the abandonment / removal of pipes and culverts. No deduction in length is made for spaces occupied by intermediate maintenance holes, catch basins, ditch inlets or valve chambers. Where the grade of the pipe or culvert is 10% or greater, the measurement shall be along its slope length.

f) Removal of Pipe Subdrains The unit of measurement is by the linear metre measured horizontally for the amount of pipe subdrain to be removed.

510-2.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-2.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs

The dimensions of the tops of each structure to be capped including reinforcement details shall be shown on the contract drawings in chart form etc. in order for bidders to determine the concrete and reinforcement requirements. The contract drawings shall identify the type of structures requiring a concrete cap (i.e., MH, CB, DI or VC) and their horizontal dimensions.

b) Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth The contract drawings shall identify the type of structures to be partially removed (i.e., MH, CB, DI or VC) and their partial removal depth when located beyond the roadway.

c) Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts The type of pipe (CSP, concrete, clay, asbestos, cast iron, plastic, timber, etc) and their diameters are shown on the contract drawings, in order to determine opening sizes requiring filling.

d) Removal of Pipes and Culverts The type of pipe (CSP, concrete, clay, asbestos, cast iron, plastic, timber, etc) and their diameters are shown on the contract drawings.

October 2016 Page 5 of 8 B510-2

Page 544: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

510-2.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter

Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter All curb and gutter removals are documented by station to station locations and offset from the roadway centreline on the Quantity sheets. The removal of asphalt and concrete curb and gutter systems are documented under their respective tender items in separate columns on the Quantity sheets. Concrete spillway removals will be included under the tender item - Removal of Concrete Curb and Gutter. Concrete spillway and concrete curb and gutter entries are shown in separate columns on the Quantity sheets. Asphalt spillway removals will be included under the tender item Removal of Asphalt Curb and Gutter. Asphalt spillway and asphalt curb and gutter entries are shown in separate columns on the Quantity sheets. The individual column entries are totalled and are transferred to the Form of Tender.

b) Removal of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth Capping of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs Each structure to be removed, abandoned or capped is documented by station location, and offset from the roadway centreline. Regardless of the type, size and depth of the structures to be removed, abandoned or capped they will be summarized under their respective tender items. Frames and grates which are to be salvaged and re-used on the same contract must be identified by means of an asterisk and a note on the removal Quantity sheet. The "Quantities - Drainage, Manholes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets " sheet will indicate where the frames and grates are to be re-used. The individual column entries are totalled and are transferred to the Form of Tender. Where excavations are to be backfilled with granular, then the quantities of granular shall be shown under the appropriate roadway granular item.

October 2016 Page 6 of 8 B510-2

Page 545: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

c) Abandonment of MHs, CBs, DIs and VCs, Partial-Depth The depth of partial removal shall be specified for the structures located beyond the roadway (variation item). Separate columns are to be used for variable partial removal depths.

d) Abandonment of Pipes and Culverts The station location and offset from the roadway centreline of pipe and/or culvert to be abandoned shall be shown on the Quantity sheets. The individual column entries are totalled and are transferred to the Form of Tender.

e) Removal of Pipes and Culverts The type of pipe/culvert is to be specified. The removal of pipes and culverts of different types are shown in separate columns on the Quantity sheet(s). Each pipe or culvert to be removed shall be identified by station location and offset from the roadway centreline. The individual column removal lengths are totalled, combined into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender. The removal of pipes and the removal of pipes for salvage are documented in the same columns. An asterisk is shown in the Sta-Sta column against the pipe(s) to be salvaged. A note "* To be Salvaged" is shown on the Quantity sheet.

f) Removal of Pipe Subdrains The removal of pipe subdrains is to be shown in separate columns on the Quantity sheet(s). Each length of pipe subdrains to be removed shall be identified by station location and offsets right and left of the roadway centreline. The individual column removal lengths are totalled, combined into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender.

g) Removal of Hydrants Removal of Valves Removal of Watermain Appurtenances The removal of hydrants and valves are documented by indicating the station location together with the designations right and left of the roadway centreline. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender. An asterisk is shown in the Sta-Sta column against the hydrants and/or valves to be salvaged. A note "* To be Salvaged" is shown on the Quantity sheet.

October 2016 Page 7 of 8 B510-2

Page 546: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - DRAINAGE WORK

510-2.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions When asphalt curb and gutter has been included in the Removal of Asphalt Pavement tender item, a non-standard special provision is required stating that payment for removal of asphalt curb and gutter adjacent to roadway pavement removal is included in the Removal of Asphalt Pavement item. A non-standard special provision containing details for the salvage of drainage related materials shall be included when required. Frames, grates or covers, watermain appurtenances, cut stone curb, and hydrants are specified to be salvaged. If any of these materials are not to be salvaged, a non-standard special provision is required to override the specification requirement.

510-2.9.4 Documentation Accuracy Stations and individual quantity entries are shown to the nearest whole number metres. Offsets are recorded to 0.1 metre accuracy.

October 2016 Page 8 of 8 B510-2

Page 547: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - FENCE AND NOISE BARRIER WORK

February 2014 Page 1 of 4 B510-3

B510-3 - REMOVAL -FENCE AND NOISE BARRIER WORK - OPSS 510 510-3.1 GENERAL

This section is for fence and noise barrier removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials.

510-3.2 REFERENCES CDED B510-0 - Removal 510-3.3 TENDER ITEMS

Removal of Fence Removal of Noise Barrier

510-3.4 SPECIFICATIONS

Details of removing fence and noise barrier are contained in OPSS 510.

510-3.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

510-3.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

510-3.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

Page 548: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - FENCE AND NOISE BARRIER WORK

February 2014 Page 2 of 4 B510-3

510-3.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependant upon the specific project requirements as described in CDED B510-0.2 References.

510-3.7.1 Fence and Noise Barrier Work Removals

Fencing and noise barrier components in a re-usable condition should be considered for salvage. Only the noise barrier panels and fire hose access unit components may be salvaged from noise barrier systems.

Noise barrier panels and fire hose access units that are salvaged are reused preferably on the same contract. A pre-inspection of the condition and the number of panels to be salvaged is necessary. Salvaged materials may be:

i) Re-used preferably on the same contract ii) Stockpiled at a location designated by the Ministry

a) Removal of Fence

The work under this item includes the complete removal of all fences regardless of type. Cross fence removal shall not extend beyond the right of way limit.

b) Removal of Noise Barriers

The work under this item includes the removal of all noise barriers regardless of type. Footings are removed to a depth of 1.3 m only.

510-3.8 COMPUTATION a) Removal of Fence b) Removal of Noise Barriers

These are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items. The unit of measure is the linear distance in metres.

510-3.8.1 Sources of Information

The main sources of information for these items are Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books, Contour plans, and Contract Drawings.

Page 549: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - FENCE AND NOISE BARRIER WORK

February 2014 Page 3 of 4 B510-3

510-3.8.2 Method of Calculation a) Removal of Fence

The removal of fencing is measured horizontally in metres along the centreline of the installation to be removed, with no deduction for spaces occupied by gates. Measurement will not be made across openings not occupied by gates.

b) Removal of Noise Barriers

The removal of noise barrier is measured in metres from end to end of each installation.

510-3.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-3.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information.

510-3.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Removal of Fence

The removal of fence is documented by station to station limits and offsets right and left of the roadway centreline. The removal of cross fences is documented to the right of way limit. The type of fence is specified. Each type of fence is to be shown in a separate column. The individual column removal lengths are totalled, combined into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender.

b) Removal of Noise Barrier

The removal of noise barrier is documented by station to station limits and offsets right and left of the roadway centreline. The barrier panel material type and support (Ground Mounted, Structure Mounted, Barrier Mounted) shall be identified at the top of the column. Examples of material type are Concrete Panel, Steel Panel, Wood Panel, Fibreglas Panel. Separate columns are required for each material type and support.

Page 550: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - FENCE AND NOISE BARRIER WORK

February 2014 Page 4 of 4 B510-3

The individual column removal lengths are totalled, combined into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender.

510-3.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions

A non-standard special provision required to specify re-use of salvaged components on a specific project or to have work completed other than described in the specification.

510-3.9.4 Documentation Accuracy

Stations and individual quantity entries are shown to the nearest whole number metres. Offsets are recorded to 0.1 metre accuracy.

Page 551: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

B510-4 - REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK - OPSS 510

510-4.1 GENERAL This section is for delineator, traffic barrier and energy attenuator removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials.

510-4.2 REFERENCES CDED B510-0 - Removal

510-4.3 TENDER ITEMS Removal of Delineator Posts Removal of Cable Guide Rail Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier Removal of Anchor Blocks Removal of Concrete Barrier Removal of Energy Attenuators Removal of Ramp Closure Gates

510-4.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of removing delineator, traffic barrier and energy attenuator are contained in OPSS 510.

510-4.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

November 2014 Page 1 of 9 B510-4

Page 552: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

510-4.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

510-4.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

510-4.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependent upon the specific project requirements as described in CDED B510-0.2 References.

510-4.7.1 Salvage Barrier rails, channels and guide rail cable in re-usable condition should be considered for salvage. Salvaging of anchor blocks is to be considered based on the need for reuse on a specific contract. Only precast anchor blocks should be considered for salvage. Salvaging of energy attenuators in full or in part will depend on the type of system installed and the condition of the individual units. Since these systems are costly, any reusable components should be considered. Concrete pads and back walls associated with the attenuators and end treatments are not salvageable. Modules should be inspected for ultra-violet sunlight deterioration prior to considering salvage. Precast concrete barrier shall only be salvaged when they have connection systems currently approved for use. Salvaged materials may be: a) Re-used on the same contract b) Stockpiled at a location designated by the Ministry

510-4.7.2 Removal a) Removal of Delineator Posts

The work under this item includes the removal of either delineator or guide posts. These posts can be wood, metal or flexible.

November 2014 Page 2 of 9 B510-4

Page 553: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

b) Removal of Cable Guide Rail

The work under this item includes the removal of systems regardless of the number of cables exclusive of anchor blocks.

c) Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail

The work under this item includes systems with single or double rails with and without channel.

d) Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier

The work under this item includes steel box beam median barriers and steel box beam guide rail systems, exclusive of anchor blocks.

e) Removal of Anchor Blocks

The work under this item includes the removal of concrete anchor blocks associated with cable guide rail and steel box beam barrier systems when they require removal or relocation.

f) Removal of Concrete Barrier

The work under this item includes permanent concrete barrier which can consist of cast in place or precast barrier and the associated concrete pad as specified. This item also includes removal of temporary concrete barrier left in place from a previous contract which is not suitable for reuse. This item also includes removal of any concrete backfill between back to back barrier at bridge piers as well as barrier transitions. Removal of asphalt surfacing over granular fill, between back to back barriers will be included under its respective item. If the precast concrete barrier meets the connection requirements for reuse on future projects, then a non-standard tender item for, "Removal and Salvage of Temporary Concrete Barrier", should be requested.

g) Removal of Energy Attenuators

Energy attenuators for removal may include the following: Crash Cushions:

- Inertial Barrier Modules

November 2014 Page 3 of 9 B510-4

Page 554: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

- GREAT System - Connecticut Impact Attenuation System (CIAS) - Hi-dro System - Trend End Treatment - REACT 350 - Quadguard System - Quadguard Wide System - Quadguard Extra Wide System - TAU-II System - TAU-II Wide System - TAU-II Extra Wide System - Smart System - QuadTrend System - Box Beam Bursting Energy Absorbing Terminal System (BB-BEAT)

Steel Beam Guide Rail End Terminals:

- Crash-Cushion Attenuating Terminal (CAT-350) System - Extruder Terminal System - Sequential Kinking Terminal System - X-Lite Tangent Terminal System - Eccentric Loader

The work under this item includes the removal of the complete systems including all hardware, concrete pads, backwalls as well as anchoring devices, and associated anchoring devices.

h) Removal of Ramp Closure Gates

The work under this item includes concrete footings, gates, signs and all associated hardware.

510-4.8 COMPUTATION Removal of Delineator Posts Removal of Cable Guide Rail Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier Removal of Anchor Blocks Removal of Concrete Barrier Removal of Energy Attenuators Removal of Ramp Closure Gates

These are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items.

November 2014 Page 4 of 9 B510-4

Page 555: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

510-4.8.1 Sources of Information

The main sources of information for these items are Field Note Books, B-Plans, ETR Books, and Contour plans.

510-4.8.2 Method of Calculation

a) Removal of Delineator Posts

The unit of measurement for the removal of delineator posts is each. b) Removal of Cable Guide Rail

Cable guide rail removal is measured horizontally in metres along the centreline of the feature from centre to centre of end anchor blocks with no additional measurement made for overlapping lengths at intermediate anchor blocks.

c) Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail

The unit of measurement for the removal of steel beam guide rail, temporary transition rails not associated with temporary CATS, transition rails between permanent CATS and concrete barriers, and temporary transitions to existing rigid structures, is by the metre, measured horizontally along the centreline of the feature from end to end of terminal tips.

d) Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier

The unit of measurement for the removal of steel box beam barrier and rail connections to temporary concrete barrier, is measured horizontally in metres along the centreline of the feature from centre to centre of end anchor blocks with no additional measurement made for overlapping lengths at intermediate anchor blocks.

e) Removal of Anchor Blocks

The unit of measurement for the removal of anchor blocks is each. f) Removal of Concrete Barrier

The unit of measurement for removal of concrete barrier is by the metre, measured horizontally along the centreline of the barrier from end to end of the installation and/or end treatments. No deductions shall be made for lengths occupied by lighting pole footings and overhead sign structure footings. The

November 2014 Page 5 of 9 B510-4

Page 556: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

removal of two back to back type B or E1 barriers will be treated as a single installation for measurement purposes, and are only measured once.

g) Removal of Energy Attenuators

The unit of measurement for the removal of energy attenuators is each.

510-4.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-4.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Removal of Energy Attenuators

The following must also be shown for bidder information in tabular form on the plans:

- The number of Fitch or Energite modules to be removed at each location. - The number of bays at each GREAT location to be removed. - The number of steel cylinders including reinforced concrete backwall,

with/without reinforced concrete pad, at each CIAS location to be removed. - The number of bays including reinforced concrete pad and backwall at each

Hi-Dro system location to be removed, etc. - Removal of concrete pad and anchor block in conjunction with Trend End

Treatments.

510-4.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Removal of Delineator Posts

The removal of delineator posts are documented by indicating the station to station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline. The type of posts (i.e., wood, steel, or flexible) is specified, with the quantity of each type documented in separate columns. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total and are transferred to Form of Tender.

November 2014 Page 6 of 9 B510-4

Page 557: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

b) Removal of Cable Guide Rail

Individual removal lengths are documented by station to station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline. Separate columns are to be used to identify and document the length of 1, 3, and 6 cable systems to be removed. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

c) Removal of Steel Beam Guide Rail d) Removal of Steel Box Beam Barrier

The individual removal lengths are documented by station to station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline. The number of rails (single rail, double rail) and the presence of a channel (with channel, without channel) is specified. Each variation is shown in separate columns. Steel box beam guide rails and steel box beam median barriers are documented in the same column. Steel beam guide rail and box beam guide rail sections used as temporary transition rails joining concrete barrier to temporary concrete barrier (TCB), steel beam guide rail to TCB, box beam guide rail to TCB, and temporary transitions connecting TCB to bridge barrier wall shall be documented in a separate column. The individual column entries are totalled and combined into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender.

e) Removal of Anchor Blocks

The removal of anchor blocks is documented by indicating the station location with the designation right and left of the roadway centreline. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

f) Removal of Concrete Barrier

The individual removal lengths are documented by station to station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline.

November 2014 Page 7 of 9 B510-4

Page 558: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

The type of concrete barrier to be removed is identified by item variation. Example types include:

- Cast In-Place - Precast - Back to Back - Back to Back, Granular Filled - Back to Back, Concrete Filled - Transition

Quantities of each type are detailed in separate columns. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total, which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

g) Removal of Energy Attenuators

The removal of energy attenuators are documented by indicating the station to station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline. Each type of attenuator system is identified in separate columns on the Quantity Sheet. The number of each complete type of energy attenuator system to be removed is documented at each location on the Quantity sheet. The salvage of energy attenuators is documented in the same columns. An asterisk is shown against the attenuators to be salvaged with a note "* To be Salvaged" on the Quantity sheet. The individual column entries are totalled and combined into the tender total, which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

h) Removal of Ramp Closure Gates

The removal of ramp closure gates is documented by station limits with the designation right or left of the roadway centreline. The individual column entries are totalled and combined into the tender total, which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

510-4.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions

A NSSP is required to specify salvage requirements or to have work completed other than described in the specification.

November 2014 Page 8 of 9 B510-4

Page 559: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

REMOVAL - DELINEATORS, TRAFFIC BARRIERS DETAIL ESTIMATING AND ENERGY ATTENUATOR WORK

Precast concrete barrier and ramp closure gates are specified to be salvaged. If the materials are not to be salvaged, a non-standard special provision is required to override the specification requirement. The re-use of salvaged material and/or the delivery location is specified by non-standard special provision.

510-4.9.4 Documentation Accuracy

Stations and individual quantity entries are shown to the nearest whole number metres.

November 2014 Page 9 of 9 B510-4

Page 560: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 561: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 1 of 8 B510-5

B510-5 – REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK – OPSS 510 510-5.1 GENERAL

This section is for Pavement Work removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal of materials.

510-5.2 REFERENCES CDED B510-0 - Removal CDED B399-2 - Reclaim Asphalt Pavement

510-5.3 TENDER ITEMS Cutting Existing Pavement Removal of Asphalt Pavement Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces Removal of Asphalt - Treated Base Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures Removal of Concrete Pavement Removal of Cement - Treated Base Removal of Concrete Base Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth

510-5.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of removing pavement, both asphalt and concrete, are contained in OPSS 510.

510-5.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

510-5.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

Page 562: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 2 of 8 B510-5

510-5.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

510-5.7 DESIGN

Removals required are dependent upon the specific project requirements as described in CDED B510-0.2 References.

510-5.7.1 Pavement Work Removals

a) General

The removal of asphaltic or concrete pavement, concrete or cement treated base specifically required to facilitate removal or partial removal of maintenance holes, catch basins, ditch inlets, valve chambers, pipe culverts, sewers, watermains and other utilities will be included in the price bid for the applicable tender item for removal of the under pavement component. Where however there is a separate tender item for removal of pavement or base which overlaps the removal of pavement or base necessary to remove the aforementioned sub-surface structures, then payment will be made under the applicable tender item(s) for pavement and base removal. When the granular and/or subgrade material underlying the pavement is being excavated as part of the Earth Excavation, Grading item, the pavement is included in both the earth excavation volume (m³) and the appropriate removal of pavement item(s) (m²).

b) Cutting Existing Pavement

This item is used when it is necessary to construct a straight and vertical cut in asphalt or concrete pavement in order to produce a clean edge on the pavement to be left in place when the formation of joints is not addressed elsewhere in the contract documents.

Cutting existing asphalt pavement is necessary to:

i) Remove existing pavement in order to remove or place an underground utility,

culvert or duct where the existing road is not being resurfaced; ii) Remove existing pavement in order to construct new curb and gutter within

the existing paved surface which is not being resurfaced; iii) Remove an existing pavement lane or taper;

Page 563: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 3 of 8 B510-5

iv) Reduce the existing pavement width.

Cutting is always required when removing portions of concrete pavement, asphalt covered concrete pavement and concrete or cement treated base.

c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement

This work includes full depth asphalt pavement removal and asphalt sidewalk removal whether on the roadway surface or encountered within an excavation. This item also includes: i) Removal of asphalt pavement that has been resurfaced with surface treatment

or other thin treatment. ii) Removal of prime, surface treatment, and mulch pavement over 50 mm in

depth over granular surfaces. Prime, surface treatment, and mulch pavement 50 mm or less in depth over granular surfaces do not qualify for payment under this item, but are included for payment under the earth excavation item if their removal is necessary. Note: Mulch is a historical cold mix pavement material produced from Granular A and cutback or emulsified asphalt. This item does not include pavement removal areas for jointing required as part of the paving operation under OPSS 313.

d) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces

This work includes the removal of asphalt pavement from concrete surfaces on roadways.

e) Removal of Concrete Pavement Removal of Concrete Base Removal of Cement Treated Base

These items include removals of full depth concrete pavement, concrete pavement that is surfaced with asphalt, concrete base, concrete ripple strip and cement treated base, whether on the roadway surface or encountered within an excavation. The removal of asphalt pavement from concrete surfaces is not part of the item.

Page 564: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 4 of 8 B510-5

f) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base

This work includes removal of full depth asphalt treated base whether on roadway surface or encountered within an excavation.

g) Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth

This work includes the removal of asphalt or concrete pavement to a partial depth as specified in the contract. This work is done when the existing asphalt pavement depth is at least 65 mm or greater in depth, and a minimum depth of 40 mm will remain in place.

h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

This item includes the removal of asphalt pavement and waterproofing from concrete surfaces on bridge decks. The depths and limits of asphalt removal as well as the presence of waterproofing will be detailed on the contract plans. When the entire bridge deck is being removed, the work of asphalt removal from the bridge deck should not be included with the concrete bridge deck removal item.

510-5.8 COMPUTATION

a) Cutting Existing Pavement b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces d) Removal of Concrete Pavement e) Removal of Concrete Base f) Removal of Cement Treated Base g) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement Partial Depth i) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth j) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

These are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items.

510-5.8.1 Sources of Information

a) Cutting Existing Pavement b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces d) Removal of Concrete Pavement

Page 565: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 5 of 8 B510-5

e) Removal of Concrete Base f) Removal of Cement Treated Base g) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement Partial Depth i) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth j) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

The main sources of information are field note books, B-plans, Pavement Design Report, Soils Profile, Bore Hole data, and Core Logs.

510-5.8.2 Method of Calculation

a) Cutting Existing Pavement

The unit of measurement for this item is the metre measured horizontally. The quantity is computed by scaling or chainage as applicable along the sawcut from the design drawings.

b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces d) Removal of Concrete Pavement e) Removal of Concrete Base f) Removal of Cement Treated Base g) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth i) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth j) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

The unit of measurement for the removal of pavement structures is in square metres based on horizontal measure. Deductions will not be made from the area occupied by maintenance holes, catch basins, or valve chambers lying within the pavement removal limits. The removal areas are determined from cross sections, plans and profiles. Full depth pavement removals will be measured whether removed from the roadway surface or encountered within an excavation. The removal of pavement from the roadway surface and buried pavement is quantified separately.

510-5.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-5.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to each tender item is as follows:

Page 566: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 6 of 8 B510-5

a) Cutting Existing Pavement

Complex cutting situations should be detailed on contract drawings. b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces d) Removal of Concrete Pavement e) Removal of Concrete Base f) Removal of Cement Treated Base g) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth i) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth j) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

Show the pavement removal work on plans according to OPSD 100 series. For removal work not included in the OPSD 100 series, a legend designating the work must be included on the first removal plan sheet. The partial depth removal of asphalt and concrete pavement should be detailed in typical sections in the contract drawings. Temporary ramping at daily shutdown is required with partial depth removal of asphalt pavement work. Include typical sections in the drawings to show temporary longitudinal and transverse ramps and applicable dimensions.

510-5.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Work locations are documented by station to station limits and offsets right or left of the roadway centreline on a Miscellaneous Quantity sheet. Removal of different pavement depths and/or type is documented in separate columns. Partial depth removal of different depths is documented in separate columns. The removal of buried asphalt or concrete is documented in separate columns regardless of type or composition. Depth may be specified as a single value or a range. The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

Page 567: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 7 of 8 B510-5

510-5.9.2.1 Variation Items Information specific to each tender item is as follows: a) Cutting Existing Pavement

The pavement depth and type (reinforced concrete, unreinforced concrete, or asphalt) is specified.

b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement

The pavement depth and location (pvm’t, sidewalk, buried pvm’t) is specified. Pvm’t refers to pavement at the surface.

c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces

The pavement depth is specified. d) Removal of Concrete Pavement

The pavement depth and type (reinforced concrete, unreinforced concrete, or asphalt surfaced concrete) is specified.

e) Removal of Concrete Base

The base depth and type (reinforced or unreinforced) is specified. f) Removal of Cement Treated Base

The base depth is specified. g) Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth

The average depth of removal is specified. h) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth

The average depth of removal is specified.

510-5.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions NSSP is required for the following:

- when salvage/stockpiling/re-use of removed pavement materials is required or to have work completed other than described in the specification.

Page 568: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL-PAVEMENT WORK

April 2014 Page 8 of 8 B510-5

- to preclude or further limit the weight of milling equipment from that specified in OPSS 510, used to remove asphalt from bridge decks if this is a concern.

- to specify the location of drainage cuts in shoulder asphalt, when only the

pavement in the traffic lane(s) is being partial depth removed

- to specify the size of reinforcement in concrete, when the concrete is to be sawcut.

510-5.9.4 Documentation Accuracy

Depths are recorded to the nearest 5 mm.

a) Cutting Existing Pavement

Station locations are recorded in 0.1 m accuracy. Offsets are recorded in 0.01 m, 0.1 m or whole numbers depending on the nature of the work. Individual lengths are entered in whole number metres on the Quantity Sheets.

b) Removal of Asphalt Pavement c) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces d) Removal of Concrete Pavement e) Removal of Concrete Base f) Removal of Cement Treated Base g) Removal of Asphalt Treated Base h) Removal of Asphalt Pavement, Partial Depth i) Removal of Concrete Pavement, Partial Depth j) Removal of Asphalt Pavement from Concrete Surfaces on Structures

For the above items, stations are recorded to the nearest whole number metre. Offsets are recorded in 0.1 m accuracy. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number square metres.

Page 569: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - CONCRETE WORK

B510-6 - REMOVAL - CONCRETE WORK - OPSS 510 510-6.1 GENERAL

This section is for Concrete Work removal tender items. The work covered by this tender item includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials for retaining walls, footings (other than bridge footings), foundations, concrete culverts including associated wingwalls and retaining walls, concrete appurtenances and similar concrete structures as specified. The Removal of Pipes and Culverts item (see CDED B510-2) is used for the removal of concrete pipe culverts.

510-6.2 REFERENCES CDED B510-0 - Removal

510-6.3 TENDER ITEM Removal of Concrete (Normal, m3, PQP)

510-6.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of removing concrete are contained in OPSS 510.

510-6.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to this tender item. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

510-6.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs) Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

October 2016 Page 1 of 3 B510-6

Page 570: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - CONCRETE WORK

510-6.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

510-6.7 DESIGN Removals required are dependent upon the specific project requirements as described in CDED B510-0.2 References.

510-6.7.1 Concrete Removal Work

a) General The removal of asphalt or concrete pavements, curbs, curb and gutters and sidewalks specifically required to facilitate the removal or partial removal of concrete culverts and sewers will be included in the price bid for the Removal of Concrete tender item. Where however, there are separate tender items for removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk which overlaps the removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk necessary to remove the sub-surface structures, then payment for the removal of the surface feature will be made under the appropriate tender item(s) for removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk.

b) Removal of Concrete No excavation calculations are required for the removal of the items covered under Removal of Concrete. Voids remaining after removal of these components will be backfilled with native or imported material. If imported granular is required to be used to backfill the excavation it shall be included in the tender quantity for the appropriate roadway granular item.

510-6.8 COMPUTATION Removal of Concrete This is a Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) item

510-6.8.1 Sources of Information The main sources of information are existing Drawings and Plans.

October 2016 Page 2 of 3 B510-6

Page 571: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - CONCRETE WORK

510-6.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for this item is the cubic metre. Removal quantities are calculated using existing drawings, plans, and field measurements. If structure drawings are not available the computation will be completed using field measurements and the dimensions of standard concrete components (ie. culverts) of the same type and size.

510-6.9 DOCUMENTATION

510-6.9.1 Contract Drawings Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to this tender item is as follows: Detailed removal drawings of existing concrete culverts and other structures are required with the contract when the structure is to be partially removed to allow for modifications, such as an extension.

510-6.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets) Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to this tender item is as follows: The station or station limits, offset, and if available the structure name should be specified for ease of reference for each structure to be removed. Individual removal quantities are totalled into the tender total and transferred to the Form of Tender.

510-6.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions A non-standard special provision may be required to include such details as limits of removals, saw cuts at removal limits when only a portion of structure is to be removed, removal restrictions or any other pertinent details related to the removal operation.

510-6.9.4 Documentation Accuracy Concrete quantity entries are recorded to the nearest cubic metre. Stations are recorded in whole number metre. Offsets are recorded in 0.1 m or whole numbers depending on the nature of the work.

October 2016 Page 3 of 3 B510-6

Page 572: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 573: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK

February 2014 Page 1 of 4 B510-7

B510-7 - REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK - OPSS 510 510-7.1 GENERAL

This section is for Right of Way Work removal tender items. The work covered by these tender items includes the removal and disposal, or removal and salvage of materials typically found within the highway right of way and not covered elsewhere.

510-7.2 REFERENCES

CDED B510-0 - Removal

510-7.3 TENDER ITEMS

Removal of Concrete Sidewalk Removal of Sign Support Structure Removal of Sign Support Structure Footings Removal of Gabions

510-7.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of removing right of way items are contained in OPSS 510.

510-7.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

510-7.5.1 Non-Standard Special Provisions (NSSPs)

Some removal operations may have their own specific requirements, in which case a non-standard special provision may be required to include such information as, limits of removal, removal restrictions, salvage/stockpiling, or other pertinent information.

510-7.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are in the OPSD 100 series.

Page 574: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK

February 2014 Page 2 of 4 B510-7

510-7.7 DESIGN

Removals required are dependant upon the specific project requirements as described in CDED B510-0.2 References.

510.7.7.1 Salvage

Overhead sign support structures and signs are specified to be salvaged. A pre-inspection of the condition of these structures is necessary. Salvaged materials may be: i) Re-used preferably on the same contract ii) Stockpiled at a location designated by the Ministry

510-7.7.2 Removal of Concrete Sidewalk This work includes the removal of concrete sidewalk to the limits specified on the contract drawings. The removal of concrete sidewalk specifically required to facilitate removal or partial removal of maintenance holes, catch basins, ditch inlets, valve chambers, pipe culverts, sewers, watermains and other utilities will be included in the price bid for the applicable tender item for removal of the under pavement component. Where however there is a separate tender item for removal of concrete sidewalk which overlaps the removal of pavement or base necessary to remove the aforementioned sub-surface structures, then payment will be made under the tender item(s) for concrete sidewalk removal.

510-7.8 COMPUTATION

a) Removal of Concrete Sidewalk b) Removal of Sign Support Structures c) Removal of Sign Support Footings d) Removal of Gabions

These are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items.

510-7.8.1 Sources of Information

The main sources of information are: a) Existing Plans and Drawings b) Regional Structural Section.

Page 575: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK

February 2014 Page 3 of 4 B510-7

510-7.8.2 Method of Calculation a) Removal of Concrete Sidewalk

The unit of measurement for the removal of concrete sidewalk is in square metres based on horizontal measure. Deductions will not be made from the area occupied by maintenance holes, catch basins, or valve chambers lying within the removal limits.

b) Removal of Sign Support Structures c) Removal of Sign Support Footings

The unit of measurement for these items is each. d) Removal of Gabions

The unit of measurement for the removal of gabions is by volume in cubic metres.

510-7.9 DOCUMENTATION 510-7.9.1 Contract Drawings

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information.

510-7.9.2 Quantity Sheets (Q-sheets)

Refer to 510-0.9 for general documentation information. Information specific to the tender items are as follows: a) Removal of Concrete Sidewalk

The station limits of the concrete sidewalk removal and the offsets right or left of the roadway centreline are specified.

a) Removal of Sign Support Structures b) Removal of Sign Support Footings

The station location of each sign support and footings as well as the offsets right or left of the roadway centreline should be specified. The number of footings at each sign support is entered as the quantity.

The sign supports and footings are summarized in separate columns.

Page 576: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - RIGHT OF WAY WORK

February 2014 Page 4 of 4 B510-7

c) Removal of Gabions

The station or station limits of the gabion removal and the offsets right or left of the roadway centreline are specified.

510-7.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions

A non-standard SP may be required to detail specific removal limits of overhead sign support structure footings. Overhead sign support structures and signs are specified to be salvaged. The re-use of the salvaged material or the delivery location is specified by non-standard special provision. If the materials are not to be salvaged, a non-standard special provision is required to override the specification requirement.

510-7.9.4 Documentation Accuracy a) Removal of Concrete Sidewalk

Stations are recorded to the nearest whole number metre. Offsets are recorded in 0.1 m accuracy. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number square metres.

b) Removal of Sign Support Structures c) Removal of Sign Support Footings

Stations and offsets are shown in whole number metres. d) Removal of Gabions

Stations and offsets are shown in whole number metres. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest 0.1 cubic metres.

Page 577: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - MISCELLANEOUS WORK

February 2014 Page 1 of 2 B510-8

B510-8 - REMOVAL - MISCELLANEOUS WORK 510-8.1 GENERAL

These tender items are generally required in order to facilitate the cleaning and coating of structural steel components on bridges prior to coating.

510-8.2 REFERENCES

Structural Steel Coating Manual. Regional Structural Section and Area Offices

510-8.3 TENDER ITEMS Removal and Reinstallation of Steel Handrails Removal and Reinstallation of Diaphragms Removal and Reinstallation of Railway Blast Deflection Plates Removal and Reinstallation of Appurtenances Removal of Appurtenances

510-8.4 SPECIFICATIONS - none 510-8.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

These items are all governed by non-standard special provisions. Samples can be found in the Structural Steel Coating Manual, Part 2.

510-8.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - none 510-8.7 DESIGN

Details as to when these tender items are to be used are found in the Structural Steel Coating Manual, Part 2.

510-8.8 COMPUTATION Computation details are found in the Structural Steel Coating Manual, Part 2 for each item.

Page 578: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REMOVAL - MISCELLANEOUS WORK

February 2014 Page 2 of 2 B510-8

510-8.9 DOCUMENTATION Documentation details are found in the Structural Steel Coating Manual, Part 2 for each item.

Page 579: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

B511 - RIP-RAP, ROCK PROTECTION AND GRANULAR SHEETING - OPSS 511 511.1 GENERAL Excavation for placing rip-rap, rock protection, and granular sheeting is part of each

individual tender item. 511.1.1 Rip-Rap Rip-rap is a special application of rock protection. It consists of rocks, broken rocks,

cobbles, stones, boulders or concrete debris placed together in a set and stable manner to a specified thickness for the protection of earth slopes and surfaces.

It is used in areas where erosion is a problem or anticipated, or where the appearance

of the placed rocks is an important factor. Areas of rip-rap applications may include:

a) Earth slopes b) Culvert and sewer ends c) Streambeds and slopes d) Ditches with gradients 5% and greater e) Around manholes, catch basins or ditch inlets constructed in ditches or on ditch

slopes. Rip-rap is commonly used in conjunction with a filter medium such as geotextile or

granular sheeting. These prevent loss of fines from beneath the rip-rap and subsequent collapse of the protection scheme. In some cases, more complex layered filter systems may be required, as recommended by the geotechnical or foundation staff on the project.

Rip-rap shall not be used in waterbodies if it contains concrete debris. Suitable

alternatives are available. Consult with the foundation, geotechnical, and environmental staff on the project as required.

511.1.2 Rock Protection Rock protection consists of broken rocks, rocks, cobbles, boulders and/or concrete

debris dumped or placed in random but stable manner.

April 2017 Page 1 of 6 B511

Page 580: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

The primary use of rock protection is to protect ditches and channels from erosion, including the banks and underwater portions.

Rock protection is laid to a specified depth and elevation and commonly placed in

conjunction with a filter medium. In waterbodies, rock protection shall only be used as required for the purpose of scour

protection for structures and shall not contain concrete debris. Suitable alternatives may be considered.

511.1.3 Granular Sheeting Granular sheeting consists of a surface layer of granular material which has to

conform to a specified gradation. It is used for erosion protection and also applied in areas of ground water seepage. The decision to include "Granular Sheeting" into the contract rests with the geotechnical and foundation staff on the project.

511.1.4 Geotextile Geotextile is a synthetic fabric. The primary function of this material is:

a) To separate two types of soils of different sizes and structures that would readily mix under the influence of load and water migration.

b) To filter or to hold back soil particles while allowing the passage of water. c) To drain or to ensure the rapid removal of moisture without buildup of hydrostatic

pressures. d) To reinforce, mainly by tensile strength of fabrics and their resistance to puncture

(burst), tear and shear forces.

The application of geotextile is designated by its:

a) Strength class (i.e. Class I or II) b) Fabric structure (woven or non-woven) c) Equivalent opening size d) Minimum nominal thickness

Geotextile may be used to act as a separator and filter between the rip-rap or rock protection and underlying material, depending on the existing soil conditions. The need for geotextiles should be assessed on a project-specific basis. Where the

April 2017 Page 2 of 6 B511

Page 581: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

OPSS 511 requirements for geotextile are not appropriate, the geotextile requirements shall be specified in the Contract Drawings or by Non-Standard Special Provision.

The decision to use geotextile is the responsibility of the geotechnical and foundation staff on the project.

A comprehensive write-up on the use of geotextiles is contained in the MTO publications "The Geotechnical Use of Filter Fabrics in Highway Construction" Report EM-13 and Engineering Geotextiles Report EM-45.

If surface conditions, on which geotextile will be placed, are such that it is not

possible to place the geotextile in a reasonably level manner (undulating ground or high water level) a levelling layer of approved material should be placed to provide a satisfactory surface. Geotextile placement below water and particularly in flowing water conditions can be difficult as the geotextile and rock materials placed on top of it may become dislodged and carried downstream during periods of high flow. Where these conditions exist, consult with the geotechnical and foundation staff on the project for suitable alternatives.

511.2 REFERENCES The Geotechnical Use of Filter Fabrics in Highway Construction - MTO Report

EM-13 Engineering Geotextiles, MTO Report EM-45 Structure Design Manual OPSS 1004 Aggregates - Miscellaneous 511.3 TENDER ITEMS Rip-Rap (Variation, m², PQP) Rock Protection (Normal, m³, PQP) Granular Sheeting (Normal, m², PQP) Geotextile (Variation, m², PQP) 511.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender items are covered by OPSS 511.

April 2017 Page 3 of 6 B511

Page 582: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

511.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review the applicable

special provisions. 511.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Rip-rap treatment with Geotextile for Ditch Inlet Manholes and for Sewer and Culvert

Outlets is identified on the standard drawings in the 800 series. There are no standard drawings available for rock protection and granular sheeting.

However, a typical application of rock protection is illustrated in the structural manual, drawing number SS16-20.

511.7 DESIGN - Not Used. 511.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. 511.8.1 Source of Information Construction recommendations for the above tender items are found in the

Geotechnical Report and Foundation Investigation and Design Report as administered by the Regional Geotechnical Section and the Foundations Office respectively.

The need for the application of geotextiles with any of the associated tender items

should be reviewed by the geotechnical and foundation staff on the project and should not be included automatically.

511.8.2 Method of Calculation Rip-Rap The unit of measurement for rip-rap is square metre. The areas recommended for

rip-rap are scaled from the plans. Slope measurements are to be scaled from cross-sections. The computation of the area is based on the width x length.

April 2017 Page 4 of 6 B511

Page 583: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

Rock Protection The unit of measurement for rock protection is cubic metre. The computation of the

volume for rock protection is based on the area (average width x length) x the recommended depth. Areas and slope measurements are scaled from cross sections.

Granular Sheeting The unit of measurement for granular sheeting is square metre. The depth of granular

to be applied, the depth of excavation required, and the possible use of geotextile are determined by the Regional Geotechnical Section and the Foundations Office.

Granular sheeting does not require compaction. Slope measurements are scaled from

cross-sections. Geotextile The unit of measurement for geotextile is square metre. Slope measurements are to

be scaled from cross-sections. The computation of the area is based on the width x length. No allowance is made for material overlap.

511.9 DOCUMENTATION 511.9.1 Contract Drawings

Areas for the above tender items are shown on the construction plan sheets. Typical sections are to be included on the drawings to clarify complex applications, geotextile anchorage, and other requirements.

The depth of granular sheeting and rock protection shall be identified on a typical

section. 511.9.2 Quantity Sheets

Quantities are listed on the “Quantities - Miscellaneous 1” sheet. Locations are documented by station to station limits and offsets left or right of the

roadway centreline. The column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

April 2017 Page 5 of 6 B511

Page 584: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING Rip-Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting

511.9.2.1 Variation Items

a) Rip-Rap

Rip-Rap is a variation item. The variation is the type of rip-rap (R-10 or R-50). The quantities for each type of variation are documented in separate columns on the Quantity Sheets. The variation information is entered upon creation of the individual columns and is displayed in the resultant column headings. To determine the type of rip-rap see OPSS 1004.

b) Geotextile

Geotextile is a variation item. The variation is the class (Class I or Class II), type (Woven or Non-woven), and filtration opening size (FOS 50-100 micron, FOS 75-150 micron, FOS 105-210 micron, or FOS 150-300 micron). The quantities for each type of variation are documented in separate columns on the Quantity Sheets. The variation information is entered upon creation of the individual columns and is displayed in the resultant column headings. The number of geotextile variations shall be minimized to the extent possible.

511.9.2.1 Documentation Accuracy Stations and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number metre. Offsets are recorded in 0.1 of a metre.

April 2017 Page 6 of 6 B511

Page 585: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GABIONS

January 2014 Page 1 of 5 B512

B512 - GABIONS - OPSS 512 512.1 GENERAL

Gabions are contained rectangular units made of steel wire mesh and filled with stone. The double twisted wire mesh is galvanized and PVC (polyvinyl chloride) coated. Gabions are flexible and permeable baskets or mats that when combined, may be used for applications ranging from riverbank erosion protection to retaining systems.

Gabion baskets are supplied in collapsed form that require site assembly and hand placement of stone (Figure 1). They are manufactured in standard sizes with the following nominal dimensions:

Width 0.5m or 1.0m Length 1.5, 2.0, 3.0 or 4.0m Height 0.3, 0.5 or 1.0m

Figure 1 - Gabion Basket Gabion baskets stacked vertically are referred to as gabion structures. Gabion mats, generally used as channel lining, are supplied in 30 metre rolls with or without filter cloth. They are manufactured in nominal widths or 2.0 or 3.0 m and standard heights (depths) of 0.23 and 0.30 m.

Page 586: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GABIONS

January 2014 Page 2 of 5 B512

512.2 REFERENCES Foundation Investigation and Design Report – project specific MTO Drainage Management Manual MTO Retained Soil Systems Guidelines MTO Structural Manual Maccaferri Gabions - Design and Installation Guides

512.3 TENDER ITEMS

The tender items associated with the placing of gabions and erection of gabion structures are: Gabions Gabion Structures Not Exceeding 2m Height

512.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The installation of gabions is detailed in OPSS 512. The installation of gabion structures is detailed in OPSS 512 amended by special provision. Materials for gabion baskets and mats are specified in OPSS 1430.

512.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items.

512.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings for gabions. 512.7 DESIGN

The main sources of information are the Regional Geotechnical Section, Regional Environmental Section, Pavements and Foundations Section and the Regional Structural Section. For design application details, see manufacturers' publications.

Page 587: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GABIONS

January 2014 Page 3 of 5 B512

Gabion baskets may be used for the following installations:

Retaining walls Wingwalls Weirs Headwalls Toe walls Channel lining Slope paving Culvert aprons

Where gabion installation is of a simple nature, i.e channel lining, slope paving, aprons or weirs, the work under the item "Gabions" is all-inclusive, covering any excavation for gabions and bedding, placement of granular for bedding, use of geotextiles and the installation of the gabion. Geotextile may be used to separate the gabion baskets from the adjacent and underlying earth and/or backfill material, depending on the existing soil conditions and proposed backfill properties. The need for geotextiles should be assessed on a project-specific basis. Where the OPSS 512 requirements for geotextile are not appropriate, the geotextile requirements shall be specified in the Contract Drawings or by Non-Standard Special Provision. When a gabion installation has a retaining function and holds back an embankment, i.e. headwall, wingwall, retaining wall or toe wall, it is described as a gabion structure and the item "Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height" should be used. Height is measured from the base of the gabion structure and includes embedment depth, when applicable. The designer may consult with the Regional Structural Section when designing "Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height". Design checks for bearing, sliding and overturning are required. For work under the item “Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height”, excavation for structure, granular bedding and backfill, and protection system (if required) are covered by separate tender items. In the case of granular backfill, the tender item would be the appropriate general granular item in the contract. If the Contractor chooses or requires a protection system and the ‘Protection System’ tender item is not used to cover this in the contract, such protection system shall be according to OPSS 539 and the costs would be included in the Gabion Structures Not Exceeding 2 m Height tender item. At MTO, retaining structures less than 2 m in height are considered landscape walls. For gabion structures exceeding 2 m in height, the MTO Retained Soils Systems process shall be followed.

Page 588: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GABIONS

January 2014 Page 4 of 5 B512

512.7.1 Information to be Provided to Bidders The Designer should identify whether protection systems are required. The designer shall consult with the Regional Geotechnical Section to determine whether protection systems are required. If so, a Foundation Investigation Report describing the subsurface conditions in the vicinity of the protection systems should be provided and a separate OPSS 539 ‘Protection System’ tender item should be included in the contract.

512.8 COMPUTATION

The items Gabions and Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height are both Plan Quantity Payment items. The unit of measurement for Gabions and Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height is the cubic metre. The volumes of Gabions and Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height are calculated from the number and dimensions of baskets shown on the design drawings. Excavation for the Gabions item is carried out according to OPSS 206. Excavation for the Gabion Structures not Exceeding 2m Height item is carried out according to OPSS 902. When required, it should include excavation for bedding and frost tapers. The designer is referred to Section B902 of the CDED.

512.9 DOCUMENTATION

512.9.1 Contract Drawings Both new and existing gabions, or gabion structures requiring extension are shown on the plans and profiles of the contract drawings. Typical cross-sections should be included in the contract drawings that show dimensions, any bedding and backfill requirements and excavation limits. Where there is a requirement for a protection system, the line of protection or a protection system shall be shown on the contract drawings depending on the magnitude of the protection required. The actual length and location of the protection system required is the contractor’s responsibility. Performance levels should be included on the contract drawings. A separate tender item is provided to cover the protection work.

Page 589: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING GABIONS

January 2014 Page 5 of 5 B512

Material for bedding and backfill must be identified on the drawings even when it is to be provided under the Earth Excavation (Grading) or Earth Borrow item. The OPSS 1004 gradation of the gabion stone, G-3 or G-10, shall be identified on the drawings.

512.9.2 Quantity Sheets The quantity for each Gabion or Gabion Structure location is shown separately on "Quantities - Miscellaneous 1" sheet. The column total provides the tender quantity.

512.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations are recorded to the nearest whole metre. Offsets are recorded to 0.1 of a metre. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest cubic metre.

Page 590: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 591: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

B517 - DEWATERING - OPSS 517 517.1 GENERAL

Dewatering is the work of removing water or lowering groundwater levels within the work area to facilitate construction. Temporary flow passage is the work of diverting water away from the work area to facilitate construction. Refer to Appendix A: MOECC Dewatering Legislative Requirements and Application to Highway Construction projects for information related to water taking legislation.

517.2 REFERENCES Provincial Engineering Memoranda MTO Gravity Pipe Design Guidelines MTO Highway Drainage Design Standards MTO Drainage Management Manual MTO IDF Curve Look Up Tool EPO Interpretive Bulletin Water Taking November 2016

517.3 TENDER ITEMS Dewatering System (Normal, Non-PQP, Lump Sum) Temporary Flow Passage System (Normal, Non-PQP, Lump Sum)

517.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for dewatering system and temporary flow passage system are contained in OPSS 517.

517.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

May 2017 Page 1 of 7 B517

Page 592: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

517.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings applicable to this work.

517.7 DESIGN The contractor is responsible for the design, installation, operation, maintenance and removal of any dewatering and temporary flow passage systems. Designers shall refer to the EPO Interpretive Bulletin Water Taking November 2016 for guidance on water taking activities on highway construction projects. A dewatering system is used for the removal of groundwater and includes stormwater resulting from rainfall events from within an excavation and may include use of a groundwater control system. A temporary flow passage system is used for the passive (without pumping) or active (with pumping) diversion of surface water away from a working area including contingency measures to manage higher flows. The work of dewatering and/or temporary flow passage is normally included with the cost of the associated tender item. However, for some conditions, the work is paid separately through the dewatering system or temporary flow passage system item. The dewatering system or temporary flow passage system or both item(s) shall be used at locations where any of the following conditions apply: 1) Under normal summer construction season conditions, the volume of water to be

pumped, diverted, or otherwise controlled by a dewatering system in order to carry out the work exceeds 400 m3/day.

2) The design storm return period for a temporary flow passage system, as

determined according to MTO Highway Drainage Design Standard TW-1, exceeds 5 years. Note this standard only applies to passive systems. When the presence of fisheries significantly restricts the time available to carry out the work (i.e., in-water work timing window for fisheries), a longer return period may be specified to mitigate the potential schedule impacts due to inclement weather.

3) A dewatering or temporary flow passage system is required to rehabilitate a bridge

or structural culvert. 4) The use of one or both of the items is recommended by the foundation engineer.

May 2017 Page 2 of 7 B517

Page 593: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

At locations where none of the above conditions apply, the dewatering system or temporary flow passage system item is not used, and the work required to control the water is part of the associated work item(s). Only one or one of each item shall be used for each location where any of the above conditions apply. The item selection depends on the work required and/or the site conditions, and/or as recommended in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report or the Pavement Design Report. The items are typically used for culvert, sewer, and watermain work, but may also be used when structural rehabilitation work below water level is required or for other work requiring the control of water. These items are not used for the dewatering of excavations for the construction of structures. The Dewatering Structure Excavations item is used for this work (see CDED B902). Typically, foundation investigations are carried out for the construction of new foundation components. However, a foundation investigation may be appropriate solely for the purpose of providing soil and groundwater information for dewatering or temporary flow passage system bidding and design. Consult with a foundation or geotechnical engineer to determine if the site conditions warrant this investigation.

517.7.1 Source of Information Sources of information include the Foundation Investigation and Design Report and hydrology and hydraulic analysis information for the design of the associated work.

517.7.2 Information to be Provided to Bidders The following shall be provided for each location requiring the dewatering system or temporary flow passage system item: 1) The latitude and longitude co-ordinates for the IDF Curve as determined using the

MTO IDF Curve Look up Tool for the contract. On some contracts, there may have been more than one (1) IDF curve used and all locations shall be provided.

2) The minimum design storm return period, for temporary flow passage system item

only. 3) Design flow rates corresponding to the 2, 5, 10 and 25-year return periods of the

water body. The preconstruction survey distance, if required, that corresponds to an identified dewatering location.

4) When available, the Foundation Investigation Report and/or soils borehole logs.

May 2017 Page 3 of 7 B517

Page 594: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

Full engineering cross sections through the dewatering system and temporary flow passage system item locations and drainage channel cross sections obtained for the purpose of hydraulic analysis should be provided, when available.

517.8 COMPUTATION These are lump sum items, no quantity computation is required.

517.9 DOCUMENTATION

517.9.1 Contract Drawings Normally the contractor designs the temporary flow passage system alignment. However, when a temporary flow passage system must be constructed along a specific alignment, for example as a result of consultation with regulatory agencies, show the alignment on a drawing detail. When the alignment of the temporary flow passage system must be revised for different contract stages, show the alignment revision for each stage.

517.9.2 Quantity Sheets A separate dewatering system or temporary flow passage system item shall be used for each location requiring the item. A separate quantity sheet column is required for each item. The location and position column of the quantity sheet shall show the station limits of the area requiring dewatering, and a description of the work requiring dewatering eg. Sta. 12+455 – 12+490, C/L Culvert Replacement. A value of 100% is entered in the item quantity column.

517.9.3 Tender Item List A separate dewatering system or temporary flow passage system item shall be used for each location requiring the item. Each separate location is located in a separate section of the tender item list.

May 2017 Page 4 of 7 B517

Page 595: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

517.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions A NSSP is required when flow rates through the work site requiring dewatering or temporary flow passage system are influenced by upstream control structures. Contact information, operating schedules, and other relevant information to be provided. NSSPs that ‘red-flag’ site conditions or require system components (eg. tremie plug for cofferdams) are included when recommended by the foundation engineer.

517.9.5 Documentation Accuracy Record station entries to the nearest whole metre.

May 2017 Page 5 of 7 B517

Page 596: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

Appendix A

MOECC Dewatering Legislative Requirements and Application to Highway Construction Projects

New Legislative Requirements: In 2016, the Ministry of Environment and Climate Change (MOECC) introduced new legislation on water taking for road construction purposes, and specifically applicable to this document, construction site dewatering. Water taking activities and sources were clarified and the legislative requirements redefined. Dependent on the water taking volume limits and sources of water, a Permit to Take Water (PTTW) or registration of the water taking activity in the Environmental Activity and Sector Registry (EASR) may or may not be required. To determine the construction site dewatering needs and approval requirements for a project, designers shall refer to the EPO Interpretive Bulletin Water Taking November 2016 for information and guidance on the application process for draft PTTWs and preparation of Water Taking Plans and Discharge Plans to support registration in EASR by the contractor. Table 1.0 provides an overview of the new water taking limits, sources of water and the new legislative requirements.

Water Taking Limits/day Stormwater Groundwaterx

xx xx

xx xx

xx x

Passive (gravity) water body flow diversionsActive (pumping) water body flow diversionsNote: x indicates the contributing source of water

Table 1.0: Application of MOECC's New Water Taking Legislation

No EASR registration or PTTW

Approval Requirements

< 50 m3

> 50 and < 400 m3

> 400 m3

No EASR registration or PTTW

EASR registration - no PTTW

PTTW

No EASR registration or PTTW

No EASR registration or PTTW

Application to Highway Construction Projects: To illustrate the application of the new legislative requirements, the following scenarios of water taking activities on a highway construction site have been provided: 1. Removal of groundwater from a work area, including incoming surface runoff originating from a

rainfall event into the work area, which does not naturally discharge into the water body within the confines of the work area, is a dewatering activity.

May 2017 Page 6 of 7 B517

Page 597: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING DEWATERING

2. Removal of groundwater and stormwater resulting from a rainfall event from a work area that naturally discharges into the water body within the confines of the work area is a stormwater management (SWM) activity.

3. Removal of surface water originating from a rainfall event from a work area, excluding the

stormwater volume being discharged with a dewatering activity, is a SWM activity. 4. Removal of water body flows from a work area is a temporary flow passage activity.

May 2017 Page 7 of 7 B517

Page 598: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 599: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT SMALL SIGNS AND SUPPORTS

B703 – PERMANENT SMALL SIGNS AND SUPPORTS – OPSS 703 703.1 GENERAL

A permanent small ground mounted sign assembly is defined as a permanent sign(s) and its support system with a sign panel area including tab(s) not greater than 3.6 m². Permanent small ground mounted signs are supported on breakaway or non-breakaway support systems, consisting of one or two wood posts, and one, or two, or three metal posts. Breakaway sign support systems with wooden or steel posts have been designed to resist wind loading and meet the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350. Breakaway sign support systems are acceptable on high speed and low speed roadways. Non-breakaway sign support systems with steel posts have been designed to resist wind loading, will bend upon impact, and are acceptable on low speed roadways when barrier curb is present. Based on the sign dimensions specified at each sign location in the Contract, the Contractor is given the option of selecting, supplying and installing one of the acceptable small sign support systems in accordance with the sign dimensions and maximum sign areas specified in the MTODs and OPSDs.

703.2 REFERENCES Highway Design Bulletin 2011-002 Roadside Safety Manual Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTOD) Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) Ontario Traffic Manual

703.3 TENDER ITEMS Small Signs, Ground Mounted, New Small Signs, Relocation Small Signs, Removal

703.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for Permanent Small Signs and Support Systems are contained in Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSS) 703.

November 2014 Page 1 of 4 B703

Page 600: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT SMALL SIGNS AND SUPPORTS

703.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

703.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD) and Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

703.7 DESIGN Design shall be in accordance with the appropriate MTODs and OPSDs. The designer shall contact the MTO Regional Traffic Office and/or Services Coordinators to obtain input in determining the condition of existing signs, required changes to existing signs, and new sign requirements. The designer shall prepare a list of all new signs, and signs to be relocated or removed. The list shall be summarized in the signing table for insertion into the contract documents. A sample signing table is shown in the Documentation section below.

703.7.1 Source of Information The Regional Traffic Office and/or Services Coordinators are the main sources of information for the above noted tender items and shall provide input for the preparation of the sign inventory, signing table and sign lay-out drawings.

703.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment Items. The quantity is based on each small sign assembly installation, relocation, and removal. The unit of measurement for Small Signs is for each small sign assembly installed, relocated, and removed.

November 2014 Page 2 of 4 B703

Page 601: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT SMALL SIGNS AND SUPPORTS

703.9 DOCUMENTATION 703.9.1 Signing Table

Where new signs are to be installed, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, sign message description, sign size, total sign area, support type, sign supplier and action information shall be detailed in the table. Where existing signs are to be relocated, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, sign message description, sign size, total sign area, support type, and action information shall be detailed in the signing table. The existing sign location shall be provided in the comments cell, for example as in the sample table below. Where existing sign installations are to be removed, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, message description, sign size, total sign area, and action information shall be detailed in the table.

703.9.2 Sample Signing Table

Location: Highway 401 – Westbound Station Offset

from ES (m)

Sign Number

Symbol/ Message

Description

Size BxH (cm)

Sign Area

(sq.m)

Support Type

Sign Supplied

By

Action

Comments

10+450 1.5 Wa-123R + Wa-123t

Right lane ends, xxx m

90x90 90x45

1.22 N/A N/A Rem None

10+500 2.0 Rb-1A Maximum 100 60x90 0.54 BK MTO New Behind SBGR

11+500 2.0 G-300 London 110 180x90 1.62 BK MTO Rel Existing at 10+475

Notes: Offset from ES: Indicate offset from edge of shoulder to nearest edge of sign. Sign Size: Indicate dimensions of each individual sign board, B for width and

H for height. Total Sign Area: Indicate total area of the sign board including any tabs. Support Type: Indicate BK for breakaway sign support, NBK for non-breakaway

sign support, and N/A for not applicable when support to be removed.

Supplied By: For each sign board indicate the supplier, i.e. MTO, Other, or N/A.

November 2014 Page 3 of 4 B703

Page 602: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT SMALL SIGNS AND SUPPORTS

Action Code: Indicate New, Rel for relocation and/or Rem for removal. Comments: Special comments that are not covered in any of the column such

as existing sign location etc. 703.9.3 Drawings

The Designer shall prepare a plan view sign lay-out drawing at a scale of 1:1000 or a scale as directed by the MTO Regional Traffic Office to detail all information shown in the signing table for review and approval by the MTO Regional Traffic Office. The final plan view sign lay-out drawing shall be a part of the Contract Document and the signing table may be shown on the same drawing. The Designer shall define all acronyms used in the signing table on the drawing.

703.9.4 Quantity Sheets

Permanent new sign installations, relocations, and removals, shall be indicated on a Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet by location, station and offset, and shall be equal to the number of signs detailed in the signing table.

703.9.5 Schedule of Materials

MTO-supplied signs are listed in the Tender document on the “Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner”. The designer shall enter the appropriate information, (i.e. U.O.M., Description, Supply Point, and Quantity) into the Contract Preparation System (CPS) on the “Supplies by MTO” form found under the “Form of Tender” menu item in the appropriate Work Project file. Note: Where more than one sign board or tab is mounted on a sign assembly, each individual signboard or tab is counted as one in the Schedule of Materials. (i.e. Where there is one signboard and two sign tabs on a sign assembly being supplied by MTO, a total of three would be added to the Schedule of Materials.)

703.9.6 Documentation Accuracy

Sign installation station shall be recorded to the nearest whole meter. Sign offset from the edge of the shoulder shall be recorded to the nearest 0.1 of a meter. Sign area shall be recorded to the nearest 0.01 of a square meter. Sign quantity shall be recorded to the whole number. Spot checking required.

November 2014 Page 4 of 4 B703

Page 603: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING POST MOUNTED DELINEATORS

B704 – POST MOUNTED DELINEATORS – OPS 704 704.1 GENERAL

Post mounted delineators are installed adjacent to the travelled portion of the roadway in series to guide drivers by describing the horizontal alignment of the roadway and identifying its limits. Post mounted delineators are supplementary guidance devices that remain visible during periods when roads are wet and / or snow covered.

704.2 REFERENCES

Ontario Traffic Manual Book 6 – Warning Signs Ontario Traffic Manual Book 7 – Temporary Conditions Ontario Traffic Manual Book 11 – Markings and Delineation

704.3 TENDER ITEMS

Post Mounted Delineators (variation) 704.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for Post Mounted Delineators are contained in OPSS 704.

704.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

704.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

704.7 DESIGN

Design considerations including need, location, and spacing requirements for post mounted delineators are found in Books 6, 7, and 11 of the Ontario Traffic Manual.

November 2014 Page 1 of 2 B704

Page 604: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING POST MOUNTED DELINEATORS

704.8 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items. The quantity is based on each completed post and delineator installation. The unit of measurement for post mounted delineators is each.

704.9 DOCUMENTATION

The tender item is a variation item. A separate column on the quantity sheets is required for each variation to indicate the type of delineator: Type A (125 mm x 125 mm) or Type B (250 mm x 250 mm). Post mounted delineator quantities and locations are indicated on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets under the appropriate column heading, showing station to station limits and location, left or right of centerline. Each column is totalled, added together, and transferred to the tender document. Show the location and post spacing for each run of post mounted delineators on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD number and installation type (i.e. Type A or Type B) shown adjacent to the symbol.

704.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Record stations to the nearest whole metre and quantity entries to the number of units required.

November 2014 Page 2 of 2 B704

Page 605: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FLEXIBLE DELINEATOR POSTS

B705 – FLEXIBLE DELINEATOR POSTS – OPSS 705 705.1 GENERAL

Much like post mounted delineators, flexible delineator posts are installed adjacent to the travelled portion of the roadway in series to guide drivers by describing the horizontal alignment of the roadway and identifying its limits. Flexible delineator posts are supplementary guidance devices that remain visible during periods when roads are wet and / or snow covered. Flexible delineator posts can also be used for channelization purposes. Typically, additional signing is not attached to flexible delineator posts. Generally, flexible delineator posts are used for temporary delineation and channelization applications and are installed at locations where repeated impacts would be reasonably expected to occur. The use of flexible delineator posts may also be appropriate for use in unique permanent applications.

705.2 REFERENCES

Ontario Traffic Manual Book 6 – Warning Signs Ontario Traffic Manual Book 7 – Temporary Conditions Ontario Traffic Manual Book 11 – Markings and Delineation

705.3 TENDER ITEMS Flexible Delineator Post - Permanent (variation) Flexible Delineator Post - Temporary (variation) Flexible Delineator Post - Relocation (variation) 705.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for Post Mounted Delineators are contained in OPSS 705.

705.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

November 2014 Page 1 of 3 B705

Page 606: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FLEXIBLE DELINEATOR POSTS

705.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

705.7 DESIGN

Design considerations including need, location, and spacing for flexible delineator post installation should be determined through discussion with the Regional Traffic Section in conjunction with the guidance for post mounted delineators found in Books 6, 7, and 11 of the Ontario Traffic Manual. In general, flexible delineator posts should be used sparingly in order to maximize their visual impact. The location and proximity of flexible delineator posts to the edge of travelled way or edge of shoulder should be considered with respect to impact on and impact from winter maintenance operations. Flexible delineator posts should not be placed in locations that will hinder snow removal operations nor should they be placed in locations where they will be exposed to a high incidence of impacts from snow removal equipment.

705.8 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items. The quantity is based on each completed installation. The unit of measurement for flexible delineator posts is each.

705.9 DOCUMENTATION

Show the location and post spacing for each run of flexible delineator posts on the contract drawings with the appropriate MTOD number for permanent, temporary, and relocated flexible delineator posts. Also indicate the type of post required (i.e. Type A or Type B) adjacent to the symbol. Flexible Delineator Post - Temporary – this item pays for the supply and removal of the units. The total cannot exceed the largest number of units in place at any one time during the contract. Flexible Delineator Post - Relocation – this item is comprised of all relocations during the contract.

November 2014 Page 2 of 3 B705

Page 607: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING FLEXIBLE DELINEATOR POSTS

The tender items are variation items. A separate column on the quantity sheets is required for each variation to indicate the type of flexible delineator post: Type A (Fixed Surface Mount Base) or Type B (Driveable Soil Anchor Base). Flexible delineator post quantities and locations are indicated on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets under the appropriate column heading, showing station to station limits and location, left or right of centerline and offsets where required. Each column is totalled, added together, and transferred to the tender document. Please refer to the following two examples when calculating the quantities for temporary installations:

Example 1:

Stage Posts Installed Flexible Delineator Post - Temporary

Flexible Delineator Post - Relocation

1 500 500 0

2 400 0 400

3 600 100 500

Total NA 600 900 Example 2:

Stage Posts Installed Flexible Delineator Post - Temporary

Flexible Delineator Post - Relocation

1 500 500 0

2 400 400 0

3 600 0 600

Total NA 900 600 Example 2 is essentially the same as Example 1; however, for Example 2, the posts from Stage 1 are not available for use in Stage 2. As a result, there are a total of 900 posts installed at one time in Example 2, while in example 1, the total installed at one time is 600.

705.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Stations are recorded to the nearest whole metre, offsets are recorded to the nearest 0.1 m, and quantity entries to the number of units required.

November 2014 Page 3 of 3 B705

Page 608: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 609: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

B706 - TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES - OPSS 706 706.1 GENERAL

Temporary traffic control devices are used for guidance, information, and to control the flow of traffic during construction. Temporary traffic control devices include the following:

• Temporary Traffic Control Signs • Road Closing/Restriction Notice Sign (TC-64) • Automated Flagger Assistance Devices (AFAD) • Portable Variable Message Sign (PVMS)

Temporary Traffic Control Signs Temporary traffic control signs are all traffic control signs and associated devices identified in OTM Book 7, including vehicles and sign trailers required to support signs and equipment to supply sign lighting; but excludes highway number markers. Contract Information Signs A contract information sign is a sign installed to inform motorists of the type of construction work taking place. There are two types of contract information signs: a TC-81 sign and an Owner supplied contract information sign. Road Closing/Restriction Notice Sign (TC-64) A road closing/restriction notice sign (TC-64) is a sign installed to provide advance notice of a road or exit ramp which is to be closed or restricted. Automated Flagger Assistance Devices (AFAD) Automated fFlagger assistance devices (AFAD) are self-contained, portable traffic control systems where the signal and/or control arm are operated remotely by a traffic control person (TCP). Portable Variable Message Sign (PVMS) A portable variable message sign (PVMS) is a traffic control device that is capable of displaying digital messages. PVMS are used in work zones to provide road users with advance information of work operations which are outside their expectations such as closures or speed reductions. PVMS should be used for situations where conditions are changing and are in addition to Temporary Traffic Control Signs required by the Ontario Traffic Manual.

February 2017 Page 1 of 12 B706

Page 610: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

706.2 REFERENCES Ontario Traffic Manual Book 7 - Temporary Conditions Roadside Safety Manual

706.3 TENDER ITEMS Temporary Traffic Control Signs (LS, normal) Road Closing/Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) (Each, Normal, PQP) Automated Flagger Assistance Devices (Each, Normal, PQP) Portable Variable Message Sign (Temporary) (Each, Variation, PQP) Portable Variable Message Sign, Relocation (Each, Variation, PQP)

706.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for these temporary traffic control devices are contained in Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSS) 706.

706.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

706.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings applicable to this work.

706.7 DESIGN Bilingual Signing If the contract is in a bilingual area, separate English and French signs shall be installed. The designer shall contact the MTO Regional Traffic Section to obtain the French translation. Contract Information Sign The designer shall select the appropriate contract information sign based on the contract value and duration. Option 1 - Shall be selected for all stationary contracts that do not meet the criteria

of Option 2, Option 3 or Option 4. Option 2 - Shall be selected for all stationary contracts exceeding $500,000 in value

and a minimum of 3 months or 60 working days in duration.

February 2017 Page 2 of 12 B706

Page 611: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 3 - Shall be selected for all stationary contracts exceeding $500,000 in value and a minimum of 3 months or 60 working days in duration located on the QEW.

Option 4 - Shall be selected for all stationary contracts in Northern Ontario (all

areas north of, and including the districts of Parry Sound and Nipissing) exceeding $500,000 in value and a minimum of 3 months or 60 working days in duration.

Examples of the 4 different contract information sign options can be found in the Appendix. ** Fill-in the required information (i.e. # of kilometres, location or highway number)

for the applicable contract information signs. If the contract is in a designated bilingual area the corresponding French contract information signs must also be included. For example, TC-81b and TC-81bF would both be included for a highway widening project in a designated bilingual area. Option 1

Sign Number Message Details Sign Number Message Details

TC-81a Highway Improvements Next ** km TC-81aF Amélioration de la route

sur ** km

TC-81b Highway Widening Next ** km TC-81bF Élargissement de la route

sur ** km

TC-81c Highway Resurfacing Next ** km TC-81cF Resurfaçage de la route

sur ** km

TC-81d Bridge Work ** TC-81dF Travaux sur le pont

**

February 2017 Page 3 of 12 B706

Page 612: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 2

Sign Number Message Details Sign Number Message Details

8190E Highway

** Improvements

8190F Autoroute

** Améliorations

8191E Highway

** Widening

8191F Autoroute

** Élargissement

8192E Highway

** Resurfacing

8192F Autoroute

** Resurfaçage

8193E Highway

** Bridge Work

8193F Aut. **

Travaux sur le pont

8194E Highway

** New Interchange

8194F Aut. ** Nouvel

échangeur Option 3

Sign Number Message Details Sign Number Message Details

8200E QEW

Highway Improvements

8200F QEW

Autoroute Améliorations

8201E QEW

Highway Widening

8201F QEW

Autoroute Élargissement

8202E QEW

Highway Resurfacing

8202F QEW

Autoroute Resurfaçage

8203E QEW

Highway Bridge Work

8203F QEW

Travaux sur le pont

8204E QEW

Highway New Interchange

8204F QEW

Nouvel échangeur

February 2017 Page 4 of 12 B706

Page 613: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 4

Sign Number Message Details Sign Number Message Details

8195E Highway

** Improvements

8195F Autoroute

** Améliorations

8196E Highway

** Widening

8196F Autoroute

** Élargissement

8197E Highway

** Resurfacing

8197F Autoroute

** Resurfaçage

8198E Highway

** Bridge Work

8198F Aut. **

Travaux sur le pont

8199E Highway

** New Interchange

8199F Aut. ** Nouvel

échangeur Road Closing/Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) The designer shall contact the Regional Traffic Section for input in determining the location and messaging of road closing/restriction notice signs (TC-64). Automated Flagger Assistance Devices (AFAD) The locations of the AFAD are determined in consultation with the Regional Traffic Section. Portable Variable Message Sign (PVMS) The designer shall contact the Regional Traffic Section for input in determining the PVMS location or relocation. Location of the PVMS should be based on the clear zone guidelines specified in the Roadside Safety Manual. If the sign has to be installed closer to the EP, then provisions for protecting traffic from the hazard should be considered and included in the design. The designer shall determine if a temporary granular pad or crib is required to install the PVMS at the specified location or relocation. If the contract is in a bilingual area, an additional PVMS sign shall be installed for the approved equivalent French message. The French and English PVMS shall be spaced a minimum of 150 m apart. PVMS sign messaging shall be provided by the Regional Traffic Section.

February 2017 Page 5 of 12 B706

Page 614: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

706.7.1 Source of Information The Regional Traffic Section is the main source of information for the above noted tender items. The Regional Traffic Section shall provide input for the preparation of the signing table for contract information signs.

706.8 COMPUTATION The basis of payment for Temporary Traffic Control Signs is lump sum. In the tender, the item is lump sum with a quantity of 100%. Road Closing/Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) is a Plan Quantity Payment Item. The quantity is based on each road closing/restriction notice sign installation. The unit of measurement for Road Closing/Restriction Notice Sign is each. Automated Flagger Assistance Devices is a Plan Quantity Payment Item. The AFAD item price includes supply and placement at the initial location, and as many relocations of the AFAD as is required. The contract quantity of AFAD should be the maximum number of AFAD required to be in operation at any time over the contract duration. The unit of measurement for AFAD is each. Portable Variable Message Sign (Temporary) is a Plan Quantity Payment Item. The PVMS (Temporary) item price includes supply and placement at the initial location. The contract quantity of PVMS should be the maximum number of PVMS required to be in operation at any time over the contract duration. The unit of measurement for PVMS (Temporary) is each. Portable Variable Message Sign, Relocation is a Plan Quantity Payment Item. The PVMS, Relocation item price is for the number of relocations of the PVMS. The unit of measurement for PVMS, Relocation is each.

706.9 DOCUMENTATION

706.9.1 Contract Drawings Contract Information Sign The contract information sign number and message shall be detailed in a signing table and included in the contract drawings for review and approval by the MTO Regional Traffic Section.

February 2017 Page 6 of 12 B706

Page 615: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Sample Sign Table

Sign Number Message Details Sign Number Message Details

8190E Highway

401 Improvements

8190F Autoroute

401 Améliorations

Road Closing/Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) The designer shall prepare a plan view drawing at a scale of 1:1000 or a scale as directed by the Regional Traffic Section to detail the location and message information for review and approval by the Regional Traffic Section. The final plan view sign lay-out drawing shall be included in the contract drawings along with the message details. AFAD The AFAD locations are shown on the contract drawings, typically on staging drawings. Where multiple AFAD or AFAD relocations are required, the AFAD are numbered, e.g. AFAD-1, AFAD-2, etc. The AFAD station location is shown along with offsets. PVMS The PVMS or PVMS relocations are shown on the contract drawings, typically on staging drawings. Where multiple PVMS locations are required, the PVMS are numbered, e.g. PVMS-1, PVMS-2, etc. Where multiple PVMS relocations are required, they are numbered, e.g. PVMS-1-R1, PVMS-2-R2, etc. A detail shall be provided in the contract drawings for the construction of a granular pad or crib if required for any PVMS locations or relocations.

706.9.2 Schedule of Materials Signs supplied by MTO are listed in the Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner.

706.9.3 Quantity Sheets Road Closing/Restriction Notice Signs (TC-64) Road closing/restriction notice signs shall be indicated on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet by a quantity of ‘1’. The quantity shown on the q sheet shall be equal to the number of signs detailed in the Contract Drawings.

February 2017 Page 7 of 12 B706

Page 616: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

AFAD Each AFAD is shown on a separate line entry on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet by a quantity of 1. The AFAD is identified in the Location/Description column by the same identifier used on the contract drawings, e.g. AFAD-1, AFAD-2, etc. PVMS PVMS (Temporary) shall be indicated on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet. PVMS (Temporary) is identified in the Location/Description column by the same identifier used in the contract drawings, e.g. PVMS-1, PVMS-2, etc. Quantity Sheet information should include highway, stage, and station and offset for each PVMS (Temporary). The Portable Variable Message Sign (Temporary) is a variation item. The temporary base requirement (existing ground, granular pad, timber crib) is specified by variation. The language of message (English or French) is also specified by variation. A separate column on the quantity sheets is required for each variation. PVMS, Relocation shall be indicated on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet. PVMS, Relocation is identified in the Location/Description column by the same identifier used in the contract drawings, e.g. PVMS-1-R1, PVMS-2-R2, etc. Quantity Sheet information should include highway, stage, and station and offset for each PVMS relocation. The Portable Variable Message Sign, Relocation item is a variation item. The temporary base requirement (existing ground, granular pad, timber crib) is specified by variation. The language of message (English or French) is also specified by variation. A separate column on the quantity sheets is required for each variation The individual column entries are totalled into the tender total which is transferred to the Form of Tender.

706.9.4 Documentation Accuracy Stations and quantities shall be recorded to the whole number. Offsets shall be recorded to the nearest 0.1 m.

February 2017 Page 8 of 12 B706

Page 617: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

APPENDIX Option 1 Contract Information Sign Examples

February 2017 Page 9 of 12 B706

Page 618: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 2 Contract Information Sign Examples

February 2017 Page 10 of 12 B706

Page 619: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 3 Contract Information Sign Examples

February 2017 Page 11 of 12 B706

Page 620: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES

Option 4 Contract Information Sign Examples

February 2017 Page 12 of 12 B706

Page 621: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MODIFIED OVERHEAD SIGNBOARDS

B707 - MODIFIED OVERHEAD SIGNBOARDS - OPSS 707 707.1 GENERAL

A modified overhead signboard is a thin metal aluminum sheet that varies in dimension, most commonly 1200 mm x 2400 mm. Its use is to overlay and change the message on an existing overhead extruded sign, both whole and portion, and it is also used as an overlay to update the reflectivity of an entire existing sign with no change in message.

The Modified Overhead Signboards item is applicable only to permanent changes to existing overhead signboards. Temporary overlays used during construction shall be included under the appropriate tender item, such as the Traffic Control Signing item or a non-standard tender item.

707.2 REFERENCES Ontario Traffic Manual (OTM) Sign Support Manual

707.3 TENDER ITEMS Modified Overhead Signboards

707.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for overlay signboards are contained in Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSS) 707.

707.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

707.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings applicable to this work.

April 2016 Page 1 of 4 B707

Page 622: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MODIFIED OVERHEAD SIGNBOARDS

707.7 DESIGN Modified overhead signboard design details shall be drafted by Highway Standards Branch (HSB) Traffic Office. The designer shall contact the MTO Regional Traffic Section to obtain overlay sign design details. The MTO Regional Traffic Section will, in turn, contact HSB Traffic Office to obtain overlay sign design details. HSB Traffic Office shall prepare sign lay-out drawing(s) at a scale of 1:10 or a scale as directed by the MTO Regional Traffic Office to detail all information shown in the signing table in the Contract Drawings. Where partial overlays are required, an original of the sign with the partial overlay highlighted is to be provided for context. Dimensions shall be indicated to facilitate proper placement of the overlay where required.

707.7.1 Source of Information The Regional Traffic Section and/or the General Services Co-ordinators are the main sources of information for the above noted tender items and the Regional Traffic Office shall provide input for the preparation of the signing table and sign design details.

707.8 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment Items. The quantity is based on each overlay signboard installed. The unit of measurement for Modified Overhead Signboards is each.

707.9 DOCUMENTATION 707.9.1 Signing Table

The station, cardinal direction, sign number, sign message description, presence of existing overlay, modified overhead signboard size and action information and any comments shall be detailed in a signing table, and accompanied by explanatory notes. An example signing table is shown below.

April 2016 Page 2 of 4 B707

Page 623: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MODIFIED OVERHEAD SIGNBOARDS

Signing Table: Location: Highway 400

Station Cardinal Direction

Sign Number

Symbol/ Message

Description

Existing Overlay?

Modified Signboard Size

B x H (mm)

Action

Comments

10+450 North G109 Turn-off Arrows

3050 x 4270 Partial Install at end of Stage 2

10+500 South HOV-4R HOV Do not cross right

1520 x 1520 Full

10+600 North G112 Right Lane Ends, 500m

Y 1200 x 600 Partial

Notes:

Existing Overlay? Y means existing overlay signboard panel is present Overlay Size: Indicate dimensions of each individual sign board, B for width

and H for height. Action: Indicate full overlay (Full) or partial overlay (Partial) Comments: Special comments that are not covered in any of the column

such as existing sign, etc. 707.9.2 Contract Drawings

The sign lay-out drawing(s) prepared by HSB Traffic Office shall be included in the Contract Drawings. The signing table and explanatory notes shall be included in the Contract Drawings, and may be shown on the same drawing as the sign lay-out drawing(s).

707.9.3 Quantity Sheets

Overlay signboards for installation shall be indicated on a Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet by location and station. The total quantity shall be equal to the number of modified signboards detailed in the signing table.

707.9.4 Schedule of Materials

MTO-supplied signs are listed in the Tender document on the “Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner”. The designer shall enter the appropriate information, (i.e. U.O.M., Description, Supply Point, and Quantity) into the Contract Preparation

April 2016 Page 3 of 4 B707

Page 624: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MODIFIED OVERHEAD SIGNBOARDS

System (CPS) on the “Supplies by MTO” form found under the “Form of Tender” menu item in the appropriate Work Project file. Note: Where more than one modified signboard is mounted on an existing overhead

sign, each individual signboard is counted as one (1) in the Schedule of Materials.

707.9.5 Documentation Accuracy

Modified Overhead Signboard quantities shall be recorded to the whole number.

April 2016 Page 4 of 4 B707

Page 625: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PORTABLE TEMPORARY TRAFFIC SIGNALS

B708 - PORTABLE TEMPORARY TRAFFIC SIGNALS - OPSS 708 708.1 GENERAL

Portable temporary traffic signals (PTTS) are used where is it necessary to temporarily control traffic by signals, to facilitate construction operations i.e. lanes reduction to a single lane of traffic for both directions.

708.2 REFERENCES Provincial Engineering Memorandum Traffic Office #2016-01, November 30, 2016 OTM Book 7 & 12 Designated Sources for Materials List 6.70.60

708.3 TENDER ITEMS Portable Temporary Traffic Signals (each, normal, PQP)

708.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for PTTS are covered by OPSS 708.

708.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions.

708.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS - none

708.7 DESIGN The designer should determine whether PTTS would be a cost effective method to control traffic, with consideration of the cost of associated work meeting Ministry requirements. Traffic Office memorandum 2016-01 provides direction for the use of PTTS on Ministry projects.

November 2016 Page 1 of 3 B708

Page 626: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PORTABLE TEMPORARY TRAFFIC SIGNALS

The use and locations of the PTTS are determined in consultation with the regional Traffic Section. PTTS locations are shown on the contract drawings consistent with the PHM-125 legal document(s), when required. Signal timing and the fill-ins for the Generic Signal Timing Sheet(s) are to be sent to the regional Traffic Section for review and comment.

708.8 COMPUTATION The PTTS item price includes supply and placement at the initial location, and as many relocations of the PTTS as is required. The contract quantity of PTTS should be the maximum number of PTTS required to be in operation at any time over the contract duration. The quantity is paid as each. PTTS is a plan quantity payment item. The PTTS item is for the supply and operation of the PTTS only. If the use of the PTTS requires other work such as earth / rock grading, temporary concrete barrier, stop blocks, energy attenuators, etc., this work is quantified and documented according to the appropriate standard items.

708.9 DOCUMENTATION

708.9.1 Contract Drawings PTTS locations are shown on the contract drawings, typically on staging drawings, consistent with the PHM 125 drawing(s). Where multiple PTTS or PTTS relocations are required, the PTTS are numbered on the PHM-125 and the contract drawings as applicable, e.g. PTTS-1, PTTS-2, etc. The PTTS station location is shown along with offsets, as measured from the road centreline (control line) to the signal heads.

708.9.2 Quantity Sheets Each PTTS is shown on a separate line entry on the Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 sheet with a quantity of 1 in the applicable column. The PTTS is identified in the Location and Position column by the same identifier used on the PHM-125 and the contract drawings, e.g. PTTS-1, PTTS-2, etc.

708.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations are rounded to whole numbers. Offsets are shown to 0.1 m accuracy.

November 2016 Page 2 of 3 B708

Page 627: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PORTABLE TEMPORARY TRAFFIC SIGNALS

708.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions OPSS 708 specifies that operation of PTTS shall be permitted between April 1st and November 30th of each calendar year. When operation before April 1st or after November 30th is required, the requirements must be specified with reference to the specific PTTS. This will require an NSSP. Where MTO supplies the PTTS, the PTTS is listed in the Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Ministry.

November 2016 Page 3 of 3 B708

Page 628: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 629: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

B710 - PAVEMENT MARKING - OPSS 710

710.1 GENERAL

Pavement marking may be carried out by district forces under Services (sundry) or by the contractor. While in the past all pavement marking was strictly a maintenance operation, the present trend is towards including some or all of the work in the construction contracts.

The designer will consult with the District Engineer, who will recommend either to make pavement marking a district responsibility, or to include the appropriate items in the contract. He may also recommend pavement marking materials when it is inappropriate to give the contractor the option indicated in the specification.

In any case the responsibility for the actual marking scheme rests with the Regional Traffic Section. Based on policies in the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices of Ontario, the Traffic Section will provide the requirements for temporary and permanent pavement markings.

To aid the Traffic Section, Regional Planning & Design Section will provide plan information such as:

- partial pavement removal which may require temporary pavement marking;

- detour drawings with traffic directions;

- staging schemes with traffic directions;

- number of lifts of pavement courses;

- final pavement scheme;

The Regional Traffic Section will indicate the pavement markings on these plans. Quantities are calculated either by the Traffic Section or Planning & Design Section depending on regional preference.

710.1.1 Tender Items

1. Pavement Marking - Item Pavement Marking Symbols - Item

2. Pavement Marking, Durable - Item Pavement Marking Symbols, Durable - Item

3. Pavement Marking, Temporary - Item

September 2011 Page 1 of 6 B710

Page 630: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary - Item

4. Pavement Marking, Temporary, Removable - Item Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary, Removable - Item

5. Pavement Marking Obliterating - Item

The first item in each pair is for marking of lane lines, the second is for the marking of symbols, such as arrows. When no symbols are required, only the first item will appear in the contract.

Selection of Tender Item

Pavement MarkingPavement Marking Symbols

These items are intended for permanent markings of 2-lane highways or 4-lane highways with low traffic volumes. Surface courses are usually HL 1, HL 3, HL 4, or Concrete.

Pavement Marking is also used for edge lines in conjunction with Pavement Marking, Durable for lane lines.

Marking materials for these items are traffic paints, organic solvent based or water based.

Pavement Marking, Durable Pavement Marking Symbols, Durable

These items are intended for permanent marking of multi-lane highways with high traffic volumes. Surface courses are usually HL 1, HL 3, OFC, DFC or Concrete.

Marking materials for these items are field reacted cold plastics, thermoplastics or preformed plastic tape.

Pavement Marking, Temporary Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary

These items are intended for temporary marking of temporary driving surfaces. Normally this would include detours, lane shifts and other traffic diversions. A marking scheme is required for temporary pavement marking.

Temporary pavement markings do not require removal or obliteration because, normally, temporary driving surfaces are either covered over by subsequent paving lifts, or they may be removed (e.g. detours).

September 2011 Page 2 of 6 B710

Page 631: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

For temporary pavement marking the contractor may choose from all marking materials unless instructed otherwise in the contract. When designating a specific marking material, the appropriate materials for these items are traffic paints or temporary preformed plastic tapes.

Simple resurfacing jobs do not require temporary pavement marking. In this case permanent marking items and associated short term pavement marking requirements of OPSS 710 apply, provided the exposure of the various temporary driving surfaces to traffic is within the time limits permitted by Table 1 in OPSS 710.

Short term pavement markings are markings that are placed prior to the placement of permanent pavement markings, on a milled surface, levelling course, binder course or surface course pavement where existing lane widths, arrangements and alignments are maintained. Short term pavement markings are not quantified for payment purposes.

Pavement Marking, Temporary - Removable Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary - Removable

These items are intended for temporary marking of pavement surfaces which are temporarily used for interim traffic patterns, but will ultimately receive permanent markings for final traffic pattern. For these items the contractor may use only removable preformed plastic tape as marking material, which he has to remove after use unless instructed otherwise in the contract by special provision.

Pavement Marking Obliterating

This item is usually required when an existing pavement marking pattern is changed without the need of any other work, such as milling or resurfacing before the change in traffic pattern.

There is no Ministry policy regarding the method of obliterating. Obliterating has been accomplished by removal (grinding) or by painting over the markings with black paint.

In the absence of a Ministry policy it is a regional (district) choice which method to specify. A special provision is required to direct the contractor which method to use.

710.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for all pavement marking are contained in Ontario Provincial Standard Specification 710.

710.1.3 Special Provisions

A special provision is required with the item "Pavement Marking Obliterating".

September 2011 Page 3 of 6 B710

Page 632: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

710.2 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

QUANTITY CALCULATIONS

For Solid Lines: Station to station distance for each length of solid, 10 cm wide line. For 20 cm lines the length is doubled. Stop blocks are measured in 10 cm equivalents.

For Broken Lines: Station to station distance for each length of broken line, divided by the sum of the length of the stripe plus gap, multiplied by the length of the stripe.

e.g. for 3m - 6 m marking

Q = ((D/(3+6)) x 3 = (D/9) x 3 = D/3

Individual quantity entries should be divisible by the length of the stripe.

Line markings are calculated separately for solid lines, broken lines, white or yellow.

Marking symbols (arrows etc.) are counted individually.

Pavement marking obliterating quantities are distances in metres of actual lengths to be obliterated.

710.3 DOCUMENTATION

Generally, traffic marking schemes prepared by Regional Traffic are required for any permanent pavement marking (paint or durable) and for temporary pavement marking, i.e. detours, traffic shifts and diversions. The marking schemes will become part of the contract drawings or alternatively, they may be given to construction to be handed to the successful bidder.

In either case, the scheme must show station to station and location of:

Type of Marking Colour Width

Solid Line White 10 cm

20 cm

September 2011 Page 4 of 6 B710

Page 633: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

Yellow 10 cm

Broken Line White 10 cm

20 cm

Yellow 10 cm

Symbols (Arrows, Letters, Numbers)

White -

Each line marking item may require one or more columns on the Quantity Sheet (Quantities - Miscellaneous I or II). In these columns different types of lines, solid, broken, white or yellow are documented separately, totalled and combined into one tender item.

Each marking symbol item requires a separate column on the quantity sheet. The columns are totalled to arrive at the Tender Total.

Tender Totals are transferred to the tender documentation.

When the contractor is not given the option of choosing the marking materials, as allowed by the specification, the designer must indicate the specific material in the headings of the quantity sheet. The recommendation for a specific marking material must come from the district after consultation with the Maintenance Operations Office.

Documentation for the item "Pavement Marking Obliterating" is similar to the documentation for other pavement marking items. Solid lines, broken lines, stop blocks, etc., are detailed in separate columns. The separate columns are combined into one tender item total and transferred to the tender document.

710.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Tender Totals are given in whole numbers, stations are recorded in whole number metres.

September 2011 Page 5 of 6 B710

Page 634: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PAVEMENT MARKING

Marking Material - Selection Guide

Tender Item TrafficVolume AADT

Per Lane

Traffic Paint Temp. Preformed Plastic, Pavement

Marking Tape

Durable Pavement * Marking Material

Organic Solvent Based

Water Based

Remov-able

Non-Remov-

able

FieldReacted

Thermo-Plastic **

Preformed Plastic Tape

Pavement Marking (2-lane, 4-lane, sideroads)All Edge Lines

< 5000 X X - - - - -

> 5000 X X - - X X X

multilane, hot mix or concrete

< 5000 X X - - X X X

Pavement Marking Symbols (stop blocks, arrows, letters)

- X X - - X X X

< 5000 - - - - X X XPavement Marking - Durable (multi-lane, hot mix or concrete) > 5000 - - - - X X X

Pavement Marking Symbols - Durable

- - - - - X X X

< 5000 X X X X - - -Pavement Marking - Temporary (detours, lane shifts) > 5000 X X X X - - -

Pavement Marking Symbols - Temporary

- X X X X - - -

Pavement Marking Temporary - Removable

- - - X - - - -

Pavement Marking Symbols, Temporary - Removable

- - - X - - - -

* Durable Pavement marking materials are not recommended without illumination. ** Thermo plastics are not recommended on concrete pavements or on asphalt pavements older than

one year.

September 2011 Page 6 of 6 B710

Page 635: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ADJUST CGR and CGR POST REPLACEMENT

B721-1 - ADJUST CABLE GUIDE RAIL and CABLE GUIDE RAIL POST REPLACEMENT - OPSS 721

721-1.1 GENERAL

Cable guide rail (CGR) systems consist of three steel cables mounted on wooden posts. The system is anchored by concrete blocks. The performance of the system is extremely sensitive to mounting height and the tension of the cables. Refer to the Roadside Safety Manual for further information on CGR. This applies to the adjustment of existing CGR only. For new CGR installations, refer to CDED B799-8.

721-1.2 REFERENCES Roadside Safety Manual Highway Design Bulletin (HDB) 2011-003

721-1.3 TENDER ITEM Adjust Cable Guide Rail (Normal, metre, PQP) Cable Guide Rail Post Replacement (Normal, each, PQP)

721-1.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for the adjustment of CGR and CGR post replacement are contained in OPSS 721.

721-1.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions.

721-1.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSDs).

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 B721-1

Page 636: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ADJUST CGR and CGR POST REPLACEMENT

721-1.7 DESIGN Allowable deviations from standard mounting heights of existing CGR on pavement rehabilitation projects are provided in the Roadside Safety Manual and HDB 2011-003. The purpose of the “Adjust Cable Guide Rail” item is to allow for the adjustment of the mounting height of an existing CGR installation. Generally, adjustment is necessary at locations where the pavement rehabilitation strategy will raise the existing ground elevation adjacent to an existing guide rail installation. An evaluation of existing guide rail will provide the designer with an inventory of the type of existing guide rail systems as well as the existing mounting height. When adjusting CGR systems, the posts remain in their current location and the cables are reinstalled at the new mounting height. If the CGR was installed according to OPSD 913.130, there should be approximately 150 mm of space available for adjustment assuming that this is the first adjustment. The cables are not to be installed within 200 mm of the top of the posts. This ensures that the cables do not interfere with the reflectorized strip. The “Adjust Cable Guide Rail” tender item also includes the removal and replacement of cable clamps and nails, the installation of one new turnbuckle per cable between anchor blocks, and the installation of new reflectorized strips. When a section of existing CGR that is in acceptable condition according to HDB 2011-003 has existing CGR posts that will be in conflict with construction work such as replacement of a culvert, the posts may be replaced under the “Cable Guide Rail Post Replacement” item.

721-1.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. For the adjust cable guide rail item, compute measurement in metres, from centre to centre of anchor blocks, along the centre line of the guide rail installation, with no additions made for the overlapping length at intermediate anchor blocks. Compute cable guide rail post replacement in units of each post.

721-1.9 DOCUMENTATION Enter adjust CGR quantities, scaled from plans, onto the “Quantities - Miscellaneous 1” sheet, showing station to station and location, left or right, with offsets if required. Use a separate line for each installation of CGR.

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 B721-1

Page 637: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ADJUST CGR and CGR POST REPLACEMENT

Adjust CGR is shown on the contract drawings with the OPSD number shown adjacent to the symbol. Enter cable guide rail post replacement locations, scaled from plans, onto the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheet, showing station to station and location, left or right, with offsets if required. Use a separate line for each segment of post replacement. The number of posts to be replaced for each segment will be entered as the quantity. The length of each segment of post replacement should be a multiple of the standard 3.6 m post spacing. The limits of cable guide rail post replacement are shown on the contract drawings.

721-1.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record station and quantity entries to the nearest whole metre for adjustment length or whole number for post replacement. Record offsets only when the installation is not according to standard, and then to 0.1 m accuracy.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 B721-1

Page 638: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 639: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

B721-2 - STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL - OPSS.PROV 721 721-2.1 GENERAL Steel beam guide rail (SBGR) is a semi-rigid barrier system which restrains and

redirects vehicles by a combination of beam bending (W-shaped steel section), tension, and the lateral restraint provided by the posts (wooden or steel).

Optimum SBGR performance depends on the proper mounting height of the beam. It

is essential that this height is maintained for the full service life of the installation. SBGR systems can be used for roadside or median applications. The single rail

SBGR system is used as a roadside barrier while the double rail SBGR system is used as a median barrier or core-collector separator.

Refer to the Roadside Safety Manual for further information on SBGR. 721-2.2 REFERENCES CDED Section B206-1 - Earth Excavation (Grading) Roadside Safety Manual Highway Design Bulletin 2004-001 Highway Design Bulletin 2005-001 Highway Design Bulletin 2005-003 Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001 Highway Design Bulletin 2007-004 Highway Design Bulletin 2008-001 Highway Design Bulletin 2011-003 Highway Standards Branch DCSO #2016-01 721-2.3 TENDER ITEMS

• Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail (variation type, by m, PQP) • Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail, Base Plated

For Shallow Culverts (variation type, by m, PQP) • Single Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail with Channel (variation type, by m, PQP) • Double Rail Steel Beam Guide Rail (variation type, by m, PQP) • Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Wooden Posts (variation type, by m, PQP) • Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Steel Posts (variation type, by m, PQP) • Adjust Steel Beam Guide Rail, Steel Posts with

Steel Offset Blocks (variation type, by m, PQP)

July 2016 Page 1 of 10 B721-2

Page 640: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

721-2.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for SBGR are contained in OPSS.PROV 721. 721-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to chapter `E' of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions. 721-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of Ontario Provincial

Standard Drawings (OPSDs) and the 900 series of Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTODs).

721-2.7 DESIGN Types of Steel Beam Guide Rail Systems Steel beam guide rail consists of the following three systems:

1) Single rail steel beam guide rail; 2) Single rail steel beam guide rail with channel; and 3) Double rail steel beam guide rail.

A steel channel section can be added to the single rail SBGR system (steel channel is

always provided on double rail SBGR) for the purpose of providing additional stiffness at connections to structures and concrete barriers (to decrease barrier deflection) in accordance with applicable OPSDs. Although the use of guide rail adjacent to curb and gutter is not desirable, single rail SBGR with channel can be placed adjacent to curb and gutter. Double rail SBGR can only be placed adjacent to mountable curb and gutter.

Length of Guide Rail Systems For warrants in choosing the appropriate length of guide rail refer to the Roadside

Safety Manual and the Memorandum: Guide Rail Protection on the Inside of Horizontal Curves & Length of Barrier Protection for Water Hazards (Nov. 18, 2002).

Shoulder Rounding The minimum shoulder rounding width for installation of SBGR is 1.0 m.

July 2016 Page 2 of 10 B721-2

Page 641: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

Types of Steel Beam Guide Rail Type M (M20 and M30) steel beam guide rail is a modified version of the single rail

steel beam guide rail system. Type M SBGR may be installed up to a maximum offset of 125 mm beyond the gutter

line of barrier curb or mountable curb. Where sidewalks are provided, the system should be installed a minimum offset of 1.8 m beyond the gutter line of barrier curb.

Steel channel shall not be used with Type M SBGR, except at structure approaches as

an interim measure. Until new Type M structure connection(s) are finalized and implemented, new Type M SBGR installations will require a Type M transition rail with a nominal length of 2 m in accordance with MTOD 912.124 to transition to a nominal standard length of 20 m of SBGR with Channel for the overlapped structure connection in accordance with applicable OPSDs.

Types of Posts

SBGR (with or without channel) shall be installed using either steel posts with routed

wooden blocks, steel posts with plastic blocks, or wooden posts with wooden blocks. Installations having a mix of steel and wooden posts in a complete system are not acceptable, with the exception of end terminals, where breakaway wooden posts are required. Extension of an existing wooden post installation with steel posts shall only be allowed when the extension length is greater than 100 m.

Anchoring of System Ends Each end of the system should be anchored by an appropriate end treatment, end

terminal system, or structure / concrete barrier connection.

A. End Terminal Systems

A crashworthy end terminal system shall be installed at the following locations: • Approach end on divided highways and one-way ramps; • Approach and leaving end on undivided highways and two-way ramps; and • Left (median) shoulder on the leaving end on divided highways when the

leaving end is located within the clear zone for opposing traffic. For information regarding the selection of end terminal systems, refer to the Roadside Safety Manual and Highway Design Bulletin 2005-001. For Type M20 and Type M30 SBGR installations, Type M (MGS) Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal systems shall be used.

July 2016 Page 3 of 10 B721-2

Page 642: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

B. Leaving End Treatments: The leaving end treatment is to be installed on divided highways and one-way ramps. The leaving end treatment should not be installed on undivided highways or as an approach terminal system. When SBGR is installed on the left (median) shoulder of a divided highway, the leaving end treatment should not be used when the end of the SBGR is located within the clear zone for opposing traffic. Post 1 of the leaving end treatment should be located at least 4 m beyond the end of the obstacle being shielded. The buried leaving end treatment shall no longer be used for new installations.

Treatments at Culverts With Minimal Cover and Other Buried Structure Locations The treatment at culverts with minimal cover is to be used to span over top of larger

culverts or other buried structures that have less than 1.1 m of backfill and cover material. At each location where the treatment at culverts with minimal cover is installed, the embankment shall be widened to the minimum dimensions specified on the OPSD, as required. Similar details are also available for Type M30 SBGR on applicable MTODs. Refer to CDED Section B206-1, Highway Design Bulletin 2005-003, and Highway Standards Branch DCSO #2016-01 for more information.

At culvert and other buried structure locations, with less than 1.1 m of cover, where the SBGR length over the structure is greater than 7.6 m, the MTOD 912.249 treatment shall be used.

Installations at Rock Cut Locations The rock cut installation method for both steel and wooden SBGR posts is to be used

if solid rock exists within the full standard length of post embedment. Minimum hole diameters as specified on the MTOD shall be provided by the contractor. This installation method is not necessary for SBGR installations in rock fill where solid rock is not expected to be located within the full standard length of post embedment. Refer to Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001 for more information. Installations for Entrances and Intersecting Roadways

The steel beam installation for entrances and intersecting roadways is used to specify the construction details of a roadside SBGR system around the radius of an intersecting roadway or entrance. For applicable radii, refer to OPSD 912.531. SBGR installations on radii exceeding that specified on OPSD 912.531 do not require this treatment.

July 2016 Page 4 of 10 B721-2

Page 643: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

Retrofitting SBGR at Existing Embankments For retrofit of SBGR to existing embankments, ensure that the embankment cross-

section is adequate to accommodate the installation with the breakpoint in the rounding located at the backside of the posts and the granular base and subbase at a slope of 3H:1V or flatter. Where embankment widening is necessary, ensure that drainage requirements are properly addressed.

Adjustment of Existing SBGR Installations Mounting height tolerances for SBGR are specified in OPSS.PROV 721. There are

three tender items available for adjustment of SBGR. The purpose of these items is to allow for the adjustment of the mounting height of an existing SBGR installation on wooden or steel posts. Generally, adjustment is necessary at locations where the pavement rehabilitation strategy will raise the existing ground elevation adjacent to an existing guide rail installation. An evaluation of the existing guide rail will provide the designer with an inventory of the type of existing guide rail systems as well as existing mounting height. Existing SBGR installations may consist of the following configurations:

1) Wooden posts with wooden offset blocks:

Although still installed today, these systems were used primarily in the years prior to implementation of SBGR on steel posts in 1995. When adjusting these systems, the posts remain in their current location, but the offset block and rail (and channel, where necessary) are reinstalled at the new mounting height. If the guide rail was installed according to OPSD 912.140, there should be approximately 150 mm of space available for adjustment assuming this is the first adjustment. The evaluation of existing guide rail should determine whether the existing installation can accommodate the proposed change in height.

2) Steel post with steel offset blocks: Steel post systems have been the most common SBGR configuration since they were first implemented in 1995 mainly due to their relative ease of handling and installation. Steel offset blocks were used exclusively with steel post systems from 1995 through 2002 when the standard was revised to specify routed wooden blocks. When they are adjusted, existing steel post systems with steel offset blocks will be retrofitted with routed wooden or plastic offset blocks. This requires the punching of a new hole to accommodate the wooden or plastic offset block.

July 2016 Page 5 of 10 B721-2

Page 644: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

3) Steel posts with wooden or plastic offset blocks: From 2003 through to early 2008, steel post systems were installed exclusively with routed wooden offset blocks. In 2008, plastic offset blocks were implemented as an alternative to the routed wooden offset blocks. Since that time, steel post systems with plastic offset blocks have been the most common SBGR system.

Selection of the appropriate tender item for adjustment of each installation will ensure that the Contractor addresses the unique adjustment requirements of each system configuration. Tender items for SBGR adjustment include the removal and replacement of existing hardware including bolts, washers, and nuts as well as the installation of new reflectors. For SBGR with steel offset blocks, replacement of the steel offset blocks with plastic or wooden offset blocks is included. Review of Existing End Terminals and Leaving End Treatments Existing end terminals and leaving end treatments should be reviewed when SBGR is being considered for adjustment. A. Existing End Terminals

Existing end terminals may consist of eccentric loader terminal (ELT) systems, extruder terminal (ET) systems, or sequential kinking terminal (SKT) systems: ELT Systems: • Replace ELT installations that are greater than or equal to 5 years in age with a

new steel beam energy attenuating terminal (SBEAT) system. However, an SBEAT System cannot be installed on a horizontal curve with a radius of less than 190m; in this case, a new ELT is to be installed;

ET and SKT Systems: • Existing ET and SKT Systems consist of several different variations on wooden

and steel posts. • Replace ET and SKT System installations on wooden posts with a new SBEAT

System. • ET and SKT Systems on steel posts that are in good condition may be adjusted.

July 2016 Page 6 of 10 B721-2

Page 645: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

B. Leaving End Treatments Existing leaving end treatments may consist of buried leaving end treatments (formerly OPSD 912.233) or upright “fishtail” ends: • Buried leaving end treatments are a challenge to adjust and could be replaced

with a standard leaving end treatment according to OPSD 912.235. This would require the removal of 16 m of existing SBGR and subsequent installation of 4 m of new SBGR according to OPSD 912.235;

• Existing upright “fishtail” type end treatments typically have been installed

based on the extension requirements for unanchored guide rail in accordance with Table 3.4.2 in the Roadside Safety Manual. When replacing an upright “fishtail” end treatment, ensure that the standard OPSD 912.235 SBGR leaving end treatment extends a minimum of 4 m beyond the hazard;

• Where an existing buried end treatment or upright “fishtail” end treatment is on

the leaving end of a SBGR installation located on an undivided highway or at a location on a divided highway where the end of the SBGR is located within the clear zone for opposing traffic, the treatment should be considered for replacement with a crashworthy end terminal (e.g. SBEAT System).

721-2.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. Quantities are computed in metres, and measured horizontally from end to end along

the centre line of the installation. The horizontal length shall include the following when specified:

• End treatments; • Rock cut installations; • Installation at entrances and intersecting roadways; • Permanent transition installations at median hazards; • Permanent connections to concrete barrier; and • Structure connections.

SBGR terminal systems are included in separate tender items to the limits specified

on the appropriate OPSD and are not included in the lengths for the tender items detailed above in 721-2.3.

Where guide rail systems overlap in a transition between different types of systems,

compute the length of each system under the corresponding guide rail item, as if the

July 2016 Page 7 of 10 B721-2

Page 646: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

other type did not exist. Terminal systems that form part of transitions shall be counted under the appropriate terminal system tender items.

SBGR treatment at culverts and other buried structures with minimal cover, including

base plates are included as a separate tender item to the limits specified on the appropriate MTOD and are not included in the lengths for the tender items detailed above in 721-2.3.

721-2.9 DOCUMENTATION SBGR and Adjust SBGR quantities are variation items. Separate columns on the

“Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets are required for each variation to indicate the type and location of each SBGR type including treatments by applicable OPSD or MTOD, showing station to station and location, left or right of centreline. Provide offsets if required. For Adjust SBGR, locations where existing channel is to be reinstalled are shown in a separate column with column notation “With Channel”.

New Installations For new installations, SBGR is depicted on the contract drawings with the designation

“SBGR”, or “SBGR with Channel”, as appropriate, shown adjacent to the symbol. Detail the station and offset for the start and end of each change in direction and/or offset of SBGR.

For new installations of Type M SBGR, the systems including treatments are depicted

on the contract drawings with the designation “Type M20 SBGR” or “Type M30 SBGR” and the appropriate MTOD number shown adjacent to the symbol. Detail the station and offset for the start and end of each change in type and/or direction and/or offset of Type SBGR.

Retrofit Situations

For retrofit situations where existing SBGR is being extended or partially replaced, the SBGR should be depicted on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD number (912.130 or 912.140) such that the new post type will match the existing post type (i.e. steel or wooden). Median Installations For median installations, double rail SBGR is depicted on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD number shown adjacent to the symbol.

July 2016 Page 8 of 10 B721-2

Page 647: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

Adjustments, End Treatments, Transitions, Connections, and Anchorages Adjust SBGR, end treatments, transitions, structure / concrete barrier connections and anchorage are depicted on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD or MTOD number shown adjacent to the symbol.

The SBGR leaving end treatment is depicted on the contract drawings with the OPSD

or MTOD number shown adjacent to the SBGR symbol. Document the SBGR leaving end treatment under the standard item, single rail SBGR. Include full payment for this treatment under this item for the equivalent length of single rail SBGR (up to Post 1). Identify locations of this treatment in the Q-sheets, showing both the beginning and end stations, and left or right of centreline and noting in the location and position column “Leaving End Treatment”.

Treatments at Culverts With Minimal Cover Document the SBGR or Type M SBGR treatment at culverts with minimal cover,

with a culvert length less than 7.6m (MTOD 912.245 & 912.246) under the standard item, single rail SBGR. Include full payment for this treatment under this item for the equivalent length of single rail SBGR. Culvert lengths greater than 7.6m require base plated Type M SBGR and shall use a separate tender item. Length is defined as culvert length parallel to roadway to include any skew. This length shall be subtracted from the total SBGR length as it is under a separate item. Identify locations of this treatment in the Q-sheets in a column under the applicable OPSD or MTOD reference, showing both the beginning and end stations, and left or right of centreline and noting in the location and position column “Treatment at Culverts with Minimal Cover”. Show the location of the embankment widening on the contract drawings. Show the dimensions of embankment widening on cross-sections. Payment for grading should be made under the appropriate grading items.

Rock Cut Installations

For rock cut installation, the length of SBGR installed in rock cut areas shall be listed

in a separate column in the Q-sheet with the heading [Rock installation per MTOD 912.131] and stations shall be noted in the location and position column.

Installations at Entrances and Intersecting Roadways

For steel beam installation for entrances and intersecting roadways, specify the curve

radius and angle-of-curve, D. Include the length of rail installation in the tender quantity for the SBGR item. Document the end treatment or terminal system, as applicable, according to the appropriate CDED Chapter B Section.

July 2016 Page 9 of 10 B721-2

Page 648: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM GUIDE RAIL

721-2.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record station and quantity entries to the nearest whole metre. Record offsets when the installation is not according to standard, and then to 0.1 m

accuracy. Where SBGR is to be mounted beside curb and gutter, document the appropriate offsets in the contract drawings.

July 2016 Page 10 of 10 B721-2

Page 649: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

B723 – ENERGY ATTENUATORS – OPSS.PROV 723 723.1 GENERAL

Various proprietary permanent and temporary energy attenuators are used to reduce the hazard associated with the ends of permanent and temporary concrete barriers. Tables 1 and 2 in OPSS 723 list the names of systems acceptable for the items Energy Attenuator - Permanent, and Energy Attenuator - Temporary for several applications. The Contractor is given the option of supplying and installing any of the listed systems specified in the contract documents for the appropriate tender item. The energy attenuators all meet the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350. Additional background information can be found in Highway Design Bulletin 2009-003, Energy Attenuators for Concrete Barrier.

723.2 REFERENCES CDED B206-1 - Earth Excavation Grading Roadside Safety Manual Highway Design Bulletin 2009-003, Energy Attenuators for Concrete Barrier

723.3 TENDER ITEMS Energy Attenuator – Permanent, Narrow (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Permanent, Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Permanent, Extra Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Permanent, Super Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Permanent, High Exposure (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Permanent, Single Sided Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Narrow (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Extra Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Super Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Reduced Exposure (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Temporary, Dual Duty (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Narrow (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Extra Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Super Wide (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Reduced Exposure (Variation) Energy Attenuator – Relocation, Dual Duty (Variation)

March 2016 Page 1 of 6 B723

Page 650: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

723.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the Energy Attenuators are contained in OPSS 723.

723.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

723.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable Standard Drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

723.7 DESIGN Foundations: A permanent energy attenuator installation includes a new concrete pad. If an existing concrete surface or pad can be used to support the system, it should be specified in the Contract Documents. Temporary energy attenuators are typically installed on an existing surface. The designer should confirm that one of the following foundation options is available for each temporary energy attenuator installation: a. Existing concrete surface:

- min. 200 mm deep, 28 MPa min. compressive strength

b. Asphalt over compacted granular: - min. 150 mm asphalt over 150 mm min. compacted granular - the asphalt must extend a minimum of 500 mm beyond the anchor bolts

c. Asphalt over concrete: - min. 75 mm asphalt over 75 mm min. concrete, 28 MPa min. compressive

strength

If the existing surface is not suitable for the temporary installation, a concrete pad should be specified in the Contract Documents.

March 2016 Page 2 of 6 B723

Page 651: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

The designer should confirm that any existing concrete surface or pad is in good condition and will provide a smooth operating surface for the system. Unidirectional vs. Bidirectional Installations: The term “unidirectional” describes an installation configuration where traffic flow passes the energy attenuator system on one or both sides in the same direction from the upstream direction of travel (i.e. approaching the impact head of the energy attenuator). For unidirectional installations, there is no requirement for a transition panel to connect the energy attenuator to the concrete barrier because reverse direction impacts are not expected. Examples of unidirectional installations include, but are not limited to roadside shoulder installations on divided highways and one-way ramps as well as gore areas at freeway exit ramps or core-collector transfers. The term “bidirectional” describes an installation configuration where traffic flow passes the energy attenuator in the reverse / opposing direction of travel (i.e. approaching the leaving end / corner of the energy attenuator immediately adjacent to the concrete barrier). For bidirectional installations, there is a requirement for the contractor to install a transition panel to connect the energy attenuator to the concrete barrier in order to minimize the risk of a reverse direction impact snagging upon the rearmost fender panel of the energy attenuator. Examples of bidirectional installations include, but are not limited to undivided highways and narrow medians where reverse direction impacts are possible. The unidirectional / bidirectional designation is not required when specifying the single-sided tender items since the QuadTrend and BB-BEAT Systems are always physically connected to the concrete barrier. Single-Sided Installations: For single-sided installations, the granular base and earth or rock slopes for the roadway shall be widened in accordance with the minimum dimensions detailed in the appropriate OPSD. Where the roadway is being widened for installation of the terminal, ensure that drainage requirements are properly addressed. Single-sided systems should not be installed in a location where backside hits towards the concrete barrier are possible (e.g. in gore areas), or in a narrow median where backside, opposite direction hits are possible. The area behind and beyond the system should be traversable and free of fixed objects. The minimum recommended rectangular area should be 6 m wide, measured behind and perpendicular to the back of the rail, by 22 m long, measured from the front face of the system and parallel to the system.

March 2016 Page 3 of 6 B723

Page 652: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

Reduced Exposure Systems: The reduced exposure tender item provides the Contractor with the option of supplying water filled energy attenuator system as an alternative to the conventional narrow energy attenuator systems. When a reduced exposure tender item is selected, the designer should confirm that the following requirements for water filled energy attenuator systems are satisfied: a. Water filled energy attenuator systems shall be installed at an offset of not less

than 1.0 m from the edge of the travelled way. b. When installed adjacent to an existing guide rail system, the clearance shall be

less than or equal to 0.3 m or greater than or equal to 3.0 m. Otherwise, the area behind and beyond the water filled energy attenuator system shall be traversable and free of fixed objects. The minimum recommended rectangular area shall be 6 m wide, measured behind and perpendicular to the back of the system, by 22 m long, measured from the front face of the system and parallel to the system.

c. At a minimum, the first 16 m of temporary concrete barrier shall be placed

tangential to the water filled energy attenuator system. d. Water filled energy attenuator systems should not be placed where they are

planned to be left in place during a seasonal shutdown period. Curb and Gutter: Wherever possible, the designer should eliminate the use of curb with gutter in advance of and along the length of energy attenuators. See the Roadside Safety Manual for additional information.

723.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. The quantity is based on each completed installation. The unit of measurement for Energy Attenuators is each complete installation.

March 2016 Page 4 of 6 B723

Page 653: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

723.9 DOCUMENTATION The tender items are variation items (with the exception of single sided energy attenuators). Provide two columns on the quantity sheet to indicate whether each attenuator installation is a TL-2 or TL-3 configuration: • TL-3 configurations are required for high-speed installations with posted speeds

of 70 km/h and greater. • TL-2 configurations may be used for low-speed installations with posted speeds of

less than 70 km/h. Enter each installation in the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading. Enter the station at the back end of the system (at the interface between the energy attenuator and the concrete barrier or object) and indicate location, left, right, or median. Total each column and sum the TL-2 and TL-3 installations. For each permanent energy attenuator installation where there is a suitable existing concrete surface or pad, note in the location and position column of the Q-sheet: “Install on Existing Concrete Surface or Pad”, as applicable. Temporary energy attenuators are typically installed on an existing surface. For those locations where the existing surface is not suitable, a standard concrete pad should be provided. For those locations, note in the location and position column of the Q-sheet: “Install on Concrete Pad”. For all permanent installations, use the “Energy Attenuator – Permanent” standard item for the appropriate application (i.e. Wide, Extra Wide, etc.). For all temporary installations, use the “Energy Attenuator – Temporary” and “Energy Attenuator – Relocation” standard items for the appropriate application (i.e. Wide, Extra Wide, etc.). The “Energy Attenuator – Temporary” standard items pay for the supply, installation, and removal of the units. The total cannot exceed the largest number of units in place at any one time during the contract. The “Energy Attenuator – Relocation” items are comprised of all relocations during the contract. Show the location of each Energy Attenuator, Permanent and/or Temporary, and each Energy Attenuator Relocation on the contract drawings with the appropriate notation (from Table 3 in OPSS 723) shown adjacent to the symbol.

March 2016 Page 5 of 6 B723

Page 654: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ENERGY ATTENUATORS

Single-Sided Installations: For single-sided installations, show the location of the roadway widening on the contract drawings (see section B206-1, "Earth Excavation (Grading)" for more information) with the appropriate OPSD number shown adjacent to the system. Also, show roadway widening on the cross sections. Payment for all grading shall be made under appropriate grading items. When a single-sided system is connected to existing concrete barrier, the designer should include payment in the Contract Documents for the removal of the 4.0 m section of existing concrete barrier and placement of a new 4.0 m section adjacent to each system.

723.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and indicate median, left, or right side of road. The quantity is the number of units required.

March 2016 Page 6 of 6 B723

Page 655: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM ENERGY ATTENUATING TERMINAL (SBEAT) SYSTEMS

B732 - STEEL BEAM ENERGY ATTENUATING TERMINAL (SBEAT) SYSTEMS - OPSS.PROV 732

732-5.1 GENERAL

Two proprietary end terminal systems are available to terminate the ends of steel beam guide rail. OPSS.PROV 732 and applicable Standard Special Provision specifies the systems that are acceptable for the SBEAT item. The contractor selects the type of SBEAT system to be installed as a terminal for SBGR. The systems meet the crash test acceptance requirements of AASHTO Manual for Assessing Safety Hardware (MASH) Test Level (TL)-3, as indicated on the applicable OPSDs or MTODs. Application: 1) End terminal for single-sided median and shoulder installations of SBGR. 2) End terminal for single-sided concrete barrier, provided that the appropriate

SBGR transition to concrete barrier is included.

732-5.2 REFERENCES CDED B206-1 (Earth Excavation (Grading)) CDED B721-2 (Steel Beam Guide Rail) CDED B799-9 (Steel Beam Terminal) Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001, Steel Beam Guide Rail - Posts Into Rock

732-5.3 TENDER ITEM Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal System (variation, each, PQP)

732-5.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for SBEAT systems are contained in OPSS.PROV 732.

732-5.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

December 2016 Page 1 of 4 B732

Page 656: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM ENERGY ATTENUATING TERMINAL (SBEAT) SYSTEMS

732-5.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) and the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD). Grading requirements are contained in the 200 series of OPSDs. Delineation requirements are contained in the 900 series of OPSDs.

732-5.7 DESIGN SBEAT systems have been developed as end terminals for single-sided installations of SBGR (Type M20 or M30). Where applicable, a transition from SBGR to concrete barrier shall not be within the length of the SBEAT. SBEAT systems are nominally 14.3 m long and contribute nominally 10.5 m to the length-of-need for SBGR installations. Earlier versions of SBEATs that met the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350 TL-3 for use with earlier versions of SBGR had a nominal length 15.24 m.

SBEAT systems may be installed on horizontal curves with a minimum centreline radius of 190 m. For horizontal curves with a centerline radius less than 190 m, a Steel Beam Terminal (refer to CDED 799-9) shall be used. It is desirable to widen the roadway platform and flare the SBEAT away from the shoulder over the length of installation, to reduce the potential of nuisance hits. Flare rates for SBEAT systems are provided in Table 1.

Table 1 Flare Rates for SBEAT Systems

SBEAT Location Flare Rate Offset at Post 1 Notes Inside of Horizontal Curve

R ≥ 190 m 50:1 0.3 m Always

Outside of Horizontal Curve R ≥ 420 m 50:1 0.3 m Always

Outside of Horizontal Curve 190 m ≤ R < 420 m 50:1 to 25:1 0.3 to 0.6 m Always

Note: Where R is the centreline radius of the roadway. The granular base and earth or rock slopes for the roadway shall be widened to accommodate the terminal in accordance with the appropriate 200 series OPSD. Grading for SBEAT installations on horizontal curves may exceed the minimum

December 2016 Page 2 of 4 B732

Page 657: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM ENERGY ATTENUATING TERMINAL (SBEAT) SYSTEMS

dimensions shown on the OPSDs. Design cross sections shall ensure that the SBEAT can be installed at the appropriate flare rate shown in Table 1. Where the roadway is being widened for installation of an SBEAT, ensure that drainage requirements are properly addressed. Designers have the flexibility to extend the length of SBGR installations to a location where desirable grading requirements can be accommodated. Designers also have the flexibility to reduce the desirable grading requirements for new SBEAT installations when constrained by environmental or property restrictions. This may include reducing the desirable widening behind terminal post 1 and/or increasing the steepness of the slope behind the system to 3:1 in accordance with appropriate 200 series OPSD.

Desirably, the area immediately downstream of the approach of the SBEAT, behind the SBGR, should be traversable and clear for a minimum distance of 22 m long by 6 m wide in accordance with appropriate 200 series OPSD.

732-5.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The quantity is based on each installation. The unit of measurement for SBEAT is each.

732-5.9 DOCUMENTATION The tender item is a variation item. Provide up to three columns (as necessary) on the quantity sheet to indicate whether each SBEAT installation is installed ‘Parallel to Roadway’, at a ‘50:1 Flare’, or at a ‘25:1 Flare’ (on curves). Enter each SBEAT installation in the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading. Enter the station at the back end of the system (at the interface between the SBEAT and the SBGR) and indicate location, left or right of centreline. The length of an SBEAT is 14.3 m. Show the locations of the SBEAT system(s) on the contract drawings with “SBEAT” shown adjacent to the symbol. Show the location of the roadway widening on the contract drawings (see section CDED B206-1 for more information) with the appropriate 200 series OPSD number

December 2016 Page 3 of 4 B732

Page 658: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM ENERGY ATTENUATING TERMINAL (SBEAT) SYSTEMS

shown adjacent to the terminal. Also, show roadway widening on the cross sections. Payment for all grading shall be made under appropriate grading items. Locations where SBEAT posts and/or other underground hardware require excavation of rock shall be noted in the Q-sheets, as stated in CDED B721-2 and Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001.

732-5.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and indicate left or right side of road. The quantity is the number of units required. Record offsets only when the installation is not according to standard and then to 0.1 m accuracy.

December 2016 Page 4 of 4 B732

Page 659: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE BARRIER

February 2014 Page 1 of 3 B740

B740 - CONCRETE BARRIER - OPSS 740 740.1 GENERAL

Permanent concrete barriers (Types A, C, and TW) are either slip-formed or cast in place by conventional wooden or steel formwork, or may be precast when specified by the designer. Asymmetric concrete barrier shall be used when required to accommodate a grade differential (of up to 600 mm) between opposing traffic lanes, according to the Roadside Safety Manual. Designers should refer to the Roadside Safety Manual in the selection of the applicable type of concrete barrier systems to be used on a project.

740.2 REFERENCES Roadside Safety Manual

740.3 TENDER ITEMS Concrete Barrier (variation item) Tall Wall Barrier (variation item) Asymmetric Concrete Barrier (variation item) Asymmetric Tall Wall Barrier (variation item)

740.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for concrete barrier are contained in OPSS 740.

740.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

Page 660: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE BARRIER

February 2014 Page 2 of 3 B740

740.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings (OPSD).

740.7 DESIGN For installation in a roadside configuration, ensure that the Concrete Barrier is

embedded on the backside by widening the embankment a minimum of 0.5 m between the backside of the barrier and the breakpoint of the slope. Refer to the Roadside Safety Manual for additional information.

Concrete barrier should be embedded a minimum of 75 mm into the adjacent asphalt.

740.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. Quantities are computed in metres. Measurements are scaled or measured along the centreline of each installation. Where two concrete barriers are constructed back to back, Type 'A-2' or ‘TW-2’, they are measured as a single installation.

740.9 DOCUMENTATION

Concrete barriers are depicted on the contract drawing with the OPSD number and barrier type shown adjacent to the symbol. Barrier lengths are computed and entered on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheet without deduction for lighting pole or overhead sign footings. Each type of concrete or tall wall barrier, back to back installations, transition treatment, or end treatments must be identified in separate columns by specifying the appropriate OPSD or typical section reference at the top of each column. The station to station limits and lengths for each type of installation must be specified. The column subtotals are combined into the tender quantity for each respective tender item. When asymmetric barriers are required the designer will show the pavement elevations on both sides of the barrier at the following intervals on the contract drawings: - at all break points in the vertical alignment of the barrier or the shoulders.

Page 661: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE BARRIER

February 2014 Page 3 of 3 B740

- at the normal cross section interval throughout the tangent section. - at 10 metre intervals within the transition from tangent to full superelevation. - at the normal cross section interval throughout the superelevated section.

740.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole metre. Offsets when required are recorded to 0.1 of a metre. Spot checking required.

Page 662: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 663: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS

B741 – TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS - OPSS 741 741.1 GENERAL

Temporary concrete barriers (TCBs) are precast units that are installed with interlocking devices connecting consecutive sections. The following types of connections are acceptable for use on roadways with posted speeds less than 70 km/h: • I-Lock • Type J • Type M • Type T • Type X

The following types of connections are acceptable for use on roadways with posted speeds of 70 km/h and greater:

• Type J • Type M • Type T • Type X

The contractor shall select the type of TCB according to the specification and applicable special provisions.

741.1.1 TCB Restraint Systems TCBs are often used to provide separation between traffic and work zones. In locations where inadequate offset is available to allow for deflection of the TCBs (e.g. at edges of excavations, edges of structures, or adjacent to structures not designed for impacts), it may be necessary to restrain the barrier to minimize deflection. Restraining details have been successfully crash tested to NCHRP Report 350 TL-3 for the Type M TCB. The three restraint systems acceptable for use in MTO contracts include the following: 1) Pinning to asphalt pavement 2) Strapping to concrete pavement or bridge deck (with or without asphalt overlay) 3) Bolting through concrete bridge deck (with or without asphalt overlay) Only the TCB Type M connection should be used with restraint systems.

July 2015 Page 1 of 5 B741

Page 664: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS

Unrestrained TCB should be transitioned to restrained TCB as shown on the applicable OPSD. Similarly, unrestrained TCB should be transitioned to permanent concrete barrier as shown on the applicable OPSD. The three “TCB Restraint System” tender items cover only the supply, installation, and removal of the restraint system. “Temporary Concrete Barrier” and “Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation” tender items are computed separately. Designers should refer to Highway Design Bulletin 2008-002 for guidance on when to restrain TCB.

741.1.1 TCB, Reduced Deflection System In locations where 0.5 m minimum offset is available to allow for deflection of the TCBs (e.g. at edges of excavations, edges of structures, or adjacent to structures not designed for impacts), the reduced deflection TCB may be used instead of the restrained system. The Type X TCB does not require any restraint systems, and has been successfully crash tested to NCHRP Report 350 TL-3. Only the Type X TCB should be used for reduced deflection TCB and transitions to freestanding TCB as shown on the applicable MTODs.

741.2 REFERENCES Roadside Safety Manual Highway Design Bulletin 2008-002

741.3 TENDER ITEMS Temporary Concrete Barrier Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation Temporary Concrete Barrier, Drainage Gap Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Pinned Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Strapped Temporary Concrete Barrier Restraint System, Bolted Temporary Concrete Barrier, Reduced Deflection Temporary Concrete Barrier, Reduced Deflection, Relocation The tender item "Temporary Concrete Barrier" is used for the following work: a) Supplying and transporting the barriers to the site;

July 2015 Page 2 of 5 B741

Page 665: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS

b) The initial installation and including any additional barriers required for subsequent staging; and

c) Removal of barriers after construction has been completed. The tender item "Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation" is used for the following work: a) Relocating the barriers within the work area as required for staging or seasonal

shutdown for carryover projects; and b) The temporary storage of barriers at the site or other designated locations as

necessitated by staging or seasonal shutdown for carryover projects.

741.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for TCBs and TCB restraint systems are contained in OPSS 741.

741.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions. Non-standard special provisions are required to specify and provide payment for: • TCB that is to remain on a project upon its completion; • The identification of specific temporary storage sites for TCB that cannot be

accommodated within the project limits during staging or seasonal shutdown on carryover projects; and

• Restoration of asphalt and concrete surfaces that are disturbed during the installation and removal of TCB restraint systems.

741.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings (OPSD) and 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

741.7 DESIGN TCB should be used on a solid surface, such as asphalt or concrete pavement.

July 2015 Page 3 of 5 B741

Page 666: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS

TCB drainage gaps should only be used when justified based on the results of a hydraulic analysis. Prior to the 60% completion stage of detail design, the designer should send to the Ministry’s Design and Contract Standards Office and Bridge Office the proposed location and quantity of TCB restraint systems along with a typical section(s) showing lane widths, shoulder widths, and offset of the TCB to edge of the excavation or structure.

741.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. Quantities are computed in metres. Measurements are scaled or measured along the centreline of each installation.

The unit of measurement for TCB drainage gaps is each complete installation. Transitions from restrained TCB to unrestrained TCB are included in the computed length for the appropriate TCB restraint system. Transitions from reduced deflection TCB to unrestrained TCB are included in the computed length for reduced deflection TCB. When a transition from unrestrained TCB to permanent concrete barrier is included in the contract, the length of the transition is included in the computed length for the appropriate TCB restraint system.

741.9 DOCUMENTATION

TCBs are depicted on the contract drawings with the designation “TCB” or “TCB Relocation” shown adjacent to the symbol. Detail the station and offset for the start and end of each change in direction and/or offset of TCB. Show the locations of the TCB drainage gaps on the contract drawings with the OPSD reference and station shown adjacent to the symbol. Temporary Concrete Barrier - This item pays for the supply of the precast units, the total cannot exceed the largest number of units in place at any one time during the contract. Measurement is from end to end of all locations, restrained and unrestrained.

July 2015 Page 4 of 5 B741

Page 667: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIERS

Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation - This item will be comprised of all relocations during the contract. Measurement is from end to end of each individual relocation. Temporary concrete barrier lengths, temporary concrete barrier, relocation lengths, temporary concrete barrier, reduced deflection lengths, and temporary concrete barrier, reduced deflection, relocation lengths are computed and entered on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets, showing station to station and location, left or right of centreline. Provide offsets if required. For contracts that include multiple construction stages, the quantities shall be broken down by each individual stage. Enter each TCB drainage gap installation in the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading showing station and location, left or right of centreline. Provide offsets if required. For contracts that include multiple construction stages, the quantities shall be broken down by each individual stage. TCB restraint system locations are depicted on the contract drawings with the appropriate OPSD number shown adjacent to the symbol. The limits of restraint shall be clearly indicated. The applicable standard drawings shall be included in the contract. TCB restraint system lengths are computed and entered on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous" sheets under the appropriate column heading, showing station to station and location, left or right of centreline. Provide offsets if required. Total each column and transfer the tender totals to the tender document. For contracts that include multiple construction stages, the quantities shall be broken down by each individual stage. Reduced deflection TCB system lengths are depicted on the contract drawings with the designation “TCB-RD” shown adjacent to the TCB symbol. The minimum 32 m long transitions required on each end of the TCB-RD system are depicted with the designation “TCB-RD-T” shown adjacent to the TCB symbol. Detail the station and offset for the start and end of each change in direction and/or offset of TCB-RD and TCB-RD-T.

741.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole metre. Offsets when required are recorded to 0.1 of a metre. Spot checking required.

July 2015 Page 5 of 5 B741

Page 668: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 669: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MOVABLE TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIER

B741-2 - MOVABLE TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIER - SSP 741S02 741-2.1 GENERAL

Quickchange® moveable barrier (QMB) is a proprietary system by Barrier Systems Inc. that consists of freestanding precast concrete segments that are positively connected to form a continuous barrier that can be frequently shifted laterally with a QMB barrier transfer machine. QMB has been successfully crash tested to NCHRP Report 350 TL-3. Like temporary concrete barriers (TCBs), movable temporary concrete barriers (MTCBs) are used to provide separation between traffic and work zones. MTCBs are shifted laterally to allow for peak hour traffic, expanding work zones, and used in contracts with complex staging. MTCB should only be used when it is more cost effective than standard TCB.

741-2.2 REFERENCES Roadside Safety Manual CDED B723 - Energy Attenuators

741-2.3 TENDER ITEMS Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier (normal, m, PQP) Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation (normal, m, PQP) Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift (normal, LS) The tender item “Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier” is used for the following work: a) Supplying and transporting the barriers to the site; b) The initial installation and including any additional barriers required for

subsequent staging; and c) Removal of barriers after construction has been completed. The tender item “Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation” is used for the following work: a) Relocating the barriers from one location to another within the work area as

required for staging, which typically occurs when construction operations move from one stage to the next, or seasonal shutdown for carryover projects; and

August 2016 Page 1 of 4 B741-2

Page 670: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MOVABLE TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIER

b) The temporary storage of barriers at the site or other designated locations as

necessitated by staging or seasonal shutdown for carryover projects. The tender item “Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift” is used for the following work: a) The lateral displacement of the barriers, which is typically completed to facilitate

the opening or closing of traffic lane(s). The lateral displacement may vary throughout the length of a barrier installation.

741-2.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier are contained in SSP 741S02 as an amendment to OPSS 741.

741-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

741-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

741-2.7 DESIGN MTCB shall be used on a solid surface, such as asphalt or concrete pavement. Prior to the 60% completion stage of detail design, the designer shall send to the Ministry’s Design and Contract Standards Office the proposed location and quantity of MTCB along with a typical section(s) showing lane widths, shoulder widths, and staging configurations. MTCB is only compatible with the Absorb 350 Energy Attenuator System.

August 2016 Page 2 of 4 B741-2

Page 671: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MOVABLE TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIER

741-2.8 COMPUTATION The following are Plan Quantity Payment items: • Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier • Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation Quantities are computed in metres. Measurements are scaled or measured along the centreline of each installation. The following are Lump Sum items: • Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift The number of shifts required for construction is determined by the contractor and paid as lump sum.

741-2.9 DOCUMENTATION 741-2.9.1 Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier

MTCBs are depicted on the contract drawings with the applicable MTOD drawing number. Detail the station and offset for the start and end of each change in direction and/or offset of movable barrier. Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier - This item pays for the supply of the precast units, the total cannot exceed the largest number of units in place at any one time during the contract. Measurement is from end to end of all locations. Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Relocation - This item will be comprised of all barrier relocations during the contract. Measurement is from end to end of each individual relocation. Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift - This item will be comprised of all lateral displacements during the contract. MTCB relocation lengths, and shifts are computed and entered on the “Quantities-Miscellaneous” sheets, showing station to station and location, left or right of centreline. Provide offsets if required. Shifts are paid as lump sum but station locations should still be shown on Q-sheets. For contracts that include multiple construction stages, the quantities shall be broken down by each individual stage.

August 2016 Page 3 of 4 B741-2

Page 672: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING MOVABLE TEMPORARY CONCRETE BARRIER

The designer should include sufficient detail in the Contract Documents (e.g. drawings detailing typical staging cross sections and plan drawings) showing barrier alignment and offsets for conditions before and after the shift operation.

741-2.9.2 Energy Attenuator MTCB is only compatible with the Absorb 350 Energy Attenuator System (MTOD 924.130). Where required, the energy attenuator(s) shall be shown at the end(s) of the MTCB on the contract drawings with the applicable MTOD drawing number. When energy attenuators are required for use with MTCB, separate tender items shall be included for their placement and relocation. Shifting of energy attenuators is covered under the Movable Temporary Concrete Barrier, Shift tender item. The energy attenuator tender items applicable for use with MTCB are: • 0723-4108 Energy Attenuator - Temporary, Reduced Exposure • 0723-4113 Energy Attenuator - Relocation, Reduced Exposure Energy attenuator tender items shall be as per CDED B723.

741-2.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole metre. Offsets when required are recorded to 0.1 of a metre. Spot checking required.

741-2.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions Non-standard special provisions are required to specify and provide payment for: • The identification of specific temporary storage sites for MTCB that cannot be

accommodated within the project limits during staging or seasonal shutdown on carryover projects.

August 2016 Page 4 of 4 B741-2

Page 673: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING C.I.A.S. SYSTEM

February 2014 Page 1 of 2 B753

B753 - CONNECTICUT IMPACT ATTENUATION SYSTEM - OPSS 753 753.1 GENERAL The Connecticut impact attenuation system (CIAS) is a non-proprietary system used

mainly to protect wider objects such as bridge piers and high mast poles or to protect terminal ends of longitudinal barriers found in gore areas.

This attenuation system consists of 14 steel cylinders of varying wall thickness and two

different diameters placed on a concrete pad against a concrete backwall. The system meets NCHRP Report 350 Test Level 3.

753.2 REFERENCES Roadside Safety Manual 753.3 TENDER ITEM

Connecticut Impact Attenuation System 753.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the Connecticut impact attenuation system are contained in

OPSS 753. 753.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special

provisions. 753.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial

Standard Drawings (OPSD). Delineation requirements are contained in the 900 series of OPSDs.

Page 674: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING C.I.A.S. SYSTEM

February 2014 Page 2 of 2 B753

753.7 DESIGN

Median Installation

a) The CIAS should only be installed at a 10° skew to the centreline of the roadway when the length of the median hazard and the median width can accommodate a CIAS at each end of the hazard within the limits specified in OPSD 923.245. In this case, the designer should specify that the system be installed according to OPSD 923.245.

b) The CIAS should only be installed at a 0° skew to the centreline of the roadway

when the length of the median hazard is too long or the median width is too narrow to accommodate a CIAS at each end of the hazard within the limits specified in OPSD 923.245. In this case, the designer should specify that the system be installed according to OPSD 923.244.

753.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measurement is each. Quantities are based on each complete installation. 753.9 DOCUMENTATION For the Connecticut impact attenuation system tender item, enter each installation as a

separate line entry under the appropriate column heading on the "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet. Indicate the station at the back of the concrete "backwall" and the location left or right of centreline. Total the column and transfer the tender total to the tender document.

Show locations of CIAS installations on the contract drawings with the OPSD number

shown adjacent to the symbol. 753.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and quantity entries to the number of units

required. Record offsets when the installation is not according to standard - and then to 0.1 m

accuracy.

Page 675: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

B760 - NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS – OPSS 760 760.1 GENERAL Proprietary noise barrier systems are designed and manufactured by the noise barrier

companies in accordance with the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CHBDC) and the Ministry's acoustical, material and construction requirements including CSA Standard for Certification of Noise Barriers Z107.9-00. Noise barrier systems accepted for use on ministry contracts are listed in the ministry’s "Designated Sources for Materials" (DSM).

760.2 REFERENCES Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CDHBC) Bridge Office Design Bulletin dated Dec. 6, 2006 CSA Standard Z107.9-00 for Noise Barriers Acoustical Design Advice Reports for Noise Barriers MTO Roadside Safety Manual 1993 MTO DSM – Noise Barriers 760.3 TENDER ITEMS Noise Barrier System* Noise Barrier System including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier* Noise Barrier System on Structures* Noise Barrier Access *Each height of noise barrier requires a separate tender item. See Tender Items Master

File (CPS). 760.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for noise barrier systems are contained in OPSS 760. 760.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions.

June 2015 Page 1 of 7 B760

Page 676: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

760.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings for noise barrier systems. 760.7 DESIGN 760.7.1 General The tender package should be prepared in a manner so as to permit the contractor to

select appropriate noise barrier systems from the DSM meeting the requirements of the contract.

Working drawings for noise barrier systems are prepared by the manufacturer of the system selected by the contractor.

760.7.2 Noise Barrier Design Elements Refer to DSM about product attributes for each noise barrier system. 760.7.3 Design Loads Structural design of noise barrier systems is by the noise barrier system manufacturer

based on loadings specified in the CHBDC and the Contract Documents. Reference wind load along with its respective area or city (e.g. 415 Pa for Hamilton

area) shall be specified in SSP 760F01. 760.7.4 Acoustics The Acoustical Design Advice Reports for noise barrier systems prepared during the

design phase of the project, will contain recommendations for reflective barriers or for single or double-sided sound-absorptive barrier material on a project and/or site specific basis. The acoustical characteristics of the noise barrier system shall be specified in SSP 760F01.

760.7.5 Aesthetics The number of colours, texture and their proportions of the overall noise barrier area

shall be specified in SSP 760F01. 760.7.6 Noise Barrier Footings Sub-surface conditions along the barrier alignment should be investigated during the

design phase of the project. The borehole data shall be included in the contract

June 2015 Page 2 of 7 B760

Page 677: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

drawings. The rock line, based on the summary of borehole logs, shall be shown on profile drawings. The related soil design parameters shall be specified in SSP 760F01.

In areas where unsuitable soils, shale, rock, non-level ground surface (slopes) or high

water table are encountered, additional investigations may be required to determine if any non-standard special provisions or operational constraints are required in the Contract.

760.7.7 Noise Barrier Systems on Structures A separate tender item is required for noise barrier systems anchored onto bridge,

culvert headwall, and retaining wall structures. When a noise barrier is to be installed on or within 6 m of a structure (bridge, culvert

or retaining wall), the designer shall consider Bridge Office Design Bulletin for “Interim Guideline for Noise Barrier Walls on Bridges” dated Dec 6, 2006.

760.7.8 Noise Barrier Systems including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier A separate item is required for Noise Barrier System including Precast Noise/Traffic

Barrier.

Noise barrier systems are considered to be roadside obstacles and should be treated as such according to the Roadside Safety Manual. Any required protection (i.e. guiderail) shall be detailed under their respective tender items.

In some cases where there is not enough physical room adjacent to the roadway to

install a separate noise barrier behind a guide rail system, combined proprietary noise/traffic barrier systems are available and listed on the applicable noise barrier DSM.

Transitions from standard guide rail systems to proprietary noise/traffic barrier

systems are available and should be specified accordingly in the Contract. 760.7.9 Noise Barrier Access A separate tender item is required for noise barrier access. When required, the Contract shall include the installation of access openings for fire

hose access, person door access, or any other purposes. The designer shall establish locations for the access openings.

June 2015 Page 3 of 7 B760

Page 678: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

760.8 COMPUTATION Tender items for all Noise Barrier System items are Plan Quantity Payment Items. 760.8.1 Noise Barrier Systems Noise Barrier Systems including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier Noise Barriers Systems on Structures 760.8.1.1 Sources of Information In order to establish the horizontal barrier alignment upon which the computed

quantities are based, major sources of information available to the designer include but not limited to the Acoustical Design Advice Reports for noise barrier systems. The information supplied includes the acoustical recommendations of the barrier material, the recommended height and approximate alignment of the noise barrier which will provide the most cost-effective attenuation of traffic noise. The recommended height of the noise barrier is assumed to be from the original ground line along the barrier alignment unless otherwise specified.

Geotechnical investigation report include borehole data, description of subsurface

conditions and soil design parameters along the barrier alignment. Structural information if required include existing structure details, design

recommendations for noise barriers mounted on or within 6 m of structures and typical mounting and/or footing details related to these conditions.

Surveys and Plans include B-plans, ETR plates, "as constructed" plans, and field

survey notes as needed. 760.8.1.2 Method of Calculation The basic unit for the computation of quantities is the linear metre. Quantities are

determined from the plans, along the horizontal barrier alignment. Stepping of the noise barrier panels at termination points, shall be calculated as part

of the adjoining barrier as if there were no difference in height. When it is necessary to make a transition from one barrier height to another, the length of barrier involved in accomplishing the transition is calculated as part of the higher barrier.

Quantities for "Noise Barrier Systems including Precast Noise/ Traffic Barrier" are computed along the horizontal alignment between, but not including the Precast "Noise/ Traffic Barrier" approach treatment and any traffic barrier termination treatment required as well as any areas which may only require the "Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier" without a noise barrier mounted on top of it. A separate item must be included for these traffic barrier treatments. The maximum height of the

June 2015 Page 4 of 7 B760

Page 679: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

noise barrier system including precast noise/traffic barrier shall be 5.0m above the pavement elevation.

Quantities for 'Noise Barriers Systems on Structures' are computed along the

horizontal barrier alignment between the end posts connected to the structure wall. The maximum height of the noise barrier system on structures shall be 5.0m above the pavement elevation or top of sidewalk.

760.8.2 Noise Barrier Access 7608.2.1 Source of Information The designer shall establish locations for the access openings for fire hose, person

door, or any other accesses. 7608.2.2 Method of Calculation The basic unit for the computation of quantities is "each". 760.9 DOCUMENTATION 760.9.1 Noise Barrier Systems Noise Barrier Systems including Precast Noise/Traffic Barrier

Noise Barrier Systems on Structures Quantities are entered on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheets on a station to station

basis by location and offset for each change in the horizontal alignment of the barrier. Stations and calculated quantities are recorded in whole numbers. Offsets, from a well-defined line, such as the centreline, curb, retaining wall, or edge of pavement, are entered to the nearest tenth of a metre.

A separate column is required for each tender item. Each column is totalled and the

total transferred to the tender form with the proper item description, unit and specification entry.

760.9.2 Noise Barrier Access

Each fire hose access opening is entered on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheets by station, location and by the fire hydrant sign number (km). Fire hydrant sign numbers, which are based on official highway kilometre posts, are recorded to the nearest 50 metres.

Each person door access opening is entered on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheets by station, location and by the fire hydrant sign number (km).

June 2015 Page 5 of 7 B760

Page 680: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

All other access openings are entered by station number, type and size. Stations are recorded in whole numbers.

The item is totalled and the total transferred to the tender form along with the proper

item description, unit and specification entry. 760.9.3 Contract Drawings Noise barrier system location and height are to be provided in the contract drawings

through plans, profile, typical sections and quantity sheets. Soils information consisting of a summary of borehole logs, shall be included for all ground-mounted noise barrier systems.

760.9.3.1 Plan Noise barrier systems, shall be represented on the plan view by a distinctive

prominent line for each type of barrier with appropriate labels defining the type of the noise barrier systems.

In order to define the exact location of the barrier, the following information shall be

shown on the drawings:

- barrier limits, identified by stations, and - intermediate barrier section ends and changes in the horizontal alignment of the

barrier defined by stations and offsets (offsets, in metres, shown from a well-defined line such as the centreline, edge of pavement, curb or structure)

760.9.3.2 Profile Profiles of the top and base of the noise barrier systems shall be shown on the profile

view with the barrier limits defined by stations. a) Ground-Mounted Noise Barriers For ground-mounted applications, the following information shall be shown:

- original ground line, - rock line (where applicable), - bottom-of-barrier profile - top-of-barrier profile, - where applicable, a profile inset for any section of barrier at an angle to the

control line, Stepping required maintaining barrier height, horizontal panel position along a

gradient transition and end treatments shall not be shown on the profile.

June 2015 Page 6 of 7 B760

Page 681: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING NOISE BARRIER SYSTEMS

b) Noise Barriers on Structures The profile view for noise barrier systems mounted on structures (bridge, culvert or

retaining wall) shall show the top of noise barrier systems and details of the structure. Noise barrier height shall be indicated.

The profile of the structure barrier wall, culvert headwall, or retaining wall shall show

the station and elevation at each end of the structure. The percent gradient between break points shall be indicated.

760.9.3.3 Typical Sections and Details Typical sections for noise barrier systems shall be detailed on contract drawings:

- grading details, - design features of earth berms and the installation of noise barrier systems along

these berms, - top soil, seeding/sodding, or paving requirements adjacent to noise barrier

systems, - drainage details (ditches, culverts, ditch inlets, sub-drains), - installation requirements for noise barrier systems in close proximity to utilities,

chain link security fences, and traffic barriers. - installation of traffic barriers.

Special footings, mounting of noise barriers on structures, termination of noise barriers at existing conditions, etc. shall be shown in typical drawings and details.

760.9.4 Quantity Sheets The entry of quantities for all noise barrier items on the Miscellaneous 1 Quantity

Sheets is described in Chapter F. 760.9.5 No-Plans Contract Format The use of the no-plans contract format is not recommended for noise barrier projects.

June 2015 Page 7 of 7 B760

Page 682: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 683: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGHWAY FENCE

March 2013 Page 1 of 4 B771

B771 – STANDARD HIGHWAY FENCE - OPSS 771 771.1 GENERAL This section covers the requirement for items related to the construction of fencing on

or along the highway right-of-way limits, including connections to cross fences. The Highway Fence item provides for the erection of farm fence along highway

right-of-way limits. Gates and brace panels are provided where required, under separate tender items.

For full details of fencing Rights-of-Way, refer to Admin-Property Directive B-3. 771.2 REFERENCES Admin-Property Directive B-3 771.3 TENDER ITEMS

Highway Fence Gates Brace Panels

771.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for construction of highway fence are contained in OPSS 771. 771.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special

provisions. 771.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of

Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD) Manual. Include MTOD 971.101, MTOD 971.102 (when solid rock is encountered), and

MTOD 971.103 in the Contract Documents that include the Highway Fence tender item.

Page 684: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGHWAY FENCE

March 2013 Page 2 of 4 B771

771.7 DESIGN 771.7.1 Highway Fence Openings in the right-of-way fence where no gate is provided are not measured, but

are treated as two fence terminals. Normally, no fencing is computed for cross fences, unless there is an agreement with

the property owner stating otherwise. Following the installation of the cross fence brace panel, the existing fence fabric is unrolled back into place to meet the new right-of-way fence.

771.7.2 Brace Panels Brace panels are computed in accordance with the following requirements:

1) At cross fences (separating property owners) - 3 panels required; one forming part of the cross fence, and two erected as part of the highway fence

2) At cross fences (not separating property owners) - 1 brace panel is required to

be installed on the cross fence at the straining post.

3) At all horizontal angles exceeding 22 degrees - 2 panels

4) On all curves of radius 900 m or less - 2 panels at each end of curve and plus 2 panels at midpoint

5) Gate locations and openings - 2 panels at each site in fence

6) At all vertical angles exceeding 22 degrees - 2 panels

7) At crossings of watercourses (maximum span: 6m) - 2 panels

8) Terminals - 1 panel per terminal

9) Existing fence (adjacent to a removed section) - 1 panel per terminal

10) New fence - on clear fence runs with none of the above cases – 2 panels at

approximately 200 m intervals, with a maximum interval of 230 m. 771.7.3 Gates

Page 685: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGHWAY FENCE

March 2013 Page 3 of 4 B771

Existing gates shall be replaced when fencing is replaced during reconstruction or widening projects. When fencing new rights-of-way, gates shall be provided at locations agreed upon between the ministry and the adjacent property owner(s).

771.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. For Plan Quantity, base measurement on the units shown below: A. Highway Fence Measure the Highway Fence length in metres following the contour of the ground for

the actual length of Highway Fence erected with no deductions for gate openings and brace panels. The tender quantity is measured to the nearest whole metre.

B. Gates The unit of measurement for gates is "each”, with double gates counted as one gate. C. Brace Panels The unit of measurement for brace panels is "each", regardless of material type. 771.8.1 Sources of Information Generally, new Highway Fence is erected on the right-of-way limits as a replacement

for existing fencing removed under the same contract. Refer to Property Agreements and P-Plans for details of existing fences and gates.

771.9 DOCUMENTATION A. Contract Drawings Fences and gates are to be shown on the contract drawings, including the following

information: 1) Fence and gate symbols; and 2) MTOD number. The chainage of cross fence connections is to be shown. B. Contract Documents

Page 686: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGHWAY FENCE

March 2013 Page 4 of 4 B771

Fencing quantities, scaled from plans or taken from Property Agreements, may be entered directly onto the "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet, showing beginning and end stations, indicating left or right. Include offsets, if applicable. Provide the chainage location of any cross fence that is to be connected, for the purpose of listing brace panels.

Show the station for the centre of each gate following the respective fence entry in

the “Location and Position” column, indicating left or right, with offset distance where the gate is set back from the fence line. Show "single gate" or "double gate", as appropriate, in the "Location and Position" column along with the gate opening width (m), against each gate entry. The number of gates is based on the total number of gate openings, with double gates counted as one gate.

Each set of brace panels is shown in one line in the Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet.

A set of brace panels may consist of either one, two or three brace panels, depending upon the design situation described in Sub-section 771.7.2, Brace Panels, above. The chainage of the applicable ‘terminal post’ is provided in the station column. Offset, left or right, and the type of installation (gate, cross fence, watercourse, etc) is provided in the ‘location and position’ column. Brace panel quantities (1, 2 or 3) are shown in a column with the title ‘brace panel’. At watercourse crossings, identify the chainage of the terminal post on each side with one brace panel allocated to each side.

771.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and quantity entries to the number of units

required. Record offsets only when the installation is not according to standard - and then to

0.1 m accuracy.

Page 687: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CHAIN-LINK FENCE

March 2013 Page 1 of 3 B772

B772 - CHAIN-LINK FENCE - OPSS 772 772.1 GENERAL

This section covers the requirement for items related to the construction of chain-link fence, including connections to cross fences. Chain-link fence is used mainly on the right-of-way limits of urban freeways and expressways to prevent pedestrian and animal access to the right-of-way, and at patrol yards for security purposes. Gates are provided where required. Generally, new chain-link fence is erected on the right-of-way limits as a replacement for existing fencing removed under the same contract. Chain-link fence is also occasionally used in medians to prevent pedestrians crossing the highway, such as in the vicinity of service areas. For full details of fencing rights-of-way, refer to Admin-Property Directive B-3.

772.2 REFERENCES Admin-Property Directive B-3 Roadside Safety Manual

772.3 TENDER ITEMS Chain-Link Fence (variation item) Gates

772.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the construction of chain-link fence are contained in OPSS 772.

772.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

Page 688: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CHAIN-LINK FENCE

March 2013 Page 2 of 3 B772

772.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) Manual.

772.7 DESIGN Any chain-link fence located within the clear zone described in Chapter 2 of the Roadside Safety Manual, shall use tension wire as the top member, and not pipe top rail.

772.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. For Plan Quantity, base measurement on the units shown below: A. Chain-Link Fence Measure the chain-link fence length in metres following the contour of the ground for the actual length of chain-link fence erected with no deductions for gate openings. B. Gates The unit of measurement for gates is "each", with double gates counted as one gate.

772.8.1 Source of Information Refer to Property Agreements and P-Plans for details of existing fences and gates.

772.9 DOCUMENTATION A. Contract Drawings Fences and gates are to be shown on the contract drawings, including the following information: 1) Fence and gate symbols; and 2) OPSD number.

Page 689: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CHAIN-LINK FENCE

March 2013 Page 3 of 3 B772

B. Contract Documents Enter chain-link fence quantities, scaled from plans or taken from Property Agreements, onto the "Quantities - Miscellaneous" sheet, showing stations and location, indicating left or right. Include offsets, if applicable. Provide the chainage location of any cross fence that is to be connected to the chain-link fence. List quantities for chain-link fence with top wire in a separate column from chain-link fence with top rail. Calculate a subtotal for each column before combining them to give a single tender total, which is transferred to the tender document. List quantities (m) for those locations where barbed wire is required, for patrol yards and other service areas, under an additional column headed "Chain-Link Fence [Top Wire - Barbed Wire]". Total the barbed wire quantities, for information only. Show the station for the centre of each gate following the respective fence entry in the “Location and Position” column, indicating left or right, with offset distance where the gate is set back from the fence line. Show "single gate" or "double gate", as appropriate, in the "Location and Position" column along with the gate opening width (m), against each gate entry. The number of gates is based on the total number of gate openings, with double gates counted as one gate. For chain-link fence concrete barrier”, the length of chain-link fence installed on concrete barrier shall be listed in a separate column on the Q-sheet with the heading “Chain-Link Fence [Concrete Barrier]”. Chainages shall be noted in the “Location and Position” column. Include full payment for this installation under the Chain-Link Fence item.

772.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and quantity entries to the number of units required. Record offsets only when the installation is not according to standard - and then to 0.1 m accuracy.

Page 690: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 691: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REACT 350

799-2 - REACT 350 799-2.1 GENERAL

The REACT 350 is a proprietary energy attenuation system to reduce the hazard associated with the ends of permanent concrete barrier. The system meets the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350 and is available in two configurations that consist of 4 polyethylene cylinders for TL-2 installations, or 9 polyethylene cylinders for TL-3 installations.

799-2.2 REFERENCES Highway Design Bulletin 2004-002 799-2.3 TENDER ITEMS

- Permanent REACT 350 799-2.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the REACT 350 are contained in SSP 799S04. 799-2.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

799-2.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

799-2.7 DESIGN Design shall be in accordance with the appropriate MTODs.

September 2011 Page 1 of 2 B799-2

Page 692: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING REACT 350

799-2.8 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment Items. The quantity is based on each completed installation.

The unit of measurement for Permanent REACT 350 is each complete installation. 799-2.9 DOCUMENTATION

The tender items are variation items. Provide two columns on the quantity sheet to indicate whether each Permanent REACT 350 installation consists of 4 cylinders (TL-2) or 9 cylinders (TL-3). 1. TL-3 configurations are required for high-speed installations with posted

speeds of 70 km/h and greater. 2. TL-2 configurations may be used for low speed installations with posted

speeds of less than 70 km/h. Each installation is entered as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading on a "Quantities - Miscellaneous - 1" sheet or a "Miscellaneous" sheet. The station at the rear of the system is entered and location left or right of centreline is indicated. Each column is totalled, added together, and transferred to the tender document. For each location where a standard concrete pad is required, note in the location and position column of the Q-sheet: “Concrete Pad”.

Show the location of each Permanent REACT 350 on the contract drawings with the appropriate MTOD number shown adjacent to the symbol.

799-2.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Record stations to the nearest whole metre and indicate median, left, or right side of the road. The quantity is the number of units required.

September 2011 Page 2 of 2 B799-2

Page 693: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RAMP CLOSURE GATES

May 2013 Page 1 of 3 B799-6

799-6 – RAMP CLOSURE GATES 799-6.1 GENERAL

Ramp closure gates are used for access control purposes to close entrance ramps to freeway facilities during planned and unplanned closures. The ramp closure gate is a swing-style aluminium truss gate. The gate truss is welded to a hollow tube mounted onto a base plated tubular support post that is anchored to a concrete footing with breakaway couplings. The ramp closure gate is based on the swing-style breakaway gate designed by the Midwest Roadside Safety Facility (MwRSF) for the South Dakota Department of Transportation (SDDOT) in 1995. When in the “closed” position, the gates are placed such that they extend across the roadway perpendicular to the direction of oncoming traffic. When not in use, the gates are placed into the “open” position aligned parallel to the adjacent roadway. The system meets the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350 at Test Level (TL) 3 when in the “open” position. The system is available in two standard lengths: 9m and 12m and two standard configurations: single gate and twin gate (9m twin only).

799-6.2 REFERENCES

Not applicable. 799-6.3 TENDER ITEMS

- Ramp Closure Gates - Concrete in Ramp Closure Gate Support Footings

799-6.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for Ramp Closure Gates are contained in SSP 799S12.

Page 694: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RAMP CLOSURE GATES

May 2013 Page 2 of 3 B799-6

799-6.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter "E" of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

799-6.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD). A ramp closure gate sign installation drawing is available from the Traffic Office.

799-6.7 DESIGN Gates shall be positioned on the Contract Drawings in accordance with the

appropriate installation MTODs. Select the appropriate gate length and gate configuration based on the site conditions to ensure that the ramp closure gate(s) will span the roadway when in the “closed” position.

799-6.8 COMPUTATION

These are Plan Quantity Payment Items. The quantity is based on each completed installation.

The unit of measurement for Ramp Closure Gate and Concrete in Ramp Closure Gate Support Footings is each complete installation.

799-6.9 DOCUMENTATION

Enter each installation in the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading. Enter the station corresponding to the location of the footing and indicate location, left or right of centreline. Total the column. Show the location of each ramp closure gate on the contract drawings with the appropriate MTOD number shown adjacent to the symbol.

Page 695: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RAMP CLOSURE GATES

May 2013 Page 3 of 3 B799-6

799-6.9.1 Documentation Accuracy

Record stations to the nearest whole metre. The quantity is the number of units required.

Page 696: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 697: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGH TENSION THREE CABLE GUIDE RAIL

B799-8 - HIGH TENSION THREE CABLE GUIDE RAIL AND HIGH TENSION CABLE GUIDE RAIL TERMINAL SYSTEMS - SSP 799S15

799-8.1 GENERAL High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail (HT3CGR) is a proprietary flexible roadside

barrier system consisting of three 19 mm diameter steel cables attached to steel line posts with cables anchored at each end into a proprietary High Tension Cable Guide Rail Terminal System (HTCGRTS).

HT3CGR is configured either as a shoulder installation or as a slope installation. The

shoulder installation has the traffic face of the system located at the edge of shoulder in front of the rounding breakpoint. The slope installation has the traffic face of the system located beyond the shoulder and rounding breakpoint on the frontslope or sideslope.

The cable mounting heights for each cable need to be maintained for the full service

life of the installation. HT3CGR meets the crash test acceptance requirements of AASHTO MASH TL-3. HTCGRT systems include several steel line posts that are used to transition the cable

downward from HT3CGR over a specified length to ground level where they are attached to the anchor assembly in the ground.

HTCGRTS meet the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350 TL-3

and/or AASHTO MASH TL-3 as noted on the applicable standard drawing. 799-8.2 REFERENCES Highway Standards Branch DCSO #2016-12 Highway Design Bulletin #2011-003 Roadside Safety Manual 799-8.3 TENDER ITEMS High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail - Shoulder Installation (normal, m, PQP) High Tension Three Cable Guide Rail - Slope Installation (normal, m, PQP) High Tension Cable Guide Rail Terminal System (normal, each, PQP)

December 2016 Page 1 of 4 B799-8

Page 698: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGH TENSION THREE CABLE GUIDE RAIL

799-8.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for HT3CGR and HTCGRTS are contained in SSP 799S15. 799-8.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review applicable standard special provisions. 799-8.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of

Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTODs). 799-8.7 DESIGN For calculating length of need for HT3CGR refer to the Roadside Safety Manual and

Highway Design Bulletin #2011-03. The length of the HTCGRTS at both ends of the HT3CGR are located beyond the calculated length of need.

For determining type of HT3CGR installation, shoulder installation or slope

installation, refer to Highway Standards Branch DCSO #2016-12. HT3CGR may be installed on the inside and outside of horizontal curves with

centreline radii of 250 m and greater. One HTCGRTS is required at each end of a HT3CGR installation. There are no

requirements for intermediate anchors within a HT3CGR installation. There are no transitions currently available that transition HT3CGR to or from Steel Beam Guide Rail or Concrete Barrier.

The granular base and earth or rock frontslopes or sideslopes for the roadway in

vicinity of HTCGRTS shall be widened according to the applicable 200 series MTOD and detailed accordingly on the design cross sections to accommodate the HTCGRTS. For shoulder installations, the HTCGRTS is flared away from the edge of shoulder to provide a 0.6m offset from edge of shoulder to the centre of anchor to minimize nuisance impacts and snow plow damage. For HT3CGR slope installations, the HTCGRTS does not need to be flared away from the shoulder as the centre of anchor should already be offset approximately 0.45 m from the edge of shoulder. HTCGRTS are designed to release the cables from the anchor assembly when errant vehicles from either direction impact the terminal in vicinity of where the cables are attached to the anchor assembly.

December 2016 Page 2 of 4 B799-8

Page 699: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGH TENSION THREE CABLE GUIDE RAIL

Designers have the flexibility to extend the length of HT3CGR installations to a location where roadway widening requirements for the HTCGRTS can be accommodated.

Desirably, the area immediately downstream of the approach end of the HTCGRTS

behind the HT3GR where the cables are attached to the anchor assembly, should be traversable and clear of fixed obstacles for a minimum distance of 23.0 m long by 6.0 m wide according to the applicable 200 series MTOD.

Delineation of the HTCGRTS shall be provided at edge of shoulder adjacent to the

approach and leaving ends of the HT3CGR installations according to the applicable 900 series MTOD.

799-8.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment items. For the HT3CGR items, compute measurement in metres, from the anchor point

located at the end of each HTCGRTS installation, with no reductions made for the length of the HT3CGR within the HTCGRTS.

For HTCGRTS item, the quantity is based on each installation. The unit of measurement for HTCGRTS is each. 799-8.9 DOCUMENTATION Enter HT3CGR, onto the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheet, showing station to station

and location, left or right, with offsets. Use a separate line for each installation of HT3CGR.

HT3CGR are shown on the contract drawings with “HT3CGR-Shoulder” or

“HT3CGR-Slope” shown adjacent to the “guide rail” symbol according to OPSD 101.013.

Enter HTCGRTS onto the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheet, showing station to

station and location, left or right, with offset to the centre of the anchor at the end of HTCGRTS. The length of HTCGRTS is 12.0 m. Use a separate line for each installation of HT3CGR.

HTCGRTS are shown on the contract drawings with “HTCGRTS” shown adjacent to

the “guide rail” symbol according to OPSD 101.013 at each end of the HT3CGR installation.

December 2016 Page 3 of 4 B799-8

Page 700: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING HIGH TENSION THREE CABLE GUIDE RAIL

Show the location of the roadway widening on the contract drawings (see section

CDED B206-1 for more information) with the appropriate 200 series MTOD number shown adjacent to the HTCGRTS. Also show roadway widening on the cross sections. Payment for all grading shall be made under the appropriate grading items.

On contracts where HT3CGR posts are required to be installed in rock, calculate the

approximate percentage of post installations that will require excavation of rock within their full depth of embedment. Include a note on each Q-sheet where HT3CGR is listed, as follows: “Approximately X% of post installations for cable guide rail on this contract will encounter rock within their full depth of installation.” Rounding to the nearest 5% is appropriate.

Where excavation of rock may be required for installation of the anchor assembly or

line posts within the HTCGRTS, identify each location in a separate column in the Q-sheet with the heading “Rock Excavation”.

799-8.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record station and quantity entries for HT3CGR to the nearest whole metre. Record station entries for each HTCGRTS to the nearest whole metre. Quantity is the

number of installations required. Record offsets to 0.1 m accuracy and indicate left or right side of road.

December 2016 Page 4 of 4 B799-8

Page 701: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM TERMINAL

B799-9 - STEEL BEAM TERMINAL (SBT) - SSP 799S16 799-9.1 GENERAL

A SBT is a flared, redirective, non-energy absorbing end terminal used to terminate single rail steel beam guide rail on horizontal curves with radii less than 190 m. One proprietary SBT is currently available that meets the crash test acceptance requirements of AASHTO Manual for Assessing Safety Hardware (MASH) Test Level TL-3. Application: 1) End terminal for shoulder installations of SBGR on horizontal curves with a

centerline radius less than 190 m. For radii greater or equal to 190 m, a Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal system shall be used.

799-9.2 REFERENCES CDED B206-1 (Earth Grading) CDED B721-2 (Steel Beam Guide Rail) Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001, Steel Beam Guide Rail - Posts Into Rock

799-9.3 TENDER ITEM Steel Beam Terminal System (normal, each, PQP)

799-9.4 SPECIFICATION The requirements for SBT are contained in SSP 799S16.

799-9.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

December 2016 Page 1 of 3 B799-9

Page 702: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM TERMINAL

799-9.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 and 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTODs).

799-9.7 DESIGN SBT systems are only installed on horizontal curves with a centreline radius less than 190 m. On curves with a radius greater or equal to 190 m, a SBEAT shall be used. SBT systems are nominally 14.3 m long, same as SBEAT systems, and contribute nominally 10.0 m tangent to the length-of-need for SBGR installations. SBT’s are flared away from the shoulder over the length of installation with the face of post 1 offset 1.2 m from edge of shoulder. The granular base and earth or rock slopes for the roadway shall be widened to accommodate the terminal in accordance with the appropriate 200 series MTOD. Where the roadway is being widened for installation of an SBT, ensure that drainage requirements are properly addressed. Where widening is required and soft ground or muskeg is known or suspected to be present, investigation for widening and subexcavation details will typically be required. Designers have the flexibility to extend the length of SBGR installations to a location where desirable grading requirements can be accommodated for the SBT. Desirably, the area immediately downstream of the approach end of the SBT behind the system should be traversable and clear for a minimum distance of 22 m long by 6 m wide in accordance with appropriate 200 series MTOD.

799-9.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The quantity is based on each installation. The unit of measurement for SBT is each.

December 2016 Page 2 of 3 B799-9

Page 703: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STEEL BEAM TERMINAL

799-9.9 DOCUMENTATION Enter each SBT installation in the “Quantities Miscellaneous” sheets as a separate line entry under the appropriate column heading. Enter the station at the back end of the system (at the interface between the SBT and the SBGR) and indicate location, left or right of centreline. The length of an SBT is 14.3 m. Show the locations of the SBT system(s) on the contract drawings with “SBT” shown adjacent to the symbol. Show the roadway widening on the contract drawings (see section CDED B206-1 for more information) with the appropriate 200 series MTOD number shown adjacent to the terminal. Also, show roadway widening on the cross sections. Quantities for all grading work shall be included with appropriate grading items. Locations where SBT posts and/or other underground hardware require excavation of rock shall be noted in the Q-sheets, as stated in CDED B721-2 and Highway Design Bulletin 2006-001.

799-9.9.1 Documentation Accuracy Record stations to the nearest whole metre and indicate left or right side of road. The quantity is the number of units required. Record offsets only when the installation is not according to standard and then to 0.1 m accuracy.

December 2016 Page 3 of 3 B799-9

Page 704: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 705: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGN SUPPORT SYSTEM

B799-10 - PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGNS AND SUPPORT SYSTEMS - SSP 799S17

799-4.1 GENERAL

A permanent ground mounted intermediate sign support system is defined as a permanent sign(s) and its breakaway support system with the total sign panel area including any tab(s) greater than 3.6 m² and less than or equal to 7.2 m². The sign panel(s) shall be plywood with a maximum width of 2.4 m and height ranging from 1.5 m to 3.0 m maximum. The intermediate sign is attached to the Slip-Safe Supreme™ system which is a proprietary breakaway support system developed by Nucor Marion Steel. This system consists of two steel posts each composed of two Rib-Bak posts bolted together along with associated hardware including breakaway components at ground level. This breakaway steel sign support system has been designed to appropriate wind speed and pressure for a 10 year return period in Ontario according to the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code and meet the crash test acceptance requirements of NCHRP Report 350, Test Level 3. This system is acceptable for installations on all provincial highways.

799-4.2 REFERENCES Design and Contract Standards Office Memo # 2017-01 Roadside Safety Manual Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTOD) Ontario Traffic Manual

799-4.3 TENDER ITEMS Intermediate Signs, Ground Mounted, New (Normal, each, PQP) Intermediate Signs, Relocation (Normal, each, PQP) Intermediate Signs, Removal (Normal, each, PQP)

799-4.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for Permanent Ground Mounted Intermediate Sign Support Systems are contained in Standard Special Provision (SSP) 799S17.

February 2017 Page 1 of 5 B799-10

Page 706: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGN SUPPORT SYSTEM

799-4.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

799-4.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 900 series of the Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTODs).

799-4.7 DESIGN Design shall be in accordance with the appropriate MTODs. The total sign(s) area including all tabs should be from 3.6 m² to 7.2 m². The maximum width (B) of the sign shall be 2.4 m and range of height (H) of the sign including all tabs shall be from 1.5 m to 3.0 m. While 2.4 m wide small signs with heights less than 1.5 m and areas less than 3.6 m² may be installed on intermediate sign support system, it is generally more economical to install small signs on a small sign support system. The designer shall contact the MTO Regional Traffic Office and/or Services Coordinators to obtain input in determining the condition of existing signs, required changes to existing signs, and new sign requirements. The designer shall prepare a list of all new signs, and signs to be relocated or removed. The list shall be summarized in the signing table for insertion into the contract documents. A sample signing table is shown in the Documentation section below. Sign installations are intended for installation on traversable roadsides with sideslopes 3H:1V or flatter, and posts should be offset more than 1.5 m from bottom of drainage ditches, and offset more than 2.1 m from the traffic face of a guide rail system. Design cross-sections shall ensure these minimum offsets are provided. Sign locations shall adhere to the minimum offsets specified in the applicable MTOD. Sign installations should not be installed within the 22 m x 6 m obstacle clear area behind guide rail terminal systems. Sign installations are intended for installation in competent soils of uniform composition. Site foundation conditions requiring a modification to the design or use of another sign support system include: • Rock cut • Rock fills • Soil is exceptionally soft or loose.

February 2017 Page 2 of 5 B799-10

Page 707: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGN SUPPORT SYSTEM

799-4.7.1 Source of Information The Regional Traffic Office and/or Services Coordinators are the main sources of information for the above noted tender items and shall provide input for the preparation of the sign inventory, signing table and sign lay-out drawings.

799-4.8 COMPUTATION These are Plan Quantity Payment Items. The quantity is based on each intermediate sign assembly installation, relocation, and removal. The unit of measurement for Intermediate Signs is for each intermediate sign assembly installed, relocated, and removed.

799-4.9 DOCUMENTATION

799-4.9.1 Signing Table Where new signs are to be installed, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, sign message description, sign size, total sign area, sign supplier and action information shall be detailed in the table. Where existing signs are to be relocated, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, sign message description, sign size, total sign area, and action information shall be detailed in the signing table. The existing sign location shall be provided in the comments cell, for example as in the sample table below. Where existing sign installations are to be removed, the station location, offset from edge of shoulder, sign number, message description, sign size, total sign area, and action information shall be detailed in the table.

February 2017 Page 3 of 5 B799-10

Page 708: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGN SUPPORT SYSTEM

799-4.9.2 Sample Signing Table Location: Highway 400 – Northbound Station Offset

From ES (m)

Sign Number

Symbol/ Message Description

Size BxH (cm)

Sign Area (m²)

Sign Supplied

By

Action Comments

10+650 5.0 Gt1c + Gt1cB

Conservation Park Advance + Conservation Park Advance (French)

240x120+ 240x120 5.76 MTO Rel Existing at

11+175

12+100 4.0

Gd17 + Gd17t + Gd17B + Gd17tB

Municipality Centre off Hwy + Tab + Municipality Centre off Hwy (French) + Tab

240x120+ 240x30+ 240x120+ 240x30

7.20 MTO New None

24+950 3.6 Gt1A + Gt1aB

Provincial Park Advance + Provincial Park Advance (French)

240x120+ 240x150 6.48 N/A Rem Not required

Notes: Offset from ES: Indicate offset from edge of shoulder to nearest edge of sign. Sign Size: Indicate dimensions of each individual sign board, B for width and H for height. Total Sign Area: Indicate total area of the sign board including any tabs. Supplied By: For each sign board indicate the supplier, i.e. MTO, Other, or N/A. Action Code: Indicate New, Rel for relocation and/or Rem for removal. Comments: Special comments that are not covered in any of the column such as existing sign

location etc. 799-4.9.3 Drawings

The Designer shall prepare a plan view sign lay-out drawing at a scale of 1:1000 or a scale as directed by the MTO Regional Traffic Office to detail all information shown in the signing table for review and approval by the MTO Regional Traffic Office. The final plan view sign lay-out drawing shall be a part of the Contract Document and the signing table may be shown on the same drawing. The Designer shall define all acronyms used in the signing table on the drawing.

799-4.9.4 Quantity Sheets Permanent new sign installations, relocations, and removals, shall be indicated on a Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet by location, station and offset, and shall be equal to the number of signs detailed in the signing table.

February 2017 Page 4 of 5 B799-10

Page 709: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PERMANENT INTERMEDIATE SIGN SUPPORT SYSTEM

799-4.9.5 Schedule of Materials MTO-supplied signs are listed in the Tender document on the “Schedule of Materials to be Supplied by the Owner”. The designer shall enter the appropriate information, (i.e. U.O.M., Description, Supply Point, and Quantity) into the Contract Preparation System (CPS) on the “Supplies by MTO” form found under the “Form of Tender” menu item in the appropriate Work Project file. Note: Where more than one sign board or tab is mounted on a sign assembly, each individual signboard or tab is counted as one in the Schedule of Materials. (i.e. Where there is one signboard and two sign tabs on a sign assembly being supplied by MTO, a total of three would be added to the Schedule of Materials.)

799-4.9.6 Documentation Accuracy Sign installation station shall be recorded to the nearest whole meter. Sign offset from the edge of the shoulder shall be recorded to the nearest 0.1 of a meter. Sign area shall be recorded to the nearest 0.01 of a square meter. Sign quantity shall be recorded to the whole number. Spot checking required.

February 2017 Page 5 of 5 B799-10

Page 710: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 711: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TOPSOIL

B802 - TOPSOIL - OPSS 802

802.1 GENERAL

This is not a Plan Quantity Payment Item.

Topsoil is a fertile, loamy organic material which usually forms the top layer of the earth's surface and is essential for vegetative growth. Topsoil is a non-renewable resource which demands particular attention in the design of earth works. Generally, topsoil is unacceptable as embankment material.

Material from swamps or muskeg areas cannot be used in place of topsoil.

Topsoil is usually obtained through stripping operations under the tender item Earth Excavation (Grading). Once stripped, topsoil may be stockpiled within or outside the right-of-way limits for subsequent placement on the newly constructed earth slopes and other designated areas which are to undergo sodding or seeding.

Usually newly constructed cut, fill and ditch slopes are to be treated with topsoil if sufficient material is available from stripping operations. Topsoil application is then followed by seeding or sodding for vegetative growth. However, when insufficient topsoil quantities are available, seeding and mulching may be recommended to be applied directly to the earth slopes. Areas to be sodded always require topsoil.

The normal application of topsoil is 50 mm. Applications exceeding 50 mm on clay slopes may cause slope failure and should be avoided. Excess application for the purpose of eliminating surplus topsoil should also be avoided. Topsoil surplus to the requirements of the contract should be stockpiled either within or outside the ROW, at locations considered most cost-effective and convenient for future use.

The Regional Geotechnical Section is to be consulted to determine the percentage of stripping quantity which may be used as topsoil. This percentage will vary with each project depending on soil types, presence of existing sodded areas, and geographic location.

802.1.1 Tender Items

The tender items associated with topsoil are as follows:

a) Topsoil from Stockpiles

This item includes the preparation of surfaces graded under the same contract, loading of topsoil obtained from stockpiles generated from the grading operations, hauling and spreading of the material, and trimming of stockpile sites after completion of the work.

September 2011 Pg. 1 of 4 B802

Page 712: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TOPSOIL

b) Topsoil, Imported

This item is used on projects where topsoil required exceeds the topsoil available from stripping operations or existing stockpiles. The deficiency is to be computed and included with the item "Topsoil, Imported". Under this item the contractor is required to supply, load, haul and spread the required topsoil, after preparing the surfaces constructed under the same contract.

However, before importing of topsoil is contemplated, consideration should be given to increasing the stripping requirements for the project by stripping fills over 1.2 m in height, thus reducing the need to import topsoil. The cost for additional earth borrow material which may result due to this operation will, on most contracts, offset both the economic and environmental costs of importing topsoil.

c) Preparation for Topsoil

The use of this item is restricted to projects on which surfaces, graded under a previous contract, are to be cleared of any debris, fine graded and loosened prior to commencement of topsoil operations. Topsoil will then be placed under the tender items "Topsoil from Stockpiles" or "Topsoil, Imported.

802.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for placing topsoil are detailed in OPSS 802.

802.1.3 Special Provisions

The Designer should refer to Chapter `E' of this Manual to review the applicable Special Provisions.

When surplus topsoil is to be stockpiled outside the ROW, the general special provision listed in Chapter `E' of this manual is required to indicate the stockpile location.

When topsoil from an existing stockpile is to be used, a Non-Standard special provision is required to indicate the stock- pile location and the quantity available.

802.1.4 Standard Drawings

There are no Ministry standard drawings directly applicable to this type of work. The OPS Grading construction standard drawings in the 200 series should be referenced.

802.2 COMPUTATION

September 2011 Pg. 2 of 4 B802

Page 713: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TOPSOIL

The unit of measure for the tender items Topsoil from Stockpiles and Topsoil, Imported is the cubic metre. For the tender item Preparation for Topsoil, the unit of measure is lump sum.

802.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information for the above items are: Regional Geotechnical Section Landscape Planning Unit, Maintenance Branch Regional Environmental Unit

802.2.2 Methods of Calculation

a) Topsoil from Stockpiles Topsoil, Imported

The computation of the volume of topsoil required is based on the area (average width times length) times the recommended depth. The areas of the slopes to be top soiled are to be scaled from the cross sections. Slope measurements are to be contour measurements.

On cut and fill sections, the topsoil is to start at the subgrade (bottom of granular sub-base) and is to extend to the limit of grading.

b) Preparation for Topsoil

The computation of the lump sum quantity for the Preparation for Topsoil item is based on the average width times length, contour measurement. The areas to be treated are identical to those to be followed up by topsoil.

802.3 DOCUMENTATION

Topsoil items are not indicated on the contract plans or profiles.

The summarized quantities are transferred from the calculation sheet to the Quantities 1 or 2 Sheet.

Every area to be topsoiled is to be documented by Station to Station and left or right location. Quantity entries on major reconstruction projects are documented in 350 m intervals. Quantity entries for each of the topsoil items are totalled. These totals are the tender quantities and are transferred to the tender documentation.

Documentation for the tender item "Preparation for Topsoil" requires that the m2

quantity upon which the lump sum is based, be shown on the Quantity sheet at the top of the column.

September 2011 Pg. 3 of 4 B802

Page 714: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TOPSOIL

The tender total for "Topsoil from Stockpiles" is recorded on the stripping breakdown block on the "Quantities - Grading" Sheet, on the line "Topsoil Required". If this total exceeds the "Stripping Available" entry, consideration may be given to the item "Topsoil, Imported".

802.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Calculated quantities for topsoil items are recorded in whole number cubic metres.

Stations are recorded in whole number metres.

September 2011 Pg. 4 of 4 B802

Page 715: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SODDING

B803 – SODDING – OPSS 803 803.1 GENERAL

The establishment of a permanent vegetative cover on roadsides is an integral part of road construction. Establishing permanent vegetative cover is accomplished by either seeding or sodding perennial seed mixes. Sodding uses perennial turfgrass mixes, pre-grown and rooted to specific size and density. Sodding is an erosion control measure for both the short term (construction) and the long term (maintenance). It has the advantage of instant ground cover and a clean, finished, aesthetically-pleasing appearance.

803.1.1 Sod Sod is applied to bare earth areas on the right-of-way. The application of topsoil (reference B802, Topsoil) prior to sodding is recommended. Sodding, is a more expensive alternative to seeding and shall be considered in the following situations; • on existing sodded or lawn areas where construction activities will necessitate

removal of the existing lawn,

• on channelized islands over 7.5 m in width from face to face of curb and gutter,

• on ditch bottoms having a 0 to 3% gradient, where there is concern for the susceptibility of the soil to erosion,

• on the slopes of ditches having a 3 to 5% gradient,

• on medians and boulevards in areas of high pedestrian traffic or on roads with an urban cross-section design,

• on earth slopes 2:1 and steeper where a clean, finished appearance is a consideration. However, there are other considerations to make when revegetating an earth slope. Design decisions shall be made based on discussions with environmental planners, geotechnical specialists and landscape architects. Placement of sod on slopes may require staking to hold the sod securely to the slope until the roots penetrate to provide stability. The decision to stake the sod is made by the Contractor placing the sod.

803.1.2 Maintenance

There is a requirement for a 30 consecutive calendar day maintenance period to commence following completion of the sod placement. The maintenance will include any required watering and is bid as part of the Sod tender item.

November 2015 Page 1 of 3 B803

Page 716: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SODDING

803.2 REFERENCES CDED Section B802, Topsoil Specifications, Classifications and Use of Turfgrass Sod for Ontario

803.3 TENDER ITEMS Sod (variation item)

803.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for Sod are contained in OPSS 803.

803.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter 'E' of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

803.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS none

803.7 DESIGN Refer to B802, Topsoil to establish and document topsoil requirements related to placement of sod. Specify Kentucky Bluegrass sod for areas that are sunny to slightly shady. Specify Kentucky Bluegrass / Fine Fescue sod for shadier areas. For further information, see the reference document: Specifications, Classifications and Use of Turfgrass Sod for Ontario.

803.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The Sod item is measured in square metres from the design cross sections or scaled from the contract drawings for each location. On sloped earth areas, contour

November 2015 Page 2 of 3 B803

Page 717: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SODDING

measuring applies. For ditch slopes, the width of sodding required up both sides of the ditch will be taken as 1.0 m on either side from the bottom of each ditch slope.

803.8.1 Sources of Information The main sources of information are cross sections, field investigations, Property Agreements, the Regional Environmental Unit, and the Design Standards Section of the Design and Contract Standards Office.

803.9 DOCUMENTATION Sod is a variation item. The type of sod, Kentucky Bluegrass or Kentucky Bluegrass/Fine Fescue is specified. Each type of sod application shall be detailed in separate columns of the Quantities – Miscellaneous sheet. Application areas are specified by station to station locations and offset position. For each area, enter the quantity in m² in a separate row. Show the sod locations on the contract drawings by symbol and legend. Standard symbols and legends shall be used. In some cases, the areas to be sodded may be too small or complicated to delineate, in which case the Quantity Sheet documentation will suffice.

803.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Station and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole metre. Offsets when required are recorded to 0.1 of a metre. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number. Spot checking required.

November 2015 Page 3 of 3 B803

Page 718: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 719: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 1 of 8 B804

B804 - SEED AND COVER – OPSS 804 804.1 GENERAL

The establishment of permanent vegetative growth on roadsides is an integral part of road construction and is an erosion control measure for both the short term (construction) and the long term (maintenance). Seed and cover is a two-stage operation where the seed and fertilizer are applied to the finished grade, followed by the application of a cover material. Seeding establishes a permanent vegetative growth for long-term erosion protection and right-of-way enhancement. The applied cover material protects the finished grade for the short term and provides a favourable environment for seed to germinate. Seed and cover is applied to all bare earth areas within the right-of-way, earth stockpile areas, earth borrow sites, earth disposal areas and all areas where construction activities will destroy existing vegetation. Areas excluded from seed and cover include areas which will be protected by other means such as sodding, compost seeding, reforestation, tree and shrub planting, rip-rap, granular sheeting or rock protection. The designer is encouraged to review these other sections of the CDED Manual for a description of the warrants for use and design requirements. The warrants for use of seed and cover in this guide extend from flat earth areas up to and including 2:1 earth slopes. For earth slopes with gradients in excess of 2:1 and flatter slopes with unacceptable risk of erosion, it is strongly recommended that the designer employ specific design solutions for these areas rather than using a standard treatment. The specific design solution should take into account soils, degree of slope, length and height of slope, surface drainage, water table, slope orientation and other factors that may be relevant. There are a variety of design products and technologies available for earth slope surficial stability that are not described herein. The application of topsoil prior to seeding on all contracts in Southern Ontario is required. The application of topsoil on all contracts in Northern Ontario is strongly recommended.

804.2 REFERENCES None.

Page 720: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 2 of 8 B804

804.3 TENDER ITEMS

As there are so many possible combinations from eight seed mixes and three cover types, it was decided to restrict the number of tender items for this work to four.

The tender items are: Seed

This item includes surface preparation, seeding and fertilizer application only. Seed and Mulch

This item includes surface preparation, seeding and fertilizer application and the appropriate cover application of hydraulic mulch or straw mulch, at the Contractor’s discretion.

Seed and Erosion Control Blanket

This item includes surface preparation, seeding and fertilizer application and the appropriate cover application of erosion control blanket.

Seed and Matrix

This item includes surface preparation, seeding and fertilizer application and the appropriate cover application of bonded fibre matrix or fibre reinforced matrix, at the Contractor’s discretion

804.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the application of seed and cover are described in standard special provision 804S01.

Specific changes to the product selection for cover materials will require modification of the appropriate materials clause in SSP 804S01.

804.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no OPS or Ministry standard drawings applicable to this work.

Page 721: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 3 of 8 B804

804.7 DESIGN 804.7.1 Seed Mixes

The designer should specify the Standard Roadside Mix as the default seed mix unless the MTO Regional Environmental Planner or Consultant Environmental Planner or the Consultant Landscape Architect has recommended another prescriptive mix. The seed mix options available to the designer are:

Standard Roadside Mix

A tested mix of hardy roadside perennial grasses that have performed well in highway situations. This mix should be the default seed mix for most roadside seeding work.

Crown Vetch Mix Crown Vetch Mix is a blend of a hardy legume and a hardy turfgrass. The turfgrass

provides control and top growth until the Crown Vetch plants grow and develop after several seasons. Crown Vetch produces a mass of purple flowers in season and is a vigorous ground cover. This mix is primarily used to re-vegetate slope areas when erosion and soil fertility may be a problem.

Birdsfoot Trefoil Mix

Birdsfoot trefoil mix is a blend of another hardy legume and a hardy turfgrass. Very similar growth characteristics to the Crown Vetch mix, except a little slower growing, less vigorous, and Trefoil has masses of yellow flowers in season. As with Crown Vetch, this mix is primarily used to re-vegetate slope areas when erosion and soil fertility may be a problem. It is hardier in the north than Crown Vetch and is not as aggressive in growth and habit.

Salt Tolerant Mix

The salt tolerant mix is a blend mixture of several turfgrass species with a proven resistance to salt. The salt tolerance mix should be specified in areas such as medians, shoulder strips, and shoulder ditches, when salt is thought to be in heavier concentrations.

Lowland Mix

The lowland mix was developed with several species of turfgrasses that grow well in low- lying wet areas. The lowland mix should be specified along waterbody edges in low-lying areas when light seasonal flooding is a possibility.

Page 722: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 4 of 8 B804

Acidic Soil Mix

The acidic soil mix was developed to provide adequate vegetative cover on areas of low fertility and high acidity. The acidic soil mix should be used in areas of low fertility, medium to high acidity, and in the northern areas of the province.

Old Field Mix

This mix is used to provide an accelerated successional cover to a mature field condition, and uses native species of aster and goldenrod to comprise the majority of the mix. Old Field should be selected where there will be fallow areas left alone with little or no maintenance, no mowing and the area will be self-sustaining. It is more suitable in rural areas than urban or suburban situations.

Northern Ontario Mix

This mix is designed to suit the limited topsoil conditions and acidity of Northern Ontario sites. May be selected when there will be fallow areas left alone with little or no maintenance, no mowing, and the area will be required to be self- sustaining. More suitable in rural areas than urban or suburban.

804.7.2 Cover

After the seed and fertilizer has been applied by hydraulic seeder/mulcher, a temporary cover material is typically placed to (1) protect the earth areas from erosion until the vegetation grows and (2) protect the germinating seeds from damage. In some cases, cover is not required. In areas where seed will establish quickly, soil is fertile and slopes minimal seed alone may suffice. There are three types of cover materials available for selection by the designer:

Mulch

Mulch can be hydraulic mulch or straw mulch and is suitable where; the soils are not highly erodable, seed will not be applied during temperature extremes and the earth slopes vary from flat up to, and including, a 3:1 gradient. Hydraulic mulches are processed fibres of wood, straw, cotton, cellulose pulp, or any combination of these materials and are applied to the earth areas by a hydraulic seeder/mulcher through a truck-mounted nozzle gun.

Page 723: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 5 of 8 B804

Straw mulch consists of chopped straw applied to the seeded area via a straw mulch blower and coated with a tackifier to hold it together. A straw mulch application requires several pieces of equipment and several people working and operating the equipment. While the Contractor has the option of selecting either hydraulic mulch or straw mulch, in almost all instances, hydraulic mulch is selected due to ease of application and cost advantages. Hydraulic mulch, when properly applied at the specified rate, produces a thin ‘skin’ that adheres to the earth surfaces and provides a basic level of short-term protection for the earth surface and the germinating seeds. It is not recommended for use when seeding will be applied in temperature or weather extremes, such as summer droughts or late-season seeding when some over-winter protection will be required. In these instances an alternative cover application of erosion control blanket or matrix is suggested. Alternately, the designer may select another method of establishing vegetation such as sodding, compost seeding, turf reinforcement mats, reforestation planting or tree and shrub planting to establish control of the earth surfaces.

Erosion Control Blanket

For potential erosion problems based on soils/slope information, and/or earth slopes where the slope gradient is steeper than 3:1 but not steeper than 2:1, the designer may select Erosion Control Blanket (ECB) as an alternative cover. ECBs are a family of products that are supplied in rolls, they are machine woven mats with a variety of materials sandwiched between the two woven layers. Materials can be wood, coco or cotton fibre, straw, or any combination depending upon manufacturer. ECBs are unrolled over the seeded earth area and stapled in place. ECBs provide a superior level of erosion control and greater protection for germinating seedlings when compared to the standard hydraulic mulch cover. OPSS 804 provides a generic description for the basic level of Erosion Control Blanket, which will suit the majority of application needs on MTO projects. If the designer needs to provide a higher level of erosion control, then mid or high range proprietary ECB products should be specified.

Matrix

For potential erosion problems based on soils/slope information, and/or earth slopes where the slope gradient is steeper than 3:1 but not steeper than 2:1, the designer may select Matrix as an alternative cover. Matrix is a 100% biodegradable product consisting of stranded wood fibres held together by organic or mineral bonding agents. When matrix is mixed with water, applied to earth surfaces and allowed to dry it forms a viscous material that creates a high strength, porous, and erosion-resistant uniform cohesive mat. This mat is applied at a higher

Page 724: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 6 of 8 B804

product rate than hydraulic mulch and provides greater protection for the germinating seedlings and superior erosion protection than regular hydraulic mulch. The Contractor has the option of selecting either Bonded Fibre Matrix (BFM) or Fibre Reinforced Matrix (FRM). BFM has a curing period of not more than 48 hours, FRM has a short two hour curing period. BFM will typically be selected due to lower cost, with FRM used where conditions for BFM curing are not present. The main differences between matrix and ECB are the means by which they cover the earth area and the method of application. Cost is not normally a determining factor. In order to help the designer select the appropriate cover application, the following chart should be reviewed.

Cover

Application

Cover

Characteristics

Cover

Application

Pros Cons

Mulch Exceptionally thin ‘skin’ applied to earth surface. Sets up when dry to form a uniform cohesive mat

Applied via hydraulic seeder/mulcher

Fast, efficient application for flat earth areas and gentle earth slopes

Cheap

Light application can compromise erosion control

Remote areas can be ignored due to truck-mounted application

Less successful in temp/weather extremes

Less successful on erodible soils/steep slopes

Erosion Control Blanket

Rolled mats have some depth, matting and texture and are secured into the soil with staples

Area must be seeded first and then the ECBs are manually rolled and stapled in place

Consistent depth, texture and matting provides a more conducive germinating environment for seedlings

Many choices of blanket including photo and bio degradable

Longer protection than default cover

Lower chances of product failure than default cover

Improper placement or lack of fine grading can result in ‘tenting’ and possible erosion of soil beneath the ECB

Blanket needs to be anchored and dug in at top of slope

Labour intensive installation

Matrix Relatively thin ‘skin’ applied to earth surface. Sets up when dry to form a uniform cohesive mat

Applied via hydraulic seeder/mulcher

Fast, efficient application When properly applied

can resist moderate to severe weather events

Longer protection than mulch

Light application can compromise erosion control

Heavy application can inhibit seed germination

Remote areas can be ignored due to truck-mounted application

Page 725: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 7 of 8 B804

804.7.3 Sources of Information The main sources of information are the design cross sections, field investigations, the Geotechnical Engineer, Environmental Planner and/or Landscape Architect. Specific recommendations for alternative seed mixes and/or alternative cover materials should be obtained from professionals with training and experience in the fields of erosion and sediment control, civil engineering, biology, horticulture and/or landscape architecture.

804.8 COMPUTATION All of these tender items are Plan Quantity Payment (PQP) items and are measured in

square metres from the design cross sections or scaled from the contract drawings for each different specified type of permanent seed mix and each type of specified cover material. The area measure is determined by the slope measure and the distance of all earth areas covered, plus the required 300 mm overlap application. The designer should not be overly restrictive when calculating earth areas that require seeding and cover treatment after construction. Construction activities usually exceed the planned ‘area of construction’ and most contracts usually require fairly extensive seeding of areas outside the theoretical limits of construction.

804.9 DOCUMENTATION 804.9.1 Contract Drawings

In addition to the Quantity Sheet documentation, it is recommended that if various seed mix and cover type combinations are used on one contract, the designer should delineate the various seed mix and cover application types on the contract drawings by using symbols and a supplemental legend.

804.9.2 Quantity Sheets

All seed and cover applications should be detailed by station to station location and offset on a Miscellaneous 1 Quantity Sheet. The type of seed mix is an item variation. A separate column is used to quantify each different seed mix type and each different cover application type. Each column with the same cover material application is sub-totalled independently and then all of the column sub-totals with the same cover material application are added together to give a total tender quantity for that item in square metres. This total is then transferred to the tender document against the appropriate tender item.

Page 726: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING SEED AND COVER

April 2014 Page 8 of 8 B804

804.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number in metres. Station offsets are recorded in 0.1 of a metre.

Page 727: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

B805 – TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL MEASURES - OPSS 805 805.1 GENERAL

Construction activities frequently remove protective cover and expose soil to accelerated rates of erosion. Sediments generated thereby can be conveyed via runoff and channelized flow to impact sensitive receiving waters or other environmentally sensitive areas. Temporary erosion and sediment control measures are warranted on contracts which call for grading, drainage and other work that will disturb the earth surface. Measures shall be employed to minimize erosion and to remove sediments from water flowing from the construction site in order to meet environmental legislative requirements. OPSS 805 does not identify all available erosion and sediment control measures which the designer may consider, however, it does address most of the temporary measures commonly used during construction. The specification provides a large number of options for specifying either generic or specific items. When generic items are specified, the specification is designed so that the contractor is given the option of choosing from amongst a variety of items. This permits the cost-effective selection of end result performance items. In addition, OPSS 805 addresses the management of erosion and sediment control items which includes the requirements for maintaining erosion and sediment control measures and the removal of accumulated sediments from behind such measures. Design guidance provided in this section is not intended to supercede detail design of temporary erosion and sediment controls. Information within this section is intended to assist in the design and estimating required for the preparation of the contract package. The following constraints should be observed when considering the use of tender items found within OPSS 805:

• For control of erosion on bare earth surfaces other than temporary control in areas of channelized flow, reference should be made to OPSS 804 Construction Specification for Seed and Cover.

• All temporary measures identified in OPSS 805 are intended for removal at the completion of the contract or when permanent erosion and sediment control measures are in place and functioning.

• Permanent erosion and sediment control measures are not covered by OPSS 805.

• The measures identified in OPSS 805 are intended for use only during normal spring, summer, and fall construction.

• Special measures not addressed by OPSS 805 may be required when permanent cover will not be established prior to winter shut down.

January 2016 Page 1 of 10 B805

Page 728: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

• Winter construction may require special measures not addressed in OPSS 805.

• When identifying the location of rock flow check dams, the designer should consider their location and potential for an errant vehicle following the ditch line to impact rock flow check dams. A rock flow check dam presents a potential snagging point for an errant vehicle. Designers should try to locate rock flow check dams in roadside ditches as far from the traveled portion of the roadway as practical or where they will be located behind existing roadside barriers. Shielding of rock flow check dams should be considered as a last resort when the rock flow check dams need to be located where there is a high potential for impact.

805.1.1 Maintenance

All temporary measures identified in OPSS 805 require inspection, maintenance and sediment removal to ensure that they function as intended. In selecting any temporary measures, consideration should be given to the length of time such measures shall be in place, the effectiveness of related erosion control measures such as seeding and cover specifications, resulting frequency of sediment removal and the removal of the measures at the end of the contract. The designer should consider the following factors when selecting temporary erosion and sediment control measures:

• Straw bales are intended for use over short periods of time to ensure protection during establishment of vegetative cover, and in conjunction with an operational constraint for a time limit (e.g. 45 days) for the placement of specified, permanent cover after the completion of grading.

• Placement of erosion and sediment control measures should always take into account the access needs for maintenance and final removal.

805.2 REFERENCES

MTO Environmental Guide for Erosion and Sediment Control during Construction of Highway Projects HSB Provincial Engineering Memorandum 2015-05, New Erosion and Sedimentation Control Program – Design Policy

805.3 TENDER ITEMS Unit of Measure - By Metre Light-Duty Sediment Barriers Light-Duty Straw Bale Barriers Light-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Light-Duty Fibre Roll Barriers

January 2016 Page 2 of 10 B805

Page 729: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers Heavy-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Heavy-Duty Wire-Backed Silt Fence Barriers Berm Barriers Sandbag Barriers Fibre Roll Grade Breaks Turbidity Curtains Unit of Measure - By Each Flow Check Dams Straw Bale Flow Check Dams Fibre Roll Flow Check Dams Sandbag Flow Check Dams Rock Flow Check Dams Sediment Traps Slope Drains Diversion Ditches Sediment Traps for Dewatering Filter Bags Cofferdams

805.4 SPECIFICATIONS Details of the work are contained in OPSS 805.

805.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable special provisions. The timing for installation and removal of measures is specified in SSP 805F01.

805.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable Standard Drawings are contained in the 219 series of the Ontario Provincial Standards Drawings (OPSD) and Ministry of Transportation of Ontario Drawings (MTOD).

805.7 DESIGN Three approaches to temporary erosion and sediment control are addressed by OPSS 805 including:

January 2016 Page 3 of 10 B805

Page 730: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

1) the use of mitigation measures that control erosion by slowing the velocity of

water in channelized flow;

2) the use of mitigation measures that control sedimentation by ponding water from overland flow and allowing sediment to settle out; and

3) the use of mitigation measures that minimize damage from sediment release by isolating environmentally sensitive areas and work areas.

Under each approach a number of items are available for selection by the designer through OPSS 805. Table 1 provides design criteria and limits of use for temporary erosion and sediment control measures addressed in OPSS 805. The MTO Environmental Guide for Erosion and Sediment Control during Construction of Highway Projects shall be consulted for more detailed guidance on selection and design of temporary erosion and sediment controls including development of Erosion and Sediment Control Plans when required.

805.7.1 Slowing Water to Control Erosion in Channelized Flow The following tender items are available in OPSS 805 to minimize and control erosion of bare earth surfaces in channels, ditches and swales until such time as the specified permanent protection is provided:

Flow Check Dams Straw Bale Flow Check Dams Fibre Roll Flow Check Dams Sandbag Flow Check Dams Rock Flow Check Dams

805.7.2 Ponding Water to Control Sediment OPSS 805 addresses two kinds of temporary sediment control measures to pond water:

• sediment barriers; and

• sediment traps.

The following sediment barrier tender items are available in OPSS 805 to prevent sediment from entering concentrated flows found in swales, ditches, and watercourses, or from reaching other sensitive locations including private property: Light-Duty Sediment Barriers Light-Duty Straw Bale Barriers Light-Duty Silt Fence Barriers

January 2016 Page 4 of 10 B805

Page 731: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

Light-Duty Fibre Roll Barriers Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers Heavy-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Heavy-Duty Wire Backed Silt Fence Barriers Berm Barriers Sandbag Barriers Fibre Roll Grade Breaks Sediment traps are designed to receive sediments and control the release of water by intercepting and ponding sediment-laden concentrated flows in ditches and channels or from dewatering operations. They are designed to hold water for sufficient duration for settling sediments. The following trap tender items are available in OPSS 805: Sediment Traps Sediment Traps for Dewatering Filter Bags

805.7.3 Isolating Sensitive Areas and Work Areas OPSS 805 addresses the following situations where measures are required to isolate sensitive areas and work areas:

• where work must be done within a waterbody and sediments generated in the work area must be prevented from entering the adjacent waterbody; and

• where runoff or other water flowing from adjacent areas into the work area can cause erosion damage to the work area and result in the need for additional erosion and sediment control downstream of the work area.

The following tender items are available in OPSS 805 to isolate in-water work areas to prevent the passage of sediments to the adjacent water body:

Coffer Dams Turbidity Curtains Where runoff or other water can flow into or over the work area resulting in erosion and sediment damage, the following tender items are available in OPSS 805:

Light-Duty Sediment Barriers Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers Slope Drains Diversion Ditches

January 2016 Page 5 of 10 B805

Page 732: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

805.8 COMPUTATION

805.8.1 Sources of Information The main sources for information are field investigations, drainage plans, grading plans, fisheries assessments, erosion and sediment overview risk assessments, the Regional Geotechnical Section and the Regional Environmental Section.

805.8.2 Method of Calculation All tender items in this specification are PQP and are measured in metres or by each. The quantity for items measured in metres is calculated following the alignment of the item and the contour of the ground. All elements, including the rock flow check dam, required for the construction of a sediment trap are included with the sediment trap tender item. All elements, including the barrier and rock flow check dam, required for the construction of a sediment trap for dewatering are included with the sediment trap for dewatering tender item. All elements, including the corrugated pipe, inlet and outlet end sections, sediment trap and berm barrier, required for the construction of a slope drain are included with the slope drain tender item. All elements required for the construction of diversion ditches, including the excavation of the ditch, flow check dams, and other applicable components, are included with the diversion ditch tender item. All elements required for the construction of berm barriers, including the berm material, geotextile, and other applicable components, are included with the berm barriers tender item. Removal of materials used in the construction of measures and sediment removal are paid under the appropriate tender item for the temporary measure involved. Sediment removal is part of the maintenance component of the work.

805.9 DOCUMENTATION 805.9.1 Contract Drawings Show the location and, where applicable, the plan alignment of the following items.

Include a reference to the appropriate OPSD number. In some cases, a drawing detail will be required to clearly show the requirements.

January 2016 Page 6 of 10 B805

Page 733: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

Light-Duty Straw Bale Barriers Light-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Light-Duty Fibre Roll Barriers Heavy-Duty Silt Fence Barriers Heavy-Duty Wire-Backed Silt Fence Barriers Sandbag Barriers Fibre Roll Grade Breaks Straw Bale Flow Check Dams Fibre Roll Flow Check Dams Sandbag Flow Check Dams Rock Flow Check Dams Sediment Traps Slope Drains Sediment Traps for Dewatering Turbidity Curtains With the OPSD reference, show applicable dimensional information, as follows:

Light Duty Fibre Roll Barriers – roll diameter, ‘d’ Fibre Roll Grade Breaks - roll diameter, ‘d’ Fibre Roll Flow Check Dams - roll diameter, ‘d’ Sediment Traps - basin length, ‘L’ m Slope Drains - pipe diameter, mm Sediment Traps for Dewatering - basin dimensions, ‘L x L’ m Typical fibre roll diameters are 150, 200, and 300 mm. When a silt fence barrier is used for property delineation, a notation (“For Property Delineation”) shall be included under the OPSD reference. When the contract drawings do not include removal or new construction drawings, the above information may be included in table format on the location or typical section drawings. There is no OPSD for the cofferdams, filter bags, diversion ditches, and berm barriers items. The work required for these items shall be shown on a drawing detail. Details and components may include but not be limited to: Cofferdams - alignment, offset from waterbody

Filter Bags - volume of water to be filtered, geotextile filtration opening size (FOS)

Diversion Ditches - alignment, dimensions, erosion control blanket, check dams, riprap

Berm Barriers - alignment, dimensions, geotextile, outlet, riprap

January 2016 Page 7 of 10 B805

Page 734: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

805.9.2 Quantity Sheets

Record all items on the Quantities - Miscellaneous Sheets. Each tender item requires a separate column. Enter each separate installation on one line of the Q-sheet. Show the chainage and offset in the location column. For linear measured (metre) tender items, enter the calculated installation length. For items with ‘each’ measure, enter the unit quantity ‘1’ for each installation.

805.9.3 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded to the nearest metre. Offsets are recorded to the nearest 0.1 m. Quantity entries are recorded to the nearest metre.

805.9.4 Non-Standard Special Provisions

Write project and item specific requirements in an NSSP using the standard format described in this manual. Topics that may require an NSSP are:

• a filter bag geotextile with different properties than those specified is required;

• the retention of riparian vegetation constraint must be relaxed;

• a different timing constraint for the protection of erodible stockpiles is required;

• changes to the earth layer compaction method.

January 2016 Page 8 of 10 B805

Page 735: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

TABLE 1 OPSS 805 Design Criteria and Limits for Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control Temporary

Control Measure

Catchment Area

Flow Velocity

Channel Slope Barrier Length/Unit

Area Upstream

Life Expectancy

****

Slowing Water to Control Erosion in Channelized Flow

Flow Check Dams*** 2 ha 0.15 m/s 0.5 % N.A. N.A. 45 days

Straw Bale Flow Check Dams 2 ha 0.3 m/s 0.5 % N.A. N.A. 45 days

Fiber Roll Flow Check Dams 2 ha 0.15 m/s 0.5 % N.A. N.A. 6 months

Sand Bag Flow Check Dams 2 ha 1 m/s 0.5 % N.A. N.A. 6 months

Rock Flow Check Dams* 4 ha 2 m/s 0.5 % N.A. N.A. 6 months

Ponding Water to Control Sediment

Light-Duty Sediment Barriers *** N.A. 0.15 m/s N.A. 3:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Light-Duty Straw Bale Barriers N.A. 0.3 m/s N.A. 3:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Light-Duty Silt Fence Barriers N.A. 0.15 m/s N.A. 3:1 30 m/1000m2 6 months

Light-Duty Fibre Roll Barriers N.A. Roll size

dependent N.A. 3:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers *** N.A. 0.3 - 1.0 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Heavy-Duty Silt Fence Barriers N.A. 0.3 - 0.5 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 6 months

Heavy-Duty Wire-Backed Silt Fence Barriers

N.A. 0.3 - 1.0 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 2-3 years

Berm Barriers N.A. 1 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 6 months

Sand Bag Barriers N.A. 1 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 6 months

Fibre Roll Grade Breaks N.A. 1 m/s N.A. Up to

1:1 30 m/1000m2 6 months

Sediment Traps 2 ha 1.5 m/s N.A. N.A. N.A. 6 months

Sediment Traps for Dewatering Pump size dependent N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A. 6 months **

Filter Bags Pump and sediment particle size dependent N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A.

Variable per manufacturer’s

direction

January 2016 Page 9 of 10 B805

Page 736: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING TEMPORARY EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL

Temporary Control Measure

Catchment Area

Flow Velocity

Channel Slope Barrier Length/Unit

Area Upstream

Life Expectancy

****

Isolating Sensitive Areas and Work Areas

Turbidity Curtains N.A. 0.3 m/s all in-water body controls require site specific engineering design

Coffer Dams all in-water body controls require site specific engineering design

Light-Duty Sediment Barriers *** 2 ha 0.15 m/s N.A. 3:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Heavy-Duty Sediment Barriers *** 2 ha 0.3 - 1.0 m/s N.A. 2:1 30 m/1000m2 45 days

Slope Drains 2 ha N.A. N.A. 1.5:1 N.A. 6 months

Diversion Ditches 2 ha N.A. 6 months * Rock Flow Check Dams intended for placement in situations which exceed the limits outlined in this

table require site specific engineering design.

** Life Expectancy of Sediment Traps for Dewatering is dependent on the type of sediment barrier used in its construction.

*** Minimum design criteria have been used for the general category control measures. If this limit is to be exceeded, the designer must specify a specific measure.

**** Life Expectancy assumes that regular maintenance is being undertaken.

January 2016 Page 10 of 10 B805

Page 737: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROOTWAD STRUCTURES

B810 - ROOTWAD STRUCTURES - OPSS 810 810.1 GENERAL

Rootwads in a combination with interlocking tree materials are utilized with other tree parts and vegetation methods to stabilize waterbody banks and provide aquatic habitat.

810.2 REFERENCES - None 810.3 TENDER ITEMS

Rootwad Structure (Normal, each, PQP) 810.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The construction requirements for the installation of rootwad structures are contained in OPSS 810.

810.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

810.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

810.07 DESIGN

Rootwads move the thalweg away from the streambank so that the bank is less susceptible to erosion through hydraulic forces. This, in effect, reduces the energy environment along the streambank/water interface so that riparian vegetation can provide the necessary bank protection and habitat values. Rootwads also generate turbulence that creates streambed scour and provides cover and substrate for aquatic organisms.

May 2017 Page 1 of 4 CDED B810

Page 738: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROOTWAD STRUCTURES

Rootwads offer the following advantages: 1. Are typically cost-effective because they utilize natural materials that are often

found on or near the site. 2. Eventually decompose, thus allowing the restored riparian zone to function

naturally. 3. Create habitat complexity, hydraulic diversity, and substrate sorting. 4. Induce less local sediment deposition than other flow deflection structures. Rootwads do have their limitations being thresholds for allowable shear stress. Field studies suggest that their performance is highly dependent upon their orientation with respect to flow direction. Thus, the use of rootwads for erosion control should be limited to conditions where the up and downstream ends are secured and at least one stable meander sequence exists upstream. However, these requirements do not limit the use of rootwads for habitat enhancement or augmenting riparian vegetation restoration. Rootwads require a thorough and immediate revegetation plan for complete and long-term project success, and if not constructed properly, fish habitat enhancement values may be less than desired. Finally, if not orientated correctly with respect to the thalweg and scour depth, and if protective measures for flanking are not accounted for, waterbody bank failure may result. Although rootwads have the potential to function well on many types of streams, the risk of failure, habitat benefits, complication of design and construction, and overall aesthetics can differ among streams. Project success is often dependent on thorough knowledge of physical stream processes and ecological relations in the project stream, as well as experience in the design and construction of stabilization measures. Considerations when evaluating site viability for rootwads include, but are not limited to: 1. Habitat Requirements Streambank stabilization projects where natural materials are used to produce

structural diversity, velocity differentials, scour, undercut banks, and substrate sorting are good candidates.

2. Sediment Dynamics Rootwads should not be used where sediment deposition along the bank is

desirable.

May 2017 Page 2 of 4 CDED B810

Page 739: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROOTWAD STRUCTURES

3. Stream Size Rootwads are best suited for streams where the effective rootwad surface spans

the distance between base scour elevation and near bank-full elevation. 4. Planform Stability Stable meander geometry must exist at least one meander sequence above and

below the project area, e.g. the incoming flow direction must be consistent. 5. Grade Stability Channel incision should be absent or bed elevation must be maintained naturally

or by other grade control features. Rootwads do not provide grade control. 6. Bank Soils Rootwads may have limited success and are considered at high risk of failure on

streams where streambed and banks consist of uniform sand (<15 percent silt/clay).

7. Life of Rootwad Structure Rootwads are best where temporary (5-15 yr.) stabilization is needed and riparian

vegetation will thrive. Rootwads decompose, so the flow deflection benefits are temporary and vegetation must replace the rootwads to provide long-term stability.

810.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure for rootwad structures is each.

810.9 DOCUMENTATION 810.9.1 Contract Drawings

A plan shall be provided, and show:

• Location of the rootwad structures. • Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for each

rootwad structure. • Original ground contour.

May 2017 Page 3 of 4 CDED B810

Page 740: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROOTWAD STRUCTURES

• Low water level. • Cover treatment/erosion control for disturbed ground areas and graded slopes.

810.9.2 Quantity Sheets

The locations and quantities of rootwad structures are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. Each location may have more than one rootwad structure. The quantity entered in the Q-sheet for each location is the number of rootwad structures to be constructed. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

May 2017 Page 4 of 4 CDED B810

Page 741: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LARGE WOODY DEBRIS

B811 - LARGE WOODY DEBRIS - OPSS 811 811.1 GENERAL

Large woody debris (LWD) is an important structural and functional component of stream ecosystems. Large woody debris represents a multi-functional value by increasing types and sizes of pools, sediment storage, and scour, added cover, and the stabilization of critical spawning areas such as gravel beds. LWD can dramatically increase channel aggregation and therefore help re-establish riparian vegetation.

811.2 REFERENCES - None

811.3 TENDER ITEMS Large Woody Debris (Normal, m)

811.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of large woody debris are contained in OPSS 811.

811.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

811.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

811.7 DESIGN LWD can influence the flow and the shape of the stream channel. Large woody debris slows the flow through a bend in the stream, while accelerating flow in the constricted area downstream of the obstruction. Large woody debris also plays a major role in stream channel morphology, contributing to formation of pool habitat, increasing meandering, and increasing

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B811

Page 742: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LARGE WOODY DEBRIS

sediment capacity. Large woody debris dissipates flow energy, resulting in improved fish migration and channel stability. Positive effects of LWD are well- documented in high gradient streams, as well as low gradient streams with fine substrates. Placing LWD into streams is a popular technique to improve fish habitat. Large woody debris has two main purposes. One purpose is to alter flows in some way to improve aquatic habitat. The other has many objectives which are listed below: 1. Create pool habitat. 2. Generate scour. 3. Increase depths through shallow reaches. 4. Divert flows away from a bank to reduce erosion. 5. Armor stream banks to reduce erosion. 6. Promote point bar formation through induced sediment deposition. 7. Increase instream cover and refugia. For the purposes of altering flows LWD can be successfully implemented in any sized stream as long as a stable bank is available. Large woody debris should never be anchored to an actively eroding bank or an actively incising channel bed. Large woody debris should be added to areas where existing LWD is rare or absent. LWD can increase flow resistance in a stream and should not be implemented in stream reaches where existing flood hazard is high.

811.8 COMPUTATION The unit of measure for large woody debris is metre. The length is measured along the top of the waterbody bank.

811.9 DOCUMENTATION

811.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the LWD. • Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for each

location of large woody debris. • Original ground contour. • Normal water level. • Cover treatment/erosion control for disturbed ground areas and graded slopes. A note is to be included if excavated material is acceptable to be used in lieu of backfill stone: “Excavated bank material may be re-used as backfill stone”.

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B811

Page 743: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LARGE WOODY DEBRIS

811.9.2 Quantity Sheets

The locations and quantities of large woody debris are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

811.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Individual quantity entries are recorded to the nearest 0.1 m. The tender item total is rounded to the nearest 0.1 m.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B811

Page 744: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 745: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LUNKERS

B812 - LUNKERS - OPSS 812 812.1 GENERAL

LUNKERS are structures that provide bank stability and improve aquatic habitat. LUNKERS are constructed of wood or stone and installed at the toe of a slope within a watercourse and incorporate other bank stabilization methods (e.g. bioengineering) for up-slope stabilization.

812.2 REFERENCES MTO Environmental Guide for Fish and Fish Habitat

812.3 TENDER ITEMS Wood LUNKERS (Normal, metre, Non-PQP) Stone LUNKERS (Normal, metre, Non-PQP)

812.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of LUNKERS are contained in OPSS 812.

812.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

812.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 of the Ministry of Transportation Ontario Drawings (MTODs).

812.07 DESIGN LUNKERS are crib-like, wooden or stone structures installed along the toe of a waterbody bank to create overhead bank cover and resting areas for fish. They can be used in rivers or streams independently or in conjunction with erosion control measures such as bioengineering techniques.

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B812

Page 746: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LUNKERS

LUNKERS were originally developed as habitat enhancement structures to provide both waterbody bank stability and waterbody bank cover. While their use has primarily focused on providing trout habitat, they are applicable to other species as well. LUNKERS are appropriate for application on the outside of a waterbody bend or on actively eroding banks. The flows of the waterbody where the LUNKER is installed must be sufficient to prevent the build-up of sediment in the LUNKER. LUNKERS are ideal in channel situations where there is predominately large (i.e. cobble/boulder size) streambed material in the channel with an average grade of less than 4%. These streams are gently meandering and have defined pools and riffles. LUNKER structures are designed to be placed below the elevation of the low water level typically along the outside bends of a waterbody where the channel depth is consistently higher than the top of the LUNKER. They are also designed to be hydraulically stable. For LUNKERS to function properly and provide the intended benefits, consideration must be given to their location and placement. LUNKERS should not be used if the current is not fast enough or the LUNKERS cannot be constructed to produce adequate stream flows that both discourage new sediment deposition and also mobilize previously accumulated sediments. It may be necessary to place streambed material (i.e. in-channel boulders) to force flows through the structure. These should be positioned during construction. LUNKERS work well at improving habitat in areas with degraded channel banks that are void or lacking in vegetation and therefore have decreased cover and increased water temperatures. They can also provide a deeper and narrower cross section where the channel width has become unnaturally wide and shallow. LUNKERS provide a location that is completely covered in shade, has lower velocities, yet maintains adequate depth for the aquatic population (as opposed to the typical shallow depths found along the channel shore/bank). Additionally, LUNKERS serve as protection from erosive channel forces on the bank thus stabilizing the bank vegetation. LUNKERS are not recommended for streams subject to severe flooding. Waterbodies which move large volumes of sediment are not appropriate for the design and placement of LUNKERS since they are typically well entrenched and actively moving laterally.

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B812

Page 747: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LUNKERS

812.8 COMPUTATION The unit of measure for LUNKERS is metre. The length is measured along the top of the waterbody bank.

812.9 DOCUMENTATION

812.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan and typical cross section(s) shall be provided, and show: • Location of the LUNKER structure; • Local stationing and station limits (if available) and unique identifier for the

LUNKER; • Original ground contour; • Type of streambed material; • High water level; and • Cover treatment/erosion control for disturbed ground areas and graded slopes

812.9.2 Quantity Sheets The locations and quantities of LUNKER structures are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are shown using local stationing (if available) and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

812.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Individual quantity entries are recorded to the nearest 0.1 m. The tender item total is rounded to the nearest 0.1 m.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B812

Page 748: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 749: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RIFFLES ON STREAMBEDS

B820 - RIFFLES ON STREAMBEDS - OPSS 820 820.1 GENERAL

Riffles on streambeds are used to help provide a range of flow velocities, flow depths and substrates and hence a diversity of habitats within a channel. Riffles improve water quality through the oxygenation of water over riffles, reducing the re-suspension of fine sediment that can cause turbidity and spread of sediment-bound contaminants downstream.

820.2 REFERENCES CDED B823 Low Flow Channels OPSS 1005 Aggregates – Streambed Material

820.3 TENDER ITEMS Riffles (Normal, m², PQP)

820.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of riffles are contained in OPSS 820.

820.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

820.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

May 2017 Page 1 of 4 CDED B820

Page 750: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RIFFLES ON STREAMBEDS

820.7 DESIGN The design of riffles for natural channels is based on consultation with and/or the recommendations of environmental staff on the project. Most natural channel designs comprise a series of riffles, made up of high points composed of coarse substrate. At low flows, riffles have turbulent, shallow flow that aids to increase the streams dissolved oxygen content, and are the most productive areas for generating food and acting as spawning grounds. Riffles are characteristic of meandering streams. On average they tend to occur at intervals of 5 to 7 times the bankfull channel width. Riffles form the transition zones between bends. In low flow conditions, the flow over riffles is super-critical at which point they experience scour. However, larger substrate in the riffles is more resistant to erosion and they stay stable under all but most severe food events. Riffles create resistance to flow, and tend to migrate slowly downstream with the progression of the meander’s movement. The design shall mimic the riffles naturally occurring in the waterway to the greatest extent possible. The design and installation of a riffle shall not cause any negative impacts to the discharge rates or sediment loads of the subject watercourse. Riffles shall increase the channel roughness to provide improved habitat diversity and dissolved oxygen content for fish and aquatic life. The design must ensure that the riffle(s) will not redirect the stream flow and cause erosion or instability in the waterbody banks. Riffles should be located along straight reaches of the waterway or at meander inflection points. Riffles should not be located on bends as they may direct flows into the downstream bank, causing erosion. The heights of the riffles should be set to follow the average slope of the reach. If using riffles to control erosion, the height of the riffle should backflood to the base of the next riffle upstream. Riffles should typically be designed to block no more than 10% of the channel cross-sectional area and the height be kept under 500 mm to minimize disruption to high flows. The crest of the riffle should be keyed into the bed and banks and the rocks extended to the bankfull level. The riffle crest shall be composed of large upstream facing stone to ensure that migration of materials is minimized. Refer to OPSS 1005. The upstream facing slope of a riffle shall be no greater than 4H:1V. Elevating the crest will form a natural pool area to ensure that the watercourse will be maintained during low flows and provide a low velocity basin to reduce scouring of fine-grained channel bottoms. Riffle stone mixture is placed to create the downstream slope. Refer to OPSS 1005.

May 2017 Page 2 of 4 CDED B820

Page 751: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RIFFLES ON STREAMBEDS

The downstream face shall have a slope that is equal to that of a natural riffle in the watercourse, or the average slope of the watercourse derived from 200 m upstream and 200 m downstream of the new riffle. The riffle shall be less in height that the normal water level of the channel, with the exception of some sporadic emergent boulders or cobbles. A low flow channel shall be included in the design. Refer to CDED B823 for low flow channels. Each riffle shall span the width of the high water level of the channel and range in length between one and two times the high water level width of the channel. If multiple riffles are installed in sequence, the spacing between riffles should be designed based one or more of the following: • natural riffles that are accumulating; • the distance observed between existing riffles in a similar undisturbed section of

the watercourse; • meander cross-over points; or • five to seven average wetted stream widths apart.

820.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure for riffles is square metre. The square metre area is measured from the design cross sections or scaled from the contract drawings for each location.

820.9 DOCUMENTATION

820.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the riffles. Include width and length dimensions for each. • Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for each riffle. • Existing ground contour, and excavation/grading limits, if required. • Streambed material to be placed (refer to OPSS 1005). • Riffle height, measured from base of placement to the crest. • Normal and high water levels. • References to applicable OPSD.

May 2017 Page 3 of 4 CDED B820

Page 752: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING RIFFLES ON STREAMBEDS

820.9.2 Quantity Sheets The locations and quantities of riffles are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The square metre quantity is entered in the appropriate Q-sheet column for each riffle location. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

820.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and offsets are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 metres. Individual quantity entries are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 m². The tender item total is rounded to the nearest whole number.

May 2017 Page 4 of 4 CDED B820

Page 753: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING POOLS IN STREAMBEDS

B821 - POOLS IN STREAMBEDS - OPSS 821 821.1 GENERAL

Pools in streambeds are used to help provide a range of flow velocities, flow depths and substrates and hence a diversity of habitats within a channel. Pools, in combination with riffles, improve water quality by reducing the capacity of the stream to transport sediment.

821.2 REFERENCES OPSS 1005 Aggregates – Streambed Material

821.3 TENDER ITEMS Pools (Normal, m², PQP)

821.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of pools are contained in OPSS 821.

821.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

821.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

821.7 DESIGN The design of pools for natural channels is based on consultation with and/or the recommendations of environmental staff on the project. Most natural channels comprise a series of pools made up of low points with finer bed materials. Pools are formed at the concave banks in the bend.

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B821

Page 754: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING POOLS IN STREAMBEDS

Pools are excavated from the streambed to increase the channel depth and provide habitat, refuge, and migration passage downstream and/or upstream of high velocity areas, such as riffles or culverts. The designed pool depth and form should be designed to be compatible with other pools within the system. Pools are designed to complement the natural flow pattern of the stream, and prevent any negative impacts to the discharge rates or sediment loads of the watercourse. The design and installation prevents bank instability or erosion and scouring of the streambed. Pools should not be lined with stone (unless required for protection) so they can adjust naturally with flow conditions. However, streambed material is placed immediately downstream of the pool to provide streambed protection and variety in the substrate. Refer to OPSS 1005. Overhanging or in-stream cover can be incorporated into the design of the pool to provide cover for aquatic life and fish species. Cover elements in the design may include, but are not limited to the placement of sporadic cobbles or boulders in the pool or riparian plantings to provide overhanging vegetation. Culvert outlet pools are designed to be slightly deeper to provide additional energy dissipation function. When pools are installed at the downstream end of a culvert, the design is to ensure that a minimum of 200 mm of water depth is maintained in the culvert and at the culvert inlet upstream. Pools at culvert outlets are typically 2 to 4 times the culvert diameter in length and 0.5 times the culvert diameter in depth (but should always be a minimum of 1 meter in depth).

821.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure for pools is square metre. The square metre area is calculated based on the plan area at each location.

821.9 DOCUMENTATION

821.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the pools. Include width and length dimensions for each. • Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for each pool. • Existing streambed ground contour, and excavation/grading limits.

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B821

Page 755: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING POOLS IN STREAMBEDS

• Streambed material to be placed (refer to OPSS 1005). • Depth of streambed material. • Pool depth, measured from base of existing streambed to the bottom of the pool. • Normal and high water levels. • References to applicable OPSD.

821.9.2 Quantity Sheets

The locations and quantities of pools are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The square metre quantity is entered in the appropriate Q-sheet column for each pool location. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

821.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and offsets are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 metres. Individual quantity entries are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 m². The tender item total is rounded to the nearest whole number.

821.9.4 Non-Standard Documentation When streambed material excavated to form pools is to be re-used elsewhere, a non-standard special provision is required to specify the requirements.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B821

Page 756: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 757: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCKY RAMPS ON STREAMBEDS

B822 - ROCKY RAMPS ON STREAMBEDS - OPSS 822 822.1 GENERAL

Rocky ramps on streambeds are used to help provide a range of flow velocities, flow depths and substrates and hence a diversity of habitats within a channel. They also improve water quality.

822.2 REFERENCES OPSS 1005 Aggregates – Streambed Material

822.3 TENDER ITEMS Rocky Ramps (Normal, m², PQP)

822.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of rocky ramps are contained in OPSS 822.

822.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

822.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

822.7 DESIGN Rocky ramps on streambeds are structures commonly used on low obstructions less than four metres high. They consist of rocky ramps with a series of pools separated by ridges over which the water flows. These ridges are low enough to enable fish to move between the pools and therefore pass upstream. The gradient on which they are built is usually 1:20.

May 2017 Page 1 of 4 CDED B822

Page 758: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCKY RAMPS ON STREAMBEDS

It is necessary to survey the site properly to ensure that the design, especially the height levels, is adequate to permit water flow down the rocky ramps and that it is of low enough energy to allow fish to pass around the barrier. Individual designs vary depending on the site (taking into account factors such as the stream size, flow rates, stream gradients, stream bank slope and streambed substrata type), the availability of materials (especially suitable rocks/concrete) and the nature of the obstruction to be overcome (such as the height and morphology of a weir wall). Rocky ramp on streambeds are designed to provide a pool – boulder weir sequence that permits the passage of fish over an in-stream barrier. The slope of the ramp is determined based on all of the following: • The height of the obstruction;

• The water levels and discharge rates;

• The required velocity based on the burst speed of local fish species;

• The water depth required for fish passage;

• The distance available downstream for the ramp; and

• The slope of the waterway in an undisturbed reach of the watercourse containing a boulder weir.

When possible, the design should incorporate the removal of the in-stream obstruction (e.g. weir or dam) from the streambed prior to installing the rocky ramp. Excavation of the streambed or addition of material to the streambed shall be completed to obtain the desired slope. A streambed that has been excavated to the desired slope shall have a layer of boulder weir stone mixture placed the prepared surface. If the streambed must be built-up, the material used shall be boulder weir stone mixture (refer to OPSS 1005). Site specific measures may be required to prevent the stream flow from seeping down into the ramp. Measures such as a clay core or liner, or addition of fine material in the boulder weir stone mixture may be used for preventing seepage. Once the desired slope and height of the ramp is obtained, large stones shall be arranged to create boulder weir-pool sequences down the face of the slope. The spacing and height requirements of the boulder weirs and pools shall be specified in the design. The rocky ramp shall span the entire width of the watercourse channel and extend past the high water level up the watercourse banks to provide armoring against erosion. The entire length of the rocky ramp shall include a low flow channel to ensure fish passage during all water level conditions.

May 2017 Page 2 of 4 CDED B822

Page 759: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCKY RAMPS ON STREAMBEDS

822.8 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure for rocky ramps is square metre. The square metre area is calculated based on the plan area at each rocky ramp location.

822.9 DOCUMENTATION

822.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the rocky ramps and individual boulder weirs and pools. Include

width and length dimensions for each.

• Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for each rocky ramp.

• Existing streambed contour and design contour, if excavation/grading required.

• Profile with overall and local slopes along the rocky ramps and depths and/or elevations of boulder weir crests and pools.

• Streambed material(s) to be placed (refer to OPSS 1005).

• Depth of streambed material(s).

• Normal and high water levels.

• References to applicable OPSD.

822.9.2 Quantity Sheets The locations and quantities of rocky ramps are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The square metre quantity is entered in the appropriate Q-sheet column for each rocky ramp location. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

May 2017 Page 3 of 4 CDED B822

Page 760: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING ROCKY RAMPS ON STREAMBEDS

822.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and offsets are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 metres. Individual quantity entries are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 m². The tender item total is rounded to the nearest whole number.

822.9.4 Non-Standard Documentation When existing obstructions to fish passage within the stream are to be removed, a non-standard special provision is required to specify the requirements.

May 2017 Page 4 of 4 CDED B822

Page 761: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LOW FLOW CHANNELS

B823 - LOW FLOW CHANNELS - OPSS 823 823.1 GENERAL

Low flow channels are constructed to maintain and enhance fish passage in a waterbody or culvert.

823.2 REFERENCES OPSS 1005 Aggregates - Streambed Material

823.3 TENDER ITEMS Low Flow Channel (Normal, m, PQP) Low Flow Channel (Normal, tonnes, Non-PQP)

823.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of low flow channels are contained in OPSS 823.

823.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

823.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

823.7 DESIGN The design of low flow channels is based on consultation with and/or the recommendations of environmental staff on the project. The low flow channel design should create a low width to depth ratio channel that is within the streambed.

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B823

Page 762: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LOW FLOW CHANNELS

The low flow channel should not affect the hydraulic design criteria of any culverts and shall prevent any scouring or erosion of the streambed or waterbody banks. The success of this technique on sand-bed channels is virtually nonexistent due to the high transport rates of sediment under nearly all flow regimes. The watercourse velocity within the low flow channel should not exceed the burst speed of the resident or target fish species. Fish passage during all water level conditions should be accommodated, with the exception of an approved watercourse diversion. This may require excavation of the streambed. The excavated materials shall be used to line the low flow channel, except if it is fine silt and/or clay it shall not be used for lining the channel. If the excavated materials are fine grain materials, streambed material shall be used to line the channel. Refer to OPSS 1005.

823.8 COMPUTATION Low flow channel by the metre is a Plan Quantity Payment item. Low flow channel by the tonne is not a Plan Quantity Payment item. When streambed material is not required, the unit of measure for low flow channel is the metre. Measurement is based on the length of the low flow channel centreline. When streambed material is required to be placed on the streambed and to construct the low flow channel, the unit of measure for low flow channel is the mass of streambed material in tonnes. A conversion factor of 2.0 tonnes/m³ should be used.

823.9 DOCUMENTATION

823.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the low flow channel.

• Station limits, or other location referencing, and unique identifier for the low flow channel.

• Cross section showing the dimensions of the low flow channel, and excavation and streambed material placement, if applicable.

• Existing streambed contour and design contour, if excavation/grading required.

• Overall slope of the low flow channel.

• Streambed material to be placed (refer to OPSS 1005).

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B823

Page 763: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING LOW FLOW CHANNELS

• Depth of streambed material.

• Low and normal water levels.

• References to applicable OPSD.

• Include a note specifying the requirements when existing streambed materials to be excavated are to be re-used in the work.

823.9.2 Quantity Sheets

The locations and quantities of low flow channels are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Locations are identified by station, or other location referencing, and the unique identifiers used on the contract drawings. The metre or tonnage quantity, as applicable, is entered in the appropriate Q-sheet column for each low flow channel location. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

823.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and offsets are recorded in whole number metres. Individual quantity entries for low flow channel by the metre are recorded to an accuracy of 0.1 metres. The tender item total is rounded to the nearest 0.1 m. Individual quantity entries for low flow channel by the tonne are recorded to the nearest whole number. The tender item total is rounded to the nearest whole number.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B823

Page 764: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 765: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING BAFFLES IN A CULVERT

B824 - BAFFLES IN A CULVERT - OPSS 824 824.1 GENERAL

Baffles in a culvert are constructed to direct water flow and enhance fish passage.

824.2 REFERENCES OPSS 1005 Aggregates - Streambed Material

824.3 TENDER ITEMS Baffles in a Culvert (Normal, each, PQP)

824.4 SPECIFICATIONS The construction requirements for the installation of culvert baffles are contained in OPSS 824.

824.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS Refer to Chapter “E” of this Manual to review the applicable standard special provisions.

824.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 200 series of Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD).

824.7 DESIGN The design of baffles is based on consultation with and/or the recommendations of environmental staff on the project. Baffles will create hydraulic conditions that will maintain fish passage through the entire length of the Culvert, and are permanent structures designed to be hydraulically stable within the culvert.

May 2017 Page 1 of 3 CDED B824

Page 766: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING BAFFLES IN A CULVERT

The design and installation of baffles must be considered during the hydraulic design of the culvert. Fish passage during all water level conditions shall be accommodated, with the exception of an approved watercourse diversion. The baffles provide localized resting areas, and a stream velocity that is equal to or less than the burst speed of fish species present in the watercourse for all water level conditions. Baffles shall have a sufficient downstream angle to prevent the collection of sediment and/or debris. The installation and operation of baffles shall not cause scouring or erosion of the watercourse banks or streambed. Baffles may be constructed of rock or concrete.

824.8 COMPUTATION This is a Plan Quantity Payment item. The unit of measure for baffles in a culvert is each. The work is for the construction of baffles, only. The placement of streambed material and construction of a low flow channel within the culvert requires the use of the low flow channel item (refer to section B823).

824.9 DOCUMENTATION

824.9.1 Contract Drawings A plan shall be provided, and show: • Location of the baffles. • Station reference and culvert number and/or stream name. • Baffle material. For rock, refer to OPSS 1005. For concrete, the material

requirements must be specified on the drawings. • Baffle elevation, dimensions, spacing, and downstream angle. • References to applicable OPSD.

May 2017 Page 2 of 3 CDED B824

Page 767: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING BAFFLES IN A CULVERT

824.9.2 Quantity Sheets The location and quantities of baffles in a culvert are documented on Miscellaneous 1 Q-Sheets. Each culvert location is identified by station reference and culvert number and/or stream name. The number of baffles is entered in the appropriate Q-sheet column for each culvert location. The individual column entries are automatically totaled and transferred to the Tender Item List.

824.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Individual quantity entries are recorded to the nearest whole number.

May 2017 Page 3 of 3 CDED B824

Page 768: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 769: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-1

902 - EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES - OPSS 902

902.1 GENERAL

902.1.1 Excavation for Structures

Excavation for structures deals with excavation in earth or rock for the placement of the following structures:

- Bridges - Working slabs/pads - footings for piers and abutments - wingwalls

- Concrete Culverts - footings - aprons - wingwalls

- Retaining Walls - footings - wingwalls

with additional excavations for:

- Bedding - box culverts - working slabs

- Frost Tapers - bridges - concrete culverts - retaining walls

902.1.2 Backfill to Structures

This is not a separate tender item. Granular backfill is included as part of the general granular item.

Concrete structures may be backfilled with rock. In certain circumstances, when granular material is not readily available or in order to reduce high granular costs, rock available for fill may be used as backfill material. Before opting for rock backfill, a cost

comparison must be completed to determine the more economical alternative.

When rock is used as structure backfill, a standard Special Provision must be included stating the gradation of the backfill material, together with MTO

Standard Drawings (Structural). The rock backfill is paid for as part of the rock excavation from which it is obtained.

902.1.3 Tender Items

The tender items associated with excavation and backfill for structures are:

Earth Excavation for Structure

Page 770: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-2

Rock Excavation for Structure

Unwatering Structure Excavation

Clay Seal

Related Tender Items

Other tender items usually required with the excavation and backfilling of structures are:

Granular B Type I

Granular B Type II

Roadway Protection

Track Protection

902.1.4 Specifications

The work of excavation for structures in both earth and rock, and the placing of granular backfill, are detailed in OPSS 902.

902.1.5 Special Provisions

The designer should investigate to determine whether any Standard Special Provisions are required to be included in the contract.

902.1.6 Standard Drawings

To establish the physical limits upon which to base quantities, the designer must be familiar with:

1) Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings - 800 Series 2) Ontario Provincial Standards Drawaing - 3000, 4000 Series.

902.2 COMPUTATION

Earth Excavation for Structure and Rock Excavation for Structure are Plan Quantity Payment items.

Unwatering Structure Excavation and Clay Seal are not Plan Quantity Payment items.

902.2.1 Source of Information

The main sources of information are the Foundation Design Section, the Structural Office/Section and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

902.2.2 Method of Calculation

Page 771: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-3

Earth and Rock Excavation

The total excavation for structure includes the excavations required to place the concrete structure, beddings and frost tapers.

The price bid for the appropriate Structure Excavation tender item also includes the removal of overlying asphaltic or concrete pavements, curb and gutters and sidewalks. Where however there are separate tender items for removal of pavements, curb and gutter or sidewalk which overlaps the removal of pavement, curb and gutter or sidewalk over the structure excavation, then payment for the removal of these surface features will be made under the appropriate tender items, for removal of pavement, curb and gutter and sidewalk.

The excavation required to place a concrete structure is determined by calculating the volume in cubic metres normally based on:

1. - an upper limit of: a) original ground, or b) the designated payment surface (see 902.2.3)

2. - a lower limit of: a) bottom of footings b) bottom of bedding c) bottom of working slab/pad d) other special application

3. - the plan area of the footings

In excavating for standard and rigid frame open-footing concrete culverts, the materialbetween the walls/footings and above the stream bed elevation shall be part of the structure excavation (see Figure 902-1).

Excavation in rock is the same as that for earth, except that the upper limit is the rock line rather than the original ground line. Should a culvert occur in a rock cut location, the upper limit of rock is the top of shatter.

Backfill - Granular/Rock

Granular backfill quantities are computed according to the dimensions shown on the OPS Drawings or the Structure Drawings. The upper limit is the bottom of granular sub-base (except for retaining walls in cuts), and includes backfill for frost tapers, where required.

Rock backfill quantities for bridge abutments are computed according to OPSD 3505 depending on whether the structure or roadbed is constructed first. This will be determined in consultation with the Structural Section.

Clay Seal

No volume calculations for clay seal are needed. If excavation is required to place the clay seal, the volume is computed and shown only as "material available for fill".

902.2.3 Designated Payment Surface

Page 772: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-4

If using the original ground elevation results in excessive overlap between earth excavation for structure and earth excavation for grading, the designer, in consultation with the Structural Office/Section, may choose a designated payment surface at a lower elevation, with the purpose of reducing the overlap. When the original ground line is well above the subgrade line (and, in fact, above the top of proposed pavement), then a Designated Payment Surface could be struck at the subgrade elevation. This surface would be horizontal both longitudinally and transversely, (see Figures B902-2 and B902-3).

The following considerations affect the application of the Designated Payment Surface (DPS):

a) Overlapping excavations are to be tolerated unless the Highway Designer decides that the volume obtained is unrealistic, to the extent that contract balancing would be based on erroneous quantities;

b) The DPS is to be used only in exceptional situations.

902.3 DOCUMENTATION

902.3.1 Contract Drawings

Concrete Culverts

New concrete culverts and existing concrete culverts requiring extension are shown on the plans and profiles of the contract drawings.

Where the design shows a need for roadway or track protection, a protection scheme will be provided by the Regional Structural Section, and shown in full detail on the Structural Drawings. A separate tender item must be provided to cover the protection work.

Designated Payment Surface

For each structure that utilizes a designated payment surface, a detailed sketch with supporting elevation(s) must be shown on the highway grading drawings, and not on structural drawings.

Use of Specific Materials

When the design depends on the use of a specific material, that material must be identified on the drawings even when it is to be provided under the Earth Excavation(Grading) or Earth Borrow item.

Clay Seal

A detailed dimensioned sketch for each location must be shown on the contract drawings.

Page 773: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-5

Page 774: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-6

902.3.2 Contract Documents

Excavation for Structures

Excavation quantities for each structure, computed in cubic metres to the nearest whole number, must be checked 100%.

Page 775: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL FOR STRUCTURES

96 05 B902-7

The quantity for each bridge, concrete culvert and retaining wall is shown separately on "Quantities - Miscellaneous 1 or 2 "or "Quantities - Structures" sheet, and the columns (Earth, Rock) totalled to form the tender quantities.

Excavated Material should be made available for full reductions by showing the quantityon the quantities -grading sheet.

Unwatering Structure Excavation

Where unwatering operations are required, the appropriate column should show "100%" against the structure entry on the quantity sheet.

Granular Backfill

The granular quantity for each bridge, concrete culvert and retaining wall is listed separately on the "Quantities - 1" or "Quantities - 2" sheet. The column subtotal is transferred to the main granular item on the "Quantites - Hot Mix and Granulars" sheet and included in the tender quantity.

Clay Seal

Clay seal is documented on the same quantity sheet where concrete culverts are documented. It is identified as a separate tender item without quantity entries. Note that clay seal information for pipe culvert locations are kept separately from those for concrete culverts, and generate a separate lump sum tender item under OPSS 421.

Page 776: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 777: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CULVERTS

95 04 B904-1

904 - CONCRETE IN CULVERTS - OPSS 904

904.1 GENERAL

The work under this item consists of the constructing of falsework, supplying, mixing, pouring, finishing and curing of concrete. The concrete footing is included in the concrete in culvert item. These design guide lines should be read in conjunction with B905

Concrete culverts are divided into two groups.

a) Standard Culverts b) Special Design Culverts

Each group may be broken down into either Rigid Frame Open Footing Type, Rigid Frame Box Type or Non-Rigid Frame Box Type Culverts.

Standard Culverts as well as Special Design Culverts are designed by the Regional Structural Section or by the Structural Office. The designer decides on the location and opening size of a standard concrete culvert. For larger catchment areas the Hydrology Section is contacted to provide the necessary information on the required opening size.

When extending existing concrete box culverts designers should determine whether existing accumulated sediment requires removal from within the culvert in order to reestablish design drainage capacity.

904.1.1 Tender Items

- Concrete in Culverts 904.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for concrete in culverts are covered by OPSS 904.

The requirements for Precast Box Culverts are covered by OPSS 422 and OPSS 1821.

904.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review applicable special provisions. The standard special provision, whereby the contractor may substitute precast concrete box

culverts for cast-in-place concrete box culverts, should be included in the contract.

904.1.4 Standard Drawings

Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) are not available for concrete culverts. Sampledrawings for a standard culvert size are contained in the Concrete Culvert Design and Detailing Manual prepared by the Structural Office.

Page 778: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CULVERTS

95 04 B904-2

904.2 COMPUTATION

This is a Plan Quantity Payment item.

904.2.1 Sources of Information

a) MTO Concrete Culvert Design and Detailing Manual

This manual contains instructions on the structural design and details only. It does not provide any information on culvert size or culvert type selection.

b) MTO Drainage Manual

This manual contains information to determine the culvert size, the type and drainage design procedure.

c) Soils Design Information (Report and Profile) provided by the Geotechnical Section.

d) OPSS 422 and 1821

These specifications cover the requirements for material, design, fabrication and installation of single-cell precast box culverts not exceeding 3 m in span for placement under a minimum fill depth of 600 mm.

904.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for concrete in culvert is cubic metre.

The concrete tender quantity is forwarded to the designer/project manager, by either the Regional Structural Section or by the Structural Office.

904.3 DOCUMENTATION

a) Contract Drawings

The designer/project manager includes the culvert drawings provided by the Structural Section/Office into the contract.

b) Quantity Sheet

The documentation of "Excavation and Backfill for structures" is explained in Section B902 of this manual.

Concrete, reinforcing steel and coated reinforcing steel for culverts form separate tender items. However, when the totalled quantity of reinforcing steel for all concrete culverts in a contract is less than 5 tonnes, then the reinforcing steel will be included in the concrete item and there will be no separate tender item for reinforcing steel. In this case OPS Specification 905 shall be shown against the Concrete in Culvert item in the tender form.

Page 779: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CULVERTS

95 04 B904-3

The volume of concrete is transferred from the drawings to any Miscellaneous Quantity Sheet and listed against the station and location for each concrete culvert. Quantities in each column are totalled. This total is the tender total and is transferred to the Form of Tender.

The Structural Section/Office shall supply separate estimated quantities for coated and uncoatedreinforcing steel, for the Estimating Office, in the "Notes to Planning and Design." These notes are for information purposes only, and form part of the structural package sent to Planning and Design. Planning and Design will forward these quantities to the Estimating Office.

904.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole numbers. Concrete quantity entries are recorded in 0.1 m3 . 100% checking is required.

Page 780: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 781: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CULVERTS

96 05 B905-1

905 - REINFORCING STEEL - OPSS 905 - COATED REINFORCING STEEL - OPSS 905

905.1 GENERAL

The work under these items consists of the placing of steel reinforcement. The following designguidelines should be read in conjunction with B904.

905.1.1 Reinforcing Steel

"Coated reinforcing steel" is steel covered with an epoxy protective coating to prevent prematuredeterioration. It is used in structure areas exposed to road salt.

905.1.2 Tender Items

- Reinforcing Steel Bar - Coated Reinforcing Steel Bar - Mechanical Connectors - Coated Mechanical Connectors 905.1.3 Specifications The requirements for the work of placing reinforcing steel are contained in OPSS 905.

905.1.4 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter "E" of this manual to review applicable special provisions.

905.1.5 Standard Drawings

Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings (OPSD) are not available for placing reinforcing steel.

Reinforcing steel details are provided on structural drawings by the Structural Office/Section.

905.2 COMPUTATION

These are Lump Sum items.

905.2.1 Method of Calculation

The Structural Office/Section shall provide both coated and uncoated reinforcing steel tonnages for use by the Estimating Office in the "Notes to Planning and Design". These quantities will not form part of the tender documents.

Page 782: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING CONCRETE CULVERTS

96 05 B905-2

905.3 DOCUMENTATION

a) Contract Drawings

The designer includes the pertinent drawings provided by the Structure Office/Section into the contract.

b) Quantity Sheet

When the sum of the quantities for each type of steel, (i.e. uncoated and coated) required for all cast in place concrete culverts is 5 tonnes or greater then separate lump sum bid tender items will be set up for: Reinforcing Steel, and Coated Reinforcing Steel.

The Quantity sheet will be completed by showing the notation 100% against each component requiring steel reinforcement (i.e.) concrete culvert, headwall, appurtenance etc.

The notations "100%" and "L.S." must also be shown in the "Totals" and "Unit" lines respectively for the appropriate rebar items.

However, when the sum of the quantity of reinforcing steel required for cast in place culverts on a project is less than 5 tonnes then the reinforcing steel will be included in the tender item - "Concrete in Culverts", and there will not be a separate rebar tender item. In this case OPSS 905 shall be shown against the item " Concrete in Culverts" on the Form of Tender.

The Structural Office/Section shall supply separate estimated quantities for coated and uncoated reinforcing steel, for the Estimating Office, in the "Notes to Planning and Design." These notes are for information purposes only, and form part of the structural package sent to Planning and Design. Planning and Design will forward these quantities to the Estimating Office.

905.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Stations are recorded in whole numbers.

Page 783: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STRUCTURAL WOOD SYSTEMS

June 2013 Page 1 of 3 B907

B907 - STRUCTURAL WOOD SYSTEMS - OPSS 907 907.1 GENERAL

Structural wood systems, composed of modular bridge components, include all wood in the structure and cribs, and include the associated decking, ramps, bank seats, sidewalks and railings.

907.2 REFERENCES

Ministry of Transportation Publications – Structural Manual Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code

907.3 TENDER ITEMS

Wood in Structure Wood in Cribs

907.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 907. 907.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS

There are currently no special provisions associated with this specification. 907.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS

There are no standard drawings pertaining to Structural Wood Systems. 907.7 DESIGN

The design shall be according to the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code and the Structural Manual.

Page 784: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STRUCTURAL WOOD SYSTEMS

June 2013 Page 2 of 3 B907

907.8 COMPUTATION 907.8.1 Item Payment Basis

Wood in Structure Wood in Cribs

907.8.2 Sources of Information

The main sources of information for the above tender items are the Foundation Design Section, the Structural Office and the Regional Geotechnical Section.

907.8.3 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for the Wood in Structure item is lump sum per cubic metre of volume. The lump sum per cubic metre units are only used for cost estimating. In the tender, this will be a LS item with a quantity of 100%. The unit of measurement for the Wood in Cribs item is the volume in cubic metres. Each component (i.e. pier, abutment) shall be calculated separately and the total summed for each individual structure. The volume of wood shall be calculated based on dressed dimensions and shall be given to the nearest 0.1 of a cubic metre.

907.9 DOCUMENTATION 907.9.1 Drawings

The designer shall include all the pertinent information in the contract drawings. Field Fabrication When field fabrication of wood components is required, the designer shall indicate this on the Contract Drawings under Construction Notes. Bolts, Rods and Lag Screws Where prebored holes in wood are required, they shall be specified as such on the Contract Drawings.

Page 785: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING STRUCTURAL WOOD SYSTEMS

June 2013 Page 3 of 3 B907

Geotextile - Wood in Cribs The designer shall indicate on the Contract Drawings the Geotextile placement details.

Stress-Laminated Wood Decks

The designer shall indicate on the Contract Drawings the stressing forces as well as any stressing sequence requirements.

907.9.2 Quantity Sheets

Each tender item is to be entered into a separate column in the Quantity Sheet-Quantities-Structure. The tender item name is the column heading. For the Wood in Structure tender item, the structure name is labelled in one row. The total is entered as cubic metres for lump sum per cubic metre tender items where the appropriate row and column meet. Contract Preparation System will convert lump sum per cubic metre tender items to lump sum items and insert 100% as the tender quantity. For multiple structures on one contract, it is appropriate to use a separate Wood in Structure tender item for each applicable structure. A separate row in the Quantity sheet is used for each bridge.

Page 786: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 787: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING METAL TRAFFIC BARRIERS AND METAL RAILINGS FOR STRUCTURES

B908 - METAL TRAFFIC BARRIERS AND METAL RAILINGS FOR STRUCTURES - OPSS.PROV 908

908.1 GENERAL

Metal traffic barriers and metal railings are constructed on structures to meet the barrier requirements of the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CHBDC).

908.2 REFERENCES Ministry of Transportation Publications – Structural Manual Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CHBDC)

908.3 TENDER ITEMS Metal Traffic Barrier Barrier Wall Railing Parapet Wall Railing Pedestrian Railing Bicycle Railing

908.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for metal traffic barriers and metal railings are contained in OPSS 908.

908.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items.

908.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Drawings for metal traffic barriers and railings on structures are contained in MTO Structural Standard Drawings.

November 2014 Page 1 of 2 B908

Page 788: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING METAL TRAFFIC BARRIERS AND METAL RAILINGS FOR STRUCTURES

908.7 DESIGN Refer to the Structural Manual and Structural Standard Drawings for barriers and railings on structures. Design requirements for bridge railings are contained in the Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CHBDC).

908.8 COMPUTATION 908.8.1 Item Payment Basis

These are Plan Quantity Payment items.

908.8.2 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement is in metres from end to end of railing. Where a railing system overlaps with an adjacent railing system that is paid for under another tender item, the measurement shall extend from the end of the subject railing system as if the adjacent rail did not exist. Concrete exterior end wall panels and wingwall panels are not considered to be part of a railing system and are not included in the length of a railing system.

908.9 DOCUMENTATION 908.9.1 Contract Drawings

Railings are indicated on the contract drawings using the appropriate standard drawing number, if applicable.

908.9.2 Quantity Sheets Metal traffic barrier and railing installations on structures are recorded on Quantities-Structure Q-Sheet. For multiple structures on the same contract, separate tender items are used for each applicable structure.

908.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Stations and quantities for barriers and railings for structures are recorded to the nearest metre.

November 2014 Page 2 of 2 B908

Page 789: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERPROOFING BRIDGE DECK

B914 – WATERPROOFING BRIDGE DECK – OPSS.PROV 914 914.1 GENERAL

Waterproofing the bridge deck is done on the recommendation of the Regional Structural Section. The top surface of the top slab of a cast-in-place structural concrete culvert may be considered as a bridge deck where waterproofing is required. Included in the area to be waterproofed are the adjacent vertical sides to an elevation of 300 mm below the top surface of the top slab. Hot Applied Asphalt Membrane waterproofing is used on new and existing concrete bridge decks.

914.2 REFERENCES

Ministry of Transportation Publications – Structural Manual

914.3 TENDER ITEMS

Bridge Deck Waterproofing Modification of Deck Drains Form and Fill Grooves Membrane Reinforcement Deck Surface Preparation

914.4 SPECIFICATIONS

The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 914.

914.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter “E” of this manual to review the special provisions applicable to these tender items. Include the appropriate special provisions as required.

December 2014 Page 1 of 3 B914

Page 790: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERPROOFING BRIDGE DECK

914.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS Applicable standard drawings are contained in the 3000 series of the Ontario Provincial Standard Drawings Manual. Where modification of deck drains for existing decks is required, the designer shall include the appropriate OPSD in the Contract Documents.

914.7 DESIGN Refer to the Structural Manual and Structural Standard Drawings (SSD). The work of Membrane Reinforcement, Form and Fill Grooves, and Deck Surface Preparation are included in the tender item Bridge Deck Waterproofing, except when the location of joints or cracks in the deck that will require use of membrane reinforcement cannot be pre-determined. In this case, the tender item Membrane Reinforcement is included along with the Bridge Deck Waterproofing item. Tack coating of the concrete surface is included in the bridge deck waterproofing tender item. Tack coating of the protection board shall be quantified separately as part of the OPSS 308 tack coat item.

914.8 COMPUTATION 914.8.1 Item Payment Basis

Bridge Deck Waterproofing Modification of Deck Drains Form and Fill Grooves Membrane Reinforcement Deck Surface Preparation The work of Membrane Reinforcement, Form and Fill Grooves, and Deck Surface Preparation is normally included with the Bridge Deck Waterproofing item.

914.8.2 Sources of Information The main source of information for the above tender items is the Regional Structural Section.

December 2014 Page 2 of 3 B914

Page 791: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING WATERPROOFING BRIDGE DECK

914.8.3 Method of Calculation The unit of measurement for the Bridge Deck Waterproofing item is LS/m². The m² quantity is calculated for cost estimating only. In the tender, the item is lump sum (LS) with a quantity of 100%. The following four items are PQP items: • The unit of measurement for the Modification of Deck Drains item is each. • The unit of measurement for the Form and Fill Grooves item is metres. • The unit of measurement for the Membrane Reinforcement item is metres. • The unit of measurement for the Deck Surface Preparation item is the area in

square metres.

914.9 DOCUMENTATION 914.9.1 Contract Drawings

The designer shall indicate the required thickness of the combined asphalt and waterproofing system on the Contract Drawings. When a 20 mm wide by 20 mm deep form and fill groove in the asphalt is required to accommodate movement, its location and dimensions shall be shown on the Contract Drawings.

914.9.2 Quantity Sheets Each tender item is to be entered into a separate column in the Quantities-Structure Q-Sheet. For the Bridge Deck Waterproofing item, the m2 quantity is entered. CPS will automatically convert the m² quantity to lump sum (LS) with 100% as quantity. For multiple structures on the same contract, separate tender items are used for each applicable structure.

914.9.3 Documentation Accuracy Linear (m) and area (m²) quantities are documented to the nearest 0.01 m or m².

December 2014 Page 3 of 3 B914

Page 792: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 793: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

932 - CRACK REPAIR - CONCRETE- OPSS 932

932.1 GENERAL

The designer should indicate the approximate location, depth and extent of cracks to be repaired. Not all cracks need to be shown. Locations requiring special access equipment such as scaffolding should be represented reasonably accurately. Typical sections are acceptable for repeated types of work in similar locations and the condition survey has to be made available.

The designer should contact the supplier of the materials to confirm the material to be used is appropriate for the application, installation, temperatures and pressures.

932.1.1 Tender Items

Crack Injection Routing and Sealing - Hot-Poured Rubberized Joint Sealing Compound Routing and Sealing - Cold Applied Joint Sealing Compound

932.1.2 Specifications

The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 932.

932.1.3 Special Provisions

The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review any applicable special provisions.

932.1.4 Standard Drawings

Presently there are no standard drawings pertaining to Crack Injection. Routing and Sealing drawings are illustrated in the Ontario Provincial Standard Manual in the 500 series.

932.2 COMPUTATION

932.2.1 Source of Information

The main source of information for the above tender items is contained in the Structural Design Manual. The designer should also contact the supplier of materials to confirm the material to be used is appropriate for the application, installations, temperatures and pressures.

Rev. Date: 02/99 Crack Repair - Concrete B932-1

Page 794: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

932.2.2 Method of Calculation

The unit of measurement for the tender item Crack Injection is the length of the accepted injected crack in metres.

The unit of measurement for the tender items Routing and Sealing - Hot-Poured Rubberized Joint Sealing Compound and Routing and Sealing - Cold Applied Joint Sealing Compound will be the length of routed and sealed crack in metres.

932.3 DOCUMENTATION

The location of each repair area is indicated on any Quantities - Miscellaneous sheet.

932.3.1 Documentation Accuracy

Summarized repair areas are recorded in whole number linear metres.

Rev. Date: 02/99 Crack Repair - Concrete B932-2

Page 795: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS

November 2013 Page 1 of 5 B942

B942 - PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS - OPSS 942 942.1 GENERAL

Ground anchors are systems used to transfer tensile loads to soil or rock. These systems comprise prestressing steel tendons, steel anchorages, spacers, centralizers and grout. Permanent anchors also require corrosion protection. Ground anchor design and construction require test anchors and production anchors. Test anchors are to provide design information and to verify ground anchor capacity prior to production anchor installation and testing. Usually one (1) or two (2) anchors are subjected to pre-production tests depending on the scope and complexity of the project. Test anchors are subjected to rigorous testing characterized by a number of cyclic loadings for extended duration of up to 24 hours. Production anchors testing are to be carried out on each anchor. Production anchors testing are for anchor performance verification and are of relatively short duration. Post grouting is a process of regrouting an anchor after the primary grout has set. Post grouting is used as a method of increasing the capacity of an anchor.

942.2 REFERENCES Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code Foundation Investigation and Design Reports – project-specific Post Tensioning Institute (PTI) – Recommendations for Prestressed Rock and Soil Anchors.

942.3 TENDER ITEMS Pre-Production Test Anchors Production Anchor Post-Grouting of Bond Length

942.4 SPECIFICATIONS The requirements for the above tender items are contained in OPSS 942.

Page 796: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS

November 2013 Page 2 of 5 B942

942.5 SPECIAL PROVISIONS The designer should refer to Chapter 'E' of this manual to review the applicable special provisions.

942.6 STANDARD DRAWINGS There are no standard drawings associated with these tender items.

942.7 DESIGN

942.7.1 General The ground anchor system must resist imposed tensile loads and limit displacements of the structure to within Service Limit States (SLS) during the service life of the installation and to prevent failure at Ultimate Limit State (ULS). Guidelines for design, installation, stressing, inspection and testing of ground anchors are available in a number of publications including the Post Tensioning Institute (PTI) – Recommendations for Prestressed Rock and Soil Anchors. Recommendations for ground anchors shall be included in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report. This is administered by the Pavements and Foundations Section, Materials Engineering and Research Office.

942.7.2 Geotechnical Resistance (pull-out Capacity) Both immediate and time-dependent failure mechanisms for ground anchor components shall be considered. Provided that the strength and durability of ground anchor components is adequate, design can be based on the bond stress at the interface between the anchor grout and the soil or rock. Recommendations for the bond stress shall be provided in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report.

942.7.3 Spacing, Bond Length and Free-Stressing Length Spacing requirements prevent interference between bond zones that could reduce the pullout resistance of the ground anchor. Bond length requirements should be sufficient for the ground anchor to provide acceptable stress-strain performance over its service life. A minimum length of 3 m is typically required to account for installation uncertainties.

Page 797: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS

November 2013 Page 3 of 5 B942

Free stressing length should be sufficient to transfer load resistance beyond the assumed failure wedge of the foundation material. The approximate angle of the failure wedge can be calculated by well-established methods considering the geometry of the anchored structure and the internal strength of the foundation material.

942.7.4 Post Grouting To increase the capacity of the anchor, post-grouting can be used. Post-grouting includes the regrouting of the anchor after the primary grout has set to enlarge the bond stress area under grouting pressure. Post-grouting can either be specified or can be used in response to not achieving design capacities during construction. The Contract Administrator shall be notified prior to the commencement of post-grouting of both permanent and temporary anchors.

942.7.5 Anchor Tests Pre-Production Test Anchors are installed and tested prior to production tests. For test anchors, the anchors are subjected to rigorous test procedures characterized by a number of cyclic loadings and also maintaining the maximum test load up to 24 hours. Proof tests on production anchors are for anchor performance verification. Proof tests shall be carried out on all ground anchors. Proof tests are of relatively short duration (10 to 30 minutes for temporary and permanent anchors respectively).

942.8 COMPUTATION

942.8.1 Sources of Information The main sources of information for anchors are: a) Foundation Investigation and Design Reports, administered by the Pavements and

Foundations Section, Materials Engineering and Research Office. b) Bridge Office/Structural Sections c) Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code d) Post Tensioning Institute (PTI)

942.8.2 Method of Calculation

942.8.2.1 Pre-Production Test Anchors The unit of measurement for pre-production test anchors is the actual length in metres (m) of the anchor from anchor plate to tip.

Page 798: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS

November 2013 Page 4 of 5 B942

942.8.2.2 Production Anchors

The unit of measurement for test anchors is the actual length, in metres (m), of the anchor from anchor plate to tip.

942.8.2.3 Post Grouting of Bond Length The unit measurement for post grouting is kilograms of grout used. Tender quantity may be established in consultation with the Pavements and Foundations Section, MERO.

942.9 DOCUMENTATION

942.9.1 Drawings For all designs, a plan illustrating the anchor layout, spacing, inclination and orientation shall be provided in a foundation layout drawing in the contract drawings. Chainage and offset shall be indicated on the drawing as required. The foundation layout drawing shall also include sections, components and details that depict the anchor type, minimum total anchor lengths, design loads, diameters, and materials. The dimensions of anchor holes shall be indicated, including length, diameter and tolerances. A unique identification number shall be provided to describe each anchor. Some of the above information may be provided in an adjacent table on the contract drawings, if practical. Any requirements for waterproofing of anchor holes shall be detailed on the foundation layout drawing, when required according to the Foundation Investigation and Design report. The maximum factored loads at Serviceability Limit State (SLS) and Ultimate Limit State (ULS) shall be provided on the drawing.

942.9.2 Quantity Sheets For each of the Pre-Production Test Anchors, Production Anchor and Post-Grouting of Bond Length tender items, enter the tender item name in the heading of one column of the Quantity Sheet – Quantities – Structure. In one line, enter the total quantity for the entire contract. For contracts with a large number of anchors or when anchors are located in various locations, each location may be identified by chainage and offset on one line and the applicable quantity (total length, m) entered in the applicable column.

Page 799: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

DETAIL ESTIMATING PRESTRESSED SOIL AND ROCK ANCHORS

November 2013 Page 5 of 5 B942

942.9.3 Non-standard Special Provisions If applicable, specify the number of pre-production test anchors in a special provision. List project-specific requirements for pre-production test anchors, as applicable. Requirements for placing grout, including strength, shall be included in a special provision. If applicable, requirements for post-grouting of the bond length shall be included. Include requirements for cement bentonite slurry in the free-stressing length, as applicable. Bond stress, bond lengths and free stressing lengths shall be included in a special provision, if applicable, according to the Foundation Investigation and Design Report. Requirements for testing of production anchors shall be indicated in a special provision. Special provisions may be recommended to address site specific concerns identified in the Foundation Investigation and Design Report. For example, alerting the Contractor of cobbles or boulders in the native soil or alerting the Contractor of susceptibility of soils to cave-in may be required. When appropriate, some of the information listed under Contract Drawings subsection may be provided in a special provision. Specify the name, location and contact information for a testing laboratory to perform testing on behalf of the owner, when required.

Page 800: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 801: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials

CHAPTER C

DESIGNATED SOURCES

FOR MATERIALS

August 2017 CDED C-050

Page 802: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 803: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials (DSM)

DESIGNATED SOURCES FOR MATERIALS (DSM) 1.0 Introduction

The Designated Sources for Materials (DSM) Manual contains the Ministry’s official list of pre-qualified products and vendors for use on MTO highway construction and maintenance contracts. The DSM is the MTOs official list of pre-qualified products and vendors for use on MTO highway construction and maintenance contracts. TRA hosts and publishes the MTO DSM. The Ministry’s DSM is found on The Road Authority (TRA) website.

2.0 The Road Authority (TRA) The Road Authority (TRA) is a web portal and database exhibiting products and services available for use in public works infrastructure. The portal brings together companies offering these products and services with the municipal and provincial governments who procure them, as well as engineering consultants providing services to them. In addition to having a directory to find products, infrastructure owners benefit by sharing information. TRA was developed as a public-private partnership by the Ontario Good Roads Association (OGRA), a not-for-profit organization supporting Ontario’s municipalities. The web site is used as an information resource tool by the Ministry and by local municipalities across the Province. TRA is delivered by ASI Technologies Inc.

3.0 Prequalification Through its partnerships, TRA plays a key role in product prequalification across Ontario, both at the provincial and municipal level. Many Ontario municipalities require products to obtain the Products Management Committee "A" as a prerequisite to prequalification. TRA Membership is a prerequisite of being on the DSM.

3.1 Product Classification Classification is a process whereby products and related technologies are evaluated against relevant standards and specifications. TRA Products Management Committee (PMC) is responsible for the process of Classification. TRA publishes online, the decisions taken by the PMC.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 5 CDED C-100

Page 804: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials (DSM)

To support procurement activities of governments in the province, PMC was created to review products, comparing them to recognized standards and evaluating their applicability for Ontario jurisdictions. The "Accepted for Use" designation indicates that a product has been reviewed by the PMC and meets established criteria to be recommended as acceptable for use in Ontario. It is a qualifier to doing business with the Province of Ontario and for placement on the DSM. It does not guarantee that a product will be specified by MTO. Other municipalities, especially smaller ones that do not have the resources to manage their own pre-qualified products lists and to review products, rely purely on the lists published by the MTO, other municipalities and The Road Authority.

3.2 The Classification Process The first step towards Classification of a product is for a company to become a member of TRA. Once they have subscribed, a “product profile” can be added which includes identifying any applicable product categories, and recognized standards that the product meets. Once the product’s details are complete, the Pre-Qualification Application is completed and submitted to the PMC. Documents certifying the standards that the product meets and any testing or evaluations conducted on the product are submitted along with supporting documentation for the standards, such as verification from a third-party agency or lab noting that a standard has been met. Supporting documentation from other public owners or road authorities, expressing approval or acceptability of the product, can also be submitted. Once completed, the application is sent to the PMC committee co-ordinator to be placed on the agenda for the next meeting. Meetings are usually held monthly. If everything is in order, they may make a decision at that meeting. If they need more information, they will re-consider the product at a subsequent meeting, once the information is received.

3.3 Classification Matrix PMC employs a classification matrix in their product evaluations. Whatever classification they assign to the product is reflected in the TRA database. The classification system is based on a progressive matrix; at the lowest level, manufacturers can post a product without verified qualification; and at the highest level, posted products are tested by an accredited laboratory, and then successfully applied by a reputable organization. Some products, however, may not require

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 5 CDED C-100

Page 805: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials (DSM)

verification. The Committee also considers "grandfathering" of proven or existing products for inclusion in the matrix. Technical support documentation is maintained on file with TRA providing a reference for review. A copy of the Product Classification Matrix can be obtained from the TRA website.

4.0 MTO's DSM Requirements for Listing of Vendors and Products MTO requirements for listing of vendors and products is outlined in DSM 100 - General Requirements for Listing of Vendors and Products, available from the TRA website or the DSM folder within CPS. This document outlines the criteria for: development of a product listing, product acceptance, continued acceptance, removal from the DSM, and reinstatement to the DSM. In addition to the general criteria for product acceptance outlined in DSM 100, each MTO custodial office has their own specific criteria for product acceptance. Products accepted for use on the DSM must meet both the criteria. An MTO custodial office with listing(s) on the DSM must review them on a regular basis to ensure that the products and vendors continue to meet Ministry standards and/or specifications. When standards and/or specifications are updated, MTO custodial offices must ensure that associated product listings are updated accordingly. When an OPS or MTO standard is created or cancelled, the MTO custodial office may need to create or cancel associated DSM listings accordingly.

4.1 Custodial Office Criteria for Creation of a New DSM Listing A DSM listing is created by an MTO custodial office based on the following criteria:

a) No OPS/MTO standards exist. b) Special applications are not adequately covered by internal or external

standards. c) Consequences of product failure are extremely costly. d) Items are large and expensive. e) Public safety concern with the use of the product are significant. f) Compliance with standards cannot be readily verified because testing cannot

be completed within a reasonable period of time or within the duration on a typical highway contract.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 5 CDED C-100

Page 806: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials (DSM)

g) Testing for compliance with existing standards does not guarantee quality where it is impossible to determine “after the fact” whether the problem was “manufacturing” or “placement method” related.

h) Quality with products persist.

5.0 DSM Online Interface DSM product listings are managed by DSM Custodians from the associated custodial offices, via the online system at MTO.roadauthority.com. A copy of the MTO DSM Interface User Guide is available in the DSM folder in CPS. The user manual provides detailed information about editing lists and accessing the online system.

5.1 System Access for DSM Custodians A list of DSM Custodians with system access, responsible for each listing, is provided in Section C-130 of this chapter. New custodians must contact the DSM Coordinator to gain appropriate access. The Engineering Standards Analyst within ESSMS fulfills this role. The contact information is provided in Section C-110 of this chapter. The DSM Coordinator will contact ASI to arrange for appropriate access. New DSM Custodians will subsequently receive an email from ASI with a Log In ID and Password.

5.2 Deadline for Submission of Listings The deadline for the submission of changes is one week prior to publishing which takes place bi-monthly on the first business day of February, April, June, August, October, and December. Prior to the deadline all lists are left open for editing and can be revised and re-submitted numerous times if necessary; after the deadline all lists are locked and no further edits can be made.

6.0 Delisting of Vendors As per DSM 100.06 companies are required to maintain their registration with TRA in good standing in order to remain on the DSM. Upon failure of a company to renew their yearly registration, TRA will notify the vendor. If payment is not subsequently received by the due date then TRA will initiate the process for removal of the company’s information and will notify the DSM Custodian accordingly. Upon receiving a request from TRA for delisting of a company DSM Custodians must follow the procedures outlined in Table A below.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 4 of 5 CDED C-100

Page 807: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C Designated Sources for Materials (DSM)

Table A DSM Delisting Procedures for Non-Payment of Fees

Step 1

Notify Vendor of Outstanding Fees

TRA/ASI to notify vendor (1) of outstanding fees, and (2) the actions to be taken if payment is not received within 4 weeks of the date of the notice. If payment is not received by due date TRA/ASI to proceed to Step 2.

Step 2

Remove Vendor Information from TRA Website

TRA/ASI will proceed with deactivation of the vendor’s profile from the TRA website for all applicable product listings. TRA to notify the vendor (1) of the action taken and (2) that MTO will proceed with delisting of products if payment is not received within 4 weeks of the date of the notice. TRA will send copy of the notice and a request to delist the products to the applicable MTO DSM custodian(s), if payment is not received.

Step 3

Issue Delisting Notice

When the request and a copy of Step 2 notice is received, DSM custodian(s) to issue delisting notice to vendor (see below for standard wording). A copy of the notice is to be provided to TRA/ASI (Anita Downie).

Step 4

Delist Vendor’s Products

MTO will delist the vendor’s products on the next available DSM publishing date.

Notes: 1) If payment is received at any time prior to the delisting of the vendor’s products, TRA/ASI shall

immediately inform the DSM custodian and TRA/ASI shall reactivate the vendor’s profile removed in Step 2.

2) Steps 1 and 2 are necessary to avoid situation of vendor receiving a delisting notice without prior warning or action. These steps are normally sufficient to prompt fee payment.

3) A vendor may receive more than one notice, from different DSM custodians.

6.1 Standard Wording for Delisting Notice The following standard wording is to be used for issuing of Delisting Notices: The Ministry has partnered with the Ontario Good Roads Association to support The Road Authority (TRA) as a one-window information resource. This partnership requires maintenance of product registration with TRA for the continued listing of products on the Ministry of Transportation’s Designated Sources for Materials (DSM). According to TRA records, the membership fees required for registration of the following products have not been paid:

1. [Insert DSM #.##.##, Product Name] Be advised that if the membership fees are not paid, the Ministry will remove the products listed above from the DSM as part of the [insert relevant DSM publishing date] DSM update. To arrange for payment of TRA membership fees please contact:

Anita Downie ASI Technologies Inc., 321 Parkhurst Square, Unit B Brampton, ON, L6T 5H5 Phone: 905-459-9200 E-mail: [email protected]

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 5 of 5 CDED C-100

Page 808: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 809: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C MTO and TRA Contact Information

MTO AND TRA CONTACT INFORMATION General Information

• Log-in site for DSM Custodians is http://mto.roadauthority.com • Enquiries related to the submission and publishing of lists should be directed to [email protected] • A copy of MTO DSM User Guide can be obtained from Contract Preparation System (CPS) under DSM

List # 00.00.00 or by contacting [email protected] • A copy of DSM 100 General Requirements for Listing of Vendors and Products, and Notification to

Companies with Products Listed in the MTO DSM can be obtained from www.roadauthority.com

The Road Authority (TRA)

Correspondence - 2130 Williams Pkwy, Brampton, ON, L6S 5X7

TRA Enquiries - [email protected]

[email protected] - PMC Product Coordinator, engineering technical issues with TRA products, and escalated data issues.

ASI Technologies Inc.

Correspondence - 321 Parkhurst Square, Unit B, Brampton, ON, L6T 5H5

Technical Enquiries - [email protected] or 905-459-9200

Anita Downie [email protected]

- Day-to-day operation of TRA, invoicing, and main contact for data.

Peter Henderson [email protected]

- TRA/DSM system support, maintenance, and data, IT technical issues, liaison with DSM custodians and administrator on operational issues, and escalated client-facing issues.

Steve Desrocher [email protected]

- Policy issues and liaison with MTO and OGRA regarding service agreement matters.

MTO

Rachel Kyte [email protected]

- Distribution of DSM information, coordination of submissions, publishing of listings, posting of DSM documents in CPS, and publishing of hardcopy DSM manual.

Mark Rankie [email protected]

- Planning, coordination and implementation of responsibilities under the service agreement, recommendation of improvements, and identification of non-compliance issues.

Aimee Tupaz [email protected]

- Development of policies and procedures for product management, and management of the service agreement.

August 2017 Page 1 of 1 CDED C-110

Page 810: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 811: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodial Offices Contact List

DSM CUSTODIAL OFFICES CONTACT LIST

Office Section Role Name Position

Contract Management

Office

Maintenance Performance Section

Contact Alain Beaulieu Manager, Maint. Office

Contact Chris Raymond Head, Maint. Performance

Custodian Gabriella Gevaert Transportation Technician

Traffic Office (Central Region)

Electrical Engineering Section Contact Eric Yao Head

ITS Program Contact Robert Chan Supervising Eng.

Custodian Ying Hu Project Eng.

Design and Contract

Standards Office

Bridge Office

Contact Magdy Meleka Head Bridge Standards

Contact Kwong-Yiu Chu Sr. Bridge Engineer

Custodian Chris Parsons Lead Bridge Eng.

Design Standards Section Custodian Mark Ayton Sr. Eng., Hwy Design

Materials Engineering &

Research Office

Bituminous Section Contact Pamela Marks Head

Custodian Masud Ahmed Sr. Bitum. Mat’ls Eng. Officer

Concrete Section

Contact Hannah Schell Head

Custodian Jennifer Astle-Tranmer

Sr. Conc. & Mat’ls Eng. Officer

Custodian Steve Paiva Sr. Conc. & Mat’ls Eng. Officer

Custodian Mohammad Aqel Concrete Eng.

Custodian Grant Ridley Chemical Eng.

Pavement & Foundation Section

Contact Betty Bennett Sr. Pavement Design Eng.

Contact Ken Ahmad Sr. Foundations Eng.

Contact Tony Sangiuliano Sr. Foundations Eng.

Custodian David Staseff Sr. Foundations Eng.

Soils & Aggregates Section

Contact John Blair Sr. Soils & Agg. Eng.

Custodian Henry Bykerk Sr. Agg. Eng. Officer

Traffic Office

Electrical Engineering Section

Contact Arun Kapur Sr. Electrical Eng.

Custodian Martin Aitkenhead Head

Traffic Operations Section

Contact Ousama Shebeeb Traffic Signals Eng.

Custodian Martin Sedkowski Specialist Operations

Custodian Tracey Difede Sr., Project Mgr.

August 2017 Page 1 of 1 CDED C-120

Page 812: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 813: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

DSM CUSTODIAN LIST # Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.30 Emulsified BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.40 Crack Sealant, Rubberized Asphalt, Hot Poured

BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.20 Concrete 03.20.45 Joint Sealant, Rubberized Asphalt, Hot Poured

CONC 416-235-3705 Jennifer Astle-Tranmer

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.45 Liquid BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.70 Patching, Proprietary Products BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.10 Antistripping Additives BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.22 Asphalt Cement, Performance Graded (PGAC)

BITU 416-235-3715 Masud Ahmed

3 Pavement 3.05 Asphalt 03.05.25 Aggregates: Surface Friction Courses

SOAG 416-235-3705 Henry Bykerk

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.35 Inks, Transparent TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.64 Sheeting, Type I (Engineering Grade)

TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.68 Sheeting, Type III and Type IV (High-Intensity)

TRAF 905-704-2200 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.69 Sheeting, Type V (Super-High-Intensity)

TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.70 Sheeting, Type VI, Roll Up (High Reflectivity, Micro-Prismatic, Fluorescent)

TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.71 Sheeting, Type VII, Type VIII and Type IX (High Reflectivity, Micro-Prismatic, Fluorescent)

TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.73 Sheeting, Type XI (Proposed) - Diamond Grade DG3 Series 4000

TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.75 Sheeting, Vinyl TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.70 Signing 05.70.76 Sheeting, Vinyl, Fluorescent TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin Sedkowski

5 General 5.80 Traffic Barriers 05.80.25 Temporary Concrete Barrier SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.33 Line Obliterating Paint,

Pavement Markings, Temporary CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.38 Lines, Permanent, Glass Beads, Reflective

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.40 Lines, Permanent, Paint, Pavement Markings

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.43 Lines, Permanent, Polymeric Spray, Pavement Markings

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

August 2017 Page 1 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 814: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.44 Lines, Permanent, Two Year Pavement Markings

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.45 Lines, Permanent, Durable, Pavement Markings

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.50 Lines, Temporary, Tape, Pavement Markings

CONC 416-235-3705 Grant Ridley

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.25 Guide Rail Reflectors SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.18 Delineator Posts, Flexible TRAF 905-704-2649 Martin

Sedkowski 5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.35 Line Removal Systems,

Pavement Markings TRAF 905-704-2200 Martin

Sedkowski 5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.55 Markers, Pavement, Raised,

Permanent TRAF 905-704-2960 Tracey

Difede

5 General 5.85 Traffic Guidance 05.85.56 Markers, Pavement, Recessed, Permanent

TRAF 905-704-2960 Tracey Difede

5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.60 Plastic, Fibre Reinforced SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.85 Steel SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.90 Wood SAFE 905-704-2295 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.20 Concrete SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.40 Noise Barrier On Structures SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 5 General 5.50 Noise Barriers 05.50.50 Noise/Traffic Barriers SAFE 905-704-2293 Mark Ayton 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.10 Aluminum ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.11 Anchor, Rock Installation ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.12 Anchorage Assembly in

Concrete ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.15 Base, Grooved-Coupler ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.20 Concrete, Spun ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.35 High Mast, Device for Raising

and Lowering ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.40 High Mast, Sectional Steel ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.75 Sectional Steel ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.80 Steel, Base Mounted ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.85 Heavy Class - Base Mounted -

Steel, Sectional Steel ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.60 Poles 06.60.90 Wood ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.20 Assemblers of Control Cabinet

Assemblies ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.22 Enclosure for Control Cabinet ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead 6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.25 Surge Arrestor ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin

Aitkenhead

August 2017 Page 2 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 815: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.40 Distribution Assembly ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.45 L-Handles, Surface Mounted, Padlockable

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.65 Power Supply 06.65.75 Substation Distribution Assembly ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.25 Flasher Beacon and Pedestrian Signal Heads

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.27 Flasher Beacon, Solar Powered ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.35 Hanger Assembly ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.45 Lamps ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.47 LED Lamps (Signal Modules) ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.70 Signal Arm, Overbrace ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.75 Signal Arm, Single Member ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.80 Signal Control, Flasher Complete Mechanism Assembly

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.81 Signal Control, Flasher Mechanism Components

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.83 Signal Control, Specialty Flasher ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.90 Signal Head, Fibreoptic, Turn Arrow

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.92 Traffic Signal Head ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.94 Traffic Signal Head, Snow Shields

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.85 Signal / Flasher Equip.

06.85.95 Uninterruptible Power Supplies (UPS)

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.80 Signal Actuation Equip. / Mat'ls

06.80.15 Detector, Emergency Vehicle Pre-Emption **

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.80 Signal Actuation Equip. / Mat'ls

06.80.20 Detector, Loop, Sealant ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.80 Signal Actuation Equip. / Mat'ls

06.80.31 Detector, Probe ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.80 Signal Actuation Equip. / Mat'ls

06.80.40 Detector, Vehicle ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.80 Signal Actuation Equip. / Mat'ls

06.80.60 Pushbuttons, Pedestrian ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.68 Subsurface Traffic Sensing System

06.68.50 Magnetic Detectors - Suspended ATMS 416-235-4501 Ying Hu

6 Electrical 6.68 Subsurface Traffic Sensing System

06.68.60 Magnetic Detector Cards - Suspended

ATMS 416-235-4501 Ying Hu

6 Electrical 6.70 Traffic Electronic Control Equip.

06.70.60 Traffic Signals, Portable, Temporary

TRAF 905-704-2960 Tracey Difede

August 2017 Page 3 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 816: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.30 Duct Fittings, Expansion and Deflection

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.30 Emergency Vehicle Pre-emption Board

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.35 In-Line Fuse Holder, Breakaway ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.35 Flasher 204 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.40 Isolator, A.C. 252 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.45 Grounding Rods ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.45 Isolator, D.C. 242 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.50 Loop Detector 222 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.60 Photoelectric Controller ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.62 Photoelectric Controller Mounting Adapter

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.70 Relay 430 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.75 Steel Footing ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.78 Steel Footing, Base Plate ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.80 Steel Footing, Mounting Hardware Kit

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.80 Switch Pack 200 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.25 Elec. Accessories 06.25.85 Thread Locking Compound ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.06 Cable, Extra Low Voltage, Loop Detector Lead-in Type

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.12 Cable, Interconnection ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.12 Cabinet 332 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.13 Cabinet 332, MTO ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.14 Cabinet 336 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.15 Cabinet 401, C,D,S, R ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.16 Digital Thermostat ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.17 Cable, Low Voltage, Pre-Emption **

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.17 Cabinet Heater ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

August 2017 Page 4 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 817: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.75 Sign Lighting ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.80 Sign Truss Fittings ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.85 Underpass Luminaire ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.15 Brackets, Aluminum ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.20 Brackets, Steel Truss ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.40 High Mast, High Pressure Sodium, Luminaire

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.48 High Pressure Sodium, Lamps ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.49 High Pressure Sodium, Lamps, with Igniter

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.50 Roadway Lighting, High Pressure Sodium, Luminaire

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.52 Roadway Lighting, Light Emitting Diode (Led), Luminaire

ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.40 Luminaires & Hardware

06.40.55 Obstruction Luminaire ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.19 Cable, Traffic Signals, Riser ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.19 Conflict Monitor ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.05 Cable & Assoc. Hardware

06.05.20 Cable, Traffic Signals ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.20 Conflict Monitor 212 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.30 Electronic Hwy Information

06.30.21 Portable Variable Message Signs (PVMS)

ATMS 416-235-4501 Ying Hu

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.25 Controller 170 ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

6 Electrical 6.28 Elec. Controlling Equip., Signals

06.28.26 Controller 170E ELEC 905-704-2254 Martin Aitkenhead

8 Buildings 8.25 Doors 08.25.40 Overhead, Insulated MAIN 905-704-2203 Gabriella Gevaert

8 Buildings 8.25 Doors 08.25.50 Overhead, Non-insulated MAIN 905-704-2203 Gabriella Gevaert

8 Buildings 8.35 Heating Systems 08.35.35 Infra-red Single Tube System MAIN 905-704-2203 Gabriella Gevaert

8 Buildings 8.35 Heating Systems 08.35.40 Infra-red Vacuum Tube MAIN 905-704-2203 Gabriella Gevaert

9 Structural 9.60 Railing 09.60.30 Bridge Guide Rail BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.65 Reinforcement 09.65.58 Reinforcing Steel Bars, Mechanical Connectors

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.65 Reinforcement 09.65.70 Reinforcing Steel, Epoxy Coated, Coaters and Fabricators

CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

August 2017 Page 5 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 818: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

9 Structural 9.65 Reinforcement 09.65.73 Reinforcing Steel, Organic Coating System, and Patching Compounds

CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

9 Structural 9.65 Reinforcement 09.65.76 Reinforcing Steel, Stainless, Mills and Fabricators

CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

9 Structural 9.65 Reinforcement 09.65.80 Reinforcing Steel, Uncoated, Fabricators and Mills

CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

9 Structural 9.70 Retainment of Soil 09.70.52 Retained Soil Systems (RSS), False Abutment, High Performance Level

FOUN 416-235-3715 David Staseff

9 Structural 9.70 Retainment of Soil 09.70.53 Retained Soil Systems (RSS), True Abutment

FOUN 416-235-3715 David Staseff

9 Structural 9.70 Retainment of Soil 09.70.56 Retained Soil Systems (RSS), Wall / Slope

FOUN 416-235-3715 David Staseff

9 Structural 9.70 Retainment of Soil 09.70.59 Retained Soil Systems (RSS), Roadbase Embankment

FOUN 416-235-3715 David Staseff

9 Structural 9.75 Sign Supports 09.75.15 Bridge Mounted, Aluminum BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.75 Sign Supports 09.75.20 Column, Breakaway, Steel BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.75 Sign Supports 09.75.55 Overhead, Monotube, Steel BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.90 Waterproofing for Bridge Deck

09.90.15 Asphalt, Rubberized, Hot Applied (Poured)

CONC 416-235-3705 Jennifer Astle-Tranmer

9 Structural 9.90 Waterproofing for Bridge Deck

09.90.60 Protection Board CONC 416-235-3705 Jennifer Astle-Tranmer

9 Structural 9.15 Bearings, Bridge 09.15.35 Grout, Cement Based Non-Shrink

CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.39 Low VOC BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.25 Concrete 09.25.40 Hydraulic Cements and Supplementary Cementing Materials

CONC 416-235-3705 Mohammad Aqel

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.60 Paint Coating Systems for Galvanized Surfaces

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.65 Seal Coatings for Metallized Surfaces

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.70 Two (2)-Coat Zinc-Rich Rapid Deployment Coating Systems for Structural Steel

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.15 Bearings, Bridge 09.15.71 Rotational, Pot, Class 1A BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.15 Bearings, Bridge 09.15.75 Rotational, Disc, Class 2A BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.15 Bearings, Bridge 09.15.80 Rotational, Spherical, Class 3A BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.90 Zinc-Rich Touch-up BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

August 2017 Page 6 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 819: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER C DSM Custodian List

# Category # Section DSM # Title Office Office # Custodian

9 Structural 9.25 Concrete 09.25.05 Admixtures, Air Entraining CONC 416-235-3705 Mohammad Aqel

9 Structural 9.20 Coatings 09.20.10 Coal Tar Epoxy for Structural Steel Piles

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.25 Concrete 09.25.10 Admixtures, Chemical and Superplasticizing

CONC 416-235-3705 Mohammad Aqel

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.18 Expansion, Injection Systems for Armouring

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.20 Expansion, Modular BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.24 Expansion, Strip Seals Anchored in Concrete, Type A, Steel Plate Clamping Device

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.27 Expansion, Strip Seals Anchored in Concrete, Type C, Retainers and Stop Bars

BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.30 Expansion, Strip Seals in Elastomeric Concrete, Type A, Steel Plate Clamping Device

BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.32 Expansion, Strip Seals in Elastomeric Concrete, Type C, Retainers

BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.40 Joints 09.40.33 Expansion, Strip Seals in Preformed Retainer, Anchored on Existing Armouring

BRDG 905-704-2405 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.15 Bearings, Bridge 09.15.25 Elastomeric, Laminated BRDG 905-704-2351 Chris Parsons

9 Structural 9.25 Concrete 09.25.25 Curing Membrane Compounds, Type 2, White Pigmented

CONC 416-235-3705 Mohammad Aqel

9 Structural 9.30 Dowel Adhesives 09.30.25 Acrylic and Epoxy Resins CONC 416-235-3705 Steve Paiva

August 2017 Page 7 of 7 CDED C-130

Page 820: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 821: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CDED CHAPTER D Specifications

CHAPTER D

SPECIFICATIONS

August 2017 CDED D-050

Page 822: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 823: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs)

ONTARIO PROVINCIAL STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS (OPSSs) 1.0 Introduction

This section of the CDED covers the implementation and use of Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs) in MTO Contracts. The Ontario Provincial Standards for Roads and Public Works (OPS) consists of an eight-volume set of standards. There are three types of Ontario Provincial Standards: • Municipal and Provincial Common OPSSs and OPSDs - Volumes 1 to 4 • Provincial-Oriented OPSSs - Volumes 5 and 6 • Municipal-Oriented OPSSs - Volumes 7 and 8 Municipal-Oriented Specifications are not used by MTO therefore this section considers only the OPSSs published by the OPS Organization that are contained in the following volumes: • Volume 1 - General and Construction Specifications • Volume 2 - Material Specifications • Volume 5 - MTO General Conditions of Contract and General & Construction

Specifications • Volume 6 - Material Specifications

Upon publishing copies in PDF format can be obtained from the MTO Library website at: https://www.raqs.mto.gov.on.ca/techpubs/ops.nsf/OPSHomepage

2.0 Implementation of OPSSs in CPS

Standard specifications published by OPS are not immediately implemented for use by MTO therefore a "List of Active OPSSs" is published in this chapter of the CDED in order to provide information regarding the OPSSs that have been implemented for use in MTO contracts. The list is updated concurrently with Contract Preparation System (CPS) updates when necessary. Designers can also refer directly to CPS to determine which OPSSs are active.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 1 of 3 CDED D-200

Page 824: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs)

3.0 List of Active OPSSs The following sections discuss the information shown under the headings on the "List of Active OPSSs".

4.0 OPSS Number Every OPSS is given a unique number which has been allocated to allow for additions to the system.

5.0 Type Every OPSS is categorized as municipal-provincial common (COMM), provincial- oriented (PROV), or municipal-oriented (MUNI). Ministry contracts will contain primarily COMM and/or PROV specifications. When a municipal-oriented (MUNI) specification is needed in an MTO contract, it is added via the use of a special provision.

6.0 Title As shown on each OPSS.

7.0 Issue Date Every specification is provided with an issue date (also known as the version date) which represents the month and year in which the specification was published by OPS. Please note that the issue date, appears with the OPSS number in sections F and G of the Schedule of Provisions, Contract Plans, Standard Drawing, Specifications and General Conditions found in the Contract Tender document.

8.0 Implementation Date OPSSs are not automatically implemented for use in MTO contracts upon publication. The implementation date of an OPSS is typically established after publication in order to allow sufficient notice for tender package preparation and changes to the contract documents. The implementation date chosen will depend on the extent of changes required and is subject to the policy contained in Quality and Standards Directive QST-C-13. The implementation date shown corresponds to the earliest tender advertising date of the contracts which must contain the new or revised standard specification. It is

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 2 of 3 CDED D-200

Page 825: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D Ontario Provincial Standard Specifications (OPSSs)

advisable to retain a copy of superseded standard specifications in the Standard Specifications Manuals until the revised standard specification is implemented.

August 2017 (UNDER REVIEW) Page 3 of 3 CDED D-200

Page 826: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should
Page 827: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

LIST OF ACTIVE OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

DIVISION 1 – GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS

100 PROV MTO General Conditions of Contract Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

102 COMM Weighing of Materials Oct 1992 Mar 17, 1994

106 PROV Electrical Work Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

120 PROV The Use of Explosives Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

127 PROV Schedule of Rental Rates for Construction Equipment Including Model and Specification Reference

Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

180 PROV Management of Excess Materials Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

182 PROV Environmental Protection for Construction In and Around Waterbodies and On Waterbody Banks

Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

DIVISION 2 – GENERAL GRADING

201 COMM Clearing, Close Cut Clearing, Grubbing and Removal of Surface Boulders Nov 2011 Jun 20, 2013

202 PROV Rock Removal by Manual Scaling, Machine Scaling, Trim Blasting, or Controlled Blasting

Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

203 PROV Rock Stabilization Nov 2014 Aug 27, 2015

206 PROV Grading Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

209 PROV Embankments over Swamps and Compressible Soils Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

212 PROV Borrow Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

220 PROV Wick Drain Installation Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

DIVISION 3 – PAVEMENT (FLEXIBLE AND RIGID)

301 COMM Restoring Unpaved Roadway Surfaces Sep 1988 Nov 1, 2003

304 COMM Single and Double Surface Treatment Nov 2006 Feb 14, 2008

305 PROV Granular Sealing Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

307 COMM Stockpiling of Patching Materials Apr 2012 Jul 5, 2012

308 PROV Tack Coating and Joint Painting Apr 2012 Jul 5, 2012

311 COMM Asphalt Sidewalk and Sidewalk Resurfacing Asphalt Sidewalk, Driveway, Boulevard and Sidewalk Resurfacing

Sep 1988 Nov 1, 2003

312 COMM Asphalt Curb and Gutter Systems and Asphalt Surfacing of Gutters Sep 1988 Nov 1, 2003

313 PROV Hot Mix Asphalt – End Result Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

314 PROV Untreated Subbase, Base, Surface, Shoulder, Selected Subgrade and Stockpiling Nov 2015 Apr 28, 2016

316 COMM Extruded Expanded Polystyrene Frost Heave Treatment Apr 2008 Jun 5, 2008

320 PROV Open Graded Drainage Layer Apr 2016 Jun 9, 2016

330 PROV In-Place Full Depth Reclamation of Bituminous Pavement and Underlying Granular Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

331 PROV Full Depth Reclamation With Expanded Asphalt Stabilization Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

332 PROV Hot In-Place Recycling and Hot In-Place Recycling With Integral Overlay Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

333 PROV Cold In-Place Recycling Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

August 2017 Page 1 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 828: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

335 PROV Cold In-Place Recycling with Expanded Asphalt Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

336 COMM Micro-Surfacing (Reissued November 2010) Nov 2009 Sep 29, 2011

337 COMM Slurry Seal Nov 2008 Jun 20, 2013

341 COMM Routing and Sealing Cracks in Hot Mix Asphalt Pavement May 1994 Aug 1, 1996

342 PROV Grinding of Centreline and Shoulder Rumble Strips Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

350 COMM Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base Mar 1998 Jan 27, 1999

351 COMM Concrete Sidewalk Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

353 COMM Concrete Curb and Gutter Systems Sep 1996 Nov 11, 1998

355 PROV Installation of Interlocking Concrete Pavers Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

360 COMM Full Depth Repair of Concrete Pavement or Concrete Base Mar 1995 Feb 24, 1999

362 COMM Fast Track Full Depth Repairs To Concrete Pavement Mar 1998 Feb 24, 1999

363 PROV Repairing Rigid Pavement with Precast Concrete Slabs Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

364 COMM Partial Depth Repairs in Concrete Pavement Sep 1996 Feb 24, 1999

365 PROV Cross-Stitching Longitudinal Cracks in Concrete Pavement and Concrete Base Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

369 COMM Sealing or Resealing of Joints and Cracks In Concrete Pavement Nov 2008 Mar 12, 2009

DIVISION 4 – DRAINAGE, WATERMAINS, AND UTILITY

401 PROV Trenching, Backfilling, and Compacting Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

402 PROV Excavating, Backfilling, and Compacting for Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets, and Valve Chambers

Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

403 PROV Rock Excavation for Pipelines, Utilities, and Associated Structures In Open Cut (Formerly OPSS 515)

Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

404 COMM Support Systems (Formerly OPSS 538) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

405 COMM Pipe Subdrains Nov 2008 Aug 27, 2009

407 MTC Manholes, Catch Basins and Ditch Inlets (MTC) Mar 1984 Nov 1, 2001

409 COMM Closed Circuit Television Inspection of Pipelines Nov 2013 Jun 12, 2014

410 PROV Pipe Sewer Installation in Open Cut Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

415 COMM Tunnelling Feb 1990 Aug 1, 1992

416 COMM Jacking & Boring Feb 1990 Aug 1, 1992

421 PROV Pipe Culvert Installation in Open Cut Nov 2015 Dec 17, 2015

422 COMM Precast Reinforced Concrete Box Culverts and Box Sewers In Open Cut (Reissued November 2010)

Apr 2004 Sep 29, 2011

441 PROV Watermain Installation In Open Cut Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

490 COMM Site Preparation For Pipelines, Utilities, and Associated Structures (Formerly OPSS 503)

Apr 2016 Jun 9, 2016

491 COMM Preservation, Protection, and Reconstruction of Existing Facilities (Formerly OPSS 504) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

492 COMM Site Restoration Following Installation of Pipelines, Utilities, and Associated Structures Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

493 COMM Temporary Potable Water Supply Services (Reissued November 2010) Nov 2009 Sep 29, 2011

August 2017 Page 2 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 829: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

DIVISION 5 – MISCELLANEOUS

501 PROV Compacting Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

510 PROV Removal Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

511 COMM Rip Rap, Rock Protection and Granular Sheeting Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

512 PROV Installation of Gabions Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

517 PROV Dewatering Nov 2016 Jun 8, 2017

539 PROV Temporary Protection Systems Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

DIVISION 6 – ELECTRICAL

602 COMM Installation of Electrical Chambers Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

603 COMM Installation of Ducts Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

604 COMM Installation of Cable Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

609 COMM Grounding Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

610 PROV Removal of Electrical Equipment and Materials Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

611 COMM Installation of Underpass Luminaires Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

614 COMM Installation of Power Supply Equipment Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

615 PROV Installation of Poles Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

616 COMM Footings and Pads for Electrical Equipment Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

617 COMM Installation of Roadway Luminaires Nov 2013 Mar 27, 2014

620 PROV Traffic Signal Equipment Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

621 PROV Electrical Traffic Control Devices Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

622 PROV Installation of Traffic Signal Controllers Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

623 PROV Traffic Actuation Equipment Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

630 PROV Installation of Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

631 COMM Concrete Footings and Maintenance Platforms for High Mast Lighting Poles Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

DIVISION 7 – TRAFFIC SAFETY

703 COMM Permanent Small Signs and Support Systems Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

704 COMM Post Mounted Delineators Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

705 COMM Flexible Delineators Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

706 PROV Traffic Control Signing (Formerly OPSS 543) Nov 2016 Mar 2, 2017

707 COMM Modified Overhead Signboards Nov 2015 Apr 28, 2016

708 PROV Portable Temporary Traffic Signals Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

710 COMM Pavement Marking (Formerly OPSS 532) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

721 PROV Steel Beam Guide Rail and Cable Guide Rail Nov 2015 Apr 28, 2016

723 PROV Energy Attenuators Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

732 PROV Guide Rail End Treatment - Steel Beam Energy Attenuating Terminal Systems Apr 2016 Jun 9, 2016

740 COMM Concrete Barriers (Formerly OPSS 553) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

741 COMM Temporary Concrete Barriers Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

August 2017 Page 3 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 830: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

753 COMM Connecticut Impact Attenuation System (CIAS) Nov 2013 Jul 10, 2014

760 COMM Noise Barrier Systems Nov 2014 Oct 22, 2015

771 PROV Standard Highway Fence Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

772 COMM Chain-Link Fence Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

791 COMM Expanded Metal Anti-Glare Screen Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

DIVISION 8 – ENVIRONMENTAL AND LANDSCAPE

801 COMM Protection of Trees (Formerly OPSS 565) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

802 COMM Topsoil (Formerly OPSS 570) Nov 2010 Sep 29, 2011

803 COMM Sodding Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

804 PROV Seed and Cover Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

805 COMM Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control Measures Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

810 PROV Rootwad Structures Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

811 PROV Large Woody Debris Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

812 PROV LUNKERS Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

820 PROV Riffles On Streambeds Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

821 PROV Pools In Streambeds Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

822 PROV Rocky Ramps On Streambeds Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

823 PROV Low Flow Channels Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

824 PROV Baffles In a Culvert Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

DIVISION 9 – STRUCTURAL

902 COMM Excavating and Backfilling – Structures Nov 2010 Jun 20, 2013

903 PROV Deep Foundations Apr 2016 Jun 9, 2016

904 PROV Concrete Structures Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

905 PROV Steel Reinforcement for Concrete Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

906 COMM Structural Steel for Bridges Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

907 COMM Structural Wood Systems Apr 2011 Jun 20, 2013

908 PROV Metal Traffic Barriers and Metal Railings For Structures Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

909 PROV Prestressed Concrete - Precast Girders Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

910 PROV Prestressed Concrete - Cast-in-place Apr 2008 Jun 11, 2009

911 PROV Coating Structural Steel Systems Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

913 COMM Embedded Work In Structures for Electrical Systems Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

914 PROV Waterproofing Bridge Decks With Hot Applied Asphalt Membrane Nov 2014 Dec 18, 2014

915 PROV Sign Support Structures Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

918 PROV Modular Bridge Structures for Temporary Installations Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

919 COMM Formwork and Falsework Nov 2011 Jul 5, 2012

920 PROV Deck Joint Assemblies, Preformed Seals, Joint Fillers, Joint Seals, Joint Sealing Compounds, and Waterstops - Structures

Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

August 2017 Page 4 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 831: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

922 PROV Installation of Bearings Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

928 COMM Structure Rehabilitation – Concrete Removal Apr 2012 Jul 5, 2012

929 COMM Abrasive Blast Cleaning – Concrete Construction Apr 2012 Jul 5, 2012

930 PROV Structure Rehabilitation – Concrete Patches, Refacing and Overlays Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

931 COMM Structure Rehabilitation – Shotcrete May 1994 Sep 1, 1995

932 COMM Crack Repair – Concrete Nov 2009 Jan 28, 2010

935 PROV Impressed Cathodic Protection System for Bridge Structures Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

942 COMM Prestressed Soil and Rock Anchors Nov 2009 Dec 5, 2013

DIVISION 10 - AGGREGATES

1001 COMM Aggregates - General Nov 2013 Jan 30, 2014

1002 PROV Aggregates - Concrete Apr 2013 Jun 20, 2013

1003 PROV Aggregates - Hot Mixed Asphalt Apr 2013 Jun 20, 2013

1004 PROV Aggregates - Miscellaneous Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

1005 PROV Aggregates - Streambed Material Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

1006 PROV Aggregates - Surface Treatment Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

1010 PROV Aggregates - Base, Subbase, Select Subgrade and Backfill Material Apr 2013 Jun 20, 2013

DIVISION 11 - BITUMENS

1101 PROV Performance Graded Asphalt Cement Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

1102 PROV Liquid Asphalt Used In Spraying, Sealing, and Priming Applications Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

1103 PROV Emulsified Asphalt Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1151 PROV Superpave and Stone Mastic Asphalt Mixtures Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1152 PROV SC-800 Patching Material Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1153 PROV Emulsified Asphalt Patching Material Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

DIVISION 12 – SEALS, BEARINGS, WATERSTOPS

1202 PROV Bearings – Elastomeric Plain and Steel Laminated Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1203 PROV Bearings – Rotational and Sliding Surface Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1204 COMM Polyvinyl Chloride Waterstops Nov 2003 Apr 21, 2004

1205 PROV Clay Seal Apr 2015 Jun 25, 2015

1210 PROV Deck Joint Assemblies Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1212 COMM Hot-Poured Rubberized Asphalt Joint Sealing Compound Nov 2003 Apr 21, 2004

1213 COMM Hot Applied Rubberized Asphalt Waterproofing Membrane Mar 1998 Mar 1, 1998

1215 COMM Protection Board Mar 1998 Mar 1, 1998

DIVISION 13 – CEMENT AND CONCRETE

1301 COMM Cementing Materials Sep 1996 Sep 1, 1996

1302 COMM Water Sep 1996 Sep 1, 1996

August 2017 Page 5 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 832: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

1303 PROV Admixtures For Concrete Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

1305 COMM Moisture Vapour Barriers Nov 2008 Aug 27, 2015

1306 COMM Burlap Nov 2011 Mar 15, 2012

1308 COMM Joint Filler in Concrete Nov 2003 Apr 21, 2004

1312 COMM Latex Modifiers For Use In Concrete Sep 1996 Sep 1, 1996

1315 COMM White Pigmented Curing Compounds For Concrete Sep 1996 Sep 1, 1996

1350 PROV Concrete - Materials and Production Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

1351 COMM Precast Reinforced Concrete Components for Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, Ditch Inlets and Valve Chambers

Nov 2004 Jan 19, 2005

1352 COMM Precast Concrete Barriers Nov 1989 Nov 1, 1989

1359 COMM Unshrinkable Backfill May 1993 May 1, 1993

DIVISION 14 - METAL

1430 COMM Gabion Baskets and Mats Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

1440 PROV Steel Reinforcement for Concrete Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

1441 COMM Load Transfer Assemblies Sep 1988 Sep 1, 1988

1442 COMM Epoxy Coated Steel Reinforcement for Concrete May 1994 May 1, 1994

1443 COMM Organic Coatings for Steel Reinforcement May 1994 May 1, 1994

DIVISION 15 – SAFETY RELATED

1503 COMM Cable Guide Rail Nov 2010 Dec 16, 2010

1504 PROV Steel Beam Guide Rail Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

1505 PROV Channel Components for Steel Beam Guide Rail Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

1540 COMM Standard Highway Fence Components Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

1541 COMM Chain-Link Fence Components Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

DIVISION 16 – WOOD AND PLASTICS

1601 PROV Wood, Preservative Treatment and Shop Fabrication Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

1605 COMM Expanded Extruded Polystyrene Pavement Insulation Nov 1989 Nov 1, 1989

DIVISION 17 - COATINGS

1704 PROV Paint Coating Systems for Structural Steel Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

1712 COMM Organic Solvent Based Traffic Paint Feb 1991 Feb 1, 1991

1713 COMM Thermoplastic Pavement Marking Materials Feb 1991 Feb 1, 1991

1714 COMM Field Reacted Polymeric Pavement Marking Materials Feb 1991 Feb 1, 1991

1715 COMM Performed Plastic Pavement Marking Tape Feb 1991 Feb 1, 1991

1716 COMM Water-Borne Traffic Paint Feb 1991 Feb 1, 1991

1750 COMM Traffic Paint Reflectorizing Glass Beads Dec 1983 Dec 1, 1983

August 2017 Page 6 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 833: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

DIVISION 18 – PIPES AND ASSOCIATED DRAINAGE ITEMS

1801 COMM Corrugated Steel Pipe (CSP) Products Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

1802 COMM Smooth Walled Steel Pipe Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

1820 PROV Circular and Elliptical Concrete Pipe Nov 2014 Jan 8, 2015

1821 COMM Precast Reinforced Concrete Box Culverts and Box Sewers May 1993 May 1, 1993

1840 COMM Non-Pressure Polyethylene Plastic Pipe Products Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

1841 COMM Non-Pressure Polyvinyl Chloride Pipe Products Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

1842 COMM Pressure Polyethylene Pipe Products Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

1843 COMM Non-Pressure Polypropylene (PP) Plastic Pipe Products Nov 2013 Jun 12, 2014

1850 COMM Frames, Grates, Covers and Gratings Apr 2013 Jun 20, 2013

1854 COMM High Density Polyethylene (HDPE) and Expanded Polystyrene (EPS) Adjustment Units for Maintenance Holes, Catch Basins, and Valve Chambers

Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

1860 COMM Geotextiles Apr 2012 Jul 5, 2012

DIVISION 19 - ENVIRONMENTAL

Currently no specifications.

DIVISION 20 – SIGNS AND SIGN SUPPORTS

2001 COMM Signs Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

DIVISION 21 – CLOTHING, CLOTH AND THE LIKE

Currently no specifications.

DIVISION 22 - UNASSIGNED

Currently no specifications.

DIVISION 23 - MISCELLANEOUS

2301 PROV Impressed Cathodic Protection System for Bridge Structures Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

DIVISION 24 – ELECTRICAL

2401 COMM Electrical Handholes Nov 2010 Jun 2, 2011

2409 COMM Traffic Signal Cable Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

2410 COMM Extra Low Voltage Cable Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

2414 COMM Power Supply Equipment Nov 2014 Feb 26, 2015

2420 COMM Wood Poles Nov 2010 Jun 2, 2011

2421 COMM Spun Concrete Poles Nov 2012 Mar 7, 2013

2422 PROV Heavy Class Steel and Sectional Steel Poles, Base Mounted Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

2423 PROV Steel Poles, Base Mounting Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

2426 COMM Steel Truss Brackets Nov 2007 Dec 20, 2007

August 2017 Page 7 of 8 CDED D-205

Page 834: CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND …...CONTINUING RECORD OF REVISIONS MADE to the CONTRACT DESIGN, ESTIMATING AND DOCUMENTATION (CDED) MANUAL VOLUMES 1, 2A and 2B This sheet should

CHAPTER D List of Active OPSSs

OPSS Type Title Issue Date

Imp. Date

2428 COMM Aluminum Tapered Elliptical Brackets Nov 2007 Dec 20, 2007

2432 COMM High Pressure Sodium Luminaires for Highway Lighting Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

2434 PROV High Pressure Sodium Luminaires for Underpass Lighting Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

2452 COMM Aluminum Poles, Base Mounting Nov 2010 Jun 2, 2011

2453 PROV Sectional Steel Poles Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

2460 COMM Traffic Signal Arms, Brackets, Hangers, Fittings and Hardware Nov 2009 Mar 11, 2010

2461 PROV Signal Heads Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

2471 PROV Sectional Steel High Mast Lighting Poles Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

2474 PROV Anchorage Assembly - High Mast Lighting Pole Nov 2016 Jan 12, 2017

2475 PROV Uninterruptible Power Supply Systems for LED Traffic Signals Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

2476 COMM Raising and Lowering Equipment for High Mast Poles Nov 2010 Jun 2, 2011

2479 COMM Floodlight Luminaires used in High Mast Lighting Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

2485 COMM Photoelectric Controllers Nov 2015 Mar 3, 2016

2492 COMM Rigid Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Junction Boxes Sep 1984 Sep 1, 1984

DIVISION 25 - CHEMICALS

2502 PROV Sodium Chloride Apr 2017 Jun 8, 2017

2510 COMM Tall Oil Pitch Emulsion Nov 2015 Jan 28, 2016

August 2017 Page 8 of 8 CDED D-205